As filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on December 4, 2006
Registration No.  333-           
 
 
UNITED STATES SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549
 
Form  F-1
REGISTRATION STATEMENT
UNDER
THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933
 
TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS L.P.
(Exact name of Registrant as specified in its charter)
 
         
Republic of the Marshall Islands   4400   Not Applicable
(State or other jurisdiction of
incorporation or organization)
  (Primary Standard Industrial
Classification Code Number)
  (I.R.S. Employer
Identification Number)
Bayside House, Bayside Executive Park
West Bay Street and Blake Road
P.O. Box AP-59212
Nassau, Commonwealth of the Bahamas
(242) 502-8820
(Address, including zip code, and telephone number, including area code, of registrant’s principal executive offices)
Watson, Farley & Williams (New York) LLP
Attention: Daniel C. Rodgers
100 Park Avenue, 31st Floor
New York, New York 10017
(212) 922-2200
(Name, address, including zip code, and telephone number, including area code, of agent for service)
 
Copies to:
     
David Matheson
Christopher Hall
Perkins Coie LLP
1120 N.W. Couch Street, 10th Floor
Portland, Oregon 97209
(503) 727-2000
  Alan Baden
Catherine Gallagher
Vinson & Elkins L.L.P.
666 Fifth Avenue, 26th Floor
New York, NY 10103
(212) 237-0000
 
     Approximate date of commencement of proposed sale to the public: As soon as practicable after this Registration Statement becomes effective.
 
     If any of the securities being registered on this Form are to be offered on a delayed or continuous basis pursuant to Rule 415 under the Securities Act of 1933, check the following box.     o
     If this Form is filed to register additional securities for an offering pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering.     o
     If this Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(c) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering.     o
     If this Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(d) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering.     o
 
CALCULATION OF REGISTRATION FEE
               
               
               
      Proposed Maximum     Amount of  
Title of Each Class of     Aggregate Offering     Registration  
Securities To be Registered     Price(1)(2)     Fee  
               
Common units, representing limited partner interests
    $169,050,000     $18,089  
               
               
(1)  Includes common units issuable upon exercise of the underwriters’ over-allotment option.
 
(2)  Estimated solely for the purpose of calculating the registration fee pursuant to Rule 457(o).
 
     The Registrant hereby amends this Registration Statement on such date or dates as may be necessary to delay its effective date until the Registrant shall file a further amendment which specifically states that this Registration Statement shall thereafter become effective in accordance with Section 8(a) of the Securities Act of 1933 or until the registration statement shall become effective on such date as the Securities and Exchange Commission, acting pursuant to said Section 8(a), may determine.
 
 


 

The information in this prospectus is not complete and may be changed. We may not sell these securities until the registration statement filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission is effective. This prospectus is not an offer to sell these securities and it is not soliciting an offer to buy these securities in any jurisdiction where the offer or sale is not permitted.

SUBJECT TO COMPLETION, DATED DECEMBER 4, 2006
PROSPECTUS
7,000,000 Common Units
Representing Limited Partner Interests
(TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS LOGO)
Teekay Offshore Partners L.P.
$              per common unit
 
    We are selling 7,000,000 common units. We have granted the underwriters an option to purchase up to 1,050,000 additional common units to cover over-allotments, if any.
    We are a Marshall Islands limited partnership recently formed by Teekay Shipping Corporation, a leading provider of marine services to the global oil and natural gas industries, as part of its strategy to expand its operations in the offshore oil marine transportation, processing and storage sectors. Immediately following this offering, we will own a 26.0% interest in and control Teekay Offshore Operating L.P., a Marshall Islands limited partnership (or OPCO ), which will own substantially all of the offshore oil transportation and storage assets of Teekay Shipping Corporation. Although we are organized as a partnership, we have elected to be taxed as a corporation solely for U.S. federal income tax purposes. This is the initial public offering of our common units. We currently expect the initial public offering price to be between $19.00 and $21.00 per common unit. Our common units have been approved for listing on the New York Stock Exchange, subject to official notice of issuance, under the symbol “TOO.”
 
Investing in our common units involves risks. Please read “Risk Factors” beginning on page 18.
    These risks include the following:
       •  Because our partnership interest in OPCO currently represents our only cash-generating asset, our cash flow initially will depend completely on OPCO’s ability to make distributions to its partners, including us.
 
       •  We may not have sufficient cash from operations to enable us to pay the minimum quarterly distribution on our common units.
 
       •  OPCO must make substantial capital expenditures to maintain and expand the operating capacity of its fleet, which will reduce our cash available for distribution.
 
       •  OPCO’s substantial debt levels may limit its or our flexibility in obtaining additional financing, pursuing other business opportunities and our paying distributions to you.
 
       •  OPCO derives a substantial majority of its revenues from a limited number of customers, and the loss of any such customer could result in a significant loss of revenues and cash flow.
 
       •  We depend on Teekay Shipping Corporation to assist us and OPCO in operating our businesses and competing in our markets.
 
       •  Our growth depends on continued growth in demand for offshore oil transportation, processing and storage services.
 
       •  Because payments under OPCO’s contracts of affreightment are based on the volume of oil it transports, the utilization of OPCO’s shuttle tanker fleet and the success of its shuttle tanker business depends upon continued production from existing or new oil fields it services, which is beyond our or OPCO’s control and generally declines naturally over time.
 
       •  Teekay Shipping Corporation and its affiliates may engage in competition with OPCO and us.
 
       •  Our general partner and its affiliates have conflicts of interest and limited fiduciary duties, which may permit them to favor their own interests to your detriment.
 
       •  Our general partner, which is owned and controlled by Teekay Shipping Corporation, makes all decisions on our behalf, subject to the limited voting rights of our common unitholders.
 
       •  Even if public unitholders are dissatisfied, they cannot initially remove our general partner without Teekay Shipping Corporation’s consent.
 
       •  You will experience immediate and substantial dilution of $15.72 per common unit.
 
       •  Our general partner has a call right that may require you to sell your common units at an undesirable time or price.
 
       •  We will be subject to taxes, which will reduce our cash available for distribution to you.
    Neither the Securities and Exchange Commission nor any state securities commission has approved or disapproved of these securities or determined if this prospectus is truthful or complete. Any representation to the contrary is a criminal offense.
 
                 
    Per Common Unit   Total
         
Public Offering Price
  $       $    
Underwriting Discount(1)
  $       $    
Proceeds to Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. (before expenses)
  $       $    
 
(1)  Excludes structuring fee of $       .
      The underwriters expect to deliver the common units to purchasers on or about                    , 2006.
 
Citigroup Merrill Lynch & Co.
 
Morgan Stanley A.G. Edwards Deutsche Bank Securities Raymond James
Simmons & Company DnB NOR Markets Fortis Securities
           International
The date of this prospectus is                     , 2006.


 

LOGO LOGO
LOGO
LOGO LOGO


 

TABLE OF CONTENTS
           
    Page
     
    1  
      1  
      2  
      3  
      3  
      4  
      4  
      7  
      7  
      7  
      9  
      12  
    18  
      18  
      33  
      41  
    44  
    45  
    46  
    47  
      47  
      49  
      53  
      59  
    64  
      64  
      65  
      67  
      69  
      69  
      70  
      71  
      71  
      72  
      72  
    74  
    79  
      79  
      81  
      82  
      83  
      85  
      97  
      101  
 
Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements
    102  
      102  

i


 

           
    Page
     
 
Recent Accounting Pronouncements
    105  
      105  
    108  
      108  
      110  
      116  
      118  
      120  
    124  
      124  
      125  
      125  
      126  
      127  
      130  
      130  
      133  
      134  
      135  
      136  
      137  
      141  
      141  
      141  
    154  
      154  
      155  
      156  
      157  
      157  
      157  
      158  
    160  
    161  
      161  
      162  
      163  
      166  
      167  
      168  
      168  
      169  
      169  
    170  
      170  
      174  

ii


 

           
    Page
     
    177  
      177  
      177  
      177  
    179  
      179  
      179  
      179  
      179  
      179  
      181  
      182  
      183  
      184  
      185  
      185  
      185  
      187  
      187  
      187  
      187  
      188  
      188  
      189  
      189  
      190  
      190  
      190  
      190  
    191  
    192  
      192  
      192  
      196  
      196  
    198  
      198  
      198  
    200  
    202  
    206  
    206  
    206  
    207  
    207  
    208  
    209  

iii


 

         
    Page
     
    F-1  
APPENDIX A Form of First Amended and Restated Agreement of Limited Partnership of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. 
    A-1  
APPENDIX B Glossary of Terms
    B-1  
 
      You should rely only on the information contained in this prospectus. We have not, and the underwriters have not, authorized any other person to provide you with different information. If anyone provides you with different or inconsistent information, you should not rely on it. We are not, and the underwriters are not, making an offer to sell these securities in any jurisdiction where an offer or sale is not permitted. You should assume that the information appearing in this prospectus is accurate as of the date on the front cover of this prospectus only. Our business, financial condition, results of operations and prospects may have changed since that date.

iv


 

SUMMARY
      This summary highlights information contained elsewhere in this prospectus. Unless we otherwise specify, all information and data in this prospectus about our business and fleet refer to the business and fleet that will be contributed to us as of the closing of this offering. You should read the entire prospectus carefully, including the historical and pro forma financial statements and the notes to those financial statements. The information presented in this prospectus assumes (a) an initial public offering price of $20.00 per unit and (b) unless otherwise noted, that the underwriters’ over-allotment option is not exercised. You should read “Risk Factors” for information about important factors that you should consider before buying the common units.
      All references in this prospectus to “our,” “we,” “us” and “the Partnership” refer to Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. and its subsidiaries, including Teekay Offshore Operating L.P. (or OPCO). All references in this prospectus to “OPCO” when used in a historical context refer to OPCO’s predecessor companies and their subsidiaries, and when used in the present tense or prospectively refer to OPCO and its subsidiaries, collectively, or to OPCO individually, as the context may require. Please read Note 1 to the audited combined consolidated financial statements of Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor included elsewhere in this prospectus for a description of OPCO’s predecessor companies. Upon the completion of this offering, Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. will own a 25.99% limited partner interest in OPCO as well as the 0.01% general partner interest in OPCO through its ownership of OPCO’s general partner, Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C. References in this prospectus to “Teekay Shipping Corporation” refer, depending upon the context, to Teekay Shipping Corporation and/or any one or more of its subsidiaries. References in this prospectus to “our general partner” refer to Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C. References to “Petrojarl ASA” refer to Petrojarl ASA, which was renamed Teekay Petrojarl ASA on December 1, 2006. We include a glossary of some of the terms used in this prospectus in Appendix B. Unless otherwise indicated, all references to “dollars” and “$” in this prospectus are to, and amounts are presented in, U.S. Dollars.
Teekay Offshore Partners L.P.
      We are an international provider of marine transportation and storage services to the offshore oil industry. We were formed in August 2006 by Teekay Shipping Corporation (NYSE: TK), a leading provider of marine services to the global oil and natural gas industries, to further develop its operations in the offshore market. We plan to leverage the expertise, relationships and reputation of Teekay Shipping Corporation and our controlled affiliates to pursue growth opportunities in this market. Upon the closing of this offering, Teekay Shipping Corporation will own a 65.0% interest in us, including a 2.0% general partner interest through our general partner, which Teekay Shipping Corporation owns and controls.
      Upon the closing of this offering, we will own a 26.0% interest in Teekay Offshore Operating L.P. (or OPCO ), which owns and operates the world’s largest fleet of shuttle tankers, in addition to floating storage and offtake (or FSO ) units and double-hull conventional oil tankers. We will control OPCO through our ownership of its general partner, and Teekay Shipping Corporation will own the remaining 74.0% interest in OPCO.
      In addition to OPCO’s activities, we intend to expand our marine transportation and storage services to include floating production, storage and offloading (or FPSO ) units, which produce and process oil offshore in addition to providing storage and offtake.
      OPCO’s fleet currently consists of:
  •  Shuttle Tankers  — 36 shuttle tankers, 24 of which are owned fully or jointly and 12 of which are chartered-in, and all of which operate under contracts of affreightment for various offshore oil fields or under fixed-rate time charter or bareboat charter contracts for specific oil field installations. The majority of the contract of affreightment volumes are life-of -field, which, according to data provided by Wood MacKenzie Ltd., have a weighted-average remaining life of 16 years. The time charters and bareboat charters have an average remaining contract term of approximately 6 years.
        A shuttle tanker is a specialized ship designed to transport crude oil and condensates from offshore oil field installations to onshore terminals and refineries. Shuttle tankers are equipped with sophisticated loading and positioning systems that allow the vessels to load cargo safely and reliably

1


 

from oil field installations, even in harsh weather conditions. Demand for shuttle tanker services is projected to grow significantly due to expected growth in worldwide offshore crude oil production, particularly in deep water and remote areas. According to Douglas-Westwood Ltd., worldwide oil transported via shuttle tankers is expected to increase from approximately 3.3 million barrels per day in 2006 to approximately 4.5 million barrels per day in 2015.
  •  FSO Units  — 4 FSO units, all of which are owned and operate under fixed-rate contracts with an average remaining term of approximately 5 years. An FSO unit provides on-site storage for an oil field installation that has no storage facilities or that requires supplemental storage. According to International Maritime Associates (or IMA ), over the next five years the world FSO fleet will increase from 86 to between 117 and 127 units.
 
  •  Conventional Oil Tankers  — 9 Aframax-class conventional crude oil tankers, all of which are owned and operate under fixed-rate time charters with Teekay Shipping Corporation with an average remaining term of approximately 8 years.
      In June 2006, Teekay Shipping Corporation entered into an agreement with Petrojarl ASA to form a joint venture company called Teekay Petrojarl Offshore through which the joint venture partners have agreed to exclusively pursue new opportunities involving FPSO and FSO units. Petrojarl ASA is one of the largest independent FPSO operators and deployed the first FPSO in the North Sea in 1986. Pursuant to an omnibus agreement we will enter into upon the closing of this offering, Teekay Shipping Corporation will offer to us its interest in certain future FPSO and FSO projects under the joint venture agreement. On October 18, 2006, Teekay Shipping Corporation completed a tender offer for the outstanding shares of Petrojarl ASA, resulting in Teekay Shipping Corporation owning a majority of, and having the ability to control, Petrojarl. Demand for FPSO units is projected to grow significantly due to expected growth in worldwide crude oil production, particularly in deep waters and remote areas. According to IMA, over the next five years the world FPSO fleet will increase from 111 units to between 198 and 209 units.
      Under the omnibus agreement, Teekay Shipping Corporation also will be obligated to offer to us prior to the end of the second quarter of 2008 the opportunity to acquire two shuttle tankers and one FSO unit currently undergoing conversion from conventional oil tankers or being upgraded. The two shuttle tankers will operate under 13-year bareboat charters and the FSO unit will operate under a 7-year time charter. Teekay Shipping Corporation will also be obligated to offer to us under the omnibus agreement certain other shuttle tankers, FSO units and FPSO units it may acquire in the future.
      Teekay Shipping Corporation formed OPCO in September 2006 and has subsequently transferred to it a majority of OPCO’s operating assets. These transactions and additional transactions relating to OPCO that will occur prior to or at the closing of this offering and described in this prospectus will affect OPCO’s results compared to the historical results of its predecessors. The most significant of these changes are described in this prospectus under “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Items You Should Consider When Evaluating Our Historical Financial Performance and Assessing Our Future Prospects.”
Business Opportunities
      We believe the following industry dynamics create a favorable environment to expand our business:
  •  Growing offshore oil production. The following trends forecasted by Douglas-Westwood Ltd. should support continued growth in the offshore sector:
  •  offshore oil production will grow from approximately 33% of global oil production in 2005 to approximately 37% by 2015;
 
  •  deepwater oil production will increase from approximately 3 million barrels per day in 2005, or 12% of offshore production, to over 8 million barrels per day in 2015, or approximately 25% of offshore production; and
 
  •  after 2010, all growth in global offshore oil production will be from deep waters.
  We believe this forecasted growth in deepwater offshore oil production will increase demand for shuttle tankers and FPSO units compared to pipelines or fixed production platforms, which may not be economical or technically feasible in deep waters and remote areas.

2


 

  •  Increased outsourcing of offshore services. We believe there is a growing trend among major oil companies to outsource to independent contractors offshore transportation, processing and storage functions. We also believe there is a growing number of smaller oil companies entering the offshore sector, as oil demand and prices drive future exploration and production. Smaller oil companies generally outsource their offshore service requirements due to capital expenditure constraints and lack of in-house expertise. These smaller companies primarily focus on marginal or remote projects, which favor the employment of shuttle tankers, FSO units and FPSO units.
 
  •  Customer demand for dependable and integrated solutions. Many offshore projects, particularly those located in deep water or remote locations, require a combination of the types of offshore services OPCO provides. Major oil companies are highly selective in their choice of contractors to provide these services due to the high level of capital investment and the need for uninterrupted production from the oil fields. We believe we can bundle services and offer a reliable, integrated “one-stop-shop” solution for customers in the offshore sector.
      We can provide no assurance, however, that the industry dynamics described above will continue or that we will be able to expand our business.
Competitive Strengths
      We believe that we are well positioned to execute our business strategies successfully because of the following competitive strengths:
  •  Leading position in the shuttle tanker sector. OPCO is the world’s largest owner and operator of shuttle tankers, as it owned or operated 36 of the 58 vessels in the world shuttle tanker fleet as at November 1, 2006. OPCO’s large fleet size ensures that it can provide comprehensive coverage of charterers’ requirements and provides opportunities to enhance the efficiency of operations and increase fleet utilization.
 
  •  Offshore operational expertise and enhanced growth opportunities through our relationship with Teekay Shipping Corporation. Teekay Shipping Corporation has achieved a global brand name in the shipping industry and the offshore market, developed an extensive network of long-standing relationships with major oil companies and earned a reputation for reliability, safety and excellence. We expect to benefit from Teekay Shipping Corporation’s over 25-year history of providing shuttle tanker and offshore services to customers through access to its personnel, pursuant to services agreements, and its competitiveness in bidding for new projects. Additionally, we expect to benefit from improved leverage with leading shipyards during periods of vessel production constraints and from Teekay Shipping Corporation’s control of and joint venture with Petrojarl ASA and our rights to participate in certain Petrojarl FPSO projects under the omnibus agreement.
 
  •  Cash flow stability from contracts with leading energy companies. We benefit from stability in cash flows due to the long-term, fixed-rate contracts underlying most of OPCO’s business. OPCO is able to secure long-term contracts because its services are an integrated part of offshore oil field projects and a critical part of the logistics chain of the fields.
 
  •  Disciplined vessel acquisition strategy and successful project execution. OPCO’s fleet has been built through successful new project tenders and acquisitions, and this strategy has contributed significantly to its leading position in the shuttle tanker market.
 
  •  Financial flexibility to pursue acquisitions and other expansion opportunities. We believe our financial flexibility will provide us with acquisition and expansion opportunities. OPCO has access to approximately $1.6 billion under credit facilities for working capital and acquisition purposes, approximately $300 million of which we anticipate will be undrawn.
Business Strategies
      Our primary business objective is to increase distributions per unit by executing the following strategies:
  •  Expand global operations in high growth regions. As offshore exploration and production activity continues to accelerate worldwide, we will seek to continue to expand shuttle tanker and FSO unit operations into growing offshore markets such as Brazil and Australia. In addition, we intend to

3


 

  pursue opportunities in new markets such as Arctic Russia, Eastern Canada, the Gulf of Mexico, Asia and Africa.
 
  •  Pursue opportunities in the FPSO sector. We believe Teekay Shipping Corporation’s control of and joint venture with Petrojarl ASA will enable us to competitively pursue FPSO projects anywhere in the world by combining Petrojarl’s engineering and operational expertise with Teekay Shipping Corporation’s global marketing organization and extensive customer and shipyard relationships.
 
  •  Acquire additional vessels on long-term fixed-rate contracts. We intend to continue acquiring shuttle tankers and FSO units with long-term contracts, rather than ordering vessels on a speculative basis, and we intend to follow this same practice in acquiring FPSO units. We also anticipate growing by acquiring additional limited partner interests in OPCO that Teekay Shipping Corporation may offer us in the future.
 
  •  Provide superior customer service by maintaining high reliability, safety, environmental and quality standards. Energy companies seek transportation partners that have a reputation for high reliability, safety, environmental and quality standards. We intend to leverage OPCO’s and Teekay Shipping Corporation’s operational expertise and customer relationships to further expand a sustainable competitive advantage with consistent delivery of superior customer service.
 
  •  Manage the conventional tanker fleet to provide stable cash flows. The terms for OPCO’s existing long-term conventional tanker charters are 5 to 12 years. We believe the fixed-rate time charters for these tankers will provide stable cash flows during their terms and a source of funding for expanding offshore operations.
Risk Factors
      An investment in our common units involves risks associated with our business, our partnership structure and the tax characteristics of our common units. Those risks are described under the caption “Risk Factors” immediately following this summary beginning on page 18.
The Transactions
      We were recently formed as a Marshall Islands limited partnership to hold an interest in OPCO and its subsidiaries, which own and operate a fleet of shuttle tankers, FSO units and conventional oil tankers, and to hold interests in other entities through which we may expand our business.
      Prior to the closing of this offering, Teekay Shipping Corporation and OPCO have entered, or will enter, into transactions by which, among other things, OPCO will acquire its fleet of 36 shuttle tankers, four FSO units and nine Aframax-class conventional tankers. In addition, in October 2006 OPCO amended an existing credit facility to provide for borrowings of up to $455 million and entered into a new $940 million revolving credit facility. Prior to the closing, OPCO will pay a dividend to Teekay Shipping Corporation in an amount sufficient to decrease OPCO’s cash balance to $90.0 million, which dividend would have been $154.1 million as of June 30, 2006 and which we anticipate will be approximately $160 million based on our estimated cash balance at the closing of this offering. For a description of these transactions, please read Notes 1 and 3 to our pro forma consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this prospectus.
      At or prior to the closing of this offering, the following transactions will occur to transfer to us a 26.0% interest in OPCO and effect the public offering of our common units:
  •  Teekay Shipping Corporation will transfer to us a 25.99% limited partner interest in OPCO and will transfer to us its 100% interest in Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C., which holds a 0.01% general partner interest in OPCO;
 
  •  we will issue to Teekay Shipping Corporation 2,800,000 common units and 9,800,000 subordinated units, representing a 63.0% limited partner interest in us, and non-interest bearing promissory notes with an aggregate principal amount approximating the net proceeds of this offering (the TSC Notes );
 
  •  we will issue to Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C., a wholly owned subsidiary of Teekay Shipping Corporation, the 2.0% general partner interest in us and all of our incentive distribution rights,

4


 

  which will entitle our general partner to increasing percentages of the cash we distribute in excess of $0.4025 per unit per quarter; and
 
  •  we will issue 7,000,000 common units to the public in this offering, representing a 35.0% limited partner interest in us, and will use the net proceeds of this offering, estimated at $127.8 million, to repay the TSC Notes. Please read “Use of Proceeds.”
      In addition, at or prior to the closing of this offering:
  •  we will enter into an omnibus agreement with Teekay Shipping Corporation, our general partner and others governing, among other things:
  •  when we and Teekay Shipping Corporation may compete with each other; and
 
  •  certain rights of first offer on shuttle tankers, FSO units, FPSO units and conventional oil tankers;
  •  we, OPCO and operating subsidiaries of OPCO will enter into various services agreements with certain subsidiaries of Teekay Shipping Corporation pursuant to which those subsidiaries will agree to provide to us and OPCO administrative services and to OPCO’s operating subsidiaries strategic consulting, advisory, ship management, technical and/or administrative services; and
 
  •  operating subsidiaries of OPCO will enter into fixed-rate time-charter contracts with Teekay Shipping Corporation pursuant to which Teekay Shipping Corporation will charter OPCO’s nine conventional oil tankers for initial terms ranging from approximately 5 to 12 years, with an average term of approximately 8 years.
      For further details on our agreements with Teekay Shipping Corporation and OPCO’s credit facilities, please read “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions” and “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Liquidity and Capital Resources — Credit Facilities.”
Holding Company Structure
      We are a holding entity and will conduct our operations and business through controlled affiliates, as is common with publicly traded limited partnerships, to maximize operational flexibility. Initially, we will conduct all of our operations through OPCO and its subsidiaries. We intend to conduct additional operations in the future through wholly owned subsidiaries.

5


 

Organizational Structure After the Transactions
      The following diagram depicts our organizational structure after giving effect to the transactions described above:
         
Public Common Units
    35.0 %
Teekay Shipping Corporation’s Common Units
    14.0  
Teekay Shipping Corporation’s Subordinated Units
    49.0  
Teekay Shipping Corporation’s General Partner Interest
    2.0  
       
      100.0 %
       
(GRAPH)

6


 

Management of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P.
      Our general partner, Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C., a Marshall Islands limited liability company, will manage our operations and activities. The Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer and three of the directors of Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C. also serve as executive officers or directors of Teekay Shipping Corporation and of the general partner of Teekay LNG Partners L.P. (NYSE: TGP). For more information about these individuals, please read “Management — Directors and Executive Officers of Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C.”
      Our wholly owned subsidiary, Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C., the general partner of OPCO, will manage OPCO’s operations and activities. The board of directors of our general partner has the authority to appoint and elect the directors of Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C., who in turn appoint the officers of Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C. Certain directors and officers of our general partner also serve as directors or executive officers of OPCO’s general partner. The partnership agreement of OPCO will provide that certain actions relating to OPCO must be approved by the board of directors of our general partner on our behalf. These actions will include, among other things, establishing maintenance capital and other cash reserves and the determination of the amount of quarterly distributions by OPCO to its partners, including us. Please read “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions — OPCO Partnership Agreement and Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C. Limited Liability Company Agreement.”
      Unlike shareholders in a publicly traded corporation, our unitholders will not be entitled to elect our general partner or its directors.
      Our general partner will not receive any management fee or other compensation in connection with its management of our business, but it will be entitled to be reimbursed for all direct and indirect expenses incurred on our behalf. Our general partner will also be entitled to distributions on its general partner interest and, if specified requirements are met, on its incentive distribution rights. Please read “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions” and “Management — Reimbursement of Expenses of Our General Partner.”
      We, OPCO and operating subsidiaries of OPCO will enter into various services agreements with certain subsidiaries of Teekay Shipping Corporation pursuant to which those subsidiaries will provide to us and OPCO all of our and OPCO’s administrative services and to OPCO’s operating subsidiaries substantially all of their strategic consulting, advisory, ship management, technical and/or administrative services. Please read “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions — Advisory and Administrative Services Agreements.”
Principal Executive Offices and Internet Address; SEC Filing Requirements
      Our principal executive offices are located at Bayside House, Bayside Executive Park, West Bay Street and Blake Road, Nassau, Commonwealth of The Bahamas, and our phone number is (242) 502-8820. Our website is located at http://www.teekayoffshore.com. We expect to make our periodic reports and other information filed with or furnished to the SEC available, free of charge, through our website, as soon as reasonably practicable after those reports and other information are electronically filed with or furnished to the SEC. Information on our website or any other website, including Teekay Shipping Corporation’s website, is not incorporated by reference into this prospectus and does not constitute a part of this prospectus. Please see “Where You Can Find More Information” for an explanation of our reporting requirements as a foreign private issuer.
Summary of Conflicts of Interest and Fiduciary Duties
      Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C., our general partner, has a legal duty to manage us in a manner beneficial to our unitholders. This legal duty is commonly referred to as a “fiduciary” duty. However, because Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C. is owned by Teekay Shipping Corporation, the officers and directors of Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C. also have fiduciary duties to manage the business of Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C. in a manner beneficial to Teekay Shipping Corporation. In addition:
  •  the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer and three of the directors of Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C. also serve as executive officers or directors of Teekay Shipping Corporation

7


 

  and of the general partner of Teekay LNG Partners L.P. and as the executive officers and directors of OPCO’s general partner;
 
  •  Teekay Shipping Corporation and its other affiliates may engage in competition with us; and
 
  •  we have entered into arrangements, and may enter into additional arrangements, with Teekay Shipping Corporation and certain of its subsidiaries relating to the chartering of certain vessels, the provision of certain services and other matters.
Please read “Management” and “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions.”
      The general partner of OPCO has a fiduciary duty to manage OPCO in a manner beneficial to us, as the general partner’s owner, and to OPCO’s limited partners, including us and Teekay Shipping Corporation. Our general partner’s board of directors will appoint the directors of OPCO’s general partner. The board of directors of our general partner, which includes some of the directors and executive officers of Teekay Shipping Corporation, may resolve any conflict between the interests of us and our unitholders and Teekay Shipping Corporation and its affiliates, and has broad latitude to consider the interests of all parties to the conflict. The resolution of these conflicts may not be in the best interest of us or our unitholders.
      As a result of these relationships, conflicts of interest may arise in the future between us and our unitholders, on the one hand, and Teekay Shipping Corporation and its other affiliates, including our general partner and OPCO, on the other hand. For a more detailed description of the conflicts of interest and fiduciary duties of our general partner, please read “Conflicts of Interest and Fiduciary Duties.”
      In addition, our partnership agreement contains provisions that reduce the standards to which our general partner would otherwise be held under Marshall Islands law. For example, our partnership agreement limits the liability and reduces the fiduciary duties of our general partner to our unitholders. Our partnership agreement also restricts the remedies available to unitholders. By purchasing a common unit, you are agreeing to the modified standard of fiduciary duties and to certain actions that may be taken by our general partner, all as set forth in the partnership agreement. Please read “Conflicts of Interest and Fiduciary Duties” for a description of the fiduciary duties that would otherwise be imposed on our general partner under Marshall Islands law, the material modifications of those duties contained in our partnership agreement and certain legal rights and remedies available to our unitholders under Marshall Islands law.
      For a description of other relationships we have with our affiliates, please read “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions.”

8


 

The Offering
Common units offered to the public 7,000,000 common units.

8,050,000 common units if the underwriters exercise their over-allotment option in full.
 
Units outstanding after this offering 9,800,000 common units and 9,800,000 subordinated units, each representing a 49.0% limited partner interest in us.
 
Use of proceeds We intend to use the net proceeds of this offering to repay non-interest bearing promissory notes we will issue to Teekay Shipping Corporation as partial consideration for our acquisition of our 26.0% interest in OPCO.
 
The net proceeds from any exercise of the underwriters’ over-allotment option will be used to redeem common units from Teekay Shipping Corporation equal to the number of units for which the underwriters exercise their over-allotment option.
 
Cash distributions We intend to make minimum quarterly distributions of $0.35 per common unit to the extent we have sufficient cash from operations after establishment of cash reserves and payment of fees and expenses, including payments to our general partner in reimbursement for all expenses incurred by it on our behalf. In general, we will pay any cash distributions we make each quarter in the following manner:
 
• first, 98.0% to the holders of common units and 2.0% to our general partner, until each common unit has received a minimum quarterly distribution of $0.35 plus any arrearages from prior quarters;
 
• second, 98.0% to the holders of subordinated units and 2.0% to our general partner, until each subordinated unit has received a minimum quarterly distribution of $0.35; and
 
• third, 98.0% to all unitholders, pro rata, and 2.0% to our general partner, until each unit has received an aggregate distribution of $0.4025.
 
If cash distributions exceed $0.4025 per unit in a quarter, our general partner will receive increasing percentages, up to 50.0% (including its 2.0% general partner interest), of the cash we distribute in excess of that amount. We refer to these distributions as “incentive distributions.”
 
We must distribute all of our cash on hand at the end of each quarter, less reserves established by our general partner to provide for the proper conduct of our business, to comply with any applicable debt instruments or to provide funds for future distributions. We refer to this cash as “available cash,” and we define its meaning in our partnership agreement and in the glossary of terms attached as Appendix B. The amount of available cash may be greater than or less than the aggregate amount of the minimum quarterly distributions to be distributed on all units.
 
The amount of available cash we need to pay the minimum quarterly distributions for four quarters on our common units, subordinated units and the 2.0% general partner interest to be outstanding immediately after this offering is $28.0 million.

9


 

We believe, based on the estimates contained in and the assumptions listed under “Our Cash Distribution Policy and Restrictions on Distributions — Pro Forma and Forecasted Cash Available for Distribution” and “— Summary of Significant Policies and Forecast Assumptions,” that we will have sufficient cash available for distributions to enable us to pay 100.0% of the minimum quarterly distribution of $0.35 per unit on all of our common and subordinated units for each full quarter through December 31, 2007.
 
Our pro forma cash available generated during 2005 and the twelve months ended June 30, 2006 would have been sufficient to allow us to pay 100.0% of the minimum quarterly distributions on our common units and 98.8% and 67.4%, respectively, of the minimum quarterly distributions on our subordinated units during those periods. Please read “Our Cash Distribution Policy and Restrictions on Distributions — Pro Forma and Forecasted Cash Available for Distribution.”
 
Subordinated units Teekay Shipping Corporation will initially own all of our subordinated units. The principal difference between our common units and subordinated units is that in any quarter during the subordination period, holders of the subordinated units are entitled to receive the minimum quarterly distribution of $0.35 per unit only after the common units have received the minimum quarterly distribution plus any cumulative arrearages in the payment of the minimum quarterly distribution from prior quarters. Subordinated units will not accrue arrearages. The subordination period generally will end if we have earned and paid at least $1.40 on each outstanding unit and the corresponding distribution on the 2.0% general partner interest for any three consecutive four- quarter periods ending on or after December 31, 2009. The subordination period may also end prior to December 31, 2009, if certain financial tests are met as described below.
 
When the subordination period ends, all subordinated units will convert into common units on a one-for-one basis, and the common units will no longer be entitled to arrearages.
 
Early conversion of subordinated units If we have earned and paid at least $2.10 (150.0% of the annualized minimum quarterly distribution) on each outstanding unit for any four-quarter period ending on or before the date of determination, the subordinated units will convert into common units. Please read “How We Make Cash Distributions — Subordination Period.”
 
Issuance of additional units Our partnership agreement allows us to issue an unlimited number of units without the consent of our unitholders.
 
Limited voting rights Our general partner will manage and operate us. Unlike the holders of common stock in a corporation, you will have only limited voting rights on matters affecting our business. You will have no right to elect our general partner or the directors of our general partner on an annual or other continuing basis. Our general partner may not be removed except by a vote of the holders of at least 66 2 / 3 % of the outstanding units, including any units owned by our general partner and its affiliates, voting

10


 

together as a single class. Upon consummation of this offering, Teekay Shipping Corporation will own an aggregate of approximately 64.3% of our common and subordinated units (approximately 58.9% if the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional common units in full). This initially will give Teekay Shipping Corporation the ability to prevent removal of our general partner. Please read “The Partnership Agreement — Voting Rights.”
 
Call right If at any time our general partner and its affiliates own more than 80.0% of the outstanding common units, our general partner has the right, but not the obligation, to purchase all, but not less than all, of the remaining common units at a price equal to the greater of (x) the average of the daily closing prices of the common units over the 20 trading days preceding the date three days before notice of exercise of the call right is first mailed and (y) the highest price paid by our general partner or any of its affiliates for common units during the 90-day period preceding the date such notice is first mailed. Our general partner is not obligated to obtain a fairness opinion regarding the value of the common units to be repurchased by it upon the exercise of this limited call right.
 
U.S. federal income tax
considerations
Although we are organized as a partnership, we have elected to be taxed as a corporation solely for U.S. federal income tax purposes. We believe that, under current U.S. federal income tax law, some portion of the distributions you receive from us will constitute dividends, and if you are an individual citizen or resident of the United States or a U.S. estate or trust and meet certain holding period requirements, such dividends are expected to be taxable as “qualified dividend income” currently subject to a maximum 15.0% U.S. federal income tax rate. Other distributions will be treated first as a non-taxable return of capital to the extent of your tax basis in your common units and, thereafter, as capital gain. We estimate that if you hold the common units that you purchase in this offering through the period ending December 31, 2009, the distributions you receive, on a cumulative basis, that will constitute dividends for U.S. federal income tax purposes will be approximately 70.0% of the total cash distributions you receive for that period. Please read “Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Considerations — United States Federal Income Taxation of U.S. Holders — Ratio of Dividend Income to Distributions” for the basis and assumptions for this estimate. Please also read “Risk Factors — Tax Risks” for a discussion of proposed legislation regarding qualified dividend income.
 
Exchange listing Our common units have been approved for listing on the New York Stock Exchange, subject to official notice of issuance, under the symbol “TOO.”

11


 

Summary Historical and Pro Forma Financial and Operating Data
      The following table presents, in each case for the periods and as at the dates indicated, summary:
  •  historical financial and operating data of Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor; and
 
  •  pro forma financial and operating data of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P.
      The summary historical financial and operating data has been prepared on the following basis:
  •  the historical financial and operating data of Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor as at and for the years ended December 31, 2001, 2002 and 2003 are derived from the unaudited combined consolidated financial statements of Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor, which are not included in this prospectus;
 
  •  the historical financial and operating data of Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor as at and for the years ended December 31, 2004 and 2005 are derived from the audited combined consolidated financial statements of Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor included elsewhere in this prospectus; and
 
  •  the historical financial and operating data of Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor as at and for the six months ended June 30, 2005 and June 30, 2006 are derived from the unaudited combined consolidated financial statements of Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor, which, other than the unaudited combined balance sheet as at June 30, 2005, are included elsewhere in this prospectus.
      The unaudited pro forma financial data of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. presented for the year ended December 31, 2005 and as at and for the six months ended June 30, 2006 are derived from our unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this prospectus. The pro forma income statement data for the year ended December 31, 2005 and for the six months ended June 30, 2006 assumes this offering and related transactions occurred on January 1, 2005. The pro forma balance sheet data assumes this offering and related transactions occurred on June 30, 2006. A more complete explanation of the pro forma data can be found in our unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements.
      Net voyage revenues ( i.e. voyage revenues less voyage expenses) for Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor for 2005, the six months ended June 30, 2005 and the six months ended June 30, 2006 were $733.0 million, $367.9 million and $338.4 million, respectively. The decrease in net voyage revenues from the first half of 2005 to the first half of 2006 was primarily due to:
  •  A decrease of $17.3 million from the conventional oil tanker segment. During the first six months of 2006, the average number of chartered-in conventional tankers was lower than the same period in 2005. All chartered-in conventional tankers were operated by Navion Shipping Ltd. On July 1, 2006, OPCO transferred Navion Shipping Ltd. to Teekay Shipping Corporation.
 
  •  A decrease of $12.2 million from the shuttle tanker segment, primarily due to the sale of two older shuttle tankers in March and October 2005 and a decrease from shuttle tankers servicing contracts of affreightment. In 2006, annual seasonal maintenance of North Sea oil field facilities primarily occurred in the second quarter instead of the third quarter, as is typical and as occurred in 2005. The annual maintenance season results in a decline in oil production on certain oil fields in the North Sea at which OPCO’s shuttle tankers are employed under contracts of affreightment.
      Net income for Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor for 2005 and the six months ended June 30, 2005 was $84.7 million and $69.2 million, respectively. Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor incurred a loss of $16.8 million for the six months ended June 30, 2006. The change from net income to a net loss from the first half of 2005 to the first half of 2006 was primarily due to:
  •  A decrease in revenues as stated above.
 
  •  Foreign exchange loss of $18.7 million in the first six months of 2006 compared to foreign exchange gain of $25.7 million for the same period in 2005. OPCO’s foreign currency exchange gains and losses, substantially all of which have been unrealized, are due primarily to the period-end revaluation of Norwegian Kroner-denominated advances from affiliates. Prior to the closing of this offering, OPCO’s debt will be in U.S. Dollars, which we believe will reduce the fluctuations in operating results from foreign exchange gains and losses.

12


 

  •  Income tax expense of $7.8 million in the first six months of 2006 compared to an income tax recovery of $15.8 million for the same period in 2005.
      Although results for the third quarter ended September 30, 2006 are not yet available, we expect higher net income than for the second quarter ended June 30, 2006, primarily due to higher revenues from our shuttle tanker segment and a small gain from the sale of an older shuttle tanker. Higher revenues expected in our shuttle tanker segment in the third quarter are primarily due to higher utilization of the shuttle tanker fleet as a result of the completion during the second quarter of seasonal maintenance of certain North Sea offshore oil facilities. In addition, time charter rates on certain shuttle tankers increased as a result of recent contract renewals at higher rates. We are not aware of any material events that occurred in the third quarter that we believe will have an adverse impact on the third quarter financial results or that change our forecast for the year ending December 31, 2007.
      The following table includes two financial measures, net voyage revenues and EBITDA, which we use in our business and are not calculated or presented in accordance with GAAP. We explain these measures and reconcile them to their most directly comparable financial measures calculated and presented in accordance with GAAP in “— Non-GAAP Financial Measures” below.

13


 

      The following table should be read together with, and is qualified in its entirety by reference to, the historical combined consolidated and unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements and the accompanying notes included elsewhere in this prospectus. The table should be read together with “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations.”
                                                                           
    Historical   Pro Forma
         
        Six    
        Months       Six
        Ended   Year   Months
    Years Ended December 31,   June 30,   Ended   Ended
            December 31,   June 30,
    2001   2002   2003   2004   2005   2005   2006   2005   2006
                                     
    (unaudited)   (audited)   (unaudited)   (unaudited)
                 
    (in thousands, except per unit and fleet data)
Income Statement Data:
                                                                       
Voyage revenues
    $137,258       $156,745       $747,383       $986,504       $807,548       $400,315       $386,724       $678,888       $349,299  
                                                       
Operating expenses:
                                                                       
 
Voyage expenses(1)
    7,447       8,894       146,893       118,819       74,543       32,400       48,344       93,935       60,186  
 
Vessel operating expenses(2)
    31,617       42,395       87,507       105,595       104,475       52,900       52,954       114,843       57,545  
 
Time-charter hire expenses
                235,976       372,449       373,536       176,276       165,935       145,423       76,288  
 
Depreciation and amortization
    45,167       49,579       93,269       118,460       107,542       55,620       51,331       116,922       56,138  
 
General and administrative
    10,424       11,733       33,968       65,819       85,856       37,838       43,469       61,546       32,265  
 
Vessel and equipment writedowns and (gain) loss on sale of vessels
                63       (3,725 )     2,820       5,369       1,845       (9,423 )     (305 )
 
Restructuring charge
                            955             453       955       453  
                                                       
Total operating expenses
    94,655       112,601       597,676       777,417       749,727       360,403       364,331       524,201       282,570  
                                                       
Income from vessel operations
    42,603       44,144       149,707       209,087       57,821       39,912       22,393       154,687       66,729  
Interest expense
    (31,090 )     (28,136 )     (46,872 )     (43,957 )     (39,791 )     (20,100 )     (24,504 )     (73,458 )     (36,961 )
Interest income
    999       549       1,278       2,459       4,605       2,271       3,291       5,265       3,834  
Equity income (loss) from joint ventures
    2,634       4,597       5,047       6,162       5,199       2,573       3,191       (971 )     (49 )
Gain (loss) on sale of marketable securities
    (1,415 )     (1,227 )     517       94,222                                
Foreign currency exchange gain (loss)(3)
    3,685       (35,121 )     (17,821 )     (37,910 )     34,178       25,730       (18,688 )     9,281       (4,339 )
Income tax recovery (expense)
    (4,963 )     (8,116 )     (30,035 )     (28,188 )     13,873       15,786       (7,762 )     13,873       (7,762 )
Other — net
    2,923       1,313       4,455       14,064       9,091       3,694       5,694       5,689       5,694  
Non-controlling interest
    (2,345 )     (1,212 )     (2,763 )     (2,167 )     (229 )     (692 )     (414 )     (87,248 )     (21,541 )
                                                       
Net income (loss)
    $13,031       $(23,209 )     $63,513       $213,772       $84,747       $69,174       $(16,799 )     $27,118       $5,605  
                                                       
Pro forma net income per common unit (basic and diluted)(4)
                                                            $1.40       $0.56  
 
Balance Sheet Data (at end of period):
                                                                       
Cash and marketable securities
    $32,605       $39,754       $160,957       $143,729       $128,986       $119,495       $133,962               $90,000  
Vessels and equipment(5)
    709,787       725,263       1,431,947       1,427,481       1,300,064       1,346,328       1,260,765               1,528,480  
Total assets
    878,816       1,002,452       2,037,855       2,040,642       1,884,017       1,913,756       1,866,330               2,038,218  
Total debt(6)
    456,761       673,074       1,354,392       1,210,998       991,855       1,045,094       971,992               1,317,314  
Non-controlling interest(7)
    13,199       14,412       15,525       14,276       11,859       14,597       11,770               437,450  
Total owner’s/partners’ equity
    369,287       262,835       529,794       659,212       740,379       727,052       727,801               138,405  
 
Cash Flow Data:
                                                                       
Net cash provided by (used in):
                                                                       
 
Operating activities
    $34,054       $12,110       $227,297       $242,592       $152,687       $81,232       $48,705                  
 
Financing activities
    298,471       151,340       731,329       (69,710 )     (201,554 )     (153,647 )     (42,602 )                
 
Investing activities
    (299,920 )     (156,301 )     (837,423 )     (190,110 )     34,124       48,182       (1,127 )                
 
Other Financial Data:
                                                                       
Net voyage revenues
    $129,811       $147,851       $600,490       $867,685       $733,005       $367,915       $338,380       $584,953       $289,113  
EBITDA(8)
    93,252       62,073       232,411       401,918       213,602       126,837       63,507       198,360       102,632  
Capital expenditures:
                                                                       
 
Expenditures for vessels and equipment
    128,297       56,017       146,279       170,630       24,760       7,116       5,054       23,675       5,054  
 
Expenditures for drydocking
    4,774       9,038       11,980       9,174       8,906       2,679       3,780       8,906       3,780  
 
Fleet Data:
                                                                       
Average number of shuttle tankers(9)
    8.7       11.1       30.5       37.9       35.8       35.9       35.1       37.9       37.2  
Average number of conventional tankers(9)
    7.1       7.0       27.4       40.7       41.2       40.2       34.3       10.5       10.0  
Average number of FSO units(9)
    1.7       2.0       2.2       3.0       3.0       3.0       3.0       3.0       3.0  

14


 

(1)  Voyage expenses are all expenses unique to a particular voyage, including any bunker fuel expenses, port fees, cargo loading and unloading expenses, canal tolls, agency fees and commissions.
 
(2)  Vessel operating expenses include crewing, repairs and maintenance, insurance, stores, lube oils and communication expenses.
 
(3)  Substantially all of these foreign currency exchange gains and losses were unrealized and not settled in cash. Under U.S. accounting guidelines, all foreign currency-denominated monetary assets and liabilities, such as cash and cash equivalents, accounts receivable, accounts payable, advances from affiliates and deferred income taxes, are revalued and reported based on the prevailing exchange rate at the end of the period. Our primary source for the foreign currency gains and losses is our Norwegian Kroner-denominated advances from affiliates, which totaled $157.6 million at June 30, 2006, $164.6 million at December 31, 2005 and $188.5 million at December 31, 2004.
 
(4)  Please read Note 6 of our unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements included in this prospectus for a calculation of our pro forma net income per unit.
 
(5)  Vessels and equipment consists of (a) vessels, at cost less accumulated depreciation, (b) vessels under capital leases, at cost less accumulated depreciation, and (c) advances on newbuildings.
 
(6)  Total debt includes long-term debt, capital lease obligations and advances from affiliates.
 
(7)  Historical non-controlling interest represents minority interests of third parties in joint ventures to which OPCO or its subsidiaries were a party. Pro forma non-controlling interest represents these minority interests and the minority interests in OPCO’s five 50%-owned joint ventures that OPCO has consolidated on a pro forma basis, together with Teekay Shipping Corporation’s 74.0% limited partner interest in OPCO.
 
(8)  EBITDA is calculated as net income (loss) before interest, taxes, depreciation and amortization, as set forth in “— Non-GAAP Financial Measures” below, which also includes reconciliations of EBITDA to our most directly comparable GAAP financial measures. EBITDA includes the following items:
                                                                           
    Historical   Pro Forma
         
        Six    
        Months       Six
        Ended   Year   Months
    Years Ended December 31,   June 30,   Ended   Ended
            December 31,   June 30,
    2001   2002   2003   2004   2005   2005   2006   2005   2006
                                     
    (unaudited)   (audited)   (unaudited)   (unaudited)
                 
    (in thousands)
Vessel and equipment writedowns and gain (loss) on sale of vessels
    $—       $—       $(63 )     $3,725       $(2,820 )     $(5,369 )     $(1,845 )     $9,423       $305  
Gain (loss) on sale of marketable securities
    (1,415 )     (1,227 )     517       94,222                                
Foreign currency exchange gain (loss)
    3,685       (35,121 )     (17,821 )     (37,910 )     34,178       25,730       (18,688 )     9,281       (4,339 )
                                                       
  Total     $2,270       $(36,348 )     $(17,367 )     $60,037       $31,358       $20,361       $(20,533 )     $18,704       $(4,034 )
                                                       
(9)  Historical average number of ships consists of the average number of owned (excluding vessels owned by OPCO’s five 50%-owned joint ventures) and chartered-in vessels that were in OPCO’s possession during a period. Pro forma average number of ships consists of the average number of chartered-in and owned vessels (including vessels owned by OPCO’s 50%-owned joint ventures, as OPCO has consolidated the five joint ventures on a pro forma basis) in OPCO’s possession during the pro forma periods.
Non-GAAP Financial Measures
      This discussion presents:
  •  Non-GAAP financial measures included above in “Summary Historical and Pro Forma Financial and Operating Data;” and
 
  •  Reconciliations of these non-GAAP financial measures to our most directly comparable financial measures under GAAP.

15


 

      Net Voyage Revenues. Consistent with general practice in the shipping industry, we use net voyage revenues (defined as voyage revenues less voyage expenses) as a measure of equating revenues generated from voyage charters to revenues generated from time charters, which assists us in making operating decisions about the deployment of vessels and their performance. Under time charters and bareboat charters the charterer typically pays the voyage expenses, whereas under voyage charter contracts and contracts of affreightment the shipowner typically pays the voyage expenses. Some voyage expenses are fixed, and the remainder can be estimated. If OPCO, as the shipowner, pays the voyage expenses, it typically passes the approximate amount of these expenses on to its customers by charging higher rates under the contract or billing the expenses to them. As a result, although voyage revenues from different types of contracts may vary, the net revenues after subtracting voyage expenses, which we refer to as net voyage revenues, are comparable across the different types of contracts. We principally use net voyage revenues, a non-GAAP financial measure, because it provides more meaningful information to us than voyage revenues, the most directly comparable GAAP financial measure. Net voyage revenues are also widely used by investors and analysts in the shipping industry for comparing financial performance between companies in the shipping industry to industry averages.
      The following table reconciles net voyage revenues with voyage revenues:
                                                                         
    Historical   Pro Forma
         
        Six    
        Months       Six
        Ended   Year   Months
    Years Ended December 31,   June 30,   Ended   Ended
            December 31,   June 30,
    2001   2002   2003   2004   2005   2005   2006   2005   2006
                                     
    (unaudited)   (audited)   (unaudited)   (unaudited)
                 
    (in thousands)
Voyage revenues
  $ 137,258     $ 156,745     $ 747,383     $ 986,504     $ 807,548     $ 400,315     $ 386,724     $ 678,888     $ 349,299  
Voyage expenses
    7,447       8,894       146,893       118,819       74,543       32,400       48,344       93,935       60,186  
                                                       
Net voyage revenues
  $ 129,811     $ 147,851     $ 600,490     $ 867,685     $ 733,005     $ 367,915     $ 338,380     $ 584,953     $ 289,113  
                                                       
      EBITDA. Earnings before interest, taxes, depreciation and amortization is used as a supplemental financial measure by management and by external users of our financial statements, such as investors, as discussed below:
  •  Financial and operating performance. EBITDA assists our management and investors by increasing the comparability of the fundamental performance of OPCO and us from period to period and against the fundamental performance of other companies in our industry that provide EBITDA information. This increased comparability is achieved by excluding the potentially disparate effects between periods or companies of interest expense, taxes, depreciation or amortization, which items are affected by various and possibly changing financing methods, capital structure and historical cost basis and which items may significantly affect net income between periods. We believe that including EBITDA as a financial and operating measure benefits investors in (a) selecting between investing in us and other investment alternatives and (b) monitoring the ongoing financial and operational strength and health of OPCO and us in assessing whether to continue to hold common units.
 
  •  Liquidity. EBITDA allows us to assess the ability of assets to generate cash sufficient to service debt, make distributions and undertake capital expenditures. By eliminating the cash flow effect resulting from the existing capitalization of OPCO and other items such as drydocking expenditures, working capital changes and foreign currency exchange gains and losses (which may vary significantly from period to period), EBITDA provides a consistent measure of OPCO’s ability to generate cash over the long term. Management uses this information as a significant factor in determining (a) OPCO’s proper capitalization (including assessing how much debt to incur and whether changes to the capitalization should be made) and (b) whether to undertake material capital expenditures and how to finance them, all in light of existing cash distribution commitments to unitholders. Use of EBITDA as a liquidity measure also permits investors to assess the

16


 

  fundamental ability of OPCO and us to generate cash sufficient to meet cash needs, including distributions on our common units.
      EBITDA should not be considered an alternative to net income, operating income, cash flow from operating activities or any other measure of financial performance or liquidity presented in accordance with GAAP. EBITDA excludes some, but not all, items that affect net income and operating income, and these measures may vary among other companies. Therefore, EBITDA as presented below may not be comparable to similarly titled measures of other companies.
                                                                         
    Historical   Pro Forma
         
        Six Months       Six
        Ended   Year   Months
    Years Ended December 31,   June 30,   Ended   Ended
            December 31,   June 30,
    2001   2002   2003   2004   2005   2005   2006   2005   2006
                                     
    (unaudited)   (audited)   (unaudited)   (unaudited)
                 
    (in thousands)
Reconciliation of “EBITDA” to “Net income (loss)”:
                                                                       
Net income (loss)
    $13,031       $(23,209 )     $63,513       $213,772       $84,747       $69,174       $(16,799 )     $27,118       $5,605  
Depreciation and amortization
    45,167       49,579       93,269       118,460       107,542       55,620       51,331       116,922       56,138  
Interest expense, net
    30,091       27,587       45,594       41,498       35,186       17,829       21,213       68,193       33,127  
Provision (benefit) for income taxes
    4,963       8,116       30,035       28,188       (13,873 )     (15,786 )     7,762       (13,873 )     7,762  
                                                       
EBITDA
    $93,252       $62,073       $232,411       $401,918       $213,602       $126,837       $63,507       $198,360       $102,632  
                                                       
Reconciliation of “EBITDA” to “Net operating cash flow”:
                                                                       
Net operating cash flow
    $34,054       $12,110       $227,297       $242,592       $152,687       $81,232       $48,705       $212,382       $81,895  
Non-controlling interest
    (2,345 )     (1,212 )     (2,763 )     (2,167 )     (229 )     (692 )     (414 )     (87,248 )     (21,541 )
Expenditures for drydocking
    4,774       9,038       11,980       9,174       8,906       2,679       3,780       8,906       3,780  
Interest expense, net
    30,091       27,587       45,594       41,498       35,186       17,829       21,213       66,973       32,516  
Gain (loss) on sale of vessels
                (63 )     3,725       9,423       4,831       305       9,423       305  
Gain (loss) on sale of marketable securities, net of writedowns
    (1,415 )     (1,227 )     (4,393 )     94,222                                
Loss on writedown of vessels and equipment
                            (12,243 )     (10,200 )     (2,150 )            
Write-off of capitalized loan costs
                                              (3,402 )      
Equity income (net of dividends received)
    2,540       2,849       (1,234 )     (1,338 )     2,449       2,573       691       (971 )     (49 )
Change in working capital
    25,341       12,000       (10,602 )     37,709       (22,951 )     (3,918 )     9,870       (22,951 )     9,870  
Foreign currency exchange gain (loss) and other, net
    212       928       (33,405 )     (23,497 )     40,374       32,503       (18,493 )     15,248       (4,144 )
                                                       
EBITDA
    $93,252       $62,073       $232,411       $401,918       $213,602       $126,837       $63,507       $198,360       $102,632  
                                                       

17


 

RISK FACTORS
      Although many of our business risks are comparable to those a corporation engaged in a similar business would face, limited partner interests are inherently different from the capital stock of a corporation. You should carefully consider the following risk factors together with all of the other information included in this prospectus when evaluating an investment in our common units.
      If any of the following risks actually occur, our business, financial condition, operating results or cash flows could be materially adversely affected. In that case, we might not be able to pay distributions on our common units, the trading price of our common units could decline, and you could lose all or part of your investment.
Risks Inherent in Our Business
Because our partnership interest in OPCO currently represents our only cash-generating asset, our cash flow initially will depend completely on OPCO’s ability to make distributions to its partners, including us.
      Our cash flow initially will depend completely on OPCO’s distributions to us as one of its partners. The amount of cash OPCO can distribute to its partners will principally depend upon the amount of cash it generates from its operations, which may fluctuate from quarter to quarter based on, among other things:
  •  the rates its obtains from its charters and contracts of affreightment;
 
  •  the price and level of production of, and demand for, crude oil, particularly the level of production at the offshore oil fields OPCO services under contracts of affreightment;
 
  •  the level of its operating costs, such as the cost of crews and insurance;
 
  •  the number of off-hire days for its fleet and the timing of, and number of days required for, drydocking of its vessels;
 
  •  the rates, if any, at which OPCO may be able to redeploy shuttle tankers in the spot market as conventional oil tankers during any periods of reduced or terminated oil production at fields serviced by contracts of affreightment;
 
  •  delays in the delivery of any newbuildings or vessels undergoing conversion and the beginning of payments under charters relating to those vessels;
 
  •  prevailing global and regional economic and political conditions;
 
  •  currency exchange rate fluctuations; and
 
  •  the effect of governmental regulations and maritime self-regulatory organization standards on the conduct of its business.
      The actual amount of cash OPCO will have available for distribution also will depend on other factors such as:
  •  the level of capital expenditures it makes, including for maintaining vessels or converting existing vessels for other uses and complying with regulations;
 
  •  its debt service requirements and restrictions on distributions contained in its debt instruments;
 
  •  fluctuations in its working capital needs;
 
  •  its ability to make working capital borrowings; and
 
  •  the amount of any cash reserves, including reserves for future maintenance capital expenditures, working capital and other matters, established by the board of directors of our general partner.
      OPCO’s limited partnership agreement provides that it will distribute its available cash to its partners on a quarterly basis. OPCO’s available cash includes cash on hand less any reserves that may be appropriate for operating its business. The amount of OPCO’s quarterly distributions, including the amount

18


 

of cash reserves not distributed, will be determined by the board of directors of our general partner on our behalf.
      The amount of cash OPCO generates from operations may differ materially from its profit or loss for the period, which will be affected by non-cash items. As a result of this and the other factors mentioned above, OPCO may make cash distributions during periods when it records losses and may not make cash distributions during periods when it records net income.
We may not have sufficient cash from operations to enable us to pay the minimum quarterly distribution on our common units or to increase distributions.
      The source of our earnings and cash flow initially will consist exclusively of cash distributions from OPCO. Therefore, the amount of distributions we are able to make to our unitholders will fluctuate, initially, based on the level of distributions made by OPCO to its partners, including us, and, in the future, based on the level of distributions made by OPCO and any subsidiaries through which we later conduct operations. Neither OPCO nor any such operating subsidiaries may make quarterly distributions at a level that will permit us to make distributions to our common unitholders at the minimum quarterly distribution level or to increase our quarterly distributions in the future. In addition, while we would expect to increase or decrease distributions to our unitholders if OPCO increases or decreases distributions to us, the timing and amount of any such increased or decreased distributions will not necessarily be comparable to the timing and amount of the increase or decrease in distributions made by OPCO to us.
      Our ability to distribute to our unitholders any cash we may receive from OPCO or any future operating subsidiaries is or may be limited by a number of factors, including, among others:
  •  interest expense and principal payments on any indebtedness we incur;
 
  •  restrictions on distributions contained in any of our current or future debt agreements;
 
  •  fees and expenses of us, our general partner, its affiliates or third parties we are required to reimburse or pay, including expenses we will incur as a result of being a public company; and
 
  •  reserves our general partner believes are prudent for us to maintain for the proper conduct of our business or to provide for future distributions.
      Many of these factors will reduce the amount of cash we may otherwise have available for distribution. We may not be able to pay distributions, and any distributions we do make may not be at or above our minimum quarterly distribution. The actual amount of cash that is available for distribution to our unitholders will depend on several factors, many of which are beyond the control of us or our general partner.
The assumptions underlying our estimate of cash available for distribution that we include in “Our Cash Distribution Policy and Restrictions on Distributions” are inherently uncertain and are subject to significant business, economic, financial, regulatory and competitive risks and uncertainties that could cause actual results to differ materially from those forecasted.
      Our estimate of cash available for distribution set forth in “Our Cash Distribution Policy and Restrictions on Distributions” includes our estimate of operating results and cash flows for the year ending December 31, 2007. The estimate has been prepared by management and we have not received an opinion or report on it from our or any other independent auditor. The assumptions underlying the estimate are inherently uncertain and are subject to significant business, economic, regulatory and competitive risks and uncertainties that could cause actual results to differ materially from those estimated. If we do not achieve the estimated results, we may not be able to pay the full minimum quarterly distribution or any amount on the common units or subordinated units, in which event the market price of the common units may decline materially.
      The amount of available cash we need to pay the minimum quarterly distributions for four quarters on the common units, the subordinated units and the 2.0% general partner interest to be outstanding immediately after this offering is $28.0 million. Pro forma available cash to make distributions generated

19


 

during the year ended December 31, 2005 and the twelve months ended June 30, 2006, would have been sufficient to allow us to pay 100.0% of the minimum quarterly distribution on the common units, but would have allowed us to pay only 98.8% and 67.4%, respectively, of the minimum quarterly distribution on the subordinated units during those periods. For a calculation of our ability to make distributions to unitholders based on our pro forma results for the year ended December 31, 2005 and the twelve months ended June 30, 2006 and for a forecast of our ability to pay the full minimum quarterly distributions on the common units, the subordinated units and the 2.0% general partner interest for the year ending December 31, 2007, please read “Our Cash Distribution Policy and Restrictions on Distributions.”
Our ability to grow may be adversely affected by our cash distribution policy. OPCO’s ability to meet its financial needs and grow may be adversely affected by its cash distribution policy.
      Our cash distribution policy, which is consistent with our partnership agreement, requires us to distribute all of our available cash each quarter. Accordingly, our growth may not be as fast as businesses that reinvest their available cash to expand ongoing operations.
      OPCO’s cash distribution policy requires it to distribute all of its available cash each quarter. In determining the amount of cash available for distribution by OPCO, the board of directors of our general partner, in making the determination on our behalf, will approve the amount of cash reserves to set aside, including reserves for future maintenance capital expenditures, working capital and other matters. OPCO also relies upon external financing sources, including commercial borrowings, to fund its capital expenditures. Accordingly, to the extent OPCO does not have sufficient cash reserves or is unable to obtain financing, its cash distribution policy may significantly impair its ability to meet its financial needs or to grow.
OPCO must make substantial capital expenditures to maintain the operating capacity of its fleet, which will reduce cash available for distribution. In addition, each quarter our general partner is required to deduct estimated maintenance capital expenditures from operating surplus, which may result in less cash available to unitholders than if actual maintenance capital expenditures were deducted.
      OPCO must make substantial capital expenditures to maintain, over the long term, the operating capacity of its fleet. We estimate that maintenance capital expenditures for OPCO, which initially is our only operating controlled affiliate and of which we will initially own a 26.0% interest, will average approximately $73.9 million per year, including for replacing current vessels at the end of their useful lives. We intend to expand our fleet through wholly owned subsidiaries, which would increase the level of our maintenance capital expenditures. Maintenance capital expenditures include capital expenditures associated with drydocking a vessel, modifying an existing vessel or acquiring a new vessel to the extent these expenditures are incurred to maintain the operating capacity of our fleet. These expenditures could increase as a result of changes in:
  •  the cost of labor and materials;
 
  •  customer requirements;
 
  •  increases in fleet size or the cost of replacement vessels;
 
  •  governmental regulations and maritime self-regulatory organization standards relating to safety, security or the environment; and
 
  •  competitive standards.
      In addition, actual maintenance capital expenditures will vary significantly from quarter to quarter based on the number of vessels drydocked during that quarter. Significant maintenance capital expenditures will reduce the amount of cash OPCO has available to distribute to us and that we have available for distribution to our unitholders.
      Our partnership agreement requires our general partner to deduct our estimated, rather than actual, maintenance capital expenditures from operating surplus each quarter in an effort to reduce fluctuations in

20


 

operating surplus. The amount of estimated maintenance capital expenditures deducted from operating surplus is subject to review and change by the conflicts committee at least once a year. In years when estimated maintenance capital expenditures are higher than actual maintenance capital expenditures, the amount of cash available for distribution to unitholders will be lower than if actual maintenance capital expenditures were deducted from operating surplus. If our general partner underestimates the appropriate level of estimated maintenance capital expenditures, we may have less cash available for distribution in future periods when actual capital expenditures begin to exceed our previous estimates.
We will be required to make substantial capital expenditures to expand the size of our fleet. We generally will be required to make significant installment payments for acquisitions of newbuilding vessels or for the conversion of existing vessels prior to their delivery and generation of revenue. Depending on whether we finance our expenditures through cash from operations or by issuing debt or equity securities, our ability to make cash distributions may be diminished or our financial leverage could increase or our unitholders could be diluted.
      We intend to make substantial capital expenditures to increase the size of our fleet. The total delivered cost for a shuttle tanker is approximately $60 to $100 million, an FSO unit is approximately $20 to $50 million and an FPSO unit is approximately $100 million to $1.0 billion, although actual costs will vary significantly depending on the market price charged by shipyards, the size and specifications of the vessel, governmental regulations and maritime self-regulatory organization standards.
      We and Teekay Shipping Corporation regularly evaluate and pursue opportunities to provide marine transportation services for new or expanding offshore projects. Under an omnibus agreement that we will enter into at the closing of this offering, Teekay Shipping Corporation will be required to offer to us, within 365 days of their deliveries, certain shuttle tankers, FSO units and FPSO units Teekay Shipping Corporation may acquire, including two shuttle tankers and one FSO unit currently being converted from conventional oil tankers or being upgraded by Teekay Shipping Corporation. Neither we nor Teekay Shipping Corporation may be awarded charters or contracts of affreightment relating to any of the projects we pursue or it pursues, and we may choose not to purchase the vessels Teekay Shipping Corporation is required to offer to us under the omnibus agreement. If we obtain from Teekay Shipping Corporation any offshore project, we will need to incur significant capital expenditures to build the offshore vessels needed to fulfill the project requirements. If we choose to purchase the shuttle tankers or FSO or FPSO units Teekay Shipping Corporation will be required to offer to us, we plan to finance the cost either through internally generated funds, debt or equity financings or the issuance to it of equity securities. Please read “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions — Omnibus Agreement.”
      We generally will be required to make installment payments on newbuildings prior to their delivery. We typically must pay 20.0% of the purchase price of a shuttle tanker upon signing the purchase contract, even though delivery of the completed vessel will not occur until much later (approximately two to three years from the order). If we finance these acquisition costs by issuing debt or equity securities, we will increase the aggregate amount of interest or minimum quarterly distributions we must make prior to generating cash from the operation of the newbuilding.
      To fund the remaining portion of these and other capital expenditures, we will be required to use cash from operations or incur borrowings or raise capital through the sale of debt or additional equity securities. Use of cash from operations will reduce cash available for distribution to unitholders. Our ability to obtain bank financing or to access the capital markets for future offerings may be limited by our financial condition at the time of any such financing or offering as well as by adverse market conditions resulting from, among other things, general economic conditions and contingencies and uncertainties that are beyond our control. Our failure to obtain the funds for future capital expenditures could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition and on our ability to make cash distributions. Even if we are successful in obtaining necessary funds, the terms of such financings could limit our ability to pay cash distributions to unitholders. In addition, incurring additional debt may significantly increase our interest expense and financial leverage, and issuing additional equity securities may result in significant unitholder dilution and would increase the aggregate amount of cash required to

21


 

meet our minimum quarterly distribution to unitholders, which could have a material adverse effect on our ability to make cash distributions.
OPCO’s substantial debt levels may limit its or our flexibility in obtaining additional financing, pursuing other business opportunities and paying distributions to you.
      Assuming we had completed this offering and the related transactions on June 30, 2006, our consolidated debt would have been $1.3 billion, all of which relates to OPCO. If we are awarded contracts for additional offshore projects, our consolidated debt and capital lease obligations may significantly increase. Following this offering, we and OPCO will continue to have the ability to incur additional debt, including approximately $300 million of borrowings available under OPCO’s revolving credit facilities, subject to limitations in the credit facilities. Our level of debt could have important consequences to us, including the following:
  •  our ability to obtain additional financing, if necessary, for working capital, capital expenditures, acquisitions or other purposes may be impaired or such financing may not be available on favorable terms;
 
  •  we will need a substantial portion of our cash flow to make principal and interest payments on our debt, reducing the funds that would otherwise be available for operations, future business opportunities and distributions to unitholders;
 
  •  our debt level will make us more vulnerable than our competitors with less debt to competitive pressures or a downturn in our business or the economy generally; and
 
  •  our debt level may limit our flexibility in responding to changing business and economic conditions.
      Our ability to service our debt will depend upon, among other things, our future financial and operating performance, which will be affected by prevailing economic conditions and financial, business, regulatory and other factors, some of which are beyond our control. If our operating results are not sufficient to service our current or future indebtedness, we will be forced to take actions such as reducing distributions, reducing or delaying our business activities, acquisitions, investments or capital expenditures, selling assets, restructuring or refinancing our debt, or seeking additional equity capital or bankruptcy protection. We may not be able to effect any of these remedies on satisfactory terms, or at all.
Financing agreements containing operating and financial restrictions may restrict OPCO’s and our business and financing activities.
      The operating and financial restrictions and covenants in OPCO’s financing arrangements and any future financing agreements for OPCO or us could adversely affect its and our ability to finance future operations or capital needs or to engage, expand or pursue our business activities. For example, the arrangements may restrict OPCO’s or our ability to:
  •  incur or guarantee indebtedness;
 
  •  change ownership or structure, including mergers, consolidations, liquidations and dissolutions;
 
  •  make dividends or distributions;
 
  •  make certain negative pledges and grant certain liens;
 
  •  sell, transfer, assign or convey assets;
 
  •  make certain investments; and
 
  •  enter into a new line of business.
      In addition, OPCO’s credit facilities require OPCO to maintain a minimum liquidity (cash, cash equivalents and undrawn committed revolving credit lines) of $75.0 million, with aggregate liquidity of not less than 5.0% of the total consolidated debt of OPCO and its subsidiaries. OPCO’s or our ability to comply with covenants and restrictions contained in debt instruments may be affected by events beyond its or our control, including prevailing economic, financial and industry conditions. If market or other

22


 

economic conditions deteriorate, compliance with these covenants may be impaired. If restrictions, covenants, ratios or tests in the financing agreements are breached, a significant portion of the obligations may become immediately due and payable, and the lenders’ commitment to make further loans may terminate. Neither OPCO nor we might have, or be able to obtain, sufficient funds to make these accelerated payments. In addition, obligations under OPCO’s credit facilities are secured by certain of its vessels, and if it is unable to repay debt under the credit facilities, the lenders could seek to foreclose on those assets. Please read “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operation — Liquidity and Capital Resources — Covenants and Other Restrictions in Our Financing Agreements” and “— Credit Facilities.”
Restrictions in OPCO’s debt agreements may prevent it or us from paying distributions.
      The payment of principal and interest on OPCO’s debt will reduce cash available for distribution to us and on our units. In addition, we anticipate that OPCO’s financing agreements will prohibit the payment of distributions upon the occurrence of the following events, among others:
  •  failure to pay any principal, interest, fees, expenses or other amounts when due;
 
  •  failure to notify the lenders of any material oil spill or discharge of hazardous material, or of any action or claim related thereto;
 
  •  breach or lapse of any insurance with respect to the vessels;
 
  •  breach of certain financial covenants;
 
  •  failure to observe any other agreement, security instrument, obligation or covenant beyond specified cure periods in certain cases;
 
  •  default under other indebtedness;
 
  •  bankruptcy or insolvency events;
 
  •  failure of any representation or warranty to be materially correct;
 
  •  a change of control, as defined in the applicable agreement; and
 
  •  a material adverse effect, as defined in the applicable agreement, occurs.
      For more information regarding these financing arrangements, please read “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Conditions and Results of Operations — Liquidity and Capital Resources.”
Net voyage revenues for Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor declined for the first half of 2006 compared to the first half of 2005.
      Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor generated net voyage revenues ( i.e. voyage revenues less voyage expenses) of $733.0 million during the year ended December 31, 2005. Its net voyage revenues for the six months ended June 30, 2006 declined to $338.4 million from $367.9 million for the six months ended June 30, 2005, primarily as a result of:
  •  a decrease in the number of chartered-in conventional oil tankers held by an entity that OPCO sold to Teekay Shipping Corporation on July 1, 2006; and
 
  •  reduced volumes transported under contracts of affreightment during the second quarter of 2006 due to earlier-than-normal annual maintenance of certain North Sea oil field facilities, which typically occurs in the third quarter.
If net voyage revenues were to continue to decline, it could adversely affect our ability to make cash distributions.
OPCO derives a substantial majority of its revenues from a limited number of customers, and the loss of any such customers could result in a significant loss of revenues and cash flow.
      OPCO has derived, and we believe it will continue to derive, a substantial majority of revenues and cash flow from a limited number of customers. Teekay Shipping Corporation and Statoil ASA accounted for approximately 27% and 26%, respectively, of combined consolidated voyage revenues during the six

23


 

months ended June 30, 2006, approximately 31% and 23%, respectively, of combined consolidated voyage revenues during 2005, and approximately 40% and 19%, respectively, of combined consolidated voyage revenues during 2004. No other customer accounted for 10% or more of revenues during any of these periods. Assuming we had completed this offering and the related transactions on January 1, 2005, these two customers would have accounted for approximately 19% and 29%, respectively, of consolidated voyage revenues during the six months ended June 30, 2006 and approximately 18% and 27%, respectively, during 2005.
      If OPCO loses a key customer, it may be unable to obtain replacement long-term charters or contracts of affreightment and may become subject, with respect to any shuttle tankers redeployed on conventional oil tanker trades, to the volatile spot market, which is highly competitive and subject to significant price fluctuations. If a customer exercises its right under some charters to purchase the vessel, OPCO may be unable to acquire an adequate replacement vessel. Any replacement newbuilding would not generate revenues during its construction and OPCO may be unable to charter any replacement vessel on terms as favorable to it as those of the terminated charter.
      The loss of any of OPCO’s significant customers could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition and our ability to make cash distributions.
We will depend on Teekay Shipping Corporation to assist us and OPCO in operating our businesses and competing in our markets. In the past, OPCO generally fulfilled its own managerial, operational and administrative needs.
      We, OPCO and operating subsidiaries of OPCO will, and any of our future operating subsidiaries may, enter into various services agreements with certain subsidiaries of Teekay Shipping Corporation pursuant to which those subsidiaries will provide to us and OPCO all of our and OPCO’s administrative services and to the operating subsidiaries substantially all of their managerial, operational and administrative services (including vessel maintenance, crewing, purchasing, shipyard supervision, insurance and financial services) and other technical and advisory services. Our operational success and ability to execute our growth strategy will depend significantly upon the satisfactory performance of these services by the Teekay Shipping Corporation subsidiaries. Our business will be harmed if such subsidiaries fail to perform these services satisfactorily or if they stop providing these services to us, OPCO or its operating subsidiaries. Prior to this offering, OPCO generally fulfilled its own managerial, operational and administrative needs, but relied upon affiliates of Teekay Shipping Corporation to provide technical services. Following this offering, OPCO’s operating subsidiaries will provide technical and voyage management services for their conventional Aframax tankers, but will rely on certain subsidiaries of Teekay Shipping Corporation for substantially all other services.
      Our ability to compete for offshore oil marine transportation, processing and storage projects and to enter into new charters or contracts of affreightment and expand our customer relationships will depend largely on our ability to leverage our relationship with Teekay Shipping Corporation and its reputation and relationships in the shipping industry. If Teekay Shipping Corporation suffers material damage to its reputation or relationships, it may harm our or OPCO’s ability to:
  •  renew existing charters and contracts of affreightment upon their expiration;
 
  •  obtain new charters and contracts of affreightment;
 
  •  successfully interact with shipyards during periods of shipyard construction constraints;
 
  •  obtain financing on commercially acceptable terms; or
 
  •  maintain satisfactory relationships with suppliers and other third parties.
      If our or OPCO’s ability to do any of the things described above is impaired, it could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition and our ability to make cash distributions.

24


 

      OPCO’s operating subsidiaries and any of our future operating subsidiaries may also contract with certain subsidiaries of Teekay Shipping Corporation for the Teekay Shipping Corporation subsidiaries to have newbuildings constructed or existing vessels converted on behalf of the operating subsidiaries and to incur the construction-related financing. The operating subsidiaries would purchase the vessels on or after delivery based on an agreed-upon price. OPCO’s operating subsidiaries do not currently have this type of arrangement with Teekay Shipping Corporation or any of its affiliates.
Our growth depends on continued growth in demand for offshore oil transportation, processing and storage services.
      Our growth strategy focuses on expansion in the shuttle tanker, FSO and FPSO sectors. Accordingly, our growth depends on continued growth in world and regional demand for these offshore services, which could be negatively affected by a number of factors, such as:
  •  decreases in the actual or projected price of oil, which could lead to a reduction in or termination of production of oil at certain fields we service or a reduction in exploration for or development of new offshore oil fields;
 
  •  increases in the production of oil in areas linked by pipelines to consuming areas, the extension of existing, or the development of new, pipeline systems in markets we may serve, or the conversion of existing non-oil pipelines to oil pipelines in those markets;
 
  •  decreases in the consumption of oil due to increases in its price relative to other energy sources, other factors making consumption of oil less attractive or energy conservation measures;
 
  •  availability of new, alternative energy sources; and
 
  •  negative global or regional economic or political conditions, particularly in oil consuming regions, which could reduce energy consumption or its growth.
      Reduced demand for offshore marine transportation, processing or storage services would have a material adverse effect on our future growth and could harm our business, results of operations and financial condition.
Because payments under OPCO’s contracts of affreightment are based on the volume of oil it transports, OPCO’s utilization of its shuttle tanker fleet and the success of its shuttle tanker business depends upon continued production from existing or new oil fields it services, which is beyond our or OPCO’s control and generally declines naturally over time. Any decrease in the volume of oil OPCO transports under contracts of affreightment could adversely affect our business and operating results.
      A majority of OPCO’s shuttle tankers operate under contracts of affreightment. Payments under these contracts of affreightment are based upon the volume of oil OPCO transports, which depends upon the level of oil production at the fields OPCO services under the contracts. Oil production levels are affected by several factors, all of which are beyond our or OPCO’s control, including: geologic factors, including general declines in production that occur naturally over time; the rate of technical developments in extracting oil and related infrastructure and implementation costs; and operator decisions based on revenue compared to costs from continued operations. Factors that may affect an operator’s decision to initiate or continue production include: changes in oil prices; capital budget limitations; the availability of necessary drilling and other governmental permits; the availability of qualified personnel and equipment; the quality of drilling prospects in the area; and regulatory changes. In addition, the volume of oil OPCO transports may be adversely affected by extended repairs to oil field installations or suspensions of field operations as a result of oil spills or otherwise.
      The rate of oil production at fields OPCO services may decline from existing or future levels, and may be terminated. If such a reduction or termination occurs, the spot market rates, if any, in the conventional oil tanker trades at which OPCO may be able to redeploy the affected shuttle tankers may be

25


 

lower than the rates previously earned by the vessels under the contracts of affreightment, which would reduce its and our results of operations and ability to make cash distributions.
The duration of many of OPCO’s shuttle tanker and FSO contracts is the life of the relevant oil field or is subject to extension by the field operator or vessel charterer. If the oil field no longer produces oil or is abandoned or the contract term is not extended, OPCO will no longer generate revenue under the related contract and will need to seek to redeploy affected vessels.
      Many of OPCO’s shuttle tanker contracts have a “life-of -field” duration, which means that the contract continues until oil production at the field ceases. If production terminates for any reason, OPCO no longer will generate revenue under the related contract. Other shuttle tanker and FSO contracts under which OPCO’s vessels operate are subject to extensions beyond their initial term. The likelihood of these contracts being extended may be negatively affected by reductions in oil field reserves, low oil prices generally or other factors. If OPCO is unable to promptly redeploy any affected vessels at rates at least equal to those under the contracts, if at all, its and our operating results will be harmed. Any potential redeployment may not be under long-term contracts, which may affect the stability of OPCO’s and our cash flow and ability to make cash distributions.
The results of OPCO’s shuttle tanker operations in the North Sea are subject to seasonal fluctuations.
      Due to harsh winter weather conditions, oil field operators in the North Sea typically schedule oil platform and other infrastructure repairs and maintenance during the summer months. Because the North Sea is our primary existing offshore oil market, this seasonal repair and maintenance activity contributes to quarter-to -quarter volatility in our results of operations, as oil production typically is lower in the second and third quarters in this region compared with production in the first and fourth quarters. Because a significant portion of OPCO’s North Sea shuttle tankers operate under contracts of affreightment, under which revenue is based on the volume of oil transported, the results of these shuttle tanker operations in the North Sea under these contracts generally reflect this seasonal production pattern. When OPCO redeploys affected shuttle tankers as conventional oil tankers while platform maintenance and repairs are conducted, the overall financial results for its North Sea shuttle tanker operations may be negatively affected as the rates in the conventional oil tanker markets at times may be lower than contract of affreightment rates. In addition, OPCO seeks to coordinate some of the general drydocking schedule of its fleet with this seasonality, which may result in lower revenues and increased drydocking expenses during the summer months.
Our growth depends on our ability to expand relationships with existing customers and obtain new customers, for which we will face substantial competition.
      One of our principal objectives is to enter into additional long-term, fixed-rate time charters and contracts of affreightment. The process of obtaining new long-term time charters and contracts of affreightment is highly competitive and generally involves an intensive screening process and competitive bids, and often extends for several months. Shuttle tanker, FSO and FPSO contracts are awarded based upon a variety of factors relating to the vessel operator, including:
  •  industry relationships and reputation for customer service and safety;
 
  •  experience and quality of ship operations;
 
  •  quality, experience and technical capability of the crew;
 
  •  relationships with shipyards and the ability to get suitable berths;
 
  •  construction management experience, including the ability to obtain on-time delivery of new vessels according to customer specifications;
 
  •  willingness to accept operational risks pursuant to the charter, such as allowing termination of the charter for force majeure events; and
 
  •  competitiveness of the bid in terms of overall price.

26


 

      We expect substantial competition for providing services for potential shuttle tanker, FSO and FPSO projects from a number of experienced companies, including state-sponsored entities. OPCO’s Aframax conventional tanker business also faces substantial competition from major oil companies, independent owners and operators and other sized tankers. Many of our competitors have significantly greater financial resources than do we, OPCO or Teekay Shipping Corporation, which also may compete with us. We anticipate that an increasing number of marine transportation companies — including many with strong reputations and extensive resources and experience — will enter the FSO and FPSO sectors. This increased competition may cause greater price competition for charters. As a result of these factors, we may be unable to expand our relationships with existing customers or to obtain new customers on a profitable basis, if at all, which would have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition and our ability to make cash distributions.
Delays in deliveries of newbuilding vessels or of conversions of existing vessels could harm our operating results.
      The delivery of any newbuildings or vessel conversions we may order could be delayed, which would delay our receipt of revenues under the charters or other contracts related to the vessels. In addition, under some charters we may enter into that are related to a newbuilding or conversion, if our delivery of the newbuilding or converted vessel to our customer is delayed, we may be required to pay liquidated damages during the delay. For prolonged delays, the customer may terminate the charter and, in addition to the resulting loss of revenues, we may be responsible for additional, substantial liquidated damages.
      The completion and delivery of newbuildings or vessel conversions could be delayed because of:
  •  quality or engineering problems, the risk of which may be increased with FPSO units due to their technical complexity;
 
  •  changes in governmental regulations or maritime self-regulatory organization standards;
 
  •  work stoppages or other labor disturbances at the shipyard;
 
  •  bankruptcy or other financial crisis of the shipbuilder;
 
  •  a backlog of orders at the shipyard;
 
  •  political or economic disturbances;
 
  •  weather interference or catastrophic event, such as a major earthquake or fire;
 
  •  requests for changes to the original vessel specifications;
 
  •  shortages of or delays in the receipt of necessary construction materials, such as steel;
 
  •  inability to finance the construction or conversion of the vessels; or
 
  •  inability to obtain requisite permits or approvals.
      If delivery of a vessel is materially delayed, it could adversely affect our results of operations and financial condition and our ability to make cash distributions.
Charter rates for conventional oil tankers may fluctuate substantially over time and may be lower when we are or OPCO is attempting to recharter conventional oil tankers, which could adversely affect operating results. Any changes in charter rates for shuttle tankers or FSO or FPSO units could also adversely affect redeployment opportunities for those vessels.
      Our ability to recharter OPCO’s conventional oil tankers following expiration of existing time-charter contracts commencing in 2011 and the rates payable upon any renewal or replacement charters will depend upon, among other things, the state of the conventional tanker market. Conventional oil tanker trades are highly competitive and have experienced significant fluctuations in charter rates based on, among other things, oil and vessel demand. For example, an oversupply of conventional oil tankers can significantly reduce their charter rates. There also exists some volatility in charter rates for shuttle tankers and FSO and FPSO units.

27


 

      Six of OPCO’s fixed-term charters and eleven contracts of affreightment (representing approximately 10% of OPCO’s aggregate contract of affreightment volumes) are scheduled to expire prior to December 31, 2008. If, upon expiration or termination of these or other contracts, long-term recharter rates are lower than existing rates, our earnings and cash flow under any new contracts could be adversely affected.
Over time, vessel values may fluctuate substantially and, if these values are lower at a time when we are or OPCO is attempting to dispose of vessels, we or OPCO may incur a loss.
      Vessel values for shuttle tankers, conventional oil tankers and FSO and FPSO units can fluctuate substantially over time due to a number of different factors, including:
  •  prevailing economic conditions in oil and energy markets;
 
  •  a substantial or extended decline in demand for oil;
 
  •  increases in the supply of vessel capacity; and
 
  •  the cost of retrofitting or modifying existing vessels, as a result of technological advances in vessel design or equipment, changes in applicable environmental or other regulations or standards, or otherwise.
      If a charter or contract of affreightment terminates, we or OPCO may be unable to re-deploy the affected vessels at attractive rates and, rather than continue to incur costs to maintain and finance them, may seek to dispose of them. Inability to dispose of vessels at a reasonable value could result in a loss on their sale and adversely affect our or OPCO’s results of operations and financial condition.
We may be unable to make or realize expected benefits from acquisitions, and implementing our growth strategy through acquisitions may harm our business, financial condition and operating results.
      Our growth strategy includes selectively acquiring existing shuttle tankers and FSO and FPSO units or businesses that own or operate these types of vessels. Historically, there have been very few purchases of existing vessels and businesses in the FSO and FPSO segments. Factors that may contribute to a limited number of acquisition opportunities for FSO units and FPSO units in the near term include the relatively small number of independent FSO and FPSO fleet owners. In addition, competition from other companies, many of which have significantly greater financial resources than do we or Teekay Shipping Corporation, could reduce our acquisition opportunities or cause us to pay higher prices.
      Any acquisition of a vessel or business may not be profitable at or after the time of acquisition and may not generate cash flow sufficient to justify the investment. In addition, our acquisition growth strategy exposes us to risks that may harm our business, financial condition and operating results, including risks that we may:
  •  fail to realize anticipated benefits, such as new customer relationships, cost-savings or cash flow enhancements;
 
  •  be unable to hire, train or retain qualified shore and seafaring personnel to manage and operate our growing business and fleet;
 
  •  decrease our liquidity by using a significant portion of available cash or borrowing capacity to finance acquisitions;
 
  •  significantly increase our interest expense or financial leverage if we incur additional debt to finance acquisitions;
 
  •  incur or assume unanticipated liabilities, losses or costs associated with the business or vessels acquired; or
 
  •  incur other significant charges, such as impairment of goodwill or other intangible assets, asset devaluation or restructuring charges.

28


 

      Unlike newbuildings, existing vessels typically do not carry warranties as to their condition. While we generally inspect existing vessels prior to purchase, such an inspection would normally not provide us with as much knowledge of a vessel’s condition as we would possess if it had been built for us and operated by us during its life. Repairs and maintenance costs for existing vessels are difficult to predict and may be substantially higher than for vessels we have operated since they were built. These costs could decrease our cash flow and reduce our liquidity.
Terrorist attacks, increased hostilities or war could lead to further economic instability, increased costs and disruption of business.
      Terrorist attacks, such as the attacks that occurred in the United States on September 11, 2001, and the current conflicts in Iraq and Afghanistan and other current and future conflicts, may adversely affect our or OPCO’s business, operating results, financial condition, ability to raise capital and future growth. Continuing hostilities in the Middle East may lead to additional armed conflicts or to further acts of terrorism and civil disturbance in the United States or elsewhere, which may contribute further to economic instability and disruption of oil production and distribution, which could result in reduced demand for our or OPCO’s services.
      In addition, oil facilities, shipyards, vessels, pipelines and oil fields could be targets of future terrorist attacks. Any such attacks could lead to, among other things, bodily injury or loss of life, vessel or other property damage, increased vessel operational costs, including insurance costs, and the inability to transport oil to or from certain locations. Terrorist attacks, war or other events beyond our control that adversely affect the distribution, production or transportation of oil to be shipped by us could entitle customers to terminate the charters and impact the use of shuttle tankers under contracts of affreightment, which would harm our or OPCO’s cash flow and business.
Operations outside the United States expose us and OPCO to political, governmental and economic instability, which could harm our and its operations.
      Because OPCO’s operations are primarily conducted outside of the United States, they may be affected by economic, political and governmental conditions in the countries where it engages in business or where its vessels are registered. Any disruption caused by these factors could harm its or our business, including by reducing the levels of oil exploration, development and production activities in these areas. OPCO derives some of its revenues from shipping oil from politically unstable regions. Conflicts in these regions have included attacks on ships and other efforts to disrupt shipping. In addition, vessels trading in some of these regions have been subject, in limited instances, to piracy. Hostilities or other political instability in regions where OPCO operates or where we or OPCO may operate could have a material adverse effect on the growth of our or its business, results of operations and financial condition and ability to make cash distributions. In addition, tariffs, trade embargoes and other economic sanctions by the United States or other countries against countries in Southeast Asia or elsewhere as a result of terrorist attacks, hostilities or otherwise may limit trading activities with those countries, which could also harm our or OPCO’s business and ability to make cash distributions. Finally, a government could requisition one or more of our vessels, which is most likely during war or national emergency. Any such requisition would cause a loss of the vessel and could harm our cash flow and financial results.
Marine transportation is inherently risky, particularly in the extreme conditions in which many of OPCO’s vessels operate. An incident involving significant loss of product or environmental contamination by any of its vessels could harm its and our reputation and business.
      Vessels and their cargoes and oil production facilities OPCO services are at risk of being damaged or lost because of events such as:
  •  marine disasters;
 
  •  bad weather;

29


 

  •  mechanical failures;
 
  •  grounding, capsizing, fire, explosions and collisions;
 
  •  piracy;
 
  •  human error; and
 
  •  war and terrorism.
      OPCO’s shuttle tanker fleet primarily operates in the North Sea. Harsh weather conditions in this or other regions in which it operates or we or it in the future may operate may increase the risk of collisions, oil spills, or mechanical failures.
      An accident involving any of our or OPCO’s vessels could result in any of the following:
  •  death or injury to persons, loss of property or damage to the environment and natural resources;
 
  •  delays in the delivery of cargo;
 
  •  loss of revenues from charters or contracts of affreightment;
 
  •  liabilities or costs to recover any spilled oil or other petroleum products and to restore the eco-system where the spill occurred;
 
  •  governmental fines, penalties or restrictions on conducting business;
 
  •  higher insurance rates; and
 
  •  damage to our and OPCO’s reputation and customer relationships generally.
      Any of these results could have a material adverse effect on our and OPCO’s business, financial condition and operating results. In addition, any damage to, or environmental contamination involving, oil production facilities serviced could suspend that service and result in loss of revenues. For example, in the first quarter of 2005, three oil fields in the North Sea temporarily shut down as a result of a gas leakage and equipment problems of third parties, which resulted in a decrease in our net voyage revenues during the shutdown.
Insurance may be insufficient to cover losses that may occur to our or OPCO’s property or result from our or its operations.
      The operation of shuttle tankers, conventional oil tankers and FSO and FPSO units is inherently risky. All risks may not be adequately insured against, and any particular claim may not be paid by insurance. In addition, substantially all of OPCO’s vessels are not insured against loss of revenues resulting from vessel off-hire time, based on the cost of this insurance compared to OPCO’s off-hire experience. Any claims covered by insurance would be subject to deductibles, and since it is possible that a large number of claims may be brought, the aggregate amount of these deductibles could be material. Certain insurance coverage is maintained through mutual protection and indemnity associations, and as a member of such associations OPCO or we may be required to make additional payments over and above budgeted premiums if member claims exceed association reserves.
      We or OPCO may be unable to procure adequate insurance coverage at commercially reasonable rates in the future. For example, more stringent environmental regulations have led in the past to increased costs for, and in the future may result in the lack of availability of, insurance against risks of environmental damage or pollution. A catastrophic oil spill or marine disaster could exceed the insurance coverage, which could harm our or OPCO’s business, financial condition and operating results. Any uninsured or underinsured loss could harm our or OPCO’s business and financial condition. In addition, the insurance may be voidable by the insurers as a result of certain actions, such as vessels failing to maintain certification with applicable maritime self-regulatory organizations.

30


 

      Changes in the insurance markets attributable to terrorist attacks may also make certain types of insurance more difficult to obtain. In addition, the insurance that may be available may be significantly more expensive than existing coverage.
We or OPCO may experience operational problems with vessels that reduce revenue and increase costs.
      Shuttle tankers are complex and their operation is technically challenging. To the extent we acquire FPSO units, this complexity and challenge will increase. Marine transportation operations are subject to mechanical risks and problems. Operational problems may lead to loss of revenue or higher than anticipated operating expenses or require additional capital expenditures. Any of these results could harm our or OPCO’s business, financial condition and operating results.
The offshore shipping and storage industry is subject to substantial environmental and other regulations, which may significantly limit operations or increase expenses.
      OPCO’s operations are affected by extensive and changing environmental protection laws and other regulations and international conventions, including those relating to equipping and operating offshore vessels and vessel safety. OPCO has incurred, and expects to continue to incur, substantial expenses in complying with these laws and regulations, including expenses for vessel modifications and changes in operating procedures. Additional laws and regulations may be adopted that could limit our or OPCO’s ability to do business or further increase costs, which could harm our or OPCO’s business. In addition, failure to comply with applicable laws and regulations may result in administrative and civil penalties, criminal sanctions or the suspension or termination of operations. We may become subject to additional laws and regulations if we enter new markets or trades.
      In addition to international regulations affecting oil tankers generally, countries having jurisdiction over North Sea areas also impose regulatory requirements applicable to operations in those areas. Operators of North Sea oil fields impose further requirements. As a result, OPCO must make significant expenditures for sophisticated equipment, reporting and redundancy systems on its shuttle tankers. Additional regulations and requirements may be adopted or imposed that could limit OPCO’s or our ability to do business or further increase the cost of doing business in the North Sea or other regions in which OPCO now or we or OPCO in the future may operate.
      The United States Oil Pollution Act of 1990 (or OPA 90 ) also has increased expenses in the industry. OPA 90 provides for potentially unlimited joint, several, and strict liability for owners, operators and demise or bareboat charterers for oil pollution and related damages in U.S. waters, which include the U.S. territorial sea and the 200-nautical mile exclusive economic zone around the United States. OPA 90 applies to discharges of any oil from a vessel, including discharges of oil tanker cargoes and discharges of fuel and lubricants from an oil tanker. To comply with OPA 90, vessel owners generally incur increased costs in meeting additional maintenance and inspection requirements, in developing contingency arrangements for potential spills and in obtaining required insurance coverage. OPA 90 contains financial responsibility requirements for vessels operating in U.S. waters and requires vessel owners and operators to establish and maintain with the U.S. Coast Guard evidence of insurance or of qualification as a self-insurer or other acceptable evidence of financial responsibility sufficient to meet certain potential liabilities under OPA 90 and the U.S. Comprehensive Environmental Response, Compensation and Liability Act (or  CERCLA ), which imposes similar liabilities upon owners, operators and bareboat charterers of vessels from which a discharge of “hazardous substances” (other than oil) occurs. Under OPA 90 and CERCLA, owners, operators and bareboat charterers are jointly and severally strictly liable for costs of cleanup and damages resulting from a discharge or threatened discharge within U.S. waters. This means we and OPCO may be subject to liability even if not negligent or at fault. OPA 90 and CERCLA do not preclude claimants from seeking damages resulting from the discharge of oil and hazardous substances under other applicable law, including maritime tort law.
      Many states in the United States bordering on a navigable waterway have enacted legislation providing for potentially unlimited strict liability without regard to fault for the discharge of pollutants

31


 

within their waters. An oil spill or other event could result in significant liability, including fines, penalties, criminal liability and costs for natural resource damages. The potential for these releases could increase to the extent we increase our operations in U.S. waters.
      In addition, we believe that the heightened environmental, quality and security concerns of insurance underwriters, regulators and charterers will generally lead to additional regulatory requirements, including enhanced risk assessment and security requirements and greater inspection and safety requirements on all vessels in the oil tanker markets.
      These requirements are likely to add incremental costs to our and OPCO’s operations and the failure to fulfill these requirements may affect the ability of our and OPCO’s vessels to obtain and, possibly, collect on insurance or to obtain the required certificates for entry into the different ports where OPCO operates.
      Our and OPCO’s business is indirectly affected by price controls, tax and accounting regimes and other regulations that apply to the oil industry generally and offshore exploration, development and production activities specifically. New regulations that restrict any of these activities could decrease demand for services and have a material adverse effect on our or OPCO’s business, financial condition and operating results.
Exposure to currency exchange rate fluctuations will result in fluctuations in cash flows and operating results.
      OPCO currently is paid in Norwegian Kroners under three charters and contracts of affreightment. In addition, we, OPCO and its operating subsidiaries will enter into services agreements with certain subsidiaries of Teekay Shipping Corporation pursuant to which those subsidiaries will provide to us and OPCO administrative services and to OPCO’s operating subsidiaries managerial, operational and administrative services. Under the services agreements, the applicable subsidiaries of Teekay Shipping Corporation are paid in U.S. Dollars for reasonable direct and indirect expenses incurred in providing the services. A substantial majority of those expenses are in Norwegian Kroners. The Teekay Shipping Corporation subsidiaries are paid under the services agreements based on a fixed U.S. Dollar/ Norwegian Kroner exchange rate until December 31, 2008. Thereafter, the exchange rate is not fixed, which may result in increased payments under the services agreements if the strength of the U.S. Dollar declines relative to the Norwegian Kroner.
Our lack of experience in FPSO operations and reliance on Petrojarl ASA could affect our ability to enter and operate in the FPSO sector.
      We have no experience providing FPSO offshore services, which are technically complicated. Teekay Shipping Corporation has entered into a joint venture agreement with Petrojarl ASA, which Teekay Shipping Corporation controls, that focuses on pursuing new projects involving FPSO units and FSO units. Pursuant to the omnibus agreement to be entered into upon the closing of this offering, Teekay Shipping Corporation will be required to offer to us its interest in certain FPSO projects under the joint venture agreement. Please read “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transaction — Omnibus Agreement” and “— Joint Venture with Petrojarl ASA.” We would rely on Petrojarl ASA’s expertise to enter the FPSO sector through any of these opportunities. If Petrojarl ASA was unable or unwilling to provide engineering and other services to the joint venture or us, it would materially and adversely affect our ability to operate in the FPSO sector.
The redeployment risk of FPSO units is high given their lack of alternative uses and significant costs.
      FPSO units are specialized vessels that have very limited alternative uses and high fixed costs. If we acquire FPSO units and they are not, as a result of contract termination or otherwise, subject to a long-term profitable contract, we may be required to bid for projects at unattractive rates in order to reduce our losses relating to the vessels.

32


 

We have no history operating as a separate publicly traded entity and will incur increased costs as a result of being a publicly traded limited partnership.
      We have no history operating as a separate publicly traded entity. As a publicly traded limited partnership, we will be required to comply with the SEC’s reporting requirements and with corporate governance and related requirements of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act, the SEC and the securities exchange on which our common units will be listed. We will incur significant legal, accounting and other expenses in complying with these and other applicable regulations. We anticipate that our incremental general and administrative expenses as a publicly traded limited partnership will be approximately $1.5 million annually, and will include costs associated with annual reports to unitholders, tax return preparation, investor relations, registrar and transfer agent’s fees, incremental director and officer liability insurance costs and officer and director compensation.
Many seafaring employees are covered by collective bargaining agreements and the failure to renew those agreements or any future labor agreements may disrupt operations and adversely affect our cash flows.
      A significant portion of Teekay Shipping Corporation’s seafarers that crew certain OPCO vessels and Norwegian-based onshore operational staff that provide services to us, OPCO and its operating subsidiaries are employed under collective bargaining agreements. Teekay Shipping Corporation may be subject to additional labor agreements in the future. Teekay Shipping Corporation may be subject to labor disruptions if relationships deteriorate with the seafarers or the unions that represent them. The collective bargaining agreements may not prevent labor disruptions, particularly when the agreements are being renegotiated. Salaries are typically renegotiated annually or bi-annually for seafarers and annually for onshore operational staff. Although these negotiations have not caused labor disruptions in the past, any future labor disruptions could harm our or OPCO’s operations and could have a material adverse effect on our or its business, results of operations and financial condition and ability to make cash distributions.
Risks Inherent in an Investment in Us
Teekay Shipping Corporation and its affiliates may engage in competition with OPCO and us.
      Teekay Shipping Corporation and its affiliates may engage in competition with us. Pursuant to the omnibus agreement, Teekay Shipping Corporation, Teekay LNG Partners L.P. and their respective controlled affiliates (other than us, OPCO and its and our subsidiaries) generally will agree not to engage in, acquire or invest in any business that owns, operates or charters (a) dynamically-positioned shuttle tankers (other than those operating in the conventional oil tanker trade under contracts with a remaining duration of less than three years, excluding extension options), (b) FSO units or (c) FPSO units (collectively offshore vessels ) without the consent of our general partner. The omnibus agreement, however, allows Teekay Shipping Corporation, Teekay LNG Partners L.P. and any of such controlled affiliates to:
  •  own, operate and charter offshore vessels if the remaining duration of the time charter or contract of affreightment for the vessel, excluding any extension options, is less than three years;
 
  •  own, operate and charter offshore vessels and related time charters or contracts of affreightment acquired as part of a business or package of assets if a majority of the value of the total assets or business acquired is not attributable to the offshore vessels and related contracts, as determined in good faith by Teekay Shipping Corporation’s board of directors or the conflicts committee of the board of directors of Teekay LNG Partners’ general partner, as applicable; however, if at any time Teekay Shipping Corporation or Teekay LNG Partners completes such an acquisition, it must, within 365 days of the closing of the transaction, offer to sell the offshore vessels and related contracts to us for their fair market value plus any additional tax or other similar costs to Teekay Shipping Corporation or Teekay LNG Partners that would be required to transfer the vessels and contracts to us separately from the acquired business or package of assets; or
 
  •  own, operate and charter offshore vessels and related time charters and contracts of affreightment that relate to a tender, bid or award for a proposed offshore project that Teekay Shipping

33


 

  Corporation or any of its subsidiaries has submitted or received or hereafter submits or receives; however, at least 365 days after the delivery date of any such offshore vessel, Teekay Shipping Corporation must offer to sell the vessel and related time charter or contract of affreightment to us, with the vessel valued (a) for newbuildings originally contracted by Teekay Shipping Corporation, at its “fully -built-up cost” (which represents the aggregate expenditures incurred (or to be incurred prior to delivery to us) by Teekay Shipping Corporation to acquire, construct and/or convert and bring such offshore vessel to the condition and location necessary for our intended use, plus project development costs for completed projects and projects that were not completed but, if completed, would have been subject to an offer to us) and (b) for any other vessels, Teekay Shipping Corporation’s cost to acquire a newbuilding from a third party or the fair market value of an existing vessel, as applicable, plus in each case any subsequent expenditures that would be included in the “fully -built-up cost” of converting the vessel prior to delivery to us.

      If we decline the offer to purchase the offshore vessels and time charters described in the immediately preceding two bullet points, Teekay Shipping Corporation or Teekay LNG Partners, as applicable, may own and operate the offshore vessels, but may not expand that portion of its business.
      In addition, pursuant to the omnibus agreement, Teekay Shipping Corporation, Teekay LNG Partners and any of their respective controlled affiliates (other than us, OPCO and its and our subsidiaries) may:
  •  acquire, operate and charter offshore vessels and related time charters and contracts of affreightment if our general partner has previously advised Teekay Shipping Corporation or Teekay LNG Partners that our general partner’s board of directors has elected, with the approval of its conflicts committee, not to cause us or our controlled affiliates to acquire or operate the vessels and related time charters and contracts of affreightment;
 
  •  acquire up to a 9.9% equity ownership, voting or profit participation interest in any publicly-traded company engages in, acquires or invests in any business that owns, operates or charters offshore vessels and related time charters and contracts of affreightment;
 
  •  provide ship management services relating to owning, operating or chartering offshore vessels and related time charters and contracts of affreightment; or
 
  •  own a limited partner interest in OPCO or own shares of Petrojarl ASA.
      In addition, Petrojarl ASA has the right to continue to own, operate and charter its four FPSOs and one shuttle tanker until such time, if ever, Teekay Shipping Corporation acquires 100% of Petrojarl ASA. If that happens, Teekay Shipping Corporation will be required to offer to us certain of Petrojarl ASA’s fleet and Petrojarl ASA’s interests in its joint venture projects with Teekay Shipping Corporation.
      If there is a change of control of Teekay Shipping Corporation or of the general partner of Teekay LNG Partners, the non-competition provisions of the omnibus agreement may terminate, which termination could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition and our ability to make cash distributions. Please read “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions — Omnibus Agreement.”
Our general partner and its other affiliates own a controlling interest in us and have conflicts of interest and limited fiduciary duties, which may permit them to favor their own interests to your detriment.
      Following this offering, Teekay Shipping Corporation will indirectly own the 2.0% general partner interest and a 63.0% limited partner interest in us and will own and control our general partner, which controls us. Although our general partner has a fiduciary duty to manage us in a manner beneficial to us and our unitholders, the directors and officers of our general partner have a fiduciary duty to manage our general partner in a manner beneficial to Teekay Shipping Corporation. Furthermore, certain directors and officers of our general partner may be directors or officers of affiliates of our general partner. Conflicts of interest may arise between Teekay Shipping Corporation and its affiliates, including our general partner, on the one hand, and us and our unitholders, on the other hand. As a result of these conflicts, our general

34


 

partner may favor its own interests and the interests of its affiliates over the interests of our unitholders. Please read “— Our partnership agreement limits our general partner’s fiduciary duties to unitholders and restricts the remedies available to unitholders for actions taken by our general partner.” These conflicts include, among others, the following situations:
  •  neither our partnership agreement nor any other agreement requires Teekay Shipping Corporation or its affiliates (other than our general partner) to pursue a business strategy that favors us or utilizes our assets, and Teekay Shipping Corporation’s officers and directors have a fiduciary duty to make decisions in the best interests of the stockholders of Teekay Shipping Corporation, which may be contrary to our interests;
 
  •  the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer and three of the directors of our general partner also serve as executive officers or directors of Teekay Shipping Corporation and the general partner of Teekay LNG Partners L.P.;
 
  •  our general partner is allowed to take into account the interests of parties other than us, such as Teekay Shipping Corporation, in resolving conflicts of interest, which has the effect of limiting its fiduciary duty to our unitholders;
 
  •  our general partner has limited its liability and reduced its fiduciary duties under the laws of the Marshall Islands, while also restricting the remedies available to our unitholders and, as a result of purchasing common units, unitholders are treated as having agreed to the modified standard of fiduciary duties and to certain actions that may be taken by our general partner, all as set forth in our partnership agreement;
 
  •  our general partner determines the amount and timing of our asset purchases and sales, capital expenditures, borrowings, issuances of additional partnership securities and reserves, each of which can affect the amount of cash that is available for distribution to our unitholders;
 
  •  in some instances, our general partner may cause us to borrow funds in order to permit the payment of cash distributions, even if the purpose or effect of the borrowing is to make a distribution on the subordinated units or to make incentive distributions or to accelerate the expiration of the subordination period;
 
  •  our general partner determines which costs incurred by it and its affiliates are reimbursable by us;
 
  •  our partnership agreement does not restrict our general partner from causing us to pay it or its affiliates for any services rendered to us on terms that are fair and reasonable or entering into additional contractual arrangements with any of these entities on our behalf;
 
  •  our general partner intends to limit its liability regarding our contractual and other obligations;
 
  •  our general partner may exercise its right to call and purchase common units if it and its affiliates own more than 80.0% of our common units;
 
  •  our general partner controls the enforcement of obligations owed to us by it and its affiliates; and
 
  •  our general partner decides whether to retain separate counsel, accountants or others to perform services for us.
      Please read “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions,” “Conflicts of Interest and Fiduciary Duties” and “The Partnership Agreement.”
Although we control OPCO through our ownership of its general partner, OPCO’s general partner owes fiduciary duties to OPCO and OPCO’s other partner, Teekay Shipping Corporation, which may conflict with the interests of us and our unitholders.
      Conflicts of interest may arise as a result of the relationships between us and our unitholders, on the one hand, and OPCO, its general partner and its other limited partner, Teekay Shipping Corporation, on the other hand. Teekay Shipping Corporation owns a 74.0% limited partner interest in OPCO and controls

35


 

our general partner, which appoints the directors of OPCO’s general partner. The directors and officers of OPCO’s general partner have fiduciary duties to manage OPCO in a manner beneficial to us, as such general partner’s owner. At the same time, OPCO’s general partner has a fiduciary duty to manage OPCO in a manner beneficial to OPCO’s limited partners, including Teekay Shipping Corporation. The board of directors of our general partner may resolve any such conflict and has broad latitude to consider the interests of all parties to the conflict. The resolution of these conflicts may not always be in the best interest of us or our unitholders.
      For example, conflicts of interest may arise in the following situations:
  •  the allocation of shared overhead expenses to OPCO and us;
 
  •  the interpretation and enforcement of contractual obligations between us and our affiliates, on the one hand, and OPCO or its subsidiaries, on the other hand;
 
  •  the determination and timing of the amount of cash to be distributed to OPCO’s partners and the amount of cash to be reserved for the future conduct of OPCO’s business;
 
  •  the decision as to whether OPCO should make asset or business acquisitions or dispositions, and on what terms;
 
  •  the determination or the amount and timing of OPCO’s capital expenditures;
 
  •  the determination of whether OPCO should use cash on hand, borrow or issue equity to raise cash to finance maintenance or expansion capital projects, repay indebtedness, meet working capital needs or otherwise; and
 
  •  any decision we make to engage in business activities independent of, or in competition with, OPCO.
The fiduciary duties of the officers and directors of our general partner may conflict with those of the officers and directors of OPCO’s general partner.
      Our general partner’s officers and directors have fiduciary duties to manage our business in a manner beneficial to us and our partners. However, the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer and all of the non-independent directors of our general partner also serve as executive officers or directors of OPCO’s general partner and of Teekay Shipping Corporation and the general partner of Teekay LNG Partners L.P., and, as a result, have fiduciary duties, among others, to manage the business of OPCO in a manner beneficial to OPCO and its partners, including Teekay Shipping Corporation. Consequently, these officers and directors may encounter situations in which their fiduciary obligations to OPCO, Teekay Shipping Corporation or Teekay LNG Partners L.P., on one hand, and us, on the other hand, are in conflict. The resolution of these conflicts may not always be in the best interest of us or our unitholders. For a more detailed description of the conflicts of interest involving our general partner, please read “Conflicts of Interest and Fiduciary Duties.”
Our partnership agreement limits our general partner’s fiduciary duties to our unitholders and restricts the remedies available to unitholders for actions taken by our general partner.
      Our partnership agreement contains provisions that reduce the standards to which our general partner would otherwise be held by Marshall Islands law. For example, our partnership agreement:
  •  permits our general partner to make a number of decisions in its individual capacity, as opposed to in its capacity as our general partner. Where our partnership agreement permits, our general partner may consider only the interests and factors that it desires, and in such cases it has no duty or obligation to give any consideration to any interest of, or factors affecting us, our affiliates or our unitholders. Decisions made by our general partner in its individual capacity will be made by its sole owner, Teekay Shipping Corporation, and not by the board of directors of our general partner. Examples include the exercise of its call right, its voting rights with respect to the units it owns, its registration rights and its determination whether to consent to any merger or consolidation of the partnership;

36


 

  •  provides that our general partner is entitled to make other decisions in “good faith” if it reasonably believes that the decision is in our best interests;
 
  •  generally provides that affiliated transactions and resolutions of conflicts of interest not approved by the conflicts committee of the board of directors of our general partner and not involving a vote of unitholders must be on terms no less favorable to us than those generally being provided to or available from unrelated third parties or be “fair and reasonable” to us and that, in determining whether a transaction or resolution is “fair and reasonable,” our general partner may consider the totality of the relationships between the parties involved, including other transactions that may be particularly favorable or advantageous to us; and
 
  •  provides that our general partner and its officers and directors will not be liable for monetary damages to us or our limited partners for any acts or omissions unless there has been a final and non-appealable judgment entered by a court of competent jurisdiction determining that the general partner or those other persons acted in bad faith or engaged in fraud, willful misconduct or gross negligence.
      In order to become a limited partner of our partnership, a common unitholder is required to agree to be bound by the provisions in the partnership agreement, including the provisions discussed above. Please read “Conflicts of Interest and Fiduciary Duties — Fiduciary Duties.”
Fees and cost reimbursements, which our general partner will determine for services provided to us, will be substantial and will reduce our cash available for distribution to you.
      Prior to making any distribution on the common units, we or OPCO will pay fees for services provided to us, OPCO and its operating subsidiaries by certain subsidiaries of Teekay Shipping Corporation, and we will reimburse our general partner for all expenses it incurs on our behalf. These fees will be negotiated on our behalf by our general partner, and our general partner will also determine the amounts it is reimbursed. These fees and expenses will include all costs incurred in providing certain administrative services to us and OPCO and certain advisory, ship management, technical and administrative services to OPCO’s operating subsidiaries, including services rendered to us pursuant to the agreements described below under “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions — Advisory and Administrative Services Agreements.” The payment of fees to Teekay Shipping Corporation and reimbursement of expenses to our general partner could adversely affect our ability to pay cash distributions to you.
Our general partner, which is owned and controlled by Teekay Shipping Corporation, makes all decisions on our behalf, subject to the limited voting rights of our common unitholders. Even if public unitholders are dissatisfied, they cannot initially remove our general partner without Teekay Shipping Corporation’s consent.
      Unlike the holders of common stock in a corporation, unitholders have only limited voting rights on matters affecting our business and, therefore, limited ability to influence management’s decisions regarding our business. Unitholders did not elect our general partner or its board of directors and will have no right to elect our general partner or its board of directors on an annual or other continuing basis. Teekay Shipping Corporation, which owns and controls our general partner, appoints our general partner’s board of directors, which in turn appoints the board of directors of OPCO’s general partner. Our general partner makes all decisions on our behalf. If the unitholders are dissatisfied with the performance of our general partner, they will have little ability to remove our general partner. As a result of these limitations, the price at which the common units will trade could be diminished because of the absence or reduction of a takeover premium in the trading price.
      The unitholders will be unable initially to remove our general partner without its consent because our general partner and its affiliates will own sufficient units upon completion of this offering to be able to prevent its removal. The vote of the holders of at least 66 2 / 3 % of all outstanding units, voting together as a single class, is required to remove our general partner. Following the closing of this offering, Teekay

37


 

Shipping Corporation will own 64.3% of the units. Also, if our general partner is removed without “cause” during the subordination period and no units held by our general partner and Teekay Shipping Corporation are voted in favor of that removal, all remaining subordinated units will automatically convert into common units and any existing arrearages on the common units will be extinguished. A removal of our general partner under these circumstances would adversely affect the common units by prematurely eliminating their distribution and liquidation preference over the subordinated units, which would otherwise have continued until we had met certain distribution and performance tests. “Cause” is narrowly defined to mean that a court of competent jurisdiction has entered a final, non-appealable judgment finding our general partner liable for actual fraud or willful or wanton misconduct in its capacity as our general partner. Cause does not include most cases of charges of poor management of the business.
      Furthermore, unitholders’ voting rights are further restricted by our partnership agreement provision providing that any units held by a person that owns 20.0% or more of any class of units then outstanding, other than our general partner, its affiliates, their transferees, and persons who acquired such units with the prior approval of the board of directors of our general partner, cannot vote on any matter. Our partnership agreement also contains provisions limiting the ability of unitholders to call meetings or to acquire information about our operations, as well as other provisions limiting the unitholders’ ability to influence the manner or direction of management.
The control of our general partner may be transferred to a third party without unitholder consent.
      Our general partner may transfer its general partner interest to a third party in a merger or in a sale of all or substantially all of its assets without the consent of the unitholders. In addition, our partnership agreement does not restrict the ability of the members of our general partner from transferring their respective membership interests in our general partner to a third party. In the event of any such transfer, the new members of our general partner would be in a position to replace the board of directors and officers of our general partner with their own choices and to control the decisions taken by the board of directors and officers.
If we cease to control OPCO, we may be deemed to be an investment company under the Investment Company Act of 1940.
      If we cease to manage and control OPCO and are deemed to be an investment company under the Investment Company Act of 1940 because of our ownership of OPCO partnership interests, we would either have to register as an investment company under the Investment Company Act, obtain exemptive relief from the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission or modify our organizational structure or our contract rights to fall outside the definition of an investment company. Registering as an investment company could, among other things, materially limit our ability to engage in transactions with affiliates, including the purchase and sale of certain securities or other property to or from our affiliates, restrict our ability to borrow funds or engage in other transactions involving leverage, and require us to add additional directors who are independent of us or our affiliates.
You will experience immediate and substantial dilution of $15.72 per common unit.
      The assumed initial public offering price of $20.00 per common unit exceeds pro forma net tangible book value of $4.28 per common unit. Based on an assumed initial public offering price of $20.00 per unit, you will incur immediate and substantial dilution of $15.72 per common unit. This dilution results primarily because the assets contributed by our general partner and its affiliates are recorded at their historical cost, and not their fair value, in accordance with GAAP. Please read “Dilution.”
We may issue additional equity securities without your approval, which would dilute your ownership interests.
      Our general partner, without the approval of our unitholders, may cause us to issue an unlimited number of additional units or other equity securities.

38


 

      The issuance by us of additional common units or other equity securities will have the following effects:
  •  our unitholders’ proportionate ownership interest in us will decrease;
 
  •  the amount of cash available for distribution on each unit may decrease;
 
  •  because a lower percentage of total outstanding units will be subordinated units, the risk that a shortfall in the payment of the minimum quarterly distribution will be borne by our common unitholders will increase;
 
  •  the relative voting strength of each previously outstanding unit may be diminished; and
 
  •  the market price of the common units may decline.
In establishing cash reserves, our general partner may reduce the amount of cash available for distribution to you.
      OPCO’s partnership agreement provides that the board of directors of our general partner, on our behalf, will approve the amount of reserves from OPCO’s cash flow that will be retained by OPCO to fund its future operating expenditures. Our partnership agreement requires our general partner to deduct from our operating surplus cash reserves that it determines are necessary to fund our future operating expenditures. These reserves will affect the amount of cash available for distribution by OPCO to us and by us to our unitholders. In addition, our general partner may establish reserves for distributions on the subordinated units, but only if those reserves will not prevent us from distributing the full minimum quarterly distribution, plus any arrearages, on the common units for the following four quarters. As described above in “Risks Inherent in Our Business — OPCO must make substantial capital expenditures to maintain the operating capacity of its fleet, which will reduce cash available for distribution. In addition, each quarter our general partner is required to deduct estimated maintenance capital expenditures from operating surplus, which may result in less cash available to unitholders than if actual maintenance capital expenditures were deducted,” our partnership agreement requires our general partner each quarter to deduct from operating surplus estimated maintenance capital expenditures, as opposed to actual expenditures, which could reduce the amount of available cash for distribution.
Our general partner has a call right that may require you to sell your common units at an undesirable time or price.
      If at any time our general partner and its affiliates own more than 80.0% of the common units, our general partner will have the right, which it may assign to any of its affiliates or to us, but not the obligation, to acquire all, but not less than all, of the common units held by unaffiliated persons at a price not less than their then-current market price as determined in accordance with our partnership agreement. As a result, you may be required to sell your common units at an undesirable time or price and may not receive any return on your investment. You may also incur a tax liability upon a sale of your units. For additional information about the call right, please read “The Partnership Agreement — Call Right.”
      At the completion of this offering and assuming no exercise of the underwriters’ over-allotment option, Teekay Shipping Corporation, an affiliate of our general partner, will own approximately 28.6% of the common units. At the end of the subordination period, assuming no additional issuances of common units, no exercise of the underwriters’ over-allotment option and conversion of our subordinated units into common units, Teekay Shipping Corporation will own approximately 64.3% of the common units. Teekay Shipping Corporation may acquire additional common units from us in connection with future transactions or through open-market or negotiated purchases.
Our partnership agreement restricts the voting rights of unitholders owning 20% or more of our common units.
      Our partnership agreement restricts unitholders’ voting rights by providing that any units held by a person that owns 20.0% or more of any class of units then outstanding, other than our general partner, its

39


 

affiliates, their transferees and persons who acquired such units with the prior approval of the board of directors of our general partner, cannot vote on any matter. The partnership agreement also contains provisions limiting the ability of unitholders to call meetings or to acquire information about our operations, as well as other provisions limiting the unitholders’ ability to influence the manner or direction of management.
You may not have limited liability if a court finds that unitholder action constitutes control of our business.
      As a limited partner in a partnership organized under the laws of the Marshall Islands, you could be held liable for our obligations to the same extent as a general partner if you participate in the “control” of our business. Our general partner generally has unlimited liability for the obligations of the partnership, such as its debts and environmental liabilities, except for those contractual obligations of the partnership that are expressly made without recourse to our general partner. In addition, the Marshall Islands Limited Partnership Act (or the Marshall Islands Act ) provides that a unitholder may be liable to us for the amount of a distribution for a period of three years from the date of the distribution, as described below under “Unitholders may have liability to repay distributions.” In addition, the limitations on the liability of holders of limited partner interests for the obligations of a limited partnership have not been clearly established in some jurisdictions in which we do business. Please read “The Partnership Agreement — Limited Liability” for a discussion of the implications of the limitations on liability to a unitholder.
We can borrow money to pay distributions, which would reduce the amount of credit available to operate our business.
      Our partnership agreement will allow us to make working capital borrowings to pay distributions. Accordingly, we can make distributions on all our units even though cash generated by our operations may not be sufficient to pay such distributions. Any working capital borrowings by us to make distributions will reduce the amount of working capital borrowings we can make for operating our business. For more information, please read “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Liquidity and Capital Resources — Credit Facilities.”
Increases in interest rates may cause the market price of our common units to decline.
      An increase in interest rates may cause a corresponding decline in demand for equity investments in general, and in particular for yield-based equity investments such as our common units. Any such increase in interest rates or reduction in demand for our common units resulting from other relatively more attractive investment opportunities may cause the trading price of our common units to decline.
There is no existing market for our common units, and a trading market that will provide you with adequate liquidity may not develop. The price of our common units may fluctuate significantly, and you could lose all or part of your investment.
      Prior to this offering, there has been no public market for our common units. After this offering, there will be only 7,000,000 publicly traded common units. We do not know the extent to which investor interest will lead to the development of a trading market or how liquid that market might be. You may not be able to resell your common units at or above the initial public offering price. Additionally, the lack of liquidity may result in wide bid-ask spreads, contribute to significant fluctuations in the market price of the common units and limit the number of investors who are able to buy the common units.
Unitholders may have liability to repay distributions.
      Unitholders may have to repay amounts wrongfully distributed to them. Under the Marshall Islands Act, we may not make a distribution to you if the distribution would cause our liabilities to exceed the fair value of our assets. Marshall Islands law provides that for a period of three years from the date of the impermissible distribution, limited partners who received the distribution and who knew at the time of the

40


 

distribution that it violated Marshall Islands law will be liable to the limited partnership for the distribution amount. Purchasers of units who become limited partners are liable for the obligations of the transferring limited partner to make contributions to the partnership that are known to the purchaser at the time it became a limited partner and for unknown obligations if the liabilities could be determined from the partnership agreement. Liabilities to partners on account of their partnership interest and liabilities that are non-recourse to the partnership are not counted for purposes of determining whether a distribution is permitted.
We have been organized as a limited partnership under the laws of the Republic of The Marshall Islands, which does not have a well-developed body of partnership law.
      Our partnership affairs are governed by our partnership agreement and by the Marshall Islands Act. The provisions of the Marshall Islands Act resemble provisions of the limited partnership laws of a number of states in the United States, most notably Delaware. The Marshall Islands Act also provides that it is to be applied and construed to make it uniform with the Delaware Revised Uniform Limited Partnership Act and, so long as it does not conflict with the Marshall Islands Act or decisions of the Marshall Islands Courts, interpreted according to the non-statutory law (or case law ) of the courts of the State of Delaware. There have been, however, few, if any, court cases in the Marshall Islands interpreting the Marshall Islands Act, in contrast to Delaware, which has a fairly well-developed body of case law interpreting its limited partnership statute. Accordingly, we cannot predict whether Marshall Islands courts would reach the same conclusions as Delaware courts. For example, the rights of our unitholders and the fiduciary responsibilities of our general partner under Marshall Islands law are not as clearly established as under judicial precedent in existence in Delaware. As a result, unitholders may have more difficulty in protecting their interests in the face of actions by our general partner and its officers and directors than would unitholders of a limited partnership formed in the United States.
Because we are organized under the laws of the Marshall Islands, it may be difficult to serve us with legal process or enforce judgments against us, our directors or our management.
      We are organized under the laws of the Marshall Islands, and all of our assets are located outside of the United States. Our business is operated primarily from our offices in the Bahamas, Norway and Singapore. In addition, our general partner is a Marshall Islands limited liability company and a majority of its directors and officers are non-residents of the United States, and all or a substantial portion of the assets of these non-residents are located outside the United States. As a result, it may be difficult or impossible for you to bring an action against us or against these individuals in the United States if you believe that your rights have been infringed under securities laws or otherwise. Even if you are successful in bringing an action of this kind, the laws of the Marshall Islands and of other jurisdictions may prevent or restrict you from enforcing a judgment against our assets or the assets of our general partner or its directors and officers. For more information regarding the relevant laws of the Marshall Islands, please read “Service of Process and Enforcement of Civil Liabilities.”
Tax Risks
      In addition to the following risk factors, you should read “Business — Taxation of the Partnership,” “Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Considerations” and “Non-United States Tax Considerations” for a more complete discussion of the expected material U.S. federal and non-U.S.  income tax considerations relating to us and the ownership and disposition of common units.
U.S. tax authorities could treat us as a “passive foreign investment company,” which could have adverse U.S. federal income tax consequences to U.S. holders.
      A foreign entity taxed as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes will be treated as a “passive foreign investment company” (or PFIC ), for U.S. federal income tax purposes if at least 75.0% of its gross income for any taxable year consists of certain types of “passive income,” or at least 50.0% of the

41


 

average value of the entity’s assets produce or are held for the production of those types of “passive income.” For purposes of these tests, “passive income” includes dividends, interest, and gains from the sale or exchange of investment property and rents and royalties other than rents and royalties that are received from unrelated parties in connection with the active conduct of a trade or business. For purposes of these tests, income derived from the performance of services does not constitute “passive income.” U.S. shareholders of a PFIC are subject to a disadvantageous U.S. federal income tax regime with respect to the income derived by the PFIC, the distributions they receive from the PFIC, and the gain, if any, they derive from the sale or other disposition of their shares in the PFIC.
      While there are legal uncertainties involved in this determination, our counsel, Perkins Coie LLP, is of the opinion that we should not be a PFIC based on certain assumptions made by them as well as certain representations we made to them regarding the composition of our assets, the source of our income, and the nature of our operations following this offering. However, no assurance can be given that the U.S. Internal Revenue Service will accept this position or that we would not constitute a PFIC for any future taxable year if there were to be changes in our assets, income or operations.
The preferential tax rates applicable to qualified dividend income are temporary, and the enactment of proposed legislation could affect whether dividends paid by us constitute qualified dividend income eligible for the preferential rate.
      Certain of our distributions may be treated as qualified dividend income eligible for preferential rates of U.S. federal income tax to U.S. individual unitholders (and certain other U.S. unitholders). In the absence of legislation extending the term for these preferential tax rates, all dividends received by such U.S. taxpayers in tax years beginning on January 1, 2011 or later will be taxed at ordinary graduated tax rates. Please read “Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Considerations — United States Federal Income Taxation of U.S. Holders — Distributions.”
      In addition, proposed legislation would deny the preferential rate of U.S. federal income tax currently imposed on qualified dividend income with respect to dividends received from a non-U.S.  corporation, unless the non-U.S.  corporation either is eligible for benefits of a comprehensive income tax treaty with the United States or is created or organized under the laws of a foreign country which has a comprehensive income tax system. Because the Marshall Islands has not entered into a comprehensive income tax treaty with the United States and imposes only limited taxes on entities organized under its laws, it is unlikely that we could satisfy either of these requirements. Consequently, if this legislation were enacted the preferential tax rates of federal income tax discussed under “Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Considerations — United States Federal Income Taxation of U.S. Holders — Distributions” may no longer be applicable to distributions received from us. As of the date hereof, it is not possible to predict with any certainty whether the proposed legislation will be enacted.
We will be subject to taxes, which will reduce our cash available for distribution to you.
      Some of our subsidiaries will be subject to tax in the jurisdictions in which they are organized or operate, reducing the amount of cash available for distribution. In computing our tax obligation in these jurisdictions, we are required to take various tax accounting and reporting positions on matters that are not entirely free from doubt and for which we have not received rulings from the governing authorities. We cannot assure you that upon review of these positions the applicable authorities will agree with our positions. A successful challenge by a tax authority could result in additional tax imposed on our subsidiaries, further reducing the cash available for distribution. In addition, changes in our operations or ownership could result in additional tax being imposed on us, OPCO or our or its subsidiaries in jurisdictions in which operations are conducted. For example, if Teekay Shipping Corporation holds less than 50.0% of the value of our units in the future, our U.S. source income may become subject to taxation under Section 883 of the U.S. Internal Revenue Code. Please read “Business — Taxation of the Partnership.”

42


 

You may be subject to income tax in one or more non-U.S.  countries, including Canada, as a result of owning our common units if, under the laws of any such country, we or OPCO are considered to be carrying on business there. Such laws may require you to file a tax return with and pay taxes to those countries.
      We intend that our affairs and the business of each of our controlled affiliates, including OPCO, will be conducted and operated in a manner that minimizes income taxes imposed upon us and these controlled affiliates or which may be imposed upon you as a result of owning our common units. However, because we are organized as a partnership, there is a risk in some jurisdictions that our activities and the activities of OPCO and our or its subsidiaries may be attributed to our unitholders for tax purposes and, thus, that you will be subject to tax in one or more non-U.S.  countries, including Canada, as a result of owning our common units if, under the laws of any such country, we or OPCO are considered to be carrying on business there. Under the Income Tax Act (Canada), our election to be treated as a corporation for U.S. tax purposes has no effect. Therefore, we will continue to be treated as a partnership for Canadian tax purposes. If you are subject to tax in any such country, you may be required to file a tax return with and to pay tax in that country based on your allocable share of our income. We may be required to reduce distributions to you on account of any withholding obligations imposed upon us by that country in respect of such allocation to you. The United States may not allow a tax credit for any foreign income taxes that you directly or indirectly incur.
      We believe we can conduct our and OPCO’s activities in a manner so that our unitholders should not be considered to be carrying on business in Canada solely as a consequence of the acquisition, holding, disposition or redemption of our common units. However, the question of whether either we or any of our controlled affiliates will be treated as carrying on business in any country, including Canada, will largely be a question of fact determined through an analysis of contractual arrangements, including the services agreements we, OPCO and its operating subsidiaries will enter into with subsidiaries of Teekay Shipping Corporation, and the way we and OPCO conduct business or operations, all of which may change over time. Please read “Non-United States Tax Considerations — Canadian Federal Income Tax Considerations.” The laws of Canada or any other foreign country may also change, which could cause the country’s taxing authorities to determine that we or OPCO are carrying on business in such country and are subject to its taxation laws. Any foreign taxes imposed on us, OPCO or any subsidiaries will reduce our cash available for distribution to you.
The ratio of dividend income to distributions on our common units is subject to business, economic and other uncertainties as well as tax reporting positions with which the IRS may disagree, which could result in a higher ratio of dividend income to distributions and adversely affect the value of the common units.
      We estimate that approximately 70.0% of the total cash distributions made to a purchaser of common units in this offering who owns those units from the date of the offering through December 31, 2009 will constitute dividend income. The remaining portion of the distributions will be treated first as a nontaxable return of capital to the extent of the purchaser’s tax basis in its common units and thereafter as capital gains. These estimates are based on certain assumptions which are subject to business, economic, regulatory, competitive and political uncertainties beyond our control. In addition, these estimates are based on current U.S. federal income tax law and tax reporting positions that we will adopt and with which the IRS could disagree. As a result of these uncertainties, these estimates may be incorrect and the actual percentage of total cash distributions that will constitute dividend income could be higher, and any difference could adversely affect the value of the common units. Please read “Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Considerations — United States Federal Income Taxation of U.S. Holders — Ratio of Dividend Income to Distributions.”

43


 

USE OF PROCEEDS
      We expect to receive net proceeds of approximately $127.8 million from the sale of 7,000,000 common units offered by this prospectus, assuming an initial public offering price of $20.00 per unit and after deducting estimated underwriting discounts and commissions and structuring fees and paying estimated offering expenses. We will use the net proceeds from this offering to repay non-interest bearing promissory notes we will issue to Teekay Shipping Corporation prior to the closing of this offering as partial consideration for our acquisition of our 26.0% interest in OPCO. The aggregate principal amount of the notes will approximate the amount of our net proceeds from this offering.
      If the underwriters exercise their over-allotment option, we will use the net proceeds to redeem common units from Teekay Shipping Corporation. The number of units we will redeem will equal the number of units for which the underwriters exercise their over-allotment option.

44


 

CAPITALIZATION
      The following table shows:
  •  our historical capitalization as of June 30, 2006; and
 
  •  our pro forma capitalization as of June 30, 2006, adjusted to reflect the offering of the common units, the application of the net proceeds we receive in this offering in the manner described under “Use of Proceeds” on the preceding page and related formation and contribution transactions. Please read “Summary — The Transactions.”
      This table is derived from and should be read together with the historical combined consolidated financial statements of Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor and our pro forma consolidated financial statements and the accompanying notes included elsewhere in this prospectus. You should also read this table in conjunction with “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations.”
                       
    As of June 30, 2006
     
    Actual   Pro Forma
         
    (in thousands)
Total cash and cash equivalents(1)(2)(3)
    $133,962       $90,000  
             
Long-term debt, including current portion:
               
 
Advances from affiliates (including accrued interest)(2)
    394,849        
 
Long-term debt(1)(4)
    543,543       1,317,314  
 
Obligation under capital lease(5)
    33,600        
             
   
Total long-term debt
    971,992       1,317,314  
Non-controlling interest(6)
    11,770       437,450  
Equity:
               
 
Owners’/ partners’ equity
    727,801        
 
Held by public:
               
   
Common units
          127,800  
 
Held by the general partner and its affiliates:
               
   
Common units
          2,284  
   
Subordinated units
          7,995  
   
General partner interest
          326  
             
     
Total equity
    727,801       138,405  
             
     
Total capitalization
    $1,711,563       $1,893,169  
             
 
Prior to or at the closing of this offering, OPCO will:
(1)  increase its borrowings under its revolving credit facilities to $1.08 billion (excluding debt relating to its five 50%-owned joint ventures, which as of June 30, 2006 totaled $237.3 million). As at June 30, 2006, the net amount of the additional debt would have been $536.5 million;
 
(2)  repay all of its advances from affiliates;
 
(3)  declare and pay a dividend to Teekay Shipping Corporation in an amount sufficient to decrease OPCO’s outstanding cash balance to approximately $90.0 million. As at June 30, 2006, this amount would have been $154.1 million, although we anticipate the actual amount will be approximately $160 million based on our estimated cash balance at the closing of this offering. To the extent OPCO’s advances from affiliates are settled through ways that do not involve cash, such as conversion to equity or contribution of the advances to OPCO, the amount of the dividend will be increased by a corresponding amount; and
 
(4)  modify its five 50%-owned joint venture agreements such that it will consolidate the debt referred to in note (1) above, which totaled $237.3 million as of June 30, 2006.
 
(5)  In September 2006, OPCO purchased the Fuji Spirit , an Aframax-class conventional crude oil tanker that was financed under a capital lease.
 
(6)  Prior to or at the closing of this offering, we will acquire a 26.0% interest in OPCO (including the 25.99% limited partner interest we will hold directly and the 0.01% general partner interest we will hold through our ownership of OPCO’s sole general partner, Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C.), thus leaving Teekay Shipping Corporation with a 74.0% direct interest in OPCO. As at June 30, 2006, Teekay Shipping Corporation’s 74.0% pro forma share of the net assets of OPCO would have been $393.9 million.

45


 

DILUTION
      Dilution is the amount by which the offering price will exceed the net tangible book value per common unit after this offering. Assuming an initial public offering price of $20.00 per common unit, on a pro forma basis as of June 30, 2006, after giving effect to this offering of common units, the application of the net proceeds in the manner described under “Use of Proceeds” and the formation and contribution transactions related to this offering, our net tangible book value would have been $85.6 million, or $4.28 per common unit. Purchasers of common units in this offering will experience substantial and immediate dilution in net tangible book value per common unit for financial accounting purposes, as illustrated in the following table.
                   
Assumed initial public offering price per common unit
          $ 20.00  
 
Pro forma net tangible book value per common unit before this offering(1)
  $ (3.24 )        
 
Increase in net tangible book value per common unit attributable to purchasers in this offering
    7.52          
             
Less: Pro forma net tangible book value per common unit after this offering(2)
            4.28  
             
Immediate dilution in net tangible book value per common unit to purchasers in this offering
          $ 15.72  
             
 
(1)  Determined by dividing the total number of units (2,800,000 common units, 9,800,000 subordinated units and the 2.0% general partner interest represented by 400,000 general partner units) to be issued to our general partner and its affiliates for their contribution of assets and liabilities to us into the net tangible book value of the contributed assets and liabilities.
 
(2)  Determined by dividing the total number of units (9,800,000 common units, 9,800,000 subordinated units and the 2.0% general partner interest represented by 400,000 general partner units) to be outstanding after this offering into our pro forma net tangible book value, after giving effect to the application of the net proceeds of this offering.
      The following table sets forth the number of units that we will issue and the total consideration contributed to us by our general partner and its affiliates and by the purchasers of common units in this offering upon consummation of the transactions contemplated by this prospectus.
                                   
    Units Acquired   Total Consideration
         
    Number   Percent   Amount   Percent
                 
General partner and its affiliates(1)(2)
    13,000,000       65.0 %   $ 10,605,895       7.0 %
New investors
    7,000,000       35.0       140,000,000       93.0  
                         
 
Total
    20,000,000       100.0 %   $ 150,605,895       100.0 %
                         
 
(1)  Upon the consummation of the transactions contemplated by this prospectus, our general partner and its affiliates will own an aggregate of 2,800,000 common units and 9,800,000 subordinated units and the 2.0% general partner interest represented by 400,000 general partner units.
 
(2)  The assets contributed by our general partner and its affiliates were recorded at historical book value, rather than fair value, in accordance with GAAP. Book value of the consideration provided by our general partner and its affiliates, as of June 30, 2006, was $10.6 million.

46


 

OUR CASH DISTRIBUTION POLICY AND RESTRICTIONS ON DISTRIBUTIONS
      You should read the following discussion of our cash distribution policy and restrictions on distributions in conjunction with specific assumptions included in this section. In addition, you should read “Forward-Looking Statements” and “Risk Factors” for information regarding statements that do not relate strictly to historical or current facts and certain risks inherent in our business.
General
Rationale for Our Cash Distribution Policy
      Our cash distribution policy reflects a basic judgment that our unitholders will be better served by our distributing our cash available (after deducting expenses, including estimated maintenance capital expenditures and reserves) rather than retaining it. Because we believe we will generally finance any expansion capital expenditures from external financing sources, we believe that our investors are best served by our distributing all of our available cash. Our cash distribution policy is consistent with the terms of our partnership agreement, which requires that we distribute all of our available cash quarterly (after deducting expenses, including estimated maintenance capital expenditures and reserves).
Limitations on Cash Distributions and Our Ability to Change Our Cash Distribution Policy
      There is no guarantee that unitholders will receive quarterly distributions from us. Our distribution policy is subject to certain restrictions and may be changed at any time, including:
  •  Our unitholders have no contractual or other legal right to receive distributions other than the obligation under our partnership agreement to distribute available cash on a quarterly basis, which is subject to our general partner’s broad discretion to establish reserves and other limitations.
 
  •  The board of directors of OPCO’s general partner, Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C. (subject to approval by the board of directors of our general partner), has authority to establish reserves for the prudent conduct of OPCO’s business. The establishment of these reserves could result in a reduction in cash distributions to you from levels we currently anticipate pursuant to our stated distribution policy.
 
  •  While our partnership agreement requires us to distribute all of our available cash, our partnership agreement, including provisions requiring us to make cash distributions contained therein, may be amended. Although during the subordination period, with certain exceptions, our partnership agreement may not be amended without the approval of non-affiliated common unitholders, our partnership agreement can be amended with the approval of a majority of the outstanding common units after the subordination period has ended. At the closing of this offering, Teekay Shipping Corporation will own 28.6% of the outstanding common units and 100.0% of the outstanding subordinated units.
 
  •  Even if our cash distribution policy is not modified or revoked, the amount of distributions we pay under our cash distribution policy and the decision to make any distribution is determined by the board of directors of our general partner, taking into consideration the terms of our partnership agreement.
 
  •  Under Section 51 of the Marshall Islands Limited Partnership Act, we may not make a distribution to you if distribution would cause our liabilities to exceed the fair value of our assets.
 
  •  We may lack sufficient cash to pay distributions to our unitholders due to decreases in net voyage revenues or increases in operating expenses, principal and interest payments on outstanding debt, tax expenses, working capital requirements, maintenance capital expenditures or anticipated cash needs.
 
  •  Our distribution policy will be affected by restrictions on distributions under OPCO’s credit facility agreements, which contain material financial tests and covenants that must be satisfied. These financial tests and covenants are described in this prospectus in “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Liquidity and Capital Resources —

47


 

  Covenants and Other Restrictions in Our Financing Agreements.” Should OPCO be unable to satisfy these restrictions included in the credit agreements or if OPCO is otherwise in default under the credit agreements, it would be prohibited from making cash distributions to us, which would materially hinder our ability to make cash distributions to you, notwithstanding our stated cash distribution policy.
 
  •  If we make distributions out of capital surplus, as opposed to operating surplus, such distributions will constitute a return of capital and will result in a reduction in the minimum quarterly distribution and the target distribution levels. We do not anticipate that we will make any distributions from capital surplus.

      Our ability to make distributions to our unitholders depends on the performance of our controlled affiliates, including OPCO, and their ability to distribute funds to us. Upon the closing of this offering, our interest in OPCO will be our only cash-generating asset. The ability of our controlled affiliates, including OPCO, to make distributions to us may be restricted by, among other things, the provisions of existing and future indebtedness, applicable partnership and limited liability company laws and other laws and regulations.
      We have a limited operating history upon which to rely with respect to whether we will have sufficient cash available for distributions to allow us to pay the minimum quarterly distributions on our common and subordinated units. While we believe, based on our financial forecast and related assumptions, that we will have sufficient cash to enable us to pay the full minimum quarterly distribution on all of our common and subordinated units for the year ending December 31, 2007, we may be unable to pay the full minimum quarterly distribution or any amount on our common units.
Our Ability to Grow Depends on Our and OPCO’s Ability to Access External Expansion Capital
      Because we and OPCO distribute all of our and its available cash, growth may not be as fast as businesses that reinvest their available cash to expand ongoing operations. We expect that we and OPCO will rely upon external financing sources, including bank borrowings and the issuance of debt and equity securities, to fund acquisitions and expansion and investment capital expenditures. As a result, to the extent OPCO or we are unable to finance growth externally, the cash distribution policy will significantly impair our or its ability to grow. To the extent we issue additional units in connection with any acquisitions or expansion or investment capital expenditures, the payment of distributions on those additional units may increase the risk that we will be unable to maintain or increase our per unit distribution level, which in turn may affect the available cash that we have to distribute on each unit. There are no limitations in our partnership agreement on our ability to issue additional units, including units ranking senior to the common units. The incurrence of additional borrowings or other debt by OPCO or us to finance our growth strategy would result in increased interest expense, which in turn may affect the available cash that OPCO has to distribute to us and that we have to distribute to our unitholders.

48


 

Initial Distribution Rate
      The amount of the minimum quarterly distribution is $0.35 per unit, or $1.40 per unit per year. The amount of available cash from operating surplus, which we also refer to as cash available for distributions, needed to pay the minimum quarterly distribution on all of the common units and subordinated units and the 2.0% general partner interest to be outstanding immediately after this offering for one quarter and for four quarters will be approximately:
                         
    Number of Units   One Quarter   Four Quarters
             
Common units
    9,800,000     $ 3,430,000     $ 13,720,000  
Subordinated units
    9,800,000       3,430,000       13,720,000  
2% general partner interest(1)
    400,000       140,000       560,000  
                   
Total
    20,000,000     $ 7,000,000     $ 28,000,000  
 
(1)  The number of general partner units is determined by multiplying the total number of units deemed to be outstanding ( i.e. , the total number of common and subordinated units outstanding divided by 98.0%) by the general partner’s 2.0% general partner interest.
      Upon completion of this offering, our general partner will adopt a policy pursuant to which we will pay an initial quarterly distribution of $0.35 per unit for each complete quarter. Beginning with the quarter ending December 31, 2006, we will distribute, within 45 days after the end of each quarter, all of our available cash to unitholders of record on the applicable record date. We will adjust our first distribution for the period from the closing of this offering through December 31, 2006 based on the actual length of the period.
      During the subordination period, before we make any quarterly distributions to subordinated unitholders, our common unitholders are entitled to receive payment of the full minimum quarterly distribution plus any arrearages in distributions from prior quarters. Please read “How We Make Cash Distributions — Subordination Period.” The amount of the minimum quarterly distribution is $0.35 per unit, or $1.40 per unit per year. We cannot guarantee, however, that we will pay the minimum quarterly distribution or any amount on the common units in any quarter.
      Our general partner will be entitled to 2.0% of all distributions that we make prior to our liquidation. The general partner’s initial 2.0% interest in these distributions may be reduced if we issue additional units in the future and our general partner does not contribute a proportionate amount of capital to us to maintain its initial 2.0% general partner interest. Our general partner has the right, but not the obligation, to contribute a proportionate amount of capital to us to maintain its current general partner interest.
      In the sections that follow, we present in detail the basis for our belief that we will be able to pay our minimum quarterly distribution on all of our common units and on all of our subordinated units for the year ending December 31, 2007. We present two tables, consisting of:
  •  Pro Forma Results of Operations for the year ended December 31, 2005 and the twelve months ended June 30, 2006, and Forecasted Results of Operations for the year ending December 31, 2007.
 
  •  Pro Forma Cash Available for Distribution for the year ended December 31, 2005 and the twelve months ended June 30, 2006, and the Forecasted Cash Available for Distribution for the year ending December 31, 2007.
Pro Forma and Forecasted Results of Operations
      We present below a forecast of the expected results of operations for Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. for the year ending December 31, 2007. We also present the unaudited pro forma consolidated results of operations for the year ended December 31, 2005 and the twelve months ended June 30, 2006. Our forecast presents, to the best of our knowledge and belief, the expected results of operations for Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. for the forecast period.

49


 

      Our forecast reflects our judgment as of the date of this prospectus of conditions we expect to exist and the course of action we expect to take during the year ending December 31, 2007. The assumptions disclosed in Note 3 to the forecast are those that we believe are significant to our forecasted results of operations. We believe that we have a reasonable objective basis for those assumptions listed in Note 3 to the forecast. We believe our actual results of operations will approximate those reflected in our forecast, but we can give no assurance that our forecasted results will be achieved. There will likely be differences between our forecast and the actual results and those differences could be material. Our and OPCO’s operations are subject to numerous risks that are beyond our control. If the forecast is not achieved, we may not be able to pay cash distributions on our common units at the initial distribution rate stated in our cash distribution policy or at all.
      Our forecast of our results of operations is a forward-looking statement and should be read together with the historical combined consolidated financial statements of Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor and the accompanying notes included elsewhere in this prospectus and together with “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations.” The forecast has been prepared by and is the responsibility of the management of our general partner.
      Neither Ernst & Young LLP, our independent registered public accounting firm, nor any other independent registered public accounting firm have compiled, examined or performed any procedures with respect to the forecasted financial information or pro forma information for the twelve months ended June 30, 2006 contained herein, nor have they expressed any opinion or given any other form of assurance on such information or its achievability, and they assume no responsibility for, and disclaim any association with, such forecasted and pro forma financial information. Ernst & Young LLP’s reports included in this prospectus relate to historical financial information of Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor, Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. and Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C. Those reports do not extend to the tables and the related forecasted and pro forma financial information contained in this section and should not be read to do so.
      When considering our financial forecast, you should keep in mind the risk factors and other cautionary statements included under the heading “Risk Factors” elsewhere in this prospectus. Any of the risks discussed in this prospectus could cause our actual results of operations to vary significantly from the financial forecast.
      We are providing the financial forecast to supplement the historical combined consolidated financial statements of Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor and our pro forma combined consolidated financial statements in support of our belief that we will have sufficient cash available to allow us to pay cash distributions on all of our outstanding common and subordinated units for each quarter in the year ending December 31, 2007 at our stated initial distribution rate. Please read “Note 3. Summary of Significant Forecast Assumptions” for further information as to the assumptions we have made for the financial forecast.
      We do not undertake any obligation to release publicly the results of any future revisions we may make to the financial forecast or to update the financial forecast to reflect events or circumstances after the date of this prospectus. Therefore, we caution you not to place undue reliance on this information.
      The unaudited pro forma consolidated results of operations for the year ended December 31, 2005 and the twelve months ended June 30, 2006 are presented to illustrate the assumed effects of:
  •  our acquisition from Teekay Shipping Corporation of a 26.0% interest in OPCO, including a 25.99% limited partner interest held directly by us and the 0.01% general partner interest held by us through our ownership of Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C., OPCO’s sole general partner;
 
  •  Teekay Shipping Corporation’s transfer to OPCO of all of the outstanding interests of Norsk Teekay Holdings Ltd., Teekay Nordic Holdings Inc., Teekay Offshore Australia Trust and Pattani Spirit L.L.C. (the OPCO Operating Subsidiaries );

50


 

  •  OPCO’s entry into new fixed-rate time-charter contracts with Teekay Shipping Corporation for nine of OPCO’s Aframax-class conventional crude oil tankers;
 
  •  OPCO’s transfer to Teekay Shipping Corporation of all chartered-in conventional crude oil and product tankers in Navion Shipping Ltd. (a subsidiary of Norsk Teekay), a 1987-built shuttle tanker (the Nordic Trym ), OPCO’s single anchor loading equipment, a 1992-built chartered-in shuttle tanker (the Borga ) and a 50.0% interest in Alta Shipping S.A., which has no material assets (collectively, the Non-OPCO Assets );
 
  •  OPCO’s purchase of the Fuji Spirit , an Aframax-class conventional crude oil tanker financed under a capital lease until its purchase by OPCO in September 2006;
 
  •  OPCO’s entry into amended operating agreements for its five 50%-owned joint ventures whereby OPCO will have unilateral control of each joint venture, which will require OPCO to consolidate the joint ventures in accordance with GAAP;
 
  •  OPCO’s incurrence of additional debt to increase its outstanding debt to $1.08 billion (excluding debt relating to the five joint ventures, which totaled $237.3 million as at June 30, 2006);
 
  •  Teekay Shipping Corporation’s contribution to OPCO of interest rate swaps with a notional principal amount of $1.09 billion, a weighted-average fixed interest rate of 5.5% (including the margin OPCO pays on its floating-rate debt) and a weighted-average remaining term of 9.7 years;
 
  •  OPCO’s repayment of all of its advances from affiliates;
 
  •  OPCO’s declaration and payment of a dividend to Teekay Shipping Corporation in an amount sufficient to decrease OPCO’s outstanding cash balance to $90.0 million;
 
  •  the completion of this offering; and
 
  •  the use of the net proceeds of this offering to repay non-interest bearing promissory notes we will issue to Teekay Shipping Corporation, as described in “Use of Proceeds.”
      The pro forma data included herein is not indicative of forecasted financial results nor does it represent comparable results of operations.
      The unaudited pro forma consolidated results of operations for the year ended December 31, 2005 are based on the audited historical combined consolidated financial statements of Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor included elsewhere in this prospectus, as adjusted to illustrate the estimated pro forma effects of the transactions described above. These unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements should be read together with “Selected Historical and Pro Forma Financial and Operating Data,” “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations,” the combined consolidated financial statements of Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor and the notes to those statements included elsewhere in this prospectus. The unaudited pro forma consolidated results of operations for the twelve months ended June 30, 2006 are based in part on the unaudited historical combined financial statements of Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor, which are not included in this prospectus, as adjusted to illustrate the estimated pro forma effects of the transactions described above.

51


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS L.P.
PRO FORMA AND FORECASTED RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
                             
    Consolidated    
    Pro Forma   Forecast
         
    Year   Twelve Months   Year
    Ended   Ended   Ending
    December 31,   June 30,   December 31,
    2005   2006   2007
             
    (unaudited)
     
    (in thousands, except for per unit amounts)
Voyage revenues
    $678,888       $688,666       $749,312  
                   
Operating expenses:
                       
Voyage expenses
    93,935       112,866       146,739  
Vessel operating expenses
    114,843       113,977       124,038  
Time-charter hire expense
    145,423       152,797       146,418  
Depreciation and amortization
    116,922       113,473       115,647  
General and administrative
    61,546       65,779       64,615  
Gain of sale of vessels
    (9,423 )     (4,897 )      
Restructuring charge
    955       1,408        
                   
Total operating expenses
    524,201       555,403       597,457  
                   
Income from vessel operations
    154,687       133,263       151,855  
Other items:
                       
Interest expense
    (73,458 )     (74,953 )     (73,245 )
Interest income
    5,265       6,590       3,600  
Foreign currency exchange gain (loss)
    9,281       (5,137 )      
Income tax recovery (expense)
    13,873       (9,675 )     4,000  
Other — net
    4,718       10,663       10,917  
                   
Income before non-controlling interest
    114,366       60,751       97,127  
Non-controlling interest
    (87,248 )     (47,494 )     (74,997 )
                   
Net income
    $27,118       $13,257       $22,130  
                   
General partner’s interest in net income
    $542       $265       $443  
Limited partners’ interest:
                       
 
Net income
    $26,576       $12,992       $21,687  
 
Net income per:
                       
   
- Common unit (basic and diluted)
    $1.40       $1.33       $1.40  
   
- Subordinated unit (basic and diluted)
    $1.31       $—       $0.81  
   
- Unit (basic and diluted)
    $1.36       $0.66       $1.11  
Please read the accompanying summary of significant accounting policies and forecast assumptions.

52


 

Summary of Significant Accounting Policies and Forecast Assumptions
Note 1. Basis of Presentation
      The accompanying financial forecast and related notes of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. present the forecasted results of operations of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. for the year ending December 31, 2007, based on the assumption that, as of the closing of this offering, we will acquire a 26.0% interest in OPCO, including a 25.99% limited partner interest held directly by us and a 0.01% general partner interest held through our ownership of Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C., OPCO’s sole general partner. Upon the closing of this offering, we will issue common units and subordinated units, representing limited partner interests to Teekay Shipping Corporation, and our 2.0% general partner interest and incentive distribution rights to our general partner, Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C., a wholly owned subsidiary of Teekay Shipping Corporation. We will issue to investors common units, representing limited partner interests, pursuant to this offering. The accompanying financial forecast is presented in accordance with the guidelines established by the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants.
      In constructing the unaudited pro forma consolidated results of operations for the year ended December 31, 2005 and for the twelve months ended June 30, 2006, we used the historical combined consolidated results of operations for Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor for those periods and adjusted such results of operations as described in “— Pro Forma and Forecasted Results of Operations” above.
Note 2: Summary of Significant Accounting Policies
      Organization. We are a Marshall Islands limited partnership formed on August 31, 2006 to acquire from Teekay Shipping Corporation a 26.0% interest in OPCO. Our general partner is Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C., a wholly owned subsidiary of Teekay Shipping Corporation.
      Principles of Consolidation. This financial forecast includes our accounts and those of our wholly owned subsidiaries and partially-owned subsidiaries we control, including OPCO. All intercompany transactions and balances have been eliminated in consolidation.
      Use of Estimates. The preparation of financial statements in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the amounts reported in the financial statements and accompanying notes. Actual results could differ from those estimates.
      Reporting Currency. The financial forecast is stated in U.S. Dollars because we operate in international shipping markets that typically utilize the U.S. Dollar as the functional currency. Transactions involving other currencies during a period are converted into U.S. Dollars using the exchange rates in effect at the time of the transactions. At the balance sheet dates, monetary assets and liabilities that are denominated in currencies other than the U.S. Dollar are translated to reflect the period-end exchange rates. Resulting gains or losses are reflected in our consolidated statements of income.
      Revenue Recognition. We recognize revenues from time charters and bareboat charters daily over the term of the charter as the applicable vessel operates under the charter. We do not recognize revenue during days that the vessel is off-hire. All voyage revenues from voyage charters are recognized on a percentage of completion method. We use a discharge-to -discharge basis in determining percentage of completion for all spot voyages, and voyages servicing contracts of affreightment, whereby we recognize revenue ratably from when product is discharged (unloaded) at the end of one voyage to when it is discharged after the next voyage. We do not begin recognizing voyage revenue until a charter has been agreed to by the customer and us, even if the vessel has discharged its cargo and is sailing to the anticipated load port on its next voyage. Shuttle tanker voyages servicing contracts of affreightment with offshore oil fields commence with tendering of notice of readiness at a field, within the agreed lifting range, and end with tendering of notice of readiness at a field for the next lifting.
      Voyage Expenses. Voyage expenses are all expenses unique to a particular voyage, including any bunker fuel expenses, port fees, cargo loading and unloading expenses, canal tolls, agency fees and

53


 

commissions. Voyage expenses are typically paid by the customer under time charters and bareboat charters and by the shipowner under contracts of affreightment and voyage charters. Voyage expenses are recognized when incurred.
      Vessel Operating Expenses. Vessel operating expenses, which include crewing, repairs and maintenance, insurance, stores, lube oils and communication expenses, are typically paid by the shipowner other than under bareboat charters, where the customer typically pays these expenses. The two largest components of vessel operating expenses are crews and repairs and maintenance. Vessel operating expenses are recognized when incurred.
      Cash and Cash Equivalents. We classify all highly liquid investments with a maturity date of three months or less when purchased as cash and cash equivalents.
      Vessels and Equipment. All pre-delivery costs incurred during the construction of newbuildings are capitalized, including interest, supervision and technical costs. The acquisition cost and all costs incurred to restore used vessels purchased to the standard required to properly service customers are capitalized. Vessels are depreciated to their estimated residual value. Depreciation is calculated on a straight-line basis over a vessel’s useful life. Depreciation is calculated using an estimated useful life of 25 years for our vessels, from the date the vessel was originally delivered from the shipyard or a shorter period if regulations are expected to prevent us from operating the vessels for 25 years. Depreciation and amortization includes depreciation on all owned vessels and vessels accounted for as capital leases.
      Generally, we drydock each shuttle tanker and conventional oil tanker every two and a half to five years. We capitalize a substantial portion of the costs we incur during drydocking and amortize those costs on a straight-line basis from the completion of a drydocking to the estimated completion of the next drydocking. We expense costs related to routine repairs and maintenance incurred during drydocking that do not improve or extend the useful lives of the assets. When significant drydocking expenditures occur prior to the expiration of this period, we expense the remaining unamortized balance of the original drydocking cost in the month of the subsequent drydocking.
      We assess vessels and equipment for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate the carrying amount of an asset may not be recoverable. We measure recoverability of an asset by comparing its carrying amount to future undiscounted cash flows that the asset is expected to generate over its expected remaining useful life. If we consider a vessel or equipment to be impaired, we recognize impairment in an amount equal to the excess of the carrying value of the asset over its fair market value.
      Direct Financing Leases. We assemble, install, operate and lease equipment that reduces volatile organic compound emissions (or VOC Equipment ) during loading, transportation and storage of oil and oil products. Leasing of the VOC Equipment is accounted for as a direct financing lease, with lease payments received being allocated between the net investment in the lease and other income using the effective interest method so as to produce a constant periodic rate of return over the lease term.
      Loan Costs. Loan costs, including fees, commissions and legal expenses associated with the loans, are presented as other assets and capitalized and amortized on a straight-line basis over the term of the relevant loan. Amortization of loan costs is included in interest expense.
      Derivative Instruments. We utilize derivative financial instruments to reduce interest rate risks. We do not hold or issue derivative financial instruments for trading purposes. Statement of Financial Accounting Standards (or SFAS ) No. 133, Accounting for Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities , which was amended in June 2000 by SFAS No. 138 and in May 2003 by SFAS No. 149, establishes accounting and reporting standards for derivative instruments and hedging activities. It requires that an entity recognize all derivatives as either assets or liabilities in the statement of financial condition and measure those instruments at fair value. Derivatives that are not hedges or are not designated as hedges are adjusted to fair value through income. If the derivative is a hedge, depending upon the nature of the hedge, changes in the fair value of the derivatives are either offset against the fair value of assets, liabilities or firm commitments through income, or recognized in other comprehensive income until the hedged item

54


 

is recognized in income. The ineffective portion of a derivative’s change in fair value is immediately recognized into income.
      Goodwill and Intangible Assets. Goodwill is not amortized, but reviewed for impairment annually or more frequently as impairment indicators arise. Intangible assets with finite lives are amortized over their useful lives. Intangible assets, which consist of contracts of affreightment acquired as part of the purchase of Navion AS (or Navion ) in April 2003, are amortized over their respective lives, with the amount amortized each year being weighted based on the projected revenue to be earned under the contracts.
      Income Taxes. OPCO’s Norwegian subsidiaries and Australian ship-owning subsidiary are subject to income taxes. We account for such taxes using the liability method pursuant to SFAS No. 109, “Accounting for Income Taxes.”
Note 3: Summary of Significant Forecast Assumptions
      Vessel Deliveries and Vessel Sales. The forecast reflects or assumes, as appropriate, the following changes in OPCO’s fleet:
  •  the sale of two older shuttle tankers in March and October 2005 (collectively, the 2005 Shuttle Tanker Dispositions );
 
  •  the sale of an older shuttle tanker in July 2006 (the 2006 Shuttle Tanker Disposition );
 
  •  the sale and lease back of an older shuttle tanker in March 2005;
 
  •  the sale of a 2000-built liquid petroleum gas carrier (the Dania Spirit ) to a subsidiary of Teekay Shipping Corporation in June 2005 (or the 2005 Conventional Tanker Disposition ); and
 
  •  the conversion of the Navion Saga, a Suezmax-class conventional crude oil tanker, to an FSO unit and the subsequent commencement of a three-year FSO time-charter contract beginning in the second quarter of 2007.
      Foreign Currency. Although OPCO operates in international shipping markets, which typically utilize the U.S. Dollar as the functional currency, a small portion of OPCO’s voyage revenues are denominated in Norwegian Kroner. For purposes of this forecast, we have assumed an exchange rate of 1 U.S. Dollar to 6.425 Kroner for the year ending December 31, 2007. Please read “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Items You Should Consider When Evaluating Our Historical Performance and Assessing Our Future Prospects.”
      Net Voyage Revenues. Consistent with general practice in the shipping industry, we use net voyage revenues (defined as voyage revenues less voyage expenses) as a measure of equating revenues generated from voyage charters to revenues generated from time charters, which assists us in making operating decisions about the deployment of vessels and their performance. Under time-charter and bareboat charter contracts, the charterer typically pays the voyage expenses, whereas under voyage charter contracts and contracts of affreightment the shipowner typically pays the voyage expenses. Some voyage expenses are fixed, and the remainder can be estimated. If OPCO, as the shipowner, pays the voyage expenses, it typically passes the approximate amount of these expenses on to customers by charging higher rates under the contract or billing the expenses to them. As a result, although voyage revenues from different types of contracts may vary, the net revenues after subtracting voyage expenses, which we refer to as net voyage revenues, are comparable across the different types of contracts. We principally use net voyage revenues, a non-GAAP financial measure, because it provides more meaningful information to us than voyage revenues, the most directly comparable GAAP financial measure. Net voyage revenues are also widely used by investors and analysts in the shipping industry for comparing financial performance between companies in the shipping industry to industry averages.
      Forecasted net voyage revenues for the year ending December 31, 2007 is approximately $17.6 million greater than the pro forma results for the year ended December 31, 2005, primarily as a result of an increase from new and renewed shuttle tanker and FSO unit time charters and bareboat charters at higher

55


 

rates, which occurred in the ordinary course of business and were the result of negotiations between the relevant parties. This forecasted increase in net voyage revenues is partially offset by the 2005 Shuttle Tanker Dispositions, the 2005 Conventional Tanker Disposition, the 2006 Shuttle Disposition and the redelivery of one chartered-in vessel back to its owner in April 2006.
      Forecasted net voyage revenues for the year ending December 31, 2007 is approximately $26.8 million greater than the pro forma results for the twelve months ended June 30, 2006, primarily as a result of an increase in new and renewed shuttle tanker and FSO unit time charters and bareboat charters at higher rates. In addition, during the first half of 2006, our pro forma results included earlier annual seasonal maintenance on certain North Sea oil fields compared to 2005. As a result, the pro forma results for the twelve months ended June 30, 2006 had two maintenance seasons in the twelve-month period, whereas the other twelve month periods have the usual one maintenance season as described below. The forecasted increase in net voyage revenues is partially offset by the 2006 Shuttle Disposition and redelivery of one chartered-in vessel back to its owner in April 2006.
      Due to the harsh winter weather conditions, oil field operators in the North Sea typically schedule oil platform and other infrastructure repairs and maintenance during the summer, typically in the third quarter. Because a significant portion of OPCO’s North Sea shuttle tankers operate under contracts of affreightment, under which revenue is based on volume of oil transported, the results of the shuttle tanker operations in the North Sea under these contracts generally reflect this seasonal production pattern. The affected shuttle tankers are typically redeployed as conventional oil tankers during maintenance season; the rates in the conventional market may be higher or lower than the fixed-rates under the contracts of affreightment.
      The forecast is based upon estimated average daily hire rates and the total number of days OPCO’s vessels are expected to be on-hire during the year ending December 31, 2007. In determining this we have assumed that off-hire for owned vessels will be similar to levels of off-hire for 2005 and the first six months of 2006 and that shuttle tankers servicing contracts of affreightment will be utilized at levels similar to those for 2005 and the first six months of 2006. These assumptions include expected off-hire due to scheduled drydockings. The amount of actual off-hire time depends upon, among other things, the time a vessel spends in drydocking for repairs, maintenance or inspection, equipment breakdowns or delays due to accidents, crewing strikes, certain vessel detentions or similar problems as well as failure to maintain the vessel in compliance with its specifications and contractual standards or to provide the required crew.
      Average daily hire rates for each vessel are derived from OPCO’s contracts of affreightment, time charters and bareboat charters. The average daily hire rate is equal to the voyage revenues earned by a vessel during a given period, divided by the total number of days the vessel is not off-hire.
      Vessel Operating Expenses. Forecasted vessel operating expenses for the year ending December 31, 2007 is approximately $9.2 million and $10.1 million greater than the pro forma results for the year ended December 31, 2005 and the twelve months ended June 30, 2006, respectively, primarily as a result of an increase in operating expenses from the conversion of the Navion Saga to an FSO unit, which has higher operating costs on average compared to a conventional tanker, and an increase in crew and officers’ salaries due to changes in crew composition and general wage escalations. These forecasted increases are partially offset by decreases in operating expenses from the 2005 Shuttle Tanker Dispositions, the 2005 Conventional Tanker Disposition and the 2006 Shuttle Disposition.
      Some of the more significant vessel operating expenses include crewing and other labor and related costs, repairs and maintenance and insurance costs. Upon the closing of this offering, all of OPCO’s seafaring employees will become employees of other Teekay Shipping Corporation subsidiaries and OPCO’s operating subsidiaries will enter into services agreements with Teekay Shipping Corporation subsidiaries by which the Teekay Shipping Corporation subsidiaries will provide crewing and other vessel operation services. Please read “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions — Advisory and Administrative Services Agreements.” Labor and related costs for purposes of this forecast are based upon estimated payments under these services agreements, historical experience and contractual unionized wage rates. Insurance costs are estimated based upon anticipated premiums.

56


 

      Time-Charter Hire Expense. Our forecast for the year ending December 31, 2007 assumes that we will charter-in an average of 11.7 shuttle tankers during this period. Our forecast for the number of chartered-in vessels and the average rate per day is primarily based upon existing time-charter contracts. Forecasted time-charter hire expense for the year ending December 31, 2007 is approximately $1.0 million greater than the pro forma results for the year ended December 31, 2005, primarily due to estimated annual rate escalations, partially offset by an estimated 13% decrease in the average number of vessels chartered-in. Forecasted time-charter hire expense for the year ending December 31, 2007 is approximately $6.4 million less than the pro forma results for the twelve months ended June 30, 2006 due to an estimated 20% decrease in the average number of vessels chartered-in, partially offset by estimated annual rate escalations.
      Depreciation and Amortization. Forecasted depreciation for the year ending December 31, 2007 is approximately $1.3 million less than the pro forma results for the year ended December 31, 2005, primarily as a result of a decrease in depreciation from the 2005 Shuttle Tanker Dispositions and the 2005 Conventional Tanker Disposition and a decrease in amortization from the expiration in 2005 of two of our contracts of affreightment, partially offset by a forecasted increase in depreciation of the costs to convert the Navion Saga to an FSO unit, vessel upgrades and an increase in amortization of drydock expenditures. Forecasted depreciation and amortization for the year ending December 31, 2007 is approximately $2.2 million greater than the pro forma results for the twelve months ended June 30, 2006, primarily due to an increase in the forecasted depreciation as previously mentioned, partially offset by a decrease in depreciation from the 2006 Shuttle Disposition.
      Our forecast for depreciation expense assumes that no vessels are purchased or sold during the year ending December 31, 2007. Depreciation is calculated on a straight-line basis over a vessel’s useful life, which we estimate to be 25 years. The value of contracts of affreightment acquired is being amortized over their respective lives, with the amount amortized each year being weighted based on the projected revenue to be earned under the contracts.
      General and Administrative Expenses. Forecasted general and administrative expenses for the year ending December 31, 2007 is approximately $3.1 million greater than the pro forma results for the year ended December 31, 2005, primarily as a result of a forecasted increase in total shore-staff compensation and an estimated $1.5 million increase for public-company costs, reimbursements to our general partner and payments to certain subsidiaries of Teekay Shipping Corporation for administrative and certain other services to be provided to us, OPCO and its operating subsidiaries under services agreements to be entered into upon the closing of this offering. Forecasted general and administrative expenses for the year ending December 31, 2007 is approximately $1.1 million less than the pro forma results for the twelve months ended June 30, 2006, primarily as a result of forecasted decreases in shore-staff incentive compensation, substantially offset by the estimated increase for public-company costs, reimbursements to our general partner and payments to certain subsidiaries of Teekay Shipping Corporation for administrative and certain other services.
      Interest Expense. Forecasted interest expense for the year ending December 31, 2007 is approximately $0.2 million and $1.7 million less than the pro forma results for the year ended December 31, 2005 and the twelve months ended June 30, 2006, respectively, primarily as a result of a lower outstanding average debt balance under revolving credit facilities and term loans during the year ending December 31, 2007. This forecasted decrease is partially offset by a forecasted increase in interest expense from an estimated increase in the floating interest rates on term loans. Our forecast for the year ending December 31, 2007 assumes an average revolving credit facility balance outstanding of $1.03 billion with an estimated weighted-average interest rate of 5.5% per annum, which rate is based upon the average effective interest rate on the revolving credit facilities after giving effect to existing interest rate swap agreements. Our forecast for the year ending December 31, 2007 assumes an average outstanding term loan balance of $218.8 million with an estimated weighted average interest rate of 6.25% per annum, which rate is based upon an estimated LIBOR rate of 5.75% plus the applicable margins under the term loans.

57


 

      Interest Income. Forecasted interest income for the year ending December 31, 2007 is approximately $1.7 million and $3.0 million less than the pro forma results for the year ended December 31, 2005 and the twelve months ended June 30, 2006, respectively, primarily as a result of assumed lower average cash balances outstanding during the year ending December 31, 2007 compared to the year ended December 31, 2005 and the twelve months ended June 30, 2006. Our forecast for the year ending December 31, 2007 assumes an average cash balance outstanding of $90.0 million, and an average rate of return of 4% per annum.
      Income Taxes. Forecasted income tax recovery for the year ending December 31, 2007 is approximately $9.9 million less and $13.7 million greater than the pro forma results for the year ended December 31, 2005 and the twelve months ended June 30, 2006, respectively. The decrease and increase in forecasted income tax recovery are primarily the result of deferred income tax recoveries during the year ended December 31, 2005 and deferred income tax expenses during the twelve months ended June 30, 2006, from unrealized foreign currency exchange losses and gains, respectively, on intercompany loans with certain Norwegian subsidiaries. The majority of these amounts do not have a cash impact. Our forecast assumes a constant foreign exchange rate throughout 2007.
      Other-Net. Forecasted other income for the year ending December 31, 2007 is approximately $6.2 million and $0.3 million greater than the pro forma results for the year ended December 31, 2005 and the twelve months ended June 30, 2006, respectively, primarily as a result of:
  •  a pro forma $3.4 million write-off of capitalized loan costs on January 1, 2005;
 
  •  $2.8 million and $0.9 million of other expenses incurred during the year ended December 31, 2005 and the twelve months ended June 30, 2006, respectively;
      partially offset by
  •  an estimated $0.6 million decrease in the income received from our VOC Equipment during the year ending December 31, 2007 compared to the twelve months ended June 30, 2006.
      Our forecast for the year ending December 31, 2007 consists of $10.9 million of income from VOC Equipment. This amount is based upon amounts to be received from existing lease contracts and amounts expected to be received on VOC Equipment currently being assembled and installed on certain shuttle tankers.
      Non-Controlling Interest. Forecasted non-controlling interest for the year ending December 31, 2007 is approximately $12.3 million less and $27.5 million greater than the pro forma results for the year ended December 31, 2005 and the twelve months ended June 30, 2006, respectively, primarily as a result of a $17.2 million decrease and a $36.4 million increase in income before non-controlling interest, respectively. Our forecast for the year ending December 31, 2007 assumes that OPCO will earn $90.9 million in net income ($67.3 million — non-controlling owner’s portion), OPCO’s five 50%-owned joint venture shuttle tankers will earn $15.4 million in net income ($7.7 million — non-controlling owner’s portion), and OPCO’s one 89%-owned FSO unit will earn $0.6 million net income ($0.1 million — non-controlling owner’s portion), resulting in a total non-controlling interest of $75.0 million.
      Drydocking and Replacement Reserve. Forecasted initial annual maintenance capital expenditures for OPCO’s fleet are $73.9 million per year, which includes $12.2 million for drydocking costs and $61.7 million, including financing costs, for replacing OPCO’s shuttle tankers, FSO units and conventional tankers at the end of their useful lives.

58


 

      Regulatory, Industry and Economic Factors. We forecast for the year ending December 31, 2007 based on the following assumptions related to regulatory, industry and economic factors:
  •  no material nonperformance or credit-related defaults by suppliers, customers or vendors;
 
  •  no new regulation or any interpretation of existing regulations that, in either case, would be materially adverse to our or OPCO’s business.
 
  •  no material accidents, releases, weather-related incidents, unscheduled downtime or similar unanticipated events;
 
  •  no major adverse change in the markets in which OPCO operates resulting from production disruptions, reduced demand for oil or significant changes in the market prices of oil;
 
  •  no material changes to market, regulatory and overall economic conditions; and
 
  •  an annual inflation rate of 2.0% to 3.0%, depending upon the applicable jurisdiction.
Pro Forma and Forecasted Cash Available for Distribution
      If we had completed the transactions contemplated in this prospectus on January 1, 2005 or July 1, 2005 as a publicly-traded partnership, pro forma cash available for distribution generated during the year ended December 31, 2005 and the twelve months ended June 30, 2006 would have been approximately $27.8 million and $23.4 million, respectively. This amount would have been sufficient to make aggregate cash distributions equal to 100.0% of the minimum quarterly distribution of $0.35 per unit per quarter (or $1.40 per unit on an annualized basis) on our common units for the year ended December 31, 2005 and for the twelve months ended June 30, 2006 and 98.8% and 67.4%, respectively, of the minimum quarterly distribution on our subordinated units for those periods.
      The following table illustrates, on a pro forma basis, for the year ended December 31, 2005 and for the twelve months ended June 30, 2006, the amount of cash available for distribution that would have been available for distributions to our unitholders, assuming that this offering and the related transactions had been consummated on January 1, 2005 and July 1, 2005, respectively.
      The table below also sets forth our calculation of forecasted cash available for distribution to our unitholders and general partner based on the Pro Forma and Forecasted Results of Operations set forth above. Based on the financial forecast and related assumptions, we forecast that our cash available for distribution generated during the year ending December 31, 2007 will be approximately $30.9 million. This amount would be sufficient to pay 100.0% of the minimum quarterly distribution of $0.35 per unit on all of our common units and subordinated units for the four quarters ending December 31, 2007.
      You should read “Note 3. Summary of Significant Forecast Assumptions” included as part of the financial forecast for a discussion of the material assumptions underlying our forecast of EBITDA that is included in the table below. Our forecast is based on those material assumptions and reflects our judgment of conditions we expect to exist and the course of action we expect to take. The assumptions disclosed in our financial forecast are those that we believe are significant to generate the forecasted EBITDA. If our estimate is not achieved, we may not be able to pay distributions on the common units at the initial distribution rate of $0.35 per unit per quarter ($1.40 per unit on an annualized basis). Our financial forecast and the forecast of cash available for distribution set forth below have been prepared by our management. Our independent registered public accounting firm has not examined, compiled, or otherwise applied procedures to our financial forecast and the forecast of cash available for distribution set forth below and, accordingly, do not express an opinion or any other form of assurance on it.
      EBITDA should not be considered an alternative to net income, operating income, cash flow from operating activities or any other measure of financial performance or liquidity calculated in accordance with GAAP.

59


 

      When considering our forecast of cash available for distribution for the year ending December 31, 2007, you should keep in mind the risk factors and other cautionary statements under the heading “Risk Factors” and elsewhere in this prospectus. Any of these factors or the other risks discussed in this prospectus could cause our financial condition and consolidated results of operations to vary significantly from those set forth in the financial forecast and the forecast of cash available for distribution set forth below.
      Although we forecast sufficient available cash to pay the full minimum quarterly distribution on all of our common and subordinated units for the year ending December 31, 2007, OPCO’s new credit facility allows it to make working capital borrowings and to loan the proceeds to us, which we could use to make distributions. This allows us to manage fluctuations in OPCO’s working capital.

60


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS L.P.
PRO FORMA AND FORECASTED CASH AVAILABLE FOR DISTRIBUTION
                           
    Consolidated Pro Forma   Forecast(1)
         
    Year   Twelve Months   Year
    Ended   Ended   Ending
    December 31,   June 30,   December 31,
    2005   2006   2007
             
    (unaudited)
     
    (dollars in thousands except per unit amounts)
EBITDA(2)
    $198,360       $204,769       $203,423  
 
Adjustments for other non-cash items:
                       
 
Non-controlling interest
    87,248       47,494       74,997  
 
Write-off of capitalized loan costs
    3,402              
 
Foreign currency exchange loss (gain)
    (9,281 )     5,137        
 
Gain on sale of vessels
    (9,423 )     (4,897 )      
                   
      270,306       252,503       278,420  
                   
 
Adjustments for cash items and maintenance capital expenditures reserves:
                       
 
Minority owners share of cash available for distribution from joint ventures
    (15,328 )     (14,351 )     (11,863 )
 
Cash interest expense
    (72,238 )     (73,733 )     (72,285 )
 
Cash interest income
    5,265       6,590       3,600  
 
Cash income tax expense
    (2,762 )     (2,699 )     (1,000 )
 
Public partnership expenses
    1,500       1,500       1,500  
 
Drydocking capital expenditure reserve(3)
    (12,240 )     (12,240 )     (12,240 )
 
Replacement capital expenditure reserve(3)
    (61,680 )     (61,680 )     (61,680 )
                   
Cash available for distribution from OPCO
    112,823       95,890       124,452  
TSC’s 74.0% limited partner share of OPCO’s available cash
    (83,489 )     (70,959 )     (92,094 )
Public partnership expenses
    (1,500 )     (1,500 )     (1,500 )
                   
Cash available for distribution
    $27,834       $23,431       $30,858  
                   
Expected distributions:
                       
Distributions per unit
    $1.40       $1.40       $1.40  
Distributions to our public common unitholders(4)
    9,800       9,800       9,800  
Distributions to TSC — common units(4)
    3,920       3,920       3,920  
Distributions to TSC — subordinated units
    13,720       13,720       13,720  
Distributions to TSC — general partner interest
    560       560       560  
                   
Total distributions(5)
    $28,000       $28,000       $28,000  
                   
Excess (shortfall)
    $(166 )     $(4,569 )     $2,858  
Annualized initial quarterly distribution per unit
    $1.40       $1.40       $1.40  
Aggregate distributions based on annualized minimum quarterly distribution
    $28,000       $28,000       $28,000  
Percent of minimum quarterly distributions payable to common unitholders
    100.0 %     100.0 %     100.0 %
Percent of minimum quarterly distributions payable to subordinated unitholders
    98.8 %     67.4 %     100.0 %

61


 

(1)  The forecasted column is based on the assumptions set forth in “— Pro Forma and Forecasted Results of Operations — Summary of Significant Accounting Policies and Assumptions.”
 
(2)  EBITDA is a non-GAAP financial measure, which we use as it is an important supplemental measure of performance and liquidity. EBITDA means earnings before interest, taxes, depreciation and amortization. This measure is not calculated or presented in accordance with GAAP. We explain this measure below and reconcile it to its most directly comparable financial measures calculated and presented in accordance with GAAP.
      EBITDA is used as a supplemental financial measure by management and by external users of our financial statements, such as investors, to assess:
  •  the financial and operating performance of assets without regard to financing methods, capital structure, income taxes or historical cost basis; and
 
  •  the ability to generate cash sufficient to service debt, make distributions to our unitholders and undertake capital expenditures.
      EBITDA should not be considered an alternative to net income, operating income, cash flow from operating activities or any other measure of financial performance or liquidity presented in accordance with GAAP. EBITDA excludes some, but not all, items that affect net income and operating income, and these measures may vary among other companies.
      Therefore, EBITDA as presented below may not be comparable to similarly titled measures of other companies. The following table presents a reconciliation of EBITDA to the most directly comparable GAAP financial measures on a pro forma and forecasted basis for each of the periods indicated.
                         
    Consolidated Pro Forma   Forecast
         
    Year   Twelve Months   Year
    Ended   Ended   Ending
    December 31,   June 30,   December 31,
    2005   2006   2007
             
    (unaudited)
     
    (in thousands)
Reconciliation of “EBITDA” to “Net operating cash flow”:
                       
Net operating cash flow
    $212,382       $185,553       $188,146  
Non-controlling interest
    (87,248 )     (47,494 )     (74,997 )
Interest expense, net
    66,973       67,143       68,685  
Change in working capital
    (22,951 )     (9,162 )      
Foreign currency exchange gain (loss) and other, net
    15,248       (5,747 )     1,000  
Gain on sale of vessels
    9,423       4,897        
Expenditures for drydocking
    8,906       10,007       20,589  
Write-off of capitalized loan costs
    (3,402 )            
Equity loss (net of dividends received)
    (971 )     (428 )      
                   
EBITDA
    $198,360       $204,769       $203,423  
                   
(3)  Our partnership agreement requires that an estimate of the maintenance capital expenditures necessary to maintain our asset base be subtracted from operating surplus each quarter, as opposed to amounts actually spent. Because our interest in OPCO will represent our only cash-generating asset upon the closing of this offering, an estimate of its maintenance capital expenditures is more meaningful. The board of directors of our general partner, Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C., will approve the amount of OPCO’s reserves for maintenance capital expenditures and other purposes. Our initial estimated maintenance capital expenditures for OPCO are $73.9 million per year. The amount of estimated maintenance capital expenditures attributable to future drydocking expenses is based on the

62


 

average annual anticipated drydocking over the remaining useful lives of OPCO’s vessels. The actual cost of maintenance capital expenditures, including for drydocking, vessel replacement and other items, will depend on a number of factors, including, among others, prevailing market conditions, charter hire rates and the availability and cost of financing at the time of vessel replacement. We may elect to fund some or all maintenance capital expenditures through the issuance of additional common units, which may be dilutive to existing unitholders. Please read “Risk Factors — Risks Inherent in Our Business — OPCO must make substantial capital expenditures to maintain the operating capacity of its fleet, which will reduce cash available for distribution. In addition, each quarter our general partner is required to deduct estimated maintenance capital expenditures from operating surplus, which may result in less cash available to unitholders than if actual maintenance capital expenditures were deducted.”
 
(4)  Assumes the underwriters’ option to purchase additional common units is not exercised. The net proceeds from any exercise of the underwriters’ option to purchase additional common units will be used to redeem common units from Teekay Shipping Corporation. The number of units redeemed would equal the number of units for which the underwriters exercise their over-allotment option.
 
(5)  Represents the amount required to fund distributions to our unitholders and our general partner for four quarters based upon our minimum quarterly distribution rate of $0.35 per unit.

63


 

HOW WE MAKE CASH DISTRIBUTIONS
Distribution of Available Cash
General
      Within approximately 45 days after the end of each quarter, beginning with the quarter ending December 31, 2006, we will distribute all of our available cash (defined below) to unitholders of record on the applicable record date. We will adjust the minimum quarterly distribution for the period from the closing of this offering through December 31, 2006 based on the actual length of the period.
Available Cash
      We define available cash in the glossary, and it generally means, for each fiscal quarter, all cash on hand at the end of the quarter (including our proportionate share of cash on hand of certain subsidiaries we do not wholly own, including OPCO):
  •  less the amount of cash reserves (including our proportionate share of cash reserves of certain subsidiaries we do not wholly own) established by our general partner to:
  •  provide for the proper conduct of our business (including reserves for future capital expenditures and for anticipated credit needs);
 
  •  comply with applicable law, any debt instruments or other agreements; or
 
  •  provide funds for distributions to our unitholders and to our general partner for any one or more of the next four quarters;
  •  plus all cash on hand (including our proportionate share of cash on hand of certain subsidiaries we do not wholly own) on the date of determination of available cash for the quarter resulting from working capital borrowings made after the end of the quarter. Working capital borrowings are generally borrowings that are made under credit agreements and in all cases are used solely for working capital purposes or to pay distributions to partners.
Intent to Distribute the Minimum Quarterly Distribution
      We intend to distribute to the holders of common units and subordinated units on a quarterly basis at least the minimum quarterly distribution of $0.35 per unit, or $1.40 per unit per year, to the extent we have sufficient cash on hand to pay the distribution after we establish cash reserves and pay fees and expenses. The amount of available cash from operating surplus needed to pay the minimum quarterly distribution for one quarter on all units outstanding immediately after this offering and the related distribution on the 2.0% general partner interest is approximately $7.0 million.
      However, there is no guarantee that we will pay the minimum quarterly distribution on the units in any quarter. Even if our cash distribution policy is not modified or revoked, the amount of distributions paid under our policy and the decision to make any distribution is determined by our general partner, taking into consideration the terms of our partnership agreement. Because our 26.0% interest in OPCO will be our only cash-generating asset upon the closing of this offering, the amount of our distributions to unitholders initially will depend upon distributions by OPCO to us. OPCO will be prohibited from making any distributions to us if it would cause an event of default, or an event of default is existing, under its credit agreements. Please read “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Liquidity and Capital Resources — Credit Facilities” and “— Covenants and Other Restrictions in Our Financing Agreements” for a discussion of the restrictions to be included in the credit agreements that may restrict OPCO’s ability to make distributions.

64


 

Operating Surplus and Capital Surplus
Overview
      All cash distributed to unitholders will be characterized as either “operating surplus” or “capital surplus.” We treat distributions of available cash from operating surplus differently than distributions of available cash from capital surplus.
Definition of Operating Surplus
      We define operating surplus in the glossary, and for any period it generally means:
  •  $15.0 million; plus
 
  •  all cash receipts (including our proportionate share of cash receipts for certain subsidiaries we do not wholly own, including OPCO) after the closing of this offering, excluding cash from (1) borrowings, other than working capital borrowings, (2) sales of equity and debt securities, (3) sales or other dispositions of assets outside the ordinary course of business, (4) termination of interest rate swap agreements, (5) capital contributions or (6) corporate reorganizations or restructurings; plus
 
  •  working capital borrowings (including our proportionate share of working capital borrowings for certain subsidiaries we do not wholly own) made after the end of a quarter but before the date of determination of operating surplus for the quarter; plus
 
  •  interest paid on debt incurred (including periodic net payments under related interest rate swap agreements) and cash distributions paid on equity securities issued, in each case (and including our proportionate share of such interest and cash distributions paid by certain subsidiaries we do not wholly own), to finance all or any portion of the construction, expansion or improvement of a capital asset such as vessels during the period from such financing until the earlier to occur of the date the capital asset is put into service or the date that it is abandoned or disposed of; plus
 
  •  interest paid on debt incurred (including periodic net payments under related interest rate swap agreements) and cash distributions paid on equity securities issued, in each case (and including our proportionate share of such interest and cash distributions paid by certain subsidiaries we do not wholly own), to pay the construction period interest on debt incurred (including periodic net payments under related interest rate swap agreements), or to pay construction period distributions on equity issued, to finance the construction projects described in the immediately preceding bullet; less
 
  •  all of our operating expenditures (including our proportionate share of operating expenditures by certain subsidiaries we do not wholly own) after the closing of this offering and the repayment of working capital borrowings, but not (1) the repayment of other borrowings, (2) actual maintenance capital expenditures, or expansion capital expenditures or investment capital expenditures, (3) transaction expenses (including taxes) related to interim capital transactions or (4) distributions; less
 
  •  estimated maintenance capital expenditures and the amount of cash reserves (including our proportionate share of cash reserves for certain subsidiaries we do not wholly own) established by our general partner to provide funds for future operating expenditures.
      If a working capital borrowing, which increases operating surplus, is not repaid during the twelve-month period following the borrowing, it will be deemed repaid at the end of such period, thus decreasing operating surplus at such time. When such working capital borrowing is in fact repaid, it will not be treated as a reduction in operating surplus because operating surplus will have been previously reduced by the deemed repayment.
      As described above, operating surplus includes a provision that will enable us, if we choose, to distribute as operating surplus up to $15.0 million of cash we receive in the future from non-operating

65


 

sources, such as asset sales, issuances of securities and long-term borrowing, that would otherwise be distributed as capital surplus. In addition, the effect of including, as described above, certain cash distributions on equity securities or interest payments on debt in operating surplus also would be to increase operating surplus by the amount of any such cash distributions or interest payments. As a result, we may distribute as operating surplus up to the amount of any such cash distributions or interest payments of cash we receive from non-operating sources.
Capital Expenditures
      For purposes of determining operating surplus, maintenance capital expenditures are those capital expenditures required to maintain over the long term the operating capacity of or the revenue generated by capital assets, and expansion capital expenditures are those capital expenditures that increase the operating capacity of or the revenue generated by capital assets. To the extent, however, that capital expenditures associated with acquiring a new vessel increase the revenues or the operating capacity of the fleet, those capital expenditures would be classified as expansion capital expenditures.
      Investment capital expenditures are those capital expenditures that are neither maintenance capital expenditures nor expansion capital expenditures. Investment capital expenditures largely will consist of capital expenditures made for investment purposes.
      Examples of investment capital expenditures include traditional capital expenditures for investment purposes, such as purchases of securities, as well as other capital expenditures that might be made in lieu of such traditional investment capital expenditures, such as the acquisition of a capital asset for investment purposes.
      Examples of maintenance capital expenditures include capital expenditures associated with drydocking a vessel or acquiring a new vessel to the extent such expenditures are incurred to maintain the operating capacity of or the revenue generated by the fleet. Maintenance capital expenditures will also include interest (and related fees) on debt incurred and distributions on equity issued to finance the construction of a replacement vessel and paid during the construction period, which we define as the period beginning on the date of entry into a binding construction contract and ending on the earlier of the date that the replacement vessel commences commercial service or the date that the replacement vessel is abandoned or disposed of. Debt incurred to pay or equity issued to fund construction period interest payments, and distributions on such equity, will also be considered maintenance capital expenditures.
      Because we expect that maintenance capital expenditures will be very large and vary significantly in timing, the amount of actual maintenance capital expenditures may differ substantially from period to period, which could cause similar fluctuations in the amounts of operating surplus, adjusted operating surplus, and available cash for distribution to our unitholders if we subtracted actual maintenance capital expenditures from operating surplus each quarter. Accordingly, to eliminate the effect on operating surplus of these fluctuations, our partnership agreement will require that an amount equal to an estimate of the average quarterly maintenance capital expenditures necessary to maintain the operating capacity of or the revenue generated by our capital assets over the long term be subtracted from operating surplus each quarter, as opposed to the actual amounts spent. The amount of estimated maintenance capital expenditures deducted from operating surplus is subject to review and change by the board of directors of our general partner at least once a year, provided that any change must be approved by the board’s conflicts committee. The estimate will be made at least annually and whenever an event occurs that is likely to result in a material adjustment to the amount of our maintenance capital expenditures, such as a major acquisition or the introduction of new governmental regulations that will affect our fleet. For purposes of calculating operating surplus, any adjustment to this estimate will be prospective only. For a discussion of the amounts we have allocated toward estimated maintenance capital expenditures, please read “Our Cash Distribution Policy and Restrictions on Distributions.” The partnership agreement of OPCO requires that the board of directors of our general partner, on our behalf, must approve the amount of maintenance capital reserves for OPCO.

66


 

      Our use of estimated maintenance capital expenditures in calculating operating surplus will have the following effects:
  •  it will reduce the risk that actual maintenance capital expenditures in any one quarter will be large enough to make operating surplus less than the minimum quarterly distribution to be paid on all the units for that quarter and subsequent quarters;
 
  •  it will reduce the need for us to borrow to pay distributions;
 
  •  it will be more difficult for us to raise our distribution above the minimum quarterly distribution and pay incentive distributions to our general partner; and
 
  •  it will reduce the likelihood that a large maintenance capital expenditure in a period will prevent our general partner’s affiliates from being able to convert some or all of their subordinated units into common units since the effect of an estimate is to spread the expected expense over several periods, mitigating the effect of the actual payment of the expenditure on any single period.
Definition of Capital Surplus
      We also define capital surplus in the glossary, and it generally will be generated only by:
  •  borrowings other than working capital borrowings;
 
  •  sales of debt and equity securities; and
 
  •  sales or other dispositions of assets for cash, other than inventory, accounts receivable and other current assets sold in the ordinary course of business or non-current assets sold as part of normal retirements or replacements of assets.
Characterization of Cash Distributions
      We will treat all available cash distributed as coming from operating surplus until the sum of all available cash distributed since we began operations equals the operating surplus as of the most recent date of determination of available cash. We will treat any amount distributed in excess of operating surplus, regardless of its source, as capital surplus. As described above, operating surplus does not reflect actual cash on hand that is available for distribution to our unitholders. For example, it includes a provision that will enable us, if we choose, to distribute as operating surplus up to $15.0 million of cash we receive in the future from non-operating sources such as asset sales, issuances of securities and long-term borrowings that would otherwise be distributed as capital surplus. We do not anticipate that we will make any distributions from capital surplus.
Subordination Period
General
      During the subordination period, which we define below and in the glossary, the common units will have the right to receive distributions of available cash from operating surplus in an amount equal to the minimum quarterly distribution of $0.35 per quarter, plus any arrearages in the payment of the minimum quarterly distribution on the common units from prior quarters, before any distributions of available cash from operating surplus may be made on the subordinated units. Distribution arrearages do not accrue on the subordinated units. The purpose of the subordinated units is to increase the likelihood that during the subordination period there will be available cash from operating surplus to be distributed on the common units.

67


 

Definition of Subordination Period
      We define the subordination period in the glossary. Except as described below under “Early Termination of Subordination Period,” the subordination period will extend until the first day of any quarter, beginning after December 31, 2009, that each of the following tests are met:
  •  distributions of available cash from operating surplus on each of the outstanding common units and subordinated units equaled or exceeded the minimum quarterly distribution for each of the three, consecutive, non-overlapping four-quarter periods immediately preceding that date;
 
  •  the “adjusted operating surplus” (as defined below) generated during each of the three consecutive, non-overlapping four-quarter periods immediately preceding that date equaled or exceeded the sum of the minimum quarterly distributions on all of the outstanding common units and subordinated units during those periods on a fully diluted basis and the related distribution on the 2% general partner interest during those periods; and
 
  •  there are no arrearages in payment of the minimum quarterly distribution on the common units.
      If the unitholders remove our general partner without cause, the subordination period may end before December 31, 2009.
      Early Termination of Subordination Period. The subordination period will automatically terminate and the subordinated units will convert into common any units on a one-for-one basis if the following tests are met:
  •  distributions of available cash from operating surplus on each of the outstanding common units, subordinated units and general partner units equaled or exceeded $2.10 (150.0% of the annualized minimum quarterly distribution) for any four-quarter period immediately preceding the date of determination; and
 
  •  the “adjusted operating surplus” (as defined below) generated during any four-quarter period immediately preceding the date of determination equaled or exceeded the sum of a distribution of $2.10 per common unit (150.0% of the annualized minimum quarterly distribution) on all of the outstanding common and subordinated units on a fully diluted basis; and
 
  •  there are no arrearages in payment of the minimum quarterly distribution on the common units.
      For purposes of determining whether sufficient adjusted operating surplus has been generated under these conversion tests, the conflicts committee may adjust adjusted operating surplus upwards or downwards if it determines in good faith that the estimated amount of maintenance capital expenditures used in the determination of operating surplus was materially incorrect, based on circumstances prevailing at the time of original determination of the estimate.
Definition of Adjusted Operating Surplus
      We define adjusted operating surplus in the glossary, and for any period it generally means:
  •  operating surplus generated with respect to that period; less
 
  •  any net increase in working capital borrowings (including our proportionate share of any changes in working capital borrowings of certain subsidiaries we do not wholly own, including OPCO) with respect to that period; less
 
  •  any net reduction in cash reserves (including our proportionate share of cash reserves of certain subsidiaries we do not wholly own) for operating expenditures with respect to that period not relating to an operating expenditure made with respect to that period; plus
 
  •  any net decrease in working capital borrowings (including our proportionate share of any changes in working capital borrowings of certain subsidiaries we do not wholly own) with respect to that period; plus

68


 

  •  any net increase in cash reserves (including our proportionate share of cash reserves of certain subsidiaries we do not wholly own) for operating expenditures with respect to that period required by any debt instrument for the repayment of principal, interest or premium.
      Adjusted operating surplus is intended to reflect the cash generated from operations during a particular period and therefore excludes net increases in working capital borrowings and net drawdowns of reserves of cash generated in prior periods.
Effect of Expiration of the Subordination Period
      Upon expiration of the subordination period, each outstanding subordinated unit will convert into one common unit and will then participate pro rata with the other common units in distributions of available cash. In addition, if the unitholders remove our general partner other than for cause and units held by our general partner and its affiliates are not voted in favor of such removal:
  •  the subordination period will end and each subordinated unit will immediately convert into one common unit;
 
  •  any existing arrearages in payment of the minimum quarterly distribution on the common units will be extinguished; and
 
  •  our general partner will have the right to convert its general partner interest and, if any, its incentive distribution rights into common units or to receive cash in exchange for those interests.
Distributions of Available Cash From Operating Surplus During the Subordination Period
      We will make distributions of available cash from operating surplus for any quarter during the subordination period in the following manner:
  •  first, 98.0% to the common unitholders, pro rata, and 2.0% to our general partner, until we distribute for each outstanding common unit an amount equal to the minimum quarterly distribution for that quarter;
 
  •  second, 98.0% to the common unitholders, pro rata, and 2.0% to our general partner, until we distribute for each outstanding common unit an amount equal to any arrearages in payment of the minimum quarterly distribution on the common units for any prior quarters during the subordination period;
 
  •  third, 98.0% to the subordinated unitholders, pro rata, and 2.0% to our general partner, until we distribute for each subordinated unit an amount equal to the minimum quarterly distribution for that quarter; and
 
  •  thereafter, in the manner described in “— Incentive Distribution Rights” below.
      The preceding paragraph is based on the assumption that our general partner maintains its 2.0% general partner interest and that we do not issue additional classes of equity securities.
Distributions of Available Cash From Operating Surplus After the Subordination Period
      We will make distributions of available cash from operating surplus for any quarter after the subordination period in the following manner:
  •  first, 98.0% to all unitholders, pro rata, and 2.0% to our general partner, until we distribute for each outstanding unit an amount equal to the minimum quarterly distribution for that quarter; and
 
  •  thereafter, in the manner described in “— Incentive Distribution Rights” below.
      The preceding paragraph is based on the assumption that our general partner maintains its 2.0% general partner interest and that we do not issue additional classes of equity securities.

69


 

Incentive Distribution Rights
      Incentive distribution rights represent the right to receive an increasing percentage of quarterly distributions of available cash from operating surplus after the minimum quarterly distribution and the target distribution levels have been achieved. Our general partner currently holds the incentive distribution rights, but may transfer these rights separately from its general partner interest. Except for transfers of incentive distribution rights to an affiliate or another entity as part of our general partner’s merger or consolidation with or into, or sale of all or substantially all of its assets to such entity, the approval of a majority of our common units (excluding common units held by our general partner and its affiliates), voting separately as a class, generally is required for a transfer of the incentive distributions rights to a third party prior to December 31, 2016. Please read “The Partnership Agreement — Transfer of Incentive Distribution Rights.” Any transfer by our general partner of the incentive distribution rights would not change the percentage allocations of quarterly distributions with respect to such rights.
      If for any quarter:
  •  we have distributed available cash from operating surplus to the common and subordinated unitholders in an amount equal to the minimum quarterly distribution; and
 
  •  we have distributed available cash from operating surplus on outstanding common units in an amount necessary to eliminate any cumulative arrearages in payment of the minimum quarterly distribution;
then, we will distribute any additional available cash from operating surplus for that quarter among the unitholders and our general partner in the following manner:
  •  first, 98.0% to all unitholders, pro rata, and 2.0% to our general partner, until each unitholder receives a total of $0.4025 per unit for that quarter (the “first target distribution”);
 
  •  second, 85.0% to all unitholders, pro rata, and 15.0% to our general partner, until each unitholder receives a total of $0.4375 per unit for that quarter (the “second target distribution”);
 
  •  third, 75.0% to all unitholders, pro rata, and 25.0% to our general partner, until each unitholder receives a total of $0.525 per unit for that quarter (the “third target distribution”); and
 
  •  thereafter, 50.0% to all unitholders, pro rata, and 50.0% to our general partner.
      In each case, the amount of the target distribution set forth above is exclusive of any distributions to common unitholders to eliminate any cumulative arrearages in payment of the minimum quarterly distribution. The percentage interests set forth above assume that our general partner maintains its 2.0% general partner interest and has not transferred the incentive distribution rights and that we do not issue additional classes of equity securities.

70


 

Percentage Allocations of Available Cash From Operating Surplus
      The following table illustrates the percentage allocations of the additional available cash from operating surplus between the unitholders and our general partner up to the various target distribution levels. The amounts set forth under “Marginal Percentage Interest in Distributions” are the percentage interests of the unitholders and our general partner in any available cash from operating surplus we distribute up to and including the corresponding amount in the column “Total Quarterly Distribution Target Amount,” until available cash from operating surplus we distribute reaches the next target distribution level, if any. The percentage interests shown for the unitholders and our general partner for the minimum quarterly distribution are also applicable to quarterly distribution amounts that are less than the minimum quarterly distribution. The percentage interests shown for our general partner include its 2.0% general partner interest and assume our general partner has contributed any capital necessary to maintain its 2.0% general partner interest and has not transferred the incentive distribution rights.
                         
        Marginal Percentage
        Interest in Distributions
    Total Quarterly Distribution    
    Target Amount   Unitholders   General Partner
             
Minimum Quarterly Distribution
    $0.35       98.0 %     2.0 %
First Target Distribution
    Up to $0.4025       98.0 %     2.0 %
Second Target Distribution
    Above $0.4025 up to $0.4375       85.0 %     15.0 %
Third Target Distribution
    Above $0.4375 up to $0.525       75.0 %     25.0 %
Thereafter
    Above $0.525       50.0 %     50.0 %
Distributions From Capital Surplus
How Distributions From Capital Surplus Will Be Made
      We will make distributions of available cash from capital surplus, if any, in the following manner:
  •  first, 98.0% to all unitholders, pro rata, and 2.0% to our general partner, until we distribute for each common unit that was issued in this offering, an amount of available cash from capital surplus equal to the initial public offering price; and
 
  •  second, 98.0% to the common unitholders, pro rata, and 2.0% to our general partner, until we distribute for each common unit, an amount of available cash from capital surplus equal to any unpaid arrearages in payment of the minimum quarterly distribution on the common units; and
 
  •  thereafter, we will make all distributions of available cash from capital surplus as if they were from operating surplus.
      The preceding paragraph is based on the assumption that our general partner maintains its 2.0% general partner interest and that we do not issue additional classes of equity securities.
Effect of a Distribution From Capital Surplus
      Our partnership agreement treats a distribution of capital surplus as the repayment of the initial unit price from this offering, which is a return of capital. Each time a distribution of capital surplus is made, the minimum quarterly distribution and the target distribution levels will be reduced in the same proportion as the distribution had to the fair market value of the common units prior to the announcement of the distribution. Because distributions of capital surplus will reduce the minimum quarterly distribution, after any of these distributions are made, it may be easier for our general partner to receive incentive distributions and for the subordinated units to convert into common units. However, any distribution of capital surplus before the minimum quarterly distribution is reduced to zero cannot be applied to the payment of the minimum quarterly distribution or any arrearages.
      Once we reduce the minimum quarterly distribution and the target distribution levels to zero, we will then make all future distributions from operating surplus, with 50.0% being paid to the holders of units and

71


 

50.0% to our general partner. The percentage interests shown for our general partner include its 2.0% general partner interest and assume the general partner maintains its 2.0% general partner interest and has not transferred the incentive distribution rights.
Adjustment to the Minimum Quarterly Distribution and Target Distribution Levels
      In addition to adjusting the minimum quarterly distribution and target distribution levels to reflect a distribution of capital surplus, if we combine our units into fewer units or subdivide our units into a greater number of units, we will proportionately adjust:
  •  the minimum quarterly distribution;
 
  •  the target distribution levels; and
 
  •  the initial unit price.
      For example, if a two-for-one split of the common and subordinated units should occur, the minimum quarterly distribution, the target distribution levels and the initial unit price would each be reduced to 50.0% of its initial level. If we combine our common units into a lesser number of units or subdivide our common units into a greater number of units, we will combine our subordinated units or subdivide our subordinated units, using the same ratio applied to the common units. We will not make any adjustment by reason of the issuance of additional units for cash or property.
      In addition, if legislation is enacted or if existing law is modified or interpreted by a governmental taxing authority so that OPCO or any subsidiary becomes subject to additional taxation as an entity for U.S. federal, state, local or foreign tax purposes, our partnership agreement specifies that the minimum quarterly distribution and the target distribution levels for each quarter will be reduced by multiplying each distribution level by a fraction, the numerator of which is available cash for that quarter and the denominator of which is the sum of available cash for that quarter plus the general partner’s estimate of our direct or indirect aggregate liability for the quarter for such taxes payable by reason of such legislation or interpretation. To the extent that the actual tax liability differs from the estimated tax liability for any quarter, the difference will be accounted for in subsequent quarters.
Distributions of Cash Upon Liquidation
      If we dissolve in accordance with the partnership agreement, we will sell or otherwise dispose of our assets in a process called liquidation. We will apply the proceeds of liquidation in the manner set forth below.
      If, as of the date three trading days prior to the announcement of the proposed liquidation, the average closing price of our common units for the preceding 20 trading days (or the current market price ) is greater than the sum of:
  •  any arrearages in payment of the minimum quarterly distribution on the common units for any prior quarters during the subordination period; plus
 
  •  the initial unit price (less any prior capital surplus distributions and any prior cash distributions made in connection with a partial liquidation);
      then the proceeds of the liquidation will be applied as follows:
  •  first, 98.0% to the common unitholders, pro rata, and 2.0% to our general partner, until we distribute for each outstanding common unit an amount equal to the current market price of our common units;
 
  •  second, 98.0% to the subordinated unitholders, pro rata, and 2.0% to our general partner, until we distribute for each subordinated unit an amount equal to the current market price of our common units; and

72


 

  •  thereafter, 50.0% to all unitholders, pro rata, 48.0% to holders of incentive distribution rights and 2.0% to our general partner.
      If, as of the date three trading days prior to the announcement of the proposed liquidation, the current market price of our common units is equal to or less than the sum of:
  •  any arrearages in payment of the minimum quarterly distribution on the common units for any prior quarters during the subordination period; plus
 
  •  the initial unit price (less any prior capital surplus distributions and any prior cash distributions made in connection with a partial liquidation);
      then the proceeds of the liquidation will be applied as follows:
  •  first, 98.0% to the common unitholders, pro rata, and 2.0% to our general partner, until we distribute for each outstanding common unit an amount equal to the initial unit price (less any prior capital surplus distributions and any prior cash distributions made in connection with a partial liquidation);
 
  •  second, 98.0% to the common unitholders, pro rata, and 2.0% to our general partner, until we distribute for each outstanding common unit an amount equal to any arrearages in payment of the minimum quarterly distribution on the common units for any prior quarters during the subordination period;
 
  •  third, 98.0% to the subordinated unitholders and 2.0% to our general partner, until we distribute for each outstanding subordinated unit an amount equal to the initial unit price (less any prior capital surplus distributions and any prior cash distributions made in connection with a partial liquidation); and
 
  •  thereafter, 50.0% to all unitholders, pro rata, 48.0% to holders of incentive distribution rights and 2.0% to our general partner.
      The immediately preceding two paragraphs are based on the assumption that our general partner maintains its 2.0% general partner interest and that we do not issue additional classes of equity securities.

73


 

SELECTED HISTORICAL AND PRO FORMA FINANCIAL AND OPERATING DATA
      The following table presents, in each case for the periods and as at the dates indicated, selected:
  •  historical financial and operating data of Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor; and
 
  •  pro forma financial and operating data of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P.
      The selected historical financial and operating data has been prepared on the following basis:
  •  the historical financial and operating data of Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor as at and for the years ended December 31, 2001, 2002 and 2003 are derived from the unaudited combined consolidated financial statements of Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor, which are not included in this prospectus;
 
  •  the historical financial and operating data of Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor as at and for the years ended December 31, 2004 and 2005 are derived from the audited combined consolidated financial statements of Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor included elsewhere in this prospectus; and
 
  •  the historical financial and operating data of Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor as at and for the six months ended June 30, 2005 and June 30, 2006 are derived from the unaudited combined consolidated financial statements of Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor, which, other than the unaudited combined balance sheet as at June 30, 2005, are included elsewhere in this prospectus.
      The unaudited pro forma financial data of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. presented for the year ended December 31, 2005 and as at and for the six months ended June 30, 2006 are derived from our unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this prospectus. The pro forma income statement data for the year ended December 31, 2005 and for the six months ended June 30, 2006 assumes this offering and related transactions occurred on January 1, 2005. The pro forma balance sheet data assumes this offering and related transactions occurred on June 30, 2006. A more complete explanation of the pro forma data can be found in our unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements.
      The following table includes two financial measures, net voyage revenues and EBITDA, which we use in our business and are not calculated or presented in accordance with GAAP. We explain these measures and reconcile them to their most directly comparable financial measures calculated and presented in accordance with GAAP in “— Non-GAAP Financial Measures” below.

74


 

      The following table should be read together with, and is qualified in its entirety by reference to, the historical combined consolidated and unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements and the accompanying notes included elsewhere in this prospectus. The table should be read together with “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations.”
                                                                           
    Historical   Pro Forma
         
        Six    
        Months       Six
        Ended       Months
    Years Ended December 31,   June 30,   Year Ended   Ended
            December 31,   June 30,
    2001   2002   2003   2004   2005   2005   2006   2005   2006
                                     
    (unaudited)   (audited)   (unaudited)   (unaudited)
                 
    (in thousands, except per unit and fleet data)
Income Statement Data:
                                                                       
Voyage revenues
    $137,258       $156,745       $747,383       $986,504       $807,548       $400,315       $386,724       $678,888       $349,299  
                                                       
Operating expenses:
                                                                       
 
Voyage expenses(1)
    7,447       8,894       146,893       118,819       74,543       32,400       48,344       93,935       60,186  
 
Vessel operating expenses(2)
    31,617       42,395       87,507       105,595       104,475       52,900       52,954       114,843       57,545  
 
Time-charter hire expenses
                235,976       372,449       373,536       176,276       165,935       145,423       76,288  
 
Depreciation and amortization
    45,167       49,579       93,269       118,460       107,542       55,620       51,331       116,922       56,138  
 
General and administrative
    10,424       11,733       33,968       65,819       85,856       37,838       43,469       61,546       32,265  
 
Vessel and equipment writedowns and (gain) loss on sale of vessels
                63       (3,725 )     2,820       5,369       1,845       (9,423 )     (305 )
 
Restructuring charge
                            955             453       955       453  
                                                       
Total operating expenses
    94,655       112,601       597,676       777,417       749,727       360,403       364,331       524,201       282,570  
                                                       
Income from vessel operations
    42,603       44,144       149,707       209,087       57,821       39,912       22,393       154,687       66,729  
Interest expense
    (31,090 )     (28,136 )     (46,872 )     (43,957 )     (39,791 )     (20,100 )     (24,504 )     (73,458 )     (36,961 )
Interest income
    999       549       1,278       2,459       4,605       2,271       3,291       5,265       3,834  
Equity income (loss) from joint ventures
    2,634       4,597       5,047       6,162       5,199       2,573       3,191       (971 )     (49 )
Gain (loss) on sale of marketable securities
    (1,415 )     (1,227 )     517       94,222                                
Foreign currency exchange gain (loss)(3)
    3,685       (35,121 )     (17,821 )     (37,910 )     34,178       25,730       (18,688 )     9,281       (4,339 )
Income tax recovery (expense)
    (4,963 )     (8,116 )     (30,035 )     (28,188 )     13,873       15,786       (7,762 )     13,873       (7,762 )
Other — net
    2,923       1,313       4,455       14,064       9,091       3,694       5,694       5,689       5,694  
Non-controlling interest
    (2,345 )     (1,212 )     (2,763 )     (2,167 )     (229 )     (692 )     (414 )     (87,248 )     (21,541 )
                                                       
Net income (loss)
    $13,031       $(23,209 )     $63,513       $213,772       $84,747       $69,174       $(16,799 )     $27,118       $5,605  
                                                       
Pro forma net income per common unit (basic and diluted)(4)
                                                            $1.40       $0.56  
Balance Sheet Data (at end of period):
                                                                       
Cash and marketable securities
    $32,605       $39,754       $160,957       $143,729       $128,986       $119,495       $133,962               $90,000  
Vessels and equipment(5)
    709,787       725,263       1,431,947       1,427,481       1,300,064       1,346,328       1,260,765               1,528,480  
Total assets
    878,816       1,002,452       2,037,855       2,040,642       1,884,017       1,913,756       1,866,330               2,038,218  
Total debt(6)
    456,761       673,074       1,354,392       1,210,998       991,855       1,045,094       971,992               1,317,314  
Non-controlling interest(7)
    13,199       14,412       15,525       14,276       11,859       14,597       11,770               437,450  
Total owner’s/partners’ equity
    369,287       262,835       529,794       659,212       740,379       727,052       727,801               138,405  
Cash Flow Data:
                                                                       
Net cash provided by (used in):
                                                                       
 
Operating activities
    $34,054       $12,110       $227,297       $242,592       $152,687       $81,232       $48,705                  
 
Financing activities
    298,471       151,340       731,329       (69,710 )     (201,554 )     (153,647 )     (42,602 )                
 
Investing activities
    (299,920 )     (156,301 )     (837,423 )     (190,110 )     34,124       48,182       (1,127 )                
Other Financial Data:
                                                                       
Net voyage revenues
    $129,811       $147,851       $600,490       $867,685       $733,005       $367,915       $338,380       $584,953       $289,113  
EBITDA(8)
    93,252       62,073       232,411       401,918       213,602       126,837       63,507       198,360       102,632  
Capital expenditures:
                                                                       
 
Expenditures for vessels and equipment
    128,297       56,017       146,279       170,630       24,760       7,116       5,054       23,675       5,054  
 
Expenditures for drydocking
    4,774       9,038       11,980       9,174       8,906       2,679       3,780       8,906       3,780  
Fleet Data:
                                                                       
Average number of shuttle tankers(9)
    8.7       11.1       30.5       37.9       35.8       35.9       35.1       37.9       37.2  
Average number of conventional tankers(9)
    7.1       7.0       27.4       40.7       41.2       40.2       34.3       10.5       10.0  
Average number of FSO units(9)
    1.7       2.0       2.2       3.0       3.0       3.0       3.0       3.0       3.0  

75


 

(1)  Voyage expenses are all expenses unique to a particular voyage, including any bunker fuel expenses, port fees, cargo loading and unloading expenses, canal tolls, agency fees and commissions.
 
(2)  Vessel operating expenses include crewing, repairs and maintenance, insurance, stores, lube oils and communication expenses.
 
(3)  Substantially all of these foreign currency exchange gains and losses were unrealized and not settled in cash. Under U.S. accounting guidelines, all foreign currency-denominated monetary assets and liabilities, such as cash and cash equivalents, accounts receivable, accounts payable, advances from affiliates and deferred income taxes, are revalued and reported based on the prevailing exchange rate at the end of the period. Our primary source for the foreign currency gains and losses is our Norwegian Kroner-denominated advances from affiliates, which totaled $157.6 million at June 30, 2006, $164.6 million at December 31, 2005 and $188.5 million at December 31, 2004.
 
(4)  Please read Note 6 of our unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements included in this prospectus for a calculation of our pro forma net income per unit.
 
(5)  Vessels and equipment consists of (a) vessels, at cost less accumulated depreciation, (b) vessels under capital leases, at cost less accumulated depreciation, and (c) advances on newbuildings.
 
(6)  Total debt includes long-term debt, capital lease obligations and advances from affiliates.
 
(7)  Historical non-controlling interest represents minority interests of third parties in joint ventures to which OPCO or its subsidiaries were a party. Pro forma non-controlling interest represents these minority interests and the minority interests in OPCO’s five 50%-owned joint ventures that OPCO has consolidated on a pro forma basis, together with Teekay Shipping Corporation’s 74.0% limited partner interest in OPCO.
 
(8)  EBITDA is calculated as net income (loss) before interest, taxes, depreciation and amortization, as set forth in “— Non-GAAP Financial Measures” below, which also includes reconciliations of EBITDA to our most directly comparable GAAP financial measures. EBITDA includes the following items:
                                                                         
    Historical   Pro Forma
         
        Six    
        Months       Six
        Ended       Months
    Years Ended December 31,   June 30,   Year Ended   Ended
            December 31,   June 30,
    2001   2002   2003   2004   2005   2005   2006   2005   2006
                                     
    (unaudited)   (audited)   (unaudited)   (unaudited)
                 
    (in thousands)
Vessel and equipment writedowns and gain (loss) on sale of vessels
    $—       $—       $(63 )     $3,725       $(2,820 )     $(5,369 )     $(1,845 )     $9,423       $305  
Gain (loss) on sale of marketable securities
    (1,415 )     (1,227 )     517       94,222                                
Foreign currency exchange gain (loss)
    3,685       (35,121 )     (17,821 )     (37,910 )     34,178       25,730       (18,688 )     9,281       (4,339 )
                                                       
Total
    $2,270       $(36,348 )     $(17,367 )     $60,037       $31,358       $20,361       $(20,533 )     $18,704       $(4,034 )
                                                       
(9)  Historical average number of ships consists of the average number of owned (excluding vessels owned by OPCO’s five 50%-owned joint ventures) and chartered-in vessels that were in OPCO’s possession during a period. Pro forma average number of ships consists of the average number of chartered-in and owned (including vessels owned by the five 50%-owned joint ventures, as OPCO has consolidated the joint ventures on a pro forma basis) in OPCO’s possession during the pro forma periods.

76


 

Non-GAAP Financial Measures
      This discussion presents:
  •  Non-GAAP financial measures included above in “Selected Historical and Pro Forma Financial and Operating Data;” and
 
  •  Reconciliations of these non-GAAP financial measures to our most directly comparable financial measures under GAAP.
      Net Voyage Revenues. Consistent with general practice in the shipping industry, we use net voyage revenues (defined as voyage revenues less voyage expenses) as a measure of equating revenues generated from voyage charters to revenues generated from time charters, which assists us in making operating decisions about the deployment of vessels and their performance. Under time charters and bareboat charters the charterer typically pays the voyage expenses, whereas under voyage charter contracts and contracts of affreightment the shipowner typically pays the voyage expenses. Some voyage expenses are fixed, and the remainder can be estimated. If OPCO, as the shipowner, pays the voyage expenses, it typically passes the approximate amount of these expenses on to its customers by charging higher rates under the contract or billing the expenses to them. As a result, although voyage revenues from different types of contracts may vary, the net revenues after subtracting voyage expenses, which we call net voyage revenues, are comparable across the different types of contracts. We principally use net voyage revenues, a non-GAAP financial measure, because it provides more meaningful information to us than voyage revenues, the most directly comparable GAAP financial measure. Net voyage revenues are also widely used by investors and analysts in the shipping industry for comparing financial performance between companies in the shipping industry to industry averages.
      The following table reconciles net voyage revenues with voyage revenues:
                                                                         
    Historical   Pro Forma
         
        Six    
        Months       Six
        Ended       Months
    Year Ended December 31,   June 30,   Year Ended   Ended
            December 31,   June 30,
    2001   2002   2003   2004   2005   2005   2006   2005   2006
                                     
    (unaudited)   (audited)   (unaudited)   (unaudited)
                 
    (in thousands)
Voyage revenues
  $ 137,258     $ 156,745     $ 747,383     $ 986,504     $ 807,548     $ 400,315     $ 386,724     $ 678,888     $ 349,299  
Voyage expenses
    7,447       8,894       146,893       118,819       74,543       32,400       48,344       93,935       60,186  
                                                       
Net voyage revenues
  $ 129,811     $ 147,851     $ 600,490     $ 867,685     $ 733,005     $ 367,915     $ 338,380     $ 584,953     $ 289,113  
                                                       
      EBITDA. Earnings before interest, taxes, depreciation and amortization is used as a supplemental financial measure by management and by external users of our financial statements, such as investors, as discussed below:
  •  Financial and operating performance. EBITDA assists our management and investors by increasing the comparability of the fundamental performance of OPCO and us from period to period and against the fundamental performance of other companies in our industry that provide EBITDA information. This increased comparability is achieved by excluding the potentially disparate effects between periods or companies of interest expense, taxes, depreciation or amortization, which items are affected by various and possibly changing financing methods, capital structure and historical cost basis and which items may significantly affect net income between periods. We believe that including EBITDA as a financial and operating measure benefits investors in (a) selecting between investing in us and other investment alternatives and (b) monitoring the ongoing financial and operational strength and health of OPCO and us in assessing whether to continue to hold common units.
 
  •  Liquidity. EBITDA allows us to assess the ability of assets to generate cash sufficient to service debt, make distributions and undertake capital expenditures. By eliminating the cash flow effect

77


 

  resulting from the existing capitalization of OPCO and other items such as drydocking expenditures, working capital changes and foreign currency exchange gains and losses (which may vary significantly from period to period), EBITDA provides a consistent measure of OPCO’s ability to generate cash over the long term. Management uses this information as a significant factor in determining (a) OPCO’s proper capitalization (including assessing how much debt to incur and whether changes to the capitalization should be made) and (b) whether to undertake material capital expenditures and how to finance them, all in light of existing cash distribution commitments to unitholders. Use of EBITDA as a liquidity measure also permits investors to assess the fundamental ability of OPCO and us to generate cash sufficient to meet cash needs, including distributions on our common units.

      EBITDA should not be considered an alternative to net income, operating income, cash flow from operating activities or any other measure of financial performance or liquidity presented in accordance with GAAP. EBITDA excludes some, but not all, items that affect net income and operating income, and these measures may vary among other companies. Therefore, EBITDA as presented below may not be comparable to similarly titled measures of other companies.
                                                                         
    Historical   Pro Forma
         
        Six    
        Months   Year   Six
        Ended   Ended   Months
    Years Ended December 31,   June 30,   December   Ended
            31,   June 30,
    2001   2002   2003   2004   2005   2005   2006   2005   2006
                                     
    (unaudited)   (audited)   (unaudited)   (unaudited)
                 
    (in thousands)
Reconciliation of “EBITDA” to “Net income (loss)”:
                                                                       
Net income (loss)
  $ 13,031     $ (23,209 )   $ 63,513     $ 213,772     $ 84,747     $ 69,174     $ (16,799 )   $ 27,118     $ 5,605  
Depreciation and amortization
    45,167       49,579       93,269       118,460       107,542       55,620       51,331       116,922       56,138  
Interest expense, net
    30,091       27,587       45,594       41,498       35,186       17,829       21,213       68,193       33,127  
Provision (benefit) for income taxes
    4,963       8,116       30,035       28,188       (13,873 )     (15,786 )     7,762       (13,873 )     7,762  
                                                       
EBITDA
  $ 93,252     $ 62,073     $ 232,411     $ 401,918     $ 213,602     $ 126,837     $ 63,507     $ 198,360     $ 102,632  
                                                       
Reconciliation of “EBITDA” to “Net operating cash flow”:
                                                                       
Net operating cash flow
  $ 34,054     $ 12,110     $ 227,297     $ 242,592     $ 152,687     $ 81,232     $ 48,705     $ 212,382     $ 81,895  
Non-controlling interest
    (2,345 )     (1,212 )     (2,763 )     (2,167 )     (229 )     (692 )     (414 )     (87,248 )     (21,541 )
Expenditures for drydocking
    4,774       9,038       11,980       9,174       8,906       2,679       3,780       8,906       3,780  
Interest expense, net
    30,091       27,587       45,594       41,498       35,186       17,829       21,213       66,973       32,516  
Gain (loss) on sale of vessels
                (63 )     3,725       9,423       4,831       305       9,423       305  
Gain on sale of marketable securities, net of writedowns
    (1,415 )     (1,227 )     (4,393 )     94,222                                
Loss on writedown of vessels and equipment
                            (12,243 )     (10,200 )     (2,150 )            
Write-off of capitalized loan costs
                                              (3,402 )      
Equity income (net of dividends received)
    2,540       2,849       (1,234 )     (1,338 )     2,449       2,573       691       (971 )     (49 )
Change in working capital
    25,341       12,000       (10,602 )     37,709       (22,951 )     (3,918 )     9,870       (22,951 )     9,870  
Foreign currency exchange gain (loss) and other, net
    212       928       (33,405 )     (23,497 )     40,374       32,503       (18,493 )     15,248       (4,144 )
                                                       
EBITDA
  $ 93,252     $ 62,073     $ 232,411     $ 401,918     $ 213,602     $ 126,837     $ 63,507     $ 198,360     $ 102,632  
                                                       

78


 

MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF
FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
      You should read the following discussion of our financial condition and results of operations in conjunction with the audited and unaudited combined consolidated financial statements and related notes of Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor (described below) and the unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements and related notes of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. included elsewhere in this prospectus. Among other things, those financial statements include more detailed information regarding the basis of presentation for the following information. The financial statements have been prepared in accordance with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles (or GAAP ) and are presented in U.S. Dollars unless otherwise indicated. Any amounts converted from another non-U.S.  currency to U.S. Dollars in this prospectus are at the rate applicable at the relevant date, or the average rate during the applicable period.
Overview
      We are an international provider of marine transportation and storage services to the offshore oil industry. We were formed in August 2006 by Teekay Shipping Corporation, a leading provider of marine services to the global oil and natural gas industries, to further develop its operations in the offshore market.
      Prior to closing this offering, Teekay Shipping Corporation will contribute entities owning and operating a fleet of shuttle tankers, floating storage and offtake (or FSO ) units and conventional oil tankers to Teekay Offshore Operating L.P. (or OPCO ). Upon the closing of this offering, we will acquire from Teekay Shipping Corporation a 26.0% interest in OPCO, including a 25.99% limited partner interest held by us and a 0.01% general partner interest held through our ownership of OPCO’s general partner, Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C. Teekay Shipping Corporation will own the remaining 74.0% interest in OPCO. The historical results discussed below, and the financial statements and related notes of what we refer to as “Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor” included elsewhere in this prospectus, are the results of the entities to be contributed to OPCO. As discussed below under “Items You Should Consider When Evaluating Our Historical Financial Performance and Assessing Our Future Prospects,” the entities contributed to OPCO will not own certain assets and operations they owned during the periods discussed below. References in this Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Conditions and Results of Operations to “OPCO” when used in a historical context refer to Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor, and when used in the present tense or prospectively refers to OPCO and its subsidiaries.
      Upon the closing of this offering, our partnership interest in OPCO will represent our only cash-generating asset. We anticipate growing by acquiring additional vessels and operations directly through wholly owned subsidiaries and by acquiring additional limited partnership interests in OPCO that Teekay Shipping Corporation may offer us in the future.
      We manage our business and analyze and report our results of operations on the basis of the following three business segments:
      Shuttle Tanker Segment. OPCO’s shuttle tanker fleet consists of 36 vessels that operate under fixed-rate contracts of affreightment, time charters and bareboat charters. Of the 36 shuttle tankers, 24 are owned (including 5 through joint ventures) and 12 are chartered-in. These shuttle tankers provide transportation services to energy companies, primarily in the North Sea and Brazil. During the six months ended June 30, 2006 and the year ended December 31, 2005, this segment generated 64.6% and 61.2%, respectively, of total net voyage revenues.
      FSO Segment. OPCO owns four FSO units, of which three operate under fixed-rate time charters and one operates under a fixed-rate bareboat charter. FSO units provide an on-site storage solution to oil field installations that have no oil storage facilities or that require supplemental storage. During the six months ended June 30, 2006 and the year ended December 31, 2005, this segment generated 3.4% and 3.2%, respectively, of total net voyage revenues.

79


 

      Conventional Tanker Segment. OPCO owns nine Aframax-class conventional crude oil tankers, all of which operate under fixed-rate time charters with Teekay Shipping Corporation. During the six months ended June 30, 2006 and the year ended December 31, 2005, this segment generated 32.0% and 35.6%, respectively, of total net voyage revenues.
      We will have the opportunity to directly acquire three vessels from Teekay Shipping Corporation by the second quarter of 2008. Pursuant to an omnibus agreement we will enter into at the closing of this offering, Teekay Shipping Corporation will be obligated to offer to us two shuttle tankers, each currently undergoing conversion, and one FSO unit currently being upgraded. The two shuttle tankers will operate under 13-year bareboat charters with Petróleo Brasileiro S.A. (or Petrobras ) and the FSO unit will operate under a seven-year time charter with a consortium of energy companies. If we elect to acquire any of these vessels, the purchase price will be the vessel’s fair market value, as agreed by Teekay Shipping Corporation and the conflicts committee of our general partner’s board of directors, plus the cost of converting or upgrading the vessel prior to delivery. Teekay Shipping Corporation will be obligated to offer to us certain other shuttle tankers, FSO units and FPSO units it may acquire in the future. Please read “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions — Omnibus Agreement.”
OPCO’s Contracts of Affreightment and Charters
      OPCO generates revenues by charging customers for the transportation and storage of their crude oil using OPCO’s vessels. Historically, these services generally have been provided under the following basic types of contractual relationships:
  •  Contracts of affreightment , whereby OPCO carries an agreed quantity of cargo for a customer over a specified trade route within a given period of time;
 
  •  Time charters , whereby vessels OPCO operates and is responsible for crewing are chartered to customers for a fixed period of time at rates that are generally fixed, but may contain a variable component based on inflation, interest rates or current market rates;
 
  •  Bareboat charters , whereby customers charter vessels for a fixed period of time at rates that are generally fixed, but the customers operate the vessels with their own crews; and
 
  •  Voyage charters , which are charters for shorter intervals that are priced on a current, or “spot,” market rate.
      The table below illustrates the primary distinctions among these types of charters and contracts:
                                 
    Contract of            
    Affreightment   Time Charter   Bareboat Charter   Voyage Charter(1)
                 
Typical contract length
    One year or more       One year or more       One year or more       Single voyage  
Hire rate basis(2)
    Typically daily       Daily       Daily       Varies  
Voyage expenses(3)
    OPCO pays       Customer pays       Customer pays       OPCO pays  
Vessel operating expenses(3)
    OPCO pays       OPCO pays       Customer pays       OPCO pays  
Off-hire(4)
  Customer typically does not pay     Varies     Customer typically pays     Customer does not pay  
 
(1)  Under a consecutive voyage charter, the customer pays for idle time.
 
(2)  “Hire” rate refers to the basic payment from the charterer for the use of the vessel.
 
(3)  Defined below under “Important Financial and Operational Terms and Concepts.”
 
(4)  “Off-hire” refers to the time a vessel is not available for service.

80


 

Important Financial and Operational Terms and Concepts
      We use a variety of financial and operational terms and concepts. These include the following:
      Voyage Revenues. Voyage revenues primarily include revenues from contracts of affreightment, time charters, bareboat charters and voyage charters. Voyage revenues are affected by hire rates and the number of days a vessel operates. Voyage revenues are also affected by the mix of business between contracts of affreightment, time charters, bareboat charters and voyage charters. Hire rates for voyage charters are more volatile, as they are typically tied to prevailing market rates at the time of a voyage.
      Voyage Expenses. Voyage expenses are all expenses unique to a particular voyage, including any bunker fuel expenses, port fees, cargo loading and unloading expenses, canal tolls, agency fees and commissions. Voyage expenses are typically paid by the customer under time charters and bareboat charters and by the shipowner under voyage charters and contracts of affreightment. When OPCO pays voyage expenses, they typically are added to the hire rates at an approximate cost.
      Net Voyage Revenues. Net voyage revenues represent voyage revenues less voyage expenses incurred by OPCO. Because the amount of voyage expenses OPCO incurs for a particular charter depends upon the type of charter, we use net voyage revenues to improve the comparability between periods of reported revenues that are generated by the different types of charters. We principally use net voyage revenues, a non-GAAP financial measure, because it provides more meaningful information to us about the deployment of our vessels and their performance than voyage revenues, the most directly comparable financial measure under GAAP. Please read “Selected Historical and Pro Forma Financial and Operating Data” for a further discussion of net voyage revenues and a reconciliation of net voyage revenues to voyage revenues.
      Vessel Operating Expenses. Under all types of charters except for bareboat charters, the shipowner is responsible for vessel operating expenses, which include crewing, repairs and maintenance, insurance, stores, lube oils and communication expenses. The two largest components of OPCO’s vessel operating expenses are crews and repairs and maintenance.
  •  Crews. For the six months ended June 30, 2006, crews represented 54.7%, 60.9% and 54.2% of vessel operating expenses for the shuttle tanker, FSO and conventional tanker segments, respectively. For the year ended December 31, 2005, these percentages were 50.8%, 65.6% and 52.7% for those respective segments. A substantial majority of OPCO’s crewing expenses have been denominated in Norwegian Kroner, which is primarily a function of the nationality of the crew. Fluctuations in the Norwegian Kroner relative to the U.S. Dollar have caused fluctuations in operating results. However, prior to the closing this offering OPCO will enter into new services agreements with subsidiaries of Teekay Shipping Corporation whereby the subsidiaries will operate and crew OPCO’s vessels. Under these service agreements, OPCO will pay all vessel operating expenses in U.S. Dollars and will not be subject to currency exchange fluctuations prior to 2009. Beginning in 2009, payments under the service agreements will adjust to reflect any change in Teekay Shipping Corporation’s cost of providing services based on fluctuations in the value of the Norwegian Kroner relative to the U.S. Dollar. We may seek to hedge this currency fluctuation risk in the future.
 
  •  Repairs and Maintenance. For the six months ended June 30, 2006, repairs and maintenance represented 31.5%, 22.6% and 34.1% of vessel operating expenses for the shuttle tanker, FSO and conventional tanker segments, respectively. For the year ended December 31, 2005, these percentages were 29.2%, 16.7% and 32.3% for those respective segments. Expenses for repairs and maintenance tend to fluctuate from period to period because most repairs and maintenance typically occur during periodic drydockings. Please read “Drydocking” below. We expect these expenses to increase as the fleet matures and expands, particularly to the extent we acquire vessels directly through our wholly owned subsidiaries rather than through OPCO.
      Time Charter Hire Expenses. Time charter hire expenses represent the cost to charter-in a vessel for a fixed period of time.

81


 

      Income from Vessel Operations. To assist us in evaluating operations by segment, we sometimes analyze the income OPCO receives from each segment after deducting operating expenses, but prior to the deduction of interest expense, taxes, foreign currency exchange gains and losses and other income and losses.
      Drydocking. OPCO must periodically drydock each of its shuttle tankers and conventional oil tankers for inspection, repairs and maintenance and any modifications to comply with industry certification or governmental requirements. OPCO may drydock FSO units if it desires to qualify them for shipping classification. Generally, each shuttle tanker and conventional oil tanker is drydocked every two and a half to five years, depending upon the type of vessel and its age. We capitalize a substantial portion of the costs incurred during drydocking and amortize those costs on a straight-line basis from the completion of a drydocking to the estimated completion of the next drydocking. We expense costs related to routine repairs and maintenance incurred during drydocking that do not improve or extend the useful lives of the assets. The number of drydockings undertaken in a given period and the nature of the work performed determine the level of drydocking expenditures.
      Depreciation and Amortization. Depreciation and amortization expense typically consists of:
  •  charges related to the depreciation of the historical cost of OPCO’s fleet (less an estimated residual value) over the estimated useful lives of the vessels;
 
  •  charges related to the amortization of drydocking expenditures over the estimated number of years to the next scheduled drydocking; and
 
  •  charges related to the amortization of the fair value of contracts of affreightment where amounts have been attributed to those items in acquisitions; these amounts are amortized over the period the asset is expected to contribute to future cash flows.
      Time Charter Equivalent Rates. Bulk shipping industry freight rates are commonly measured in the shipping industry at the net voyage revenues level in terms of “time charter equivalent” (or TCE ) rates, which represent net voyage revenues divided by revenue days.
      Revenue Days. Revenue days are the total number of calendar days OPCO’s vessels were in its possession during a period, less the total number of off-hire days during the period associated with major repairs, or drydockings. Consequently, revenue days represent the total number of days available for the vessel to earn revenue. Idle days, which are days when the vessel is available to earn revenue, yet is not employed, are included in revenue days. We use revenue days to show changes in net voyage revenues between periods.
      Average Number of Ships. Historical average number of ships consists of the average number of owned (excluding vessels owned by OPCO’s five 50%-owned joint ventures) and chartered-in vessels that were in OPCO’s possession during a period. Following the closing of this offering, average number of ships will consist of the average number of chartered-in and owned vessels (including vessels owned by five of OPCO’s 50%-owned joint ventures, as OPCO will be required to consolidate the five joint ventures on a pro forma basis) that are in OPCO’s possession during the periods. We use average number of ships primarily to highlight changes in vessel operating expenses, time charter hire expense and depreciation and amortization.
      VOC Equipment. We assemble, install, operate and lease equipment that reduces volatile organic compound emissions (or VOC Equipment ) during loading, transportation and storage of oil and oil products. Leasing of the VOC Equipment is accounted for as a direct financing lease, with lease payments received being allocated between the net investment in the lease and other income using the effective interest method so as to produce a constant periodic rate of return over the lease term.
Seasonality
      Historically, the utilization of shuttle tankers in the North Sea is higher in the winter months, as favorable weather conditions in the summer months provide opportunities for repairs and maintenance to

82


 

the offshore oil platforms. Downtime for repairs and maintenance generally reduces oil production and thus transportation requirements. OPCO generally has not experienced seasonality in its FSO and conventional tanker segments.
Items You Should Consider When Evaluating Our Historical Financial Performance and Assessing Our Future Prospects
      You should consider the following factors when evaluating our historical financial performance and assessing our future prospects:
  •  Our cash flow will be reduced by distributions on Teekay Shipping Corporation’s interest in OPCO. Following the closing of this offering, Teekay Shipping Corporation will own a 74% limited partner interest in OPCO. OPCO’s partnership agreement requires it to distribute all of its available cash each quarter. In determining the amount of cash available for distribution, the board of directors of our general partner must approve the amount of cash reserves to be set aside, including reserves for future maintenance capital expenditures, working capital and other matters. Distributions to Teekay Shipping Corporation will reduce our cash flow compared to historical results.
 
  •  On July 1, 2006, OPCO transferred certain assets to Teekay Shipping Corporation that are included in historical results of operations. On July 1, 2006, OPCO transferred to Teekay Shipping Corporation a subsidiary of Norsk Teekay Holdings Ltd. (Navion Shipping Ltd.) that chartered-in approximately 25 conventional tankers since 2004 and subsequently time-chartered the vessels back to Teekay Shipping Corporation at charter rates that provided for a 1.25% fixed profit margin. In addition, OPCO transferred to Teekay Shipping Corporation a 1987-built shuttle tanker (the Nordic Trym ), OPCO’s single anchor loading equipment, a 1992-built in-chartered shuttle tanker (the Borga ) and a 50% interest in Alta Shipping S.A., which has no material assets (collectively with Navion Shipping Ltd., the Non-OPCO Assets ). In 2005 and the six months ended June 30, 2006, the Non-OPCO Assets accounted for approximately 31.3% and 26.0%, respectively, of OPCO’s net voyage revenues. Please read the unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements and related notes of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. included elsewhere in this prospectus for further details regarding the impact of the transfer of the Non-OPCO Assets.
 
  •  Proposed amendments to OPCO’s joint venture agreements would result in five 50%-owned joint venture companies being consolidated with us under GAAP. Our historical results of operations reflect OPCO’s investment in five 50%-owned joint venture companies, accounted for using the equity method, whereby the investment is carried at the original cost plus OPCO’s proportionate share of undistributed earnings. Prior to the closing of this offering, we anticipate that the operating agreements for these joint ventures will be amended such that OPCO will have unilateral control of these joint ventures, which would require consolidation of these five joint venture companies in accordance with GAAP. Although our net income would not change due to this change in accounting, the results of the joint ventures would be reflected in our income from operations. This change would also cause the five shuttle tankers owned by these joint ventures to be included in the size of OPCO’s owned fleet for purposes of explaining future results of operations.
 
  •  The size of OPCO’s fleet continues to change. Our historical results of operations reflect changes in the size and composition of OPCO’s fleet due to certain vessel deliveries and vessel dispositions. For instance, in addition to the decrease in chartered-in vessels associated with the transfer of Navion Shipping Ltd. described above, the average number of owned vessels in OPCO’s shuttle tanker fleet (excluding the five joint venture vessels) decreased from 24.5 during 2004 to 21.0 during the six months ended June 30, 2006, while the number of chartered-in vessels in the shuttle tanker fleet increased from 13.4 to 14.1 during the same periods. Upon the closing of this offering, the number of owned shuttle tankers is expected to be 24.0 — excluding two vessels that have been sold and including the five joint venture vessels, assuming consolidation of the joint ventures as discussed above — and the number of chartered-in shuttle tankers is expected to be 12.0 — excluding one older vessel under a charter that OPCO did not renew, one joint venture vessel under

83


 

  a charter that will be consolidated and one older vessel that will be transferred to Teekay Shipping Corporation. Upon the closing of this offering, OPCO will initially own nine conventional tankers compared to an average of over 10.0 tankers during most of the past two years. In addition, the Navion Saga is being converted from a conventional oil tanker to an FSO unit. When it commences operations as an FSO unit, scheduled for the second quarter of 2007, OPCO’s FSO fleet will include four vessels, compared to three during recent years. Please read “— Results of Operations” below for further details about vessel dispositions and deliveries. Due to the nature of our business, we expect our fleet to continue to fluctuate in size and composition.
 
  •  Our historical results of operations reflect different time charter terms for OPCO’s nine conventional tankers. Prior to the closing of this offering, OPCO will enter into new fixed-rate time charters with a subsidiary of Teekay Shipping Corporation for OPCO’s nine conventional tankers at rates we believe are market-based charter rates. Please read “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions — Aframax Tanker Time-Charter Contracts With Teekay Shipping Corporation.” At various times during the previous three years, eight of these nine conventional tankers were employed on time charters with the same subsidiary of Teekay Shipping Corporation. However, the charter rates were lower, as they were based on the cash flow requirements of each vessel, which included operating expenses, loan principal and interest payments and drydock expenditures, such that OPCO achieved break-even cash flow. A ninth conventional tanker traded on voyage charters. The new fixed-rate time charters should provide additional, more stable voyage revenues for these vessels. Please read the unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements and related notes of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. included elsewhere in this prospectus for further details regarding the impact of these new time charters.
 
  •  Our historical results of operations are affected by fluctuations in currency exchange rates. Prior to the closing of this offering, we will repay our foreign currency denominated advances from affiliates. As at June 30, 2006, these advances, all from Teekay Shipping Corporation, amounted to 1.0 billion Norwegian Kroner ($157.6 million) and 25.5 million Australian Dollars ($18.9 million). Under U.S. GAAP, all foreign currency-denominated monetary assets and liabilities, such as cash and cash equivalents, accounts receivable, accounts payable, advances from affiliates and deferred income taxes are revalued and reported based on the prevailing exchange rate at the end of the period. Most of our foreign currency gains and losses are attributable to this revaluation in respect of our foreign currency denominated advances from affiliates. In addition, a substantial majority of OPCO’s crewing expenses historically have been denominated in Norwegian Kroners, which is primarily a function of the nationality of the crew. Fluctuations in the Norwegian Kroner relative to the U.S. Dollar have caused fluctuations in operating results. Prior to the closing of this offering, OPCO’s operating subsidiaries will enter into new services agreements with certain subsidiaries of Teekay Shipping Corporation whereby the Teekay Shipping Corporation subsidiaries will operate and crew the vessels. Under these service agreements, OPCO’s operating subsidiaries will pay all vessel operating expenses in U.S. Dollars, and will not be subject to currency exchange fluctuations prior to 2009. Beginning in 2009, payments under the service agreements will adjust to reflect any change in the cost to the Teekay Shipping Corporation subsidiaries of providing services based on fluctuations in the value of the Kroner relative to the U.S. Dollar. We may seek to hedge this currency fluctuation risk in the future. Please read “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions — Advisory and Administrative Services Agreements” for a description of these service agreements.
 
  •  We will incur additional general and administrative expenses. Prior to the closing of this offering, we, OPCO and its operating subsidiaries will enter into services agreements with certain subsidiaries of Teekay Shipping Corporation, pursuant to which those subsidiaries will provide to us and OPCO administrative services and to OPCO’s operating subsidiaries certain services, including strategic consulting, advisory, ship management, technical and administrative services. Our cost for these services will depend on the amount and type of services provided during each period. The services will be valued at a reasonable, arm’s-length rate that will include reimbursement of reasonable

84


 

  direct or indirect expenses incurred to provide the services. We will also reimburse our general partner for all expenses it incurs on our behalf, including CEO/ CFO compensation and expenses relating to its board of directors, including compensation, travel, and liability insurance costs. In addition, we will incur expenses as a result of being a publicly-traded limited partnership, including costs associated with annual reports to unitholders and SEC filings, investor relations, NYSE annual listing fees and tax compliance expenses. For the year ending December 31, 2007, we estimate these services and general partner reimbursements and public-company costs will increase our expenses by an additional $1.5 million. Please read the unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements and related notes of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. included elsewhere in this prospectus for further details regarding the estimated impact of these additional expenses. We may also grant equity compensation that would result in an expense to us, which may result in an increase in expenses, although we currently do not have an estimate of the possible expense. Please read “Management — 2006 Long-Term Incentive Plan.”

Results of Operations
      In accordance with GAAP, we report gross voyage revenues in our income statements and include voyage expenses among our operating expenses. However, shipowners base economic decisions regarding the deployment of their vessels upon anticipated TCE rates, and industry analysts typically measure bulk shipping freight rates in terms of TCE rates. This is because under time charters and bareboat charters the customer usually pays the voyage expenses, while under voyage charters and contracts of affreightment the shipowner usually pays the voyage expenses, which typically are added to the hire rate at an approximate cost. Accordingly, the discussion of revenue below focuses on net voyage revenues ( i.e. voyage revenues less voyage expenses) and TCE rates of our three reportable segments where applicable.
      The following table compares our operating results by reportable segment for the six months ended June 30, 2005 and 2006, and the years ended December 31, 2004 and 2005, and compares our net voyage revenues (which is a non-GAAP financial measure) by reportable segment for the six months ended June 30, 2005 and 2006, and the years ended December 31, 2004 and 2005 to voyage revenues, the most directly comparable GAAP financial measure:
                                                                 
    Six Months Ended June 30,
     
    2005   2006
         
    Shuttle   Conventional       Shuttle   Conventional    
    Tanker   Tanker   FSO       Tanker   Tanker   FSO    
    Segment   Segment   Segment   Total   Segment   Segment   Segment   Total
                                 
    (in thousands)
Voyage revenues
    $260,373       $128,030       $11,912       $400,315       $263,203       $111,555       $11,966       $386,724  
Voyage expenses
    29,681       2,326       393       32,400       44,690       3,131       523       48,344  
                                                 
Net voyage revenues
    230,692       125,704       11,519       367,915       218,513       108,424       11,443       338,380  
Vessel operating expense
    37,903       11,890       3,107       52,900       38,407       11,031       3,516       52,954  
Time charter expense
    81,035       95,241             176,276       86,597       79,338             165,935  
Depreciation and amortization
    40,054       10,771       4,795       55,620       35,811       10,787       4,733       51,331  
General and administrative(1)
    23,720       13,162       956       37,838       27,187       15,313       969       43,469  
Vessel and equipment writedowns and loss on sale of vessels
    5,369                   5,369       1,845                   1,845  
Restructuring charge
                                  453             453  
                                                 
Income (loss) from vessel operations
    $42,611       $(5,360 )     $2,661       $39,912       $28,666       $(8,498 )     $2,225       $22,393  
                                                 

85


 

                                                                 
    Year Ended December 31,
     
    2004   2005
         
    Shuttle   Conventional       Shuttle   Conventional    
    Tanker   Tanker   FSO       Tanker   Tanker   FSO    
    Segment   Segment   Segment   Total   Segment   Segment   Segment   Total
                                 
    (in thousands)
Voyage revenues
    $550,445       $411,181       $24,878       $986,504       $516,758       $266,593       $24,197       $807,548  
Voyage expenses
    69,362       49,457             118,819       68,308       5,419       816       74,543  
                                                 
Net voyage revenues
    481,083       361,724       24,878       867,685       448,450       261,174       23,381       733,005  
Vessel operating expenses
    76,197       22,790       6,608       105,595       75,196       22,679       6,600       104,475  
Time charter hire expense
    177,576       194,873             372,449       169,687       203,849             373,536  
Depreciation and amortization
    89,593       20,561       8,306       118,460       77,083       21,112       9,347       107,542  
General and administrative(1)
    45,403       19,097       1,319       65,819       55,010       29,026       1,820       85,856  
Vessels and equipment writedowns and (gain) loss on sale of vessels
    (3,725 )                 (3,725 )     2,820                   2,820  
Restructuring charge
                            955                   955  
                                                 
Income (loss) from vessel operations
    $96,039       $104,403       $8,645       $209,087       $67,699       $(15,492 )     $5,614       $57,821  
                                                 
 
(1)  Includes direct general and administrative expenses and indirect general and administrative expenses (allocated to each segment based on estimated use of corporate resources).
Six Months Ended June 30, 2006 versus Six Months Ended June 30, 2005
Shuttle Tanker Segment
      The following table provides a summary of the changes in the average number of ships owned and chartered-in for the shuttle tanker segment:
                         
    Six Months Ended June 30,    
         
    2005   2006   Percentage Change
    (Average Number of Ships)   (Average Number of Ships)   (%)
             
Owned Vessels
    22.9       21.0       (8.3 )%
Chartered-in Vessels
    13.0       14.1       8.5  
                   
Total
    35.9       35.1       (2.2 )%
                   
      The average size of the shuttle tanker fleet (including vessels chartered-in) decreased for the six months ended June 30, 2006 compared to the same period in 2005, primarily as a result of:
  •  the sale of two older shuttle tankers in March and October 2005 (collectively, the 2005 Shuttle Tanker Dispositions ); and
 
  •  the redelivery of one chartered-in vessel back to its owner in April 2006;
      partially offset by
  •  the inclusion of two additional chartered-in vessels commencing May and June 2005.
      In addition, during March 2005 OPCO sold and leased back an older shuttle tanker. This had the effect of increasing the average number of chartered-in vessels and decreasing the average number of owned vessels during the six months ended June 30, 2006 compared to the same period in 2005.

86


 

      Net Voyage Revenues. Net voyage revenues decreased by 5.3% to $218.5 million for the six months ended June 30, 2006, from $230.7 million for the same period in 2005, primarily due to:
  •  a decrease of $9.8 million from shuttle tankers servicing contracts of affreightment, which is explained in further detail below;
 
  •  a decrease of $5.9 million from the 2005 Shuttle Tanker Dispositions; and
 
  •  a decrease of $1.4 million from certain offshore equipment servicing a marginal oil field that was prematurely shut down in June 2005 due to lower than expected oil production;
      partially offset by
  •  an increase of $4.0 million due to the commencement of two long-term time charters during 2005; and
 
  •  an increase of $0.9 million due to adjustments to certain daily charter rates based on increases from rising interest rates and inflation in accordance with the bareboat charters for certain shuttle tankers.
      The $9.8 million decrease in net voyage revenues from shuttle tankers servicing contracts of affreightment during the six months ended June 30, 2006 primarily consisted of a $6.1 million reduction relating to fewer revenue days under the contracts of affreightment and a $3.7 million reduction in revenues from the redeployment of idle shuttle tankers in the conventional spot market. The $6.1 million decrease was primarily due to the earlier-than-normal annual seasonal maintenance on certain North Sea oil field facilities in 2006 compared to 2005, which resulted in a decline in oil production on oil fields at which OPCO’s vessels were employed. While the number of days that idle shuttle tankers were redeployed in the conventional spot market increased in the first half of 2006 compared to the same period in 2005, the rates they earned declined, which more than offset this increase.
      Vessel Operating Expenses. Vessel operating expenses increased slightly by 1.3% to $38.4 million for the six months ended June 30, 2006, from $37.9 million for the same period in 2005, primarily due to:
  •  an increase of $3.0 million for increased salaries for crew and officers due to a change in crew composition on one vessel upon the commencement of a new short-term time-charter contract in 2005 as well as general wage escalations; and
 
  •  an increase of $0.6 million due to repairs and maintenance relating to certain vessels and an increase in the cost of lubricants as a result of higher crude costs;
      partially offset by
  •  a decrease of $2.8 million from the 2005 Shuttle Tanker Dispositions.
      Time-Charter Hire Expense. Time-charter hire expense increased by 6.9% to $86.6 million for the six months ended June 30, 2006, from $81.0 million for the same period in 2005, primarily due to:
  •  a 8.5% increase in the average number of vessels chartered-in;
  partially offset by
  •  a 1.0% decrease in the average per day time-charter hire expense to $33,998 from $34,332 for the same period in 2005.
      The reduction in average per day time-charter hire expense was primarily due to the sale and leaseback of an older shuttle tanker in March 2005, which had, on average, a lower daily hire rate than OPCO’s other chartered-in shuttle tankers and due to a negotiated rate reduction in May 2005 on one of our chartered-in shuttle tankers as a result of extending the contract for three years.

87


 

      Depreciation and Amortization. Depreciation and amortization expense decreased 10.6% to $35.8 million for the six months ended June 30, 2006, from $40.1 million for the same period in 2005, primarily due to:
  •  a decrease of $1.9 million relating to a reduction in amortization from the expiration during 2005 of two contracts of affreightment and declines in revenue from remaining contracts of affreightment;
 
  •  a decrease of $1.0 million relating to a $12.2 million write-down during 2005 of the carrying value of certain offshore equipment servicing a marginal oil field that was prematurely shut down due to lower than expected oil production; and
 
  •  a decrease of $0.9 million relating to the 2005 Shuttle Tanker Dispositions and the sale and leaseback of one shuttle tanker in March 2005.
      Depreciation and amortization expense included amortization of drydocking costs of $2.5 million for the six months ended June 30, 2006 compared to $3.2 million for the same period in 2005, and included amortization of contracts of $6.0 million for the six months ended June 30, 2006 compared to $7.9 million for the same period in 2005.
      Vessel and Equipment Writedowns and Gain on Sale of Vessels. Vessel and equipment writedowns and gain on sale of vessels for the six months ended June 30, 2006 was a net loss of $1.8 million, which was comprised primarily of:
  •  a $2.2 million writedown of certain offshore equipment servicing a marginal oil field that was prematurely shut down in June 2005 due to lower than expected oil production. This writedown occurred due to a reassessment of the estimated net realizable value of the equipment and follows a $12.2 million writedown in 2005 arising from the early termination of a contract for the equipment;
      partially offset by
  •  $0.3 million of amortization of a deferred gain on the sale and leaseback of one shuttle tanker in March 2005.
      Vessel and equipment writedowns and gain on sale of vessels for the six months ended June 30, 2005 was a net loss of $5.4 million, which was comprised primarily of:
  •  a $10.2 million writedown of the previously-mentioned equipment;
      partially offset by
  •  a $4.9 million gain on the sale of an older shuttle tanker in the first quarter of 2005.
Conventional Tanker Segment
      The following table provides a summary of the changes in the average number of ships owned and chartered-in for the conventional tanker segment:
                         
    Six Months Ended June 30,    
         
    2005   2006   Percentage Change
    (Average Number of Ships)   (Average Number of Ships)   (%)
             
Owned Vessels
    11.0       10.0       (9.1 )%
Chartered-in Vessels
    29.2       24.3       (16.8 )
                   
Total
    40.2       34.3       (14.7 )%
                   
      The average size of the conventional crude oil tanker fleet (including vessels chartered-in) decreased for the six months ended June 30, 2006 compared to the same period in 2005, primarily as a result of:
  •  the sale of a 2000-built liquid petroleum gas carrier (the Dania Spirit ) to a subsidiary of Teekay Shipping Corporation in June 2005 (or the 2005 Conventional Tanker Disposition ); and

88


 

  •  a reduction in the average number of chartered-in conventional tankers to 24 during the six months ended June 30, 2006, from 29 in the same period in 2005. The chartered-in fleet declined as we did not renew a number of in-charters due to high rates in the time charter market.
The chartered-in conventional tanker fleet is operated by Navion Shipping Ltd. On July 1, 2006, OPCO transferred its ownership in Navion Shipping Ltd. to Teekay Shipping Corporation.
      Net Voyage Revenues. Net voyage revenues decreased 13.7% to $108.4 million for the six months ended June 30, 2006, from $125.7 million for the same period in 2005, primarily due to:
  •  a decrease of $17.0 million from the decrease in the average number of chartered-in vessels; and
 
  •  a decrease of $2.4 million relating to the 2005 Conventional Tanker Disposition;
      partially offset by
  •  an increase of $1.1 million from a 1.0% increase in our average per day TCE rate to $17,472 for the six months ended June 30, 2006, from $17,292 for the same period in 2005.
      Historically, eight owned tankers in the conventional fleet have been chartered to Teekay Chartering Limited (or TCL ) and then from TCL to OPCO’s customers. The charter rates paid by TCL were based on the cash flow requirements of each vessel, which included operating expenses, loan principal and interest payments and drydock expenditures, and resulted in break-even cash flow under this arrangement. The hire rate in the six months ended June 30, 2006 was higher than the six months ended June 30, 2005 due to larger loan interest payments. Prior to closing this offering, OPCO will enter into new fixed-rate time charters with TCL for OPCO’s nine conventional tankers at rates we believe are market-based charter rates. Please read our unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements and related notes of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. included elsewhere in this prospectus for further details regarding the impact of the new time charters.
      Vessel Operating Expenses. Vessel operating expenses decreased 7.2% to $11.0 million for the six months ended June 30, 2006, from $11.9 million for the same period in 2005, primarily due to the 2005 Conventional Tanker Disposition.
      Time-Charter Hire Expense. Time-charter hire expense decreased 16.7% to $79.3 million for the six months ended June 30, 2006, from $95.2 million for the same period in 2005, primarily due to a decrease of 16.8% in the average number of vessels chartered-in.
      The average per day time-charter hire expense for the six months ended June 30, 2006 remained substantially unchanged compared to the same period in 2005. This was primarily due to the expiration of two time-charter contracts during the first half of 2005 for two smaller vessels, which had daily hire rates that were significantly lower than our average per day time-charter hire expense, substantially offset by one new time-charter contract entered into during the first half of 2006 for a smaller vessel, which had a daily hire rate that was significantly lower than our average per day time-charter hire expense.
      Depreciation and Amortization. Depreciation and amortization expense for the six months ended June 30, 2006 was $10.8 million, substantially unchanged from the same period in 2005, primarily due to:
  •  an increase of $0.5 million from the amortization of drydock costs incurred during the second half of 2005;
      offset by
  •  a decrease of $0.5 million from the 2005 Conventional Tanker Disposition.
      Depreciation and amortization expense included amortization of drydocking costs of $1.4 million for the six months ended June 30, 2006, compared to $0.9 million for the same period in 2005.

89


 

FSO Segment
      The following table provides a summary of the average number of ships for the FSO segment.
                         
    Six Months Ended June 30,    
         
    2005   2006   Percentage Change
    (Average Number of Ships)   (Average Number of Ships)   (%)
             
Owned Vessels
    3       3        
      During the six months ended June 30, 2005 and 2006, OPCO owned and operated three FSO units. A fourth FSO unit, the Navion Saga , currently is trading as a conventional crude oil tanker within the conventional tanker segment. This vessel will commence a three-year FSO time charter contract beginning in the second quarter of 2007.
      The operating results for the FSO segment for the six months ended June 30, 2006 remained substantially unchanged from the same period in 2005.
Other Operating Results
      General and Administrative Expenses. General and administrative expenses increased 14.9% to $43.5 million for the six months ended June 30, 2006, from $37.8 million for the same period in 2005, primarily due to:
  •  an increase of $6.2 million in allocated general and administrative expenses, including employee stock compensation, from Teekay Shipping Corporation;
      partially offset by
  •  a decrease of $0.9 million relating to a reduction in costs associated with our long-term employee bonus plan.
      Interest Expense. Interest expense increased 21.9% to $24.5 million for the six months ended June 30, 2006, from $20.1 million for the same period in 2005, primarily due to:
  •  an increase of $3.1 million due to an increase in the weighted-average interest rate on OPCO’s floating-rate debt; and
 
  •  an increase of $2.9 million relating to additional debt of $171.1 million incurred during the second half of 2005;
      partially offset by
  •  a decrease of $1.0 million relating to the repayment of interest-bearing advances from affiliates; and
 
  •  a decrease of $0.2 million relating to the repayment of 8.32% First Preferred Ship Mortgage Notes during the first half of 2005.
      Interest Income. Interest income increased 44.9% to $3.3 million for the six months ended June 30, 2006, from $2.3 million for the same period in 2005. The increase is primarily due to an increase in interest rates.
      Equity Income From Joint Ventures. Equity income from joint ventures increased 24.0% to $3.2 million for the six months ended June 30, 2006, from $2.6 million for the same period in 2005, primarily due to a decrease in repair and maintenance activity on the shuttle tankers owned by the joint ventures.
      Foreign Exchange Gains (Losses). Foreign exchange losses were $18.7 million for the six months ended June 30, 2006, compared to foreign exchange gains of $25.7 million for the same period in 2005. OPCO’s foreign currency exchange gains and losses, substantially all of which have been unrealized, are due primarily to the period-end revaluation of Norwegian Kroner-denominated advances from affiliates. Gains reflect a stronger U.S. Dollar against the Kroner on the date of revaluation compared to the rate in

90


 

effect at the beginning of the period. Losses reflect a weaker U.S. Dollar against the Kroner on the date of revaluation compared to the rate in effect at the beginning of the period.
      Income Tax Recovery (Expense). Income tax expense for the six months ended June 30, 2006 was $7.8 million, compared to an income tax recovery of $15.8 million for the same period in 2005, primarily due to a $20.9 million increase in deferred income tax expense relating to unrealized foreign exchange translation gains (losses) for the six months ended June 30, 2006 and 2005, and a $4.6 million income tax recovery from the restructuring of Norwegian shuttle tanker operations during the first quarter of 2005.
      Other Income. Other income for the six months ended June 30, 2006 was $5.3 million, which was primarily comprised of $5.7 million of leasing income from OPCO’s VOC equipment, partially offset by minority interest expense of $0.4 million.
      Other income for the six months ended June 30, 2005 was $3.0 million, which was primarily comprised of $5.1 million of leasing income from VOC equipment, partially offset by $1.4 million primarily relating to fees for early termination of certain ship management contracts and minority interest expense of $0.7 million.
      Net Income. As a result of the foregoing factors, net loss was $16.8 million for the six months ended June 30, 2006, compared to net income of $69.2 million for the same period in 2005.
Year Ended December 31, 2005 versus Year Ended December 31, 2004
Shuttle Tanker Segment
      The following table provides a summary of the changes in the average number of ships owned and chartered-in for the shuttle tanker segment:
                         
    2004   2005   Percentage Change
    (Average Number of Ships)   (Average Number of Ships)   (%)
             
Owned Vessels
    24.5       22.2       (9.4 )%
Chartered-in Vessels
    13.4       13.6       1.5  
                   
Total
    37.9       35.8       (5.5 )%
                   
      The average size of the shuttle tanker fleet (including vessels chartered-in) decreased in 2005 compared to 2004, primarily as a result of:
  •  the 2005 Shuttle Tanker Dispositions and the sale of one older shuttle tanker in 2004 (or the 2004 Shuttle Tanker Disposition );
      partially offset by
  •  the delivery of a shuttle tanker newbuilding (or the 2004 Shuttle Tanker Delivery ) in March 2004 that commenced service under a long-term bareboat charter in August 2004.
      In addition, during March 2005 OPCO sold and leased back an older shuttle tanker. This had the effect of increasing the average number of chartered-in vessels and decreasing the average number of owned vessels during 2005 compared to 2004.
      Net Voyage Revenues. Net voyage revenues decreased by 6.8% to $448.5 million for 2005, from $481.1 million for 2004, primarily due to:
  •  a decrease of $22.3 million from shuttle tankers servicing contracts of affreightment, which is explained in further detail below;
 
  •  a decrease of $10.3 million from the 2005 Shuttle Tanker Dispositions;
 
  •  a decrease of $1.7 million due to the 2004 Shuttle Tanker Disposition; and

91


 

  •  a decrease of $1.6 million from certain offshore equipment servicing a marginal oil field that was prematurely shut down in June 2005 due to lower than expected oil production;
      partially offset by
  •  an increase of $1.2 million due to adjustments to the daily charter rate based on increases from rising interest rates in accordance with the bareboat charters for two shuttle tankers.
      The $22.3 million decrease from shuttle tankers servicing contracts of affreightment was primarily due to a $33.9 million reduction in revenues from a decrease in the number of revenue days from the contracts of affreightment. This decrease was primarily a result of a 14.1% decline in oil production on all oil fields in the North Sea at which OPCO’s vessels were employed, the expiration of one contract of affreightment in July 2004, and the unscheduled temporary shutdowns of three oil fields in the first quarter of 2005 due to gas leakage and equipment problems of third parties. This reduction in revenue was partially offset by an $11.6 million increase in net voyage revenues earned from redeploying the idle shuttle tankers in the conventional spot market or short-term time charters.
      Vessel Operating Expenses. Vessel operating expenses decreased slightly by 1.3% to $75.2 million for 2005, from $76.2 million for 2004, primarily due to:
  •  a decrease of $4.5 million as a result of the 2005 Shuttle Tanker Dispositions; and
 
  •  a decrease of $1.2 million as a result of a shuttle tanker commencing a long-term bareboat charter in September 2004 after it had completed a five month time charter;
      partially offset by
  •  an increase of $2.3 million due to increased repairs and maintenance relating to certain older shuttle tankers; and
 
  •  an increase of $1.9 million due to a weaker U.S. Dollar relative to the Norwegian Kroner during 2005 as compared to 2004.
      Time-Charter Hire Expense. Time-charter hire expense decreased by 4.4% to $169.7 million for 2005, from $177.6 million for 2004, primarily due to:
  •  a 5.8% decrease in the average per day time-charter hire expense to $34,190 for 2005, from $36,277 for the same period in 2004;
      partially offset by
  •  a 1.5% increase in the average number of vessels chartered-in.
      The reduction in average per day time-charter hire expense was primarily due to the sale and leaseback of an older shuttle tanker in March 2005, which had, on average, a lower daily hire rate than OPCO’s other chartered-in shuttle tankers.
      Depreciation and Amortization. Depreciation and amortization expense decreased 14.0% to $77.1 million for 2005, from $89.6 million for 2004, primarily due to:
  •  a decrease of $9.9 million relating to the 2005 Shuttle Tanker Dispositions, the 2004 Shuttle Tanker Disposition, and the sale and leaseback of one shuttle tanker in 2005;
 
  •  a decrease of $2.7 million relating to a reduction in amortization from the expiration during 2005 of two of OPCO’s contracts of affreightment; and
 
  •  a decrease of $1.5 million relating to a $12.2 million write-down during 2005 of the carrying value of certain offshore equipment servicing a marginal oil field that was prematurely shut down due to lower than expected oil production;
 
  •  partially offset by
 
  •  an increase of $2.5 million relating to the 2004 Shuttle Tanker Delivery.

92


 

      Depreciation and amortization expense included amortization of drydocking costs of $5.9 million for 2005, compared to $4.8 million for 2004, and included amortization of contracts of $14.8 million for 2005, compared to $18.4 million for 2004.
      Vessel and Equipment Writedowns and Gain (Loss) on Sale of Vessels. Vessel and equipment writedowns and gain (loss) on sale of vessels for 2005 was a net loss of $2.8 million, which was comprised of:
  •  a $12.2 million write-down of the carrying value of certain offshore equipment servicing a marginal oil field that was prematurely shut down in June 2005 (some of this equipment was re-deployed on another field in October 2005);
      partially offset by
  •  a $9.1 million gain on the 2005 Shuttle Tanker Dispositions; and
 
  •  a $0.3 million gain from amortization of a deferred gain, which relates to the sale and leaseback of an older shuttle tanker in the first quarter of 2005.
      Gain on sale of vessels for 2004 of $3.7 million represents the gain from the 2004 Shuttle Tanker Disposition.
      Restructuring Charges. Restructuring charges of $1.0 million in 2005 relate to the closure of our Sandefjord, Norway office. OPCO incurred no restructuring charges in 2004 in the shuttle tanker segment and does not expect to incur any further restructuring charges relating to the closure of this office in 2006.
Conventional Tanker Segment
      The following table provides a summary of the changes in the average number of ships owned and chartered-in for the conventional tanker segment:
                         
    2004   2005   Percentage Change
    (Average Number of Ships)   (Average Number of Ships)   (%)
             
Owned Vessels
    10.3       10.5       1.9 %
Chartered-in Vessels
    30.4       30.7       1.0  
                   
Total
    40.7       41.2       1.2 %
                   
      The average size of the conventional crude oil tanker fleet (including vessels chartered-in) increased slightly in 2005 compared to 2004, primarily as a result of:
  •  the delivery of a new conventional tanker in the third quarter of 2004 (or the 2004 Conventional Tanker Delivery );
      partially offset by
  •  the 2005 Conventional Tanker Disposition.
      Net Voyage Revenues. Net voyage revenues decreased 27.8% to $261.2 million for 2005, from $361.7 million for 2004, primarily due to:
  •  a decrease of $45.9 million relating to a decrease in the hire rate earned by five owned conventional tankers on time charters with TCL;
 
  •  a decrease of $44.0 million from the change in employment of the chartered-in conventional tankers from spot voyage charters with unrelated parties to TCL during the second quarter of 2004;
 
  •  a decrease of $11.0 million from the change in employment of one owned vessel from spot voyage charters with unrelated parties during 2004 to the subsequent charter of this vessel to TCL under the terms described below; and
 
  •  a decrease of $2.6 million relating to the 2005 Conventional Tanker Disposition;

93


 

      partially offset by
  •  an increase of $3.2 million relating to the 2004 Conventional Tanker Delivery.
      Historically, eight owned tankers in the conventional fleet have been chartered to TCL and then from TCL to OPCO’s customers. The charter rates paid by TCL were based on the cash flow requirements of each vessel, which included operating expenses, loan principal and interest payments and drydock expenditures, and resulted in break-even cash flow under this arrangement. The hire rate in 2004 was significantly higher than 2005 due to larger loan principal repayments. Prior to closing this offering, OPCO will enter into new fixed-rate time charters with TCL for OPCO’s nine conventional tankers at rates we believe are market-based charter rates. Please read our unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements and related notes of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P., included elsewhere in this prospectus for further details regarding the impact of the new time charters.
      On July 1, 2006, OPCO transferred to Teekay Shipping Corporation the Non-OPCO Assets, including OPCO’s subsidiary Navion Shipping Ltd. Navion Shipping Ltd. chartered-in conventional tankers and subsequently time chartered them to TCL at a charter rate that provided for a fixed 1.25% profit margin. However, prior to the second quarter of 2004, these conventional tankers were primarily employed on spot voyage charters directly to our customers. On average, the spot voyage charter rates earned by these conventional tankers in the first quarter of 2004 were higher than the time charter rates earned by these vessels in the first quarter of 2005, causing a decrease in net voyage revenues during 2005 compared to 2004. As a result of the transfer, OPCO will no longer earn net voyage revenues from the conventional tankers chartered-in by Navion Shipping Ltd., which were all of the conventional tankers chartered-in during 2004 and 2005. Please read the unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements and related notes of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. included elsewhere in this prospectus for further details regarding the impact of the transfer of Navion Shipping Ltd. and the other Non-OPCO Assets.
      Vessel Operating Expenses. Vessel operating expenses decreased 0.5% to $22.7 million for 2005, from $22.8 million for 2004, primarily due to the 2005 Conventional Tanker Disposition, partially offset by the 2004 Conventional Tanker Delivery.
      Time-Charter Hire Expense. Time-charter hire expense increased 4.6% to $203.8 million for 2005, from $194.9 million for 2004, primarily due to a 1.0% increase in the average number of ships chartered-in. In addition, the average per ship per day time-charter hire expense increased 3.5% to $18,194 for 2005, compared to $17,574 for 2004, due to the expiration of a number of charter hire contracts in 2004, which had daily rates that were slightly lower on average than the new charter hire contracts we entered into during 2005.
      Depreciation and Amortization. Depreciation and amortization expense increased 2.7% to $21.1 million for 2005, from $20.6 million for 2004, primarily due to the 2004 Conventional Tanker Delivery, partially offset by the 2005 Conventional Tanker Disposition. Depreciation and amortization expense included amortization of drydocking costs of $1.9 million for 2005, compared to $1.7 million for 2004.
FSO Segment
      The following table provides a summary of the changes in the average number of ships for the FSO segment.
                         
    2004   2005   Percentage Change
    (Average Number of Ships)   (Average Number of Ships)   (%)
             
Owned Vessels
    3       3        
      During 2004 and 2005, OPCO operated three FSO units. However, during the period from November 2003 to April 2004, one FSO unit, the Pattani Spirit , was undergoing a conversion from an Aframax-size conventional crude oil tanker to an FSO unit. Although this vessel was considered to be in the FSO fleet

94


 

during the conversion, it did not earn revenue during that period and, accordingly, revenue days for the FSO segment were 8.6% higher in 2005 compared to 2004.
      Net Voyage Revenues. Net voyage revenues decreased 6.0% to $23.4 million for 2005, from $24.9 million for 2004, primarily due to:
  •  a decrease of $2.8 million due a negotiated reduction to the daily bareboat charter rate on one of the FSO units;
      partially offset by
  •  an increase of $1.5 million from a full year of operations of the Pattani Spirit during 2005 compared to 2004.
      Vessel Operating Expenses. Vessel operating expenses remained consistent during 2005 and 2004.
      Depreciation and Amortization. Depreciation and amortization expense increased 12.5% to $9.3 million for 2005, from $8.3 million for 2004, primarily due to a full year of operations of the Pattani Spirit during 2005 compared to 2004. Depreciation and amortization expense included amortization of drydocking costs of $0.4 million for both 2005 and 2004.
Other Operating Results
      General and Administrative Expenses. General and administrative expenses increased 30.4% to $85.9 million for 2005, from $65.8 million for 2004, primarily due to:
  •  an increase of $8.4 million relating to the adoption of a long-term employee bonus plan during 2005;
 
  •  an increase of $7.2 million in allocated general and administrative expenses from Teekay Shipping Corporation;
 
  •  an increase of $4.5 million relating to the grant of restricted stock units of Teekay Shipping Corporation to employees in March 2005;
 
  •  an increase of $3.1 million from the strengthening in the average Norwegian Kroner/ U.S. Dollar exchange rate in 2005 compared to 2004; and
 
  •  an increase of $0.7 million in ship management fees paid to a subsidiary of Teekay Shipping Corporation for the 2004 Conventional Tanker Delivery and one FSO unit;
      partially offset by
  •  special bonuses of $3.8 million accrued during 2004 in addition to regular bonuses under the annual bonus plan.
      Interest Expense. Interest expense decreased 9.5% to $39.8 million for 2005, from $44.0 million for 2004, primarily due to:
  •  a decrease of $6.5 million relating to the repayment of long-term debt; and
 
  •  a decrease of $2.4 million relating to the repayment of interest-bearing advances from affiliates;
      partially offset by
  •  an increase of $4.7 million relating to an increase in the weighted-average interest rate on OPCO’s floating-rate debt.
      Interest Income. Interest income increased 87.3% to $4.6 million for 2005, from $2.5 million for 2004, primarily due to an increase in average cash balances during 2005 compared to 2004.

95


 

      Equity Income From Joint Ventures. Equity income from joint ventures decreased 15.6% to $5.2 million for 2005, from $6.2 million for 2004, primarily due to an increase in repair and maintenance activity on the shuttle tankers owned by joint ventures.
      Gain on Sale of Marketable Securities. No marketable securities were sold in 2005. During 2004, all marketable securities were sold for proceeds of $135.4 million, which resulted in a gain on sale of marketable securities of $94.2 million. This gain on sale primarily represented the 2004 purchase and sale of a 16% interest in a Danish shipping company that primarily operates product tankers.
      Foreign Currency Exchange Gains (Losses). Foreign currency exchange gains were $34.2 million for 2005, compared to foreign currency exchange losses of $37.9 million for 2004. OPCO’s foreign currency exchange gains and losses, substantially all of which have been unrealized, are due primarily to the period-end revaluation of Norwegian Kroner-denominated advances from affiliates. Gains reflect a stronger U.S. Dollar against the Kroner on the date of revaluation compared to the rate in effect at the beginning of the year. Losses reflect a weaker U.S. Dollar against the Kroner on the date of revaluation compared to the rate in effect at the beginning of the year.
      Income Tax Recovery (Expense). Income tax recovery was $13.9 million for 2005, compared to income tax expense of $28.2 million for 2004, primarily due to a $28.3 million decrease in deferred income tax expense relating to unrealized foreign exchange translation gains (losses) for 2005 and 2004, and $8.4 million deferred tax recovery from the restructuring of Norwegian shuttle tanker operations during the first quarter of 2005.
      Other Income. Other income for 2005 was $8.9 million, which was primarily comprised of $11.0 million of leasing income from the VOC Equipment, partially offset by $1.9 million primarily relating to fees for early termination of certain ship management contracts and minority interest expense of $0.2 million.
      Other income for 2004 was $11.9 million, which was primarily comprised of $8.4 million of leasing income from the VOC Equipment and $5.7 million of dividend income from marketable securities sold in 2004, partially offset by minority interest expense of $2.2 million.
      Net Income. As a result of the foregoing factors, net income was $84.7 million for 2005, compared to $213.8 million for 2004.
     Trends Relating to Income From Vessel Operations
      Our income from vessel operations for the conventional tanker segment has declined from $104.4 million in 2004 to a loss of $15.5 million in 2005, and from a loss of $5.4 million for the six months ended June 30, 2005 to a loss of $8.5 million for the same period in 2006. The $119.9 million decline from 2004 to 2005 is primarily due to a $100.5 million decrease in net voyages revenues from our conventional tankers on charter to TCL. Please read our results of operations for further information regarding our historical charter arrangements with TCL. Prior to the closing of this offering, OPCO will enter into new fixed-rate time charters with TCL for the nine conventional vessels that remain with OPCO after the transfer of Navion Shipping Ltd. and its chartered-in conventional tanker fleet to Teekay Shipping Corporation. These new time charters are at rates which we believe are market-based charter rates and are higher than the rates earned from our historical charter arrangements with TCL. As a result, we do not expect this trend of decreasing income from vessel operations to continue for the conventional tanker segment.
      Our income from vessel operations for the shuttle tanker segment has declined from $96.0 million in 2004 to $67.7 million in 2005, and from $42.6 million in the first six months of 2005 to $28.7 million for the same period in 2006. These declines were primarily due to decreases in net voyage revenues from our shuttle tankers. Please read our results of operations for a full explanation of these reductions in revenues. Based on our 2006 results to date and taking into account that seasonal maintenance of North Sea offshore oil facilities, which typically occurs primarily during the third quarter, was primarily completed in the second quarter of 2006, we expect that our 2006 net voyage revenues and income from vessel

96


 

operations from this segment will be consistent with 2005. Consequently, we do not expect this trend of declining income from vessel operations to continue for the shuttle tanker segment.
      Our income from vessel operations for the FSO segment has declined from $8.6 million in 2004 to $5.6 million in 2005, and from $2.6 million for the six months ended June 30, 2005 to $2.2 million for the same period in 2006. The $3.0 million decline from 2004 to 2005 is primarily due to a negotiated reduction to the daily bareboat charter rate on one of our FSO units. We do not expect this trend of decreasing income from vessel operations to continue as we do not expect such a reduction in the daily charter rate to occur in the foreseeable future and we expect to add an additional FSO unit to our FSO segment beginning in the second quarter of 2007.
Liquidity and Capital Resources
Liquidity and Cash Needs
      As at June 30, 2006, total cash and cash equivalents was $134.0 million, compared to $129.0 million and $143.7 million at December 31, 2005 and 2004, respectively. Total liquidity, including cash and undrawn long-term borrowings, was $539.5 million as at June 30, 2006, down from $729.0 million and $693.9 million as at December 31, 2005 and December 31, 2004, respectively. The decrease in liquidity was mainly the result of repayments of loans due to affiliates, scheduled reductions of revolving credit facilities and capital expenditures, partially offset by cash generated from operations. In October 2006, we refinanced OPCO’s debt obligations as described in “— Credit Facilities” below. We anticipate having total liquidity, including cash and undrawn long-term borrowings, of approximately $405 million at the closing of this offering.
      The amount of available cash we need to pay the minimum quarterly distributions for four quarters on our common units, subordinated units and the 2.0% general partner interest to be outstanding immediately after this offering is $28.0 million. Our pro forma available cash to make distributions during the year ended December 31, 2005 and the twelve months ended June 30, 2006 would have been sufficient to allow us to pay 100.0% of the minimum quarterly distribution on our common units and 98.8% and 67.4%, respectively, of the minimum quarterly distribution on our subordinated units during those periods.
      In addition to distributions on our equity interests, our primary short-term liquidity needs are to fund general working capital requirements and drydocking expenditures, while our long-term liquidity needs primarily relate to expansion and investment capital expenditures and other maintenance capital expenditures and debt repayment. Expansion capital expenditures are primarily for the purchase or construction of vessels to the extent the expenditures increase the operating capacity of or revenue generated by our fleet, while maintenance capital expenditures primarily consist of drydocking expenditures and expenditures to replace vessels in order to maintain the operating capacity of or revenue generated by our fleet. Investment capital expenditures are those capital expenditures that are neither maintenance capital expenditures nor expansion capital expenditures.
      We anticipate that our primary sources of funds for our short-term liquidity needs will be cash flows from operations. We believe that cash flows from operations will be sufficient to meet our existing short-term liquidity needs for at least the next 12 months.
      Generally, our long-term sources of funds will be from cash from operations, long-term bank borrowings and other debt or equity financings. Because we and OPCO distribute all of our and its available cash, we expect that we and OPCO will rely upon external financing sources, including bank borrowings and the issuance of debt and equity securities, to fund acquisitions and expansion and investment capital expenditures, including opportunities we may pursue under the omnibus agreement. We cannot assure you that we will be able to raise additional funds on favorable terms. For more information, please read “— Ongoing Capital Expenditures” below.

97


 

Cash Flows
      The following table summarizes OPCO’s cash and cash equivalents provided by (used for) operating, financing and investing activities for the periods presented:
                                 
    Years Ended   Six Months Ended
    December 31,   June 30,
         
    2004   2005   2005   2006
                 
    (in thousands)
Net cash flow from operating activities
    $242,592       $152,687       $81,232       $48,705  
Net cash flow from financing activities
    (69,710 )     (201,554 )     (153,647 )     (42,602 )
Net cash flow from investing activities
    (190,110 )     34,124       48,182       (1,127 )
Operating Cash Flows
      Net cash flow from operating activities decreased to $48.7 million for the six months ended June 30, 2006, from $81.2 million for the same period in 2005. This primarily reflects a decrease of $13.8 million from the timing of our cash receipts and payments and a decrease of $12.2 million in net voyage revenues earned by the shuttle tanker segment. The decrease of $13.8 million primarily represents an increase in prepaid charter hire payments and other prepaid operating expenses during the six months ended June 30, 2006. Please read “— Results of Operations” and “— Trends Relating to Income from Vessel Operations” for information on the reduction of net voyage revenues from our shuttle tanker segment.
      Net cash flow from operating activities decreased to $152.7 million in 2005, from $242.6 million in 2004, primarily reflecting a decrease of $100.6 million in net voyage revenues earned by the conventional tanker segment, a decrease of $32.6 million in net voyage revenues earned by the shuttle tanker segment, partially offset by an increase of $60.7 million as a result of the timing of our cash receipts and payments, and a $6.3 million reduction of our net interest expense. Please read “— Results of Operations” and “— Trends Relating to Income from Operations” for information on the reduction of net voyage revenues from our conventional tanker segment and our shuttle tanker segment.
      Net cash flow from operating activities depends upon the timing and amount of drydocking expenditures, repairs and maintenance activity, vessel additions and dispositions, foreign currency rates, changes in interest rates, fluctuations in working capital balances and spot market hire rates. The number of vessel drydockings tends to be uneven between years. For more information on our expected drydocking expenditures, please read “— Ongoing Capital Expenditures” below.
Financing Cash Flows
      As at June 30, 2006, through OPCO we had three long-term revolving credit facilities (or the Revolvers ) available, which, as at such date, provided for borrowings of up to $949.0 million, of which $405.5 million was undrawn. Prior to this offering, advances under these Revolvers, advances from Teekay Shipping Corporation and net cash flow from operations were used to finance OPCO’s investments in vessels and equipment and direct financing leases. Historically, advances under the Revolvers have been loaned to Teekay Shipping Corporation to temporarily finance vessels construction and for other general corporate purposes. In effect, the Revolvers were used as corporate-related debt of Teekay Shipping Corporation. Net proceeds from long-term debt, prepayments of long-term debt and net proceeds to/(advances from) affiliates during periods prior to June 30, 2006 reflect this use.
      Net financing cash outflow was $42.6 million, $153.6 million, $201.6 million and $69.7 million for the six months ended June 30, 2006 and 2005, and for the years ended December 31, 2005 and 2004, respectively. Net financing cash outflow generally represents the amount of cash flow generated from operations less the amount used for investing activities. The increase from 2004 to 2005 primarily represents a decrease in net investing cash outflow, which is explained below, partially offset by a decrease in net operating cash flow. The decrease from the six months ended June 30, 2005 to the same period in

98


 

2006 primarily represents an increase in net investing outflow, which is discussed below, and the decrease in net operating cash flow described above.
Investing Cash Flows
      During the six months ended June 30, 2006 and 2005, OPCO incurred $5.1 million and $7.1 million, respectively, of vessel upgrade costs and purchases of equipment. During the six months ended June 30, 2005, OPCO received proceeds of $64.6 million from the sale of two older shuttle tankers.
      During 2005, OPCO received proceeds of $73.2 million from the sale of three older shuttle tankers and incurred $24.8 million of capital expenditures, primarily for conversion and upgrade costs for certain FSO and shuttle tanker projects. During 2004, OPCO incurred capital expenditures for vessels and equipment of $170.6 million representing installment payments for the 2004 Shuttle Tanker Delivery and the 2004 Conventional Tanker Delivery, as well as conversion costs incurred on the FSO unit, the Pattani Spirit. During 2004, OPCO received proceeds of $7.1 million from the sale to a third party of a 1982-built shuttle tanker and $51.6 million for a 2004-built shuttle tanker, which was sold to a joint venture company.
Ongoing Capital Expenditures
      Marine transportation and storage of crude oil is a capital-intensive business, requiring significant investment to maintain an efficient fleet and to stay in regulatory compliance.
      Over the three years following the date of this offering, we estimate that OPCO will spend an average of approximately $12.0 million per year for drydocking and society classification surveys. As our fleet matures and expands, our drydocking expenses will likely increase. Ongoing costs for compliance with environmental regulations are primarily included as part of our drydocking and society classification survey costs or are a component of our operating expenses. We are not aware of any regulatory changes or environmental liabilities that we anticipate will have a material impact on our current or future operations.
      OPCO’s partnership agreement requires it to distribute all of its available cash each quarter. In determining the amount of cash available for distribution, the board of directors of our general partner, on our behalf, determines the amount of cash reserves to set aside, including reserves for future maintenance capital expenditures, working capital and other matters. Because of the substantial capital expenditures required to maintain its fleet, OPCO’s estimated initial annual maintenance capital expenditures are $73.9 million per year, which includes $12.2 million for drydocking costs and $61.7 million, including financing costs, for replacing OPCO’s shuttle tankers, FSO units and conventional tankers at the end of their useful lives. The actual cost of replacing these vessels will depend on a number of factors, including prevailing market conditions, charter rates and the availability and cost of financing at the time of replacement. Our partnership agreement requires our general partner to deduct from our operating surplus each quarter estimated maintenance capital expenditures, as opposed to actual maintenance capital expenditures, in order to reduce disparities in operating surplus caused by fluctuating maintenance capital expenditures, such as drydocking and vessel replacement. The board of directors of our general partner with the approval of its conflicts committee may change the annual amount of our estimated maintenance capital expenditures. In years when estimated maintenance capital expenditures are higher than actual maintenance capital expenditures, the amount of cash available for distribution to unitholders will be lower than if actual maintenance capital expenditures were deducted from operating surplus.

99


 

Historical Capital Expenditures
      The following table summarizes total capital expenditures for drydocking and for vessels and equipment for the periods presented. In the past, vessel replacement and fleet expansion expenditures have been categorized as “expenditures for vessels and equipment.”
                                   
    Years Ended   Six Months Ended
    December 31,   June 30,
         
    2004   2005   2005   2006
                 
    (in thousands)
Expenditures for drydocking
  $ 9,174     $ 8,906     $ 2,679     $ 3,780  
Expenditures for vessels and equipment
    170,630       24,760       7,116       5,054  
                         
 
Total capital expenditures
  $ 179,804     $ 33,666     $ 9,795     $ 8,834  
                         
Ship Financing Arrangements
      The following types of financing arrangements have been used to purchase OPCO’s vessels.
  •  Term Loans. OPCO has a 50.0% interest in five joint venture companies, each of which owns one shuttle tanker. The vessels in the joint venture have been financed with term loans that are secured by first-priority mortgages on the vessels and related collateral. Either OPCO or one of its subsidiaries guarantees 50.0% of the term loans.
 
  •  Revolving Credit Facilities. OPCO and one of its subsidiaries financed the purchases of certain vessels with long-term revolving credit facilities that are secured by first-priority mortgages on certain vessels and related collateral. We amended or replaced these facilities, as discussed below.
Credit Facilities
      In October 2006, OPCO amended one of its revolving credit facilities and terminated the other two and OPCO entered into a new $940 million revolving credit facility. The facilities have the following terms:
  •  Amended Revolving Credit Facility. This 8-year amended reducing revolving credit facility allows OPCO and it subsidiaries to borrow up to $455 million and may be used for acquisitions and for general partnership purposes. Obligations under this credit facility are secured by first-priority mortgages on eight shuttle tankers and one FSO unit. Borrowings under the facility bear interest at LIBOR plus a margin and may be prepaid at any time in amounts of not less than $5.0 million.
 
  •  New Revolving Credit Facility. The new 8-year reducing revolving credit facility allows for borrowing of up to $940 million and may be used for acquisitions and for general partnership purposes. Obligations under this credit facility are secured by first-priority mortgages in 11 shuttle tankers and 8 conventional tankers. Borrowings under the facility bear interest at LIBOR plus a margin and may be prepaid at any time in amounts of not less than $5.0 million. OPCO’s new credit facility allows it to make working capital borrowings and loan the proceeds to us (which we could use to make distributions, provided that such amounts are paid down annually).
      Through interest rate swap agreements with a weighted-average term of 9.7 years, the interest rates applicable to these two credit facilities will be fixed at 5.5% per annum. Please read “— Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk — Interest Rate Risk.” Please read “— Covenants and Other Restrictions in Our Financing Agreements” below for further information about the revolving credit facilities.
      In addition to these two revolving credit facilities, OPCO’s joint ventures will retain the term loans used to finance their vessel acquisitions and OPCO or its subsidiaries will guaranty their pro rata portion of the term loans.

100


 

Covenants and Other Restrictions in Our Financing Agreements
      All of OPCO’s vessel financings are secured by the applicable vessels. The term loans used to finance the five joint venture owned shuttle tankers and the agreements governing the two revolving credit facilities in place as of the closing of this offering contain covenants and other restrictions typical of debt financing secured by vessels, including those that restrict the relevant subsidiaries from:
  •  incurring or guaranteeing indebtedness (applicable to term loans only);
 
  •  changing ownership or structure, including mergers, consolidations, liquidations and dissolutions;
 
  •  making dividends or distributions when in default of the relevant loans;
 
  •  making capital expenditures in excess of specified levels;
 
  •  making certain negative pledges or granting certain liens;
 
  •  selling, transferring, assigning or conveying assets; or
 
  •  entering into a new line of business.
      In addition, OPCO’s two revolving credit facilities and three of the term loans contain covenants that require OPCO to maintain a minimum liquidity (cash, cash equivalents and undrawn committed revolving credit lines) of $75.0 million and at least 5.0% of the total consolidated debt of OPCO.
      OPCO is currently in compliance with all of its financing agreements and we expect that it will remain in compliance. In the future, some of the covenants and restrictions in our or OPCO’s financing agreements could restrict the use of cash generated by shipowning subsidiaries in a manner that could adversely affect our ability to pay the minimum quarterly distribution on our units. However, we currently do not expect that these covenants will have such an effect.
Contractual Obligations and Contingencies
      The following table summarizes our long-term contractual obligations as at June 30, 2006:
                                           
        Balance of   2007 and   2009 and   Beyond
    Total   2006   2008   2010   2010
                     
    (in millions)
Long-term debt(1)
    $543.5       $—     $ 299.0       $21.6     $ 222.9  
Chartered-in vessels (operating leases)
    895.4       166.2       356.5       169.7       203.0  
Commitments under capital lease
    55.3       2.1       8.2       8.2       36.8  
Advances from affiliates
    394.9       394.9                    
Commitment for VOC equipment
    18.0       18.0                    
                               
 
Total contractual obligations
    $1,907.1       $581.2     $ 663.7       $199.5     $ 462.7  
                               
 
(1)  Excludes interest payments of $15.9 million (remainder of 2006), $45.2 million (2007 and 2008), $18.7 million (2009 and 2010) and $30.4 million (beyond 2010). Expected interest payments are based on LIBOR at June 30, 2006, plus margins that ranged between 0.60% and 0.70%.
      On a pro forma basis, after giving effect to:
  •  OPCO’s incurrence of additional debt to increase its outstanding debt to $1.08 billion (excluding debt relating to five joint ventures, which totaled $237.3 million as of June 30, 2006);
 
  •  OPCO’s transfer to Teekay Shipping Corporation of all chartered-in conventional crude oil and product tankers in Navion Shipping Ltd.;
 
  •  OPCO’s purchase from Teekay Shipping Corporation of the Fuji Spirit ; and
 
  •  OPCO’s repayment of all advances from Teekay Shipping Corporation;

101


 

OPCO’s long-term contractual obligations as at June 30, 2006 would have consisted of the following:
                                           
        Balance of   2007 and   2009 and   Beyond
    Total   2006   2008   2010   2010
                     
    (in millions)
Long-term debt(1)
  $ 1,317.3     $ 8.8     $ 193.9     $ 196.5       $918.1  
Chartered-in vessels (operating leases)
    638.8       75.3       222.9       148.0       192.6  
Commitment for VOC equipment
    18.0       18.0                    
                               
 
Total pro forma contractual obligations
  $ 1,974.1     $ 102.1     $ 416.8     $ 344.5       $1,110.7  
                               
 
(1)  Excludes interest payments of $35.5 million (remainder of 2006), $132.2 million (2007 and 2008), $109.0 million (2009 and 2010) and $140.6 million (beyond 2010). Expected interest payments are based on LIBOR at June 30, 2006, plus margins that ranged up to 0.80%. Please read “— Liquidity and Capital Resources — Credit Facilities” above, “Use of Proceeds” and the unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this prospectus.
      As part of our growth strategy, we will continue to consider strategic opportunities, including the acquisition of additional vessels and expansion into new markets. We may choose to pursue such opportunities through internal growth, joint ventures or business acquisitions or the acquisition of additional units of OPCO. We intend to finance any future acquisitions through various sources of capital, including internally-generated cash flow, existing credit facilities, additional debt borrowings and the issuance of additional common units.
Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements
      Certain of OPCO’s subsidiaries have guaranteed their share of the outstanding mortgage debt in two 50%-owned joint venture companies. Please read Note 14(a) (Commitments and Contingencies — Joint Ventures) to the audited historical combined consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this prospectus. We do not believe these off-balance sheet arrangements have, and we have no other off-balance sheet arrangements that have, or are reasonably likely to have, a current or future material effect on our financial condition, results of operations, liquidity, capital expenditures or capital resources.
Critical Accounting Estimates
      We prepare our consolidated financial statements in accordance with GAAP, which require us to make estimates in the application of our accounting policies based on our best assumptions, judgments and opinions. On a regular basis, management reviews the accounting policies, assumptions, estimates and judgments to ensure that our consolidated financial statements are presented fairly and in accordance with GAAP. However, because future events and their effects cannot be determined with certainty, actual results could differ from our assumptions and estimates, and such differences could be material. Accounting estimates and assumptions discussed in this section are those that we consider to be the most critical to an understanding of our financial statements because they inherently involve significant judgments and uncertainties. For a further description of our material accounting policies, please read Note 1 (Summary of Significant Accounting Policies) to the audited historical combined consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this prospectus.
Revenue Recognition
      Description. We generate a majority of our revenues from voyages servicing contracts of affreightment and time charters and, to a lesser extent, bareboat charters and spot voyages. Within the shipping industry, the two methods used to account for voyage revenues and expenses are the percentage of completion and the completed voyage methods. Most shipping companies, including us, use the percentage of completion method. For each method, voyages may be calculated on either a load-to -load or discharge-to -discharge basis. In other words, revenues are recognized ratably either from the beginning of when product is loaded for one voyage to when it is loaded for another voyage, or from when product is

102


 

discharged (unloaded) at the end of one voyage to when it is discharged after the next voyage. We recognize revenues from time charters and bareboat charters daily over the term of the charter as the applicable vessel operates under the charter. We do not recognize revenues during days that the vessel is off-hire.
      Judgments and Uncertainties. In applying the percentage of completion method, we believe that in most cases the discharge-to -discharge basis of calculating voyages more accurately reflects voyage results than the load-to -load basis. At the time of cargo discharge, we generally have information about the next load port and expected discharge port, whereas at the time of loading we are normally less certain what the next load port will be. We use this method of revenue recognition for all spot voyages. In the case of our shuttle tankers servicing contracts of affreightment, a voyage commences with tendering of notice of readiness at a field, within the agreed lifting range, and ends with tendering of notice of readiness at a field for the next lifting. We do not begin recognizing voyage revenue for any of our vessels until a charter has been agreed to by the customer and us, even if the vessel has discharged its cargo and is sailing to the anticipated load port on its next voyage.
      Effect if Actual Results Differ from Assumptions. If actual results are not consistent with our estimates in applying the percentage of completion method, our voyage revenues could be overstated or understated for any given period by the amount of such difference.
Vessel Lives and Impairment
      Description. The carrying value of each of our vessels represents its original cost at the time of delivery or purchase less depreciation or impairment charges. We depreciate our vessels on a straight-line basis over a vessel’s estimated useful life, less an estimated residual value. The carrying values of our vessels may not represent their fair market value at any point in time since the market prices of second-hand vessels tend to fluctuate with changes in charter rates and the cost of newbuildings. Both charter rates and newbuilding costs tend to be cyclical in nature. We review vessels and equipment for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate the carrying amount of an asset may not be recoverable. We measure the recoverability of an asset by comparing its carrying amount to future undiscounted cash flows that the asset is expected to generate over its remaining useful life.
      Judgments and Uncertainties. Depreciation is calculated using an estimated useful life of 25 years for our vessels, from the date the vessel was originally delivered from the shipyard, or a shorter period if regulations prevent us from operating the vessels for 25 years. In the shipping industry, the use of a 25-year vessel life has become the prevailing standard. However, the actual life of a vessel may be different, with a shorter life resulting in an increase in the quarterly depreciation and potentially resulting in an impairment loss. The estimates and assumptions regarding expected cash flows require considerable judgment and are based upon existing contracts, historical experience, financial forecasts and industry trends and conditions. We are not aware of any indicators of impairments nor any regulatory changes or environmental liabilities that we anticipate will have a material impact on our current or future operations.
      Effect if Actual Results Differ from Assumptions. If we consider a vessel or equipment to be impaired, we recognize impairment in an amount equal to the excess of the carrying value of the asset over its fair market value. The new lower cost basis will result in a lower annual depreciation than before the vessel impairment.
Drydocking
      Description. We capitalize a substantial portion of the costs we incur during drydocking and amortize those costs on a straight-line basis from the completion of the drydocking to the estimated completion of the next drydocking. We expense costs related to routine repairs and maintenance incurred during drydocking that do not improve or extend the useful lives of the assets.

103


 

      Judgments and Uncertainties. Amortization of capitalized drydock expenditures requires us to estimate the period of the next drydocking. While we typically drydock each vessel every two and a half to five years, we may drydock the vessels at an earlier date.
      Effect if Actual Results Differ from Assumptions. If we change our estimate of the next drydock date we will adjust our annual amortization of drydocking expenditures.
Goodwill and Intangible Assets
      Description. We allocate the cost of acquired companies to the identifiable tangible and intangible assets and liabilities acquired, with the remaining amount being classified as goodwill. Certain intangible assets, such as time charters, are amortized over time. Our future operating performance will be affected by the amortization of intangible assets and potential impairment charges related to goodwill. Accordingly, the allocation of purchase price to intangible assets and goodwill may significantly affect our future operating results. Goodwill and indefinite lived assets are not amortized, but reviewed for impairment annually, or more frequently if impairment indicators arise.
      Judgments and Uncertainties. The allocation of the purchase price of acquired companies to intangible assets and goodwill requires management to make significant estimates and assumptions, including estimates of future cash flows expected to be generated by the acquired assets and the appropriate discount rate to value these cash flows. In addition, the process of evaluating the potential impairment of goodwill and intangible assets is highly subjective and requires significant judgment at many points during the analysis. The fair value of our reporting units was estimated based on discounted expected future cash flows using a weighted-average cost of capital rate. The estimates and assumptions regarding expected cash flows and the discount rate require considerable judgment and are based upon existing contracts, historical experience, financial forecasts and industry trends and conditions.
      Effect if Actual Results Differ from Assumptions. In the fourth quarter of 2005, OPCO completed its annual impairment testing of goodwill using the methodology described above, and determined there was no impairment. If actual results are not consistent with assumptions and estimates, we may be exposed to a goodwill impairment charge. As at June 30, 2006 and December 31, 2005, the net book value of goodwill was $130.5 million.
      Amortization expense of intangible assets for the years ended December 31, 2004 and 2005 were $18.4 million and $14.9 million, respectively. If actual results are not consistent with our estimates used to value our intangible assets, we may be exposed to an impairment charge and a decrease in the annual amortization expense of our intangible assets. As at June 30, 2006 and December 31, 2005, the net book value of intangible assets was $72.5 million and $78.5 million, respectively.
Derivative Instruments
      We expect to use derivative financial instruments to reduce interest rate risks. We do not expect to hold or issue derivative financial instruments for trading purposes. Statement of Financial Accounting Standards (or SFAS ) No. 133, Accounting for Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities , which was amended in June 2000 by SFAS No. 138 and in May 2003 by SFAS No. 149, establishes accounting and reporting standards for derivative instruments and hedging activities. It requires that an entity recognize all derivatives as either assets or liabilities in the statement of financial condition and measure those instruments at fair value. Derivatives that are not hedges or are not designated as hedges are adjusted to fair value through income. If the derivative is a hedge, depending upon the nature of the hedge, changes in the fair value of the derivatives are either offset against the fair value of assets, liabilities or firm commitments through income, or recognized in other comprehensive income until the hedged item is recognized in income. The ineffective portion of a derivative’s change in fair value is immediately recognized into income.

104


 

Recent Accounting Pronouncements
      In July 2006, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (or FASB ) issued FASB Interpretation No. 48, Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes, an Interpretation of FASB Statement No. 109 (or FIN 48 ). This interpretation clarifies the accounting for uncertainty in income taxes recognized in financial statements in accordance with FASB Statement No. 109, Accounting for Income Taxes. FIN 48 will require companies to determine whether it is more-likely-than-not that a tax position taken or expected to be taken in a tax return will be sustained upon examination, including resolution of any related appeals or litigation processes, based on the technical merits of the position. If a tax position meets the more-likely-than-not recognition threshold, it is measured to determine the amount of benefit to recognize in the financial statements based on guidance in the interpretation. FIN 48 is effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2006. We have not determined the effect, if any, that the adoption of FIN 48 will have on our financial position or results of operations.
Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk
      We are exposed to market risk from foreign currency fluctuations and changes in interest rates. We may use interest rate swaps to manage interest rate risks but do not use these financial instruments for trading or speculative purposes.
Interest Rate Risk
      We are exposed to the impact of interest rate changes primarily through our unhedged floating-rate borrowings. Significant increases in interest rates could adversely affect our operating margins, results of operations and our ability to service our debt. From time to time, we will use interest rate swaps to reduce our exposure to market risk from changes in interest rates. The principal objective of these contracts is to minimize the risks and costs associated with our floating-rate debt. As at June 30, 2006, OPCO’s unhedged floating-rate borrowings totaled $543.5 million. A 1.0% increase in the interest rates on that amount would result in $5.4 million in additional annual interest payments.
      The tables below provide information about OPCO’s financial instruments as at June 30, 2006 that are sensitive to changes in interest rates. For debt obligations, the table presents principal payments and related weighted-average interest rates by expected maturity dates.
      We invest our cash and marketable securities in financial instruments with maturities of less than six months within the parameters of our investment policy and guidelines.
      We may use interest rate swaps to manage the impact of interest rate changes on earnings and cash flows. Changes in the fair value of our interest rate swaps are either offset against the fair value of assets or liabilities through income, or recognized in other comprehensive income until the hedged item is recognized in income. The ineffective portion of an interest rate swap change in fair value is immediately recognized in income. Premiums and receipts, if any, are recognized as adjustments to interest expense over the lives of the individual contracts.

105


 

      The table below provides information about OPCO’s financial instruments at June 30, 2006, which are sensitive to changes in interest rates, including our debt and capital lease obligations. For long-term debt and capital lease obligations, the table presents principal cash flows and related weighted-average interest rates by expected maturity dates.
                                                                   
        Expected Maturity Date
         
    Total   2006   2007   2008   2009   2010   Thereafter   Rate(1)
                                 
    (in millions of U.S. dollars)
Long-Term Debt and Advances from Affiliates:
                                                               
 
Variable Rate Debt (U.S.$)
    543.5             15.0       284.0       10.8       10.8       222.9       5.9 %
 
Fixed-Rate Debt (Norwegian Kroner)
    157.6       157.6                                     7.5 %
 
Fixed-Rate Debt (Australian Dollar)
    18.9       18.9                                     8.0 %
Capital Lease Obligations:(2)
                                                               
 
Fixed-Rate (U.S.$)
    33.6       0.7       1.5       1.6       1.7       1.9       26.2       8.3 %
 
(1)  Rate refers to the weighted-average effective interest rate for OPCO’s debt, including the margin it pays on variable-rate debt, as at June 30, 2006, and the interest rate implicit in its capital lease obligation at the inception of the lease.
 
(2)  The capital lease obligation represents the present value of minimum lease payments, together with the purchase obligation. During June 2006, OPCO exercised the option to purchase the conventional Aframax tanker subject to the capital lease (the Fuji Spirit ), and acquired the vessel in September 2006.
     The table below provides information about OPCO’s financial instruments, on a pro forma basis, as at June 30, 2006, after giving effect to:
  •  OPCO’s incurrence of additional debt to increase OPCO’s outstanding debt to $1.08 billion (excluding debt relating to five 50%-owned joint ventures, which totaled $237.3 million as at June 30, 2006);
 
  •  OPCO’s purchase of the Fuji Spirit ;
 
  •  OPCO’s repayment of all advances from Teekay Shipping Corporation; and
 
  •  Teekay Shipping Corporation’s contribution to OPCO of interest rate swaps with a notional principal amount of $1.09 billion, a weighted-average fixed interest rate of 5.5% (including the margin OPCO pays on its floating-rate debt) and a weighted-average remaining term of 9.7 years.
      For interest rate swaps, the table presents notional amounts and weighted-average interest rates by expected contractual maturity dates.
                                                                   
        Expected Maturity Date
         
    Total   2006   2007   2008   2009   2010   Thereafter   Rate(1)
                                 
    (in millions)
Long-Term Debt:
                                                               
 
Variable Rate Debt(2)
    $1,312.2       $8.8       $76.8       $117.1       $115.4       $81.1       $913.0       5.4 %
Interest Rate Swaps:
                                                               
 
Contract Amount(3)
    $1,147.2       $4.4       $297.4       $8.5       $208.5       $8.5       $619.9       4.9 %
 
Average Fixed Pay Rate(2)
    4.9 %     4.7 %     5.4 %     4.9 %     4.3 %     4.9 %     4.8 %        
 
(1)  Rate refers to the weighted-average effective interest rate for OPCO’s debt, including the margin it pays on variable-rate debt as at June 30, 2006, and the average fixed pay rate for interest rate swap agreements, which excludes the margin OPCO pays on variable-rate debt. Interest payments for interest rate swaps are based on LIBOR.
 
(2)  Interest payments on variable-rate debt and interest rate swaps are based on LIBOR.
 
(3)  The average variable receive rate for our interest rate swaps is set quarterly at the 3-month LIBOR or semi-annually at 6-month LIBOR.

106


 

     Counterparties to these financial instruments expose us to credit-related losses in the event of nonperformance; however, counterparties to these agreements are major financial institutions, and we consider the risk of loss due to nonperformance to be minimal. We do not require collateral from these institutions. We do not hold or issue interest rate swaps for trading purposes.
      A component of the time-charter hire rate for two of OPCO’s five 50%-owned joint ventures that are consolidated on a pro forma basis fluctuates with the floating interest rates for the debt used to finance the related vessels. If interest rates increase or decrease, the amount OPCO pays under the debt relating to the chartered vessels increases or decreases by the amount of the additional or reduced interest payments, and the hire rate OPCO receives from the related time charters correspondingly changes. Consequently, the fluctuating portion of the time-charter hire rate has no net effect on OPCO’s cash flows or net income, but does affect recorded voyage revenues and interest expense.
Foreign Currency Fluctuation Risk
      Our primary economic environment is the international shipping market. This market utilizes the U.S. Dollar as its functional currency. Consequently, virtually all of our revenues and most of our operating costs are in U.S. Dollars. We incur certain vessel operating expenses and general and administrative expenses in foreign currencies, the most significant of which is the Norwegian Kroner. During the six months ended June 30, 2006 and during fiscal 2005, approximately 36.0% and 38.8%, respectively, of vessel operating costs and general and administrative expenses were denominated in Norwegian Kroner.
      Although the majority of our transactions, assets and liabilities are denominated in U.S. Dollars, certain subsidiaries of OPCO have foreign currency denominated liabilities. There is a risk that currency fluctuations will have a negative effect on the value of our cash flows. As at June 30, 2006, Teekay Shipping Corporation and certain of its subsidiaries had loaned us 1.0 billion Norwegian Kroner ($157.6 million) and 25.5 million Australian Dollars ($18.9 million). Prior to the closing of this offering, we will repay our foreign currency denominated advances from affiliates. In addition, as at June 30, 2006, we had Norwegian Kroner-denominated deferred income taxes of approximately 459.8 million ($73.9 million). We have not entered into any forward contracts to protect against currency fluctuations on any future taxes we will pay. Upon the closing this offering, OPCO will enter into new services agreements with subsidiaries of Teekay Shipping Corporation whereby the subsidiaries will operate and crew OPCO’s vessels. Under these service agreements, OPCO will pay all vessel operating expenses in U.S. Dollars and will not be subject to currency exchange fluctuations prior to 2009. Beginning in 2009, payments under the service agreements will adjust to reflect any change in Teekay Shipping Corporation’s cost of providing services based on fluctuations in the value of the Kroner relative to the U.S. Dollar. We may seek to hedge this currency fluctuation risk in the future.

107


 

INDUSTRY
      We obtained the information in this prospectus about the offshore oil industry and seaborne oil transportation industries from several independent outside sources, including Douglas-Westwood Ltd., a market survey, research and analysis firm focusing on the energy and marine industries; Wood Mackenzie Ltd., a search and consulting firm focused on the energy industry; International Maritime Associates (or IMA ), a strategic planning and consulting firm focusing on the marine and offshore sectors; R.S. Platou Shipbrokers, an international ship-brokering company that serves the shipping and offshore industries; the Energy Information Administration (or EIA ), an independent statistical and analytical agency within the U.S. Department of Energy; Clarkson Research Services (or CRS ), the research division of H. Clarkson & Co. Ltd.; and the International Energy Agency (or IEA ), an autonomous energy forum for 26 industrial countries.
The Offshore Oil Industry
      Oil continues to be the world’s primary energy source as it has been for a number of decades, with consumption of oil currently accounting for approximately 40% of global energy consumption. The EIA expects daily global oil consumption to increase from an average of approximately 84 million barrels in 2005 to approximately 98 million barrels in 2015.
      Although oil production from reservoirs beneath the ocean began in the late 19th Century, production from offshore oil fields did not begin to have a meaningful impact on the global energy market until the 1960s, when producers began to commit significant capital to developing the open shallow waters of the Gulf of Mexico and the Persian Gulf. Thereafter, offshore production rose rapidly as many countries began to explore and produce oil offshore, especially in locations bordering the North Sea. By 2005, offshore oil production had grown to approximately 33% of global oil production. According to Douglas-Westwood, offshore oil production will represent approximately 37% of world production by 2015.
Global Offshore Oil Production
(GLOBAL OFFSHORE OIL PRODUCTION BAR GRAPH)
 
Source: Douglas-Westwood Ltd., August 2006.
     Deepwater oil production is one of the fastest growing areas of the global oil industry and is replacing shallow water as the main focus of offshore oil field development. Deepwater oil production is characterized by wells located in water depths of more than 1,000 feet and has developed as countries have searched for alternative sources of oil and as exploration and production technologies have advanced. Shuttle tankers, FSO units and FPSO units are an important part of the supporting infrastructure for deepwater offshore development, as alternative solutions are typically better suited for shallow water oil production.

108


 

      Over the last decade, deepwater exploration and production has become increasingly important because it represents the only significant opportunity for large conventional reserve additions for oil companies outside Russia and the Middle East. Douglas-Westwood forecasts that deepwater oil production will increase from approximately three million barrels per day in 2005 to over eight million in 2015. As a result, Douglas-Westwood forecasts that nearly 25% of offshore oil will come from deep waters in 2015, compared to approximately 12% in 2005, and expects that all global offshore oil production growth after 2010 will be from deep waters, compensating for declining output from shallow waters, as shown in the graph below:
Offshore Production Outlook-Shallow Versus Deepwater
(OFFSHORE PRODUCTION IN OUTLOOK-SHALLOW VERSUS DEEPWATER BAR GRAPH)
 
Source: Douglas-Westwood Ltd., August 2006.
     According to Douglas-Westwood, global expenditures to explore, develop and operate offshore oil and gas fields were approximately $163 billion in 2005, and it currently estimates that this spending will increase to approximately $247 billion in 2010.
Infrastructure for Offshore Oil Field Production
      The development of offshore oil fields requires investment in production, storage, transportation and support infrastructure. Once a commercial oil field is discovered, a plan for development is created. This development plan includes:
  •  the number, location and type of wells required to efficiently produce the field’s reserves, which are determined by several factors, including the geology of the reservoir and its depth;
 
  •  the production system required to produce the field’s reserves, which is determined by a number of factors, including the water depth, geography, surrounding infrastructure and the size and content of the discovery. Depending on these factors, the production system could be a fixed installation ( i.e. , attached to the ocean floor), floating or both; and
 
  •  the processing, storage and transportation systems required to handle the field’s production and economically bring the oil to market, including the decision to use pipelines or shuttle tankers for transportation.

109


 

      OPCO’s and Teekay Shipping Corporation’s expertise is in the offshore oil transportation and storage industry, and through their expertise we provide the offshore industry a fully-integrated marine midstream solution. The main components of this solution are:
  •  offloading and transportation of cargo from oil field installations to onshore terminals via dynamically-positioned offshore loading shuttle tankers; and
 
  •  floating storage for oil field installations via FSO units.
      We intend to further expand these offshore offerings to include FPSO units that produce and process oil offshore in addition to providing storage and offtake.
Shuttle Tankers
Overview
      A shuttle tanker is a specialized ship designed to transport crude oil and condensates from offshore oil field installations to onshore terminals and refineries. Shuttle tankers are equipped with sophisticated loading systems and dynamic positioning systems that allow the vessels to load cargo safely and reliably from oil field installations, even in harsh weather conditions.
      Shuttle tankers were developed in the North Sea as an alternative to pipelines. The first cargo from an offshore field in the North Sea was shipped in 1977, and the first dynamically-positioned shuttle tankers were introduced in the early 1980s. Since 1984, over 15,000 cargoes have been lifted at various offshore fields around the world via shuttle tankers.
      Shuttle tankers are often described as “floating pipelines” because these vessels typically shuttle oil from offshore installations to onshore facilities in much the same way a pipeline would transport oil along the ocean floor. The advantages of shuttle tankers compared to pipelines are:
  •  Field operators can avoid expensive pipeline installations and tariff regimes. Shuttle tankers can therefore represent a more favorable cost solution than pipelines, especially in cases where offshore oil fields are located in deep water or remote locations with fields expected to have shorter production lives.
 
  •  Shuttle tankers can lift and transport oil from several loading facilities and transport the cargo to any port directed by the customer, thus providing destination flexibility versus a pipeline, which has dedicated receiving terminals.
 
  •  Pipeline grids, unlike shuttle tankers, often blend crude oil with varying qualities from different fields. A field operator can often achieve a better price if a cargo is sold as unblended. Field operators also have the option to segregate different crude qualities on board the shuttle tanker, which is not possible with pipelines.
 
  •  Major shuttle tanker operators have backup vessels if the primary vessel goes “off-hire” for maintenance or repair. If a pipeline network requires maintenance or repair, the network may be shut down, interrupting the supply of oil from an installation.

110


 

      The following diagram sets forth the supply chain of offshore loading by shuttle tankers to terminals.
(DIAGRAM)
      When shuttle tankers are used, crude oil and condensates produced at the field are often exported in batches. Shuttle tankers vary in size and are designed to carry 250,000 to 1.1 million barrels of crude oil per voyage, depending on the requirements of the field operator. Normally, storage capacity at the field is required in order to enable continuous production between each shuttle tanker lifting operation. Depending on the characteristics of the field, the storage facility may be part of a fixed offshore oil platform, an FPSO unit or an FSO unit. Alternatively, shuttle tankers can provide storage though a dual loading operation where a second shuttle tanker will moor before the first shuttle tanker leaves the field.
Unique Attributes of Shuttle Tankers
      Shuttle tankers are significantly different from conventional crude oil tankers. Shuttle tankers are primarily used in regions with harsher climates that require robust maneuvering capabilities, the ability to operate independently in all weather conditions, sophisticated bow loading systems, and specialized crews. Only in regions with calm ocean waters, such as West Africa or parts of Southeast Asia, can a conventional crude oil tanker be safely used for offshore loading operations. Conventional tankers load from an offshore field installation usually through a taut hawser operation and/or with tug assistance. In certain cases, dedicated shuttle tanker newbuildings are required to service the specific requirements of oil fields and installations. At times, conventional oil tankers can be converted to shuttle tankers after a substantial upgrade and investment in equipment. These upgrades typically cost between $15 and $30 million.
      Key differences between shuttle tankers and conventional oil tankers include:
  •  Design. Shuttle tankers are designed with variable pitch propellers and side thrusters, higher cargo pumping capability, dynamic positioning systems, specific loading systems for loading cargo at offshore facilities, reinforced hull design for fatigue prevention, and a wide range of area/customer specific equipment and systems.
 
  •  Voyage Length. Shuttle tanker voyages are typically short-haul to regional terminals and refineries, while conventional oil tankers traditionally trade on longer-haul voyages. The short voyages, continual loading operations and unique systems give rise to far more complex technical and performance issues for shuttle tankers than conventional tankers.
 
  •  Stringent Standards. The shuttle tanker industry is affected by standards and regulations applicable to the offshore industry, certain of which are more stringent than those applicable to conventional oil tankers.
 
  •  Nature of Contracts. Shuttle tankers are an integrated part of an offshore field development project and a critical part of the logistics chain of a field. As a result, cooperation between the

111


 

  shuttle tanker operator and the field operator is much closer than in the case of conventional tanker business, and there are usually long-term contractual arrangements between the field operator and shuttle tanker owner to lift the production from an oil field installation. By contrast, the conventional tanker market is predominantly conducted on short-term contracts, typically for one or a few voyages.
 
  •  Specialized Crewing and Staff. The workload for the crew onboard and for shore-based personnel for offshore operations is higher compared to conventional shipping, given the shorter voyage lengths and additional complexity of offshore loading operations. Maneuvering and safe handling of shuttle tankers in close proximity to offshore installations, operating the loading and dynamic positioning systems, and complying with additional offshore regulations and practices require highly skilled crew. Tailor-made training, including extensive simulator training, is an integral part of the shuttle tanker business. In addition to the normal maritime certificates for deck officers, a shuttle tanker dynamic positioning operator must qualify for a dedicated dynamic positioning certificate.

      Two of the key design attributes of a shuttle tanker include the offshore loading system and the dynamic positioning system.
Offshore Loading System
      Offshore loading involves the transfer of liquid cargo in open waters from either a fixed installation (a platform or a fixed buoy) or a floating installation (a floating loading platform, FPSO unit or FSO unit).
      The most distinguishing feature of a shuttle tanker is the sophisticated loading system located on the bow of the vessel. A bow loading system allows the shuttle tanker to load safely and reliably from a variety of offshore installations, even in extreme weather conditions. In addition to a bow loading system, a shuttle tanker can be equipped with a specialized cone-shaped loading system located on the keel of the vessel.
      An oil field installation has a field export system that connects to the loading system on the shuttle tanker. Field export systems vary in design and configuration. Field operators choose among the various export system alternatives based on reliability, safety, operational weather limitations, water depth, seabed conditions and installation and maintenance costs. The following is an overview of the most common field export systems, which generally work with all intake loading systems on shuttle tankers:
  •  Single Point Mooring (SPM). SPM was the first system introduced in the North Sea and allows a shuttle tanker to weathervane, or position the vessel in order to be less affected by the weather conditions, around a mooring point such as a floating buoy anchored to the seabed. In the 1970s, the first SPM systems relied on a taut hawser operation, in which a hawser is connected to the export system and the vessel reverses, which creates tension on the hawser. Tug or standby vessel assistance is often required under a taut hawser arrangement. A hose from the export system is then connected to the loading system on the vessel. The introduction of dynamic positioning systems in the early 1980s significantly reduced wear-and-tear on equipment related to SPM operations.
(DIAGRAM)

112


 

  •  Ugland Kongsberg Offshore Loading System (OLS). In 1986, OLS was introduced as a considerably less expensive system than the traditional SPM buoys. While SPM allowed for a taut hawser operation, OLS systems were the first to be totally dependant on the dynamic positioning system of a shuttle tanker.
(DIAGRAM)
  •  Submerged Turret Loading (STL). Introduced in 1994, STL consists of a submerged buoy that is pulled through a cone-shaped turret located on the keel of the shuttle tanker. The loading hose runs through the buoy to a rotating connector, allowing the ship to weathervane freely. STL is deployed in the most extreme weather conditions, such as those off Northwest Europe. This export system does not operate with a bow loading system.
(DIAGRAM)
  •  Single Anchor Loading (SAL). Introduced in the late 1990s, SAL provides a simple, cost effective export solution used primarily in shallow waters. A SAL system consists of a single anchor on the seabed with equipment for mooring and oil transfer to shuttle tankers.
(DIAGRAM)
  •  Tandem Loading. In a tandem loading operation, shuttle tankers connect to the stern of an FPSO unit or FSO unit. The first tandem operation was carried out in 1991. Dynamic positioning systems continuously monitor the movements and relative positions of the two units.
(DIAGRAM)

113


 

Dynamic Positioning System
      A shuttle tanker is equipped with a computerized steering and positioning system, referred to as a dynamic positioning system, which allows the vessel to remain in position in open seas, even in harsh environmental conditions. The DP system monitors wind, currents, swells and tide changes and controls the positioning of the vessel with variable pitch propellers and lateral thrusters. The development of DP systems for shuttle tankers in the early 1980s significantly increased the efficiency and reliability of offshore loading. The primary advantages of DP systems versus a taut hawser or tug-assisted operation include:
  •  wider operating range, including the capability to load in conditions with up to 17 foot significant wave height (a measure of average wave height that corresponds to approximately 30 foot maximum wave height); and
 
  •  less risk of damage and wear and tear both to the field export system and the vessels’ loading systems since no heavy loads are introduced to the system during loading.
      There are two classes of DP systems for shuttle tankers: DP1 and DP2. The classes are based on the shuttle tanker’s dynamic positioning equipment and system redundancy. DP1 systems have one set of maneuvering and computer systems, while DP2 systems include a backup for all active systems. The type of system employed is determined by the weather conditions at the oil field installation and specific field operator requirements. Due to the harsh weather conditions in the North Sea, DP2 class shuttle tankers comprise approximately 61% of the overall North Sea fleet. FSO and FPSO units in the North Sea usually require DP2 class shuttle tankers for tandem loading. In other regions, such as Brazil, the shuttle tanker fleet is primarily comprised of DP1 class vessels. These calmer regions allow the use of taut hawser and DP1 class shuttle tankers for tandem offloading. However, even in these regions there is a growing trend toward DP2 systems on newer vessels. OPCO has a fleet of 18 DP1 shuttle tankers and 18 DP2 shuttle tankers.
Markets
      As of November 1, 2006, the world shuttle tanker fleet consisted of 58 operating vessels and seven vessels on order (newbuildings or conversions). Shuttle tankers primarily operate in the major offshore producing regions with harsh climates. The following table shows the number of shuttle tankers, including vessels on order, by geographic area.
World Shuttle Tanker Fleet
                         
    Operating   On Order   Total
             
North Sea
    39       0       39  
Brazil
    11       2       13  
Eastern Canada
    6       0       6  
Russia Arctic
    0       5       5  
Australia
    1       0       1  
South Africa
    1       0       1  
                   
Total (1)
    58       7       65  
                   
 
Source: R.S. Platou Shipbrokers, November 1, 2006.
(1)  Excludes five older shuttle tankers that are awaiting conversion to FSO or FPSO units or are operating in the conventional tanker market.
     According to Douglas-Westwood, the amount of oil transported via shuttle tankers is expected to increase from approximately 3.3 million barrels per day in 2006 to approximately 4.5 million barrels per day by 2015.

114


 

Oil Transported via Shuttle Tankers
(DIAGRAM)
 
Source: Douglas-Westwood Ltd., August 2006.
     North Sea: The North Sea is the largest offshore oil producing region in the world and includes oil fields on the United Kingdom, Danish, Dutch and Norwegian continental shelves. Approximately 70% of the existing world shuttle tanker fleet currently operates in the North Sea, with operations primarily focused in the Norwegian and UK sectors. The North Sea is a mature market characterized by sophisticated participants, advanced regulations and systems, an established commercial structure and vessel operations that are embedded into the offshore oil structure. We believe most of the future development in the North Sea will be in remote or marginal fields which favor shuttle tankers over pipelines. As of November 1, 2006, OPCO owned or operated 27 of the 39 shuttle tankers in the North Sea.
      Brazil: The second largest market for shuttle tankers is off the coast of Brazil. The majority of Brazil’s offshore production is in the Campos Basin region. Currently, several oil fields are being developed or evaluated in Brazil. We expect offshore production, both deepwater and ultra-deepwater, to increase in Brazil in coming years, making this region the leading growth area for shuttle tankers. As of November 1, 2006, OPCO owned 8 of the 11 shuttle tankers operating in the Brazilian market.
      Eastern Canada: There are three major offshore fields off the east coast of Canada that are served by shuttle tankers. The crude oil produced from these fields typically is either taken to an oil transhipment terminal located in Newfoundland or directly to market on the U.S. East Coast. New offshore exploration is ongoing and, given the stable political climate, high quality of crude, good production and recovery factors, Eastern Canada is a potential growth area for shuttle tankers.
      Russian Arctic: Offshore production is increasing in the Russian Arctic. Construction of pipelines appears to not be a viable option in the region due to harsh weather and ice conditions. Recently, Sovcomflot, the Russian state-owned shipping company, ordered a series of ice-class shuttle tanker newbuildings to service the Varandey and Prirazlomnoye fields in the Pechora Sea.
      Australia: The majority of Australia’s oil reserves are located offshore, particularly off the southern and western coasts. Large parts of these regions remain unexplored. With offshore field development increasing in Australia, we also expect demand for floating production systems and shuttle tankers to increase. As of November 1, 2006, OPCO owned the only shuttle tanker operating in Australia.
      Africa: Although there is currently significant crude oil production off the coast of West Africa, the relatively calm waters there make the use of conventional oil tankers (with the assistance of tugs) a viable option for oil field operators. OPCO has operated shuttle tankers for customers in harsher regions such as South Africa.

115


 

      Gulf of Mexico/Caribbean: Substantially all of the offshore crude oil production in the Gulf of Mexico is transported via pipelines. However, with more exploration activities being carried out in deep and ultra-deep waters, we believe this region could present future opportunities for shuttle tankers. U.S. regulators approved the use of FPSO units, FSO units and shuttle tankers in the U.S. Gulf of Mexico in 2001. In the aftermath of hurricanes Katrina and Rita in 2005, which resulted in damage to the offshore oil industry infrastructure in the U.S. Gulf, Teekay Shipping Corporation operated a shuttle tanker that serviced a BP oil field installation. In July 2006, Shell chartered one of OPCO’s shuttle tankers on hurricane back-up for the 2006 hurricane season; the tanker will only operate under the charter if requested to provide services, and currently trades as part of the contract of affreightment fleet.
Competition
      OPCO is the world’s largest owner and operator of shuttle tankers. It owned or operated 36 of the 58 vessels in the world shuttle tanker fleet as of November 1, 2006. The most prominent competitor in the shuttle tanker market is Knutsen OAS Shipping, based in Haugesund, Norway. Knutsen owns 17 shuttle tankers, of which OPCO charters-in seven. Competition in the shuttle tanker market is primarily based on price, vessel specification, reputation and size of fleet, as larger fleets allow for greater vessel substitution, availability and customer service.
Contract Structures
      Shuttle tankers have three primary types of contract structures: contracts of affreightment, time charters and bareboat charters. The type of charter is determined by customer requirements for operational involvement and range of services.
      Contracts of Affreightment. Pursuant to a contract of affreightment, the customer typically pays a fixed rate per day for transportation services actually provided and the voyage related costs. These long-term, fixed-rate agreements relate to designated oil fields rather than specific vessels. The customer has access to shuttle tankers from the time when it has a cargo ready for transport at the offshore installation. The key benefits of a contract of affreightment to the customer, as compared to chartering a dedicated vessel, are: lower direct costs, as the customer pays only for the time spent lifting and transporting each individual cargo and voyage related costs; and reduced risk related to field start-up, tonnage utilization and vessel operations.
      Time Charters. A time charter is a contract for the use of a vessel for a fixed period of time at a specified daily rate. Under a typical time charter, the ship owner provides crewing and other services related to the vessel’s operation, the cost of which is included in the daily rate, and the customer is responsible for substantially all of the vessel voyage costs. When the vessel is “off-hire” — or not available for service — the customer generally is not required to pay the hire rate and the owner is responsible for all costs. The customer selects a time charter if it wants a dedicated vessel. The customer is commercially responsible for the utilization of the vessel.
      Bareboat Charters. Similar to a time charter, a bareboat charter is a contract for the use of a vessel for a fixed period of time at a specified daily rate. However, under a bareboat charter, the customer provides crewing and other services related to the vessel’s operation in addition to the all of the vessel voyage costs. During a bareboat charter, a customer must pay the charter rate regardless of whether or not the vessel is in service. A customer may select a bareboat charter if it wants a dedicated vessel to be, and is commercially responsible for, the utilization of the vessel.
Floating Storage and Offtake Units
Overview
      FSO units provide on-site storage for oil field installations that have no storage facilities or that require supplemental storage. An FSO unit is generally used in combination with a jacked-up fixed

116


 

production system, floating production systems that do not have sufficient storage facilities or as supplemental storage for fixed platform systems, which generally have some on-board storage capacity.
      An FSO unit is usually of similar design to a conventional tanker, but has specialized loading and offtake systems required by field operators or regulators. FSO units are moored to the seabed at a safe distance from a field installation and receive the cargo from the production facility via a dedicated loading system. An FSO unit is also equipped with an export system that transfers cargo to shuttle or conventional tankers. Depending on the selected mooring arrangement and where they are located, FSO units may or may not have any propulsion systems.
      FSO units are usually conversions of older single-hull conventional oil tankers. These conversions, which include a loading and offtake system and hull refurbishment, can generally extend the lifespan of a vessel by up to 20 years over the normal conventional tanker lifespan of 25 years.
Markets
      As of July 2006, IMA estimated that there are 86 FSO units operating and six FSO units on order (conventional tankers to be converted to FSO units). Over the next five years, IMA anticipates orders for between 25 and 35 additional FSO conversions. The major markets for FSO units are Asia, the Middle East, West Africa and the North Sea. The following table shows the number of FSO units, including units on order, by geographic area.
World FSO Fleet
                         
    Operating   On Order   Total
             
Asia
    30       4       34  
Middle East
    18       0       18  
Western Africa
    14       0       14  
North Sea
    8       1       9  
Mediterranean
    5       0       5  
Australia
    4       0       4  
Gulf of Mexico/ Caribbean
    4       0       4  
Brazil
    3       1       4  
                   
Total
    86       6       92  
                   
 
Source: IMA, July 2006.
Competition
      OPCO’s primary competitors in the FSO market are conventional tanker owners, who have access to tankers available for conversion, and oil field services companies and oil field engineering and construction companies who compete in the floating production system market. Competition in the FSO market is primarily based on price, expertise in FSO operations, management of FSO conversions and relationships with shipyards, as well as the ability to access vessels for conversion that meet customer specifications. OPCO’s expertise in the offshore sector and ability to source potential vessels for FSO conversions, through Teekay Shipping Corporation’s large fleet and knowledge of the second-hand market, provides a competitive advantage.
Contract Structure
      FSO units are generally placed on long-term, fixed-rate time charters or bareboat charters as an integrated part of the field development plan, and thus provide stable cash flow to the FSO unit owners.

117


 

Floating Production Storage and Offloading Units
Overview
      An FPSO unit is an offshore production facility that is typically ship-shaped and stores processed crude oil in tanks located in the hull of the vessel. An FPSO unit carries on-board all the necessary production and processing facilities normally associated with a fixed production platform. As the name suggests, FPSOs are not fixed permanently to the seabed but are designed to be moored at one location for long periods of time. The crude oil is periodically offloaded from the FPSO unit to shuttle tankers for transport to shore.
      FPSO units are typically used as production facilities to develop marginal oil fields or deepwater areas remote from the existing pipeline infrastructure. Water depth, ocean currents and harsh weather conditions also influence the decision on which type of production installation to use. A fixed installation may not be technically feasible in a particularly challenging location where a floating unit would offer the best solution. FPSO units are also a cost-effective solution for developing smaller, satellite or marginal fields in shallower water, as they can be relocated and used elsewhere when reservoirs are depleted.
      Of the four major types of floating production systems (FPSO units, semi-submersible units, tension leg platforms and SPAR buoys), FPSO units are the most common type. According to IMA, as of March 2006, FPSO units represented 61% of the floating production units in operation and 70% of the floating production units on order. FPSO units have the advantage of providing field storage, which enables them to be utilized independent of pipeline infrastructure. Typically, the other types of floating production systems do not have significant storage and need to be connected into a pipeline system or use an FSO unit for storage. FPSO units are also less weight-sensitive than other types of floating production systems and their extensive deck area provides flexibility in process plant layouts. In addition, the ability to utilize surplus or aging tanker hulls for conversion to an FPSO unit provides a relatively inexpensive solution compared to the new construction of other floating production systems.
      In a typical FPSO unit installation, the untreated wellstream is brought to the surface via subsea equipment on the sea floor that is connected to the FPSO unit by flexible flow lines called risers. The risers carry oil, gas and water from the ocean floor to the vessel, which processes it onboard. The resulting crude oil is stored in the hull of the vessel and subsequently transferred to tankers either via a buoy or tandem loading system. The FPSO unit has a sophisticated mooring system that enables it to operate safely and reliably. Where weather conditions can be extreme, most vessels have a central mooring arrangement located within the hull in a turret that allows them to weathervane in response to shifting weather direction. In areas with more benign weather, such an arrangement may not be required and the vessel may be kept on station by an array of mooring lines and anchors, known as a spread-moored system. The FPSO unit’s hull must be designed for at least the expected life of the field, but will typically be designed to allow the vessel to be redeployed to new fields, and is constructed to standards that will permit it to remain at sea during this time without access to drydocking facilities.

118


 

Markets
      FPSO units have been used to develop offshore fields around the world since the late 1970s. As of July 2006, IMA estimated there were 111 FPSO units operating and 36 FPSO units on order. Over the next five years, IMA anticipates demand for 78 to 95 additional FPSO units. Of this amount, 51 to 62 are expected to be newbuilds or converted from existing hulls and 27 to 33 are expected to be redeployments of existing units. The primary areas for FPSO units are Western Africa, Asia, Brazil, North Sea and Australia. Other types of floating production systems are primarily used in the Gulf of Mexico region, as the abundant pipeline infrastructure negates the benefits of on-board storage. The following table shows the number of FPSO units, including those on order, by geographic area.
World FPSO Fleet
                         
    Operating   On Order   Total
             
Western Africa
    27       7       34  
Asia
    28       4       32  
North Sea
    19       4       23  
Brazil
    15       8       23  
Australia
    10       5       15  
Mediterranean
    5       0       5  
Gulf of Mexico/ Caribbean
    2       1       3  
Eastern Canada
    2       0       2  
Middle East
    1       0       1  
No contract
    2       7       9  
                   
Total
    111       36       147  
                   
 
Source: IMA, July 2006.
     Due to differences in water depth, environmental conditions and field and customer requirements, the specification and costs of an FPSO unit vary significantly. The cost of a new FPSO unit can range from $100 million to over $1 billion. However, most medium-sized FPSO units cost between $250 million and $600 million. Traditionally, for large field developments, the major oil companies have owned and operated new, custom built FPSO units. FPSO units for smaller fields have generally been provided by independent FPSO contractors under life-of -field production contracts.
      We believe that there is a growing trend by oil field operators towards using independent FPSO contractors because:
  •  the major oil companies have begun to outsource operations that are outside their core business and expertise; and
 
  •  there are an increasing number of smaller oil companies operating offshore oil field installations.
      According to IMA, as of July 2006, approximately 49% of the current FPSO units operating were owned by independent FPSO contractors. However, approximately 58% of the FPSO units installed since 2001 and approximately 67% of units on order as of July 2006 are owned by independent FPSO contractors.
Competition
      In June 2006, Teekay Shipping Corporation entered into an agreement with Petrojarl ASA, a leading independent operator in the FPSO sector, to form a joint venture company called Teekay Petrojarl Offshore through which the joint venture partners agreed to exclusively pursue opportunities involving FPSO and FSO units. The joint venture will only encompass new projects and existing assets of both companies are excluded from the joint venture. The joint venture does not currently own any FPSO or

119


 

FSO units. Pursuant to an omnibus agreement we will enter into upon the closing of this offering, Teekay Shipping Corporation will offer to us its interest in certain FPSO and FSO projects under the joint venture agreement. On October 18, 2006, Teekay Shipping Corporation completed a tender offer for the outstanding shares of Petrojarl ASA, resulting in Teekay Shipping Corporation owning a majority of, and having the ability to control, Petrojarl ASA.
      Most independent FPSO contractors have backgrounds in marine energy transportation, oil field services and/or oil field engineering and construction. In addition to Petrojarl ASA, the major independent FPSO contractors are SBM Offshore, Prosafe, Bluewater, BW Offshore, Modec, Fred Olsen, Aker and Maersk.
Contract Structure
      Although the terms of FPSO contracts vary, they are generally long-term (5 to 15 years plus extension options) and provide a fixed rate that is a function of the cost of the FPSO unit, a rate based on the production output from the FPSO unit or both.
Conventional Oil Tankers
Overview
      Conventional oil tankers are used primarily for transcontinental seaborne transportation of oil. Conventional oil tankers are operated by both major oil companies (including state-owned companies) that generally operate captive fleets, and independent operators that charter out their vessels for voyage or time charter use. Most conventional oil tankers controlled by independent fleet operators are hired for one or a few voyages at a time at fluctuating market rates based on the existing tanker supply and demand. These charter rates are extremely sensitive to this balance of supply and demand, and small changes in tanker utilization have historically led to relatively large changes in short-term rates. Long-term, fixed-rate charters for crude oil transportation, such as those applicable to OPCO’s conventional tanker fleet, are less typical in the industry. As used in this discussion, “conventional” oil tankers exclude those vessels that can carry dry bulk and ore, tankers that currently are used for storage purposes and shuttle tankers.
Oil Tanker Demand
      Oil tanker demand is a function of several factors, including the location of oil production, refining and consumption and world oil demand and supply. Tanker demand is based on the amount of crude oil transported in tankers and the distance over which the oil is transported.
      Transportation Distance. The distance over which oil is transported is determined by seaborne trading and distribution patterns, which are principally influenced by the relative advantages of the various sources of production and locations of consumption. Seaborne trading patterns are also periodically influenced by geopolitical events, such as wars, hostilities and trade embargoes that divert tankers from normal trading patterns, as well as by inter-regional oil trading activity created by oil supply and demand imbalances. Traditionally, the level of exports from the Middle East has had a strong effect on the tanker market as a whole due to the relatively long distance between this supply source and typical discharge points.

120


 

      Oil Demand. The overall increase in world oil demand since 2000 has positively affected the market for seaborne oil transportation. Demand for oil is driven by the level of economic activity and industrial production. The following table indicates the geographic breakdown of world oil demand during the past six years and estimated demand for 2006 and 2007:
World Oil Demand
                                                                 
    2000   2001   2002   2003   2004   2005   2006E   2007E
                                 
    (millions of barrels per day)
OECD* North America Demand
    24.1       24.0       24.1       24.5       25.4       25.5       25.4       25.8  
OECD Europe Demand
    15.2       15.3       15.3       15.4       15.5       15.5       15.5       15.5  
OECD Pacific Demand
    8.6       8.5       8.5       8.6       8.5       8.6       8.5       8.5  
                                                 
Total OECD Demand
    47.9       47.9       47.9       48.6       49.3       49.6       49.4       49.7  
Total NON-OECD Demand
    28.6       29.2       29.9       30.7       33.1       34.0       35.1       36.2  
                                                 
Total Demand
    76.5       77.1       77.8       79.3       82.4       83.6       84.5       85.9  
                                                 
 
Source: IEA, October 2006.
OECD indicates countries that are members of the international Organization for Economic Cooperation and Development.
     Oil Supply. The world’s oil supply is concentrated in the Middle East, followed by North America and the former Soviet Union. As of January 2006, the Middle East controlled approximately 60% of the world’s proven oil reserves. For June 2006, the Middle East accounted for approximately 32% of global oil production. The size of its reserves suggests that the Middle East may supply the largest percentage of any growth in world oil consumption. In addition, the IEA estimates growth will occur in non-OPEC oil production for 2006 and 2007 from the former Soviet Union, North Africa and Latin America. These locations are generally well-suited for Aframax tanker transportation, which could favorably affect demand for Aframax tankers.
Oil Tanker Supply
      The supply of oil tankers is a function of new vessel deliveries, vessel scrapping and the conversion or loss of tonnage.
      The level of newbuilding orders is a function primarily of newbuilding prices in relation to current and prospective charter market conditions. Available shipyard capacity for newbuildings is another factor that affects tanker supply. Rising steel and equipment costs, competition for newbuilding berths from shipping sectors other than oil transportation, and a weakening U.S. Dollar led to an increase in newbuilding contract prices during 2004 to 2006. Most major shipyards have sold their newbuilding berths through 2009.
      At any point in time, the level of scrapping activity is a function primarily of scrapping prices in relation to current and prospective charter market conditions and operating, repair and survey costs. Industry regulations also affect scrapping levels. For example, the United Nation’s International Maritime Organization (or IMO ) amended regulations in 2003 to accelerate the phase-out of certain pre-1982 single-hull vessels to 2005 from 2007. IMO regulations are expected to cause approximately 30% of the existing world tanker fleet to be phased out by 2015. In addition to IMO regulation, the United States Oil Pollution Act of 1990 requires that all oil tankers entering U.S. waterways be exclusively double-hulled by 2015.
      Aging vessels typically require substantial repairs and maintenance to conform to industry standards, including repairs made in connection with special surveys, which involve periodic, thorough inspections. These surveys are part of a certification process of classification societies, and a vessel must be certified as “in-class” to continue to trade. Insurance companies and customers rely to some degree on the survey and classification regime to provide reasonable assurance of a vessel’s seaworthiness. Because the cost of maintaining a vessel in-class rises substantially as the age of the vessel increases, vessel owners often conclude that it is more economical to scrap an older vessel than to upgrade it to maintain its in-class certification. In addition, the economics of operating older vessels are adversely affected by customer

121


 

demand for the safety and reliability associated with more modern vessels, coupled with the higher charter rates and operating cost efficiencies that are typically available to newer vessels.
Types of Conventional Oil Tankers
      The world conventional oil tanker fleet is generally divided into the following types of tankers based on deadweight tonnes ( dwt ):
  •  Ultra Large Crude Carriers of 320,000 dwt or more;
 
  •  Very Large Crude Carriers of 200,000 to 320,000 dwt;
 
  •  Suezmax tankers of 120,000 to 200,000 dwt;
 
  •  Aframax tankers of 80,000 to 120,000 dwt; and
 
  •  Smaller tankers (such as Panamax and Handysize) of less than 80,000 dwt.
      To benefit from economies of scale, tanker charterers transporting crude oil typically charter the largest tanker available in the market that is appropriate for the intended journey. Factors that charterers consider include the charterers’ preference to use larger tankers for longer-haul trades and smaller tankers for medium to short-haul trades, port and canal size restrictions and cargo sizes.
      Common routes for Aframaxes are Northwest Europe to the United Kingdom and other parts of Europe, cross-Mediterranean, Caribbean to the U.S. Gulf, and Indo Pacific to Japan.
Aframax-class Tankers
      Expected Lifespan. New Aframax tankers are generally expected to have a lifespan of approximately 25 to 30 years, based on estimated hull fatigue life. However, U.S. and international regulations require the earlier phase-out of existing vessels that are not double-hulled, regardless of their expected lifespan. Approximately 78% of the current world conventional Aframax fleet is double-hulled.
      Aframax Fleet. As of November 2006, the world Aframax tanker fleet consisted of 729 vessels, of which 544 crude tankers and 139 coated tankers are termed as conventional tankers. As of November 2006, there were 211 conventional Aframax newbuildings on order for delivery through 2010. Delivery of a vessel typically occurs within three years after ordering.

122


 

Competition
      The world Aframax fleet primarily consists of captive fleets of major oil companies, including state-owned companies, and independent tanker fleets. Independent owners control the majority of the conventional Aframax fleet, with four major oil companies owning Aframax vessels. The following table shows the largest operators of conventional Aframax tankers as of November 2006, ranked by number of ships. These six Aframax operators control approximately 28% of the existing conventional Aframax fleet.
Major Aframax Conventional Tanker Operators(1)
(BAR CHART)                
 
Source: CRS, November 2006.
(1)  Conventional oil tankers exclude those vessels that can carry dry bulk and ore, tankers that currently are used for storage purposes, and shuttle tankers that are designed to transport oil from offshore production platforms to onshore storage and refinery facilities.
 
(2)  Data for Teekay Shipping Corporation includes OPCO’s Aframax tankers.
 
(3)  Aframax International operates a pool of tankers managed by OSG Corporation.
     Competition in the Aframax tanker market is affected by the availability and suitability of other size vessels that compete in the Aframax tanker market. Suezmax-size vessels and Panamax-size vessels can compete for some of the same charters for which Aframax tankers compete. Competition in this market is primarily based on: price; location (for single-voyage or short-term charters); the size, age, condition and acceptability of the vessel; oil tanker shipping experience and quality of ship operations; and the size of an operating fleet, with larger fleets allowing for greater vessel substitution, availability and customer service.
      Aframax tankers are particularly well-suited for short-haul and medium-haul crude oil routes.
      Because all of the vessels in OPCO’s conventional Aframax fleet are subject to long-term, fixed-rate charters, we do not expect to compete for deployment of the Aframax vessels until the first charter is scheduled to end in December 2011. The shuttle tankers in OPCO’s contract of affreightment fleet may operate in the conventional spot market during downtime/maintenance periods for oil field installations, which provides greater capacity utilization for the fleet.
Contract Structure
      Aframax voyages are predominantly conducted on short-term contracts or spot pricing. Spot charters involve the chartering of a specific vessel for one or a few voyages. Long-term charters of more than five years are not as common as short-term charters. OPCO’s fleet of conventional oil tankers has charters with remaining terms of 5 to 12 years.

123


 

BUSINESS
Overview
      We are an international provider of marine transportation and storage services to the offshore oil industry. We were formed by Teekay Shipping Corporation (NYSE:TK), a leading provider of marine services to the global oil and natural gas industries, to further develop Teekay Shipping Corporation’s operations in the offshore market. The Teekay organization was founded in 1973. Teekay Shipping Corporation now controls a fleet of over 150 vessels, including owned, chartered-in and newbuilding vessels, and provides comprehensive marine transportation services to major energy customers.
      Upon the closing of this offering, Teekay Shipping Corporation will contribute to us an aggregate 26.0% interest in OPCO, including a 25.99% limited partner interest and a 0.01% general partner interest. OPCO owns Teekay Shipping Corporation’s shuttle tanker and floating storage and offtake (or FSO ) operations, as well as a fleet of double-hull conventional oil tankers. We control OPCO through our ownership of its general partner. Teekay Shipping Corporation owns the remaining 74.0% limited partner interest in OPCO.
      OPCO’s fleet currently consists of:
  •  Shuttle Tankers. OPCO is the world’s largest owner and operator of shuttle tankers, with a fleet consisting of 36 vessels, 24 of which are owned fully or jointly and 12 of which are chartered-in. All of the shuttle tankers operate under contracts of affreightment for various offshore oil fields or under fixed-rate time charter or bareboat charter contracts for specific oil field installations. The majority of the contract of affreightment volumes are life-of -field, which, according to data provided by Wood MacKenzie Ltd. (or WoodMac ), have a weighted-average remaining life of 16 years. The time charter and bareboat charters have an average remaining contract term of approximately 6 years.
 
  •  FSO Units. OPCO has a fleet of four FSO units. All of the FSO units operate under fixed-rate contracts, with an average remaining term of approximately 5 years.
 
  •  Conventional Tankers. OPCO has a fleet of nine Aframax-class conventional crude oil tankers. The conventional tankers all have fixed-rate time charters with Teekay Shipping Corporation, with an average remaining term of approximately 8 years.
      In addition, Teekay Shipping Corporation has entered into an agreement with Petrojarl ASA, an independent operator in the FPSO sector, to form a joint venture company called Teekay Petrojarl Offshore through which the joint venture partners have agreed to exclusively pursue new opportunities involving FPSO and FSO units. Petrojarl ASA is one of the largest independent FPSO operators and deployed the first FPSO in the North Sea in 1986. Pursuant to an omnibus agreement we will enter into upon the closing of this offering, Teekay Shipping Corporation will offer to us its interest in certain future FPSO and FSO projects under the joint venture agreement. On October 18, 2006, Teekay Shipping Corporation completed a tender offer for the outstanding shares of Petrojarl ASA, resulting in Teekay Shipping Corporation owning a majority of, and having the ability to control, Petrojarl ASA.
      We will have the opportunity to directly acquire three vessels from Teekay Shipping Corporation by the end of the second quarter of 2008. Pursuant to the omnibus agreement, Teekay Shipping Corporation will also be obligated to offer to us two shuttle tankers, each currently undergoing conversion from conventional oil tankers, and one FSO unit currently being upgraded. The two shuttle tankers will operate under 13-year bareboat charters with Petrobras and the FSO unit will operate under a 7-year time charter with a consortium of oil companies. If we elect to acquire any of these vessels, the purchase price will be the vessel’s fair market value as agreed by Teekay Shipping Corporation and the conflicts committee of our general partner’s board of directors, plus the cost of converting or upgrading the vessel prior to delivery. Teekay Shipping Corporation will be obligated to offer to us under the omnibus agreement certain other shuttle tankers, FPSO and FSO units it may acquire in the future. Please read “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions — Omnibus Agreement.”

124


 

      We expect to benefit from Teekay Shipping Corporation’s expertise, relationships and reputation to pursue significant growth opportunities in the offshore sector. This growth may come from the acquisition of additional vessels directly through wholly owned subsidiaries of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P., the purchase of additional limited partner interests in OPCO that Teekay Shipping Corporation may offer to us in the future, or both. We believe that conducting our operations through a publicly traded limited partnership will provide us access to the public equity and debt capital markets, an attractive cost of capital for expansion and acquisitions and an enhanced ability to use our equity securities as consideration in future acquisitions.
      On August 31, 2006, we were formed as a wholly owned subsidiary of Teekay Shipping Corporation. Upon the closing of this offering, Teekay Shipping Corporation will own a 63.0% limited partner interest in us and own and control our general partner.
Business Opportunities
      We believe the following industry dynamics create a favorable environment to expand our business:
  •  Growing offshore oil production. According to Douglas-Westwood, offshore oil production is forecast to grow from approximately 33% of global oil production in 2005 to approximately 37% by 2015. Douglas-Westwood also forecasts that deepwater oil production will increase from approximately 3 million barrels per day in 2005 to over 8 million in 2015, and that approximately 25% of offshore oil will come from deep waters in 2015 compared to just 12% in 2005, and after 2010 all global offshore oil production growth will be from deep waters. We believe demand for shuttle tankers and FPSO units will increase from this forecasted growth in deepwater offshore oil production because production from deep waters and remote areas may be expensive or technically demanding to transport via pipeline. In addition, oil production from deep waters may be costly or not technically feasible for fixed production platforms, which creates opportunities for the deployment of floating production units.
 
  •  Increased outsourcing of offshore services. We believe there is a growing trend among oil field operators to outsource to independent contractors offshore transportation, processing and storage functions. For instance, Teekay Shipping Corporation was chosen by Statoil ASA, Norway’s largest energy company, to purchase its shuttle tanker operation in 2003. In addition, according to International Maritime Associates, approximately 58% of the FPSO units installed since 2001 and approximately 67% of the FPSO units on order as of July 2006 are owned by independent FPSO contractors. We also believe there is a growing number of smaller oil companies entering the offshore sector, as oil demand and prices drive future exploration and production. Smaller oil companies generally outsource their offshore service requirements due to capital expenditure constraints and lack of in-house expertise. These smaller companies are primarily focused on marginal or remote projects that favor the employment of shuttle tankers, FSO units and FPSO units.
 
  •  Customer demand for dependable and integrated solutions. Many new and existing offshore projects, particularly those located in deep waters or remote locations, require a combination of the types of offshore services OPCO provides. Moreover, the major oil companies are highly selective in their choice of contractors due to the high level of capital investment and the requirement for uninterrupted production from the oil fields. We believe we can bundle services and offer a reliable, integrated “one-stop-shop” solution for customers in the offshore sector.
Competitive Strengths
      We believe that we are well positioned to execute our business strategies successfully because of the following competitive strengths:
  •  Leading position in the shuttle tanker sector. OPCO is the world’s largest owner and operator of shuttle tankers, as it owned or operated 36 of the 58 vessels in the world shuttle tanker fleet as at November 1, 2006. OPCO’s large fleet size ensures that it can provide comprehensive coverage of

125


 

  charterers’ requirements and provides opportunities to enhance the efficiency of operations and increase fleet utilization.
 
  •  Offshore operational expertise and enhanced growth opportunities through our relationship with Teekay Shipping Corporation. Teekay Shipping Corporation has achieved a global brand name in the shipping industry and the offshore market, developed an extensive network of long-standing relationships with major energy companies and earned a reputation for reliability, safety and excellence. Some benefits we expect to receive due to our relationship with Teekay Shipping Corporation include:

  •  access through services agreements to its comprehensive market intelligence and operational and technical sophistication gained from over 25 years of providing shuttle tanker services and FSO services to offshore energy customers. We believe this expertise will also assist us in successfully expanding into the FPSO sector through Teekay Shipping Corporation’s control of and joint venture with Petrojarl ASA and our rights to participate in certain FPSO projects under the omnibus agreement;
 
  •  access to Teekay Shipping Corporation’s general commercial and financial core competencies, practices and systems, which we believe will enhance the efficiency and quality of operations;
 
  •  enhanced growth opportunities and added competitiveness in bidding for transportation requirements for offshore projects and in attracting and retaining long-term contracts throughout the world; and
 
  •  improved leverage with leading shipyards during periods of vessel production constraints, which are anticipated over the next few years, due to Teekay Shipping Corporation’s established relationships with these shipyards and the high number of newbuilding orders it places.
  •  Cash flow stability from contracts with leading energy companies. We benefit from stability in cash flows due to the long-term, fixed-rate contracts underlying most of OPCO’s business. OPCO is able to secure long-term contracts because its services are an integrated part of offshore oil field projects and a critical part of the logistics chain of the fields. Due to the integrated nature of OPCO’s services, the high cost of field development and the need for uninterrupted oil production, contractual relationships with customers with respect to any given field typically last until the field is no longer producing.
 
  •  Disciplined vessel acquisition strategy and successful project execution. OPCO’s fleet has been built through successful new project tenders and acquisitions, and this strategy has contributed significantly to its leading position in the shuttle tanker market. A significant portion of OPCO’s shuttle tanker fleet was established through the acquisition of Ugland Nordic Shipping AS in 2001 and Navion AS, Statoil ASA’s shipping subsidiary, in 2003. In addition, OPCO has increased the size of its fleet through customized shuttle tanker and FSO projects for major energy companies around the world.
 
  •  Financial flexibility to pursue acquisitions and other expansion opportunities. We believe our financial flexibility will provide us with acquisition and expansion opportunities. In October 2006 OPCO amended an existing revolving credit facility and entered into another that provides it access to a total of approximately $1.6 billion for working capital and acquisition purposes, approximately $300 million of which we anticipate will be undrawn immediately after the closing of this offering.
Business Strategies
      Our primary business objective is to increase distributions per unit by executing the following strategies:
  •  Expand global operations in high growth regions. As offshore exploration and production activity continues to accelerate worldwide, we will seek to continue to expand shuttle tanker and FSO unit operations into growing offshore markets such as Brazil and Australia. In addition, we intend to

126


 

  pursue opportunities in new markets such as Arctic Russia, Eastern Canada, the Gulf of Mexico, Asia and Africa.
 
  •  Pursue opportunities in the FPSO sector. We believe that Teekay Shipping Corporation’s control of and joint venture with Petrojarl ASA will enable us to competitively pursue FPSO projects anywhere in the world by combining Petrojarl’s engineering and operational expertise with Teekay Shipping Corporation’s global marketing organization and extensive customer and shipyard relationships.
 
  •  Acquire additional vessels on long-term fixed-rate contracts. We intend to continue acquiring shuttle tankers and FSO units with long-term contracts, rather than ordering vessels on a speculative basis, and we intend to follow this same practice in acquiring FPSO units. We believe this approach facilitates the financing of new vessels based on their anticipated future revenues and ensures that new vessels will be employed upon acquisition, which should stabilize cash flows. Additionally, we anticipate growing by acquiring additional limited partner interests in OPCO that Teekay Shipping Corporation may offer us in the future.
 
  •  Provide superior customer service by maintaining high reliability, safety, environmental and quality standards. Energy companies seek transportation partners that have a reputation for high reliability, safety, environmental and quality standards. We intend to leverage OPCO’s and Teekay Shipping Corporation’s operational expertise and customer relationships to further expand a sustainable competitive advantage with consistent delivery of superior customer service by:

  •  responsiveness, reliability, professionalism and integrity;
 
  •  adoption of responsible environmental practices and strict adherence to environmental regulations;
 
  •  dedication to safe operations; and
 
  •  use of customer feedback and industry and internal performance measures to drive continuous improvements.
  •  Manage the conventional tanker fleet to provide stable cash flows. The terms for OPCO’s existing long-term conventional tanker charters are 5 to 12 years. We believe the fixed-rate time charters for these tankers will provide stable cash flows during their terms and a source of funding for expanding offshore operations. Depending on prevailing market conditions during and at the end of each existing charter, we may seek to extend the charter, enter into a new charter, operate the vessel on the spot market or sell the vessel, in order to maximize returns on the conventional fleet while managing residual risk.
Fleet
      OPCO’s fleet consists of 36 shuttle tankers, four FSO units and nine conventional crude oil tankers, as described below.
Shuttle Tankers
      OPCO owns and operates the world’s largest fleet of shuttle tankers. All the shuttle tankers in the fleet are double-hulled tankers equipped with DP systems. The fleet consists of 24 shuttle tankers that are owned fully or jointly and 12 shuttle tankers that are chartered-in. All of the shuttle tankers are subject to fixed-rate time charter or bareboat contracts for specific offshore oil fields or under fixed-rate contracts of affreightment for various fields, with payments under the contracts of affreightment based on the volume of oil transported. The majority of the contract of affreightment volumes are life-of -field, which, according to data provided by WoodMac, have a weighted-average remaining life of 16 years. The time charter and bareboat charters have an average remaining contract term of approximately 6 years. The fleet of owned shuttle tankers is of Norwegian and Bahamian registry, while the chartered-in fleet is of Norwegian, Bahamian and Isle of Man registry.

127


 

      The following tables provide additional information about our shuttle tankers as of November 1, 2006:
                                                                 
    Capacity           Positioning   Operating   Contract       Remaining
Vessel   (dwt)   Built   Ownership   System   Region   Type (1)   Charterer   Term
                                 
Navion Hispania
    126,700       1999       100%       DP2       North Sea       CoA                  
Navion Oceania
    126,300       1999       100%       DP2       North Sea       CoA                  
Navion Anglia
    126,300       1999       100%       DP2       North Sea       CoA                  
Navion Scandia
    126,700       1998       100%       DP2       North Sea       CoA                  
Navion Britannia(2)
    124,200       1998       100%       DP2       North Sea       CoA                  
Navion Norvegia(2)
    130,600       1995       100%       DP       North Sea       CoA       Statoil          
Navion Europa(2)
    130,300       1995       100%       DP       North Sea       CoA       Chevron          
Navion Clipper
    78,200       1993       100%       DP       North Sea       CoA       Marathon Oil          
Navion Fennia(2)
    95,200       1992       100%       DP       North Sea       CoA       Hess          
                      Chartered-in                               ExxonMobil          
Grena
    148,000       2003       (until 2013)(3)       DP2       North Sea       CoA       Norsk Hydro          
                      Chartered-in                               Eni       Majority  
Bertora
    100,300       2001       (until 2011)(3)       DP2       North Sea       CoA       Mongstad  Terminal       of  
                      Chartered-in                               Draugen Transport       volumes  
Sallie Knutsen
    153,600       1999       (until 2015)       DP2       North Sea       CoA       BP       are  
                      Chartered-in                               ConocoPhillips       life-of-  
Karen Knutsen
    153,600       1999       (until 2013)       DP2       North Sea       CoA       Shell       field  
                      Chartered-in                               Total Talisman          
Elisabeth Knutsen
    124,700       1997       (until 2007)       DP2       North Sea       CoA       DONG          
                      Chartered-in                               Danoil          
Gerd Knutsen
    146,200       1996       (until 2008)       DP       North Sea       CoA       Denerco          
                      Chartered-in                               Idemitsu          
Aberdeen
    87,000       1996       (until 2009)       DP       North Sea       CoA       RWE Dea          
                      Chartered-in                               Lundin          
Randgrid(2)
    124,500       1995       (until 2014)(4)       DP       North Sea       CoA       DNO(6)          
                      Chartered-in                                          
Tordis Knutsen
    123,800       1993       (until 2007)       DP       North Sea       CoA                  
                      Chartered-in                                          
Vigdis Knutsen
    123,400       1993       (until 2008)       DP       North Sea       CoA                  
                      Lease                                          
Navion Akarita
    107,200       1991       (until 2012)(5)       DP       North Sea       CoA                  
                      Chartered-in                                          
Tove Knutsen(2)
    106,300       1989       (until 2007)       DP2       North Sea       CoA                  
Stena Sirita
    127,400       1999          50%(7)       DP2       North Sea       Time charter       ExxonMobil(8)       3 years  
Nordic Marita
    103,900       1999       100%       DP       Brazil       Time charter       Petrobras(8)       3 years  
Stena Natalita
    108,000       2001          50%(7)       DP2       North Sea       Time charter       ExxonMobil(8)       2 years  
Stena Alexita
    127,400       1998          50%(7)       DP2       North Sea       Time charter       ExxonMobil(8)       2 years  
Navion Svenita
    106,500       1997       100%       DP       Brazil       Time charter       Petrobras(8)       2 years  
Nordic Savonita
    108,100       1992       100%       DP       Brazil       Time charter       Petrobras(8)       2 years  
Nordic Torinita
    106,800       1992       100%       DP2       North Sea       Time charter       Knutsen(8)       2 years  
Basker Spirit
    97,000       1992       100%       DP       Australia       Time charter       Anzon(8)       2 years  
Navion Stavanger
    147,500       2003       100%       DP2       Brazil       Bareboat       Petrobras(9)       13 years  
Nordic Spirit
    151,300       2001       100%       DP       Brazil       Bareboat       Petrobras(9)       12 years  
Stena Spirit
    151,300       2001          50%(7)       DP       Brazil       Bareboat       Petrobras(9)       12 years  
Nordic Brasilia
    151,300       2004       100%       DP       Brazil       Bareboat       Petrobras(9)       11 years  
Nordic Rio
    151,300       2004          50%(7)       DP       Brazil       Bareboat       Petrobras(9)       11 years  
Petroatlantic
    92,900       2003       100%       DP2       North Sea       Bareboat       Petrojarl(9)       3 years  
Petronordic
    92,900       2002       100%       DP2       North Sea       Bareboat       Petrojarl(9)       3 years  
                                                 
Total capacity
    4,386,700                                                          
 
(1)  “CoA” refers to contracts of affreightment.
 
(2)  The vessel is capable of loading from an STL buoy.
 
(3)  OPCO has options to extend the time charter or purchase the vessel.
 
(4)  The time charter period is linked to the term of the transportation service agreement for the Heidrun field on the Norwegian continental shelf, which term is in turn linked to the production level at the field.
 
(5)  OPCO has options to extend the bareboat lease.
 
(6)  Not all of the contracts of affreightment customers utilize every ship in the contract of affreightment fleet.

128


 

(7)  Owned through a 50% joint venture with Stena. The parties share in the profits and losses of the joint venture in proportion to each party’s relative capital contributions. Teekay Shipping Corporation subsidiaries provide operational services for these vessels.
 
(8)  Charterer has an option to extend the time charter or bareboat charter.
 
(9)  Charterer has the right to purchase the vessel at end of the bareboat charter.
     On the Norwegian continental shelf, regulations have been imposed on the operators of offshore fields related to vaporized crude oil that is formed and emitted during loading operations and which is commonly referred to as “VOC.” To assist the oil companies in their efforts to meet the regulations on VOC emissions from shuttle tankers, OPCO and Teekay Shipping Corporation have played an active role in establishing a unique co-operation (the VOC Industry Co-operation) among all the owners of offshore fields (approximately 26 oil companies) in the Norwegian sector. The purpose of the co-operation is to implement VOC recovery systems on selected shuttle tankers and to ensure a high degree of VOC recovery at a minimum cost followed by joint reporting to the authorities. Currently, there are 13 VOC plants installed aboard shuttle tankers operated or owned by OPCO. The oil companies have engaged OPCO to undertake the day-to -day administration, technical follow-up and handling of payments through a dedicated clearing house function.
FSO Units
      OPCO has a fleet of four FSO units. All of the FSO units operate under fixed-rate time charters or bareboat charters. The average remaining contract term is approximately 5 years. Two of the FSO units are single-hulled and two are double-hulled. The FSO units are located in the North Sea, Australia and Thailand. The FSO units are of Bahamian, Australian and Liberian registry.
      The following table provides additional information about the FSO units as of November 1, 2006.
                                                         
    Capacity           Field Name and           Remaining
Vessel   (dwt)   Built   Ownership   Location   Contract Type   Charterer   Term
                             
Pattani Spirit
    113,800       1988       100 %     Platong, Thailand       Bareboat       Unocal       8 years  
Apollo Spirit
    126,900       1978       89 %     Banff, UK       Time charter       Petrojarl       8  years(1)  
Navion Saga(2)
    149,000       1991       100 %     Volve, Norway       Time charter       Statoil       3  years(3)  
Karratha Spirit
    106,600       1988       100 %     Legendre, Australia       Time charter       Woodside       1 year(3)  
                                           
Total capacity
    496,300                                                  
                                           
 
(1)  Charterer is required to charter the vessel for as long as a specified FPSO unit, the Ramform Banff , produces the Banff field, which could extend to 2014 depending on the field operator.
 
(2)  This vessel will be in drydock for FSO conversion and will trade in the spot conventional market before the FSO time charter begins, which is scheduled for the second quarter of 2007.
 
(3)  Charterer has option to extend the time charter after the initial fixed period.
Conventional Tankers
      OPCO has a fleet of nine conventional Aframax-class oil tankers that have fixed-rate time charter contracts with Teekay Shipping Corporation with terms of approximately 5 to 12 years. The average term is approximately 8 years. All of these tankers have double hulls. Eight are of the Bahamian registry and one, the Scotia Spirit , is of Norwegian registry. In addition, the shuttle tankers in the contract of affreightment fleet may operate as Aframax-class and Suezmax-class tankers in the conventional spot market during downtime/maintenance periods for oil field installations, which provides greater capacity utilization for the fleet. The conventional Aframax-class tankers cannot operate as shuttle tankers.

129


 

      The following table provides additional information about the conventional tankers as of November 1, 2006.
                                                 
    Capacity                   Remaining
Vessel   (dwt)   Built   Ownership   Contract Type   Charterer   Term(1)
                         
Kilimanjaro Spirit
    115,000       2004       100%       Time charter       Teekay       12 years  
Fuji Spirit
    106,300       2003       100%       Time charter       Teekay       12 years  
Hamane Spirit
    105,200       1997       100%       Time charter       Teekay       9 years  
Poul Spirit
    105,300       1995       100%       Time charter       Teekay       8 years  
Gotland Spirit
    95,300       1995       100%       Time charter       Teekay       8 years  
Torben Spirit
    98,600       1994       100%       Time charter       Teekay       6 years  
Scotia Spirit(2)
    95,000       1992       100%       Time charter       Teekay       5 years  
Leyte Spirit
    98,700       1992       100%       Time charter       Teekay       5 years  
Luzon Spirit
    98,600       1992       100%       Time charter       Teekay       5 years  
                                     
Total capacity
    918,000                                          
                                     
 
(1)  Charterer has options to extend each time charter on an annual basis for a total of five years after the initial term. Charterer also has the right to purchase the vessel beginning on the third anniversary of the contract at a specified price. Please read “— Vessel Contracts” below.
 
(2)  This vessel has been equipped with FSO equipment and OPCO can end the charter upon 30-days notice if it has arranged an FSO project for the vessel.
Customers
      OPCO provides marine transportation and storage services to energy and oil service companies or their affiliates. OPCO’s most important customer measured by annual voyage revenue and excluding Teekay Shipping Corporation is Statoil ASA, which is Norway’s largest energy company and one of the world’s largest producers of crude oil. Statoil created the shuttle tanker industry beginning in the late 1970s and developed the current operating model in the North Sea. Statoil chose Teekay Shipping Corporation to purchase its shuttle tanker operation in 2003, and Teekay Shipping Corporation and OPCO continue to have a close relationship with the company. Statoil is the operator for 24 oil and gas fields on the Norwegian continental shelf and accounts for approximately 60% of all Norwegian petroleum production. Statoil operates 23 seabed facilities and is a leader in sub-sea oil production. Statoil is represented in 33 countries and is engaged in oil exploration and production in 15 of these countries.
      Teekay Shipping Corporation and Statoil ASA accounted for approximately 27% and 26% respectively, of OPCO’s combined consolidated voyage revenues for the six months ended June 30, 2006, and accounted for approximately 31% and 23%, respectively, of 2005 combined consolidated voyage revenues and approximately 40% and 19%, respectively, of 2004 combined consolidated voyage revenues. No other customer accounted for 10% or more of combined consolidated voyage revenues during any of these periods.
Vessel Contracts
      OPCO generates revenues by charging customers for the transportation and storage of their crude oil using the vessels in its fleet. OPCO provides substantially all of these services under contracts of affreightment, time charters and, to a lesser extent, bareboat charters. OPCO also charters-in vessels to its fleet under time and bareboat charters. All of these contracts are described below.
Contracts of Affreightment
      Under a contract of affreightment, the shipowner commits to be available to transport the quantity of cargo requested by the customer from time to time over a specified trade route during a given period of

130


 

time. Payments under the contracts are based on a daily rate or the volume of cargo transported. Contracts of affreightment typically specify a list of vessels, any of which is approved to provide services from time to time, and relate to production from a designated offshore oil field. As at November 1, 2006, OPCO had 34 contracts of affreightment covering approximately 36 offshore oil fields and provided services under these contracts with 21 shuttle tankers.
      Although the overall arrangement between OPCO and the customers are governed by contracts of affreightment, each voyage during the term of a contract of affreightment is governed by a standard form of single-voyage time-charter contract, the material terms of which are included in the description of time charters below. The following discussion describes material terms common to all of OPCO’s contracts of affreightment, as well as certain additional material terms that only apply to some contracts.
      Scope of Services. Under each contract of affreightment, OPCO has agreed to load crude oil at the designated offshore oil field, as and when requested by the customer, and then transport the oil to a discharge port designated by the customer that is within specified geographic areas. Most of the discharge ports for contracts of affreightment relating to the North Sea are along the northern and western coasts of Europe. In providing transportation services for a particular oil field, OPCO is required to use one or more of the shuttle tankers specified in the contract of affreightment, or replacement vessels meeting certain specifications. OPCO is obligated to transport in this manner as much crude oil as the customer requests it to load from the designated offshore oil field.
      OPCO has also entered into back-up contracts of affreightment with several offshore oil field operators who own shuttle tankers dedicated to those fields, in order to provide them certainty of transportation if their vessels are unavailable for service. The back-up agreements are otherwise subject to the same material terms as the other contracts of affreightment.
      Term. Most of the volume of oil transported by OPCO under contracts of affreightment is transported under contracts with a life-of -field term that remains in effect until production is terminated at the applicable field. OPCO’s other contracts of affreightment have fixed initial terms, typically in the range of 3 to 10 years, with options exercisable by the customer to extend the contract term. OPCO’s customers have typically extended or renewed contracts of affreightment that have fixed terms. Generally, either party may terminate a contract of affreightment for failure to perform, outbreaks of war or a continuing force majeure situation.
      Payments. Under each contract of affreightment, the customer pays a daily rate during use of the vessel to load, transport and discharge the oil. The customer also pays the cost of a notional return voyage from the discharge port back to the offshore oil field, resulting in a round trip fee regardless of where OPCO deploys the shuttle tanker after it has discharged its cargo. The daily rate is initially fixed under the contract of affreightment and then escalates in agreed amounts during the term of the contract of affreightment. In addition, the customer pays OPCO’s costs of bunker fuel consumed during the voyages and port fees and cargo loading and unloading expenses; OPCO is responsible for other voyage expenses and for vessel operating expenses. Payment is due from the customer after completion of each voyage, normally within six to thirty days. OPCO is subject to hourly late fees if its does not timely deliver a vessel to the designated offshore loading facilities.
      Contracts of affreightment covering two offshore oil fields have a different payment structure. Under the contract of affreightment for the Draugen field and the Harding field in the North Sea, the customer pays a rate based on each tonne of cargo transported, rather than a fixed daily rate. The revenue under this contract varies from voyage to voyage depending on the cargo size and the port at which the cargo is discharged. The contract includes a minimum cargo size and a maximum number of days allowed at field and in port before daily rates apply. Under OPCO’s contract of affreightment for the Heidrun field in the North Sea, the customer makes monthly payments in advance based on an annual estimated amount of cargo volumes, with a subsequent adjustment for the actual volumes transported during the month.

131


 

Time Charters and Bareboat Charters
      As of November 1, 2006, OPCO:
  •  chartered-in to its fleet eleven shuttle tankers under time charters and one shuttle tanker under a bareboat charter, all for use in its contract of affreightment fleet; and
 
  •  chartered to its customers eight shuttle tankers, three FSO units and nine conventional Aframax tankers under time charters and seven shuttle tankers and one FSO unit under bareboat charters.
      A time charter is a contract for the use of a specified vessel for a fixed period of time at a specified daily rate. Under OPCO’s time charters, the shipowner is responsible for providing crewing and other vessel operating services, the cost of which is included in the daily rate, while the customer is responsible for substantially all of the voyage expenses. A bareboat charter is a contract for the use of a specified vessel for a fixed period of time at a daily or annual rate. Under OPCO’s bareboat charters, the shipowner is not responsible for providing crewing or other operational services, while the customer is responsible for all vessel operating expenses and voyage expenses.
      Initial Term; Extensions. The initial term for a time charter or bareboat charter commences upon the vessel’s delivery to the customer. Most of OPCO’s time and bareboat charters include options, exercisable by the customer, to extend the charter’s term. Under the time charters, the customer may also extend the term for periods in which the vessel is off-hire, as described below. Customers under each of OPCO’s time and bareboat charters have rights to terminate the charter prior to expiration of the original or any extended term in specified circumstances.
      Hire Rate. “Hire” rate refers to the basic payment from the customer for the use of the vessel. Under the time charters, hire is payable monthly in advance, in U.S. Dollars or Norwegian Kroners, as specified in the charter. The hire rate may include two general components — a capital cost component and an operating expense component. The capital component relates to the financing obligations for the vessel’s purchase and typically is structured to meet the repayment schedule for the financing. The capital component may vary with interest rates. The operating component is intended to compensate for crewing and other vessel operating expenses and provide the shipowner a profit. The amount of the operating component is established between the parties at the beginning of the charter and typically increases annually based on changes in a specified cost-of -living index.
      Hire payments may be reduced, or under some time charters the shipowner must pay liquidated damages, if the vessel does not perform to certain of its specifications, such as if the average vessel speed falls below a guaranteed speed or the amount of fuel consumed to power the vessel under normal circumstances exceeds a guaranteed amount.
      Under the bareboat charters, the hire rate only includes a capital cost-based component (that includes a profit margin), payable monthly in advance. The customer is also required to maintain minimum levels of insurance to cover both its and the shipowner’s interests in the vessel.
      Off-hire. Under OPCO’s time charters, when the vessel is “off-hire” — or not available for service — the customer generally is not required to pay the hire rate, and the shipowner is responsible for all costs. Prolonged off-hire may lead to vessel substitution or termination of the time charter. A vessel generally will be deemed off-hire if there is a loss of time due to, among other things:
  •  operational deficiencies; drydocking for repairs, maintenance or inspection; equipment breakdowns; or delays due to accidents, crewing strikes, certain vessel detentions or similar problems; or
 
  •  the shipowner’s failure to maintain the vessel in compliance with its specifications and contractual standards or to provide the required crew.
      Ship Management and Maintenance. Under OPCO’s time charters, the owner is responsible for the technical management of the vessel and for maintaining the vessel, periodic drydocking, cleaning and painting and performing work required by regulations. Subsidiaries of Teekay Shipping Corporation will provide these services to OPCO for all its vessels, except for its conventional Aframax tankers, pursuant to

132


 

services agreements. Please read “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions — Advisory and Administrative Services Agreements.”
      Termination. Each of OPCO’s time and bareboat charters terminates automatically upon loss of the applicable vessel. In addition, the shipowner is generally entitled to suspend performance (but with the continuing accrual to its benefit of hire payments and default interest) and, under most of the time charters and bareboat charters, terminate the charter if the customer defaults in its payment obligations. Under most of the time charters and bareboat charters, either party may also terminate the charter in the event of war in specified countries or in locations that would significantly disrupt the free trade of the vessel. Under certain of the time and bareboat charters, the customer has an option to purchase the vessel after a specified period of time or at the conclusion of the charter. In each case, the purchase price and any adjustments to the purchase price are designated in the charter. For a description of the purchase options under the time charters for OPCO’s nine conventional Aframax tankers, please read “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions — Aframax Tanker Time-Charter Contracts With Teekay Shipping Corporation.”
VOC Agreements
      Currently there are 13 VOC plants installed aboard shuttle tankers operated or owned by OPCO in Norway. OPCO owns 11 of these plants and another plant that will be installed on a vessel in 2007. All 12 of OPCO’s VOC plants currently are leased to the VOC Industry Co-operation or directly to field operators. Please read “— Fleet — Shuttle Tankers” above for a description of the VOC plants. The agreements governing the installation, operation and maintenance of the equipment required to reduce VOC emissions are described below.
      VOC agreements are entered into between the VOC Industry Co-operation or relevant field operator and the provider of shuttle tanker transportation services (or transport provider ), and provide that the transport provider is responsible for the installation, operation and maintenance of the VOC equipment for the duration of a related time charter or contract of affreightment. The transport provider retains ownership of the VOC equipment and is paid a monthly fee to cover financing of the equipment over the term of the time charter or contract of affreightment and all VOC equipment operation and maintenance expenses at cost or plus a margin. Either party may terminate the VOC agreement if the other causes an event of default.
      If the transport provider owns the vessel, it typically enters into a management services contract with another party who agrees to operate and maintain the VOC equipment in exchange for a management fee. If the transport provider does not own the vessel, in addition to entering into a management agreement relating to the VOC equipment, the transport provider also obtains the shipowner’s agreement to allow access to the vessel by appropriate parties to install, operate and maintain the VOC equipment. Either party to the management services contract may terminate the contract if the other causes an event of default. OPCO has entered into management services contracts with Teekay Marine Services AS, a subsidiary of Teekay Shipping Corporation, for its shuttle tankers on which VOC equipment has been installed.
Classification, Audits and Inspections
      All of OPCO’s shuttle tankers and conventional oil tankers have been certified as being “in-class” by their respective classification societies: American Bureau of Shipping Det Norske Veritas, Lloyd’s Register of Shipping or Nippon Kaiji Kyokai. Although FSO units and FPSO units generally are not classified by classification societies, each of OPCO’s FSO units has been inspected and certified as “in-class” by their respective classification societies. Every “in-class” vessel’s hull and machinery is “classed” by a classification society. The classification society certifies that the vessel has been built and is maintained in accordance with the rules of that classification society and complies with applicable rules and regulations of the country of registry of the vessel and the international conventions of which that country is a signatory, although for some vessels this latter certification is obtained directly from the relevant flag state authorities. Each vessel is inspected by a classification society surveyor annually, with either the second or

133


 

third annual inspection being a more detailed survey (an Intermediate Survey ) and the fourth or fifth annual inspection being the most comprehensive survey (a Special Survey ). The inspection cycle resumes after each Special Survey. Vessels also may be required to be drydocked at each Intermediate and Special Survey for inspection of the underwater parts of the vessel and resulting repairs. In-water surveys generally take vessels out of service for one day. Many of OPCO’s vessels have qualified with their respective classification societies for drydocking every four or five years in connection with the Special Survey and are no longer subject to the Intermediate Survey drydocking process. To qualify, the resiliency of the underwater coatings of each vessel was enhanced and the hull was marked to accommodate underwater inspections by divers.
      In addition to classification inspections:
  •  The vessel’s flag state, or the vessel’s classification if nominated by the flag state, inspect the vessels to ensure they comply with applicable rules and regulations of the country of registry of the vessel and the international conventions of which that country is a signatory.
 
  •  Port state control authorities, such as the U.S. Coast Guard and Australian Maritime Safety Authority, inspect some of the vessels.
 
  •  Many customers regularly inspect OPCO’s vessels as a precondition to chartering. Regular inspections are standard practice under long-term charters.
      In addition to third-party audits and inspections, the seafaring staff operating the vessels regularly inspect them and perform much of the necessary routine maintenance. Shore-based operational and technical specialists also inspect the vessels at least twice a year for conformity with established criteria. Upon completion of each inspection, recommendations are made for improving the overall condition of the vessel and its maintenance, safety and crew welfare. All recommendations are monitored until they are completed.
      Objectives in inspecting a vessel are to:
  •  ensure adherence to operating standards;
 
  •  maintain the structural integrity of the vessel;
 
  •  maintain machinery and equipment to give full reliability in service;
 
  •  optimize performance in terms of speed and fuel consumption; and
 
  •  ensure the vessel’s appearance will support the Teekay Shipping Corporation brand and meet customer expectations.
      To achieve the vessel structural integrity objective, we use a comprehensive “Structural Integrity Management System” developed by Teekay Shipping Corporation. This system is designed to monitor the condition of the vessels closely and to ensure that structural strength and integrity are maintained throughout a vessel’s life.
Safety, Management of Ship Operations and Administration
      Safety and environmental compliance are top operational priorities. The vessels are operated in a manner intended to protect the safety and health of employees, the general public and the environment. We actively manage the risks inherent in our and OPCO’s business and are committed to eliminating incidents that threaten safety and the integrity of the vessels, such as groundings, fires, collisions and petroleum spills. We are also committed to reducing emissions and waste generation.
      Key performance indicators facilitate regular monitoring of OPCO’s operational performance. Targets are set on an annual basis to drive continuous improvement, and indicators are reviewed monthly to determine if remedial action is necessary to reach the targets.
      Teekay Shipping Corporation, through certain of its subsidiaries, assists OPCO’s operating subsidiaries in managing their ship operations. Teekay Shipping Corporation has obtained through Det Norske Veritas, the Norwegian classification society, approval of its safety management system as in compliance with the

134


 

International Safety Management Code (or ISM Code ), and this system has been implemented for our Bahamian-flagged and Norwegian-flagged vessels. As part of Teekay Shipping Corporation’s ISM Code compliance, all of the vessels’ safety management certificates are being maintained through ongoing internal audits performed by Teekay Shipping Corporation’s certified internal auditors and intermediate audits performed by Det Norske Veritas.
      Teekay Shipping Corporation provides, through certain of its subsidiaries, expertise in various functions critical to the operations of OPCO’s operating subsidiaries. This affords a safe, efficient and cost-effective operation and, pursuant to administrative services agreements with certain subsidiaries of Teekay Shipping Corporation, access to human resources, financial and other administrative functions. Critical ship management functions that certain subsidiaries of Teekay Shipping Corporation have agreed to provide to OPCO’s operating subsidiaries through Teekay Shipping Corporation’s Teekay Marine Services division located in various offices around the world include:
  •  vessel maintenance;
 
  •  crewing;
 
  •  purchasing;
 
  •  shipyard supervision;
 
  •  insurance; and
 
  •  financial management services.
      Please read “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions — Advisory and Administrative Services Agreements.” These functions are supported by onboard and onshore systems for maintenance, inventory, purchasing and budget management.
      Prior to this offering, OPCO generally fulfilled its own managerial, operational and administrative needs, but relied upon affiliates of Teekay Shipping Corporation to provide technical services. Following this offering, OPCO’s operating subsidiaries will provide technical and voyage management services for their conventional Aframax tankers, but rely on certain subsidiaries of Teekay Shipping Corporation for substantially all other services.
      In addition, Teekay Shipping Corporation’s day-to -day focus on cost control will be applied to OPCO’s operations. In 2003, Teekay Shipping Corporation and two other shipping companies established a purchasing alliance, Teekay Bergesen Worldwide, which leverages the purchasing power of the combined fleets, mainly in such commodity areas as lube oils, paints and other chemicals. Through arrangements with Teekay Shipping Corporation, OPCO and we will benefit from this purchasing alliance.
      The generally uniform design of some of OPCO’s vessels and the adoption of common equipment standards should also result in operational efficiencies, including with respect to crew training and vessel management, equipment operation and repair, and spare parts ordering.
Crewing and Staff
      As of November 1, 2006, approximately 2,100 seagoing staff served on OPCO’s vessels and approximately 200 staff served on shore in technical, commercial and administrative roles in various countries. OPCO directly employs approximately 18% of the on-shore staff and employs no seagoing staff directly; instead certain subsidiaries of Teekay Shipping Corporation employ the crews, who serve on the vessels pursuant to agreements with the subsidiaries. Likewise, certain subsidiaries of Teekay Shipping Corporation provide on-shore advisory, operational and administrative support to OPCO’s operating subsidiaries pursuant to service agreements. Please read “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions — Advisory and Administrative Services Agreements.”
      Teekay Shipping Corporation regards attracting and retaining motivated seagoing personnel as a top priority, and offers seafarers highly competitive employment packages and comprehensive benefits and opportunities for personal and career development, which relates to a philosophy of promoting internally.

135


 

      Teekay Shipping Corporation has entered into a Collective Bargaining Agreement with the Polish Seafarers’ Union and the Philippine Seafarers’ Union, an affiliate of the International Transport Workers’ Federation (or ITF ), and a Special Agreement with ITF London, which covers substantially all of the officers and seamen that operate OPCO’s Bahamian-flagged vessels. Substantially all officers and seamen for the Norway-flagged vessels are covered by a collective bargaining agreement with Norwegian unions (Norwegian Maritime Officers’ Association, Norwegian Union of Marine Engineers and the Norwegian Seafarers’ Union). We believe Teekay Shipping Corporation’s relationships with these labor unions are good.
      Teekay Shipping Corporation’s commitment to training is fundamental to the development of the highest caliber of seafarers for marine operations. Teekay Shipping Corporation’s cadet training approach is designed to balance academic learning with hands-on training at sea. Teekay Shipping Corporation has relationships with training institutions in Australia, Canada, Croatia, India, Latvia, Norway, Philippines, South Africa and the United Kingdom. After receiving formal instruction at one of these institutions, cadet training continues on board vessels. Teekay Shipping Corporation also has a career development plan that was devised to ensure a continuous flow of qualified officers who are trained on its vessels and familiarized with its operational standards, systems and policies. We believe that high-quality crewing and training policies will play an increasingly important role in distinguishing larger independent shipping companies that have in-house or affiliate capabilities from smaller companies that must rely on outside ship managers and crewing agents on the basis of customer service and safety.
Risk of Loss, Insurance and Risk Management
      The operation of any ocean-going vessel carries an inherent risk of catastrophic marine disasters, death or injury of persons and property losses caused by adverse weather conditions, mechanical failures, human error, war, terrorism, piracy and other circumstances or events. The occurrence of any of these events may result in loss of revenues or increased costs.
      OPCO carries “hull and machinery” and “protection and indemnity” insurance coverage to protect against most of the accident-related risks involved in the conduct of its business. Hull and machinery insurance covers loss of or damage to a vessel due to marine perils such as collisions, grounding and weather. Protection and indemnity insurance indemnifies against other liabilities incurred while operating vessels, including injury to the crew, third parties, cargo loss and pollution. The current available amount of OPCO’s coverage for pollution is $1 billion per vessel per incident. OPCO also carries insurance policies covering war risks (including piracy and terrorism).
      Under bareboat charters, the customer is responsible to insure the vessel. We believe that current insurance coverage is adequate to protect against most of the accident-related risks involved in the conduct of OPCO’s business and that it maintains appropriate levels of environmental damage and pollution coverage. However, we cannot assure that all covered risks are adequately insured against, that any particular claim will be paid or that we or OPCO will be able to procure adequate insurance coverage at commercially reasonable rates in the future. More stringent environmental regulations at times in the past have resulted in increased costs for, and may result in the lack of availability of, insurance against the risks of environmental damage or pollution. Substantially all of OPCO’s vessels are not insured against loss of revenues resulting from vessel off-hire time, based on the cost of this insurance compared to OPCO’s off-hire experience. Please read “Risk Factors — Risks Inherent in Our Business — Insurance may be insufficient to cover losses that may occur to our or OPCO’s property or result from our or its operations.”
      We and OPCO will use in our operations Teekay Shipping Corporation’s thorough risk management program that includes, among other things, computer-aided risk analysis tools, maintenance and assessment programs, a seafarers competence training program, seafarers workshops and membership in emergency response organizations. We expect to benefit from Teekay Shipping Corporation’s commitment to safety and environmental protection as certain of its subsidiaries assist us and OPCO in managing vessel operations.

136


 

      Teekay Shipping Corporation has achieved certification under the standards reflected in International Standards Organization’s (or ISO ) 9001 for quality assurance, ISO 14001 for environment management systems, OHSAS 18001 for Occupational Health and Safety, and the IMO’s International Management Code for the Safe Operation of Ships and Pollution Prevention on a fully integrated basis.
Regulation
General
      Our business and the operation of OPCO’s vessels are significantly affected by international conventions and national, state and local laws and regulations in the jurisdictions in which its vessels operate, as well as in the country or countries of their registration. Because these conventions, laws and regulations change frequently, we cannot predict the ultimate cost of compliance or their impact on the resale price or useful life of the vessels. Additional conventions, laws and regulations may be adopted that could limit our or OPCO’s ability to do business or increase the cost of doing business and that may materially adversely affect operations. OPCO is required by various governmental and quasi-governmental agencies to obtain permits, licenses and certificates with respect to its operations. Subject to the discussion below and to the fact that the kinds of permits, licenses and certificates required for the operations of the vessels OPCO owns will depend on a number of factors, we believe that we and OPCO will be able to continue to obtain all permits, licenses and certificates material to the conduct of operations.
      We believe that the heightened environmental and quality concerns of insurance underwriters, regulators and charterers will generally lead to greater inspection and safety requirements on all vessels in the oil tanker markets and will accelerate the scrapping of older vessels throughout these industries.
Regulation — International Maritime Organization (or IMO)
      IMO regulations include the International Convention for Safety of Life at Sea (or SOLAS ), including amendments to SOLAS implementing the International Security Code for Ports and Ships (or ISPS ), the ISM Code, the International Convention on Prevention of Pollution from Ships (or the MARPOL Convention ), the International Convention on Civil Liability for Oil Pollution Damage of 1969, the International Convention on Load Lines of 1966. The IMO Marine Safety Committee has also published guidelines for vessels with dynamic positioning ( DP ) systems, which apply to shuttle tankers and DP-assisted FSO units and FPSO units. SOLAS provides rules for the construction of and equipment required for commercial vessels and includes regulations for safe operation. Flag states which have ratified the convention and the treaty generally employ the classification societies, which have incorporated SOLAS requirements into their class rules, to undertake surveys to confirm compliance.
      SOLAS and other IMO regulations concerning safety, including those relating to treaties on training of shipboard personnel, lifesaving appliances, radio equipment and the global maritime distress and safety system, are applicable to OPCO’s operations. Non-compliance with IMO regulations, including SOLAS, the ISM Code, ISPS and the specific requirements for shuttle tankers, FSO units and FPSO units under the NPD (Norway) and HSE (United Kingdom) regulations, may subject OPCO to increased liability or penalties, may lead to decreases in available insurance coverage for affected vessels and may result in the denial of access to or detention in some ports. For example, the Coast Guard and European Union authorities have indicated that vessels not in compliance with the ISM Code will be prohibited from trading in U.S. and European Union ports.
      The ISM Code requires vessel operators to obtain a safety management certification for each vessel they manage, evidencing the shipowner’s compliance with requirements of the ISM Code relating to the development and maintenance of an extensive “Safety Management System.” Such a system includes, among other things, the adoption of a safety and environmental protection policy setting forth instructions and procedures for safe operation and describing procedures for dealing with emergencies. Each of the existing vessels in OPCO’s fleet currently is ISM Code-certified, and we expect to obtain safety management certificates for each newbuilding upon delivery.

137


 

      ISPS was adopted in December 2002 in the wake of heightened concern over worldwide terrorism and became effective on July 1, 2004. The objective of ISPS is to enhance maritime security by detecting security threats to ships and ports and by requiring the development of security plans and other measures designed to prevent such threats. The United States implemented ISPS with the adoption of the Maritime Transportation Security Act of 2002 (or MTSA ), which requires vessels entering U.S. waters to obtain certification of plans to respond to emergency incidents there, including identification of persons authorized to implement the plans. Each of the existing vessels in OPCO’s fleet currently complies with the requirements of ISPS and MTSA, and we expect all newbuildings to comply upon delivery.
      Under IMO regulations an oil tanker must be of double-hull construction, be of a mid-deck design with double-side construction or be of another approved design ensuring the same level of protection against oil pollution in the event that such tanker:
  •  is the subject of a contract for a major conversion or original construction on or after July 6, 1993;
 
  •  commences a major conversion or has its keel laid on or after January 6, 1994; or
 
  •  completes a major conversion or is a newbuilding delivered on or after July 6, 1996.
      In December 2003, the IMO revised its regulations relating to the prevention of pollution from oil tankers. These regulations, which became effective April 5, 2005, accelerate the mandatory phase-out of single-hull tankers and impose a more rigorous inspection regime for older tankers. All of OPCO’s shuttle and conventional oil tankers are double-hulled and were delivered after July 6, 1996, so those tankers will not be affected directly by these IMO regulations.
Shuttle Tanker, FSO Unit and FPSO Unit Regulation
      OPCO’s shuttle tankers primarily operate in the North Sea. In addition to the regulations imposed by the IMO, countries having jurisdiction over North Sea areas impose regulatory requirements in connection with operations of shuttle tankers, FSO units and FPSO units in those areas, including HSE in the UK and NPD in Norway. These regulatory requirements, together with additional requirements imposed by operators in North Sea oil fields, require that we make further expenditures for sophisticated equipment, reporting and redundancy systems on the shuttle tankers and for the training of seagoing staff. Additional regulations and requirements may be adopted or imposed that could limit OPCO’s ability to do business or further increase the cost of doing business in the North Sea. In Brazil, Petrobras serves in a regulatory capacity and has adopted standards similar to those in the North Sea.
Environmental Regulations — The United States Oil Pollution Act of 1990 (or OPA 90)
      OPA 90 established an extensive regulatory and liability regime for the protection and cleanup of the environment from oil spills, including discharges of oil cargoes, bunker fuels or lubricants. OPA 90 affects all owners and operators whose vessels trade to the United States or its territories or possessions or whose vessels operate in United States waters, which include the U.S. territorial sea and 200-mile exclusive economic zone around the United States.
      Under OPA 90, vessel owners, operators and bareboat charterers are “responsible parties” and are jointly, severally and strictly liable (unless the spill results solely from the act or omission of a third party, an act of God or an act of war and the responsible party reports the incident and reasonably cooperates with the appropriate authorities) for all containment and cleanup costs and other damages arising from discharges or threatened discharges of oil from their vessels. These other damages are defined broadly to include:
  •  natural resources damages and the related assessment costs;
 
  •  real and personal property damages;
 
  •  net loss of taxes, royalties, rents, fees and other lost revenues;
 
  •  lost profits or impairment of earning capacity due to property or natural resources damage;

138


 

  •  net cost of public services necessitated by a spill response, such as protection from fire, safety or health hazards; and
 
  •  loss of subsistence use of natural resources.
      OPA 90 limits the liability of responsible parties. Effective as of October 9, 2006, the limit for double-hulled tank vessels was increased to the greater of $1,900 per gross ton or $16 million per tanker that is over 3,000 gross tons per incident, subject to adjustment for inflation. These limits of liability would not apply if the incident were proximately caused by violation of applicable U.S. federal safety, construction or operating regulations, including IMO conventions to which the United States is a signatory, or by the responsible party’s gross negligence or willful misconduct, or if the responsible party fails or refuses to report the incident or to cooperate and assist in connection with the oil removal activities. We currently plan to continue to maintain for each vessel pollution liability coverage in the amount of $1 billion per incident. A catastrophic spill could exceed the coverage available, which could harm our and OPCO’s business, financial condition and results of operations.
      Under OPA 90, with limited exceptions, all newly built or converted tankers delivered after January 1, 1994 and operating in United States waters must be built with double-hulls. All of OPCO’s existing shuttle tankers and conventional tankers are double-hulled.
      In December 1994, the U.S. Coast Guard (or Coast Guard ) implemented regulations requiring evidence of financial responsibility in the amount of $1,500 per gross ton for tankers, coupling the then existing OPA limitation on liability of $1,200 per gross ton with the Comprehensive Environmental Response, Compensation, and Liability Act (or CERCLA ) liability limit of $300 per gross ton. The financial responsibility limits have not been increased to comport with the amended statutory limits of OPA. However, the Coast Guard has issued a notice of policy change indicating its intention to change the financial responsibility regulations accordingly. Under the regulations, such evidence of financial responsibility may be demonstrated by insurance, surety bond, self-insurance, guaranty or an alternate method subject to agency approval. Under OPA 90, an owner or operator of a fleet of vessels is required only to demonstrate evidence of financial responsibility in an amount sufficient to cover the tanker in the fleet having the greatest maximum limited liability under OPA 90 and CERCLA.
      The Coast Guard’s regulations concerning certificates of financial responsibility (or COFR ) provide, in accordance with OPA 90, that claimants may bring suit directly against an insurer or guarantor that furnishes COFR. In addition, in the event that such insurer or guarantor is sued directly, it is prohibited from asserting any contractual defense that it may have had against the responsible party and is limited to asserting those defenses available to the responsible party and the defense that the incident was caused by the willful misconduct of the responsible party. Certain organizations, which had typically provided COFR under pre-OPA 90 laws, including the major protection and indemnity organizations, have declined to furnish evidence of insurance for vessel owners and operators if they are subject to direct actions or required to waive insurance policy defenses. The Coast Guard has indicated that it intends to propose a rule that would increase the required amount of such COFRs to $2,200 per gross ton to reflect the higher limits on liability imposed by OPA 90, as described above.
      The Coast Guard’s financial responsibility regulations may also be satisfied by evidence of surety bond, guaranty or by self-insurance. Under the self-insurance provisions, the shipowner or operator must have a net worth and working capital, measured in assets located in the United States against liabilities located anywhere in the world, that exceeds the applicable amount of financial responsibility. OPCO has complied with the Coast Guard regulations by obtaining financial guarantees from a third party. If other vessels in the fleet trade into the United States in the future, we expect that OPCO will obtain additional guarantees from third-party insurers or to provide guarantees through self-insurance.
      OPA 90 and CERCLA permit individual states to impose their own liability regimes with regard to oil or hazardous substance pollution incidents occurring within their boundaries, and some states have enacted legislation providing for unlimited strict liability for spills. OPCO intends to comply with all applicable state regulations in the ports where its vessels call.

139


 

      Owners or operators of tank vessels operating in United States waters are required to file vessel response plans with the Coast Guard, and their tank vessels are required to operate in compliance with their Coast Guard approved plans. Such response plans must, among other things:
  •  address a “worst case” scenario and identify and ensure, through contract or other approved means, the availability of necessary private response resources to respond to a “worst case discharge”;
 
  •  describe crew training and drills; and
 
  •  identify a qualified individual with full authority to implement removal actions.
      We have filed vessel response plans with the Coast Guard for the tankers we own and have received approval of such plans for all vessels in the fleet to operate in U.S. waters. In addition, OPCO conducts regular oil spill response drills in accordance with the guidelines set out in OPA 90. The Coast Guard has announced it intends to propose similar regulations requiring certain vessels to prepare response plans for the release of hazardous substances.
      OPA 90 allows U.S. state legislatures to pre-empt associated regulation if the state’s regulations are equal or more stringent. Several coastal states such as California, Washington and Alaska require state-specific COFR and vessel response plans.
      CERCLA contains a similar liability regime to OPA 90, but applies to the discharge of “hazardous substances” rather than “oil.” Petroleum products should not be considered hazardous substances under CERCLA, but additives to oil might fall within its scope. CERCLA imposes strict joint and several liability upon the owner, operator or bareboat charterer of a vessel for cleanup costs and damages arising from a discharge of hazardous substances.
      OPA 90 and CERCLA do not preclude claimants from seeking damages resulting from the discharge of oil and hazardous substances under other applicable law, including maritime tort law. The application of this doctrine varies by jurisdiction. There can be no assurance that a court in a particular jurisdiction will not determine that the carriage of oil aboard a vessel is an ultra-hazardous activity, which could result in strict liability for damages caused to injured parties even when neither we nor OPCO has acted negligently.
Environmental Regulation — Other Environmental Initiatives
      Although the United States is not a party, many countries have ratified and follow the liability scheme adopted by the IMO and set out in the International Convention on Civil Liability for Oil Pollution Damage, 1969, as amended (or CLC ), and the Convention for the Establishment of an International Fund for Oil Pollution of 1971, as amended. Under these conventions, which are applicable to vessels that carry persistent oil as cargo, a vessel’s registered owner is strictly liable for pollution damage caused in the territorial waters of a contracting state by discharge of persistent oil, subject to certain complete defenses. Many of the countries that have ratified the CLC have increased the liability limits through a 1992 Protocol to the CLC. The liability limits in the countries that have ratified this Protocol are currently approximately $4.5 million plus approximately $631 per gross registered tonne above 5,000 gross tonnes with an approximate maximum of $90 million per vessel, with the exact amount tied to a unit of account which varies according to a basket of currencies. The right to limit liability is forfeited under the CLC when the spill is caused by the owner’s actual fault or privity and, under the 1992 Protocol, when the spill is caused by the owner’s intentional or reckless conduct. Vessels trading to contracting states must provide evidence of insurance covering the limited liability of the owner. In jurisdictions where the CLC has not been adopted, various legislative schemes or common law governs, and liability is imposed either on the basis of fault or in a manner similar to the CLC.
      In addition, the IMO, various countries and states, such as Australia, the United States and the State of California, and various regulators, such as port authorities, the U.S. Coast Guard and the U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, have either adopted legislation or regulations, or are separately

140


 

considering the adoption of legislation or regulations, aimed at regulating the discharge of ballast water and the discharge of bunkers as potential pollutants.
      The United States Clean Water Act prohibits the discharge of oil or hazardous substances in U.S. navigable waters and imposes strict liability in the form of penalties for unauthorized discharges. The Clean Water Act also imposes substantial liability for the costs of removal, remediation and damages and complements the remedies available under OPA 90 and CERCLA discussed above. Pursuant to regulations promulgated by the U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (or EPA ) in the early 1970s, the discharge of sewage and effluent from properly functioning marine engines was exempted from the permit requirements of the National Pollution Discharge Elimination System. This exemption allowed vessels in U.S. ports to discharge certain substances, including ballast water, without obtaining a permit to do so. However, on March 30, 2005, a U.S. District Court for the Northern District of California granted summary judgment to certain environmental groups and U.S. states that had challenged the EPA regulations, arguing that the EPA exceeded its authority in promulgating them. On September 18, 2006, the U.S. District Court issued an order invalidating the exemption in EPA’s regulations for all discharges incidental to the normal operation of a vessel as of September 30, 2008, and directing EPA to develop a system for regulating all discharges from vessels by that date.
      Although the EPA may appeal this decision, if the exemption is repealed, we would be subject to the Clean Water Act permit requirements that could include ballast water treatment obligations that could increase the costs of operating in the United States. For example, this ruling could: require the installation of equipment on our vessels to treat ballast water before it is discharged; require the implementation of other port facility disposal arrangements or procedures at potentially substantial cost; and/or otherwise restrict OPCO’s vessel traffic in U.S. waters.
      In Norway, the Norwegian Pollution Control Authority requires the installation of VOC equipment on most shuttle tankers serving the Norwegian continental shelf. Oil companies bear the cost to install and operate the VOC equipment onboard the shuttle tankers.
Properties
      Other than vessels, neither we nor OPCO has any material property.
Legal Proceedings
      From time to time OPCO has been, and we expect that in the future we and OPCO will be, subject to legal proceedings and claims in the ordinary course of business, principally personal injury and property casualty claims. These claims, even if lacking merit, could result in the expenditure of significant financial and managerial resources. We are not aware of any legal proceedings or claims that we believe will have, individually or in the aggregate, a material adverse effect on us or OPCO.
Taxation of the Partnership
United States Taxation
      This discussion is based upon provisions of the U.S. Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (or the Code ) as in effect on the date of this prospectus, existing final and temporary regulations thereunder (or Treasury Regulations ), and current administrative rulings and court decisions, all of which are subject to change, possibly with retroactive effect. Changes in these authorities may cause the tax consequences to vary substantially from the consequences described below. The following discussion is for general information purposes only and does not purport to be a comprehensive description of all of the U.S. federal income tax considerations applicable to us.
      Election to be Taxed as a Corporation. We have elected to be taxed as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes. As such, we will be subject to U.S. federal income tax on our income to the extent it is from U.S. sources or otherwise is effectively connected with the conduct of a trade or business in the United States as discussed below.

141


 

      Taxation of Operating Income. We expect that substantially all of our gross income will be attributable to the transportation of crude oil and related products. For this purpose, gross income attributable to transportation (or Transportation Income ) includes income derived from, or in connection with, the use (or hiring or leasing for use) of a vessel to transport cargo, or the performance of services directly related to the use of any vessel to transport cargo, and thus includes both time charter or bareboat charter income.
      Transportation Income that is attributable to transportation that begins or ends, but that does not both begin and end, in the United States (or U.S. Source International Transportation Income ) will be considered to be 50.0% derived from sources within the United States. Transportation Income attributable to transportation that both begins and ends in the United States (or U.S. Source Domestic Transportation Income ) will be considered to be 100.0% derived from sources within the United States. Transportation Income attributable to transportation exclusively between non-U.S.  destinations will be considered to be 100% derived from sources outside the United States. Transportation Income derived from sources outside the United States generally will not be subject to U.S. federal income tax.
      Based on our and OPCO’s current operations, we expect substantially all of our Transportation Income to be from sources outside the United States and not subject to U.S. federal income tax. However, certain of our activities could give rise to U.S. Source International Transportation Income, and future expansion of our operations could result in an increase in the amount of U.S. Source International Transportation Income, as well as give rise to U.S. Source Domestic Transportation Income, all of which could be subject to U.S. federal income taxation, unless the exemption from U.S. taxation under Section 883 of the Code (or the Section 883 Exemption ) applies.
      The Section 883 Exemption. In general, the Section 883 Exemption provides that if a non-U.S.  corporation satisfies the requirements of Section 883 of the Code and the Treasury Regulations thereunder (or the Section 883 Regulations ), it will not be subject to the net basis and branch taxes or 4.0% gross basis tax described below on its U.S. Source International Transportation Income. The Section 883 Exemption only applies to U.S. Source International Transportation Income. As discussed below, we believe that under our current ownership structure, the Section 883 Exemption will apply and we will not be taxed on our U.S. Source International Transportation Income. The Section 883 Exemption does not apply to U.S. Source Domestic Transportation Income.
      A non-U.S.  corporation will qualify for the Section 883 Exemption if, among other things, it meets the following three requirements:
  •  it is organized in a jurisdiction outside the United States that grants an equivalent exemption from tax to corporations organized in the United States (an Equivalent Exemption );
 
  •  it satisfies one of the following three ownership tests (discussed in more detail below): (a) the more than 50.0% ownership test (or the Ownership Test ); (b) the controlled foreign corporation test (or the CFC Test ); or (c) the Publicly Traded Test (as described below); and
 
  •  it meets certain substantiation, reporting, and other requirements.
      In order to satisfy the Ownership Test, a non-U.S.  corporation must be able to substantiate that more than 50.0% of the value of its stock is owned, directly or indirectly applying attribution rules, by Qualified Shareholders for at least half the number of days in the corporation’s taxable year. For this purpose, Qualified Shareholders are: (a) individuals who are residents (as defined for U.S. federal income tax purposes) of countries that grant an Equivalent Exemption; (b) foreign corporations that meet the Publicly Traded Test of the Section 883 Regulations and are organized in countries that grant an Equivalent Exemption; or (c) certain foreign governments, non profit organizations, and certain beneficiaries of foreign pension funds. U.S. individuals and U.S. domestic corporations are not Qualified Shareholders.
      A corporation claiming the Section 883 Exemption based on the Ownership Test must obtain statements from the holders relied upon to satisfy the Ownership Test, signed under penalty of perjury,

142


 

including the holder’s name, permanent address and country where the holder is fully liable to tax, if any, a description of the holder’s ownership interest in the non-U.S.  corporation, including information regarding ownership in any intermediate entities, and certain other information. In addition, we would be required to file a U.S. federal income tax return and list on this return the name and address of each unitholder holding 5.0% or more of the value of our common units who is relied upon to meet the Ownership Test.
      The CFC Test requires that the non-U.S.  corporation claiming the Section 883 Exemption be treated as a CFC for U.S. federal income tax purposes and a qualified U.S. person ownership test is met (for the definition of a CFC, please read “Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Considerations — United States Federal Income Taxation of U.S. Holders — Consequences of Possible Controlled Foreign Corporation Classification.”
      The Publicly Traded Test requires that one or more classes of equity representing more than 50.0% of the voting power and value in a non-U.S.  corporation be “primarily and regularly traded” on an established securities market either in the United States or in a foreign country that grants an Equivalent Exemption. The Section 883 Regulations provide, in pertinent part, that stock of a foreign corporation will be considered to be “primarily traded” on an established securities market in a given country if the number of units of each class of equity that are traded during any taxable year on all established securities markets in that country exceeds the number of units in each such class that are traded during that year on established securities markets in any other single country. Equity of a foreign corporation will be considered to be “regularly traded” on an established securities market under the Section 883 Regulations if one or more classes of equity of the corporation that, in the aggregate, represent more than 50.0% of the combined vote and value of the foreign corporation are listed on such market and certain trading volume requirements are met. For this purpose, if one or more 5.0% unitholders ( i.e. , a unitholder holding, actually or constructively, at least 5.0% of the vote and value of a class of equity) own in the aggregate 50.0% or more of the vote and value of a class of equity, such class of equity will not be treated as primarily and regularly traded on an established securities market.
      We are organized under the laws of the Republic of the Marshall Islands. The U.S. Treasury Department has recognized the Republic of the Marshall Islands as a jurisdiction that grants an Equivalent Exemption. Consequently, our U.S. Source International Transportation Income (including for this purpose, any such income earned by our subsidiaries that have properly elected to be treated as partnerships or disregarded as entities separate from us for U.S. federal income tax purposes) will be exempt from U.S. federal income taxation provided we meet the Ownership Test or we satisfy either the CFC Test or the Publicly Traded Test.
      We do not believe that we will meet the CFC Test, as we do not expect to be a CFC (please read “Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Considerations — United States Federal Income Taxation of U.S. Holders — Consequences of Possible Controlled Foreign Corporation Classification”), and we currently will not meet the Publicly Traded Test. Nonetheless, as of the date of this prospectus, we believe that we should satisfy the Ownership Test based upon the ownership immediately after the closing of this offering of more than 50.0% of the value of us by Teekay Shipping Corporation.
      Based on information provided by Teekay Shipping Corporation, Teekay Shipping Corporation is organized in the Republic of the Marshall Islands and meets the Publicly Traded Test under current law and under the Section 883 Regulations. For each year during which Teekay Shipping Corporation owns more than 50.0% of the value of us and satisfies the Publicly Traded Test, we will satisfy the Ownership Test and will qualify for the Section 883 Exemption, provided that Teekay Shipping Corporation provides properly completed ownership statements to us as required under the Section 883 Regulations and we satisfy certain substantiation and documentation requirements. As of the date hereof, Teekay Shipping Corporation has indicated its willingness to provide us with such ownership statements as long as it is a Qualified Shareholder. There is no assurance that Teekay Shipping Corporation will continue to satisfy the requirements for being a Qualified Shareholder of us ( i.e. , there is no assurance it will meet the Publicly Traded Test) or that it alone will own more than 50.0% of the value of our units. Should Teekay Shipping

143


 

Corporation own less than 50.0% of the value of our units, we expect that we would not be eligible to claim the Section 883 Exemption, and, therefore, we would be subject to either net basis and branch profits taxes or the 4.0% gross basis tax described below, thereby reducing the amount of cash available for distribution to unitholders. During the twelve months ended June 30, 2006, if we were not eligible to claim the Section 883 Exemption, we would have been subject to less than $1.0 million of taxes based on our U.S. Source International Transportation Income.
      The Net Basis Tax and Branch Profits Tax. If we earn U.S. Source International Transportation Income and the Section 883 Exemption does not apply, such income may be treated as effectively connected with the conduct of a trade or business in the United States (or Effectively Connected Income ) if we have a fixed place of business in the United States and substantially all of our U.S. Source International Transportation Income is attributable to regularly scheduled transportation or, in the case of bareboat charter income, is attributable to a fixed placed of business in the United States. Based on our current operations, none of our potential U.S. Source International Transportation Income is attributable to regularly scheduled transportation or is received pursuant to bareboat charters. As a result, we do not anticipate that any of our U.S. Source International Transportation Income will be treated as Effectively Connected Income. However, there is no assurance that we will not earn income pursuant to regularly scheduled transportation or bareboat charters attributable to a fixed place of business in the United States in the future, which would result in such income being treated as Effectively Connected Income.
      U.S. Source Domestic Transportation Income generally will be treated as Effectively Connected Income.
      Any income we earn that is treated as Effectively Connected Income would be subject to U.S. federal corporate income tax (the highest statutory rate is currently 35.0%). In addition, if we earn income that is treated as Effectively Connected Income, a 30.0% branch profits tax imposed under Section 884 of the Code also would apply to such income, and a branch interest tax could be imposed on certain interest paid or deemed paid by us.
      On the sale of a vessel that has produced Effectively Connected Income, we could be subject to the net basis corporate income tax and to the 30.0% branch profits tax with respect to our gain not in excess of certain prior deductions for depreciation that reduced Effectively Connected Income. Otherwise, we would not be subject to U.S. federal income tax with respect to gain realized on the sale of a vessel, provided the sale is considered to occur outside of the United States under U.S. federal income tax principles.
      The 4.0% Gross Basis Tax. If the Section 883 Exemption does not apply and the net basis tax does not apply, we would be subject to a 4.0% U.S. federal income tax on the U.S. source portion of our gross U.S. Source International Transportation Income, without benefit of deductions.
Marshall Islands Taxation
      Based on the advice of Watson, Farley & Williams (New York) LLP, our counsel as to matters of the law of the Republic of the Marshall Islands, because we and our controlled affiliates do not, and we do not expect that we and our controlled affiliates will, conduct business or operations in the Republic of the Marshall Islands, neither we nor our controlled affiliates will be subject to income, capital gains, profits or other taxation under current Marshall Islands law. As a result, distributions by OPCO or other controlled affiliates to us will not be subject to Marshall Islands taxation.
Norway Taxation
      The following discussion is based upon the current tax laws of the Kingdom of Norway and regulations, the Norwegian tax administrative practice and judicial decisions thereunder, all as in effect as of the date of this prospectus and subject to possible change on a retroactive basis. The following discussion is for general information purposes only and does not purport to be a comprehensive description of all of the Norwegian income tax considerations applicable to us.

144


 

      Immediately following the closing of this offering, we will own approximately 26.0% of the partnership interests in OPCO. OPCO will own all of the share capital of a Marshall Islands subsidiary, Norsk Teekay Holdings Ltd. (or Holdco ). Holdco will own all of the shares of a company in Luxembourg, Teekay European Holdings S.a.r.l. (or Luxco ). Luxco will, in turn, own all of the share capital of a Dutch subsidiary, Teekay Netherlands European Holdings B.V. (or Dutchco ). Dutchco will own all of the shares of Norsk Teekay AS.
      Norsk Teekay AS is the direct or indirect parent of various operating subsidiaries in Norway and Singapore, including Teekay Norway AS, Navion Offshore Loading AS (or NOL ) and Teekay Navion Offshore Loading Pte. Ltd. (or TNOL ). Norsk Teekay AS will be capitalized with equity from Dutchco and loans from Holdco.
      Norsk Teekay AS and all of its Norwegian subsidiaries are considered to be residents of Norway for Norwegian tax purposes. As such, these companies are subject to taxation in Norway on their income regardless of where the income is derived. The generally applicable Norwegian income tax rate is 28.0%.
      Taxation of Norwegian Subsidiaries Engaged in Business Activities. All of our Norwegian subsidiaries are subject to normal Norwegian taxation. Generally, a Norwegian resident company is taxed on its income realized for tax purposes. The starting point for calculating taxable income is the company’s income as shown on its annual accounts, calculated under generally accepted accounting principles and as adjusted for tax purposes. Gross income will include capital gains, interest, dividends from certain corporations and foreign exchange gains.
      The Norwegian companies also are taxed on any gains resulting from the sale of depreciable assets. The gain on these assets is taken into income for Norwegian tax purposes at a rate of 20.0% per year on a declining balance basis.
      Generally, a Norwegian resident corporation is allowed to deduct all of the expenses it incurs in a tax year to the extent the expenses are incurred to earn income. A Norwegian company is allowed to deduct depreciation expense on the assets that it uses in its business on a declining balance basis. Interest incurred on liabilities of the company is deductible. However, in the case of intercompany loans this is dependent on the terms ( i.e. the interest rate and debt/equity ratio) being based on acceptable arms length principles.
      Norway does not allow consolidation of the income of companies in a corporate group for Norwegian tax purposes. However, a group of companies that is ultimately owned more than 90.0% by a single company can transfer its Norwegian taxable income to another Norwegian resident company in the group by making a transfer to the other company (this is referred to as making a “group contribution”). The ultimate parent in the corporate group can be a foreign company.
      Group contributions are deductible for the contributing company for tax purposes and are included in the taxable income of the receiving company in the income year in which the contribution is made. Group contributions are subject to the same rules as dividend distributions under the Norwegian Companies Act. In other words, group contributions are restricted to the amount that is available to distribute as dividends for corporate law purposes.
      The group contributions must be sanctioned by the contributing company’s Board of Directors and approved at the company’s General Meeting. Our Norwegian subsidiaries have made group contributions in the past. We intend to use the group contribution mechanism in the future to transfer taxable income in one company to other related Norwegian entities that have losses for Norwegian tax purposes.
      Our Norwegian subsidiaries incurred gains on the disposition of certain depreciable assets and other transactions prior to the acquisition of the subsidiaries by OPCO. The gain balances from these transactions must be included in the Norwegian taxable income of these subsidiaries on the basis of 20.0% of the remaining gain balance per year. The Norwegian companies also own ships used to transport crude oil and equipment to contain the release of volatile organic compounds from the loading of crude oil on the ships. The income generated from the operation of these assets is taxable in Norway.

145


 

      NOL’s subsidiary, TNOL, will own and operate a number of ships and will earn income from the operation and rental of these ships. TNOL will also undertake ship management activities on behalf of its related entities. However, the income from these activities is not expected to be significant.
      TNOL intends to distribute the cash generated from the operation of its ships to NOL and its other shareholders. As a result, we expect that NOL will earn significant dividend income from TNOL.
      Taxation of Controlled Foreign Corporations. Norwegian companies are also taxable on certain income earned by controlled foreign corporations (or CFC s) resident in low tax countries. A CFC for these purposes is a foreign resident company in which 50.0% or more of the shares or capital is owned or controlled by Norwegian resident companies or individuals, such as Navion Offshore Loading’s Singapore subsidiary, TNOL. Income earned by a CFC is directly included in the taxable income of its Norwegian parent. Norwegian CFC taxation is not imposed if the foreign company is resident in a low tax country with which Norway has concluded a tax treaty, unless the income that the foreign company earns is mainly of a passive nature. A country is a low tax country if the CFC’s income tax on profits is less than two-thirds of the Norwegian tax that would apply if the company were resident in Norway.
      Taxation of Foreign Companies and Permanent Establishments: Foreign registered companies are subject to Norwegian world wide taxation if the company’s place of effective management is situated in Norway ( Norwegian resident companies ). Furthermore, foreign registered companies, not resident in a country with which Norway has concluded a tax treaty, are taxable in Norway on business activities performed through a permanent establishment in Norway.
      Our Norwegian subsidiary Teekay Norway AS has entered into a management agreement with TNOL, under which Teekay Norway AS provides certain management services to TNOL. We intend to operate our non-Norwegian subsidiaries (including TNOL) and their business activities in a manner such that they should not be considered tax residents in Norway or to have a permanent establishment in Norway. Therefore, we believe that our non-Norwegian subsidiaries (including TNOL) will not be subject to Norwegian taxation.
      Taxation of Dividends. Generally, dividends received by a Norwegian resident company are exempt from Norwegian taxation. The exemption does not apply to dividends from companies resident outside the European Economic Area if (a) the country of residence is a low-tax country or (b) the ownership of shares in the distributing company is considered to be a “portfolio investment” ( i.e. less than 10.0% share ownership or less than two years continuous ownership period). Dividends not exempt from Norwegian taxation are subject to the general 28.0% income tax rate when received by the Norwegian resident company. A low-tax country is defined in the same manner as for the CFC rules (as described above).
      It is expected that TNOL will not be subject to Singapore taxation in respect of income from the operating and rental of its ships because of certain tax exemptions in Singapore. Thus, Singapore will most likely be regarded as a low-tax country, as described above, and accordingly it is expected that dividends received by NOL from TNOL would be subject to Norwegian taxation pursuant to Norwegian domestic tax law. However, pursuant to the Norway-Singapore Income Tax Convention (the Singapore Treaty ), dividends that a Norwegian company receives from a Singapore subsidiary are exempt from taxation in Norway as long as the income is not exempt from tax in Singapore for reasons that the income was not remitted to Singapore.
      We intend to operate TNOL in a manner such that it should be a tax resident of Singapore for purposes of the Singapore Treaty. We also intend to operate TNOL in a manner such that its income should not be considered to be mainly of a passive nature for the purposes of the Norwegian CFC rules. Therefore, we believe that the income earned by TNOL will not be subject to the Norwegian CFC rules (intended to tax Norwegian companies on passive income earned by its foreign subsidiaries as described above). Furthermore, we will also take the steps necessary to ensure that the income generated by TNOL will be considered to be remitted to Singapore. Consequently, we believe that NOL should not be subject to Norwegian tax on the dividend income that it receives from TNOL.

146


 

      As discussed above, various Norwegian subsidiaries will generate income from the operation of their assets that will be taxable in Norway. However, Norsk Teekay AS will generate interest deductions on its debt owed to Holdco and may therefore generate losses for Norwegian tax purposes (provided that the interest rate and the debt/equity ratio are based on arm’s-length principles, which we believe will be satisfied). We believe that by having the Norwegian subsidiaries that generate taxable income make group contributions to the extent other Norwegian subsidiaries have losses recognized for tax purposes ( e.g. Norsk Teekay AS), the Norwegian subsidiaries will not be subject to a material amount of Norwegian income tax.
      Correction Income Tax. Our Norwegian subsidiaries may be subject to a tax, called correction income tax, on their dividend distributions. Norwegian correction tax is levied if a dividend distribution leads to the company’s balance sheet equity at year end being lower than the company’s paid-in share capital (including share premium), plus a calculated amount equal to 72.0% of the net positive temporary timing differences between the company’s book values and tax values.
      As a result, correction tax is effectively levied if dividend distributions result in the company’s financial statement equity for accounting purposes being reduced below its equity calculated for tax purposes ( i.e. when dividends are paid out of accounting earnings that have not been subject to taxation in Norway). In addition to dividend distributions, correction tax may also be levied on the partial liquidation of the share capital of the company or if the company makes group contributions that are in excess of taxable income for the year.
      Taxation of Interest Paid by Norwegian Entities. Norway does not levy any tax or withholding tax on interest paid by a Norwegian resident company to a company that is not resident in Norway (provided that the interest rate and the debt/equity ratio are based on arm’s-length principles). Therefore, any interest paid by our Norwegian subsidiaries to companies that are not resident in Norway, such as interest paid by Norsk Teekay AS to Holdco, will not be subject to Norwegian withholding tax.
      Taxation on Distributions by Norwegian Entities. Norway levies a 25.0% withholding tax on non-residents of Norway that receive dividends from a Norwegian resident company. However, if the recipient of the dividend is resident in a country that has an income tax treaty with Norway or that is a member of the European Economic Area, the Norwegian withholding tax may be reduced or eliminated.
      As described above, Norsk Teekay AS is capitalized with equity from Dutchco, which owns 100.0% of the share capital of Norsk Teekay AS. According to Norwegian domestic tax law, Dutchco is exempt from Norwegian dividend withholding tax if Dutchco is a limited liability company resident for tax purposes within the European Economic Area. In addition, Dutchco will be protected from Norwegian dividend withholding tax under the Norway-Netherlands Income Tax Convention (or the Dutch Treaty ) because it owns more than 25.0% of the share capital of Norsk Teekay AS. We intend to operate Dutchco in a manner such that it should be a tax resident of the Netherlands for purposes of the tax treaty concluded between Norway and the Netherlands.
Luxembourg Taxation
      The following discussion is based upon the current tax laws of Luxembourg and regulations, the Luxembourg tax administrative practice and judicial decisions thereunder, all as in effect as of the date of this prospectus and subject to possible change on a retroactive basis. The following discussion is for general information purposes only and does not purport to be a comprehensive description of all of the Luxembourg income tax considerations applicable to us.
      As discussed above, immediately following the closing of this offering, we will own 26.0% of the partnership interests in OPCO, which will own all of the share capital of Holdco, a Marshall Islands subsidiary. Holdco will own all of the shares of Luxco, a Luxembourg company. Luxco will own all of the shares of a Netherlands company, Dutchco. Dutchco will own all of the shares of Norsk Teekay AS.
      Luxco will be primarily capitalized with a discounted loan from Holdco (the proceeds of which Luxco used to purchase shares in Norsk Teekay AS, which were immediately then contributed to Dutchco),

147


 

which should be considered compliant with the Luxembourg thin capitalization threshold, and a fixed interest loan from OPCO. Its only significant assets will be shares of Dutchco and a fixed interest loan to NOL.
      Luxco will be considered a Luxembourg resident company subject to taxation in Luxembourg on its income regardless of where the income is derived. The generally applicable Luxembourg income tax rate is approximately 30%.
      Taxation of Interest Income. Luxco’s loans to NOL will generate interest income. However, this interest income will be substantially offset by interest expense on the loan made by OPCO to Luxco. Accordingly, at Luxco’s current level of indebtedness and provided that Luxco does not bear any foreign exchange risk, Luxco should earn a minimum level of net interest income equal to 0.09375% or less of the loan balance to NOL, an immaterial amount that will be subject to taxation in Luxembourg. The net interest income generated from the loans to NOL can also, to the extent the interest due on the discounted loan from Holdco exceeds any dividend income from Dutchco during the same year, be offset by interest expense on Luxco’s discounted loan payable to Holdco. The deduction of interest expense on the discounted loan is subject to recapture in the future, as discussed below.
      Taxation of Potential Foreign Currency Exchange Net Gain. Luxco holds its accounts in euro, while the loan to NOL is denominated in NOK. Regardless whether they are realized or unrealized, foreign currency exchange gains are fully taxable in Luxembourg to the extent they are reflected in the accounts (under Luxembourg GAAP). Foreign currency exchange losses are in principle deductible from the taxable base of Luxco under the same conditions. We intend to minimize such foreign exchange exposure by having the loan from OPCO also NOK denominated and with the exact same terms and conditions (same principal amount and same effective date and maturity save for a differential in the interest rates leading to the small net interest income noted above) as the loan to NOL. Accordingly, we believe that the foreign exchange net gain on the loan from OPCO and on the loan to NOL should be minimized in Luxembourg.
      Taxation of Interest Payments. Luxembourg does not levy a withholding tax on interest paid to non-residents of Luxembourg, such as Holdco and OPCO, unless the interest represents a right to participate in profits of the interest-paying entity and the debt has certain other characteristics or the interest payment relates to the portion of debt used to acquire share capital, and the debt exceeds a Luxembourg “thin capitalization” threshold, or the interest rate is not regarded to be at arm’s length. We believe that the interest paid by Luxco on the types of loans made to it by Holdco and OPCO will not represent a right to participate in its profits and will be consistent with Luxembourg transfer pricing rules. Furthermore, we plan to capitalize Luxco to meet the “thin capitalization” threshold. Accordingly, we believe that interest payments made by Luxco to Holdco and OPCO will not be subject to Luxembourg withholding tax.
      Taxation of Dividends and Capital Gains. Pursuant to Luxembourg law, dividends received by Luxco from Dutchco and capital gains realized on any disposal of Dutchco shares generally will be exempt from Luxembourg taxation if the following requirements are met:
  •  Luxco is a capital company resident in Luxembourg and fully subject to tax in this country;
 
  •  Luxco owns more than 10% of Dutchco, or alternatively, Luxco’s acquisition price for the shares of Dutchco equals or exceeds Euro 1.2 million for purposes of the dividend exemption or Euro 6.0 million for purposes of the capital gains exemption;
 
  •  At the time of the dividend or disposal of shares, Luxco has owned the shares for at least 12 months (or, alternatively in the case of dividends, Luxco commits to hold the shares for at least 12 months and in the case of capital gains, Luxco commits to continue to hold at least 10% of the shares of Dutchco for at least 12 months); and
 
  •  Dutchco is a resident of the Netherlands for Dutch tax purposes and is covered by the European Union Parent-Subsidiary Directive.

148


 

      Luxco meets the ownership threshold and has owned the shares in Dutchco for at least 12 months. In addition, assuming that Dutchco is a resident of the Netherlands for Dutch tax purposes and is fully subject to the Dutch general corporate tax regime (even if it has subsidiaries that may be subject to special shipping regimes), we believe that Dutchco is covered by the European Union Parent-Subsidiary Directive. Therefore, we believe that any dividend received on or any capital gain resulting from the disposition of the shares of Dutchco will be exempt from taxation in Luxembourg.
      Notwithstanding this exemption, Luxembourg law does not permit the deduction of interest expense on loans used to purchase shares eligible for the dividend and capital gain exemption noted above, to the extent of the dividend received. Similarly, capital gains, although generally eligible for the exemption discussed above, are subject to Luxembourg taxation to the extent of any such related interest expense that has been deducted from Luxco’s taxable income (such as the net interest income on loans to NOL), in the year of disposal and for any previous year the shares have been held.
      We intend to operate Luxco such that it will not dispose of its Dutchco shares. Accordingly, we believe that Luxco will not be subject to Luxembourg dividend or capital gains taxation, and, even if it were, it would only be affected to the extent of the recapture of interest deductions discussed above.
      Taxation of Luxco Dividends. Luxembourg levies a 20% withholding tax on dividends paid by a Luxembourg company to a non-EU resident, absent an Income Tax Treaty, which would apply to dividends paid by Luxco to Holdco. However, we currently do not expect to cause Luxco to pay dividends, but to distribute all of its available cash through the payment of interest and principal on its loans owing to Holdco and/or OPCO. In addition, under current Luxembourg tax rules, it is possible to releverage the Luxembourg operations with new debt, which would allow a new Luxco to continue to distribute all of its available cash through payments of interest and principal on the new debt.
      Net Wealth Tax. Luxembourg companies are also subject to a net wealth tax, which normally is based on the company’s net asset value. Capital stock held by a company that qualifies for the dividend and capital gains exemption discussed above are excluded from net asset value in calculating this tax. Liabilities related to shareholdings excluded from the net wealth tax are not deductible from other assets subject to the net wealth tax. Furthermore, cash amounts held on January 1 with respect to the payments of interest or dividends to Luxco are subject to the net wealth tax. The cash balance on the last closed financial statements is generally used to determine the cash amount. Because Dutchco shares and the discounted loan from Holdco should be excluded from the net asset value according to the above, and taking into account that the loan to NOL should be offset by corresponding loan from OPCO, Luxco should be required to pay a nominal amount of Luxembourg net wealth tax.
Netherlands Taxation
      The following discussion is based upon the current tax laws of the Kingdom of the Netherlands and regulations, the Dutch tax administrative practice and judicial decisions thereunder, all as in effect as of the date of this prospectus and subject to possible change on a retroactive basis. The following discussion is for general information purposes only and does not purport to be a comprehensive description of all of the Dutch income tax considerations applicable to us.
      Dutchco will be capitalized solely with equity from Luxco. Its only significant asset will be the shares of Norsk Teekay AS, which is an intermediate holding company and is the direct or indirect parent of various operating subsidiaries in Norway and Singapore, including Teekay Norway AS, NOL and TNOL.
      Taxation of Dividends and Capital Gains. Pursuant to Dutch law, dividends received by Dutchco from Norsk Teekay AS and capital gains realized on any disposal of the shares of Norsk Teekay AS generally will be exempt from Dutch taxation (the participation exemption ) if the following conditions are met:
  •  Dutchco is a shareholder of at least 5.0% of the par value of the paid up share capital of Norsk Teekay AS;
 
  •  Norsk Teekay AS is subject to Norwegian profits tax;

149


 

  •  the shares are not held as stock in trade; and
 
  •  the shares of Norsk Teekay AS are not held as a portfolio investment.
Since Norsk Teekay AS is an intermediate holding company that fulfills a key position between the activities of its parent companies and the activities of operational subsidiaries, the shares in Norsk Teekay AS are not deemed to be held as a portfolio investment. However, shares are deemed to be held as a portfolio investment if the subsidiary is mainly involved in passive group financing. If the activities of the subsidiaries of Dutchco consist mostly (more than 50.0%) of direct or indirect financing of related entities, or the financing of business assets of those entities, including providing for the use or right to use those assets, the shares of the subsidiaries will be considered a portfolio investment.
      Dutchco meets the ownership threshold, and we currently expect that Dutchco will maintain its 100.0% ownership interest in Norsk Teekay AS for the foreseeable future. In addition, assuming that Norsk Teekay AS is a resident of Norway for Norwegian tax purposes, we expect Norsk Teekay AS to be fully subject to the Norwegian general corporate tax regime. In addition, we expect that the shares of Norsk Teekay AS will not be held as stock in trade or as a portfolio investment. Therefore, we believe that any dividend received on or any capital gain resulting from the disposition of the shares of Norsk Teekay AS should be exempt from taxation in the Netherlands.
      Capital losses on a disposition of the shares of Norsk Teekay AS will not be tax deductible.
      Taxation of Dutchco Dividends. In general, the Netherlands levies a 25.0% withholding tax on dividends paid by a Dutch company. The withholding tax is reduced to zero if the dividend is paid by Dutchco to Luxco, if Luxco meets the conditions of the European Union Parent-Subsidiary Directive. The Directive requires that Luxco hold at least 10.0% of the shares of Dutchco for at least one year before the dividend distribution. Luxco has owned the Dutchco shares for at least 12 months. We currently expect that Luxco will maintain its 100.0% ownership interest in Dutchco for the foreseeable future. Therefore, we believe that Dutch withholding tax will not apply to dividends paid by Dutchco to Luxco. In addition, Luxco should not be liable to Dutch corporate income tax with regards to the dividends received.
      2007 Tax Reform in the Netherlands. On November 28, 2006, the Dutch parliament passed the Corporate Income Tax 2007 Bill, which will become effective on January 1, 2007. This new legislation will affect the participation exemption. Under the new law, the requirements for the participation exemption will become:
  •  Dutchco must be a shareholder of at least 5.0% of the par value of the paid up share capital of Norsk Teekay AS; and
 
  •  the shares in Norsk Teekay AS must not be considered a portfolio investment in a company that is not subject to an adequate profit tax.
      Whether or not a shareholder’s interest in a company is a “portfolio investment” would be determined by the consolidated assets of that company. If the consolidated assets are predominantly free portfolio investments or consist predominantly of assets used for group financing activities, the shares would in principle be considered a portfolio investment. Accordingly, the assessment of the activities of the subsidiaries (active or passive) would remain very significant. If the “activities test” were not met, the participation exemption would not apply to that entity, unless the profits of the entity were subjected to an adequate profit tax. The taxation would be considered adequate if the profits are taxed against an effective tax rate of at least 10.0% over a taxable base determined according to Dutch standards.
Singapore Taxation
      Taxation of Singapore Companies Operating Ships in International Traffic. Immediately after the offering, we will have a subsidiary that is incorporated and tax resident in Singapore for Singapore tax purposes, TNOL. We expect that TNOL will own and operate Singapore-registered ships as well as non-Singapore-registered ships. It will earn charter income from these ships which are expected to operate in international waters outside the limits of the port of Singapore.

150


 

      Taxation of Charter Income from Singapore-Registered Ships. Pursuant to Section 13A of the Singapore Income Tax Act, an owner or operator of a Singapore-registered seagoing ship is tax exempt on qualifying income derived from the operating or chartering of such ships in international waters outside the limits of the port of Singapore. Qualifying income, for this purpose, includes the following:
        • freight income from the carriage of passengers, mails, livestock or goods;
 
        • charter-hire income; and
 
        • towage and salvage income.
      Taxation of Charter Income from Non-Singapore-Registered Ships. As TNOL expects to operate and charter out all of its Singapore-registered ships in international waters outside the limits of the port of Singapore, all of its income from the charter of its Singapore-registered ships should be exempt form Singapore tax under Section 13A of the Singapore Income Tax Act.
      In respect of the charter income that TNOL earns from its non-Singapore-registered ships, they are currently exempt from Singapore tax under a tax incentive being enjoyed by TNOL. TNOL was conferred the Singapore Approved International Shipping (or AIS ) status with effect from January 1, 2005. The AIS status was granted for an initial period of 10 years subject to a review at the end of the fifth year to ensure that TNOL has complied with the qualifying conditions of the incentive. At the end of the first 10 years, TNOL can apply for a further 10-year extension of the incentive.
      Under Section 13F of the Singapore Income Tax Act and the terms of the AIS incentive approval letter from the Maritime Port Authority of Singapore (or MPA ) dated January 26, 2006, the types of income that would qualify for tax exemption include:
        • charter hire/freight income from the operation of non-Singapore-registered vessels outside the limits of the port of Singapore;
 
        • dividends from approved shipping subsidiaries;
 
        • gains from the disposition of non-Singapore-registered ships for a period of 5 years from January 1, 2004 to December 13, 2008; and
 
        • foreign exchange, interest rate swaps and other derivative gains would be automatically regarded as tax exempt hedging gains for period of 5 years from January 1, 2004 to December 31, 2008.
      The AIS status awarded to TNOL is subject to TNOL meeting and continuing to meet the following conditions:
        • be a tax resident in Singapore;
 
        • own and operate a significant fleet of ships;
 
        • implement the business plan agreed with the MPA at the time of application of the incentive or such other modified plans as approved by the MPA;
 
        • the company’s shipping operations should be controlled and managed in Singapore;
 
        • incur directly attributable business spending in Singapore at an average of S$4 million a year or S$20 million over a 5 year period;
 
        • support and make significant use of Singapore’s trade infrastructure, such as banking, financial, business training, arbitration, and other ancillary services;
 
        • all ships chartered-in must be conducted on an arm’s-length basis;
 
        • inform the MPA of any changes to its Group shareholdings and operations;

151


 

        • keep proper books and records and submit annual audited accounts to the MPA, together with an annual audited statement comparing the actual total business spending in Singapore against the projected amount within 3 months of their completion; and
 
        • disclose such information to and permit such inspection of its premises by the Singapore Government, as required.
      TNOL intends to operate such that substantially all of its charter income will be exempt from Singapore tax under the AIS incentive. It also intends to operate and charter out all of its non-Singapore-registered ships in international waters outside the limits of the port of Singapore. On this basis, it expects that all of its income from the charter of its non-Singapore-registered ships should be exempt from Singapore tax under Section 13F of the Singapore Income Tax Act.
      Taxation of Investment Income. Any investment income earned by TNOL would be subject to the normal corporate tax rules. With respect to the interest income earned from deposits placed outside Singapore, the interest will be taxable in Singapore at the prevailing corporate tax rate (currently 20.0%) when received or deemed received in Singapore.
      Taxation of Ship Management Income. In addition to the above, since October 2006 TNOL has provided ship management services to related and third party companies. Income from such activities does not qualify for exemption under the AIS incentive. Accordingly, the income derived from these activities will be subject to tax at the prevailing corporate tax rate of 20.0%.
Australian Taxation
      The following discussion is based upon the current tax laws of Australia and regulations, the Australian tax administrative practice and judicial decisions thereunder, all as in effect as of the date of this prospectus and subject to possible change on a retroactive basis. The following discussion is for general information purposes only and does not purport to be a comprehensive description of all Australian income tax considerations applicable to us. This discussion only considers Australia income tax.
      OPCO will be treated as a company for Australian tax purposes. OPCO will be the beneficiary of a trust, not tax resident in Australia (or the non-resident trust ) which will own and operate the Karratha Spirit vessel in Australian waters.
      As a beneficiary of the non-resident trust, OPCO will be subject to Australian tax on the taxable income of the trust derived from Australian sources. Since the trust will only be operating one asset, the Karratha Spirit, it is expected that all taxable income of the trust would have an Australian source.
      Since, however, OPCO is not a resident of Australia, the trustee of the non-resident trust will be required to pay the Australian tax due, on behalf of OPCO (the non-resident beneficiary). This will be at 30.0% of the taxable income of the non-resident trust.
      OPCO will be required to file an Australian tax return disclosing the taxable income related to the trust and will receive a credit for the tax paid by the trustee. Hence, no further Australian income tax should be due by OPCO. Generally, a non-resident trust will be taxable on its income attributable to its operations in Australia calculated under generally accepted accounting principles, as adjusted for tax purposes. Gross income will include capital gains, interest and realized foreign exchange gains and losses. Non-resident trusts are subject to capital gains on the disposition of different classes of assets, including those which are used to carry on a business in Australia, and land and buildings situated in Australia. Capital gains can be offset by any capital losses incurred in the current year, in addition to any carried forward capital losses. Net capital gains generated by a non-resident trust are taxed at the general corporate rate of 30.0%.
      Generally, a non-resident trust is allowed to deduct the expenses it incurs in a taxation year, to the extent the expenses are incurred to earn the Australian sourced income. It is intended that the Australian operations of the non-resident trust will be partly financed by debt. As such, to the extent the interest

152


 

expense is allocable to the Australian sourced income it should generate interest deductions, subject to thin capitalization restrictions.
      Thin capitalization measures apply which limit the deductibility of interest expenditure incurred by non-resident trusts carrying on a business in Australia. The measures apply to the total debt of the Australian operations of multinational groups such that interest deductions are denied to the extent that borrowings exceed a safe harbor ratio or, alternatively, an arm’s length debt amount (as so calculated under the provisions of the Australian income tax legislation). Broadly, the safe harbor maximum amount of Australian debt for the Australian operations of a non-resident trust is 75.0% of the accounting book value of the assets of the Australian operation after being reduced by non-debt liabilities (calculated on an average basis).
      Taxation of Interest Paid in Respect of the Australian Operations. Australia levies withholding tax on interest paid to a non-resident where the interest relates to Australian operations. Therefore, any interest paid to non-residents will be subject to Australian withholding tax. Withholding tax is levied on payments of interest made to non residents, regardless of whether the interest deduction is allowed pursuant to other provisions of the Australian tax legislation. The withholding tax rate on interest is generally 10.0%, with the exception of certain interest payments to U.S. and U.K. resident financial institutions, whereby the rate is reduced to 0.0%.

153


 

MANAGEMENT
Management of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P.
      Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C., our general partner, will manage our operations and activities. Unitholders will not be entitled to elect the directors of our general partner or directly or indirectly participate in our management or operation.
      Our general partner owes a fiduciary duty to our unitholders. Our general partner will be liable, as general partner, for all of our debts (to the extent not paid from our assets), except for indebtedness or other obligations that are expressly non-recourse to it. Whenever possible, our general partner intends to cause us to incur indebtedness or other obligations that are non-recourse to it.
      At least three members of the board of directors of our general partner will serve on a conflicts committee to review specific matters that the board believes may involve conflicts of interest. The conflicts committee will determine if the resolution of the conflict of interest is fair and reasonable to us. The members of the conflicts committee may not be officers or employees of our general partner or directors, officers or employees of its affiliates, and must meet the independence standards established by the New York Stock Exchange to serve on an audit committee of a board of directors and certain other requirements. Any matters approved by the conflicts committee will be conclusively deemed to be fair and reasonable to us, approved by all of our partners, and not a breach by our general partner of any duties it may owe us or our unitholders. Our initial conflicts committee will be comprised of the members of our audit committee and will be appointed prior to the closing of this offering. For additional information about the conflicts committee, please read “Conflicts of Interest and Fiduciary Duties — Conflicts of Interest.”
      In addition, our general partner will have an audit committee of at least three independent directors. The audit committee will, among other things, review our external financial reporting, engage our external auditors and oversee our internal audit activities and procedures and the adequacy of our internal accounting controls. Our general partner will also have a corporate governance committee, which will oversee corporate governance matters, director compensation and the compensation plan described below.
      The New York Stock Exchange does not require a listed limited partnership like us to have a majority of independent directors on the board of directors of our general partner or to establish a compensation committee or a nominating/corporate governance committee. However, we intend to establish and maintain a corporate governance committee, as discussed above.
      The directors of our general partner oversee our operations. The day-to -day affairs of our business are managed by the officers of our general partner and key employees of certain of our controlled affiliates, including OPCO. Employees of certain subsidiaries of Teekay Shipping Corporation will provide assistance to us and OPCO (and, we expect, subsidiaries through which we intend to conduct additional operations in the future) pursuant to services agreements. Please read “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions — Advisory and Administrative Services Agreements.”
      The Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer of our general partner, Peter Evensen, will allocate his time between managing our business and affairs and the business and affairs of Teekay Shipping Corporation, Teekay GP L.L.C., the general partner of Teekay LNG Partners L.P., and Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C., our general partner. Mr. Evensen is the Executive Vice President and Chief Strategy Officer of Teekay Shipping Corporation and the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer of Teekay GP L.L.C. and of Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C. The amount of time Mr. Evensen will allocate among our business and the businesses of Teekay Shipping Corporation and Teekay GP L.L.C. will vary from time to time depending on various circumstances and needs of the businesses, such as the relative levels of strategic activities of the businesses. Mr. Evensen will devote sufficient time to our business and affairs as is necessary for their proper conduct.

154


 

      Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C., the general partner of OPCO, will manage OPCO’s operations and activities. The board of directors of Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C., our general partner, has the authority to appoint and elect the directors of Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C., who in turn appoint the officers of Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C. Some of the directors and officers of our general partner will also serve as directors or executive officers of OPCO’s general partner. Any amendment to OPCO’s partnership agreement or to the limited liability company agreement of OPCO’s general partner must be approved by the conflicts committee of the board of directors of our general partner, Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C. Other actions affecting OPCO, including, among other things, the amount of its cash reserves, must be approved by our general partner’s board of directors on our behalf. Please read “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions — OPCO Partnership Agreement and Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C. Limited Liability Company Agreement.”
      Officers of our general partner and those individuals providing services to us, OPCO or our subsidiaries may face a conflict regarding the allocation of their time between our business and the other business interests of Teekay Shipping Corporation or its affiliates. Our general partner intends to seek to cause its officers to devote as much time to the management of our business and affairs as is necessary for the proper conduct of our business and affairs.
      Whenever our general partner makes a determination or takes or declines to take an action in its individual capacity rather than in its capacity as our general partner, it is entitled to make such determination or to take or decline to take such other action free of any fiduciary duty or obligation whatsoever to us or any limited partner, and our general partner is not required to act in good faith or pursuant to any other standard imposed by our partnership agreement or under the Marshall Islands Act or any other law. Examples include the exercise of its call right, its voting rights with respect to the units it owns, its registration rights and its determination whether or not to consent to any merger or consolidation of the partnership. Actions of our general partner, which are made in its individual capacity, will be made by Teekay Shipping Corporation.
Directors and Executive Officers of Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C.
      The following table provides information about the directors and executive officers of our general partner, Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C. Directors are elected for one-year terms. The business address of each of our directors and executive officers listed below is c/o Bayside House, Bayside Executive Park, West Bay Street and Blake Road, Nassau, Commonwealth of The Bahamas. Ages of the directors are as of November 1, 2006.
             
Name   Age   Position
         
C. Sean Day
    57     Chairman
Bjorn Moller
    49     Vice Chairman
Peter Evensen
    48     Chief Executive Officer, Chief Financial Officer and Director
David L. Lemmon
    64     Director*
Carl Mikael L.L. von Mentzer
    62     Director*
John J. Peacock
    63     Director*
 
To be appointed to the board of directors prior to the closing of this offering.
      Certain biographical information about each of these individuals is set forth below.
      C. Sean Day has served as Chairman of Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C. and of Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C. since they were formed in August and September 2006, respectively. Mr. Day has served as Chairman of Teekay Shipping Corporation’s board of directors since 1999. From 1989 to 1999, he was President and Chief Executive Officer of Navios Corporation, a large bulk shipping company based in Stamford, Connecticut. Prior to this, Mr. Day held a number of senior management positions in the

155


 

shipping and finance industry. He is currently serving as a director of Kirby Corporation. Mr. Day also serves as the Chairman of Teekay GP L.L.C., the general partner of Teekay LNG Partners L.P.
      Bjorn Moller has served as the Vice Chairman of Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C. and of Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C. since they were formed in August and September 2006, respectively. Mr. Moller is the President and Chief Executive Officer of Teekay Shipping Corporation and has held those positions since April 1998. Mr. Moller has over 20 years’ experience in the shipping industry and has served in senior management positions with Teekay Shipping Corporation for more than 15 years. He has headed its overall operations since January 1997, following his promotion to the position of Chief Operating Officer. Prior to this, Mr. Moller headed Teekay Shipping Corporation’s global chartering operations and business development activities. Mr. Moller has also served as the Vice Chairman and as a director of Teekay GP L.L.C. since it was formed in November 2004.
      Peter Evensen has served as the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer and as a Director of Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C. and of Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C. since they were formed in August and September 2006, respectively. Mr. Evensen is also the Executive Vice President and Chief Strategy Officer of Teekay Shipping Corporation. He joined Teekay Shipping Corporation in May 2003 as Senior Vice President, Treasurer and Chief Financial Officer. He served as Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of Teekay Shipping Corporation from February 2004 until he was appointed to his current role in November 2006. Mr. Evensen has also served as Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer of Teekay GP L.L.C. since it was formed in November 2004 and as a director of Teekay GP L.L.C. since January 2005. Mr. Evensen has over 20 years’ experience in banking and shipping finance. Prior to joining Teekay Shipping Corporation, Mr. Evensen was Managing Director and Head of Global Shipping at J.P. Morgan Securities Inc. and worked in other senior positions for its predecessor firms. His international industry experience includes positions in New York, London and Oslo.
      David L. Lemmon has agreed to join the board of directors of Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C. prior to the closing of this offering. Mr. Lemmon currently serves on the board of directors of Kirby Corporation, a position he has held since April 2006. Mr. Lemmon was President and Chief Executive Officer of Colonial Pipeline Company from 1997 until his retirement from that company in January 2006.
      Carl Mikael L.L. von Mentzer has agreed to join the board of directors of Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C. prior to the closing of this offering. Mr. von Mentzer has over 30 years’ experience in the shipbuilding and offshore oil industries. Since 1998, Mr. von Mentzer has served as a non-executive director of Concordia Maritime AB in Gothenburg, Sweden and since 2002 has served as its Deputy Chairman of its board of directors. Prior to this, Mr. von Mentzer served in executive positions with various shipping and offshore oil companies, including Gotaverken Ardenal AB and Safe Partners AB in Gothenburg, Sweden and OAG Ltd. in Aberdeen, Scotland. He has also previously served as a non-executive director for Northern Offshore Ltd., in Oslo, Norway, and GVA Consultants in Gothenburg, Sweden.
      John J. Peacock has agreed to join the Board of Directors of Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C. prior to the closing of this offering. Mr. Peacock is currently the President and Chief Operating Officer of Fednav International Ltd., positions he has held since 1998. He also serves as Executive Vice-President and director of Fednav Limited. Mr. Peacock joined Fednav Limited in 1979 as its Treasurer, and in 1984 became Vice-President, Finance and a director of the Fednav Group of companies, a Canadian ocean-going dry-bulk shipowning and chartering group. Mr. Peacock has over 40 years’ accounting experience. Prior to joining the Fednav Group, he was a partner with Clarkson Gordon (now Ernst & Young) in Montreal, Canada. Mr. Peacock also currently serves as a director of Oceanex Inc.
Directors and Executive Officers of Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C.
      The following table provides information about the directors and executive officers of Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C., the general partner of OPCO. Directors are appointed for one-year terms. The

156


 

business address of each director and executive officer of Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C. listed below is c/o Bayside House, Bayside Executive Park, West Bay Street and Blake Road, Nassau, Commonwealth of The Bahamas. Ages of the directors are as of November 1, 2006.
             
Name   Age   Position
         
C. Sean Day
    57     Chairman
Bjorn Moller
    49     Vice Chairman
Peter Evensen
    48     Chief Executive Officer, Chief Financial Officer and Director
      As described above, the directors and executive officers of Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C. also serve as directors or executive officers of Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C. The business experience of these individuals is included above.
Reimbursement of Expenses of Our General Partner
      Our general partner will not receive any management fee or other compensation for managing us. Our general partner and its other affiliates will be reimbursed for expenses incurred on our behalf. These expenses include all expenses necessary or appropriate for the conduct of our business and allocable to us, as determined by our general partner.
Executive Compensation
      We and our general partner were formed in August 2006. OPCO’s general partner was formed in September 2006. Neither our general partner nor OPCO’s general partner has paid any compensation to its directors or officers or accrued any obligations with respect to management incentive or retirement benefits for the directors and officers prior to this offering. Because the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer of our general partner and of OPCO’s general partner, Peter Evensen, is an employee of Teekay Shipping Corporation, his compensation (other than any awards under the long-term incentive plan described below and the 2005 long-term incentive plan of Teekay LNG Partners, L.P.) is set and paid by Teekay Shipping Corporation, and we will reimburse Teekay Shipping Corporation for time he spends on our partnership matters. The corporate governance committee of the board of directors of OPCO’s general partner will establish the compensation for any key employees of OPCO. Officers and employees of our general partner, OPCO’s general partner or their respective affiliates may participate in employee benefit plans and arrangements sponsored by Teekay Shipping Corporation, our general partner or their affiliates, including plans that may be established in the future.
Compensation of Directors
      Officers of our general partner or Teekay Shipping Corporation who also serve as directors of our general partner or OPCO’s general partner will not receive additional compensation for their service as directors. Our general partner anticipates that each non-management director will receive compensation for attending meetings of the board of directors, as well as committee meetings. We expect non-management directors will receive a director fee of $30,000 per year and 700 common units subject to vesting over a three-year period. We intend to grant the common units to the non-management directors upon the closing of this offering. Members of the audit and conflicts committees each will receive a committee fee of $5,000 per year, and the chair of the audit committee is expected to receive an additional fee of $5,000 for serving in that role. In addition, each director will be reimbursed for out-of -pocket expenses in connection with attending meetings of the board of directors or committees. Each director will be fully indemnified by us for actions associated with being a director to the extent permitted under Marshall Islands law.

157


 

2006 Long-Term Incentive Plan
      Prior to the closing of this offering, our general partner intends to adopt the Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. 2006 Long-Term Incentive Plan for employees and directors of and consultants to our general partner and employees and directors of and consultants to its affiliates, who perform services for us. The plan provides for the award of restricted units, phantom units, unit options, unit appreciation rights and other unit or cash-based awards.
      Administration. The plan will be administered by the corporate governance committee of the board of directors of our general partner. To the extent permitted by law, the corporate governance committee may delegate any or all of its powers and duties under the plan to the chief executive officer of our general partner, subject to any limitations imposed by the corporate governance committee and certain other limitations imposed by the plan. The corporate governance committee will have the authority to, among other things, designate participants under the plan, determine the type or types of awards to be granted to a participant, determine the number of common units to be covered by awards, determine the terms and conditions applicable to awards and interpret and administer the plan.
      Number of Common Units. Subject to adjustment in the event of any distribution, recapitalization, split, merger, consolidation and the like, the number of common units available for delivery pursuant to awards granted under the plan is 1,000,000. There is no limit on the number of awards that may be granted and paid in cash. If any award is forfeited or otherwise terminates or is cancelled without delivery of common units, those units will again by available for grant under the plan. Common units delivered under the plan will consist of units acquired by our general partner on the open market, from us or from any other person or entity.
      Restricted Units and Phantom Units. A restricted unit is a common unit subject to forfeiture prior to the vesting of the award. A phantom unit is a notional unit that entitles the grantee to receive a common unit upon the vesting of the phantom unit or, in the discretion of the corporate governance committee, cash equivalent to the value of a common unit. The corporate governance committee may determine to make grants under the plan of restricted units and phantom units to plan participants containing such terms as the corporate governance committee may determine. The corporate governance committee will determine the period over which restricted units and phantom units granted to plan participants will vest. The committee may base its determination upon the achievement of specified performance goals. The corporate governance committee, in its discretion, may provide tandem vesting with respect to distributions on restricted units and may grant tandem distribution equivalent rights with respect to phantom units.
      Unit Options and Unit Appreciation Rights. The plan will permit the grant of options covering common units and the grant of unit appreciation rights. A unit appreciation right is an award that, upon exercise, entitles the participant to receive the excess of the fair market value of a unit on the exercise date over the base price established for the unit appreciation right. Such excess may be paid in common units, cash, or a combination thereof, as determined by the corporate governance committee in its discretion. The corporate governance committee will be able to make grants of unit options and unit appreciation rights under the plan to employees, consultants and directors containing such terms as the committee may determine. Unit options and unit appreciation rights may have an exercise price or base price that is no less than the fair market value of the common units on the date of grant. In general, unit options and unit appreciation rights granted will become exercisable over a period determined by the corporate governance committee.
      Other Unit or Cash-Based Awards. Subject to the terms of the plan and such other terms and conditions as the corporate governance committee deems appropriate, the corporate governance committee may grant other incentives payable in cash or in common units under the plan.
      Vesting, Exercisability and Payment of Options. Unless otherwise provided in the instrument evidencing an option, (a) in the event of a participant’s termination of service for any reason other than

158


 

cause, death, disability or retirement, the participant may exercise any vested options for a period of three months from the date of such termination, (b) in the event of a participant’s termination of service due to retirement or disability, the participant may exercise any vested options for a period of five years from the date of such termination and (c) in the event of a participant’s termination of service due to death, the participant’s beneficiary may exercise any vested options for a period of two years from the date of such termination. In the event a participant dies after termination of service but while the option is otherwise exercisable, the participant’s beneficiary may exercise vested stock options for a period of two years from the date of death, unless the corporate governance committee determines otherwise. If a participant is terminated for cause, his or her option will automatically expire, unless the corporate governance committee determines otherwise. In no event may an option be exercised after the expiration of the term provided in the instrument evidencing the option.
      Change of Control. Unless otherwise provided in the instrument evidencing the award, in the event of a change of control of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P., our general partner or Teekay Shipping Corporation, all outstanding awards will become fully and immediately exercisable and all applicable deferral and restriction limitations will lapse, unless the awards are converted, assumed or replaced by the successor company. Notwithstanding the foregoing, with respect to options and unit appreciation rights, the corporate governance committee may instead provide for the cash-out of such awards in connection with the change of control transaction. Also notwithstanding the foregoing, if so determined by the corporate governance committee, during the 60-day period from and after the change of control transaction, a participant holding an option or unit appreciation right will have the right to elect to surrender all or part of the option or unit appreciation right in exchange for a cash payment. If following a change of control transaction, a participant’s service is terminated for cause or good reason within 24 months of the transaction, any awards held by that participant that remain unvested will become fully and immediately exercisable, all applicable deferral and restriction limitations will lapse and an award that is an option or unit appreciation right will remain exercisable until the later of five years after the date of termination and the date the award would have expired by its terms if the participant’s service had not terminated.
      Term, Termination and Amendment of Plan. Our general partner’s board of directors, or its corporate governance committee, in its discretion may terminate, suspend or discontinue the plan at any time with respect to any award that has not yet been granted. Our general partner’s board of directors, or its corporate governance committee, also has the right to alter or amend the plan or any part of the plan from time to time, including increasing the number of common units that may be granted subject to unitholder approval as required by the exchange upon which the common units are listed at that time. However, other than adjustments to outstanding awards upon the occurrence of certain unusual or nonrecurring events, no change in any outstanding grant may be made that would materially impair the rights of the participant without the consent of the participant.

159


 

SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT
      The following table sets forth the beneficial ownership of units of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. that will be issued upon the consummation of this offering and the related transactions and held by beneficial owners of 5.0% or more of the units and by all directors (including the three independent directors to be appointed prior to the closing of this offering) and officers of our general partner as a group. The table does not reflect any common units that may be purchased in the offering through the directed unit program.
                                         
                    Percentage of
        Percentage of       Percentage of   Total Common
    Common   Common   Subordinated   Subordinated   and Subordinated
    Units to be   Units to be   Units to be   Units to be   Units to be
    Beneficially   Beneficially   Beneficially   Beneficially   Beneficially
Name of Beneficial Owner   Owned   Owned   Owned   Owned   Owned
                     
Teekay Shipping Corporation(1)(2)
    2,800,000       28.6 %     9,800,000       100.0 %     64.3 %
All directors and officers as a
group (6 persons)(3)
    *       *                   *  
 
  * Less than 1.0%
  (1)  Excludes the 2.0% general partner interest held by our general partner, a wholly owned subsidiary of Teekay Shipping Corporation.
 
  (2)  If the underwriters exercise the over-allotment option in full, Teekay Shipping Corporation’s percentage of common units to be beneficially owned will decrease to 17.9% and its percentage of total common and subordinated units to be beneficially owned will decrease to 58.9%.
 
  (3)  Excludes units owned by Teekay Shipping Corporation, on the board of which serve the directors of our general partner, C. Sean Day and Bjorn Moller. In addition, Mr. Moller is Teekay Shipping Corporation’s President and Chief Executive Officer, and Peter Evensen, our general partner’s Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer and a Director, is Teekay Shipping Corporation’s Executive Vice President and Chief Strategy Officer. Please read “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions — Directors and Officers of Our General Partner.”

160


 

CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS
      After this offering, Teekay Shipping Corporation, the owner of our general partner, will own 2,800,000 common units and 9,800,000 subordinated units, representing a 63.0% limited partner interest in us (57.8% if the underwriters exercise their over-allotment option in full). In addition, our general partner will own a 2.0% general partner interest in us and all of the incentive distribution rights.
Distributions and Payments to Our General Partner and its Affiliates
      The following table summarizes the distributions and payments to be made by us to our general partner and its affiliates in connection with our formation, ongoing operation and any liquidation. These distributions and payments were determined by and among affiliated entities and, consequently, are not the result of arms’-length negotiations.
Formation Stage
The consideration received by our general partner and its affiliates for the contribution to us of a 26.0% interest in OPCO (consisting of the 0.01% general partner interest and a 25.99% limited partner interest), such contribution to occur at or prior to the closing of this offering • 2,800,000 common units;

• 9,800,000 subordinated units;
 
• 2.0% general partner interest in us;
 
• the incentive distribution rights; and
 
• the net proceeds from this offering, as described in “Use of Proceeds.”
 
Please read “Summary — The Transactions” for further information about our formation and assets contributed to us in connection with the closing of this offering.
 
The common units and subordinated units owned by Teekay Shipping Corporation represent a 63.0% limited partner interest in us, which gives it the ability to control the outcome of unitholder votes on certain matters. For more information, please read “The Partnership Agreement — Voting Rights” and “— Amendment of the Partnership Agreement.”
Operational Stage
Distributions of available cash to our general partner and its affiliates We will generally make cash distributions 98.0% to unitholders (including Teekay Shipping Corporation, the owner of our general partner and the holder of 2,800,000 common units and 9,800,000 subordinated units) and the remaining 2.0% to our general partner.
 
In addition, if distributions exceed the minimum quarterly distribution and other higher target levels, our general partner, as the holder of the incentive distribution rights, will be entitled to increasing percentages of the distributions, up to 50.0%

161


 

(including distributions on the 2.0% general partner interest) of the distributions above the highest target level. We refer to the rights to the increasing distributions as “incentive distribution rights.” Please read “How We Make Cash Distributions — Incentive Distribution Rights” for more information about the incentive distribution rights.
 
Assuming we have sufficient available cash to pay the full minimum quarterly distribution on all of our outstanding units for four quarters, but no distributions in excess of the full minimum quarterly distribution, our general partner would receive an annual distribution of approximately $0.6 million on its 2.0% general partner interest and Teekay Shipping Corporation would receive an annual distribution of approximately $18.2 million on its common units and subordinated units.
 
Payments to our general partner and its affiliates Our general partner will not receive a management fee or other compensation for the management of our partnership. Our general partner and its affiliates will be entitled to reimbursement for all direct and indirect expenses they incur on our behalf. In addition, we and OPCO will (and any of our future operating subsidiaries may) pay fees to certain subsidiaries of Teekay Shipping Corporation for administrative services and OPCO’s operating subsidiaries will pay fees to certain subsidiaries of Teekay Shipping Corporation for strategic consulting, advisory, ship management, technical and administrative services. Please read “— Omnibus Agreement” and “— Advisory and Administrative Services Agreements” below.
 
Withdrawal or removal of our general partner If our general partner withdraws or is removed, its general partner interest and its incentive distribution rights will either be sold to the new general partner for cash or converted into common units, in each case for an amount equal to the fair market value of those interests. Please read “The Partnership Agreement — Withdrawal or Removal of the General Partner.”

Liquidation Stage
Liquidation Upon our liquidation, the partners, including our general partner, will be entitled to receive liquidating distributions as described in “The Partnership Agreement — Liquidation and Distribution of Proceeds.”
Agreements Governing the Transactions
      We have entered into or will enter into various documents and agreements that will effect the transactions relating to our formation and this offering, including our acquisition of interests in OPCO, the vesting of assets in, and the assumption of liabilities by, us and OPCO and the application of the proceeds of this offering. These agreements will not be the result of arms’-length negotiations and they, or any of the transactions that they provide for, may not be effected on terms at least as favorable to us as they

162


 

could have been obtained from unaffiliated third parties. All of the transaction expenses incurred in connection with these transactions will be paid from the proceeds of this offering.
Omnibus Agreement
      At the closing of this offering, we will enter into an omnibus agreement with our general partner, Teekay Shipping Corporation and Teekay LNG Partners L.P. and its general partner, Teekay GP L.L.C. The following discussion describes provisions of the omnibus agreement.
Noncompetition
      Under the omnibus agreement, each of Teekay Shipping Corporation and Teekay LNG Partners L.P. will agree, and will cause their respective controlled affiliates other than us to agree, not to engage in, acquire or invest in any business that owns, operates or charters (a) dynamically-positioned shuttle tankers (other than those operating in the conventional oil tanker trade under contracts with a remaining duration of less than three years, excluding extension options), (b) FSO units or (c) FPSO units (collectively offshore vessels ). This restriction will not apply to any tankers that Teekay LNG Partners L.P. currently owns, operates or maintains that may be subsequently converted to offshore vessels. The restriction will also not prevent Teekay Shipping Corporation, Teekay LNG Partners L.P. or any of their respective controlled affiliates from:
  •  owning, operating or chartering offshore vessels if the remaining duration of the time charter or contract of affreightment for the vessel, excluding any extension options, is less than three years;
 
  •  owning, operating or chartering offshore vessels and related time charters or contracts of affreightment acquired as part of a business or package of assets if a majority of the value of the total assets or business acquired is not attributable to the offshore vessels and related time charters and contracts of affreightment, as determined in good faith by Teekay Shipping Corporation’s board of directors or the conflicts committee of the board of directors of Teekay LNG Partners L.P.’s general partner, as applicable; however, if at any time Teekay Shipping Corporation or Teekay LNG Partners L.P. completes such an acquisition, it must, within 365 days of the closing of the transaction, offer to sell the offshore vessels and related time charters and contracts of affreightment to us for their fair market value plus any additional tax or other similar costs to Teekay Shipping Corporation or Teekay LNG Partners L.P. that would be required to transfer the offshore vessels and related time charters and contracts of affreightment to us separately from the acquired business or package of assets;
 
  •  owning, operating or chartering offshore vessels and related time charters and contracts of affreightment that relate to a tender, bid or award for a proposed offshore project that Teekay Shipping Corporation has submitted or received or hereafter submits or receives; however, at least 365 days after the delivery date of any such offshore vessel, Teekay Shipping Corporation must offer to sell the vessel and related time charter or contract of affreightment to us, with the vessel valued (a) for newbuildings originally contracted by Teekay Shipping Corporation, at its “fully -built-up cost” (which represents the aggregate expenditures incurred (or to be incurred prior to delivery to us) by Teekay Shipping Corporation to acquire, construct and/or convert and bring such offshore vessel to the condition and location necessary for our intended use, plus project development costs for completed projects and projects that were not completed but, if completed, would have been subject to an offer to us) and (b) for any other vessels, Teekay Shipping Corporation’s cost to acquire a newbuilding from a third party or the fair market value of an existing vessel, as applicable, plus in each case any subsequent expenditures that would be included in the “fully -built-up cost” of converting the vessel prior to delivery to us;
 
  •  owning, operating or chartering offshore vessels subject to the offers to us described in the immediately preceding two paragraphs pending our general partner’s determination whether to accept such offers and pending the closing of any offers we accept;

163


 

  •  owning, operating or chartering offshore vessels and related time charters and contracts of affreightment if our general partner has previously advised Teekay Shipping Corporation or Teekay LNG Partners L.P. that our general partner’s board of directors has elected, with the approval of its conflicts committee, not to cause us or our controlled affiliates to acquire the vessels and related time charters and contracts of affreightment;
 
  •  acquiring up to a 9.9% equity ownership, voting or profit participation interest in any publicly-traded company that engages in, acquires or invests in any business that owns, operates or charters offshore vessels and related time charters or contracts of affreightment;
 
  •  owning a limited partner interest in OPCO or owning shares of Petrojarl; or
 
  •  providing ship management services relating to owning, operating or chartering offshore vessels and related time charters or contracts of affreightment.
      If Teekay Shipping Corporation or Teekay LNG Partners L.P. or any of their respective affiliates owns, operates or charters offshore vessels pursuant to any of the exceptions described above, no such entity may subsequently expand that portion of its business other than pursuant to those exceptions.
      In addition to the exceptions described above, unless Teekay Shipping Corporation acquires 100% of Petrojarl ASA, Petrojarl may continue to own, operate and charter its current fleet. If Teekay Shipping Corporation acquires 100% of Petrojarl ASA, we would have certain rights to acquire Petrojarl’s fleet, as described below under “— Rights of First Offer on Shuttle Tankers, FSO Units, FPSO Units, Conventional Oil Tankers and LNG Carriers.”
      Under the omnibus agreement we will agree, and will cause our controlled affiliates to agree, not to own, operate or charter conventional crude oil tankers. This restriction will not:
  •  apply to any conventional crude oil tankers owned, operated or chartered by us or any of our controlled affiliates as of the closing of this offering, or the ownership, operation or chartering of any conventional crude oil tankers that replace any of those oil tankers (or Replacement Oil Tankers ) in connection with:
  l   the destruction or total loss of the original tanker; the tanker being damaged to an extent that makes repairing it uneconomical or renders it permanently unfit for normal use, as determined in good faith by our general partner within 90 days after the occurrence of the damage; or the tanker’s condemnation, confiscation, requisition or a similar taking of title to or use of it that continues for at least six months; or
 
  l   the replacement of a time charter existing on the closing of this offering, where the tanker that was subject to the charter has been sold or transferred due to the exercise by the customer of its right under the charter to cause the sale or transfer;
  •  prevent us or any of our controlled affiliates from:
  l   owning, operating or chartering conventional crude oil tankers and any related time charters acquired as part of a business or package of assets, if a majority of the value of the total assets or business acquired is not attributable to the crude oil tankers and any related charters, as determined in good faith by the conflicts committee of our general partner’s board of directors; however, if at any time we complete such an acquisition we must, within 30 days of the closing of the acquisition, offer to sell the oil tankers and time charters to Teekay Shipping Corporation for fair market value plus any additional tax or other similar costs to us that would be required to transfer the oil tankers and time charters to Teekay Shipping Corporation separately from the acquired business or package of assets;
 
  l   owning, operating or chartering conventional crude oil tankers and related charters subject to the offer to Teekay Shipping Corporation described in the preceding paragraph pending its determination whether to accept such offer and pending the closing of any offer it accepts;

164


 

  l   acquiring up to a 9.9% equity ownership, voting or profit participation interest in any publicly traded company that engages in, acquires or invests in any business that owns, operates or charters conventional crude oil tankers and related charters;
 
  l   owning, operating or chartering conventional crude oil tankers and related charters if Teekay Shipping Corporation has previously advised our general partner that it has elected not to acquire those tankers; or
 
  l   operating our shuttle tankers in conventional crude oil tanker trades under contracts with a duration of less than three years.
      If we or any of our controlled affiliates owns, operates or charters conventional crude oil tankers and related charters pursuant to any of the exceptions described above, neither we nor such affiliate may subsequently expand that portion of our or its business other than pursuant to those exceptions.
      In addition, under the omnibus agreement, we will agree, and will cause our controlled affiliates to agree, not to engage in, acquire or invest in any business that owns, operates or charters LNG carriers and related time charters, subject to certain exceptions.
      If Teekay Shipping Corporation or its affiliates no longer control our general partner or the general partner of Teekay LNG Partners L.P. or there is a change of control of Teekay Shipping Corporation, our general partner, the general partner of Teekay LNG Partners L.P. or Teekay Shipping Corporation, respectively, may terminate the relevant noncompetition provisions of the omnibus agreement.
Rights of First Offer on Shuttle Tankers, FSO Units, FPSO Units, Conventional Oil Tankers and LNG Carriers
      Under the omnibus agreement, Teekay Shipping Corporation and Teekay LNG Partners L.P. will grant (and will cause their respective controlled affiliates other than us to grant) to us a 30-day right of first offer on any proposed (a) sale, transfer or other disposition of any offshore vessels that, at the time of the proposed sale, transfer or other disposition, is subject to a time charter or contract of affreightment with a remaining term, excluding extension options, of at least three years or (b) chartering-out after the closing of this offering of any offshore vessel pursuant to a time charter or contract of affreightment with a term, excluding extension options, of at least three years. For any such proposed chartering-out by Teekay Shipping Corporation (or any of its controlled affiliates other than us or Petrojarl ASA), Teekay Shipping Corporation will also grant to us an alternative right to purchase the applicable vessel for its fair market value. We will grant similar rights of first offer (other than the purchase right in connection with a chartering) to Teekay Shipping Corporation for any conventional crude oil tankers and to Teekay LNG Partners L.P. for any LNG carriers we or OPCO own or might acquire or charter. Teekay Shipping Corporation and Teekay LNG Partners will provide to and receive from one another rights similar to those relating to us, but with respect to LNG carriers for Teekay LNG Partners L.P. The rights of first offer under the omnibus agreement will not apply to (a) a sale, transfer or other disposition of vessels between any controlled affiliates or pursuant to the terms of any charter, contract of affreightment or other agreement with a charter party or the party to the contract of affreightment or (b) the re-chartering of any Replacement Oil Tanker to another charter party that is not an affiliate of the existing charter party.
      We will also have the right to purchase, for fair market value, Petrojarl ASA’s existing offshore vessels and any of its joint venture interests (in each case to the extent involving an offshore vessel subject to a time charter or contract of affreightment with a remaining term of at least three years, excluding extension options) if Teekay Shipping Corporation acquires 100% of Petrojarl ASA. Petrojarl ASA has four FPSOs and one shuttle tanker, with only two of the FPSOs currently subject to contracts with a term exceeding three years. Although Teekay Shipping Corporation has an interest in acquiring 100% of Petrojarl ASA, it may choose not to do so, and a purchase would be contingent on the minority holders’ agreement to sell.

165


 

      Prior to engaging in any negotiation regarding any vessel disposition or chartering with a non-affiliated third-party, the applicable party will deliver a written notice setting forth the material terms and conditions of the proposed transaction. During the 30-day period after the delivery of such notice, the relevant parties will negotiate in good faith to reach an agreement on the transaction. If the parties do not reach an agreement within such 30-day period, they will be able within the next 180 days to sell, transfer, dispose or charter the vessel to a third party (or to agree in writing to undertake such transaction with a third party) on terms generally no less favorable to us, Teekay Shipping Corporation or Teekay LNG Partners L.P., as the case may be, than those offered pursuant to the written notice.
      If Teekay Shipping Corporation or its affiliates no longer control our general partner or the general partner of Teekay LNG Partners L.P. or there is a change of control of Teekay Shipping Corporation, our general partner, the general partner of Teekay LNG Partners L.P. or Teekay Shipping Corporation, respectively, may terminate the relevant rights of first offer provisions of the omnibus agreement.
Indemnification
      Under the omnibus agreement, Teekay Shipping Corporation will indemnify us after the closing of this offering for a period of five years against certain environmental and toxic tort liabilities to the extent arising prior to the closing date of this offering and relating to OPCO’s assets and liabilities as of the closing of this offering. Liabilities resulting from a change in law after the closing of this offering are excluded from the environmental indemnity. There is an aggregate cap of $10.0 million on the amount of the indemnity provided by Teekay Shipping Corporation for these environmental and toxic tort liabilities. No claim may be made unless the aggregate dollar amount of all claims exceeds $500,000, in which case Teekay Shipping Corporation is liable for claims only to the extent such aggregate amount exceeds $500,000.
      Teekay Shipping Corporation will also indemnify us for liabilities related to:
  •  certain defects in title to OPCO’s assets as of the closing of this offering and any failure to obtain, prior to the closing of this offering, certain consents and permits necessary to own and operate such assets, to the extent we notify Teekay Shipping Corporation within three years after the closing of this offering; and
 
  •  tax liabilities attributable to the operation of OPCO’s assets prior to the closing of this offering.
Amendments
      The omnibus agreement may not be amended without the prior approval of the conflicts committee of the board of directors of our general partner if the proposed amendment will, in the reasonable discretion of our general partner, adversely affect holders of our common units.
OPCO Partnership Agreement and Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C. Limited Liability Company Agreement
      We, on behalf of Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C. as its sole owner, and Teekay Shipping Corporation have entered into an agreement of limited partnership for OPCO. This agreement governs the ownership and management of OPCO, designates Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C. as the general partner of OPCO, and provides for quarterly distributions of available cash to the limited and general partner, as determined by us as sole member of the general partner of OPCO.
      OPCO’s partnership agreement provides that the amount of cash reserves for future maintenance capital expenditures, working capital and other matters and the amount of quarterly cash distributions to OPCO’s partners will be determined by us as the sole member of Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C. Effectively, this decision will be made by the board of directors of our general partner. This approval is also required for the following actions relating to OPCO:
  •  effecting any merger or consolidation involving OPCO;
 
  •  effecting any sale or exchange of all or substantially all of OPCO’s assets;

166


 

  •  dissolving or liquidating OPCO;
 
  •  creating or causing to exist any consensual restriction on the ability of OPCO or its subsidiaries to make distributions, pay any indebtedness, make loans or advances or transfer assets to us or our subsidiaries;
 
  •  settling or compromising any claim, dispute or litigation directly against, or otherwise relating to indemnification by OPCO of, any of the directors or officers of Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C.; or
 
  •  issuing additional partnership interests in OPCO.
      Approval of the conflicts committee of our general partner’s board of directors will be required to amend OPCO’s partnership agreement or its general partner’s limited liability company agreement.
Advisory and Administrative Services Agreements
Administrative Services Agreements With Teekay Shipping Limited
      At the closing of this offering, we and OPCO will each enter into services agreements with Teekay Shipping Limited, a Bahamian corporation and wholly owned subsidiary of Teekay Shipping Corporation, pursuant to which Teekay Shipping Limited will provide to us and OPCO all of our and its needs for non-strategic administrative services, unless the provision of those services by Teekay Shipping Limited would materially interfere with Teekay Shipping Corporation’s operations. These services will be provided in a commercially reasonably manner and upon the reasonable request of our general partner or the general partner of OPCO, as applicable. Teekay Shipping Limited will provide these services to us or OPCO directly but may subcontract for certain of these services with other entities, including other Teekay Shipping Corporation subsidiaries. We and OPCO will pay a reasonable, arms’-length fee to Teekay Shipping Limited for such services in U.S. Dollars that will include reimbursement of the reasonable cost of any direct and indirect expenses it incurs in providing these services. We and OPCO will indemnify Teekay Shipping Limited for losses it incurs in connection with providing the services, excluding losses caused by the gross negligence or willful misconduct of Teekay Shipping Limited or its employees or agents. The services will include:
  •  legal, investor relations and financial compliance services;
 
  •  bookkeeping and accounting services; and
 
  •  banking and finance services.
      To the extent we establish wholly owned subsidiaries through which we conduct additional operations in the future, we anticipate that they will enter into similar contracts with Teekay Shipping Limited.
Advisory, Technical and Administrative Services Agreements Between OPCO’s Subsidiaries and Teekay Shipping Limited
      Each of OPCO’s operating subsidiaries will enter into an Advisory, Technical and Administrative Services Agreement with Teekay Shipping Limited, pursuant to which Teekay Shipping Limited will provide advisory, technical and administrative services. These services will be provided in a commercially reasonably manner and upon the reasonable request of the operating subsidiaries. Teekay Shipping Limited will provide these services directly but may subcontract for certain of these services with other entities, including other Teekay Shipping Corporation subsidiaries. Each operating subsidiary will pay a reasonable, arms’-length fee in U.S. Dollars to Teekay Shipping Limited that will include reimbursement of the reasonable cost of any direct and indirect expenses it incurs in providing these services, which include services such as:
  •  vessel maintenance;
 
  •  crewing;

167


 

  •  purchasing;
 
  •  shipyard supervision;
 
  •  insurance;
 
  •  financial services;
 
  •  strategic planning;
 
  •  integration of any acquired businesses; and
 
  •  client relations.
      Under these services agreements, OPCO’s operating subsidiaries will pay all vessel operating expenses in U.S. Dollars and will not be subject to currency exchange fluctuations prior to 2009. Beginning in 2009, payments under the agreements of vessel operating expenses will adjust to reflect any change in Teekay Shipping Corporation’s cost of providing services based on currency exchange fluctuations.
      To the extent we establish wholly owned subsidiaries through which we conduct additional operations in the future, we anticipate that they will enter into similar contracts with Teekay Shipping Limited.
      Prior to this offering, OPCO generally fulfilled the managerial, operational and administrative needs of its operating subsidiaries, but relied upon affiliates of Teekay Shipping Corporation to provide technical services. Following this offering, OPCO’s operating subsidiaries will provide technical and voyage management services for their conventional Aframax tankers, but rely on Teekay Shipping Limited for substantially all other services.
Aframax Tanker Time-Charter Contracts With Teekay Shipping Corporation
      On October 1, 2006, OPCO chartered to Teekay Shipping Corporation its nine conventional Aframax tankers under long-term, fixed-rate contracts. The terms of the time-charter contracts range from approximately 5 to 12 years, with an average term of approximately 8 years. Each contract includes five, one-year term extensions, which are exercisable by Teekay Shipping Corporation. We believe that the time-charter rates, which will adjust for inflation, reflect market rates as of the date of the time-charter contracts. Annual payments to OPCO under the time charters initially are approximately $89 million for all nine contracts. At any time after September 30, 2009 during the term of the time-charter contracts, Teekay Shipping Corporation may elect to purchase any of the tankers for the applicable price set forth in the contracts. These purchase prices initially range from $31 million to $62 million, and decrease over time based on vessel depreciation. We believe that these charter rates and purchase prices approximate current fair market values. Please read “Business — Fleet — Conventional Tankers” and “Business — Vessel Contracts — Time Charters and Bareboat Charters.”
Joint Venture with Petrojarl ASA
      In June 2006, Teekay Shipping Corporation and Petrojarl ASA, an independent operator in the FPSO sector, entered into an agreement to form, as equal partners, a joint venture company called Teekay Petrojarl Offshore that will focus on pursuing new opportunities involving FPSO units, FSO units and other mobile oil production solutions. Each partner has agreed to pursue all such projects exclusively through the joint venture, other than projects existing at the time of the agreement or redeployment opportunities for then-existing FPSO units and FSO units, including all current FSO units in OPCO. Either party may pursue, alone or with third parties, any projects the other partner declines for the joint venture to pursue. The joint venture partners will share cash flow of the joint venture in proportion to their relative capital contributions and each partner will have equal voting power on a four-person governing board. Pursuant to the omnibus agreement described above, Teekay Shipping Corporation will offer to Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. its interest in certain FPSO projects under the joint venture agreement. On October 18, 2006, Teekay Shipping Corporation completed a tender offer for the outstanding shares of

168


 

Petrojarl ASA, resulting in Teekay Shipping Corporation owning a majority of, and having the ability to control, Petrojarl ASA.
Directors and Officers of Our General Partner
      C. Sean Day is the Chairman of our general partner, Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C., and of Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C., the general partner of OPCO. He also is the Chairman of Teekay Shipping Corporation and Teekay GP L.L.C., the general partner of Teekay LNG Partners L.P., a publicly-held partnership controlled by Teekay Shipping Corporation. His consulting company provides services primarily to affiliates of Teekay Shipping Corporation.
      Bjorn Moller is the Vice Chairman of Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C., Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C. and Teekay GP L.L.C. He also is the President and Chief Executive Officer and a director of Teekay Shipping Corporation.
      Peter Evensen is the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer and a director of Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C., Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C. and Teekay GP L.L.C. He also is the Executive Vice President and Chief Strategy Officer of Teekay Shipping Corporation.
Other Transactions Relating to OPCO
      Please read Notes 1 and 11 (audited combined consolidated financial statements) and Notes 1 and 10 (unaudited combined consolidated financial statements) to the Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor’s combined consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this prospectus for a description of certain transactions involving OPCO and Teekay Shipping Corporation or its other subsidiaries prior to the closing of this offering.

169


 

CONFLICTS OF INTEREST AND FIDUCIARY DUTIES
Conflicts of Interest
      Conflicts of interest exist and may arise in the future as a result of the relationships between our general partner and its affiliates, including Teekay Shipping Corporation, on the one hand, and us and our unaffiliated limited partners, on the other hand. The directors and officers of our general partner, Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C., have certain fiduciary duties to manage our general partner in a manner beneficial to its owner, Teekay Shipping Corporation. At the same time, our general partner has a fiduciary duty to manage us in a manner beneficial to us and our unitholders. Teekay Shipping Corporation has the authority to appoint our general partner’s directors, who in turn appoint our general partner’s officers.
      The directors and officers of OPCO’s general partner have fiduciary duties to manage OPCO in a manner beneficial to us, as such general partner’s owner. At the same time, OPCO’s general partner has a fiduciary duty to manage OPCO in a manner beneficial to OPCO’s limited partners, including Teekay Shipping Corporation. The board of directors of our general partner will resolve any such conflict and has broad latitude to consider the interests of all parties to the conflict. The resolution of these conflicts may not always be in the best interest of us or our unitholders. Our general partner’s board of directors will appoint the directors of OPCO’s general partner, who will appoint the officers of OPCO’s general partner. The Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer of our general partner and all of its non-independent directors also serve as executive officers or directors of OPCO’s general partner and of Teekay Shipping Corporation.
      Our partnership affairs are governed by our partnership agreement and the Marshall Islands Act. The provisions of the Marshall Islands Act resemble provisions of the limited partnership laws of a number of states in the United States, most notably Delaware. We are not aware of any material difference in unitholder rights between the Marshall Islands Act and the Delaware Revised Uniform Limited Partnership Act. The Marshall Islands Act also provides that it is to be applied and construed to make it uniform with the Delaware Revised Uniform Limited Partnership Act and, so long as it does not conflict with the Marshall Island Act or decisions of the Marshall Islands courts, interpreted according to the non-statutory law (or “ case law ”) of the courts of the State of Delaware. There have been, however, few, if any, court cases in the Marshall Islands interpreting the Marshall Islands Act, in contrast to Delaware, which has a fairly well-developed body of case law interpreting its limited partnership statute. Accordingly, we cannot predict whether Marshall Islands courts would reach the same conclusions as courts in Delaware. For example, the rights of our unitholders and fiduciary responsibilities of our general partner under Marshall Islands law are not as clearly established as under judicial precedent in existence in Delaware. Due to the less developed nature of Marshall Islands law, our public unitholders may have more difficulty in protecting their interests in the face of actions by our general partner or controlling unitholders than would unitholders of a limited partnership organized in the United States.
      Whenever a conflict arises between our general partner or its affiliates, on the one hand, and us or any other partner, on the other, our general partner will resolve that conflict. Our partnership agreement contains provisions that modify and limit our general partner’s fiduciary duties to the unitholders under Marshall Islands law. Our partnership agreement also restricts the remedies available to unitholders for actions taken by our general partner that, without those limitations, might constitute breaches of fiduciary duties.
      Our general partner will not be in breach of its obligations under the partnership agreement or its duties to us or the unitholders if the resolution of the conflict is:
  •  approved by the conflicts committee, although our general partner is not obligated to seek such approval;
 
  •  approved by the vote of a majority of the outstanding common units, excluding any common units owned by our general partner or any of its affiliates, although our general partner is not obligated to seek such approval;

170


 

  •  on terms no less favorable to us than those generally being provided to or available from unrelated third parties, but our general partner is not required to obtain confirmation to such effect from an independent third party; or
 
  •  “fair and reasonable” to us, taking into account the totality of the relationships between the parties involved, including other transactions that may be particularly favorable or advantageous to us.
      Our general partner may, but is not required to, seek the approval of such resolution from the conflicts committee of the board of directors of our general partner or from the common unitholders, except that OPCO’s partnership agreement requires conflicts committee approval to amend either OPCO’s partnership agreement or the limited liability company agreement of OPCO’s general partner. If our general partner does not seek approval from the conflicts committee (other than for, and only with respect to, amendments to OPCO’s and OPCO’s general partner’s agreements), and the board of directors of our general partner determines that the resolution or course of action taken with respect to the conflict of interest satisfies either of the standards set forth in the third and fourth bullet points above, then it will be presumed that, in making its decision, the board of directors, including the board members affected by the conflict, acted in good faith, and in any proceeding brought by or on behalf of any limited partner or the partnership, the person bringing or prosecuting such proceeding will have the burden of overcoming such presumption. Unless the resolution of a conflict is specifically provided for in our partnership agreement, our general partner or the conflicts committee may consider any factors it determines in good faith to consider when resolving a conflict. When our partnership agreement requires someone to act in good faith, it requires that person to reasonably believe that he is acting in the best interests of the partnership, unless the context otherwise requires. Please read “Management — Management of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P.” for information about the composition and formation of the conflicts committee of the board of directors of our general partner.
      Conflicts of interest could arise in the situations described below, among others.
Actions taken by our general partner may affect the amount of cash available for distribution to unitholders or accelerate the right to convert subordinated units.
      The amount of cash that is available for distribution to unitholders is affected by decisions of our general partner regarding such matters as:
  •  the amount and timing of asset purchases and sales;
 
  •  cash expenditures;
 
  •  borrowings;
 
  •  the issuance of additional units; and
 
  •  the creation, reduction or increase of reserves in any quarter.
      In addition, borrowings by us and our affiliates do not constitute a breach of any duty owed by our general partner to our unitholders, including borrowings that have the purpose or effect of:
  •  enabling our general partner or its affiliates to receive distributions on any subordinated units held by them or the incentive distribution rights; or
 
  •  hastening the expiration of the subordination period.
      For example, in the event we have not generated sufficient cash from our operations to pay the minimum quarterly distribution on our common units and our subordinated units, our partnership agreement permits us to borrow funds, which would enable us to make this distribution on all outstanding units. Please read “How We Make Cash Distributions — Subordination Period.”
      Our partnership agreement provides that we and our subsidiaries may borrow funds from our general partner and its affiliates. Our general partner and its affiliates may not borrow funds from us, OPCO, or our or its respective operating subsidiaries.

171


 

Neither our partnership agreement nor any other agreement requires Teekay Shipping Corporation to pursue a business strategy that favors us or utilizes our assets or dictates what markets to pursue or grow. Teekay Shipping Corporation’s directors and officers have a fiduciary duty to make these decisions in the best interests of the stockholders of Teekay Shipping Corporation, which may be contrary to our interests.
      Because officers and the directors of our general partner are also directors and officers of Teekay Shipping Corporation, such directors and officers have fiduciary duties to Teekay Shipping Corporation that may cause them to pursue business strategies that disproportionately benefit Teekay Shipping Corporation or which otherwise are not in the best interests of us or our unitholders.
Our general partner is allowed to take into account the interests of parties other than us, such as Teekay Shipping Corporation, in resolving conflicts of interest.
      Our partnership agreement contains provisions that reduce the standards to which our general partner would otherwise be held by Marshall Islands fiduciary duty law. For example, our partnership agreement permits our general partner to make a number of decisions in its individual capacity, as opposed to in its capacity as our general partner. This entitles our general partner to consider only the interests and factors that it desires, and it has no duty or obligation to give any consideration to any interest of or factors affecting us, our affiliates or any unitholder. Decisions made by our general partner in its individual capacity will be made by its sole owner, Teekay Shipping Corporation, and not by the board of directors of our general partner. Examples include the exercise of its limited call right, its voting rights with respect to the units it owns, its registration rights and its determination whether to consent to any merger or consolidation involving us.
We do not have any officers and rely solely on officers of Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C.
      Affiliates of our general partner, Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C., conduct businesses and activities of their own in which we have no economic interest. If these separate activities are significantly greater than our activities, there could be material competition for the time and effort of the officers who provide services to Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C. and its affiliates. The officers of Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C. are not required to work full-time on our affairs. These officers are required to devote time to the affairs of Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C. or its affiliates, and we reimburse their employers for the services they render to Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C. and us. None of the officers of our general partner are employees of our general partner. Our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer is also an executive officer of Teekay Shipping Corporation and the general partner of Teekay LNG Partners LP.
We will reimburse our general partner and its affiliates for expenses.
      We will reimburse our general partner and its affiliates for costs incurred in managing and operating us, including costs incurred in rendering corporate staff and support services to us. Our partnership agreement provides that our general partner will determine the expenses that are allocable to us in good faith. Please read “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions” and “Management — Reimbursement of Expenses of Our General Partner.”
Our general partner intends to limit its liability regarding our obligations.
      Our general partner intends to limit its liability under contractual arrangements so that the other party has recourse only to our assets and not against our general partner or its assets or any affiliate of our general partner or its assets. Our partnership agreement provides that any action taken by our general partner to limit its or our liability is not a breach of our general partner’s fiduciary duties, even if we could have obtained terms that are more favorable without the limitation on liability.

172


 

Common unitholders will have no right to enforce obligations of our general partner and its affiliates under agreements with us.
      Any agreements between us, on the one hand, and our general partner and its affiliates, on the other, will not grant to the unitholders, separate and apart from us, the right to enforce the obligations of our general partner and its affiliates in our favor.
Contracts between us, on the one hand, and our general partner and its affiliates, on the other, will not be the result of arms’-length negotiations.
      Neither our partnership agreement nor any of the other agreements, contracts and arrangements between us and our general partner and its affiliates are or will be the result of arms’-length negotiations. Our partnership agreement generally provides that any affiliated transaction, such as an agreement, contract or arrangement between us and our general partner and its affiliates, must be:
  •  on terms no less favorable to us then those generally being provided to or available from unrelated third parties; or
 
  •  “fair and reasonable” to us, taking into account the totality of the relationships between the parties involved (including other transactions that may be particularly favorable or advantageous to us).
      Our general partner may also enter into additional contractual arrangements with any of its affiliates on our behalf; however, there is no obligation of our general partner and its affiliates to enter into any contracts of this kind and our general partner will determine, in good faith, the terms of any of these transactions.
Except in limited circumstances, our general partner has the power and authority to conduct our business without unitholder approval.
      Under our partnership agreement, our general partner has full power and authority to do all things (other than those items that require unitholder approval or with respect to which our general partner has sought conflicts committee approval) on such terms as it determines to be necessary or appropriate to conduct our business including, but not limited to, the following:
  •  the making of any expenditures, the lending or borrowing of money, the assumption or guarantee of, or other contracting for, indebtedness and other liabilities, the issuance of evidences of indebtedness, including indebtedness that is convertible into securities of the partnership, and the incurring of any other obligations;
 
  •  the making of tax, regulatory and other filings, or rendering of periodic or other reports to governmental or other agencies having jurisdictions over our business or assets;
 
  •  the negotiation, execution and performance of any contracts, conveyances or other instruments;
 
  •  the distribution of partnership cash;
 
  •  the selection and dismissal of employees and agents, outside attorneys, accountants, consultants and contractors and the determination of their compensation and other terms of employment or hiring;
 
  •  the maintenance of insurance for our benefit and the benefit of our partners;
 
  •  the formation of, or acquisition of an interest in, and the contribution of property and the making of loans to, any other limited or general partnerships, joint ventures, corporations, limited liability companies or other relationships;
 
  •  the control of any matters affecting our rights and obligations, including the bringing and defending of actions at law or in equity and otherwise engaging in the conduct of litigation, arbitration or mediation and the incurring of legal expense and the settlement of claims and litigation;

173


 

  •  the indemnification of any person against liabilities and contingencies to the extent permitted by law;
 
  •  the purchase, sale or other acquisition or disposition of our securities, or the issuance of additional options, rights, warrants and appreciation rights relating to our securities; and
 
  •  the entering into of agreements with any of its affiliates to render services to us, our controlled affiliates or to itself in the discharge of its duties as our general partner.
      Please read “The Partnership Agreement — Voting Rights” for information regarding the voting rights of unitholders.
Common units are subject to our general partner’s call right.
      Our general partner may exercise its right to call and purchase common units as provided in the partnership agreement or assign this right to one of its affiliates or to us. Our general partner may use its own discretion, free of fiduciary duty restrictions, in determining whether to exercise this right. As a result, a common unitholder may have common units purchased from the unitholder at an undesirable time or price. Please read “The Partnership Agreement — Call Right.”
We may choose not to retain separate counsel for ourselves or for the holders of common units.
      The attorneys, independent accountants and others who perform services for us have been retained by our general partner. Attorneys, independent accountants and others who perform services for us are selected by our general partner or the conflicts committee and may perform services for our general partner and its affiliates. We may retain separate counsel for ourselves or the holders of common units in the event of a conflict of interest between our general partner and its affiliates, on the one hand, and us or the holders of common units, on the other, depending on the nature of the conflict. We do not intend to do so in most cases.
Our general partner’s affiliates, including Teekay Shipping Corporation, may compete with us.
      Our partnership agreement provides that our general partner will be restricted from engaging in any business activities other than acting as our general partner and those activities incidental to its ownership of interests in us. In addition, our partnership agreement provides that our general partner, for so long as it is general partner of our partnership, will cause its affiliates not to engage in, by acquisition or otherwise, the businesses described above under the caption “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions — Omnibus Agreement — Noncompetition.” Similarly, under the omnibus agreement, Teekay Shipping Corporation will agree and will cause it affiliates to agree, for so long as Teekay Shipping Corporation controls our partnership, not to engage in the businesses described above under the caption “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions — Omnibus Agreement — Noncompetition.” Except as provided in our partnership agreement and the omnibus agreement, affiliates of our general partner are not prohibited from engaging in other businesses or activities, including those that might be in direct competition with us.
Fiduciary Duties
      Our general partner is accountable to us and our unitholders as a fiduciary. Fiduciary duties owed to unitholders by our general partner are prescribed by law and the partnership agreement. The Marshall Islands Act provides that Marshall Islands partnerships may, in their partnership agreements, restrict or expand the fiduciary duties owed by the general partner to the limited partners and the partnership.
      Our partnership agreement contains various provisions restricting the fiduciary duties that might otherwise be owed by our general partner. We have adopted these provisions to allow our general partner to take into account the interests of other parties in addition to our interests when resolving conflicts of interest. We believe this is appropriate and necessary because the board of directors of our general partner has fiduciary duties to manage our general partner in a manner beneficial both to its owner, Teekay

174


 

Shipping Corporation, as well as to you. These modifications disadvantage the common unitholders because they restrict the rights and remedies that would otherwise be available to unitholders for actions that, without those limitations, might constitute breaches of fiduciary duty, as described below. The following is a summary of:
  •  the fiduciary duties imposed on our general partner by the Marshall Islands Act;
 
  •  material modifications of these duties contained in our partnership agreement; and
 
  •  certain rights and remedies of unitholders contained in the Marshall Islands Act.
Marshall Islands law fiduciary duty standards Fiduciary duties are generally considered to include an obligation to act in good faith and with due care and loyalty. The duty of care, in the absence of a provision in a partnership agreement providing otherwise, would generally require a general partner to act for the partnership in the same manner as a prudent person would act on his own behalf. The duty of loyalty, in the absence of a provision in a partnership agreement providing otherwise, would generally prohibit a general partner of a Marshall Islands limited partnership from taking any action or engaging in any transaction where a conflict of interest is present.
 
Partnership agreement modified standards Our partnership agreement contains provisions that waive or consent to conduct by our general partner and its affiliates that might otherwise raise issues as to compliance with fiduciary duties under the laws of the Marshall Islands. For example, Section 7.9 of our partnership agreement provides that when our general partner is acting in its capacity as our general partner, as opposed to in its individual capacity, it must act in “good faith” and will not be subject to any other standard under the laws of the Marshall Islands. In addition, when our general partner is acting in its individual capacity, as opposed to in its capacity as our general partner, it may act without any fiduciary obligation to us or the unitholders whatsoever. These standards reduce the obligations to which our general partner would otherwise be held.
 
Our partnership agreement generally provides that affiliated transactions and resolutions of conflicts of interest not involving a vote of unitholders and that are not approved by the conflicts committee of the board of directors of our general partner must be:
 
• on terms no less favorable to us than those generally being provided to or available from unrelated third parties; or
 
• “fair and reasonable” to us, taking into account the totality of the relationships between the parties involved (including other transactions that may be particularly favorable or advantageous to us).
 
If our general partner does not seek approval from the conflicts committee, and the board of directors of our general partner determines that the resolution or course of action taken with respect to the conflict of interest satisfies either of the standards set forth in the bullet points above, then it will be presumed

175


 

that, in making its decision, the board of directors acted in good faith, and in any proceeding brought by or on behalf of any limited partner or the partnership, the person bringing or prosecuting such proceeding will have the burden of overcoming such presumption. These standards reduce the obligations to which our general partner would otherwise be held.
 
In addition to the other more specific provisions limiting the obligations of our general partner, our partnership agreement further provides that our general partner and its officers and directors will not be liable for monetary damages to us or our limited partners for errors of judgment or for any acts or omissions unless there has been a final and non- appealable judgment by a court of competent jurisdiction determining that the general partner or its officers and directors acted in bad faith or engaged in fraud, willful misconduct or gross negligence.
 
Rights and remedies of unitholders The provisions of the Marshall Islands Act resemble the provisions of the limited partnership act of Delaware. For example, like Delaware, the Marshall Islands Act favors the principles of freedom of contract and enforceability of partnership agreements and allows the partnership agreement to contain terms governing the rights of the unitholders. The rights of our unitholders, including voting and approval rights and the ability of the partnership to issue additional units, are governed by the terms of our partnership agreement. Please read “The Partnership Agreement.”
 
As to remedies of unitholders, the Marshall Islands Act permits a limited partner to institute legal action on behalf of the partnership to recover damages from a third party where a general partner has refused to institute the action or where an effort to cause a general partner to do so is not likely to succeed. These actions include actions against a general partner for breach of its fiduciary duties or of the partnership agreement.

      In order to become one of our limited partners, a common unitholder is required to agree to be bound by the provisions in the partnership agreement, including the provisions discussed above. The failure of a limited partner or transferee to sign a partnership agreement does not render the partnership agreement unenforceable against that person.
      Under the partnership agreement, we must indemnify our general partner and its officers and directors to the fullest extent permitted by law, against liabilities, costs and expenses incurred by our general partner or these other persons. We must provide this indemnification unless there has been a final and non-appealable judgment by a court of competent jurisdiction determining that these persons acted in bad faith or engaged in fraud, willful misconduct or gross negligence. We also must provide this indemnification for criminal proceedings when our general partner or these other persons acted with no reasonable cause to believe that their conduct was unlawful. Thus, our general partner could be indemnified for its negligent acts if it met the requirements set forth above. To the extent that these provisions purport to include indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act, in the opinion of the Securities and Exchange Commission such indemnification is contrary to public policy and therefore unenforceable. Please read “The Partnership Agreement — Indemnification.”

176


 

DESCRIPTION OF THE COMMON UNITS
The Units
      The common units and the subordinated units represent limited partner interests in us. The holders of units are entitled to participate in partnership distributions and exercise the rights and privileges available to limited partners under our partnership agreement. For a description of the relative rights and privileges of holders of common units and subordinated units and our general partner in and to partnership distributions, please read this section and “How We Make Cash Distributions.” For a description of the rights and privileges of limited partners under our partnership agreement, including voting rights, please read “The Partnership Agreement.”
Transfer Agent and Registrar
Duties
      The Bank of New York will serve as registrar and transfer agent for the common units. We pay all fees charged by the transfer agent for transfers of common units, except the following, which must be paid by unitholders:
  •  surety bond premiums to replace lost or stolen certificates, taxes and other governmental charges;
 
  •  special charges for services requested by a holder of a common unit; and
 
  •  other similar fees or charges.
      There is no charge to unitholders for disbursements of our cash distributions. We will indemnify the transfer agent, its agents and each of their stockholders, directors, officers and employees against all claims and losses that may arise out of acts performed or omitted for its activities in that capacity, except for any liability due to any gross negligence or intentional misconduct of the indemnified person or entity.
Resignation or Removal
      The transfer agent may resign, by notice to us, or be removed by us. The resignation or removal of the transfer agent will become effective upon our appointment of a successor transfer agent and registrar and its acceptance of the appointment. If a successor has not been appointed or has not accepted its appointment within 30 days after notice of the resignation or removal, our general partner may act as the transfer agent and registrar until a successor is appointed.
Transfer of Common Units
      By transfer of common units in accordance with our partnership agreement, each transferee of common units automatically shall be admitted as a limited partner with respect to the common units transferred when such transfer and admission is reflected in our books and records. Our general partner will cause any transfers to be recorded on our books and records no less frequently than quarterly. Each transferee automatically shall be deemed to:
  •  represent that the transferee has the capacity, power and authority to become bound by our partnership agreement;
 
  •  agree to be bound by the terms and conditions of, and to have executed, our partnership agreement; and
 
  •  give the consents and approvals contained in our partnership agreement, such as the approval of all transactions and agreements that we are entering into in connection with our formation and this offering.

177


 

      We are entitled to treat the nominee holder of a common unit as the absolute owner. In that case, the beneficial holder’s rights are limited solely to those that it has against the nominee holder as a result of any agreement between the beneficial owner and the nominee holder.
      Common units are securities and are transferable according to the laws governing transfer of securities. In addition to other rights acquired upon transfer, the transferor gives the transferee the right to become a limited partner in our partnership for the transferred common units.
      Until a common unit has been transferred on our books, we and the transfer agent may treat the record holder of the unit as the absolute owner for all purposes, except as otherwise required by law or stock exchange regulations.

178


 

THE PARTNERSHIP AGREEMENT
      The following is a summary of the material provisions of our partnership agreement. The form of our partnership agreement is included in this prospectus as Appendix A. The partnership agreement of OPCO and the limited liability company agreements of our general partner and of OPCO’s general partner are included as exhibits to the registration statement of which this prospectus is a part. We will provide prospective investors with a copy of these agreements upon request at no charge.
      We summarize the following provisions of our partnership agreement elsewhere in this prospectus:
  •  with regard to distributions of available cash, please read “How We Make Cash Distributions;”
 
  •  with regard to the fiduciary duties of our general partner, please read “Conflicts of Interest and Fiduciary Duties;” and
 
  •  with regard to the transfer of common units, please read “Description of the Common Units — Transfer of Common Units.”
Organization and Duration
      We were organized on August 31, 2006 and have perpetual existence.
Purpose
      Our partnership agreement provides that we may directly or indirectly engage in business activities approved by our general partner, including owning interests in OPCO and other subsidiaries through which we intend to conduct additional operations. Although our general partner has the ability to cause us to engage in activities other than the marine transportation, processing and storage of crude oil, our general partner has no current plans to do so and may decline to do so free of any fiduciary duty or obligation whatsoever to us or the limited partners, including any duty to act in good faith or in the best interests of us or the limited partners. Our general partner is authorized in general to perform all acts it determines to be necessary or appropriate to carry out our purposes and to conduct our business.
Power of Attorney
      Each limited partner, and each person who acquires a unit from another unitholder and executes and delivers a transfer application, grants to our general partner and, if appointed, a liquidator, a power of attorney to, among other things, execute and file documents required for our qualification, continuance or dissolution. The power of attorney also grants our general partner the authority to amend, and to make consents and waivers under, the partnership agreement.
Capital Contributions
      Unitholders are not obligated to make additional capital contributions, except as described below under “— Limited Liability.”
Voting Rights
      The following matters require the unitholder vote specified below. Matters requiring the approval of a “unit majority” require:
  •  during the subordination period, the approval of a majority of the common units, excluding those common units held by our general partner and its affiliates, and a majority of the subordinated units, voting as separate classes; and
 
  •  after the subordination period, the approval of a majority of the common units.

179


 

      In voting their common and subordinated units, the general partner and its affiliates will have no fiduciary duty or obligation whatsoever to us or the limited partners, including any duty to act in good faith or in the best interests of us and the limited partners.
     
Action   Unitholder Approval Required
     
Issuance of additional units
  No approval rights.
Amendment of the partnership agreement
  Certain amendments may be made by the general partner without the approval of the unitholders. Other amendments generally require the approval of a unit majority. Please read “— Amendment of the Partnership Agreement.”
Amendment of the partnership agreement of OPCO or the limited liability company agreement of OPCO’s general partner, or other action taken by us as an equity holder of OPCO’s general partner
  No approval rights. However, approval by the conflicts committee of the board of directors of our general partner is required for these amendments and by our general partner’s board of directors for certain actions affecting OPCO. Please read “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions — OPCO Partnership Agreement and Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C. Limited Liability Company Agreement.”
Merger of our partnership or the sale of all or substantially all of our assets
  Unit majority. Please read “— Merger, Sale or Other Disposition of Assets.”
Dissolution of our partnership
  Unit majority. Please read “— Termination and Dissolution.”
Reconstitution of our partnership upon dissolution
  Unit majority. Please read “— Termination and Dissolution.”
Withdrawal of the general partner
  Under most circumstances, the approval of a majority of the common units, excluding common units held by the general partner and its affiliates, is required for the withdrawal of the general partner prior to December 31, 2016 in a manner which would cause a dissolution of our partnership. Please read “— Withdrawal or Removal of the General Partner.”
Removal of the general partner
  Not less than 66 2 / 3 % of the outstanding units, voting as a single class, including units held by our general partner and its affiliates. Please read “— Withdrawal or Removal of the General Partner.”

180


 

     
Action   Unitholder Approval Required
     
Transfer of the general partner interest in us
  Our general partner may transfer all, but not less than all, of its general partner interest in us without a vote of our unitholders to an affiliate or another person in connection with its merger or consolidation with or into, or sale of all or substantially all of its assets to such person. The approval of a majority of the common units, excluding common units held by the general partner and its affiliates, is required in other circumstances for a transfer of the general partner interest to a third party prior to December 31, 2016. Please read “— Transfer of General Partner Interest.”
Transfer of incentive distribution rights
  Except for transfers to an affiliate or another person as part of the general partner’s merger or consolidation with or into, or sale of all or substantially all of its assets to such person, the approval of a majority of the common units, excluding common units held by our general partner and its affiliates, voting separately as a class, is required in most circumstances for a transfer of the incentive distribution rights to a third party prior to December 31, 2016. Please read “— Transfer of Incentive Distribution Rights.”
Transfer of ownership interests in the general partner
  No approval required at any time. Please read “— Transfer of Ownership Interests in General Partner.”
Limited Liability
      Assuming that a limited partner does not participate in the control of our business within the meaning of the Marshall Islands Act and that he otherwise acts in conformity with the provisions of our partnership agreement, his liability under the Marshall Islands Act will be limited, subject to possible exceptions, to the amount of capital he is obligated to contribute to us for his common units plus his share of any undistributed profits and assets. If it were determined, however, that the right, or exercise of the right, by the limited partners as a group:
  •  to remove or replace our general partner;
 
  •  to approve some amendments to our partnership agreement; or
 
  •  to take other action under our partnership agreement;
constituted “participation in the control” of our business for the purposes of the Marshall Islands Act, then the limited partners could be held personally liable for our obligations under the laws of Marshall Islands, to the same extent as our general partner. This liability would extend to persons who transact business with us who reasonably believe that the limited partner is a general partner. Neither our partnership agreement nor the Marshall Islands Act specifically provides for legal recourse against our general partner if a limited partner were to lose limited liability through any fault of our general partner. While this does not mean that a limited partner could not seek legal recourse, we know of no precedent for this type of a claim in Marshall Islands case law.
      Under the Marshall Islands Act, a limited partnership may not make a distribution to a partner if, after the distribution, all liabilities of the limited partnership, other than liabilities to partners on account of their partnership interests and liabilities for which the recourse of creditors is limited to specific

181


 

property of the partnership, would exceed the fair value of the assets of the limited partnership. For the purpose of determining the fair value of the assets of a limited partnership, the Marshall Islands Act provides that the fair value of property subject to liability for which recourse of creditors is limited shall be included in the assets of the limited partnership only to the extent that the fair value of that property exceeds the non-recourse liability. The Marshall Islands Act provides that a limited partner who receives a distribution and knew at the time of the distribution that the distribution was in violation of the Marshall Islands Act shall be liable to the limited partnership for the amount of the distribution for three years. Under the Marshall Islands Act, a purchaser of units who becomes a limited partner of a limited partnership is liable for the obligations of the transferee to make contributions to the partnership, except the transferee is not obligated for liabilities unknown to the transferee at the time he became a limited partner and that could not be ascertained from the partnership agreement.
      Maintenance of our limited liability may require compliance with legal requirements in the jurisdictions in which OPCO and our or its respective subsidiaries conduct business, which may include qualifying to do business in those jurisdictions.
      Limitations on the liability of limited partners for the obligations of a limited partner have not been clearly established in many jurisdictions. If, by virtue of our ownership or control of operating subsidiaries or OPCO or otherwise, it were determined that we were conducting business in any jurisdiction without compliance with the applicable limited partnership or limited liability company statute, or that the right or exercise of the right by the limited partners as a group to remove or replace the general partner, to approve some amendments to the partnership agreement, or to take other action under the partnership agreement constituted “participation in the control” of our business for purposes of the statutes of any relevant jurisdiction, then the limited partners could be held personally liable for our obligations under the law of that jurisdiction to the same extent as the general partner under the circumstances. We intend to operate in a manner that the general partner considers reasonable and necessary or appropriate to preserve the limited liability of the limited partners.
Issuance of Additional Securities
      The partnership agreement authorizes us to issue an unlimited number of additional partnership securities and rights to buy partnership securities for the consideration and on the terms and conditions determined by the general partner without the approval of the unitholders.
      It is possible that we will fund acquisitions through the issuance of additional common units or other equity securities. Holders of any additional common units we issue will be entitled to share equally with the then-existing holders of common units in our distributions of available cash. In addition, the issuance of additional common units or other equity securities interests may dilute the value of the interests of the then-existing holders of common units in our net assets.
      In accordance with Marshall Islands law and the provisions of our partnership agreement, we may also issue additional partnership securities interests that, as determined by the general partner, have special voting or other rights to which the common units are not entitled.
      Upon issuance of additional partnership securities, our general partner will have the right, but not the obligation, to make additional capital contributions to the extent necessary to maintain its general partner interest in us at the same percentage level as before the issuance. Our general partner’s 2% interest in us will thus be reduced if we issue additional partnership securities in the future and our general partner does not elect to maintain its 2% general partner interest. Our general partner and its affiliates will also have the right, which it may from time to time assign in whole or in part to any of its affiliates, to purchase common units, subordinated units or other equity securities whenever, and on the same terms that, we issue those securities to persons other than our general partner and its affiliates, to the extent necessary to maintain its and its affiliates’ percentage interest, including its interest represented by common units and subordinated units, that existed immediately prior to each issuance. Other holders of common units will not have similar preemptive rights to acquire additional common units or other partnership securities.

182


 

Amendment of the Partnership Agreement
General
      Amendments to our partnership agreement may be proposed only by or with the consent of our general partner. However, our general partner will have no duty or obligation to propose any amendment and may decline to do so free of any fiduciary duty or obligation whatsoever to us or the limited partners, including any duty to act in good faith or in the best interests of us or the limited partners. In order to adopt a proposed amendment, other than the amendments discussed below, our general partner must seek written approval of the holders of the number of units required to approve the amendment or call a meeting of the limited partners to consider and vote upon the proposed amendment. Except as we describe below, an amendment must be approved by a unit majority.
Prohibited Amendments
      No amendment may be made that would:
        (1) increase the obligations of any limited partner without its consent, unless approved by at least a majority of the type or class of limited partner interests so affected;
 
        (2) increase the obligations of, restrict in any way any action by or rights of, or reduce in any way the amounts distributable, reimbursable or otherwise payable by us to the general partner or any of its affiliates without the consent of the general partner, which may be given or withheld at its option;
 
        (3) change the term of our partnership;
 
        (4) provide that our partnership is not dissolved upon an election to dissolve our partnership by our general partner that is approved by the holders of a unit majority; or
 
        (5) give any person the right to dissolve our partnership other than our general partner’s right to dissolve our partnership with the approval of the holders of a unit majority.
      The provision of our partnership agreement preventing the amendments having the effects described in clauses (1) through (5) above can be amended upon the approval of the holders of at least 90% of the outstanding units voting together as a single class (including units owned by our general partner and its affiliates). Upon completion of this offering, the owner of our general partner will own 64.3% of the outstanding units.
No Unitholder Approval
      Our general partner may generally make amendments to our partnership agreement without the approval of any limited partner to reflect:
        (1) a change in our name, the location of our principal place of business, our registered agent or our registered office;
 
        (2) the admission, substitution, withdrawal or removal of partners in accordance with our partnership agreement;
 
        (3) a change that our general partner determines to be necessary or appropriate for us to qualify or to continue our qualification as a limited partnership or a partnership in which the limited partners have limited liability under the laws of any jurisdiction;
 
        (4) an amendment that is necessary, upon the advice of our counsel, to prevent us or our general partner or its directors, officers, agents, or trustees from in any manner being subjected to the provisions of the U.S. Investment Company Act of 1940, the U.S. Investment Advisors Act of 1940, or plan asset regulations adopted under the U.S. Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, or ERISA, whether or not substantially similar to plan asset regulations currently applied or proposed;

183


 

        (5) an amendment that the general partner determines to be necessary or appropriate for the authorization of additional partnership securities or rights to acquire partnership securities;
 
        (6) any amendment expressly permitted in the partnership agreement to be made by the general partner acting alone;
 
        (7) an amendment effected, necessitated, or contemplated by a merger agreement that has been approved under the terms of the partnership agreement;
 
        (8) any amendment that the general partner determines to be necessary or appropriate for the formation by us of, or our investment in, any corporation, partnership or other entity, as otherwise permitted by the partnership agreement;
 
        (9) a change in our fiscal year or taxable year and related changes;
 
        (10) certain mergers or conveyances as set forth in our partnership agreement; or
 
        (11) any other amendments substantially similar to any of the matters described in (1) through (10) above.
      In addition, our general partner may make amendments to the partnership agreement without the approval of any limited partner if the general partner determines that those amendments:
        (1) do not adversely affect the limited partners (or any particular class of limited partners) in any material respect;
 
        (2) are necessary or appropriate to satisfy any requirements, conditions, or guidelines contained in any opinion, directive, order, ruling or regulation of any federal or state agency or judicial authority or contained in any federal or state statute;
 
        (3) are necessary or appropriate to facilitate the trading of limited partner interests or to comply with any rule, regulation, guideline or requirement of any securities exchange on which the limited partner interests are or will be listed for trading;
 
        (4) are necessary or appropriate for any action taken by the general partner relating to splits or combinations of units under the provisions of the partnership agreement; or
 
        (5) are required to effect the intent expressed in this prospectus or the intent of the provisions of the partnership agreement or are otherwise contemplated by the partnership agreement.
Opinion of Counsel and Unitholder Approval
      Our general partner will not be required to obtain an opinion of counsel that an amendment will not result in a loss of limited liability to the limited partners if one of the amendments described above under “— No Unitholder Approval” should occur. No other amendments to our partnership agreement will become effective without the approval of holders of at least 90.0% of the outstanding units voting as a single class unless we obtain an opinion of counsel to the effect that the amendment will not affect the limited liability under applicable law of any of our limited partners.
      In addition to the above restrictions, any amendment that would have a material adverse effect on the rights or privileges of any type or class of outstanding units in relation to other classes of units will require the approval of at least a majority of the type or class of units so affected. Any amendment that reduces the voting percentage required to take any action must be approved by the affirmative vote of limited partners whose aggregate outstanding units constitute not less than the voting requirement sought to be reduced.
Merger, Sale, or Other Disposition of Assets
      A merger or consolidation of us requires the consent of our general partner. However, our general partner will have no duty or obligation to consent to any merger or consolidation and may decline to do so free of any fiduciary duty or obligation whatsoever to us or the limited partners, including any duty to act

184


 

in good faith or in the best interests of us or the limited partners. In addition, our partnership agreement generally prohibits our general partner, without the prior approval of the holders of units representing a unit majority, from causing us to, among other things, sell, exchange, or otherwise dispose of all or substantially all of our assets in a single transaction or a series of related transactions, including by way of merger, consolidation, or other combination, or approving on our behalf the sale, exchange, or other disposition of all or substantially all of the assets of our subsidiaries. Our general partner may, however, mortgage, pledge, hypothecate, or grant a security interest in all or substantially all of our assets without that approval. Our general partner may also sell all or substantially all of our assets under a foreclosure or other realization upon those encumbrances without that approval.
      If conditions specified in our partnership agreement are satisfied, our general partner may convert us or any of our subsidiaries into a new limited liability entity or merge us or any of our subsidiaries into, or convey some or all of our assets to, a newly formed entity if the sole purpose of that merger or conveyance is to effect a mere change in our legal form into another limited liability entity. The unitholders are not entitled to dissenters’ rights of appraisal under our partnership agreement or applicable law in the event of a conversion, merger or consolidation, a sale of substantially all of our assets, or any other transaction or event.
Termination and Dissolution
      We will continue as a limited partnership until terminated under our partnership agreement. We will dissolve upon:
        (1) the election of our general partner to dissolve us, if approved by the holders of units representing a unit majority;
 
        (2) the sale, exchange, or other disposition of all or substantially all of our assets and properties and our subsidiaries;
 
        (3) the entry of a decree of judicial dissolution of us; or
 
        (4) the withdrawal or removal of our general partner or any other event that results in its ceasing to be the general partner other than by reason of a transfer of its general partner interest in accordance with the partnership agreement or withdrawal or removal following approval and admission of a successor.
      Upon a dissolution under clause (4), the holders of a unit majority may also elect, within specific time limitations, to continue our business on the same terms and conditions described in the partnership agreement by appointing as general partner an entity approved by the holders of units representing a unit majority, subject to our receipt of an opinion of counsel to the effect that the action would not result in the loss of limited liability of any limited partner.
Liquidation and Distribution of Proceeds
      Upon our dissolution, unless we are continued as a new limited partnership, the liquidator authorized to wind up our affairs will, acting with all of the powers of the general partner that are necessary or appropriate, liquidate our assets and apply the proceeds of the liquidation as provided in “How We Make Cash Distributions — Distributions of Cash Upon Liquidation.” The liquidator may defer liquidation or distribution of our assets for a reasonable period or distribute assets to partners in kind if it determines that a sale would be impractical or would cause undue loss to our partners.
Withdrawal or Removal of the General Partner
      Except as described below, our general partner has agreed not to withdraw voluntarily as our general partner prior to December 31, 2016 without obtaining the approval of the holders of at least a majority of the outstanding common units, excluding common units held by the general partner and its affiliates, and furnishing an opinion of counsel regarding limited liability. On or after December 31, 2016, our general

185


 

partner may withdraw as general partner without first obtaining approval of any unitholder by giving 90 days’ written notice, and that withdrawal will not constitute a violation of the partnership agreement. Notwithstanding the information above, our general partner may withdraw without unitholder approval upon 90 days’ notice to the limited partners if at least 50% of the outstanding common units are held or controlled by one person and its affiliates other than the general partner and its affiliates. In addition, the partnership agreement permits our general partner in some instances to sell or otherwise transfer all of its general partner interest in us without the approval of the unitholders. Please read “— Transfer of General Partner Interests” and “— Transfer of Incentive Distribution Rights.”
      Upon withdrawal of our general partner under any circumstances, other than as a result of a transfer by the general partner of all or a part of its general partner interest in us, the holders of a majority of the outstanding common units and subordinated units, voting as separate classes, may select a successor to that withdrawing general partner. If a successor is not elected, or is elected but an opinion of counsel regarding limited liability cannot be obtained, we will be dissolved, wound up and liquidated, unless within a specified period of time after that withdrawal, the holders of a unit majority agree in writing to continue our business and to appoint a successor general partner. Please read “— Termination and Dissolution.”
      Our general partner may not be removed unless that removal is approved by the vote of the holders of not less than 66 2 / 3 % of the outstanding units, voting together as a single class, including units held by the general partner and its affiliates, and we receive an opinion of counsel regarding limited liability. Any removal of our general partner is also subject to the approval of a successor general partner by the vote of the holders of a majority of the outstanding common units and subordinated units, voting as separate classes. The ownership of more than 33 1 / 3 % of the outstanding units by our general partner and its affiliates would give them the practical ability to prevent the general partner’s removal. At the closing of this offering, our general partner and its affiliates will own 64.3% of the outstanding units.
      Our partnership agreement also provides that if our general partner is removed as our general partner under circumstances where cause does not exist and units held by the general partner and its affiliates are not voted in favor of that removal:
  •  the subordination period will end and all outstanding subordinated units will immediately convert into common units on a one-for-one basis;
 
  •  any existing arrearages in payment of the minimum quarterly distribution on the common units will be extinguished; and
 
  •  the general partner will have the right to convert its general partner interest and its incentive distribution rights into common units or to receive cash in exchange for those interests based on the fair market value of the interests at the time.
      In the event of removal of the general partner under circumstances where cause exists or withdrawal of the general partner where that withdrawal violates the partnership agreement, a successor general partner will have the option to purchase the general partner interest and incentive distribution rights of the departing general partner for a cash payment equal to the fair market value of those interests. Under all other circumstances where the general partner withdraws or is removed by the limited partners, the departing general partner will have the option to require the successor general partner to purchase the general partner interest of the departing general partner and its incentive distribution rights for their fair market value. In each case, this fair market value will be determined by agreement between the departing general partner and the successor general partner. If no agreement is reached, an independent investment banking firm or other independent expert selected by the departing general partner and the successor general partner will determine the fair market value. Or, if the departing general partner and the successor general partner cannot agree upon an expert, then an expert chosen by agreement of the experts selected by each of them will determine the fair market value.
      If the option described above is not exercised by either the departing general partner or the successor general partner, the departing general partner’s general partner interest and its incentive distribution rights will automatically convert into common units equal to the fair market value of those interests as

186


 

determined by an investment banking firm or other independent expert selected in the manner described in the preceding paragraph.
      In addition, we will be required to reimburse the departing general partner for all amounts due the departing general partner, including, without limitation, any employee-related liabilities, including severance liabilities, incurred for the termination of any employees employed by the departing general partner or its affiliates for our benefit.
Transfer of General Partner Interest
      Except for the transfer by our general partner of all, but not less than all, of its general partner interest in us to:
  •  an affiliate of the general partner (other than an individual); or
 
  •  another entity as part of the merger or consolidation of our general partner with or into another entity or the transfer by the general partner of all or substantially all of its assets to another entity,
our general partner may not transfer all or any part of its general partner interest in us to another person prior to December 31, 2016 without the approval of the holders of at least a majority of the outstanding common units, excluding common units held by the general partner and its affiliates. As a condition of this transfer, the transferee must, among other things, assume the rights and duties of the general partner, agree to be bound by the provisions of the partnership agreement and furnish an opinion of counsel regarding limited liability.
      Our general partner and its affiliates may at any time transfer units to one or more persons, without unitholder approval, except that they may not transfer subordinated units to us.
Transfer of Ownership Interests in General Partner
      At any time, the members of our general partner may sell or transfer all or part of their respective membership interests in our general partner to an affiliate or a third party without the approval of our unitholders.
Transfer of Incentive Distribution Rights
      Our general partner or its affiliates or a subsequent holder may transfer its incentive distribution rights to an affiliate of the holder (other than an individual) or another entity as part of the merger or consolidation of such holder with or into another entity, or sale of all or substantially all of its assets to that entity without the prior approval of the unitholders. Prior to December 31, 2016, other transfers of the incentive distribution rights will require the affirmative vote of holders of a majority of the outstanding common units, excluding common units held by the general partner and its affiliates. On or after December 31, 2016, the incentive distribution rights will be freely transferable.
Change of Management Provisions
      The partnership agreement contains specific provisions that are intended to discourage a person or group from attempting to remove Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C. as our general partner or otherwise change management. If any person or group other than the general partner and its affiliates acquires beneficial ownership of 20.0% or more of any class of units, that person or group loses voting rights on all of its units. This loss of voting rights does not apply to any person or group that acquires the units from our general partner or its affiliates and any transferees of that person or group approved by our general partner or to any person or group who acquires the units with the prior approval of the board of directors of the general partner.

187


 

      The partnership agreement also provides that if the general partner is removed under circumstances where cause does not exist and units held by the general partner and its affiliates are not voted in favor of that removal:
  •  the subordination period will end and all outstanding subordinated units will immediately convert into common units on a one-for-one basis;
 
  •  any existing arrearages in payment of the minimum quarterly distribution on the common units will be extinguished; and
 
  •  the general partner will have the right to convert its general partner interest and its incentive distribution rights into common units or to receive cash in exchange for those interests.
Call Right
      If at any time the general partner and its affiliates hold more than 80.0% of the then-issued and outstanding partnership securities of any class, the general partner will have the right, which it may assign in whole or in part to any of its affiliates or to us, to acquire all, but not less than all, of the remaining partnership securities of the class held by unaffiliated persons as of a record date to be selected by the general partner, on at least 10 but not more than 60 days’ notice. The purchase price in this event is equal to the greater of (x) the average of the daily closing prices of the partnership securities of such class over the 20 trading days preceding the date three days before notice of exercise of the call right is first mailed and (y) the highest price paid by our general partner or any of its affiliates for partnership securities of such class during the 90-day period preceding the date such notice is first mailed.
      As a result of the general partner’s right to purchase outstanding partnership securities, a holder of partnership securities may have the holder’s partnership securities purchased at an undesirable time or price. The tax consequences to a unitholder of the exercise of this call right are the same as a sale by that unitholder of common units in the market. Please read “Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Considerations — United States Federal Income Taxation of U.S. Holders — Sale, Exchange or other Disposition of Common Units” and “— United States Federal Income Taxation of Non-U.S. Holders — Disposition of Units.”
      At the completion of this offering and assuming no exercise of the underwriters’ over-allotment option, Teekay Shipping Corporation, an affiliate of our general partner, will own approximately 28.6% of the outstanding common units. At the end of the subordination period, assuming no additional issuances of common units, no exercise of the underwriters’ over-allotment option and conversion of our subordinated units into common units, Teekay Shipping Corporation will own approximately 64.3% of the outstanding common units.
Meetings; Voting
      Except as described below regarding a person or group owning 20.0% or more of any class of units then outstanding, unitholders who are record holders of units on the record date will be entitled to notice of, and to vote at, meetings of our limited partners and to act upon matters for which approvals may be solicited. Common units that are owned by a transferee who is a record holder, but who has not yet been admitted as a limited partner, will be voted by the general partner at the written direction of the record holder. Absent direction of this kind, the common units will not be voted, except that, in the case of common units held by the general partner on behalf of unpermitted citizen assignees, the general partner will distribute the votes on those common units in the same ratios as the votes of limited partners on other units are cast.
      The general partner does not anticipate that any meeting of unitholders will be called in the foreseeable future. Any action that is required or permitted to be taken by the unitholders may be taken either at a meeting of the unitholders or without a meeting if consents in writing describing the action so taken are signed by holders of the number of units necessary to authorize or take that action at a meeting. Meetings of the unitholders may be called by the general partner or by unitholders owning at least 20% of

188


 

the outstanding units of the class for which a meeting is proposed. Unitholders may vote either in person or by proxy at meetings. The holders of a majority of the outstanding units of the class or classes for which a meeting has been called, represented in person or by proxy, will constitute a quorum unless any action by the unitholders requires approval by holders of a greater percentage of the units, in which case the quorum will be the greater percentage.
      Each record holder of a unit may vote according to the holder’s percentage interest in us, although additional limited partner interests having special voting rights could be issued. Please read “— Issuance of Additional Securities.” However, if at any time any person or group, other than the general partner and its affiliates, or a direct or subsequently approved transferee of the general partner or its affiliates or a transferee approved by the board of directors of the general partner, acquires, in the aggregate, beneficial ownership of 20% or more of any class of units then outstanding, that person or group will lose voting rights on all of its units and the units may not be voted on any matter and will not be considered to be outstanding when sending notices of a meeting of unitholders, calculating required votes, determining the presence of a quorum, or for other similar purposes. Common units held in nominee or street name account will be voted by the broker or other nominee in accordance with the instruction of the beneficial owner unless the arrangement between the beneficial owner and his nominee provides otherwise. Except as the partnership agreement otherwise provides, subordinated units will vote together with common units as a single class.
      Any notice, demand, request report, or proxy material required or permitted to be given or made to record holders of common units under the partnership agreement will be delivered to the record holder by us or by the transfer agent.
Status as Limited Partner
      Except as described above under “— Limited Liability,” the common units will be fully paid, and unitholders will not be required to make additional contributions. By transfer of common units in accordance with our partnership agreement, each transferee of common units shall be admitted as a limited partner with respect to the common units transferred when such transfer and admission is reflected in our books and records.
Indemnification
      Under the partnership agreement, in most circumstances, we will indemnify the following persons, to the fullest extent permitted by law, from and against all losses, claims, damages or similar events:
        (1) our general partner;
 
        (2) any departing general partner;
 
        (3) any person who is or was an affiliate of our general partner or any departing general partner;
 
        (4) any person who is or was an officer, director, member or partner of any entity described in (1), (2) or (3) above;
 
        (5) any person who is or was serving as a director, officer, member, partner, fiduciary or trustee of another person at the request of our general partner or any departing general partner; or
 
        (6) any person designated by our general partner.
      Any indemnification under these provisions will only be out of our assets. Unless it otherwise agrees, the general partner will not be personally liable for, or have any obligation to contribute or lend funds or assets to us to enable us to effectuate, indemnification. We may purchase insurance against liabilities asserted against and expenses incurred by persons for our activities, regardless of whether we would have the power to indemnify the person against liabilities under the partnership agreement.

189


 

Reimbursement of Expenses
      Our partnership agreement requires us to reimburse our general partner for all direct and indirect expenses it incurs or payments it makes on our behalf and all other expenses allocable to us or otherwise incurred by our general partner in connection with operating our business. These expenses include salary, bonus, incentive compensation and other amounts paid to persons who perform services for us or on our behalf, and expenses allocated to our general partner by its affiliates. Our general partner is entitled to determine in good faith the expenses that are allocable to us.
Books and Reports
      The general partner is required to keep appropriate books of our business at our principal offices. The books will be maintained for both tax and financial reporting purposes on an accrual basis. For tax and fiscal reporting purposes, our fiscal year is the calendar year.
      We will furnish or make available to record holders of common units, within 120 days after the close of each fiscal year, an annual report containing audited financial statements and a report on those financial statements by our independent chartered accountants. Except for our fourth quarter, we will also furnish or make available summary financial information within 90 days after the close of each quarter.
Right to Inspect Our Books and Records
      The partnership agreement provides that a limited partner can, for a purpose reasonably related to his interest as a limited partner, upon reasonable demand and at the limited partner’s own expense, have furnished to the limited partner:
        (1) a current list of the name and last known address of each partner;
 
        (2) a copy of our tax returns;
 
        (3) information as to the amount of cash, and a description and statement of the agreed value of any other property or services, contributed or to be contributed by each partner and the date on which each became a partner;
 
        (4) copies of the partnership agreement, the certificate of limited partnership of the partnership, related amendments and powers of attorney under which they have been executed;
 
        (5) information regarding the status of our business and financial condition; and
 
        (6) any other information regarding our affairs as is just and reasonable.
      The general partner may, and intends to, keep confidential from the limited partners trade secrets or other information the disclosure of which the general partner believes in good faith is not in our best interests or that we are required by law or by agreements with third parties to keep confidential.
Registration Rights
      Under the partnership agreement, we have agreed to register for resale under the Securities Act of 1933 and applicable state securities laws any common units, subordinated units or other partnership securities proposed to be sold by the general partner or any of its affiliates or their assignees if an exemption from the registration requirements is not otherwise available or advisable. These registration rights continue for two years following any withdrawal or removal of Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C. as our general partner. We are obligated to pay all expenses incidental to the registration, excluding underwriting discounts and commissions. Please read “Units Eligible for Future Sale.”

190


 

UNITS ELIGIBLE FOR FUTURE SALE
      After the sale of the common units offered by this prospectus, our general partner and its affiliates will hold an aggregate of 2,800,000 common units and 9,800,000 subordinated units. All of the subordinated units will convert into common units at the end of the subordination period. The sale of these common and subordinated units could have an adverse impact on the price of the common units or on any trading market that may develop.
      The common units sold in this offering will generally be freely transferable without restriction or further registration under the Securities Act of 1933. However, any common units held by an “affiliate” of ours may not be resold publicly except in compliance with the registration requirements of the Securities Act or under an exemption from the registration requirements of the Securities Act pursuant to Rule 144 or otherwise. Rule 144 permits securities acquired by an affiliate of ours to be sold into the market in an amount that does not exceed, during any three-month period, the greater of:
  •  1.0% of the total number of the class of securities outstanding; or
 
  •  the average weekly reported trading volume of the common units for the four calendar weeks prior to the sale.
      Sales under Rule 144 are also subject to specific manner of sale provisions, holding period requirements, notice requirements and the availability of current public information about us. A person who is not deemed to have been an affiliate of ours at any time during the three months preceding a sale, and who has beneficially owned common units for at least two years, would be entitled to sell those common units under Rule 144 without regard to the current public information requirements, volume limitations, manner of sale provisions, and notice requirements of Rule 144.
      The partnership agreement provides that we may issue an unlimited number of limited partner interests of any type without a vote of the unitholders. Any issuance of additional common units or other equity securities would result in a corresponding decrease in the proportionate ownership interest in us represented by, and could adversely affect the cash distributions to and market price of, common units then outstanding. Please read “The Partnership Agreement — Issuance of Additional Securities.”
      Under the partnership agreement, our general partner and its affiliates have the right to cause us to register under the Securities Act and applicable state securities laws the offer and sale of any units that they hold. Subject to the terms and conditions of the partnership agreement, these registration rights allow our general partner and its affiliates or their assignees holding any units to require registration of any of these units and to include any of these units in a registration by us of other units, including units offered by us or by any unitholder. Our general partner will continue to have these registration rights for two years following its withdrawal or removal as our general partner. In connection with any registration of this kind, we will indemnify each unitholder participating in the registration and its officers, directors and controlling persons from and against any liabilities under the Securities Act or any applicable state securities laws arising from the registration statement or prospectus. We will bear all costs and expenses incidental to any registration, excluding any underwriting discounts and commissions. Except as described below, our general partner and its affiliates may sell their units in private transactions at any time, subject to compliance with applicable laws.
      We, our subsidiaries, our general partner and its affiliates, including the directors and executive officers of our general partner, Teekay Shipping Corporation and the participants in our directed unit program, have agreed not to sell any common units for a period of 180 days (or 90 days for non-officer or director participants in our directed unit program) from the date of this prospectus, subject to certain exceptions. Please read “Underwriting” for a description of these lock-up provisions.

191


 

MATERIAL U.S. FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSIDERATIONS
      The following is a discussion of the material U.S. federal income tax considerations that may be relevant to prospective unitholders and, unless otherwise noted in the following discussion, is the opinion of Perkins Coie LLP, our U.S. counsel, insofar as it relates to matters of U.S. federal income tax law and legal conclusions with respect to those matters. The opinion of our counsel is dependent on the accuracy of representations made by us to them, including descriptions of our operations contained herein.
      This discussion is based upon provisions of the U.S. Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (or the Code ) as in effect on the date of this prospectus, existing final and temporary regulations thereunder (or Treasury Regulations ), and current administrative rulings and court decisions, all of which are subject to change, possibly with retroactive effect. Changes in these authorities may cause the tax consequences to vary substantially from the consequences described below. Unless the context otherwise requires, references in this section to “we,” “our” or “us” are references to Teekay Offshore Partners L.P.
      The following summary does not comment on all aspects of U.S. federal income taxation which may be important to particular unitholders in light of their individual circumstances, such as unitholders subject to special tax rules ( e.g. , financial institutions, insurance companies, broker-dealers, tax-exempt organizations, or former citizens or long-term residents of the United States) or to persons that will hold the units as part of a straddle, hedge, conversion, constructive sale, or other integrated transaction for U.S. federal income tax purposes, partnerships or their partners, or that have a functional currency other than the U.S. dollar, all of whom may be subject to tax rules that differ significantly from those summarized below. If a partnership or other entity taxed as a pass-through entity holds our common units, the tax treatment of a partner or owner thereof will generally depend upon the status of the partner or owner and upon the activities of the partnership or pass-through entity. If you are a partner in a partnership or owner of a pass-through entity holding our common units, you should consult your tax advisor.
      No ruling has been or will be requested from the Internal Revenue Service (or the IRS ) regarding any matter affecting us or prospective unitholders. Instead, we will rely on the opinion of Perkins Coie LLP. Unlike a ruling, an opinion of counsel represents only that counsel’s best legal judgment and does not bind the IRS or the courts. Accordingly, the opinions and statements made here may not be sustained by a court if contested by the IRS.
      This summary does not discuss any U.S. state or local, estate or alternative minimum tax considerations regarding the ownership or disposition of common units. This summary is written for unitholders that will hold their units as “capital assets” under the Code. Each prospective unitholder is urged to consult its tax advisor regarding the U.S. federal, state, local, and other tax consequences of the ownership or disposition of common units.
Election to be Taxed as a Corporation
      We have elected to be taxed as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes. As such, unitholders will not directly be subject to U.S. federal income tax on our income, but rather will be subject to U.S. federal income tax on distributions received from us and dispositions of units as described below.
United States Federal Income Taxation of U.S. Holders
      As used herein, the term U.S. Holder means a beneficial owner of our common units that is a U.S. citizen or resident (as determined for U.S. federal income tax purposes), U.S. corporation or other U.S. entity taxable as a corporation, an estate the income of which is subject to U.S. federal income taxation regardless of its source, or a trust if a court within the United States is able to exercise primary jurisdiction over the administration of the trust and one or more U.S. persons have the authority to control all substantial decisions of the trust.

192


 

Distributions
      Subject to the discussion of the rules applicable to passive foreign investment companies (or PFICs ) below, any distributions made by us with respect to our common units to a U.S. Holder generally will constitute dividends, which may be taxable as ordinary income or “qualified dividend income” as described in more detail below, to the extent of our current or accumulated earnings and profits, as determined under U.S. federal income tax principles. Distributions in excess of our earnings and profits will be treated first as a nontaxable return of capital to the extent of the U.S. Holder’s tax basis in its common units on a dollar-for-dollar basis and thereafter as capital gain. U.S. Holders that are corporations generally will not be entitled to claim a dividends received deduction with respect to any distributions they receive from us. Dividends paid with respect to our common units generally will be treated as “passive income” (or “passive category income” for taxable years beginning after December 31, 2006) or, in the case of certain types of U.S. Holders, “financial services income,” (which will be treated as “general category income” for taxable years beginning after December 31, 2006) for purposes of computing allowable foreign tax credits for U.S. federal income tax purposes.
      Dividends paid on our common units to a U.S. Holder who is an individual, trust or estate (or a U.S. Individual Holder ) will be treated as “qualified dividend income” that is taxable to such U.S. Individual Holder at preferential capital gain tax rates (through 2010) provided that: (i) our common units are readily tradable on an established securities market in the United States (such as the New York Stock Exchange on which we expect our common units will be traded); (ii) we are not a PFIC for the taxable year during which the dividend is paid or the immediately preceding taxable year (which we do not believe we are, have been or will be, as discussed below); (iii) the U.S. Individual Holder has owned the common units for more than 60 days in the 121-day period beginning 60 days before the date on which the common units become ex-dividend; and (iv) the U.S. Individual Holder is not under an obligation to make related payments with respect to positions in substantially similar or related property. There is no assurance that any dividends paid on our common units will be eligible for these preferential rates in the hands of a U.S. Individual Holder, and any dividends paid on our common units that are not eligible for these preferential rates will be taxed as ordinary income to a U.S. Individual Holder. In the absence of legislation extending the term of the preferential tax rates for qualified dividend income, all dividends received by a taxpayer in tax years beginning on January 1, 2011 or later will be taxed at ordinary graduated tax rates.
      Special rules may apply to any “extraordinary dividend” paid by us. An extraordinary dividend is, generally, a dividend with respect to a common unit if the amount of the dividend is equal to or in excess of 10.0% of a unitholder’s adjusted basis (or fair market value in certain circumstances) in such common unit. If we pay an “extraordinary dividend” on our common units that is treated as “qualified dividend income,” then any loss derived by a U.S. Individual Holder from the sale or exchange of such common units will be treated as long-term capital loss to the extent of such dividend.
      In addition, under proposed legislation, the preferential rate of federal income tax currently imposed on qualified dividend income would be denied with respect to dividends received from a non-U.S.  corporation, unless the non-U.S.  corporation either is eligible for benefits of a comprehensive income tax treaty with the United States or is created or organized under the laws of a foreign country which has a comprehensive income tax system. Because the Marshall Islands has not entered into a comprehensive income tax treaty with the United States and imposes only limited taxes on corporations organized under its laws, it is unlikely that we could satisfy either of these requirements. Consequently, if this legislation were enacted the preferential tax rates imposed on qualified dividend income may no longer be applicable to dividends received from us. Any dividends paid on our common units that are not eligible for the preferential rate will be taxed as ordinary income to a U.S. Individual Holder. As of the date hereof, it is not possible to predict with any certainty whether the proposed legislation will be enacted.

193


 

Ratio of Dividend Income to Distributions
      We estimate that for distributions made to a purchaser of common units in this offering and who owns those common units from the date of closing of this offering through December 31, 2009, approximately 70.0% of the total cash distributions made during that period, on a cumulative basis, will constitute dividend income. The remaining portion of this distribution will be treated first as a nontaxable return of capital to the extent of the purchaser’s tax basis in its common units on a dollar-for-dollar basis and thereafter as capital gain. These estimates are based upon the assumption that we will pay the minimum quarterly distribution of $0.35 per unit on our common units during the referenced period and other assumptions with respect to the period relating to capital expenditures and cash flow. These estimates and assumptions are subject to, among other things, numerous business, economic, regulatory, competitive and political uncertainties beyond our control. Further, the estimates are based on current U.S. federal income tax law and tax reporting positions that we will adopt and with which the IRS could disagree. Accordingly, we cannot assure you that these estimates will prove to be correct. The actual percentage of total cash distributions that will constitute dividend income could be higher or lower, and any differences could be material and could materially affect the value of the common units.
Consequences of Possible PFIC Classification
      A non-U.S.  entity treated as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes will be a PFIC in any taxable year in which, after taking into account the income and assets of the corporation and certain subsidiaries pursuant to a “look through” rule, either: (i) at least 75.0% of its gross income is “passive” income; or (ii) at least 50.0% of the average value of its assets is attributable to assets that produce passive income or are held for the production of passive income.
      While there are legal uncertainties involved in this determination, our counsel, Perkins Coie LLP, is of the opinion that we should not be a PFIC based on certain representations that we have made to them regarding the composition of our assets, the source of our income, and the nature of our chartering activities and other operations following this offering, including:
  •  the income derived from our time charters and contracts of affreightment will be greater than 25.0% of our total gross income at all relevant times; and
 
  •  the gross value of our vessels servicing our contracts of affreightment or operating under time charters will exceed the gross value of all other assets we own at all relevant times.
      In addition to these representations, the opinion of Perkins Coie LLP that we should not be a PFIC is based principally on the position that at least a majority, if not all, the gross income we derive from our time charters and contracts of affreightment should constitute services income, rather than rental income. Correspondingly, such services income should not constitute passive income, and the assets that we own and operate in connection with the production of such income, in particular the vessels operating under time charters or servicing contracts of affreightment, should not constitute passive assets for purposes of determining whether we are a PFIC. Regarding this position, the opinion of Perkins Coie LLP assumes that all future time charters and contracts of affreightment that we will enter into are substantially similar to those we provided to them for their review. Substantial legal authority supports this position, including case law and IRS pronouncements concerning the characterization of income derived from time charters, contracts of affreightment and similar contracts for other tax purposes. However, in the absence of any legal authority specifically relating to the statutory provisions governing PFICs, the IRS or a court could disagree with this position and the opinion we have received from Perkins Coie LLP. In addition, there is no assurance that the nature of our assets, income and operations will remain the same in the future. Moreover, the market value of our units may be treated as reflecting the value of our assets at any given time. Therefore, a decline in the market value of our units (which is not within our control) may impact the determination of whether we are a PFIC.
      If we were classified as a PFIC, for any year during which a U.S. Holder owns units, he generally will be subject to special rules (regardless of whether we continue thereafter to be a PFIC) with respect to:

194


 

(i) any “excess distribution” (generally, any distribution received by a unitholder in a taxable year that is greater than 125.0% of the average annual distributions received by the unitholder in the three preceding taxable years or, if shorter, the unitholder’s holding period for the units), and (ii) any gain realized upon the sale or other disposition of units. Under these rules:
  •  the excess distribution or gain will be allocated ratably over the unitholder’s holding period;
 
  •  the amount allocated to the current taxable year and any year prior to the first year in which we were a PFIC will be taxed as ordinary income in the current year;
 
  •  the amount allocated to each of the other taxable years in the unitholder’s holding period will be subject to U.S. federal income tax at the highest rate in effect for the applicable class of taxpayer for that year; and
 
  •  an interest charge for the deemed deferral benefit will be imposed with respect to the resulting tax attributable to each such other taxable year.
      Certain elections that would alter the tax consequences to a U.S. Holder, such as a qualified electing fund election or mark to market election, may be available to a U.S. Holder if we are classified as a PFIC. If we determine that we are or will be a PFIC, we will provide unitholders with information concerning the potential availability of such elections.
      As described above, current law provides that dividends received by a U.S. Individual Holder from a qualified foreign corporation are subject to U.S. federal income tax at preferential rates through 2010. However, if we are classified as a PFIC for a taxable year in which we pay a dividend or the immediately preceding taxable year, we would not be considered a qualified foreign corporation, and a U.S. Individual Holder receiving such dividends would not be eligible for the reduced rate of U.S. federal income tax.
Consequences of Possible Controlled Foreign Corporation Classification
      If more than 50.0% of either the total combined voting power of our outstanding units entitled to vote or the total value of all of our outstanding units were owned, directly, indirectly or constructively, by citizens or residents of the United States, U.S. partnerships or corporations, or U.S. estates or trusts (as defined for U.S. federal income tax purposes), each of which owned, directly, indirectly or constructively, 10.0% or more of the total combined voting power of our outstanding units entitled to vote (each, a United States Shareholder ), we generally would be treated as a controlled foreign corporation (or CFC ). United States Shareholders of a CFC are treated as receiving current distributions of their shares of certain income of the CFC (not including, under current law, certain undistributed earnings attributable to shipping income) without regard to any actual distributions and are subject to other burdensome U.S. federal income tax and administrative requirements but generally are not also subject to the requirements generally applicable to owners of a PFIC. Although we will not be a CFC following the Offering, U.S. persons purchasing a substantial interest in us should consider the potential implications of being treated as a United States Shareholder in the event we were to become a CFC in the future.
Sale, Exchange or other Disposition of Common Units
      Assuming we do not constitute a PFIC for any taxable year, a U.S. Holder generally will recognize taxable gain or loss upon a sale, exchange or other disposition of our common units in an amount equal to the difference between the amount realized by the U.S. Holder from such sale, exchange or other disposition and the U.S. Holder’s tax basis in such units. Subject to the discussion of extraordinary dividends above, such gain or loss will be treated as long-term capital gain or loss if the U.S. Holder’s holding period is greater than one year at the time of the sale, exchange or other disposition, and subject to preferential capital gain tax rates. Such capital gain or loss will generally be treated as U.S.-source gain or loss, as applicable, for U.S. foreign tax credit purposes. A U.S. Holder’s ability to deduct capital losses is subject to certain limitations.

195


 

Special Reporting Requirements
      A U.S. Holder who either (i) transfers more than $100,000 to us (when added to the amount of cash transferred to us by such person or a related person during the previous 12 months), or (ii) following the transfer owns, directly, indirectly or by attribution from certain related persons, at least a 10.0% interest in us, is required to file IRS Form 926 with his U.S. federal income tax return for the year of the transfer to report the transfer. In addition to the foregoing, a U.S. person who directly owns at least a 10.0% interest in us may be required to make additional disclosures on IRS Form 5471 in the event such person acquires, disposes or has his interest in us substantially increased or reduced. For these purposes, a “10.0% interest” in us generally is defined to mean 10.0% of the total voting power or value of us.
      Significant penalties may apply for failing to satisfy IRS Form 926 and IRS Form 5471 filing requirements and, thus, unitholders are advised to contact their tax advisors to determine the application of these filing requirements under their own circumstances.
United States Federal Income Taxation of Non-U.S.  Holders
      A beneficial owner of our common units (other than a partnership, including any entity or arrangement treated as a partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes) that is not a U.S. Holder is a Non-U.S.  Holder.
Distributions
      Distributions we pay to a Non-U.S.  Holder will not be subject to U.S. federal income tax or withholding tax if the Non-U.S.  Holder is not engaged in a U.S. trade or business. If the Non-U.S.  Holder is engaged in a U.S. trade or business, distributions we pay will be subject to U.S. federal income tax to the extent those distributions constitute income effectively connected with that Non-U.S.  Holder’s U.S. trade or business. However, distributions paid to a Non-U.S.  Holder who is engaged in a trade or business may be exempt from taxation under an income tax treaty if the income represented thereby is not attributable to a U.S. permanent establishment maintained by the Non-U.S.  Holder.
Disposition of Units
      The U.S. federal income taxation of Non-U.S.  Holders on any gain resulting from the disposition of our common units is generally the same as described above regarding distributions. However, individual Non-U.S.  Holders may be subject to tax on gain resulting from the disposition of our common units if they are present in the United States for 183 days or more during the taxable year in which those shares are disposed and meet certain other requirements.
Backup Withholding and Information Reporting
      In general, payments of distributions or the proceeds of a disposition of common units to a non-corporate U.S. Holder will be subject to information reporting requirements. These payments to a non-corporate U.S. Holder also may be subject to backup withholding, if the non-corporate U.S. Holder:
  •  fails to provide an accurate taxpayer identification number;
 
  •  is notified by the IRS that he has failed to report all interest or distributions required to be shown on his U.S. federal income tax returns; or
 
  •  in certain circumstances, fails to comply with applicable certification requirements.

196


 

      Non-U.S. Holders may be required to establish their exemption from information reporting and backup withholding on payments within the United States by certifying their status on IRS Form  W-8BEN, W-8ECI or W-8IMY, as applicable.
      Backup withholding is not an additional tax. Rather, a unitholder generally may obtain a credit for any amount withheld against its liability for U.S. federal income tax (and a refund of any amounts withheld in excess of such liability) by filing a return with the IRS.

197


 

NON-UNITED STATES TAX CONSIDERATIONS
Marshall Islands Tax Considerations
      The following discussion is based upon the opinion of Watson, Farley & Williams (New York) LLP, our counsel as to matters of the laws of the Republic of the Marshall Islands, and the current laws of the Republic of the Marshall Islands applicable to persons who do not reside in, maintain offices in or engage in business in the Republic of the Marshall Islands.
      Because we, OPCO and our respective subsidiaries do not, and we do not expect that we, OPCO or our respective subsidiaries will, conduct business or operations in the Republic of the Marshall Islands, and because all documentation related to this offering will be executed outside of the Republic of the Marshall Islands, under current Marshall Islands law you will not be subject to Marshall Islands taxation or withholding on distributions, including upon a return of capital, we make to you as a unitholder. In addition, you will not be subject to Marshall Islands stamp, capital gains or other taxes on the purchase, ownership or disposition of common units, and you will not be required by the Republic of the Marshall Islands to file a tax return relating to the common units.
      It is the responsibility of each unitholder to investigate the legal and tax consequences, under the laws of pertinent jurisdictions, including the Marshall Islands, of its investment in us. Accordingly, each prospective unitholder is urged to consult its tax counsel or other advisor with regard to those matters. Further, it is the responsibility of each unitholder to file all state, local and non-U.S., as well as U.S. federal, tax returns that may be required of him.
Canadian Federal Income Tax Considerations
      The following discussion is a summary of the material Canadian federal income tax considerations under the Income Tax Act (Canada) (the Canada Tax Act ), as of the date of this prospectus, that we believe are relevant to holders of common units acquired in this offering who are, at all relevant times, for the purposes of the Canada Tax Act and the Canada-United States Tax Convention 1980 (the Canada-U.S. Treaty ) resident in the United States and who deal at arm’s length with us and Teekay Shipping Corporation ( U.S. Resident Holders ).
      Under the Canada Tax Act, no taxes on income (including taxable capital gains) are payable by U.S. Resident Holders in respect of the acquisition, holding, disposition or redemption of the common units, provided that we do not carry on business in Canada and such U.S. Resident Holders do not, for the purposes of the Canada-U.S. Treaty, otherwise have a permanent establishment or fixed base in Canada to which such common units pertain and, in addition, do not use or hold and are not deemed or considered to use or hold such common units in the course of carrying on a business in Canada and, in the case of any U.S. Resident Holders that carry on an insurance business in Canada and elsewhere, such U.S. Resident Holders establish that the common units are not effectively connected with their insurance business carried on in Canada.
      In this connection, we believe that our activities and affairs and the activities and affairs of OPCO, a Marshall Island Limited Partnership in which we own a 26.0% limited partnership interest, can be conducted in a manner that both we and OPCO will not be carrying on business in Canada. As a result, U.S. Resident Holders should not be considered to be carrying on business in Canada for purposes of the Canada Tax Act solely by reason of the acquisition, holding, disposition or redemption of their common units. We intend that this is and continues to be the case, notwithstanding that in providing certain services to Teekay Offshore Partners L.P., OPCO and its operating subsidiaries, Teekay Shipping Limited (a subsidiary of Teekay Shipping Corporation that is resident and based in the Bahamas) will contract for assistance in the delivery of such services with Canadian service providers, as discussed below.
      Under the Canada Tax Act, our election to be treated as a corporation for U.S. tax purposes has no effect. Therefore, we will continue to be treated as a partnership for Canadian tax purposes. Under the Canada Tax Act, a resident of Canada (which may include a foreign corporation the central management

198


 

and control of which is in Canada) is subject to Canadian tax on its world-wide income, subject to any relief that may be provided by any relevant tax treaty. A non-resident corporation or individual that carries on a business in Canada directly or through a partnership, including through a partnership that owns an interest in another partnership, is subject to tax in Canada on income attributable to its business (or that of the partnership’s or the partnership’s interest in another partnership, as the case may be) carried on in Canada. The taxation under the Canada Tax Act is subject to the provisions of any relevant tax treaty.
      The Canada Tax Act contains special rules that provide assurance to qualifying international shipping corporations that they will not be considered resident in Canada even if they are, in whole or in part, managed from Canada. Further, the Canada Tax Act and many of the tax treaties to which Canada is a party also contain special exemptions for profits derived from international shipping operations.
      We and OPCO will enter into agreements with Teekay Shipping Limited for the provision of administrative services, and certain of OPCO’s operating subsidiaries will enter into agreements with:
  •  Teekay Shipping Limited for the provision of advisory, technical, ship management and administrative services; and
 
  •  Teekay Shipping Canada Ltd., a Canadian subsidiary of Teekay Shipping Corporation, for the provision of strategic advisory and consulting services.
      Please read “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions — Advisory and Administrative Services Agreements.”
      Certain of the services that Teekay Shipping Limited will provide to us, to OPCO and to OPCO’s operating subsidiaries under the services agreements will be obtained by Teekay Shipping Limited through subcontracts with a Canadian subsidiary of Teekay Shipping Corporation. The special rules in the Canada Tax Act and various relevant tax treaties relating to qualifying international shipping corporations and income from international shipping operations may provide relief to OPCO’s operating subsidiaries to the extent that the services provided to them by Canadian entities would otherwise result in such operating subsidiaries being considered to be resident in Canada or to be taxable in Canada on certain income from such operations by virtue of carrying on business in Canada. However, such rules would not apply to us or OPCO, as holding limited partnerships, or to our general partner or unitholders. While we do not believe it to be the case, if the arrangements described herein result in our being considered to carry on business in Canada for purposes of the Canada Tax Act, our unitholders would be considered to be carrying on business in Canada and may be required to file Canadian tax returns and, subject to any relief provided in any relevant treaty (including, in the case of U.S. Resident Holders, the Canada-U.S. Treaty), would be subject to taxation in Canada on any income that is considered to be attributable to the business carried on by us in Canada.
      We believe that we and OPCO can each conduct our respective activities and affairs in a manner so that our unitholders should not be considered to be carrying on business in Canada solely as a consequence of the acquisition, holding, disposition or redemption of our common units. Consequently, we believe our unitholders should not be subject to tax filing or other tax obligations in Canada under the Canada Tax Act. However, although we do not intend to do so, there can be no assurance that the manner in which we and OPCO carry on our respective activities will not change from time to time as circumstances dictate or warrant in a manner that may cause our unitholders to be carrying on business in Canada for purposes of the Canada Tax Act. Further, the relevant Canadian federal income tax law may change by legislation or judicial interpretation and the Canadian taxing authorities may take a different view than we have of the current law.
      It is the responsibility of each unitholder to investigate the legal and tax consequences, under the laws of pertinent jurisdictions, including Canada, of its investment in us. Accordingly, each prospective unitholder is urged to consult, and depend upon, its tax counsel or other advisor with regard to those matters. Further, it is the responsibility of each unitholder to file all state, local and non-U.S., as well as U.S. federal, tax returns that may be required of him.

199


 

INVESTMENT IN TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS L.P. BY EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLANS
      An investment in us by an employee benefit plan is subject to additional considerations because the investments of these plans are subject to the fiduciary responsibility and prohibited transaction provisions of the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974 (or ERISA ), and restrictions imposed by Section 4975 of the U.S. Internal Revenue Code. For these purposes, the term “employee benefit plan” includes, but is not limited to, qualified pension, profit-sharing and stock bonus plans, Keogh plans, simplified employee pension plans and tax deferred annuities or IRAs established or maintained by an employer or employee organization. Among other things, consideration should be given to:
  •  whether the investment is prudent under Section 404(a)(1)(B) of ERISA;
 
  •  whether in making the investment, that plan will satisfy the diversification requirements of Section 404(a)(l)(C) of ERISA; and
 
  •  whether the investment will result in recognition of unrelated business taxable income by the plan and, if so, the potential after-tax investment return.
      In addition, the person with investment discretion with respect to the assets of an employee benefit plan is a fiduciary under applicable law and should determine whether an investment in us is authorized by the appropriate governing instrument and is a proper investment for the plan.
      Section 406 of ERISA and Section 4975 of the Internal Revenue Code prohibit employee benefit plans, and IRAs that are not considered part of an employee benefit plan, from engaging in specified transactions involving “plan assets” with parties that are “parties in interest” under ERISA or “disqualified persons” under the Internal Revenue Code with respect to the plan.
      In addition to considering whether the purchase of common units is a prohibited transaction, a fiduciary of an employee benefit plan should consider whether the plan will, by investing in us, be deemed to own an undivided interest in our assets, with the result that our general partner also would be a fiduciary of the plan and our operations would be subject to the regulatory restrictions of ERISA, including its prohibited transaction rules, as well as the prohibited transaction rules of the Internal Revenue Code.
      The U.S. Department of Labor regulations provide guidance with respect to whether the assets of an entity in which employee benefit plans acquire equity interests would be deemed “plan assets” under some circumstances. Under these regulations, an entity’s assets would not be considered to be “plan assets” if, among other things:
  •  the equity interests acquired by employee benefit plans are publicly offered securities; i.e., the equity interests are widely held by 100 or more investors independent of the issuer and each other, freely transferable and registered under specified provisions of the federal securities laws;
 
  •  the entity is an “operating company” (i.e., it is primarily engaged in the production or sale of a product or service other than the investment of capital either directly or through a majority owned subsidiary or subsidiaries); or
 
  •  there is no significant investment by benefit plan investors, which means that less than 25% of the value of each class of equity interest, disregarding some interests held by our general partner, its affiliates and any other persons who have the ability to control our assets or who provide investment advice with respect to such assets, is held by the employee benefit plans referred to above, IRAs and other employee benefit plans not subject to ERISA, including governmental plans, and entities whose underlying assets include employee benefit plan (or IRA) assets by reason of an employee benefit plan’s (or IRA’s) investment in such entities.
      Our assets should not be considered “plan assets” under these regulations because we expect that the investment will satisfy the requirements in the first bullet point above (i.e., we expect that the equity interests will constitute publicly offered securities).

200


 

      Plan fiduciaries contemplating a purchase of common units should consult with their own counsel regarding the consequences under ERISA and the Internal Revenue Code in light of the serious penalties imposed on persons who engage in prohibited transactions or other violations.

201


 

UNDERWRITING
      Citigroup Global Markets Inc. and Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated are acting as joint book-running managers of this offering and as the representatives of the underwriters named below. Subject to the terms and conditions stated in the underwriting agreement dated the date of this prospectus, each underwriter named below has severally agreed to purchase from us, and we have agreed to sell to that underwriter, the number of common units set forth opposite the underwriter’s name.
           
    Number of
Underwriter   Common Units
     
Citigroup Global Markets Inc.
       
Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith
 Incorporated
       
Morgan Stanley & Co. Incorporated
       
A.G. Edwards & Sons, Inc. 
       
Deutsche Bank Securities Inc. 
       
Raymond James & Associates, Inc. 
       
Simmons & Company International
       
DnB NOR Markets, Inc. 
       
Fortis Securities LLC
       
       
 
Total
    7,000,000  
       
      The underwriting agreement provides that the obligations of the underwriters to purchase the common units included in this offering are subject to approval of legal matters by counsel and to other conditions. The underwriters are obligated to purchase all the common units (other than those covered by the over-allotment option described below) if they purchase any of the common units.
      The underwriters propose to offer some of the common units directly to the public at the public offering price set forth on the cover page of this prospectus and some of the common units to dealers at the public offering price less a concession not to exceed $           per common unit. The underwriters may allow, and dealers may reallow, a concession on sales to other dealers. If all of the common units are not sold at the initial offering price, the representative may change the public offering price and the other selling terms. The representatives have advised us that the underwriters do not intend sales to discretionary accounts to exceed 5% of the total number of our common units offered by them.
      We have granted to the underwriters an option, exercisable for 30 days from the date of this prospectus, to purchase up to 1,050,000 additional common units at the public offering price less the underwriting discount. The underwriters may exercise the option solely for the purpose of covering any over-allotments, if any, in connection with this offering. To the extent the option is exercised, each underwriter must purchase a number of additional common units approximately proportionate to that underwriter’s initial purchase commitment.
      We, our general partner, the officers and directors of our general partner, and Teekay Shipping Corporation have agreed that, for a period of 180 days from the date of this prospectus, we and they will not, without the prior written consent of the representatives, dispose of or hedge any common units or any securities convertible into or exchangeable for our common units. The representatives in their sole discretion may release any of the securities subject to these lock-up agreements at any time without notice. The representatives have no present intent or arrangement to release any of the securities subject to these lock-up agreements. The release of any lock-up is considered on a case by case basis. Factors in deciding whether to release common units may include the length of time before the lock-up expires, the number of units involved, the reason for the requested release, market conditions, the trading price of our common units, historical trading volumes of our common units and whether the person seeking the release is an officer, director or affiliate of us.

202


 

      The 180-day restricted period described in the preceding paragraph will be extended if:
  •  during the last 17 days of the 180-day restricted period we issue an earnings release or announce material news or a material event; or
 
  •  prior to the expiration of the 180-day restricted period, we announce that we will release earnings results during the 16-day period beginning on the last day of the 180-day restricted period,
in which case the restrictions described in the preceding paragraph will continue to apply until the expiration of the 18-day period beginning on the issuance of the earnings release or the announcement of the material news or event.
      At our request, the underwriters have reserved up to 10% of the common units for sale at the initial public offering price to persons who are directors, officers or employees, or who are otherwise associated with us, through a directed unit program. The number of common units available for sale to the general public will be reduced by the number of directed units purchased by participants in the program. The common units reserved for sale under the directed unit program will be subject to 90-day lock-up agreements (or 180 days if they are sold to officers, directors or employees of our general partner), subject to extension as described above in the event of earnings releases or material announcements. Any directed units not purchased will be offered by the underwriters to the general public on the same basis as all other common units offered. We have agreed to indemnify the underwriters against certain liabilities and expenses, including liabilities under the Securities Act of 1933, in connection with the sales of the directed units.
      Prior to this offering, there has been no public market for our common units. Consequently, the initial public offering price for the common units will be determined by negotiations between our general partner and the representatives and upon the recommendation of the qualified independent underwriter. Among the factors considered in determining the initial public offering price will be our record of operations, our current financial condition, our future prospects, our markets, the economic conditions in and future prospects for the industry in which we compete, our management and currently prevailing general conditions in the equity securities markets, including current market valuations of publicly traded companies considered comparable to us. We cannot assure you, however, that the prices at which the common units will sell in the public market after this offering will not be lower than the initial public offering price or that an active trading market in our common units will develop and continue after this offering.
      Our common units have been approved for listing on the New York Stock Exchange, subject to official notice of issuance, under the symbol “TOO.”
      In connection with the listing of our common units on the New York Stock Exchange, the underwriters have advised us that they will undertake to sell round lots of 100 or more of common units to a minimum of 2,000 beneficial owners.
      The following table shows the underwriting discounts and commissions that we are to pay to the underwriters in connection with this offering. These amounts are shown assuming both no exercise and full exercise of the underwriters’ option to purchase additional common units.
                 
    Paid by Teekay Offshore
    Partners L.P.
     
    No Exercise   Full Exercise
         
Per common unit
  $       $    
Total
  $       $    
      We estimate that our portion of the total expenses of this offering, excluding underwriting discounts and commissions and the structuring fee described below, will be approximately $2.7 million. The underwriters have agreed to reimburse us for a portion of these expenses in an amount of approximately $300,000.

203


 

      We will pay a structuring fee equal to an aggregate of 0.375% of the gross proceeds of this offering, not to exceed $562,500, including any exercise of the underwriters’ over-allotment option, to Citigroup Global Markets Inc. and Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated for evaluation, analysis and structuring of us.
      In connection with this offering, the underwriters may purchase and sell common units in the open market. These transactions may include short sales, syndicate covering transactions and stabilizing transactions. Short sales involve syndicate sales of common units in excess of the number of common units to be purchased by the underwriters in this offering, which creates a syndicate short position. “Covered” short sales are sales of common units made in an amount up to the number of common units represented by the underwriters’ over-allotment option. In determining the source of common units to close out the covered syndicate short position, the underwriters will consider, among other things, the price of common units available for purchase in the open market as compared to the price at which they may purchase common units through the over-allotment option. Transactions to close out the covered syndicate short involve either purchases of the common units in the open market after the distribution has been completed or the exercise of the over-allotment option. The underwriters may also make “naked” short sales of common units in excess of the over-allotment option. The underwriters must close out any naked short position by purchasing common units in the open market. A naked short position is more likely to be created if the underwriters are concerned that there may be downward pressure on the price of the common units in the open market after pricing that could adversely affect investors who purchase in this offering. Stabilizing transactions consist of bids for or purchases of common units in the open market while this offering is in progress.
      The underwriters also may impose a penalty bid. Penalty bids permit the underwriters to reclaim a selling concession from a syndicate member when the representatives repurchase common units originally sold by that syndicate member in order to cover syndicate short positions or make stabilizing purchases.
      Any of these activities may have the effect of preventing or retarding a decline in the market price of the common units. They may also cause the price of the common units to be higher than the price that would otherwise exist in the open market in the absence of these transactions. The underwriters may conduct these transactions on the New York Stock Exchange or in the over-the -counter market, or otherwise. If the underwriters commence any of these transactions, they may discontinue them at any time without notice.
      Certain of the underwriters and their affiliates have performed investment banking, commercial banking and advisory services for Teekay Shipping Corporation and its affiliate Teekay LNG Partners L.P. from time to time for which they have received customary fees and expenses. The underwriters and their affiliates may in the future perform investment banking and advisory services for us and our affiliates including Teekay Shipping Corporation from time to time and in the ordinary course of business for which they may in the future receive customary fees and expenses. Affiliates of Citigroup Global Markets Inc., Fortis Securities LLC, DnB NOR Markets, Inc. and Deutsche Bank Securities are lenders under a $550 million reducing revolving credit facility with Teekay Shipping Corporation. Additionally, affiliates of Citigroup Global Markets Inc., Deutsche Bank Securities and Fortis Securities LLC are lenders under a $940 million reducing revolving credit facility with OPCO, and affiliates of Citigroup Global Markets Inc., Fortis Securities LLC and DnB NOR Markets, Inc. are also lenders under a $455 million secured credit facility with OPCO.
      Affiliates of Citigroup Global Markets Inc., Fortis Securities LLC, DnB NOR Markets, Inc. and Deutsche Bank Securities are lenders under one of Teekay Shipping Corporation’s credit facilities, and may receive an amount from Teekay Shipping Corporation that is more than 10% of the net proceeds of this offering, if Teekay Shipping Corporation uses amounts received from us to repay borrowings under that facility. Therefore, such affiliates may be deemed to have a “conflict of interest” with us under Rule 2720 of the National Association of Securities Dealers, Inc. When a NASD member with a conflict of interest participates as an underwriter in a public offering, Rule 2720(c)(3) requires that the initial public offering price may be no higher than that recommended by a “qualified independent underwriter,”

204


 

as defined by the NASD. In accordance with this rule, Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith. Incorporated has assumed the responsibilities of acting as a qualified independent underwriter. In its role as a qualified independent underwriter, Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated has performed a due diligence investigation and participated in the preparation of this prospectus and the registration statement of which this prospectus is a part. Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated will not receive any additional fees for serving as a qualified independent underwriter in connection with this offering. We have agreed to indemnify Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated against liabilities incurred in connection with acting as a qualified independent underwriter, including liabilities under the Securities Act of 1933.
      The underwriters have advised us that they do not intend to place a prospectus on the internet or otherwise engage in an electronic distribution in connection with this offering, other than as described below. It is possible that a prospectus in electronic format may be made available on the websites maintained by one or more of the underwriters. Other than the prospectus in electronic format, the information on any such website is not part of the prospectus. The representatives may agree to allocate a number of common units to underwriters for sale to their online brokerage account holders. The representatives will allocate common units to underwriters that may make Internet distributions on the same basis as other allocations. In addition, common units may be sold by the underwriters to securities dealers who resell common units to online brokerage account holders. Any online distributions will be made in accordance with procedures for online distributions previously cleared with the SEC.
      We, our general partner, OPCO, OPCO’s general partner and Teekay Shipping Corporation and one of its subsidiaries have agreed to indemnify the underwriters against certain liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act of 1933, or to contribute to payments the underwriters may be required to make because of any of those liabilities.

205


 

SERVICE OF PROCESS AND ENFORCEMENT OF CIVIL LIABILITIES
      We are organized under the laws of the Marshall Islands as a limited partnership. Our general partner is organized under the laws of the Marshall Islands as a limited liability company. The Marshall Islands has a less developed body of securities laws as compared to the United States and provides protections for investors to a significantly lesser extent.
      Most of the directors and officers of our general partner and those of our controlled affiliates are residents of countries other than the United States. Substantially all of our and our controlled affiliates’ assets and a substantial portion of the assets of the directors and officers of our general partner are located outside the United States. As a result, it may be difficult or impossible for United States investors to effect service of process within the United States upon us, our general partner, our controlled affiliates or the directors and officers of our general partner or to realize against us or them judgments obtained in United States courts, including judgments predicated upon the civil liability provisions of the securities laws of the United States or any state in the United States. However, we have expressly submitted to the jurisdiction of the U.S. federal and New York state courts sitting in the City of New York for the purpose of any suit, action or proceeding arising under the securities laws of the United States or any state in the United States, and we have appointed Watson, Farley & Williams (New York) LLP to accept service of process on our behalf in any such action.
      Watson, Farley & Williams (New York) LLP, our counsel as to Marshall Islands law, has advised us that there is uncertainty as to whether the courts of the Marshall Islands would (1) recognize or enforce against us, our general partner or our general partner’s directors or officers judgments of courts of the United States based on civil liability provisions of applicable U.S. federal and state securities laws; or (2) impose liabilities against us, our general partner or our general partner’s directors and officers in original actions brought in the Marshall Islands, based on these laws.
LEGAL MATTERS
      The validity of the common units and certain other legal matters with respect to the laws of the Republic of the Marshall Islands will be passed upon for us by our counsel as to Marshall Islands law, Watson, Farley & Williams (New York) LLP. Certain other legal matters will be passed upon for us by Perkins Coie LLP, Portland, Oregon, who may rely on the opinions of Watson, Farley & Williams (New York) LLP, for all matters of Marshall Islands law. Certain matters with respect to this offering will be passed upon for the underwriters by Vinson & Elkins L.L.P., New York, New York.
EXPERTS
      The following financial statements included in this prospectus have been audited by Ernst & Young LLP, independent registered public accounting firm, as set forth in their reports thereon appearing elsewhere herein, and are included in reliance upon such reports given on the authority of such firm as experts in auditing and accounting:
  •  the balance sheets of Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor as at December 31, 2004 and 2005 and the related financial statements for the years ended December 31, 2004 and 2005; and
 
  •  the balance sheets for Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. and Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C. as at August 31, 2006 and August 25, 2006, respectively.
You may contact Ernst & Young LLP at address 700 West Georgia Street, Vancouver, British Columbia, V7Y 1C7, Canada.

206


 

EXPENSES RELATED TO THIS OFFERING
      The following table sets forth the main costs and expenses, other than the underwriting discounts and commissions, in connection with this offering, which we will be required to pay.
         
U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission registration fee
    $18,089  
National Association of Securities Dealers, Inc. filing fee
    17,405  
New York Stock Exchange listing fee
    150,000  
Legal fees and expenses
    1,350,000  
Accounting fees and expenses
    350,000  
Printing and engraving costs
    700,000  
Transfer agent fees and miscellaneous expenses
    5,000  
Miscellaneous
    109,506  
       
Total
    $2,700,000  
       
      All amounts are estimated except the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission registration fee, National Association of Securities Dealers Inc. filing fee and the New York Stock Exchange listing fee.
WHERE YOU CAN FIND MORE INFORMATION
      We have filed with the SEC a registration statement on Form  F-1 regarding the common units. This prospectus does not contain all of the information found in the registration statement. For further information regarding us and the common units offered in this prospectus, you may wish to review the full registration statement, including its exhibits. The registration statement, including the exhibits, may be inspected and copied at the public reference facilities maintained by the SEC at 100 F Street, N.E., Washington, D.C. 20549. Copies of this material can also be obtained upon written request from the Public Reference Section of the SEC at 100 F Street, N.E., Washington, D.C. 20549, at prescribed rates or from the SEC’s web site on the Internet at http://www.sec.gov free of charge. Please call the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330 for further information on public reference rooms. Our registration statement can also be inspected and copied at the offices of the New York Stock Exchange, Inc., 20 Broad Street, New York, New York 10005.
      Upon completion of the offering, we will be subject to the information requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, and, in accordance therewith, we will be required to file with the SEC annual reports on Form  20-F within six months of our fiscal year-end, and provide to the SEC other material information on Form  6-K. We intend to file our annual report on Form  20-F earlier than the SEC currently requires. These reports and other information may be inspected and copied at the public reference facilities maintained by the SEC or obtained from the SEC’s website as provided above. Our website on the Internet is located at http://www.teekayoffshore.com, and we expect to make our periodic reports and other information filed with or furnished to the SEC available, free of charge, through our website, as soon as reasonably practicable after those reports and other information are electronically filed with or furnished to the SEC. Information on our website or any other website is not incorporated by reference into this prospectus and does not constitute a part of this prospectus.
      As a foreign private issuer, we are exempt under the Exchange Act from, among other things, certain rules prescribing the furnishing and content of proxy statements, and the executive officers and directors of our general partner and our and principal unitholders are exempt from the reporting and short-swing profit recovery provisions contained in Section 16 of the Exchange Act. In addition, we will not be required under the Exchange Act to file periodic reports and financial statements with the SEC as frequently or as promptly as U.S. companies whose securities are registered under the Exchange Act, including the filing of quarterly reports or current reports on Form  8-K. However, we intend to furnish or make available to our unitholders annual reports containing our audited consolidated financial statements prepared in accordance

207


 

with U.S. GAAP and make available to our unitholders quarterly reports containing our unaudited interim financial information for the first three fiscal quarters of each fiscal year.
INDUSTRY AND MARKET DATA
      Clarkson Research Services Limited (or CRS ), the research division of H. Clarkson & Co. Ltd., has provided us statistical and graphical information contained in this prospectus and relating to the oil tanker industry. We do not have any knowledge that the information provided by CRS is inaccurate in any material respect. CRS has advised us that this information is drawn from its database and other sources and that: (a) some information in CRS’s database is derived from estimates or subjective judgments; (b) the information in the databases of other maritime data collection agencies may differ from the information in CRS’s database; (c) while CRS has taken reasonable care in the compilation of the statistical and graphical information and believes it to be accurate and correct, data compilation is subject to limited audit and validation procedures, and may accordingly contain errors; (d) CRS, its agents, officers and employees cannot accept liability for any loss suffered in consequence of reliance on such information or in any other manner; and (e) the provision of such information does not obviate any need to make appropriate inquiries.

208


 

FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS
      Statements included in this prospectus which are not historical facts (including our financial forecast and any other statements concerning plans and objectives of management for future operations or economic performance, or assumptions related thereto) are forward-looking statements. In addition, we and our representatives may from time to time make other oral or written statements which are also forward-looking statements. Such statements include, in particular, statements about our plans, strategies, business prospects, changes and trends in our business, and the markets in which we operate as described in this prospectus. In some cases, you can identify the forward-looking statements by the use of words such as “may,” “will,” “could,” “should,” “would,” “expect,” “plan,” “anticipate,” “intend,” “forecast,” “believe,” “estimate,” “predict,” “propose,” “potential,” “continue” or the negative of these terms or other comparable terminology.
      Forward-looking statements appear in a number of places and include statements with respect to, among other things:
  •  forecasts of our ability to make cash distributions on the units;
 
  •  future financial condition or results of operations and future revenues and expenses;
 
  •  results of operations for the quarter ended September 30, 2006;
 
  •  the repayment of debt;
 
  •  expected compliance with financing agreements and the expected effect of restrictive covenants in such agreements;
 
  •  future crude oil prices and production;
 
  •  planned capital expenditures and availability of capital resources to fund capital expenditures;
 
  •  future supply of, and demand for, crude oil;
 
  •  the ability to maintain long-term relationships with major crude oil companies;
 
  •  the ability to leverage Teekay Shipping Corporation’s relationships and reputation in the shipping industry;
 
  •  the continued ability to enter into fixed-rate time charters with customers;
 
  •  obtaining offshore projects that we or Teekay Shipping Corporation bid on;
 
  •  increasing our ownership interest in OPCO;
 
  •  Teekay Shipping Corporation increasing its ownership interest in Petrojarl ASA;
 
  •  the ability to maximize the use of vessels, including the re-deployment or disposition of vessels no longer under long-term time charter;
 
  •  expected pursuit of strategic opportunities, including the acquisition of vessels and expansion into new markets vessels;
 
  •  expected financial flexibility to pursue acquisitions and other expansion opportunities;
 
  •  the ability to compete successfully for future chartering and newbuilding opportunities;
 
  •  the expected cost of, and our ability to comply with, governmental regulations and maritime self-regulatory organization standards applicable to our business;
 
  •  the anticipated impact of future regulatory changes or environmental liabilities;
 
  •  the anticipated incremental general and administrative expenses as a public company and expenses under service agreements with other affiliates of Teekay Shipping Corporation and for reimbursements of fees and costs of our general partner;

209


 

  •  the anticipated taxation of our partnership and distributions to our unitholders, including our estimate of the percentage of our distributions that will constitute dividends;
 
  •  estimated future maintenance capital expenditures;
 
  •  expected demand in the offshore and crude oil shipping sectors in general and the demand for vessels in particular;
 
  •  customers’ increasing emphasis on environmental and safety concerns;
 
  •  anticipated restructuring charges;
 
  •  anticipated funds for liquidity needs and the sufficiency of cash flows;
 
  •  the expected effect of off-balance sheet arrangements; and
 
  •  our business strategy and other plans and objectives for future operations.
      These and other forward-looking statements are subject to the risks, uncertainties and assumptions, including those risks discussed in “Risk Factors” and those risks discussed in other reports we file with the SEC. The risks, uncertainties and assumptions involve known and unknown risks and are inherently subject to significant uncertainties and contingencies, many of which are beyond our control.
      Forward-looking statements are made based upon management’s current plans, expectations, estimates, assumptions and beliefs concerning future events impacting us and therefore involve a number of risks and uncertainties, including those risks discussed in “Risk Factors.” We caution that forward-looking statements are not guarantees and that actual results could differ materially from those expressed or implied in the forward-looking statements.
      We undertake no obligation to update any forward-looking statement or statements to reflect events or circumstances after the date on which such statement is made or to reflect the occurrence of unanticipated events. New factors emerge from time to time, and it is not possible for us to predict all of these factors. Further, we cannot assess the impact of each such factor on our business or the extent to which any factor, or combination of factors, may cause actual results to be materially different from those contained in any forward-looking statement.

210


 

INDEX TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
Financial Statements
         
       
    F-2  
Introduction
    F-3  
    F-4  
    F-5  
    F-6  
    F-7  
 
       
    F-12  
    F-13  
    F-14  
    F-15  
    F-16  
    F-17  
    F-18  
    F-33  
    F-34  
    F-35  
    F-36  
    F-37  
    F-38  
    F-39  
 
TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS L.P. 
       
    F-49  
    F-50  
    F-51  
    F-52  
 
TEEKAY OFFSHORE GP L.L.C.
       
    F-53  
    F-54  
    F-55  
    F-56  

F-1


 

UNAUDITED PRO FORMA
CONSOLIDATED
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OF
TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS L.P.

F-2


 

INTRODUCTION TO UNAUDITED PRO FORMA
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS L.P.
      During August 2006, Teekay Shipping Corporation formed Teekay Offshore Partners L.P., a Marshall Islands limited partnership (the Partnership ), as part of its strategy to expand in the marine transportation, processing and storage sectors of the offshore oil industry and for the Partnership to acquire, in connection with the Partnership’s proposed public offering of its common units, a 26.0% interest in Teekay Offshore Operating L.P. (or OPCO ), including a 25.99% limited partner interest to be held directly by the Partnership and a 0.01% general partner interest to be held through its ownership of Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C., OPCO’s sole general partner.
      Prior to the closing of the offering, Teekay Shipping Corporation will transfer to OPCO all of the outstanding interests of four wholly-owned subsidiaries, Norsk Teekay Holdings Ltd. (or Norsk Teekay ), Teekay Nordic Holdings Inc. (or Teekay Nordic ), Teekay Offshore Australia Trust and Pattani Spirit L.L.C. (collectively, the OPCO Subsidiaries or Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor ). At June 30, 2006, Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor had a fleet of 40 shuttle tankers (26 owned or held in joint ventures and 14 chartered-in), 28 conventional tankers (2 owned and 26 chartered-in) and three owned floating storage and offtake (or FSO ) units. Additionally, prior to the closing of this offering, Teekay Shipping Corporation will transfer eight Aframax-class conventional tankers to a subsidiary of Norsk Teekay. Upon the closing of this offering, OPCO will have a fleet of 36 shuttle tankers (24 owned or held in joint ventures and 12 chartered-in), 9 owned conventional tankers and four owned FSO units. The accompanying unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements give effect to this contribution, the initial public offering and related transactions. As a reorganization of entities under common control, the contribution was recorded at Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor’s cost.
      Unless the context requires otherwise, for purposes of this pro forma presentation, all references to “we”, “our”, “us” and the “Partnership” refer to Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. and its subsidiaries, including OPCO. OPCO’s financial information is consolidated with the Partnership due to the fact that the Partnership, through ownership of OPCO’s general partner, will control OPCO upon completion of the offering. References to Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor refer to OPCO’s predecessor companies and their subsidiaries as described above.
      The unaudited pro forma consolidated balance sheet as at June 30, 2006 assumes the initial public offering and related transactions occurred on June 30, 2006. The unaudited pro forma consolidated statements of income for the year ended December 31, 2005 and for the six months ended June 30, 2006 assume the initial public offering and related transactions occurred on January 1, 2005. Please read Note 1, Basis of Presentation, in the accompanying notes to the unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements for further explanation.
      The unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements and accompanying notes have been prepared in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles (or GAAP ) consistent with those used in, and should be read together with, Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor’s historical combined consolidated financial statements and related notes, which are included elsewhere in this prospectus.
      The adjustments reflected in the unaudited pro forma combined consolidated financial statements are based on currently available information and certain estimates and assumptions; therefore, actual results may differ from the pro forma adjustments. However, management believes that the assumptions used provide a reasonable basis for presenting the significant effects of the initial public offering and the related transactions, and that the pro forma adjustments in the unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements give appropriate effect to the assumptions and are applied in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States.
      The unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements do not purport to present the Partnership’s results of operations had the offering and related transactions to be effected in connection with the offering actually been completed at the dates indicated. In addition, they do not project the Partnership’s results of operations for any future period.

F-3


 

UNAUDITED PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS L.P.
UNAUDITED PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF INCOME
                                           
    Year Ended December 31, 2005
     
    Teekay   Pre-Initial   Teekay    
    Offshore   Public   Offshore   Initial Public   Teekay
    Partners   Offering   Partners   Offering   Offshore
    Predecessor   Transaction   Predecessor   Transaction   Partners L.P.
    Historical   Adjustments   Pro Forma   Adjustments   Pro Forma
                     
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars, except for unit and per unit data)
VOYAGE REVENUES
  $ 807,548       $59,058  (3a)   $ 678,888             $ 678,888  
              (229,351 )(3b)                        
              41,633  (3d)                        
                               
OPERATING EXPENSES
                                       
Voyage expenses
    74,543       19,392  (3a)     93,935               93,935  
Vessel operating expenses
    104,475       (3,558 )(3b)     114,843               114,843  
              13,926  (3d)                        
Time-charter hire expense
    373,536       (217,223 )(3b)     145,423               145,423  
              (10,890 )(3d)                        
Depreciation and amortization
    107,542       (5,375 )(3b)     116,922               116,922  
              148  (3c)                        
              14,607  (3d)                        
General and administrative
    85,856       (27,180 )(3b)     60,046       $1,500  (4a)     61,546  
              1,370  (3d)                        
Vessel and equipment writedowns and (gain) loss on sale of vessels
    2,820       (12,243 )(3b)     (9,423 )             (9,423 )
Restructuring charge
    955               955               955  
                               
Total operating expenses
    749,727       (227,026 )     522,701       1,500       524,201  
                               
Income from vessel operations
    57,821       98,366       156,187       (1,500 )     154,687  
                               
OTHER ITEMS
                                       
Interest expense
    (39,791 )     2,877  (3c)     (73,458 )             (73,458 )
              (11,577 )(3d)                        
              (39,739 )(3e)                        
              14,772  (3f)                        
Interest income
    4,605       660  (3d)     5,265               5,265  
Equity income (loss) from joint ventures
    5,199       (602 )(3b)     (971 )             (971 )
              (5,568 )(3d)                        
Foreign currency exchange gain
    34,178       (138 )(3b)     9,281               9,281  
              (567 )(3d)                        
              (24,192 )(3f)                        
Income tax recovery
    13,873               13,873               13,873  
Other — net
    9,091       (3,402 )(3e)     5,689               5,689  
                               
Total other items
    27,155       (67,476 )     (40,321 )           (40,321 )
                               
Income before non-controlling interest
    84,976       30,890       115,866       (1,500 )     114,366  
Non-controlling interest
    (229 )     (5,568 )(3d)     (5,797 )     (81,451 )(4d)     (87,248 )
                               
Net income
    $84,747       $25,322     $ 110,069       $(82,951 )     $27,118  
                               
General partner’s interest in net income
                                    $542  
Limited partners’ interest:
                                       
 
Net income
                                    $26,576  
Net income per:
                                       
 
— Common unit (basic and diluted) (note 6)
                                    $1.40  
 
— Subordinated unit (basic and diluted) (note 6)
                                    $1.31  
 
— Unit (basic and diluted) (note 6)
                                    $1.36  
Weighted-average number of units outstanding (in thousands):
                                       
 
— Common units (basic and diluted) (note 6)
                                    9,800  
 
— Subordinated units (basic and diluted) (note 6)
                                    9,800  
 
— Total limited partner units (basic and diluted) (note 6)
                                    19,600  
The accompanying notes are an integral part of the unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements.

F-4


 

UNAUDITED PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS L.P.
UNAUDITED PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF INCOME
                                           
    Six Months Ended June 30, 2006
     
    Teekay   Pre-Initial   Teekay    
    Offshore   Public   Offshore   Initial Public   Teekay
    Partners   Offering   Partners   Offering   Offshore
    Predecessor   Transaction   Predecessor   Transaction   Partners L.P.
    Historical   Adjustments   Pro Forma   Adjustments   Pro Forma
                     
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars, except unit and per unit data)
VOYAGE REVENUES
  $ 386,724     $ 31,751  (3a)   $ 349,299             $ 349,299  
              (90,657 )(3b)                        
              21,481  (3d)                        
                               
OPERATING EXPENSES
                                       
Voyage expenses
    48,344       14,442  (3a)     60,186               60,186  
              (2,600 )(3b)                        
Vessel operating expenses
    52,954       (2,053 )(3b)     57,545               57,545  
              6,644  (3d)                        
Time-charter hire expense
    165,935       (84,920 )(3b)     76,288               76,288  
              (4,727 )(3d)                        
Depreciation and amortization
    51,331       (2,551 )(3b)     56,138               56,138  
              74  (3c)                        
              7,284  (3d)                        
General and administrative
    43,469       (12,810 )(3b)     31,515     $ 750  (4a)     32,265  
Vessel and equipment writedowns and
            856  (3d)                        
 
(gain) loss on sale of vessels
    1,845       (2,150 )(3b)     (305 )             (305 )
Restructuring charge
    453               453               453  
                               
Total operating expenses
    364,331       (82,511 )     281,820       750       282,570  
                               
Income from vessel operations
    22,393       45,086       67,479       (750 )     66,729  
                               
OTHER ITEMS
                                       
Interest expense
    (24,504 )     1,409  (3c)     (36,961 )             (36,961 )
              (6,579 )(3d)                        
              (14,126 )(3e)                        
              6,839  (3f)                        
Interest income
    3,291       543  (3d)     3,834               3,834  
Equity income (loss) from joint ventures
    3,191       (203 )(3b)     (49 )             (49 )
              (3,037 )(3d)                        
Foreign currency exchange loss
    (18,688 )     612  (3b)     (4,339 )             (4,339 )
              686  (3d)                        
              13,051  (3f)                        
Income tax expense
    (7,762 )             (7,762 )             (7,762 )
Other — net
    5,694               5,694               5,694  
                               
Total other items
    (38,778 )     (805 )     (39,583 )           (39,583 )
                               
Income before non-controlling interest
    (16,385 )     44,281       27,896       (750 )     27,146  
Non-controlling interest
    (414 )     (3,037 )(3d)     (3,451 )     (18,090 )(4d)     (21,541 )
                               
Net income
    $(16,799 )   $ 41,244       $24,445     $ (18,840 )   $ 5,605  
                               
General partner’s interest in net income
                                    $112  
Limited partners’ interest:
                                       
 
Net income
                                    $5,493  
Net income per:
                                       
 
— Common unit (basic and diluted) (note 6)
                                    $0.56  
 
— Subordinated unit (basic and diluted) (note 6)
                                    $—  
 
— Unit (basic and diluted) (note 6)
                                    $0.28  
Weighted-average number of units outstanding (in thousands):
                                       
 
— Common units (basic and diluted) (note 6)
                                    9,800  
 
— Subordinated units (basic and diluted) (note 6)
                                    9,800  
 
— Total limited partner units (basic and diluted) (note 6)
                                    19,600  
The accompanying notes are an integral part of the unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements.

F-5


 

UNAUDITED PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS L.P.
UNAUDITED PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET
                                         
    As at June 30, 2006
     
    Teekay   Pre-Initial   Teekay    
    Offshore   Public   Offshore   Initial Public   Teekay
    Partners   Offering   Partners   Offering   Offshore
    Predecessor   Transaction   Predecessor   Transaction   Partners L.P.
    Historical   Adjustments   Pro Forma   Adjustments   Pro Forma
                     
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)
ASSETS
Current
                                       
Cash and cash equivalents
    $133,962       $(4,325 )(3b)     $90,000       $140,000  (4b)     $90,000  
              17,880  (3d)             (12,200 )(4c)        
              536,457  (3e)             (127,800 )(4e)        
              (6,000 )(3e)                        
              (433,849 )(3f)                        
              (154,125 )(3g)                        
Accounts receivable
    28,355       (4,500 )(3b)     25,096               25,096  
              1,241  (3d)                        
Vessels held for sale
    2,500               2,500               2,500  
Net investment in direct financing leases — current
    20,790               20,790               20,790  
Prepaid expenses and other assets
    71,239       (18,943 )(3b)     56,210               56,210  
              3,914  (3d)                        
                               
Total current assets
    256,846       (62,250 )     194,596             194,596  
                               
Vessels and equipment
                                       
At cost less accumulated depreciation
    1,227,007       (25,278 )(3b)     1,528,480               1,528,480  
              39,158  (3c)                        
              287,593  (3d)                        
Vessels under capital leases
    33,758       (33,758 )(3c)                    
                               
Total vessels and equipment
    1,260,765       267,715       1,528,480             1,528,480  
                               
Net investment in direct financing leases
    95,116               95,116               95,116  
Other assets
    50,590       (4,942 )(3b)     17,013               17,013  
              (31,756 )(3d)                        
              6,000  (3e)                        
              (2,879 )(3e)                        
Intangible assets — net
    72,464               72,464               72,464  
Goodwill
    130,549               130,549               130,549  
                               
Total assets
  $ 1,866,330       $171,888     $ 2,038,218           $ 2,038,218  
                               
 
LIABILITIES AND OWNERS’/ PARTNERS’ EQUITY
Current
                                       
Accounts payable
    $14,312       $(7,383 )(3b)     $7,030               $7,030  
              101  (3d)                        
Accrued liabilities
    34,687       (2,693 )(3b)     32,251               32,251  
              257  (3d)                        
Current portion of long-term debt
          17,656  (3d)     17,656               17,656  
Current obligation under capital leases
    1,412       (1,412 )(3c)                    
Advances from affiliates
    394,849       39,000  (3c)           127,800  (4d)      
              (433,849 )(3f)             (127,800 )(4e)        
                               
Total current liabilities
    445,260       (388,323 )     56,937             56,937  
Long-term debt
    543,543       219,658  (3d)     1299,658               1,299,658  
              536,457  (3e)                        
Obligation under capital leases
    32,188       (32,188 )(3c)                    
Deferred income taxes
    73,740               73,740               73,740  
Other long-term liabilities
    32,028               32,028               32,028  
                               
Total liabilities
    1,126,759       335,604       1,462,363             1,462,363  
                               
Commitments and contingencies (note 5)
                                       
 
Non-controlling interest
    11,770       31,756  (3d)     43,526       393,924  (4d)     437,450  
 
Owners’/partners’ equity
    727,801       (47,912 )(3b)     532,329       140,000  (4b)        
              9,444  (3d)             (12,200 )(4c)        
              (2,879 )(3e)             (393,924 )(4d)        
              (154,125 )(3g)             (127,800 )(4d)        
General partner
                                    326  
Limited partners
                                    138,079  
                               
Total liabilities and owners’/partners’ equity
  $ 1,866,330       $171,888     $ 2,038,218           $ 2,038,218  
                               
The accompanying notes are an integral part of the unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements.

F-6


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS L.P.
NOTES TO UNAUDITED PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
1. Basis of Presentation
      The unaudited pro forma consolidated statements of income for the year ended December 31, 2005 and the six months ended June 30, 2006 assume the following transactions occurred on January 1, 2005, and the unaudited pro forma consolidated balance sheet as at June 30, 2006 assumes that the following transactions occurred on June 30, 2006:
The Pre-Initial Public Offering Transactions of OPCO
  •  Teekay Shipping Corporation’s transfer to OPCO of all of the outstanding shares of the OPCO Subsidiaries. Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor’s historical audited combined consolidated financial statements for the year ended December 31, 2005 and Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor’s historical unaudited combined consolidated financial statements as at and for the six months ended June 30, 2006 contain the operations of all of these assets and, as such, no pro forma adjustment was required.
 
  •  OPCO’s entry into new time-charter contracts for nine of OPCO’s Aframax-class conventional crude oil tankers for terms of 5 to 12 years. OPCO will be responsible for bunker fuel costs on eight of these vessels. However, under the terms of the time-charter contracts, OPCO will recover the approximate amount of these bunker fuel costs from Teekay Shipping Corporation.
 
  •  OPCO’s transfer to Teekay Shipping Corporation of all chartered-in conventional crude oil and product tankers in Navion Shipping Ltd. (a subsidiary of Norsk Teekay), a 1987-built shuttle tanker (the Nordic Trym ), OPCO’s single anchor loading equipment, a 1992-built chartered-in shuttle tanker (the Borga ) and a 50.0% interest in Alta Shipping S.A., which has no material assets (collectively, the Non-OPCO Assets ).
 
  •  OPCO’s purchase of the Fuji Spirit , an Aframax-class conventional crude oil tanker currently accounted for as a capital lease, for $39.0 million.
 
  •  OPCO’s entry into amended operating agreements for five of its 50%-owned joint ventures, whereby OPCO will have unilateral control of each joint venture, which will require OPCO to consolidate these five joint venture companies in accordance with GAAP.
 
  •  OPCO’s incurrence of additional debt to increase its outstanding debt to $1.08 billion (excluding debt relating to its five 50%-owned joint ventures, which as of June 30, 2006 totaled $237.3 million). As at June 30, 2006, the net amount of the additional debt would have been $536.5 million.
 
  •  Teekay Shipping Corporation’s contribution to OPCO of interest rate swaps with a notional principal amount of $1.09 billion, a weighted-average fixed interest rate of 5.5% (including the margin OPCO pays on its floating-rate debt) and a weighted-average remaining term of 9.7 years.
 
  •  OPCO’s repayment of all of its advances from affiliates, which advances as of January 1, 2005 and June 30, 2006 were $630.9 million and $433.8 million, respectively.
 
  •  OPCO’s declaration and payment of a dividend to Teekay Shipping Corporation in an amount sufficient to decrease OPCO’s outstanding cash balance to $90.0 million. As of June 30, 2006, this amount would have been $154.1 million.
The Initial Public Offering Transactions
  •  Teekay Shipping Corporation’s transfer to the Partnership of a 26.0% interest in OPCO, including a 25.99% limited partner interest held directly by the Partnership and a 0.01% general partner interest

F-7


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS L.P.
NOTES TO UNAUDITED PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
  held by the Partnership through its ownership of OPCO’s general partner, Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C., in exchange for:
  •  the issuance to Teekay Shipping Corporation of 2,800,000 common units and 9,800,000 subordinated units of the Partnership and non-interest bearing promissory notes (the TSC Notes ); and
 
  •  the issuance to Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C., a wholly owned subsidiary of Teekay Shipping Corporation, of the 2.0% general partner interest in the Partnership and all of the Partnership’s incentive distribution rights.
  •  The Partnership’s issuance of 7,000,000 common units to the public at an assumed initial public offering price of $20.00 per common unit, resulting in aggregate gross proceeds to the Partnership of $140.0 million.
 
  •  The Partnership’s payment of estimated underwriting discounts, commissions and structuring fees of $9.5 million and estimated offering expenses of $2.7 million.
 
  •  The repayment of the TSC Notes with net proceeds of the public offering.
      The effect on the unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements of certain of the previously mentioned transactions is more fully described in Notes 3 and 4.
      The unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements are not necessarily indicative of what the Partnership’s results of operations and financial position would have been, nor do they purport to project the Partnership’s results of operations for any future periods. The unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements should be read in conjunction with the combined financial statements of Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor referred to above.
      In the opinion of management, these unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements contain all the adjustments necessarily for fair presentation.
2. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies
      The accounting policies followed in preparing the unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements are those used by Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor as set forth in its historical combined consolidated financial statements contained elsewhere in this prospectus.
3. Pre-Initial Public Offering Transactions of OPCO — Pro Forma Adjustments and Assumptions
      The unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements give pro forma effect to the following:
        (a) OPCO’s entry into new time-charter contracts for OPCO’s nine Aframax-class conventional tankers (including the Fuji Spirit ) with a subsidiary of Teekay Shipping Corporation at market-based daily rates for terms of five to twelve years. Under the terms of eight of these nine time-charter contracts, OPCO will also be responsible for the bunker fuel expenses; however, OPCO will add the approximate amount of these expenses to the daily hire rate. During the year ended December 31, 2005 and the six months ended June 30, 2006, eight of these nine tankers were employed on time-charter contracts with a subsidiary of Teekay Shipping Corporation at cash-flow break-even rates. As a result, the rates earned by each vessel, which were lower, depended upon the cash flow requirements of each vessel, which included operating expenses, loan principal and interest payments and drydock expenditures. The ninth Aframax tanker was operated on the spot market. Had these time charter contracts been entered into on January 1, 2005, OPCO’s voyage revenues and voyage expenses would have increased by $59.1 million and $19.4 million, respectively, for the year ended

F-8


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS L.P.
NOTES TO UNAUDITED PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
  December 31, 2005 and $31.8 million and $14.4 million, respectively, for the six months ended June 30, 2006.
 
        (b) OPCO’s transfer of the Non-OPCO Assets to Teekay Shipping Corporation.
 
        (c) OPCO’s purchase of the Fuji Spirit, an Aframax-class conventional crude oil tanker currently accounted for as a capital lease, for $39.0 million, which purchase was financed with a $39.0 million non-interest bearing loan from Teekay Shipping Corporation. The excess of the $39.0 million purchase price over the $33.6 million capital lease obligation at June 30, 2006 would have increased OPCO’s pro forma net book value of the Fuji Spirit from $33.8 million to $39.2 million at such date. The excess of the $39.0 million purchase price over the $35.5 million capital lease obligation at January 1, 2005 resulted in additional depreciation expense of $0.1 million each for the year ended December 31, 2005 and the six months ended June 30, 2006. The repayment of the lease obligation resulted in a reduction in interest expense of $2.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2005 and $1.4 million for the six months ended June 30, 2006.
 
        (d) The consolidation into OPCO of five 50%-owned joint venture companies, each of which owns one shuttle tanker. These five joint ventures are currently accounted for using the equity method, whereby the investment is carried at OPCO’s original cost plus its proportionate share of undistributed earnings. OPCO will enter into amended operating agreements for these joint ventures, whereby OPCO will obtain unilateral control of each joint venture, which will require OPCO to consolidate the five joint venture companies in accordance with GAAP.
 
        (e) OPCO’s incurrence of additional debt to increase its outstanding debt to $1.08 billion (excluding debt relating to its five 50%-owned joint ventures, which as of June 30, 2006 totaled $237.3 million) and Teekay Shipping Corporation’s contribution to OPCO of interest rate swaps with a notional principal amount of $1.09 billion, a weighted-average fixed interest rate of 5.5% (including the margin OPCO pays on its floating-rate debt) and a weighted-average remaining term of 9.7 years. As of June 30, 2006, the net amount of the additional debt would have been $536.5 million. In connection with this additional debt and a restructuring of OPCO’s debt facilities, OPCO would have incurred $6.0 million of loan arrangement and amendment fees and written off the unamortized balance of the capitalized loan costs on one of its revolving credit facilities that was prepaid and will be cancelled prior to the closing of the Partnership’s initial public offering. As at January 1, 2005 and June 30, 2006, this write-off would have been $3.4 million and $2.9 million, respectively. Had these transactions been completed on January 1, 2005 and had there been no prepayments of debt during the period from January 1, 2005 to June 30, 2006, OPCO’s interest expense would have increased by $39.7 million and $14.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2005 and the six months ended June 30, 2006, respectively. Consequently, the Partnership’s pro forma interest expense for the year end December 31, 2005 and the six months ended June 30, 2006 includes interest of $60.0 million and $29.5 million, respectively, from $1.08 billion of outstanding debt at a weighted-average fixed rate of 5.5%, amortization of capitalized loan costs of $1.2 million and $0.6 million, and commitment commissions on the undrawn portion of OPCO’s revolving credit facilities of $0.7 million and $0.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2005 and the six months ended June 30, 2006, respectively.
 
        (f) OPCO’s repayment of all of its advances from affiliates, which advances as of January 1, 2005 and June 30, 2006 were $630.9 million and $433.8 million, respectively. Had this repayment been made on January 1, 2005, OPCO’s interest expense would have decreased by $14.8 million and $6.8 million, respectively, and OPCO’s foreign currency exchange gain and loss would have decreased by $24.2 million and $13.1 million, respectively, for the year ended December 31, 2005 and the six months ended June 30, 2006.

F-9


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS L.P.
NOTES TO UNAUDITED PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
        (g) OPCO’s declaration and payment of a dividend to Teekay Shipping Corporation in an amount sufficient to decrease OPCO’s outstanding cash balance to $90.0 million. As of June 30, 2006, this amount would have been $154.1 million. To the extent OPCO’s advances from affiliates are settled through ways that do not involve cash, such as conversion to equity or contribution of the advances to OPCO, it is assumed that the amount of the dividend would be increased by a corresponding amount.
4. Initial Public Offering Transactions of the Partnership — Pro Forma Adjustments and Assumptions
      The unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements give pro forma effect to the following:
        (a) The Partnership’s incurrence of estimated incremental general and administrative expenses of $1.5 million annually, or $0.4 million quarterly, including costs associated with annual reports to shareholders, corporate tax compliance, investor relations, registrar and transfer agent’s fees, director and officer liability insurance costs and directors compensation and travel expenses, including expenses associated with the 2006 Long-Term Incentive Plan. The Partnership has estimated this amount based on the experience of its affiliate, Teekay LNG Partners L.P., which is a publicly-traded limited partnership.
 
        (b) The Partnership’s receipt of gross proceeds of $140.0 million from the issuance and sale of 7,000,000 common units to the public, at an assumed initial public offering price of $20.00 per common unit.
 
        (c) The Partnership’s payment of estimated underwriting discounts, commissions and structuring fees of $9.5 million and estimated offering expenses of $2.7 million in connection with the initial public offering.
 
        (d) The Partnership’s acquisition from Teekay Shipping Corporation of a 25.99% limited partner interest in OPCO and the 0.01% general partner interest in OPCO through the Partnership’s ownership of OPCO’s general partner, Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C., in exchange for the Partnership’s:
  •  issuance to Teekay Shipping Corporation of 2,800,000 common units and 9,800,000 subordinated units of the Partnership;
 
  •  issuance to Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C., a wholly owned subsidiary of Teekay Shipping Corporation, of the 2.0% general partner interest in the Partnership and all of the Partnership’s incentive distribution rights; and
 
  •  issuance to Teekay Shipping Corporation of the TSC Notes, which will occur prior to the closing of this offering. The amount of the TSC Notes will approximate the amount of the net proceeds from the initial public offering, which are estimated to be $127.8 million.
        The pro forma non-controlling interest (represented by Teekay Shipping Corporation’s 74.0% limited partner interest) of the net income of OPCO for the year ended December 31, 2005 and the six months ended June 30, 2006 was $81.5 million and $18.1 million, respectively.
 
        (e) The repayment of the TSC Notes due to Teekay Shipping Corporation with the net proceeds from the initial public offering.

F-10


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS L.P.
NOTES TO UNAUDITED PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
5. Commitments and Contingencies
      Commitments and contingencies of Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor are set out in the unaudited combined consolidated interim financial statements for the six months ended June 30, 2006 and 2005 contained elsewhere in this prospectus.
6. Net Income Per Unit
                           
    Common   Subordinated   All Unit
    Unit Holders   Unit Holders   Holders
             
    (in thousands, except number of units and per
    unit data)
Year Ended December 31, 2005
                       
 
Pro forma Net Income
    $13,720       $12,856       $26,576  
 
Pro forma Weighted Average Number of Units Outstanding
    9,800,000       9,800,000       19,600,000  
                   
 
Pro forma Net Income Per Unit
    $1.40       $1.31       $1.36  
                   
Six Months Ended June 30, 2006
                       
 
Pro forma Net Income
    $5,493       $—       $5,493  
 
Pro forma Weighted Average Number of Units Outstanding
    9,800,000       9,800,000       19,600,000  
                   
 
Pro forma Net Income Per Unit
    $0.56       $—       $0.28  
                   
      The pro forma weighted-average number of units outstanding is based upon the pro forma issuance of common units and subordinated units by the Partnership on January 1, 2005. Please read Note 1.

F-11


 

AUDITED COMBINED
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OF
TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS PREDECESSOR

F-12


 

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
To the Stockholders of
TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS PREDECESSOR
      We have audited the accompanying combined consolidated balance sheets of Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor as of December 31, 2005 and 2004, as described in Note 1, and the related combined consolidated statements of income, changes in owner’s equity and cash flows for the years ended December 31, 2005 and 2004. These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits.
      We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. We were not engaged to perform an audit of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting. Our audit included consideration of internal control over financial reporting as a basis for designing audit procedures that are appropriate in the circumstances, but not for the purpose of expressing an opinion on the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting. Accordingly, we express no such opinion. An audit also includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, and evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.
      In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the combined consolidated financial position of Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor at December 31, 2005 and 2004, and the combined consolidated results of its operations and its cash flows for the years ended December 31, 2005 and 2004 in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles.
  /s/  Ernst & Young LLP
  Chartered Accountants
Vancouver, Canada,
August 25, 2006

F-13


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS PREDECESSOR (Note 1)
AUDITED COMBINED CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF INCOME
                 
    Years Ended December 31,
     
    2004   2005
         
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)
VOYAGE REVENUES (including $249,837 for 2004 and $254,080 for 2005 of voyage revenues from related parties — notes 11b, 11e, 11g, 11i and 11j)
    $986,504       $807,548  
OPERATING EXPENSES
               
Voyage expenses (including $336 for 2004 and $600 for 2005 of voyage expenses from related parties — note 11h )
    118,819       74,543  
Vessel operating expenses
    105,595       104,475  
Time-charter hire expense
    372,449       373,536  
Depreciation and amortization
    118,460       107,542  
General and administrative (including $4,724 for 2004 and $5,438 for 2005 of general and administrative expenses from related parties — note 11f )
    65,819       85,856  
Vessel and equipment writedowns and (gain) loss on sale of vessels (note 16)
    (3,725 )     2,820  
Restructuring charge (note 10)
          955  
             
Total operating expenses
    777,417       749,727  
             
Income from vessel operations
    209,087       57,821  
             
OTHER ITEMS
               
Interest expense
    (43,957 )     (39,791 )
Interest income
    2,459       4,605  
Equity income from joint ventures
    6,162       5,199  
Gain on sale of marketable securities (note 11k)
    94,222        
Foreign currency exchange gain (loss) (note 5)
    (37,910 )     34,178  
Income tax recovery (expense) (note 13)
    (28,188 )     13,873  
Other — net (note 10)
    11,897       8,862  
             
Total other items
    4,685       26,926  
             
Net income
    $213,772       $84,747  
             
The accompanying notes are an integral part of the combined consolidated financial statements.

F-14


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS PREDECESSOR (Note 1)
AUDITED COMBINED CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
                 
    As at December 31,
     
    2004   2005
         
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)
ASSETS
Current
               
Cash and cash equivalents (notes 1 and 6)
    $143,729       $128,986  
Accounts receivable, net of allowance for doubtful accounts of $987 (December 31, 2004 — $461)
    47,554       34,425  
Vessels held for sale (note 16)
    19,116        
Net investment in direct financing leases — current (notes 1 and 14b)
    12,440       20,240  
Prepaid expenses
    16,451       36,475  
Other current assets
    11,927       6,218  
             
Total current assets
    251,217       226,344  
             
Vessels and equipment (notes 1 and 6)
               
At cost, less accumulated depreciation of $436,753 (December 31, 2004 — $445,954)
    1,391,720       1,265,630  
Vessels under capital leases, at cost, less accumulated depreciation of $3,308 (December 31, 2004 — $1,899) (note 8)
    35,761       34,434  
             
Total vessels and equipment
    1,427,481       1,300,064  
             
Net investment in direct financing leases (notes 1 and 14b)
    96,775       100,996  
Investment in joint ventures (notes 1 and 14a)
    31,134       34,402  
Other assets
    12,089       13,160  
Intangible assets — net (note 3)
    93,370       78,502  
Goodwill (note 3)
    128,576       130,549  
             
Total assets
    $2,040,642       $1,884,017  
             
 
LIABILITIES AND OWNER’S EQUITY
Current
               
Accounts payable
    $8,641       $16,808  
Accrued liabilities (note 4)
    28,872       30,750  
Current portion of long-term debt (note 6)
    48,597        
Current obligation under capital leases (note 8)
    1,247       1,355  
Advances from affiliates (note 5)
    591,925       559,250  
             
Total current liabilities
    679,282       608,163  
             
Long-term debt (note 6)
    534,983       398,360  
Obligation under capital lease (note 8)
    34,246       32,890  
Deferred income taxes (notes 1 and 13)
    113,713       57,884  
Other long-term liabilities
    4,930       34,482  
             
Total liabilities
    1,367,154       1,131,779  
             
Commitments and contingencies (notes 7, 8, 12 and 14)
               
Minority interest
    14,276       11,859  
Owner’s equity
    659,212       740,379  
             
Total liabilities and owner’s equity
    $2,040,642       $1,884,017  
             
The accompanying notes are an integral part of the combined consolidated financial statements.

F-15


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS PREDECESSOR (Note 1)
AUDITED COMBINED CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
                   
    Years Ended December 31,
     
    2004   2005
         
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)
Cash and cash equivalents provided by (used for):
               
OPERATING ACTIVITIES
               
Net income
    $213,772       $84,747  
Non-cash items:
               
 
Depreciation and amortization
    118,460       107,542  
 
(Gain) loss on sale of vessels
    (3,725 )     (9,423 )
 
(Gain) loss on sale of marketable securities, net of writedowns
    (94,222 )      
 
Loss on writedown of vessels and equipment
          12,243  
 
Equity income (net of dividends received: December 31, 2004 — $7,500; December 31, 2005 — $2,750)
    1,338       (2,449 )
 
Income taxes
    28,019       (14,202 )
 
Unrealized foreign exchange (gain) loss and other — net
    25,833       (39,816 )
Change in non-cash working capital items related to operating activities (note 15)
    (37,709 )     22,951  
Expenditures for drydocking
    (9,174 )     (8,906 )
             
Net operating cash flow
    242,592       152,687  
             
FINANCING ACTIVITIES
               
Proceeds from long-term debt
    403,000       1,226,804  
Capitalized loan costs
    (4,333 )     (639 )
Scheduled repayments of long-term debt
    (58,480 )     (29,884 )
Prepayments of long-term debt
    (662,715 )     (1,382,140 )
Repayments of capital lease obligations
    (1,159 )     (1,248 )
Investment in subsidiaries from minority owners
          8,000  
Distribution from subsidiaries to minority owners
    (2,347 )     (9,618 )
Net (advances to)/proceeds from affiliates
    256,324       (12,829 )
             
Net financing cash flow
    (69,710 )     (201,554 )
             
INVESTING ACTIVITIES
               
Expenditures for vessels and equipment
    (170,630 )     (24,760 )
Proceeds from sale of vessels and equipment
    58,742       73,220  
Purchase of marketable securities
    (163,869 )      
Proceeds from sale of marketable securities
    135,357        
Investment in direct financing leases
    (53,273 )     (23,708 )
Repayment of direct financing leases
    9,381       12,440  
Other
    (5,818 )     (3,068 )
             
Net investing cash flow
    (190,110 )     34,124  
             
(Decrease) in cash and cash equivalents
    (17,228 )     (14,743 )
Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of the period
    160,957       143,729  
             
Cash and cash equivalents, end of the period
    $143,729       $128,986  
             
Supplemental cash flow disclosure (notes 1 and 15)
               
Non-cash financing activities (note 11c)
               
The accompanying notes are an integral part of the combined consolidated financial statements.

F-16


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS PREDECESSOR (Note 1)
AUDITED COMBINED CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN OWNER’S EQUITY
                                   
        Accumulated        
        Other        
        Comprehensive       Total
    Owner’s   Income   Comprehensive   Owner’s
    Equity   (Loss)   Income   Equity
                 
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)
Balance as at December 31, 2003
    $530,677       $(883 )             $529,794  
                         
Net income
    213,772               213,772       213,772  
Other comprehensive income:
                               
 
Unrealized loss on marketable securities
            93,985       93,985       93,985  
 
Reclassification adjustment for gain on marketable securities included in net income
            (94,222 )     (94,222 )     (94,222 )
 
Unrealized gain on derivative instruments (note 12)
            53       53       53  
 
Reclassification adjustment for loss on derivatives included in net income (note 12)
            477       477       477  
                         
Comprehensive income
                    214,065          
                         
Norwegian group tax contributions (note 11a)
    1,415                       1,415  
Sale of chartering rights (note 11b)
    5,225                       5,225  
Equity contribution by Teekay Shipping Corporation (note 11c)
    35,291                       35,291  
Sale of marketable securities (note 11k)
    (126,578 )                     (126,578 )
                         
Balance as at December 31, 2004
    659,802       (590 )             659,212  
                         
Net income
    84,747               84,747       84,747  
Other comprehensive income:
                               
 
Unrealized gain on derivative instruments (note 12)
            792       792       792  
 
Reclassification adjustment for gain on derivatives included in net income (note 12)
            (94 )     (94 )     (94 )
                         
Comprehensive income
                    85,445          
                         
Norwegian group tax contributions (note 11a)
    (1,185 )                     (1,185 )
Sale of Dania Spirit (note 11d)
    (3,093 )                     (3,093 )
                         
Balance as at December 31, 2005
    $740,271       $108               $740,379  
                         
The accompanying notes are an integral part of the combined consolidated financial statements.

F-17


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS PREDECESSOR
NOTES TO THE AUDITED COMBINED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(all tabular amounts stated in thousands of U.S. Dollars, unless otherwise indicated)
1. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies
Basis of presentation
      During August 2006, Teekay Shipping Corporation formed Teekay Offshore Partners L.P., a Marshall Islands limited partnership (the Partnership ), as part of its strategy to expand in the marine transportation, processing and storage sectors of the offshore oil industry and for the Partnership to acquire, in connection with the Partnership’s proposed public offering of its common-units, a 26.0% interest in Teekay Offshore Operating L.P. (or OPCO ), including a 25.99% limited partner interest to be held directly by the Partnership and a 0.01% general partner interest to be held through its ownership of Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C., OPCO’s sole general partner. Prior to the public offering, Teekay Shipping Corporation will transfer eight Aframax-class conventional crude oil tankers to a subsidiary of Norsk Teekay Holdings Ltd. (or Norsk Teekay ) and one floating storage and offtake unit (or FSO unit ) to Teekay Offshore Australia Trust. Teekay Shipping Corporation will then transfer to OPCO all of the outstanding interests of four wholly-owned subsidiaries — Norsk Teekay, Teekay Nordic Holdings Inc. (or Teekay Nordic ), Teekay Offshore Australia Trust and Pattani Spirit L.L.C. These four wholly-owned subsidiaries, which include the eight Aframax-class conventional crude oil tankers and the FSO unit, are collectively referred to as Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor , the Predecessor or the Company . At the closing of the Partnership’s initial public offering, Teekay Shipping Corporation will sell to the Partnership the 25.99% limited partner interest in OPCO and its subsidiaries and a 100% interest in Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C., which owns the 0.01% general partner interest in OPCO, in exchange for (a) the issuance to Teekay Shipping Corporation of 2,800,000 common units and 9,800,000 subordinated units of the Partnership and of a non-interest bearing promissory note and (b) the issuance of the 2.0% general partner interest in the Partnership and all of the Partnership’s incentive distribution rights to Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C., a wholly owned subsidiary of Teekay Shipping Corporation. These transfers will represent a reorganization of entities under common control and will be recorded at historical cost. At December 31, 2005, the Predecessor had a fleet of 40 shuttle tankers (25 owned and 15 chartered-in), 38 conventional tankers (10 owned and 28 chartered-in) and three owned FSO units.
      The combined consolidated financial statements for the years ended and as at December 31, 2005 and 2004 reflect the combined consolidated financial position, results of operations and cash flows of the Predecessor and its subsidiaries. In the preparation of these combined consolidated financial statements, general and administrative expenses were not identifiable as relating solely to the vessels. General and administrative expenses, consisting primarily of salaries and other employee related costs, office rent, legal and professional fees, and travel and entertainment, were allocated based on the Predecessor’s proportionate share of Teekay Shipping Corporation’s total ship-operating (calendar) days for each of the periods presented. Management believes this allocation reasonably presents the general and administrative expenses of the Predecessor. The combined consolidated financial statements have been prepared in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States. Significant intercompany balances and transactions have been eliminated upon consolidation.
      The preparation of financial statements in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the amounts reported in the financial statements and accompanying notes. Actual results could differ from those estimates.
Reporting currency
      The combined consolidated financial statements are stated in U.S. Dollars because the Company operates in international shipping markets, the Company’s primary economic environment, which typically utilize the U.S. Dollar as the functional currency. Transactions involving other currencies during the year are converted into U.S. Dollars using the exchange rates in effect at the time of the transactions. At the

F-18


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS PREDECESSOR
NOTES TO THE AUDITED COMBINED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
(all tabular amounts stated in thousands of U.S. Dollars, unless otherwise indicated)
balance sheet dates, monetary assets and liabilities that are denominated in currencies other than the U.S. Dollar are translated to reflect the year-end exchange rates. Resulting gains or losses are reflected separately in the accompanying combined consolidated statements of income.
Operating revenues and expenses
      The Company recognizes revenues from time charters and bareboat charters daily over the term of the charter as the applicable vessel operates under the charter. The Company does not recognize revenue during days that the vessel is off-hire. All voyage revenues from voyage charters are recognized on a percentage of completion method. The Company uses a discharge-to -discharge basis in determining percentage of completion for all spot voyages and voyages servicing contracts of affreightment, whereby it recognizes revenue ratably from when product is discharged (unloaded) at the end of one voyage to when it is discharged after the next voyage. The Company does not begin recognizing voyage revenue until a charter has been agreed to by the customer and the Company, even if the vessel has discharged its cargo and is sailing to the anticipated load port on its next voyage. Shuttle tanker voyages servicing contracts of affreightment with offshore oil fields commence with tendering of notice of readiness at a field, within the agreed lifting range, and ends with tendering of notice of readiness at a field for the next lifting. The combined consolidated balance sheets reflect the deferred portion of revenues and expenses, which will be earned in subsequent periods. As at December 31, 2005, the deferred portion of revenues, which is included in accrued liabilities, was $1.4 million. There was no deferred revenue at December 31, 2004. As at December 31, 2005 and 2004, the deferred portion of expenses, which is included in prepaid expenses, was $11.8 million and $7.1 million, respectively.
      Voyage expenses are all expenses unique to a particular voyage, including bunker fuel expenses, port fees, cargo loading and unloading expenses, canal tolls, agency fees and commissions. Vessel operating expenses include crewing, repairs and maintenance, insurance, stores, lube oils and communication expenses. Voyage expenses are recognized ratably over the duration of the voyage, and vessel operating expenses are recognized when incurred. The impact of recognizing voyage expenses ratably over the length of each voyage is not materially different on a quarterly and annual basis from a method of recognizing such costs as incurred.
Cash and cash equivalents
      The Company classifies all highly-liquid investments with a maturity date of three months or less when purchased as cash and cash equivalents.
      Cash interest paid during the years ended December 31, 2005 and 2004 totaled $38.1 million and $45.0 million, respectively.
Marketable securities
      The Company’s investments in marketable securities are classified as available-for-sale securities and are carried at fair value. Net unrealized gains and losses on available-for-sale securities are reported as a component of accumulated other comprehensive income (loss).
Vessels and equipment
      All pre-delivery costs incurred during the construction of newbuildings, including interest, supervision and technical costs, are capitalized. The acquisition cost and all costs incurred to restore used vessels purchased to the standards required to properly service the Company’s customers are capitalized.

F-19


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS PREDECESSOR
NOTES TO THE AUDITED COMBINED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
(all tabular amounts stated in thousands of U.S. Dollars, unless otherwise indicated)
Capitalization of supervision and technical costs for the year ended December 31, 2004 totaled $1.2 million. No such costs were capitalized in 2005.
      Depreciation is calculated on a straight-line basis over a vessel’s estimated useful life, less an estimated residual value. Depreciation is calculated using an estimated useful life of 25 years from the date the vessel is delivered from the shipyard, or a shorter period if regulations prevent the Company from operating the vessels for 25 years. Depreciation of vessels and equipment for the years ended December 31, 2005 and 2004 totaled $86.0 million and $94.4 million, respectively. Depreciation and amortization includes depreciation on all owned vessels and vessels accounted for as capital leases (please see Note 8).
      Interest costs capitalized to vessels and equipment for the year ended December 31, 2004, totaled $0.3 million. No interest costs were capitalized for the year ended December 31, 2005.
      Generally, the Company drydocks each shuttle tanker and conventional oil tanker every two and a half to five years. FSO units generally are not drydocked. The Company capitalizes a substantial portion of the costs incurred during drydocking and amortizes those costs on a straight-line basis from the completion of a drydocking to the estimated completion of the next drydocking. The Company expenses costs related to routine repairs and maintenance incurred during drydocking that do not improve or extend the useful lives of the assets. When significant drydocking expenditures occur prior to the expiration of the original amortization period, the remaining unamortized balance of the original drydocking cost are expensed in the month of the subsequent drydocking. Amortization of drydocking expenditures for the years ended December 31, 2005 and 2004 aggregated $6.7 million and $5.6 million, respectively.
      The Company reviews vessels and equipment for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate the carrying amount of an asset may not be recoverable. Recoverability of these assets is measured by comparison of their carrying amount to future undiscounted cash flows the assets are expected to generate over their remaining useful lives. If vessels and equipment are considered to be impaired, the impairment to be recognized equals the amount by which the carrying value of the assets exceeds their fair market value (please see Note 16).
Direct financing leases
      The Company assembles, installs, operates and leases equipment that reduces volatile organic compound emissions (or VOC Equipment ) during loading, transportation and storage of oil and oil products. Leasing of the VOC Equipment is accounted for as a direct financing lease, with lease payments received being allocated between the net investment in the lease and other income using the effective interest method so as to produce a constant periodic rate of return over the lease term.
Investment in joint ventures
      The Company has a 50% participating interest in six joint venture companies (2004 — six). Five of these joint ventures each own one shuttle tanker. The remaining joint venture has a first right of refusal on Statoil ASA’s oil transportation requirements at the prevailing market rate until December 31, 2007. The joint ventures are accounted for using the equity method, whereby the investment is carried at the Company’s original cost plus its proportionate share of undistributed earnings.

F-20


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS PREDECESSOR
NOTES TO THE AUDITED COMBINED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
(all tabular amounts stated in thousands of U.S. Dollars, unless otherwise indicated)
Loan costs
      Loan costs, including fees, commissions and legal expenses, are presented as other assets and capitalized and amortized on a straight-line basis over the term of the relevant loan. Amortization of loan costs is included in interest expense.
Goodwill and intangible assets
      Goodwill is not amortized, but reviewed for impairment annually or more frequently as impairment indicators arise. Intangible assets with finite lives are amortized over their useful lives.
      The Company’s intangible assets, which consist of contracts of affreightment acquired as part of the purchase in April 2003 of Navion AS (or Navion ), are amortized over their respective lives, with the amount amortized each year being weighted based on the projected revenue to be earned under the contracts.
Derivative instruments
      The Company utilizes derivative financial instruments to reduce interest rate risks and does not hold or issue derivative financial instruments for trading purposes. Statement of Financial Accounting Standards (or SFAS ) No. 133, Accounting for Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities, which was amended in June 2000 by SFAS No. 138 and in May 2003 by SFAS No. 149, establishes accounting and reporting standards for derivative instruments and hedging activities.
      Derivative instruments are recorded as other assets or other long-term liabilities, measured at fair value. Derivatives that are not hedges or are not designated as hedges are adjusted to fair value through income. If the derivative is a hedge, depending upon the nature of the hedge, changes in the fair value of the derivatives are either offset against the fair value of assets, liabilities or firm commitments through income, or recognized in other comprehensive income (loss) until the hedged item is recognized in income. The ineffective portion of a derivative’s change in fair value is immediately recognized into income (please see Note 12).
Income taxes
      The Company’s Australian ship-owning subsidiaries and its Norwegian subsidiaries are subject to income taxes. Deferred income taxes were $57.9 million and $113.7 million as at December 31, 2005 and as at December 31, 2004, respectively. The Company accounts for such taxes using the liability method pursuant to SFAS No. 109, Accounting for Income Taxes.
Comprehensive income (loss)
      The Company follows SFAS No. 130, Reporting Comprehensive Income, which establishes standards for reporting and displaying comprehensive income (loss) and its components in the combined consolidated financial statements.
Recent accounting pronouncements
      In July 2006, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (or FASB ) issued Interpretation No. 48 (or FIN 48 ), Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes — an interpretation of FASB Statement No. 109. This interpretation clarifies the accounting for uncertainty in income taxes recognized in financial statements in accordance with FASB Statement No. 109, Accounting for Income Taxes. FIN 48 will

F-21


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS PREDECESSOR
NOTES TO THE AUDITED COMBINED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
(all tabular amounts stated in thousands of U.S. Dollars, unless otherwise indicated)
require companies to determine whether it is more-likely-than-not that a tax position taken or expected to be taken in a tax return will be sustained upon examination, including resolution of any related appeals or litigation processes, based on the technical merits of the position. If a tax position meets the more-likely-than-not recognition threshold, it is measured to determine the amount of benefit to recognize in the financial statements based on guidance in the interpretation. FIN 48 is effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2006. The Company has not determined the effect, if any, that the adoption of FIN 48 will have on the Company’s combined consolidated financial position or results of operations.
2. Segment Reporting
      The Company is engaged in the international marine transportation of crude oil through the operation of its oil tankers and FSO units. The Company’s revenues are earned in international markets.
      The Company has three reportable segments: its shuttle tanker segment; its conventional tanker segment; and its FSO segment. The Company’s shuttle tanker segment consists of shuttle tankers operating primarily on fixed-rate contracts of affreightment, time-charter contracts or bareboat charter contracts. The Company’s conventional tanker segment consists of conventional tankers operating either on fixed-rate time-charter contracts, on the spot market, or on time charters priced on a spot-market basis. The Company’s FSO segment consists of its FSO units subject to fixed-rate time-charter contracts. Segment results are evaluated based on income from vessel operations. The accounting policies applied to the reportable segments are the same as those used in the preparation of the Company’s combined consolidated financial statements.
      The following table presents voyage revenues and percentage of combined consolidated voyage revenues for customers that accounted for more than 10.0% of the Company’s combined consolidated voyage revenues during the years presented.
                 
    Year Ended   Year Ended
    December 31,   December 31,
    2004   2005
         
Teekay Shipping Corporation subsidiaries(1)
  $ 396.8 or 40 %   $ 253.1 or 31 %
Statoil ASA(2)(3)
  $ 189.7 or 19 %   $ 184.7 or 23 %
 
(1)  Conventional tanker and FSO segments.
 
(2)  Shuttle tanker segment.
 
(3)  Statoil ASA is an international oil company.

F-22


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS PREDECESSOR
NOTES TO THE AUDITED COMBINED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
(all tabular amounts stated in thousands of U.S. Dollars, unless otherwise indicated)
     The following tables present results for these segments for the years ended December 31, 2004 and 2005.
                                 
    Shuttle   Conventional        
    Tanker   Tanker   FSO    
Year Ended December 31, 2004   Segment   Segment   Segment   Total
                 
Voyage revenues
    $550,445       $411,181       $24,878       $986,504  
Voyage expenses
    69,362       49,457             118,819  
Vessel operating expenses
    76,197       22,790       6,608       105,595  
Time charter hire expense
    177,576       194,873             372,449  
Depreciation and amortization
    89,593       20,561       8,306       118,460  
General and administrative(1)
    45,403       19,097       1,319       65,819  
Vessels and equipment writedowns/(gain) loss on sale of vessels
    (3,725 )                 (3,725 )
                         
Income from vessel operations
    $96,039       $104,403       $8,645       $209,087  
                         
Voyage revenues — intersegment
    $4,607                   $4,607  
Equity income (loss) from joint ventures
    6,351       (189 )           6,162  
Investments in joint ventures at December 31, 2004
    30,603       531             31,134  
Total assets at December 31, 2004
    1,408,028       319,688       81,176       1,808,892  
Expenditures for vessels and equipment
    117,792       37,003       15,835       170,630  
                                 
    Shuttle   Conventional        
    Tanker   Tanker   FSO    
Year Ended December 31, 2005   Segment   Segment   Segment   Total
                 
Voyage revenues
    $516,758       $266,593       $24,197       $807,548  
Voyage expenses
    68,308       5,419       816       74,543  
Vessel operating expenses
    75,196       22,679       6,600       104,475  
Time charter hire expense
    169,687       203,849             373,536  
Depreciation and amortization
    77,083       21,112       9,347       107,542  
General and administrative(1)
    55,010       29,026       1,820       85,856  
Vessels and equipment writedowns/(gain) loss on sale of vessels
    2,820                   2,820  
Restructuring charge
    955                   955  
                         
Income from vessel operations
    $67,699       $(15,492 )     $5,614       $57,821  
                         
Voyage revenues — intersegment
    4,607                   4,607  
Equity income (loss) from joint ventures
    5,235       (36 )           5,199  
Investments in joint ventures at December 31, 2005
    33,907       495             34,402  
Total assets at December 31, 2005
    1,277,195       315,086       72,472       1,664,753  
Expenditures for vessels and equipment
    22,760       2,000             24,760  
 
(1)  Includes direct general and administrative expenses and indirect general and administrative expenses (allocated to each segment based on estimated use of corporate resources).

F-23


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS PREDECESSOR
NOTES TO THE AUDITED COMBINED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
(all tabular amounts stated in thousands of U.S. Dollars, unless otherwise indicated)
     A reconciliation of total segment assets to total assets presented in the combined consolidated balance sheet is as follows:
                   
    December 31,   December 31,
    2004   2005
         
Shuttle tanker segment
    $1,408,028       $1,277,195  
Conventional tanker segment
    319,688       315,086  
FSO segment
    81,176       72,472  
Cash and cash equivalents
    143,729       128,986  
Accounts receivable, prepaid expenses and other assets
    88,021       90,278  
             
 
Combined consolidated total assets
    $2,040,642       $1,884,017  
             
3. Goodwill and Intangible Assets
      The changes in the carrying amount of goodwill for the year ended December 31, 2005 for the Company’s reporting segments are as follows:
                                 
    Shuttle   Conventional        
    Tanker   Tanker   FSO    
    Segment   Segment   Segment   Total
                 
Balance as of December 31, 2004
    $128,576                   $128,576  
Goodwill acquired
    1,973                   1,973  
                         
Balance as of December 31, 2005
    $130,549                   $130,549  
                         
      As at December 31, 2005 and 2004, intangible assets consisted of:
                                                           
        December 31, 2004   December 31, 2005
    Weighted-              
    Average   Gross         Net   Gross       Net
    Amortization   Carrying   Accumulated     Carrying   Carrying   Accumulated   Carrying
    Period   Amount   Amortization     Amount   Amount   Amortization   Amount
                               
    (years)                          
Contracts of affreightment
    10.2       $124,250       $(30,880 )       $93,370       $124,250       $(45,748 )     $78,502  
      Aggregate amortization expense of intangible assets for the year ended December 31, 2005 was $14.9 million ($18.4 million — 2004). Amortization of intangible assets for the five years subsequent to December 31, 2005 is expected to be $12.1 million (2006), $11.1 million (2007), $10.1 million (2008), $9.1 million (2009), and $8.1 million (2010).
4. Accrued Liabilities
                 
    December 31,   December 31,
    2004   2005
         
Voyage and vessel
    $21,598       $24,793  
Interest
    777       712  
Payroll and benefits
    6,497       4,290  
Restructuring costs
          955  
             
      $28,872       $30,750  
             

F-24


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS PREDECESSOR
NOTES TO THE AUDITED COMBINED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
(all tabular amounts stated in thousands of U.S. Dollars, unless otherwise indicated)
5. Advances from Affiliates
                 
    December 31,   December 31,
    2004   2005
         
Norwegian Kroner-denominated Demand Promissory Note (7.5%)
    $175,830       $157,842  
Norwegian Kroner-denominated Demand Promissory Note (non-interest bearing)
    12,691       6,797  
Australian Dollar-denominated Demand Promissory Note (8.0%)
    19,898       18,720  
Other (non-interest bearing with no fixed terms of repayment)
    383,506       375,891  
             
      $591,925       $559,250  
             
      As at December 31, 2005, Teekay Shipping Corporation and certain of its subsidiaries had loaned the Company 1.1 billion Norwegian Kroner ($164.6 million) and 25.5 million Australian Dollars ($18.7 million). These promissory notes, which are due on demand, are unsecured.
      The interest expense incurred on the interest-bearing demand promissory notes for the years ended December 31, 2005 and 2004 were $14.8 million and $16.4 million, respectively.
      All Norwegian Kroner-denominated and Australian Dollar-denominated advances are revalued at the end of each period using the then prevailing Norwegian Kroner/ U.S. Dollar and Australian Dollar/ U.S. Dollar exchange rates. Due substantially to this revaluation, the Company recognized foreign exchange gains of $34.2 million during the year ended December 31, 2005 and a foreign exchange loss of $37.9 million during the year ended December 31, 2004.
6. Long-Term Debt
                 
    December 31,   December 31,
    2004   2005
         
Revolving Credit Facilities
    $495,000       $398,360  
First Preferred Ship Mortgage Notes (8.32%)
    29,088        
Term Loans due through 2019
    59,492        
             
      583,580       398,360  
Less current portion
    48,597        
             
      $534,983       $398,360  
             
      As at December 31, 2005, the Company had three long-term revolving credit facilities (or the Revolvers ) available, which, as at such date, provided for borrowings of up to $998.4 million, of which $600.0 million was undrawn. Interest payments are based on LIBOR plus margins; at December 31, 2005, the margins ranged between 0.60% and 0.70% (2004 — 0.65% and 0.88%). The total amount available under the Revolvers reduces by $99.0 million (2006), $100.3 million (2007), $315.5 million (2008), $41.8 million (2009), $43.3 million (2010) and $398.5 million (thereafter). The Revolvers are collateralized by first-priority mortgages granted on 31 of the Company’s vessels, together with other related collateral, including a guarantee from Teekay Shipping Corporation for all outstanding amounts.
      The Revolvers require that Teekay Shipping Corporation and its subsidiaries maintain a minimum level of free cash. As at December 31, 2005, this amount was $100.0 million. The Revolvers also require that Teekay Shipping Corporation and its subsidiaries maintain a minimum aggregate level of free liquidity

F-25


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS PREDECESSOR
NOTES TO THE AUDITED COMBINED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
(all tabular amounts stated in thousands of U.S. Dollars, unless otherwise indicated)
and undrawn revolving credit lines with at least six months to maturity. As at December 31, 2005, this amount was $110.5 million.
      On February 1, 2005, the Company repaid $25.7 million of the 8.32% First Preferred Ship Mortgage Notes (or the 8.32% Notes ). On March 30, 2005, the Company effectively repaid the remaining $3.4 million outstanding 8.32% Notes by depositing with the trustee, The Bank of New York, an amount that will satisfy the outstanding principal and accrued interest on the one remaining semi-annual repayment. As a result of these transactions, the 8.32% Notes are no longer collateralized by first-preferred mortgages on any of the Company’s vessels and they are not guaranteed by Teekay Shipping Corporation or any of its subsidiaries.
      The weighted-average effective interest rate on the Company’s long-term debt as at December 31, 2005 was 5.1% (December 31, 2004 — 3.4%).
      The aggregate annual long-term debt principal repayments required to be made for the five years subsequent to December 31, 2005 are $0.0 million (2006), $18.0 million (2007), $285.8 million (2008), $10.8 million (2009), $10.8 million (2010) and $73.0 million (thereafter).
7. Operating Leases
Charters-out
      Time charters and bareboat charters of the Company’s vessels to third parties are accounted for as operating leases. As at December 31, 2005, minimum scheduled future revenues to be received by the Company under time charters and bareboat charters then in place were approximately $771.0 million, comprised of $130.1 million (2006), $109.8 million (2007), $96.4 million (2008), $91.6 million (2009), $80.5 million (2010) and $262.6 million (thereafter).
      The minimum scheduled future revenues should not be construed to reflect total charter hire revenues for any of the years.
Charters-in
      As at December 31, 2005, minimum commitments owing by the Company under vessel operating leases by which the Company charters-in vessels were approximately $995.4 million, comprised of $291.8 million (2006), $165.8 million (2007) $103.0 million (2008), $79.4 million (2009), $78.4 million (2010) and $277.0 million (thereafter).
      During March 2005, the Company sold and leased back a 1991-built shuttle tanker that is now being accounted for as an operating lease. The sale generated a $2.8 million gain, which has been deferred and is being amortized over the 6.5 year term of the lease.
8. Capital Lease Obligation
      As at December 31, 2005, the Company was a party, as lessee, to a fixed-rate capital lease on one conventional Aframax-class tanker, the Fuji Spirit. Under the terms of the lease arrangement, which include the Company’s contractual right to full operation of the vessel pursuant to a bareboat charter, the Company is required to purchase the vessel at the end of its lease term for a fixed price. The Company has an option to purchase the vessel during the term of the lease. The annual interest rate implicit in this capital lease, at the inception of the lease, was 8.3%. As at December 31, 2005, the remaining

F-26


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS PREDECESSOR
NOTES TO THE AUDITED COMBINED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
(all tabular amounts stated in thousands of U.S. Dollars, unless otherwise indicated)
commitments under this capital lease, including the purchase obligation, approximated $57.3 million, including imputed interest of $23.0 million, repayable as follows:
         
Year   Commitment
     
2006
    $4.1 million  
2007
    4.1 million  
2008
    4.1 million  
2009
    4.1 million  
2010
    4.1 million  
Thereafter
    36.8 million  
9. Fair Value of Financial Instruments
      Long-term debt  — The fair values of the Company’s fixed-rate long-term debt are either based on quoted market prices or estimated using discounted cash flow analyses, based on rates currently available for debt with similar terms and remaining maturities.
      Interest rate swap agreements  — The fair value of these financial instruments, used for hedging purposes, is the estimated amount that the Company would receive or pay to terminate the agreements at the reporting date, taking into account current interest rates and the current credit worthiness of the swap counter parties.
      The estimated fair value of the Company’s financial instruments is as follows:
                                 
    December 31, 2004   December 31, 2005
         
    Carrying       Carrying    
    Amount   Fair Value   Amount   Fair Value
                 
Cash and cash equivalents
  $ 143,729     $ 143,729     $ 128,986     $ 128,986  
Long-term debt
    583,580       584,047       398,360       398,360  
Capital lease obligation
    35,493       42,684       34,245       40,015  
Derivative instruments (note 12)
                               
Interest rate swap agreements
    (649 )     (649 )     108       108  
      The Company transacts all of its derivative instruments through investment-grade rated financial institutions and requires no collateral from these institutions.
10. Restructuring Charge and Other Income
                 
    Year Ended   Year Ended
    December 31,   December 31,
    2004   2005
         
Minority interest expense
    $(2,167 )     $(229 )
Write-down in the carrying value of marketable securities
           
Volatile organic compound emissions plant lease income
    8,448       11,001  
Dividend income
    5,679        
Miscellaneous
    (63 )     (1,910 )
             
Other — net
    $11,897       $8,862  
             

F-27


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS PREDECESSOR
NOTES TO THE AUDITED COMBINED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
(all tabular amounts stated in thousands of U.S. Dollars, unless otherwise indicated)
      During the year ended December 31, 2005, the Company relocated certain operational functions within Norway and closed its office in Sandefjord, Norway. As a result, the Company incurred $1.0 million of restructuring costs during 2005.
11. Related Party Transactions
      a. During 2004, rate-effected income tax losses of $1.4 million that were generated by Norwegian subsidiaries of Teekay Shipping Corporation were transferred to the Company’s Norwegian subsidiaries. The transfer of these income tax losses were used to reduce the Company’s tax payable and has been accounted for as an equity contribution.
      During 2005, rate-effected income tax losses of $1.2 million that were generated by the Company’s Norwegian subsidiaries were transferred to the Norwegian subsidiaries of Teekay Shipping Corporation. The transfer of these income tax losses has been accounted for as an equity distribution.
      b. During March 2004, a subsidiary of Teekay Shipping Corporation acquired from Navion Shipping Ltd. (a subsidiary of the Company) the right to charter-in and market Navion Shipping Ltd.’s vessels in the spot market at a fee of 1.25% over Navion Shipping Ltd.’s charter-in cost. The cost to obtain this right was $5.2 million and has been accounted for as an equity contribution.
      During 2005 and 2004, the Company earned $205.9 million and $156.0 million, respectively, of time charter revenue pursuant to this agreement with Navion Shipping Ltd.
      During 2005 and 2004, the Company earned $8.2 million and $8.7 million, respectively, of management fees from commercial management services provided to a subsidiary of Teekay Shipping Corporation, relating to the vessels chartered from Navion Shipping Ltd.
      c. During 2004, the Kilimanjaro Spirit, a 2004-built Aframax conventional oil tanker, was transferred by a subsidiary of Teekay Shipping Corporation to the Company. This transaction was concluded between two entities under common control and, thus, the vessel acquired was recorded at its historical book value. The transfer of the vessel has been accounted for as an equity contribution.
      d. During 2005, the Company sold the Dania Spirit (a 2000-built liquid petroleum gas carrier) to a subsidiary of Teekay Shipping Corporation for $18.0 million. The resulting $3.1 million loss on sale has been accounted for as an equity distribution.
      e. Seven of the Company’s Aframax tankers have been employed on time-charter contracts with a subsidiary of Teekay Shipping Corporation at various times during the previous three years. Pursuant to these time-charter contracts, the Company earned voyage revenues of $27.9 million and $70.1 million during the years ended December 31, 2005 and 2004, respectively.
      f. Eight of the Company’s Aframax conventional oil tankers and two FSO units have been managed by subsidiaries of Teekay Shipping Corporation. Pursuant to the associated management services agreements, the Company incurred general and administrative expenses of $5.4 million and $4.7 million during the years ended December 31, 2005 and 2004, respectively (please see Note 1).
      g. One of the Company’s FSO units has been employed on a long-term bareboat charter with a subsidiary of Teekay Shipping Corporation. Pursuant to this charter contract, the Company has earned voyage revenues of $5.4 million and $3.9 million during the years ended December 31, 2005 and 2004, respectively.
      h. The Company’s shuttle tankers that service its contracts of affreightment have been employed on voyage charters when the Company has excess shuttle tanker capacity. For certain voyage charters, a

F-28


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS PREDECESSOR
NOTES TO THE AUDITED COMBINED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
(all tabular amounts stated in thousands of U.S. Dollars, unless otherwise indicated)
subsidiary of Teekay Shipping Corporation will provide ship brokerage services to the Company. The Company incurred $0.6 million and $0.3 million of voyage expenses relating to these services during the years ended December 31, 2005 and 2004, respectively.
      i. The Company’s shuttle tankers, which are typically employed on long-term time-charters, have been employed on short-term time charters with a subsidiary of Teekay Shipping Corporation where there were periods between the ending of one long-term time-charter and the beginning of another long-term time-charter. Pursuant to these short-term time-charters, the Company earned voyage revenues of $1.2 million and $4.6 million during the years ended December 31, 2005 and 2004, respectively.
      j. One of the Company’s shuttle tankers has been employed on a long-term bareboat charter with one of the Company’s joint ventures. Pursuant to the charter contract, the Company earned voyage revenues of $5.4 million and $6.5 million during the years ended December 31, 2005 and 2004, respectively.
      k. During April 2004, the Company acquired 5,812,000 shares in A/ S Dampskibsselskabet Torm from a subsidiary of Teekay Shipping Corporation for proceeds of $163.9 million. The excess of the proceeds paid by the Company over Teekay Shipping Corporation’s original cost of the shares has been accounted for as an equity distribution of $126.6 million. During the year ended December 31, 2004, the Company sold this investment to an unrelated party for proceeds of $130.6 million, which resulted in a gain on sale of marketable securities of $93.3 million.
12. Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities
      The Company uses derivatives only for hedging purposes. The following summarizes the Company’s risk strategies with respect to market risk from changes in interest rates.
      As at December 31, 2005, the Company was committed to the following interest rate swap agreement related to its LIBOR-based debt, whereby certain of the Company’s floating-rate debt was swapped with fixed-rate obligations:
                                         
            Fair Value/   Weighted-    
            Carrying   Average   Fixed
    Interest Rate   Principal   Amount of   Remaining   Interest
    Index   Amount   Liability   Term   Rate(1)
                     
                (years)    
U.S. Dollar-denominated interest rate swap(2)
    LIBOR     $ 29,700     $ 108       8.5       4.7%  
 
(1)  Excludes the margins the Company pays on its variable-rate debt (including the debt of its joint ventures), which as at December 31, 2005, ranged from 0.6% to 0.8%.
 
(2)  Principal amount reduces semiannually by $1.1 million.
      The Company is exposed to credit loss in the event of non-performance by the counter parties to the interest rate swap agreement; however, the Company does not anticipate non-performance by any of the counter parties.
      During the year ended December 31, 2005, the Company recognized a net loss of $0.2 million (2004 — net loss of $0.1 million) relating to the ineffective portion of its interest rate swap agreement. The ineffective portion of this derivative instrument is presented as equity income from joint ventures.
      As at December 31, 2005, the Company estimated, based on then-existing interest rates, that it would reclassify approximately $0.1 million of net gain on derivative instruments from accumulated other

F-29


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS PREDECESSOR
NOTES TO THE AUDITED COMBINED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
(all tabular amounts stated in thousands of U.S. Dollars, unless otherwise indicated)
comprehensive income to earnings during the next 12 months due to the payment of interest expense associated with the Company’s floating-rate debt.
      As at December 31, 2005 and 2004, the Company’s accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) of $0.1 million and $(0.6) million, respectively, consisted of unrealized gain (loss) on derivative instruments.
13. Income Taxes
      The significant components of the Company’s deferred tax liabilities and assets follow:
                   
    December 31,   December 31,
    2004   2005
         
Deferred tax liabilities:
               
 
Vessels and equipment
    $79,221       $51,483  
 
Long-term debt
    40,387       8,120  
             
Total deferred tax liabilities
    119,608       59,603  
Deferred tax assets:
               
 
Goodwill and intangible assets
    4,789       1,304  
 
Provisions
    1,106       415  
             
Total deferred tax assets
    5,895       1,719  
             
Net deferred tax liabilities
    113,713       57,884  
Current portion
           
             
Long-term portion of net deferred tax liabilities
    $113,713       $57,884  
             
      The components of income before income taxes follow:
                 
    December 31,   December 31,
    2004   2005
         
Foreign
  $ 241,960     $ 70,874  
Domestic
           
             
    $ 241,960     $ 70,874  
             
      Substantially all of the above foreign income resulted from the operations of companies that were subject to income taxes in their countries of incorporation.
      The components of the provision for income taxes follow:
                 
    December 31,   December 31,
    2004   2005
         
Current
    $(589 )     $(3,546 )
Deferred
    (27,599 )     17,419  
             
Income tax recovery (expense)
    $(28,188 )     $13,873  
             

F-30


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS PREDECESSOR
NOTES TO THE AUDITED COMBINED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
(all tabular amounts stated in thousands of U.S. Dollars, unless otherwise indicated)
      Reconciliations of the actual income tax rate attributable to pretax income and the applicable statutory income tax rate follow:
                   
    December 31,   December 31,
    2004   2005
         
Actual income tax provision/(credit) rate
    11.6 %     (19.6 )%
 
Income not subject to income taxes
    16.4       47.6  
             
Applicable statutory income tax provision rate
    28.0 %     28.0 %
             
14. Commitments and Contingencies
a) Joint Ventures
      The Company has guaranteed its share of the outstanding vessel mortgage debt in two 50%-owned joint venture companies. As at December 31, 2005, the Company had guaranteed $48.7 million, or 50% of the total $97.4 million, in outstanding mortgage debt of the joint venture companies. These joint venture companies own an aggregate of two shuttle tankers.
b) Volatile Organic Compound Emissions Plants
      The Company has been awarded a contract by a consortium of major oil companies to construct and install on seven of its shuttle tankers volatile organic compound emissions plants, which reduce emissions during cargo operations. These plants will be leased to the consortium of major oil companies. The construction and installation of these plants are expected to be completed by the end of 2006 at a total cost of approximately $106.1 million. As at December 31, 2005, the Company had made payments towards these commitments of approximately $84.1 million, with approximately $22.0 million of remaining payments required to be made in 2006 towards these commitments.
c) Other
      The Company enters into indemnification agreements in the ordinary course of business. The maximum potential amount of future payments required under these indemnification agreements is unlimited. However, the Company maintains what it believes is appropriate liability insurance that reduces its exposure and enables the Company to recover future amounts paid up to the maximum amount of the insurance coverage, less any deductible amounts pursuant to the terms of the respective policies, the amounts of which are not considered material.
15. Change in Non-Cash Working Capital Items Related to Operating Activities
                 
    Year Ended   Year Ended
    December 31,   December 31,
    2004   2005
         
Accounts receivable
    $34,755       $13,129  
Prepaid expenses and other assets
    (10,857 )     (17,471 )
Accounts payable and accrued liabilities
    (11,360 )     5,429  
Advances from affiliates
    (50,247 )     21,864  
             
Change in non-cash working capital items
    $(37,709 )     $22,951  
             

F-31


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS PREDECESSOR
NOTES TO THE AUDITED COMBINED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
(all tabular amounts stated in thousands of U.S. Dollars, unless otherwise indicated)
16. Vessel Sales and Writedowns on Vessels and Equipment
      During 2005, the Company sold two shuttle tankers built in 1981 and 1986. The results for the year ended December 31, 2005 include a gain on sale from these vessels totaling $9.1 million.
      In March 2005, the Company sold and leased back a 1991-built shuttle tanker that is now being accounted for as an operating lease. The sale generated a $2.8 million gain, which has been deferred and is being amortized over the 6.5 year term of the lease. The amortization of this deferred gain was $0.3 million in 2005.
      The results for the year ended December 31, 2005 include $12.2 million of writedowns of certain offshore equipment due to a lower estimated net realizable value arising from the early termination of a contract in June 2005.
      During 2004, the Company sold one 1982-built shuttle tanker. The results for the year ended December 31, 2004 include a $3.7 million gain on sale from this vessel.
17. Subsequent Events
      a. In February 2006, Teekay Shipping Corporation announced that it has been awarded long-term contracts to charter two Suezmax shuttle tankers and one Aframax-class shuttle tanker to a subsidiary of Petróleo Brasileiro S.A. The vessels will be chartered from a subsidiary of Norsk Teekay, at fixed-rates for a period of 13 years, commencing at various dates during the second half of 2006 and the first quarter of 2007.
      b. During June 2006, the purchase option to acquire the Fuji Spirit (a 2003-built Aframax tanker currently on a 15-year bareboat charter to the Company) was exercised for $39 million. (Please see Note 8.)
      c. Effective July 1, 2006, the Company sold its subsidiary Navion Shipping Ltd. to a subsidiary of Teekay Shipping Corporation. At the time of the sale, all of the Company’s chartered-in conventional tankers were chartered-in by Navion Shipping Ltd. and subsequently time chartered to a subsidiary of Teekay Shipping Corporation at charter rates that provided a fixed 1.25% profit margin.
18. Valuation and Qualifying Accounts
                   
    Balance at   Balance at
    beginning of   end of
    year   year
         
Allowance for bad debts:
               
 
Year ended December 31, 2004
  $ 407     $ 461  
 
Year ended December 31, 2005
    461       987  
Restructuring cost accrual:
               
 
Year ended December 31, 2004
  $     $  
 
Year ended December 31, 2005
          955  

F-32


 

UNAUDITED
COMBINED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
OF
TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS PREDECESSOR

F-33


 

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
To the Stockholders of
TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS PREDECESSOR
      We have reviewed the accompanying combined consolidated balance sheet of Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor as of June 30, 2006 as described in Note 1 and the related combined consolidated statements of income, changes in owner’s equity and cash flows for the six months ended June 30, 2006 and 2005. These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management.
      We conducted our reviews in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). A review of interim financial information consists principally of applying analytical procedures and making inquiries of persons responsible for financial and accounting matters. It is substantially less in scope than an audit conducted in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the objective of which is the expression of an opinion regarding the financial statements taken as a whole. Accordingly, we do not express such an opinion.
      Based on our reviews, we are not aware of any material modifications that should be made to the combined consolidated financial statements referred to above for them to be in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles.
      We have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the combined consolidated balance sheet of Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor as of December 31, 2005, and the related combined consolidated statements of income, changes in owner’s equity and cash flows for the year then ended, and in our report dated August 25, 2006, we expressed an unqualified opinion on those combined consolidated financial statements. In our opinion, the information set forth in the combined consolidated balance sheet as of December 31, 2005, is fairly stated, in all material respects, in relation to the combined consolidated balance sheet from which it has been derived.
  /s/  Ernst & Young LLP
  Chartered Accountants
Vancouver, Canada,
November 9, 2006

F-34


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS PREDECESSOR (Note 1)
UNAUDITED COMBINED CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF INCOME
                 
    Six Months Ended
    June 30,
     
    2005   2006
         
    (in thousands of
    U.S. dollars)
VOYAGE REVENUES (including $120,518 for 2005 and $112,119 for 2006 of voyage revenues from related parties — notes 10b, 10d, 10f and 10h)
    $400,315       $386,724  
             
OPERATING EXPENSES
               
Voyage expenses (including $131 for 2005 and $357 for 2006 of voyage expenses from related parties — note 10g)
    32,400       48,344  
Vessel operating expenses
    52,900       52,954  
Time-charter hire expense
    176,276       165,935  
Depreciation and amortization
    55,620       51,331  
General and administrative (including $3,079 for 2005 and $2,694 for 2006 of general and administrative expenses from related parties — note 10e)
    37,838       43,469  
Vessel and equipment writedowns and loss on sale of vessels (note 14)
    5,369       1,845  
Restructuring charge (note 8)
          453  
             
Total operating expenses
    360,403       364,331  
             
Income from vessel operations
    39,912       22,393  
             
OTHER ITEMS
               
Interest expense
    (20,100 )     (24,504 )
Interest income
    2,271       3,291  
Equity income from joint ventures
    2,573       3,191  
Foreign exchange (loss) gain (note 5)
    25,730       (18,688 )
Income tax recovery (expense) (note 12)
    15,786       (7,762 )
Other — net (note 8)
    3,002       5,280  
             
Total other items
    29,262       (39,192 )
             
Net income (loss)
    $69,174       $(16,799 )
             
The accompanying notes are an integral part of the unaudited interim combined consolidated financial statements.

F-35


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS PREDECESSOR (Note 1)
UNAUDITED COMBINED CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
                 
    As at   As at
    December 31,   June 30,
    2005   2006
         
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)
ASSETS
Current
               
Cash and cash equivalents (note 6)
    $128,986       $133,962  
Accounts receivable
    34,425       28,355  
Vessels held for sale
          2,500  
Net investment in direct financing leases — current (note 13c)
    20,240       20,790  
Prepaid expenses
    36,475       53,373  
Other current assets
    6,218       17,866  
             
Total current assets
    226,344       256,846  
             
Vessels and equipment (note 6)
               
At cost, less accumulated depreciation of $468,765 (December 31, 2005 — $436,753)
    1,265,630       1,227,007  
Vessels under capital leases, at cost, less accumulated depreciation of $4,014 (December 31, 2005 — $3,308) (note 7)
    34,434       33,758  
             
Total vessels and equipment
    1,300,064       1,260,765  
             
Net investment in direct financing leases (note 13c)
    100,996       95,116  
Investment in joint ventures (note 13b)
    34,402       36,260  
Other assets
    13,160       14,330  
Intangible assets — net (note 3)
    78,502       72,464  
Goodwill (note 3)
    130,549       130,549  
             
Total assets
    $1,884,017       $1,866,330  
             
 
LIABILITIES AND OWNER’S EQUITY
Current
               
Accounts payable
    $16,808       $14,312  
Accrued liabilities
    30,750       34,687  
Current obligation under capital leases (note 7)
    1,355       1,412  
Advances from affiliates (note 5)
    559,250       394,849  
             
Total current liabilities
    608,163       445,260  
             
Long-term debt (note 6)
    398,360       543,543  
Obligation under capital leases (note 7)
    32,890       32,188  
Deferred income taxes
    57,884       73,740  
Other long-term liabilities
    34,482       32,028  
             
Total liabilities
    1,131,779       1,126,759  
             
Commitments and contingencies (notes 7 and 13)
               
Minority interest
    11,859       11,770  
Owner’s equity
    740,379       727,801  
             
Total liabilities and owner’s equity
    $1,884,017       $1,866,330  
             
The accompanying notes are an integral part of the unaudited interim combined consolidated financial statements.

F-36


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS PREDECESSOR (Note 1)
UNAUDITED COMBINED CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
                   
    Six Months Ended
    June 30,
     
    2005   2006
         
    (in thousands of U.S. dollars)
Cash and cash equivalents provided by (used for):
               
OPERATING ACTIVITIES
               
Net income (loss)
    $69,174       $(16,799 )
Non-cash items:
               
 
Depreciation and amortization
    55,620       51,331  
 
Gain on sale of vessels
    (4,831 )     (305 )
 
Loss on writedown of vessels and equipment
    10,200       2,150  
 
Equity income (net of dividends received: June 30, 2006 — $2,500; June 30, 2005 — nil)
    (2,573 )     (691 )
 
Income taxes
    (18,573 )     8,636  
 
Unrealized foreign exchange (gain) loss and other — net
    (29,024 )     18,033  
Change in non-cash working capital items related to operating activities
    3,918       (9,870 )
Expenditures for drydocking
    (2,679 )     (3,780 )
             
Net operating cash flow
    81,232       48,705  
             
FINANCING ACTIVITIES
               
Proceeds from long-term debt
    626,319       238,710  
Scheduled repayments of long-term debt
    (29,884 )      
Prepayments of long-term debt
    (1,083,696 )     (93,527 )
Repayments of capital lease obligations
    (594 )     (646 )
Investment in subsidiaries from minority owners
    8,000        
Distribution from subsidiaries to minority owners
    (8,075 )     (495 )
Net (advances to)/proceeds from affiliates
    334,283       (186,644 )
             
Net financing cash flow
    (153,647 )     (42,602 )
             
INVESTING ACTIVITIES
               
Expenditures for vessels and equipment
    (7,116 )     (5,054 )
Proceeds from sale of vessels and equipment
    64,550        
Investment in direct financing leases
    (11,671 )     (5,177 )
Repayment of direct financing leases
    5,756       9,104  
Other
    (3,337 )      
             
Net investing cash flow
    48,182       (1,127 )
             
(Decrease) increase in cash and cash equivalents
    (24,233 )     4,976  
Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of the period
    143,729       128,986  
             
Cash and cash equivalents, end of the period
    $119,496       $133,962  
             
Supplemental cash flow disclosure (note 4)
               
The accompanying notes are an integral part of the unaudited interim combined consolidated financial statements.

F-37


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS PREDECESSOR (Note 1)
UNAUDITED COMBINED CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN OWNER’S EQUITY
                                   
        Accumulated        
        Other        
        Comprehensive       Total
    Owner’s   Income   Comprehensive   Owner’s
    Equity   (Loss)   Income   Equity
                 
        (in thousands of U.S. dollars)    
Balance as at December 31, 2004
    $659,802       $(590 )             $659,212  
                         
Net income
    84,747               84,747       84,747  
Other comprehensive income:
                               
 
Unrealized gain on derivative instruments (note 11)
            792       792       792  
 
Reclassification adjustment for gain on derivatives included in net income (note 11)
            (94 )     (94 )     (94 )
                         
Comprehensive income
                    85,445          
                         
Norwegian group tax contributions (note 10a)
    (1,185 )                     (1,185 )
Sale of Dania Spirit (note 10c)
    (3,093 )                     (3,093 )
                         
Balance as at December 31, 2005
    740,271       108               740,379  
                         
Net loss
    (16,799 )             (16,799 )     (16,799 )
Other comprehensive income:
                               
 
Unrealized gain on derivative instruments (note 11)
            1,168       1,168       1,168  
 
Reclassification adjustment for loss on derivatives included in net income (note 11)
            2       2       2  
                         
Comprehensive loss
                    (15,629 )        
                         
Norwegian group tax contributions (note 10a)
    2,567                       2,567  
Stock compensation expense (note 1)
    484                       484  
                         
Balance as at June 30, 2006
    $726,523       $1,278               $727,801  
                         
The accompanying notes are an integral part of the unaudited interim combined consolidated financial statements.

F-38


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS PREDECESSOR
NOTES TO THE UNAUDITED COMBINED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(all tabular amounts stated in thousands of U.S. Dollars, unless otherwise indicated)
1. Basis of presentation
      During August 2006, Teekay Shipping Corporation formed Teekay Offshore Partners L.P., a Marshall Islands limited partnership (the Partnership ), as part of its strategy to expand in the marine transportation, processing and storage sectors of the offshore oil industry and for the Partnership to acquire, in connection with the Partnership’s proposed public offering of its common units, a 26.0% interest in Teekay Offshore Operating L.P. (or OPCO ), including a 25.99% limited partner interest to be held directly by the Partnership and a 0.01% general partner interest to be held through its ownership of Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C., OPCO’s sole general partner. Prior to the public offering, Teekay Shipping Corporation will transfer eight Aframax-class conventional crude oil tankers to a subsidiary of Norsk Teekay Holdings Ltd. (or Norsk Teekay ) and one floating storage and offtake unit (or FSO unit ) to Teekay Offshore Australia Trust. Teekay Shipping Corporation will then transfer to OPCO all of the outstanding interests of four wholly owned subsidiaries — Norsk Teekay, Teekay Nordic Holdings Inc. (or Teekay Nordic ), Teekay Offshore Australia Trust and Pattani Spirit L.L.C. These four wholly-owned subsidiaries, which include the eight Aframax-class conventional crude oil tankers and the FSO unit, are collectively referred to as Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor, the Predecessor or the Company . At the closing of the Partnership’s initial public offering, Teekay Shipping Corporation will sell to the Partnership the 25.99% limited partner interest in OPCO and its subsidiaries and a 100% interest in Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C., which owns the 0.01% general partner interest in OPCO, in exchange for (a) the issuance to Teekay Shipping Corporation of 2,800,000 common units and 9,800,000 subordinated units of the Partnership and a non-interest bearing promissory note and (b) the issuance of the 2.0% general partner interest in the Partnership and all of the Partnership’s incentive distribution rights to Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C., a wholly owned subsidiary of Teekay Shipping Corporation. These transfers will represent a reorganization of entities under common control and will be recorded at historical cost. At June 30, 2006, the Predecessor had a fleet of 40 shuttle tankers (26 owned and 14 chartered-in), 36 conventional tankers (10 owned and 26  chartered-in) and three FSO units.
      The financial statements for the six months ended June 30, 2006 and 2005 and as at June 30, 2006 reflect the combined consolidated financial position, results of operations, and cash flows of the Predecessor and its subsidiaries. In the preparation of these combined consolidated financial statements, general and administrative expenses were not identifiable as relating solely to the vessels. General and administrative expenses, consisting primarily of salaries, share-based compensation and other employee related costs, office rent, legal and professional fees, and travel and entertainment, were allocated based on the Predecessor’s proportionate share of Teekay Shipping Corporation’s total ship-operating (calendar) days for each of the periods presented. Management believes this allocation reasonably presents the general and administrative expenses of the Predecessor. The unaudited interim combined consolidated financial statements have been prepared in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States. Certain information and footnote disclosures required by generally accepted accounting principles in the United States for complete annual financial statements have been omitted and, therefore, it is suggested that these interim financial statements be read in conjunction with the Company’s audited financial statements for the year ended December 31, 2005. In the opinion of management, these statements reflect all adjustments (consisting only of normal recurring accruals) necessary to present fairly, in all material respects, the Company’s combined consolidated financial position, results of operations, and cash flows for the interim periods presented. The results of operations for the six months ended June 30, 2006 are not necessarily indicative of those for a full fiscal year. Significant intercompany balances and transactions have been eliminated upon consolidation.

F-39


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS PREDECESSOR
NOTES TO THE UNAUDITED COMBINED CONSOLIDATED
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
(all tabular amounts stated in thousands of U.S. Dollars, unless otherwise indicated)
Change in Accounting Policy
      Effective January 1, 2006, the Company adopted the fair value recognition provisions of the Financial Accounting Standards Board or ( FASB ) Statement No. 123(R) (or SFAS 123(R) ), Share-Based Payment, using the “modified prospective” method. Under this transition method, compensation cost is recognized in the financial statements beginning with the effective date for all share-based payments granted after January 1, 2006 and for all awards granted to employees prior to, but not yet vested as of January 1, 2006. Accordingly, prior period amounts have not been restated.
      As a result of adopting SFAS 123(R) on January 1, 2006, the Company’s net income for the six months ended June 30, 2006 is $0.5 million lower than if it had continued to account for share-based compensation under the recognition and measurement provision of APB Opinion No. 25 (or APB ), Accounting for Stock Issued to Employees.
      Prior to January 1, 2006, the Company accounted for stock options under APB 25, using the intrinsic value method, as permitted by Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 123 (or SFAS 123 ), Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation. As the exercise price of the Company’s employee stock options equals the market price of underlying stock on the date of grant, no compensation expense has been recognized under APB 25.
      Certain employees of the Company participate in the stock option plan of the Company’s parent, Teekay Shipping Corporation. Stock options granted under this plan have a 10-year term and vest equally over three years from the grant date. All outstanding options expire between May 28, 2006 and March 7, 2016, ten years after the date of each respective grant.
      As of June 30, 2006, there was $2.2 million of total unrecognized compensation cost related to nonvested stock options granted to employees of Company. Recognition of this compensation is expected to be $0.6 million (remainder of 2006), $1.0 million (2007), $0.5 million (2008) and $0.1 million(2009).
      The weighted-average grant-date fair value of options granted during the six months ended June 30, 2006 was $11.30 per option. The fair value of each option granted was estimated on the date of the grant using the Black-Scholes option pricing model. The resulting compensation expense is being amortized over three years using the straight-line method. The following weighted-average assumptions were used in computing the fair value of the options granted: expected volatility of 31% in 2006 and 35% in 2005, expected life of five years, dividend yield of 2.0% in 2006 and 1.5% in 2005, and risk-free interest rate of 4.8% in 2006 and 4.1% in 2005.
2. Segment Reporting
      The Company has three reportable segments: its shuttle tanker segment; its conventional tanker segment; and its FSO segment. The Company’s shuttle tanker segment consists of shuttle tankers operating primarily on fixed-rate contracts of affreightment, time-charter contracts or bareboat charter contracts. The Company’s conventional tanker segment consists of conventional tankers operating either on fixed-rate time-charter contracts, on the spot market, or on time charters priced on a spot-market basis. The Company’s FSO segment consists of its FSO units subject to fixed-rate time-charter contracts. Segment results are evaluated based on income from vessel operations. The accounting policies applied to the reportable segments are the same as those used in the preparation of the Company’s combined consolidated financial statements.

F-40


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS PREDECESSOR
NOTES TO THE UNAUDITED COMBINED CONSOLIDATED
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
(all tabular amounts stated in thousands of U.S. Dollars, unless otherwise indicated)
      The following tables present results for these segments for the six months ended June 30, 2005 and 2006:
                                 
    Shuttle   Conventional        
    Tanker   Tanker   FSO    
Six Months Ended June 30, 2005   Segment   Segment   Segment   Total
                 
Voyage revenues
    $260,373       $128,030       $11,912       $400,315  
Voyage expenses
    29,681       2,326       393       32,400  
Vessel operating expenses
    37,903       11,890       3,107       52,900  
Time charter hire expense
    81,035       95,241             176,276  
Depreciation and amortization
    40,054       10,771       4,795       55,620  
General and administrative(1)
    23,720       13,162       956       37,838  
Vessels and equipment writedowns and loss on sale of vessels
    5,369                   5,369  
                         
Income (loss) from vessel operations
    $42,611       $(5,360 )     $2,661       $39,912  
                         
Voyage revenues — intersegment
    $2,291                   $2,291  
Expenditures for vessels and equipment
    6,311       137       668       7,116  
                                 
    Shuttle   Conventional        
    Tanker   Tanker   FSO    
Six Months Ended June 30, 2006   Segment   Segment   Segment   Total
                 
Voyage revenues
    $263,203       $111,555       $11,966       $386,724  
Voyage expenses
    44,690       3,131       523       48,344  
Vessel operating expenses
    38,407       11,031       3,516       52,954  
Time charter hire expense
    86,597       79,338             165,935  
Depreciation and amortization
    35,811       10,787       4,733       51,331  
General and administrative(1)
    27,187       15,313       969       43,469  
Vessels and equipment writedowns and loss on sale of vessels
    1,845                   1,845  
Restructuring charge
          453             453  
                         
Income (loss) from vessel operations
    $28,666       $(8,498 )     $2,225       $22,393  
                         
Voyage revenues — intersegment
    $2,618                   $2,618  
Expenditures for vessels and equipment
    1,954       418       2,682       5,054  
 
(1)  Includes direct general and administrative expenses and indirect general and administrative expenses (allocated to each segment based on estimated use of corporate resources).

F-41


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS PREDECESSOR
NOTES TO THE UNAUDITED COMBINED CONSOLIDATED
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
(all tabular amounts stated in thousands of U.S. Dollars, unless otherwise indicated)
     A reconciliation of total segment assets to total assets presented in the consolidated balance sheet is as follows:
                   
    December 31,   June 30,
    2005   2006
         
Shuttle tanker segment
    $1,277,195       $1,243,549  
Conventional tanker segment
    315,086       304,816  
FSO segment
    72,472       70,079  
Cash and cash equivalents
    128,986       133,962  
Accounts receivable, prepaid expenses and other assets
    90,278       113,924  
             
 
Consolidated total assets
    $1,884,017       $1,866,330  
             
3. Goodwill and Intangible Assets
      The carrying amount of goodwill for the Company’s reporting segments are as follows:
                                 
    Shuttle   Conventional        
    Tanker   Tanker   FSO    
    Segment   Segment   Segment   Total
                 
Balance as of June 30, 2006 and
December 31, 2005
    $130,549                   $130,549  
                         
      As at June 30, 2006 and December 31, 2005, intangible assets consisted of:
                                                           
        December 31, 2005     June 30, 2006
    Weighted-          
    Average   Gross       Net     Gross       Net
    Amortization   Carrying   Accumulated   Carrying     Carrying   Accumulated   Carrying
    Period   Amount   Amortization   Amount     Amount   Amortization   Amount
                               
    (years)                          
Contracts of affreightment
    10.2     $ 124,250     $ (45,748 )   $ 78,502       $ 124,250     $ (51,786 )   $ 72,464  
      Aggregate amortization expense of intangible assets for the six months ended June 30, 2006 and 2005 was $6.0 million and $7.9 million, respectively. Amortization of intangible assets for the next five years is expected to be $6.0 million (remainder of 2006), $11.1 million (2007), $10.1 million (2008), $9.1 million (2009), and $8.1 million (2010).
4. Cash Flows
      Cash interest paid by the Company during the six months ended June 30, 2006 and 2005 totaled approximately $22.6 million and $16.1 million, respectively.

F-42


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS PREDECESSOR
NOTES TO THE UNAUDITED COMBINED CONSOLIDATED
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
(all tabular amounts stated in thousands of U.S. Dollars, unless otherwise indicated)
5. Advances from Affiliates
                 
    December 31,   June 30,
    2005   2006
         
Norwegian Kroner-denominated Demand Promissory Note (7.5%)
  $ 157,842     $ 157,596  
Norwegian Kroner-denominated Demand Promissory Note (non-interest bearing)
    6,797        
Australian Dollar-denominated Demand Promissory Note (8.0%)
    18,720       18,942  
Other (non-interest bearing with no fixed terms of repayment)
    375,891       218,311  
             
    $ 559,250     $ 394,849  
             
      As at June 30, 2006, Teekay Shipping Corporation and certain of its subsidiaries had loaned the Company 1.0 billion Norwegian Kroner ($157.6 million) and 25.5 million Australian Dollars ($18.9 million). These promissory notes, which are due on demand, are unsecured.
      The interest expense incurred on the interest-bearing demand promissory notes for the six months ended June 30, 2006 and 2005 were $6.8 million and $7.8 million, respectively.
      All Norwegian Kroner-denominated and Australian Dollar-denominated advances are revalued at the end of each period using the then prevailing Norwegian Kroner/ U.S. Dollar and Australian Dollar/ U.S. Dollar exchange rates. Due substantially to this revaluation, the Company recognized foreign exchange losses of $18.7 million during the six months ended June 30, 2006 and foreign exchange gains of $25.7 million during the six months ended June 30, 2005.
6. Long-Term Debt
                 
    December 31,   June 30,
    2005   2006
         
Revolving Credit Facilities
  $ 398,360     $ 543,543  
             
      As at June 30, 2006, the Company had three long-term revolving credit facilities (or the Revolvers ) available, which, as at such date, provided for borrowings of up to $949.0 million, of which $405.5 million was undrawn. Interest payments are based on LIBOR plus margins; at June 30, 2006, the margins ranged between 0.60% and 0.70%. The total amount available under the Revolvers reduces by $49.7 million (2006), $100.3 million (2007), $315.5 million (2008), $41.8 million (2009), $43.2 million (2010) and $398.5 million (thereafter). The Revolvers are collateralized by first-priority mortgages granted on 31 of the Company’s vessels, together with other related collateral, and include a guarantee from Teekay Shipping Corporation for all outstanding amounts.
      The Revolvers require that Teekay Shipping Corporation and its subsidiaries maintain a minimum level of free cash. As at June 30, 2006, this amount was $100.0 million. The Revolvers also require that Teekay Shipping Corporation and its subsidiaries maintain a minimum aggregate level of free liquidity and undrawn revolving credit lines with at least six months to maturity. As at June 30, 2006, this amount was $126.2 million.
      The weighted average effective interest rate on the Company’s long-term debt as at June 30, 2006 was 5.9% (December 31, 2005 — 5.1%).
      During October 2006, the Company amended one of its revolving credit facilities and terminated the other two facilities and entered into a $940 million revolving credit facility. Please see Note 15.

F-43


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS PREDECESSOR
NOTES TO THE UNAUDITED COMBINED CONSOLIDATED
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
(all tabular amounts stated in thousands of U.S. Dollars, unless otherwise indicated)
      The aggregate annual long-term debt principal repayments required to be made for the periods subsequent to June 30, 2006 are $0.0 million (2006), $15.0 million (2007), $284.0 million (2008), $10.8 million (2009), $10.8 million (2010) and $222.9 million (thereafter).
7. Capital Lease Obligation
      As at June 30, 2006, the Company was a party, as lessee, to a fixed-rate capital lease on one Aframax-class conventional crude oil tanker, the Fuji Spirit. Under the terms of the lease arrangement, which include the Company’s contractual right to full operation of the vessel pursuant to a bareboat charter, the Company is required to purchase the vessel at the end of its lease term for a fixed price. The Company has an option to purchase the vessel during the term of the lease. The annual interest rate implicit in this capital lease, at the inception of the lease, was 8.3%. As at June 30, 2006, the remaining commitments under this capital lease, including the purchase obligation, approximated $55.3 million, including imputed interest of $21.7 million, repayable as follows:
         
Year   Commitment
     
2006
    $2.1 million  
2007
    4.1 million  
2008
    4.1 million  
2009
    4.1 million  
2010
    4.1 million  
Thereafter
    36.8 million  
      During June 2006, the Company exercised its option to purchase the Aframax tanker that was subject to a capital lease for $39 million. The purchase will occur in September 2006.
8. Restructuring Charge and Other Income
                 
    Six Months Ended
     
    June 30,   June 30,
    2005   2006
         
Minority interest expense
    $(692 )     $(414 )
Volatile organic compound emissions plant lease income
    5,056       5,657  
Miscellaneous
    (1,362 )     37  
             
Other — net
    $3,002       $5,280  
             
      During the six months ended June 30, 2006, the Company relocated certain operational functions to Singapore. As a result, the Company incurred $0.5 million of restructuring costs during the six months ended June 30, 2006.

F-44


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS PREDECESSOR
NOTES TO THE UNAUDITED COMBINED CONSOLIDATED
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
(all tabular amounts stated in thousands of U.S. Dollars, unless otherwise indicated)
9. Comprehensive Income
                 
    Six Months Ended
     
    June 30,   June 30,
    2005   2006
         
Net income (loss)
    $69,174       $(16,799 )
Other comprehensive income:
               
Unrealized gain on derivative instruments
    330       1,168  
Reclassification adjustment for (gain) loss on derivatives included in net income
    (72 )     2  
             
Comprehensive income (loss)
    $69,432       $(15,629 )
             
10. Related Party Transactions
      a. During 2005, rate-effected income tax losses of $1.2 million that were generated by the Company’s Norwegian subsidiaries were transferred to the Norwegian subsidiaries of Teekay Shipping Corporation. The transfer of these income tax losses has been accounted for as an equity distribution.
      During the six months ended June 30, 2006, rate-effected income tax losses of $2.6 million that were generated by Norwegian subsidiaries of Teekay Shipping Corporation were transferred to the Company’s Norwegian subsidiaries. The transfer of these income tax losses were used to reduce the Company’s tax payable and has been accounted for as an equity contribution.
      b. During March 2004, a subsidiary of Teekay Shipping Corporation acquired from Navion Shipping Ltd. (a subsidiary of the Company) the right to charter-in and market Navion Shipping Ltd.’s vessels in the spot market at a fee of 1.25% over Navion Shipping Ltd.’s charter-in cost. The cost to obtain this right was $5.2 million and has been accounted for as an equity contribution.
      During the six months ended June 30, 2006 and 2005, the Company earned $84.8 million and $98.4 million, respectively, of time charter revenue pursuant to this agreement with Navion Shipping Ltd.
      During the six months ended June 30, 2006 and 2005, the Company earned $5.1 million and $3.4 million, respectively, of management fees from commercial management services provided to a subsidiary of Teekay Shipping Corporation, relating to the vessels chartered from Navion Shipping Ltd.
      c. During June 2005, the Company sold the Dania Spirit (a 2000-built liquid petroleum gas carrier) to a subsidiary of Teekay Shipping Corporation for $18.0 million. The resulting $3.1 million loss on sale has been accounted for as an equity distribution.
      d. Seven of the Company’s Aframax tankers have been employed on time-charter contracts with a subsidiary of Teekay Shipping Corporation at various times during the previous three years. Pursuant to these time-charter contracts, the Company earned voyage revenues of $16.7 million and $13.3 million during the six months ended June 30, 2006 and 2005, respectively.
      e. Eight of the Company’s Aframax conventional oil tankers and two FSO units have been managed by subsidiaries of Teekay Shipping Corporation. Pursuant to the associated management services agreements, the Company incurred general and administrative expenses of $2.7 million and $3.1 million, respectively, during the six months ended June 30, 2006 and 2005 (please see Note 1).

F-45


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS PREDECESSOR
NOTES TO THE UNAUDITED COMBINED CONSOLIDATED
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
(all tabular amounts stated in thousands of U.S. Dollars, unless otherwise indicated)
      f. One of the Company’s FSO units has been employed on a long-term bareboat charter with a subsidiary of Teekay Shipping Corporation. Pursuant to this charter contract, the Company earned voyage revenues of $2.7 million each during the six months ended June 30, 2006 and 2005.
      g. The Company’s shuttle tankers that service its contracts of affreightment have been employed on voyage charters when the Company has excess shuttle tanker capacity. For certain voyage charters, a subsidiary of Teekay Shipping Corporation provides ship brokerage services to the Company. The Company incurred $0.4 million and $0.1 million, respectively, of voyage expenses relating to these services during the six months ended June 30, 2006 and 2005.
      h. One of the Company’s shuttle tankers has been employed on a long-term bareboat charter with one of the Company’s joint ventures. Pursuant to the charter contract, the Company earned voyage revenues of $2.7 million each during the six months ended June 30, 2006 and 2005.
11. Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities
      The Company uses derivatives only for hedging purposes. The following summarizes the Company’s risk strategies with respect to market risk from changes in interest rates.
      As at June 30, 2006, the Company was committed to the following interest rate swap agreement related to its LIBOR-based debt, whereby certain of the Company’s floating-rate debt was swapped with fixed-rate obligations:
                                         
            Fair Value/   Weighted-    
    Interest       Carrying   Average   Fixed
    Rate   Principal   Amount of   Remaining   Interest
    Index   Amount   Liability   Term   Rate(1)
                     
                (years)    
U.S. Dollar-denominated interest rate swap(2)
    LIBOR     $ 28,600     $ 1,278       8.0       4.7%  
 
(1)  Excludes the margins the Company pays on its variable-rate debt (including the debt of its joint ventures), which as at June 30, 2006 ranged from 0.6% to 0.8%.
 
(2)  Principal amount reduces semiannually by $1.1 million.
      The Company is exposed to credit loss in the event of non-performance by the counter parties to the interest rate swap agreement; however, the Company does not anticipate non-performance by any of the counter parties.
      As at June 30, 2006 and December 31, 2005, the Company’s accumulated other comprehensive income of $1.3 million and $0.1 million, respectively, consisted of unrealized gain on derivative instruments.
12. Income Taxes
      The components of the provision for income taxes follow:
                 
    Six Months Ended
     
    June 30,   June 30,
    2005   2006
         
Current
    $(315 )     $(77 )
Deferred
    16,101       (7,685 )
             
Income tax recovery (expense)
    $15,786       $(7,762 )
             

F-46


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS PREDECESSOR
NOTES TO THE UNAUDITED COMBINED CONSOLIDATED
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
(all tabular amounts stated in thousands of U.S. Dollars, unless otherwise indicated)
13. Commitments and Contingencies
a) Vessel Purchases and Conversions
      In February 2006, Teekay Shipping Corporation announced that it has been awarded 13-year fixed-rate contracts to charter two Suezmax shuttle tankers and one Aframax shuttle tanker to a subsidiary of Petróleo Brasileiro S.A. The charters are scheduled to commence during the fourth quarter of 2006 and the first quarter of 2007. In connection with these contracts, the Company has exercised the purchase option on a 2000-built Aframax tanker presently trading as part of the Company’s spot-rate chartered-in fleet, which will be converted to a shuttle tanker by the end of 2006. The purchase price for this vessel, including estimated conversion costs, is approximately $64.8 million. A second vessel that will be employed under these contracts is a 2003-built Suezmax shuttle tanker, that is already operating in the Company’s shuttle tanker fleet. Upgrade costs for this vessel are expected to be approximately $11.5 million and to be completed in July 2006. The third vessel is a 2006-built Suezmax tanker owned by Teekay Shipping Corporation, which will be converted to a shuttle tanker by February 2007.
b) Joint Ventures
      The Company has guaranteed its share of the outstanding vessel mortgage debt in two 50%-owned joint venture companies. As at June 30, 2006, the Company had guaranteed $46.8 million, or 50% of the total $93.6 million, in outstanding mortgage debt of the joint venture companies. These joint venture companies own an aggregate of two shuttle tankers.
c) Volatile Organic Compound Emissions Plants
      The Company has been awarded a contract by a consortium of major oil companies to construct and install on seven of its shuttle tankers volatile organic compound emissions plants, which reduce emissions during cargo operations. These plants are leased to the consortium of major oil companies. The construction and installation of these plants are expected to be completed by the end of 2006 at a total cost of approximately $105.9 million. As at June 30, 2006, the Company had made payments towards these commitments of approximately $87.9 million, with approximately $18.0 million of remaining payments required to be made in 2006 towards these commitments.
d) Other
      The Company enters into indemnification agreements in the ordinary course of business. The maximum potential amount of future payments required under these indemnification agreements is unlimited. However, the Company maintains what it believes is appropriate liability insurance that reduces its exposure and enables the Company to recover future amounts paid up to the maximum amount of the insurance coverage, less any deductible amounts pursuant to the terms of the respective policies, the amounts of which are not considered material.
14. Vessel Sales
      During February 2006, the Company entered into an agreement to sell one shuttle tanker built in 1981. The Company expects to record a gain of approximately $3.2 million, net of minority interest of 49.5%, relating to the sale upon delivery in the third quarter of 2006. This vessel is presented on the June 30, 2006 balance sheet as vessel held for sale.
      During the six months ended June 30, 2006, the Company incurred a $2.2 million writedown of certain offshore equipment. This writedown occurred due to a reassessment of the estimated net realizable

F-47


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS PREDECESSOR
NOTES TO THE UNAUDITED COMBINED CONSOLIDATED
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS — (Continued)
(all tabular amounts stated in thousands of U.S. Dollars, unless otherwise indicated)
value of this equipment and follows a $10.2 million writedown in June 2005 arising from the early termination of a contract for the equipment.
      In March 2005, the Company sold and leased back a 1991-built shuttle tanker that is now being accounted for as an operating lease. The sale generated a $2.8 million gain, which has been deferred and is being amortized over the 6.5 year term of the lease. The results for the six months ended June 30, 2006 include $0.3 million of amortization of this deferred gain.
      During the six months ended June 30, 2005, the Company sold one 1986-built shuttle tanker. The results for the six months ended June 30, 2005 include a $4.9 million gain on sale from this vessel.
15. Subsequent Events
      Effective July 1, 2006, the Company sold its subsidiary Navion Shipping Ltd. to a subsidiary of Teekay Shipping Corporation. At the time of the sale, all of the Company’s chartered-in conventional tankers were chartered-in by Navion Shipping Ltd. and subsequently time chartered to a subsidiary of Teekay Shipping Corporation at charter rates that provided a fixed 1.25% profit margin.
      In September 2006, the Company purchased the Fuji Spirit (a 2003-built Aframax tanker) for $39.0 million pursuant to the exercise of its purchase option in June 2006. Please see note 7.
      During October 2006, the Company amended one of its revolving credit facilities and terminated the other two facilities and entered into a $940 million revolving credit facility. The amended revolving credit facility is a $455 million eight-year facility that bears interest at LIBOR plus a margin. The Company’s obligations under this facility are collateralized by first-priority mortgages on eight shuttle tankers and one FSO unit. The new $940 million revolving credit facility is an eight-year facility that bears interest at LIBOR plus a margin. The Company’s obligations under this facility are collateralized by first priority mortgages on eleven shuttle tankers and eight conventional tankers. Both facilities contain covenants that require the maintenance of a minimum liquidity of $75.0 million and at least 5.0% of the total consolidated debt of the Company.
16. Recent Accounting Pronouncements
      In July 2006, FASB issued Interpretation No. 48 (or FIN 48 ), Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes — an interpretation of FASB Statement No. 109. This interpretation clarifies the accounting for uncertainty in income taxes recognized in financial statements in accordance with FASB Statement No. 109, Accounting for Income Taxes. FIN 48 will require companies to determine whether it is more-likely-than-not that a tax position taken or expected to be taken in a tax return will be sustained upon examination, including resolution of any related appeals or litigation processes, based on the technical merits of the position. If a tax position meets the more-likely-than-not recognition threshold, it is measured to determine the amount of benefit to recognize in the financial statements based on guidance in the interpretation. FIN 48 is effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2006. The Company has not determined the effect, if any, that the adoption of FIN 48 will have on the Company’s combined consolidated financial position or results of operations.

F-48


 

AUDITED BALANCE SHEET
OF
TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS L.P.

F-49


 

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
To the Partners of
TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS L.P.
      We have audited the accompanying balance sheet of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. as of August 31, 2006. The balance sheet is the responsibility of the Partnership’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on this balance sheet based on our audit.
      We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the balance sheet is free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the balance sheet. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall balance sheet presentation. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.
      In our opinion, the balance sheet referred to above presents fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. at August 31, 2006 in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles.
  /s/  Ernst & Young LLP
  Chartered Accountants
Vancouver, Canada,
September 6, 2006

F-50


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS L.P.
AUDITED BALANCE SHEET
           
    As at
    August 31, 2006
     
    (U.S. Dollars)
ASSETS
Current
       
Cash and cash equivalents
  $ 1,000  
       
 
Total assets
  $ 1,000  
       
Commitments and contingencies (note 2)
       
PARTNERS’ EQUITY
Limited Partner
    $980  
General Partner
    20  
       
 
Total partners’ equity
  $ 1,000  
       
The accompanying notes are an integral part of the balance sheet.

F-51


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS L.P.
NOTES TO AUDITED BALANCE SHEET
(U.S. Dollars)
1. Nature of Operations
      Teekay Offshore Partners L.P., a Marshall Islands limited partnership (or the Partnership ), was formed on August 31, 2006 to ultimately own a 26.0% interest in Teekay Offshore Operating L.P. (or OPCO ), including a 25.99% limited partner interest held directly by the Partnership and a 0.01% general partner interest held through its ownership of Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C., OPCO’s sole general partner. The Partnership’s general partner (or the General Partner ), is a wholly owned subsidiary of Teekay Shipping Corporation. The Partnership intends to obtain the foregoing assets in connection with the initial public offering of its common units (the Offering ).
      The Partnership has adopted a December 31 fiscal year end. The General Partner contributed $20 and Teekay Shipping Corporation contributed $980 to the Partnership on August 31, 2006. There have been no other transactions involving the Partnership as at August 31, 2006.
2. Subsequent Events
      At the closing of the Offering, the following are among the transactions that are expected to occur:
  •  Teekay Shipping Corporation will transfer to the Partnership a 26.0% interest in OPCO;
 
  •  The Partnership will issue to Teekay Shipping Corporation 2,800,000 common units and 9,800,000 subordinated units, representing a 63.0% limited partner interest in the Partnership, and the Partnership will be obligated to Teekay Shipping Corporation pursuant to non-interest bearing promissory notes (the TSC Notes )
 
  •  The Partnership will issue to the General Partner a 2.0% general partner interest in the Partnership and all of the Partnership’s incentive distribution rights;
 
  •  The Partnership will issue 7,000,000 common units to the public in the Offering and use the net proceeds to repay the TSC Notes and to pay expenses associated with the public offering and related transactions;
 
  •  The Partnership will enter into an omnibus agreement with Teekay Shipping Corporation, the General Partner and others governing, among other things, when the Partnership and Teekay Shipping Corporation may compete with each other; and
 
  •  The Partnership and certain of its operating subsidiaries will enter into services agreements with certain subsidiaries of Teekay Shipping Corporation pursuant to which the Teekay Shipping Corporation subsidiaries will agree to provide to the Partnership administrative services and to such operating subsidiaries strategic consulting, advisory, ship management, technical and administrative services. These services will be valued at a reasonable, arms’-length fee that will include reimbursement of reasonable direct or indirect expenses incurred to provide these services.

F-52


 

AUDITED BALANCE SHEET
OF
TEEKAY OFFSHORE GP L.L.C.

F-53


 

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
To the Member of
TEEKAY OFFSHORE GP L.L.C.
      We have audited the accompanying balance sheet of Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C. as of August 25, 2006. The balance sheet is the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on this balance sheet based on our audit.
      We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the balance sheet is free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the balance sheet. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall balance sheet presentation. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.
      In our opinion, the balance sheet referred to above presents fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C. at August 25, 2006 in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles.
  /s/  Ernst & Young LLP
  Chartered Accountants
Vancouver, Canada,
September 6, 2006

F-54


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE GP L.L.C.
AUDITED BALANCE SHEET
           
    As at
    August 25, 2006
     
    (U.S. Dollars)
ASSETS
Current
       
Cash and cash equivalents
    $980  
Investment in Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. 
    20  
       
 
Total assets
  $ 1,000  
       
MEMBER’S EQUITY
Member’s equity
  $ 1,000  
       
 
Total member’s equity
  $ 1,000  
       
The accompanying note is an integral part of the balance sheet.

F-55


 

TEEKAY OFFSHORE GP L.L.C.
NOTES TO AUDITED BALANCE SHEET
(U.S. Dollars)
1. Nature of Operations
      Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C. (or the Company ), a Marshall Islands limited liability company, was formed on August 25, 2006 to become the general partner of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. (or the Partnership ). The Company is a wholly owned subsidiary of Teekay Shipping Corporation. On August 25, 2006, Teekay Shipping Corporation contributed $1,000 to the Company in exchange for a 100.0% ownership interest. The Company has invested $20 in the Partnership for its 2.0% general partner interest. There have been no other transactions involving the Company as of August 25, 2006. The Partnership anticipates filing a registration statement for an initial public offering of its units.

F-56


 

APPENDIX A
FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED
AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP
OF
TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS L.P.


 

TABLE OF CONTENTS
             
ARTICLE I DEFINITIONS     A-1  
Section 1.1
  Definitions.     A-1  
Section 1.2
  Construction.     A-13  
 
ARTICLE II ORGANIZATION     A-13  
Section 2.1
  Formation.     A-13  
Section 2.2
  Name.     A-13  
Section 2.3
  Registered Office; Registered Agent; Principal Office; Other Offices .     A-13  
Section 2.4
  Purpose and Business .     A-14  
Section 2.5
  Powers.     A-14  
Section 2.6
  Power of Attorney .     A-14  
Section 2.7
  Term .     A-15  
Section 2.8
  Title to Partnership Assets .     A-15  
 
ARTICLE III RIGHTS OF LIMITED PARTNERS     A-16  
Section 3.1
  Limitation of Liability .     A-16  
Section 3.2
  Management of Business .     A-16  
Section 3.3
  Outside Activities of the Limited Partners .     A-16  
Section 3.4
  Rights of Limited Partners .     A-16  
 
ARTICLE IV CERTIFICATES; RECORD HOLDERS; TRANSFER OF PARTNERSHIP INTERESTS     A-17  
Section 4.1
  Certificates.     A-17  
Section 4.2
  Mutilated, Destroyed, Lost or Stolen Certificates .     A-17  
Section 4.3
  Record Holders .     A-18  
Section 4.4
  Transfer Generally .     A-18  
Section 4.5
  Registration and Transfer of Limited Partner Interests .     A-18  
Section 4.6
  Transfer of the General Partner’s General Partner Interest .     A-19  
Section 4.7
  Transfer of Incentive Distribution Rights .     A-19  
Section 4.8
  Restrictions on Transfers .     A-20  
 
ARTICLE V CAPITAL CONTRIBUTIONS AND ISSUANCE OF PARTNERSHIP INTERESTS     A-20  
Section 5.1
  Organizational Contributions .     A-20  
Section 5.2
  Initial Unit Issuances; General Partner Pre-emptive Rights .     A-20  
Section 5.3
  Contributions by Initial Limited Partners and Distributions to the General Partner and its Affiliates .     A-20  
Section  5.4
  Interest and Withdrawal .     A-21  
Section  5.5
  Issuances of Additional Partnership Securities .     A-21  
Section  5.6
  Limitations on Issuance of Additional Partnership Securities .     A-22  
Section  5.7
  Conversion of Subordinated Units .     A-22  
Section  5.8
  Limited Preemptive Right .     A-22  
Section  5.9
  Splits and Combinations .     A-23  
Section  5.10
  Fully Paid and Non-Assessable Nature of Limited Partner Interests .     A-23  

A-i


 

             
 
ARTICLE VI ALLOCATIONS AND DISTRIBUTIONS     A-23  
Section  6.1
  Allocations .     A-23  
Section  6.2
  Requirement and Characterization of Distributions; Distributions to Record Holders .     A-24  
Section  6.3
  Distributions of Available Cash from Operating Surplus .     A-24  
Section  6.4
  Distributions of Available Cash from Capital Surplus .     A-26  
Section  6.5
  Adjustment of Minimum Quarterly Distribution and Target Distribution Levels .     A-26  
Section  6.6
  Special Provisions Relating to the Holders of Subordinated Units .     A-26  
Section  6.7
  Special Provisions Relating to the Holders of Incentive Distribution Rights .     A-26  
 
ARTICLE VII MANAGEMENT AND OPERATION OF BUSINESS     A-27  
Section  7.1
  Management .     A-27  
Section  7.2
  Certificate of Limited Partnership .     A-28  
Section  7.3
  Restrictions on the General Partner’s Authority .     A-28  
Section  7.4
  Reimbursement of the General Partner .     A-29  
Section  7.5
  Outside Activities .     A-30  
Section  7.6
  Loans from the General Partner; Loans or Contributions from the Partnership or Group Members .     A-30  
Section  7.7
  Indemnification .     A-31  
Section  7.8
  Liability of Indemnitees .     A-32  
Section  7.9
  Resolution of Conflicts of Interest; Standards of Conduct and Modification of Duties .     A-33  
Section  7.10
  Other Matters Concerning the General Partner .     A-34  
Section  7.11
  Purchase or Sale of Partnership Securities .     A-34  
Section  7.12
  Registration Rights of the General Partner and its Affiliates .     A-35  
Section  7.13
  Reliance by Third Parties .     A-37  
 
ARTICLE VIII BOOKS, RECORDS, ACCOUNTING AND REPORTS     A-37  
Section  8.1
  Records and Accounting .     A-37  
Section  8.2
  Fiscal Year .     A-37  
Section  8.3
  Reports.     A-37  
 
ARTICLE IX TAX MATTERS     A-38  
Section  9.1
  Tax Elections and Information.     A-38  
Section  9.2
  Withholding .     A-38  
Section  9.3
  Conduct of Operations .     A-38  
 
ARTICLE X ADMISSION OF PARTNERS     A-38  
Section  10.1
  Admission of Initial Limited Partners .     A-38  
Section  10.2
  Admission of Additional Limited Partners .     A-39  
Section  10.3
  Admission of Successor General Partner .     A-39  
Section  10.4
  Amendment of Agreement and Certificate of Limited Partnership .     A-39  
 
ARTICLE XI WITHDRAWAL OR REMOVAL OF PARTNERS     A-40  
Section  11.1
  Withdrawal of the General Partner .     A-40  
Section  11.2
  Removal of the General Partner .     A-41  

A-ii


 

             
Section  11.3
  Interest of Departing General Partner and Successor General Partner .     A-41  
Section  11.4
  Termination of Subordination Period, Conversion of Subordinated Units and Extinguishment of Cumulative Common Unit Arrearages .     A-42  
Section  11.5
  Withdrawal of Limited Partners .     A-43  
 
ARTICLE XII DISSOLUTION AND LIQUIDATION     A-43  
Section  12.1
  Dissolution .     A-43  
Section  12.2
  Continuation of the Business of the Partnership After Dissolution .     A-43  
Section  12.3
  Liquidator.     A-44  
Section  12.4
  Liquidation .     A-44  
Section  12.5
  Cancellation of Certificate of Limited Partnership .     A-45  
Section  12.6
  Return of Contributions .     A-46  
Section  12.7
  Waiver of Partition .     A-46  
 
ARTICLE XIII AMENDMENT OF PARTNERSHIP AGREEMENT; MEETINGS; RECORD DATE     A-46  
Section  13.1
  Amendments to be Adopted Solely by the General Partner .     A-46  
Section  13.2
  Amendment Procedures .     A-47  
Section  13.3
  Amendment Requirements .     A-47  
Section  13.4
  Special Meetings .     A-48  
Section  13.5
  Notice of a Meeting .     A-48  
Section  13.6
  Record Date .     A-48  
Section  13.7
  Adjournment .     A-49  
Section  13.8
  Waiver of Notice; Approval of Meeting; Approval of Minutes .     A-49  
Section  13.9
  Quorum and Voting .     A-49  
Section  13.10
  Conduct of a Meeting .     A-49  
Section  13.11
  Action Without a Meeting .     A-50  
Section  13.12
  Right to Vote and Related Matters .     A-50  
 
ARTICLE XIV MERGER     A-50  
Section  14.1
  Authority.     A-50  
Section  14.2
  Procedure for Merger or Consolidation .     A-51  
Section  14.3
  Approval by Limited Partners of Merger or Consolidation .     A-51  
Section  14.4
  Certificate of Merger .     A-52  
Section  14.5
  Amendment of Partnership Agreement .     A-52  
Section  14.6
  Effect of Merger .     A-52  
 
ARTICLE XV RIGHT TO ACQUIRE LIMITED PARTNER INTERESTS     A-53  
Section  15.1
  Right to Acquire Limited Partner Interests .     A-53  
 
ARTICLE XVI GENERAL PROVISIONS     A-54  
Section  16.1
  Addresses and Notices .     A-54  
Section  16.2
  Further Action .     A-54  
Section  16.3
  Binding Effect .     A-54  
Section  16.4
  Integration .     A-54  

A-iii


 

             
Section  16.5
  Creditors.     A-55  
Section  16.6
  Waiver.     A-55  
Section  16.7
  Counterparts .     A-55  
Section  16.8
  Applicable Law .     A-55  
Section  16.9
  Invalidity of Provisions .     A-55  
Section  16.10
  Consent of Partners .     A-55  
Section  16.11
  Facsimile Signatures .     A-55  
Section  16.12
  Third-Party Beneficiaries .     A-55  

A-iv


 

FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED
PARTNERSHIP OF TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS L.P.
      THIS FIRST AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP OF TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS L.P., dated as of                     , 2006, is entered into by and between Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C., a Marshall Islands limited liability company, as the General Partner, and Teekay Shipping Corporation, a Marshall Islands corporation, as the Organizational Limited Partner, together with any other Persons who become Partners in the Partnership or parties hereto as provided herein. In consideration of the covenants, conditions and agreements contained herein, the parties agree as follows:
ARTICLE I
DEFINITIONS
      Section  1.1      Definitions.
      The following definitions shall be for all purposes, unless otherwise clearly indicated to the contrary, applied to the terms used in this Agreement.
      “Acquisition” means any transaction in which any Group Member acquires (through an asset acquisition, merger, stock acquisition or other form of investment) control over all or a portion of the assets, properties or business of another Person for the purpose of increasing the operating capacity or asset base of the Partnership Group from the operating capacity or asset base of the Partnership Group existing immediately prior to such transaction; provided however, that any acquisition of properties or assets of another Person that is made solely for investment purposes shall not constitute an Acquisition under this Agreement.
      “Adjusted Operating Surplus” means, with respect to any period, Operating Surplus generated with respect to such period (a) less (i) any net increase in Working Capital Borrowings (or the Partnership’s proportionate share of any net increase in Working Capital Borrowings in the case of Subsidiaries that are not wholly owned) with respect to such period and (ii) any net decrease in cash reserves for Operating Expenditures with respect to such period to the extent such reduction does not relate to an Operating Expenditure made with respect to such period, and (b) plus (i) any net decrease in Working Capital Borrowings (or the Partnership’s proportionate share of any net decrease in Working Capital Borrowings in the case of Subsidiaries that are not wholly owned) with respect to such period, and (ii) any net increase in cash reserves (or the Partnership’s proportionate share of any net increase in cash reserves in the case of Subsidiaries that are not wholly owned) for Operating Expenditures with respect to such period to the extent such reserve is required by any debt instrument for the repayment of principal, interest or premium. Adjusted Operating Surplus does not include that portion of Operating Surplus included in clause (a)(i) of the definition of Operating Surplus.
      “Affiliate” means, with respect to any Person, any other Person that directly or indirectly through one or more intermediaries controls, is controlled by or is under common control with, the Person in question. As used herein, the term “control” means the possession, direct or indirect, of the power to direct or cause the direction of the management and policies of a Person, whether through ownership of voting securities, by contract or otherwise.
      “Agreed Value” means the fair market value of the applicable property or other consideration at the time of contribution or distribution, as the case may be, as determined by the General Partner.
      “Agreement” means this First Amended and Restated Agreement of Limited Partnership of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P., as it may be amended, supplemented or restated from time to time.
      “Associate” means, when used to indicate a relationship with any Person: (a) any corporation or organization of which such Person is a director, officer or partner or is, directly or indirectly, the owner of 20% or more of any class of voting stock or other voting interest; (b) any trust or other estate in which such Person has at least a 20% beneficial interest or as to which such Person serves as trustee or in a

A-1


 

similar fiduciary capacity; and (c) any relative or spouse of such Person, or any relative of such spouse, who has the same principal residence as such Person.
      “Available Cash” means, with respect to any Quarter ending prior to the Liquidation Date:
        (a) the sum of (i) all cash and cash equivalents of the Partnership Group (or the Partnership’s proportionate share of cash and cash equivalents in the case of Subsidiaries that are not wholly owned) on hand at the end of such Quarter, and (ii) all additional cash and cash equivalents of the Partnership Group (or the Partnership’s proportionate share of cash and cash equivalents in the case of Subsidiaries that are not wholly owned) on hand on the date of determination of Available Cash with respect to such Quarter resulting from Working Capital Borrowings made subsequent to the end of such Quarter, less
 
        (b) the amount of any cash reserves (or the Partnership’s proportionate share of cash reserves in the case of Subsidiaries that are not wholly owned) established by the General Partner to (i) provide for the proper conduct of the business of the Partnership Group (including reserves for future capital expenditures and for anticipated future credit needs of the Partnership Group) subsequent to such Quarter, (ii) comply with applicable law or any loan agreement, security agreement, mortgage, debt instrument or other agreement or obligation to which any Group Member is a party or by which it is bound or its assets are subject or (iii) provide funds for distributions under Section 6.3 or 6.4 in respect of any one or more of the next four Quarters; provided, however, that the General Partner may not establish cash reserves pursuant to (iii) above if the effect of such reserves would be that the Partnership is unable to distribute the Minimum Quarterly Distribution on all Common Units, plus any Cumulative Common Unit Arrearage on all Common Units, with respect to such Quarter; and, provided further, that disbursements made by a Group Member or cash reserves established, increased or reduced after the end of such Quarter but on or before the date of determination of Available Cash with respect to such Quarter shall be deemed to have been made, established, increased or reduced, for purposes of determining Available Cash, within such Quarter if the General Partner so determines.
 
        Notwithstanding the foregoing, “Available Cash” with respect to the Quarter in which the Liquidation Date occurs and any subsequent Quarter shall equal zero.
      “Board of Directors” means the board of directors or managers of a corporation or limited liability company, as applicable, or if a limited partnership, the board of directors or board of managers of the general partner of such limited partnership.
      “Business Day” means Monday through Friday of each week, except that a legal holiday recognized as such by the government of the United States of America or the State of New York shall not be regarded as a Business Day.
      “Capital Contribution” means any cash, cash equivalents or the Net Agreed Value of Contributed Property that a Partner contributes to the Partnership.
      “Capital Improvement” means any (a) addition or improvement to the capital assets owned by any Group Member or (b) acquisition of existing, or the construction of new, capital assets (including shuttle tankers, floating storage and offtake units, floating production, storage and offloading units, crude oil tankers and related assets), in each case if such addition, improvement, acquisition or construction is made to increase the operating capacity or asset base of the Partnership Group from the operating capacity or asset base of the Partnership Group existing immediately prior to such addition, improvement, acquisition or construction.
      “Capital Surplus” has the meaning assigned to such term in Section 6.2(a).
      “Cause” means a court of competent jurisdiction has entered a final, non-appealable judgment finding the General Partner liable for actual fraud or willful misconduct in its capacity as a general partner of the Partnership.

A-2


 

      “Certificate” means a certificate (i) substantially in the form of Exhibit A to this Agreement, (ii) issued in global or book entry form in accordance with the rules and regulations of the Depositary or (iii) in such other form as may be adopted by the General Partner, issued by the Partnership evidencing ownership of one or more Common Units or a certificate, in such form as may be adopted by the General Partner, issued by the Partnership evidencing ownership of one or more other Partnership Securities.
      “Certificate of Limited Partnership” means the Certificate of Limited Partnership of the Partnership filed with the Registrar of Corporations of The Marshall Islands as referenced in Section 7.2 as such Certificate of Limited Partnership may be amended, supplemented or restated from time to time.
      “claim” (as used in Section 7.12(c)) has the meaning assigned to such term in Section 7.12(c).
      “Closing Date” means the first date on which Common Units are sold by the Partnership to the Underwriters pursuant to the provisions of the Underwriting Agreement.
      “Closing Price” means, in respect of any class of Limited Partner Interests, as of the date of determination, the last sale price on such day, regular way, or in case no such sale takes place on such day, the average of the closing bid and asked prices on such day, regular way, as reported in the principal consolidated transaction reporting system with respect to securities listed on the principal National Securities Exchange on which the respective Limited Partner Interests are listed or admitted to trading or, if such Limited Partner Interests are not listed or admitted to trading on any National Securities Exchange, the last quoted price on such day or, if not so quoted, the average of the high bid and low asked prices on such day in the over-the -counter market, as reported by any quotation system then in use with respect to such Limited Partner Interests, or, if on any such day such Limited Partner Interests of such class are not quoted by any such system, the average of the closing bid and asked prices on such day as furnished by a professional market maker making a market in such Limited Partner Interests of such class selected by the General Partner, or if on any such day no market maker is making a market in such Limited Partner Interests of such class, the fair value of such Limited Partner Interests on such day as determined by the General Partner.
      “Code” means the United States Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended and in effect from time to time. Any reference herein to a specific section or sections of the Code shall be deemed to include a reference to any corresponding provision of any successor law.
      “Combined Interest” has the meaning assigned to such term in Section 11.3(a).
      “Commences Commercial Service” and “Commenced Commercial Service” shall mean the date a Capital Improvement is first put into service by a Group Member following, if applicable, completion of construction and testing.
      “Commission” means the United States Securities and Exchange Commission.
      “Common Unit” means a Partnership Security representing a fractional part of the Partnership Interests of all Limited Partners, and having the rights and obligations specified with respect to Common Units in this Agreement. The term “Common Unit” does not refer to a Subordinated Unit prior to its conversion into a Common Unit pursuant to the terms hereof.
      “Common Unit Arrearage” means, with respect to any Common Unit, whenever issued, as to any Quarter within the Subordination Period, the excess, if any, of (a) the Minimum Quarterly Distribution with respect to a Common Unit in respect of such Quarter over (b) the sum of all Available Cash distributed with respect to a Common Unit in respect of such Quarter pursuant to Section 6.3(a)(i).
      “Conflicts Committee” means a committee of the Board of Directors of the General Partner composed entirely of two or more directors who are not (a) security holders, officers or employees of the General Partner, (b) officers, directors or employees of any Affiliate of the General Partner or (c) holders of any ownership interest in the Partnership Group other than Common Units and who also meet the independence standards required of directors who serve on an audit committee of a board of directors established by the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, and the rules and regulations of the

A-3


 

Commission thereunder and by the National Securities Exchange on which the Common Units are listed or admitted to trading.
      “Contributed Property” means each property or other asset, in such form as may be permitted by the Marshall Islands Act, but excluding cash, contributed to the Partnership.
      “Contribution Agreement” means that certain Contribution, Conveyance and Assumption Agreement, dated as of the Closing Date, among the General Partner, the Partnership, the Operating Company, Teekay Shipping Corporation and the other parties named therein, together with the additional conveyance documents and instruments contemplated or referenced thereunder.
      “Cumulative Common Unit Arrearage” means, with respect to any Common Unit, whenever issued, and as of the end of any Quarter, the excess, if any, of (a) the sum resulting from adding together the Common Unit Arrearage as to an Initial Common Unit for each of the Quarters within the Subordination Period ending on or before the last day of such Quarter over (b) the sum of any distributions theretofore made pursuant to Section 6.3(a)(ii) and the second sentence of Section 6.4 with respect to an Initial Common Unit (including any distributions to be made in respect of the last of such Quarters).
      “Current Market Price” means, in respect of any class of Limited Partner Interests, as of the date of determination, the average of the daily Closing Prices per Limited Partner Interest of such class for the 20 consecutive Trading Days immediately prior to such date.
      “Departing General Partner” means a former General Partner from and after the effective date of any withdrawal or removal of such former General Partner pursuant to Section 11.1 or 11.2.
      “Depositary” means, with respect to any Units issued in global form, The Depository Trust Company and its successors and permitted assigns.
      “Estimated Maintenance Capital Expenditures” means an estimate made in good faith by the Board of Directors of the General Partner (with the concurrence of the Conflicts Committee) of the average quarterly Maintenance Capital Expenditures that the Partnership will need to incur to maintain the operating capacity or asset base of the Partnership Group (including the Partnership’s proportionate share of the average quarterly Maintenance Capital Expenditures of its Subsidiaries that are not wholly owned), existing at the time the estimate is made. The Board of Directors of the General Partner (with the concurrence of the Conflicts Committee) will be permitted to make such estimate in any manner it determines reasonable. The estimate will be made at least annually and whenever an event occurs that is likely to result in a material adjustment to the amount of Maintenance Capital Expenditures on a long-term basis. The Partnership shall disclose to its Partners any change in the amount of Estimated Maintenance Capital Expenditures in its reports made in accordance with Section 8.3 to the extent not previously disclosed. Except as provided in the definition of Subordination Period, any adjustments to Estimated Maintenance Capital Expenditures shall be prospective only.
      “Event of Withdrawal” has the meaning assigned to such term in Section 11.1(a).
      “Expansion Capital Expenditures” means cash expenditures for Acquisitions or Capital Improvements. Expansion Capital Expenditures shall not include Maintenance Capital Expenditures. Expansion Capital Expenditures shall include interest (and related fees) on debt incurred and distributions on equity incurred, in each case, to finance the construction of a Capital Improvement and paid during the period beginning on the date that the Partnership enters into a binding obligation to commence construction of the Capital Improvement and ending on the earlier to occur of the date that such Capital Improvement Commences Commercial Service or the date that such Capital Improvement is abandoned or disposed of. Debt incurred or equity issued to fund any such construction period interest payments, or such construction period distributions on equity paid during such period shall also be deemed to be debt or equity, as the case may be, incurred to finance the construction of a Capital Improvement.
      “First Target Distribution” means $0.4025 per Unit per Quarter (or, with respect to the period commencing on the Closing Date and ending on December 31, 2006, it means the product of $0.4025 multiplied by a fraction of which the numerator is the number of days in such period, and of which the

A-4


 

denominator is the total number of days in the Quarter in which the Closing Date occurs), subject to adjustment in accordance with Section 6.5.
      “Fully Diluted Basis” means, when calculating the number of Outstanding Units for any period, a basis that includes, in addition to the Outstanding Units, all Partnership Securities and options, rights, warrants and appreciation rights relating to an equity interest in the Partnership (a) that are convertible into or exercisable or exchangeable for Units that are senior to or pari passu with the Subordinated Units, (b) whose conversion, exercise or exchange price is less than the Current Market Price on the date of such calculation, (c) that may be converted into or exercised or exchanged for such Units prior to or during the Quarter immediately following the end of the period for which the calculation is being made without the satisfaction of any contingency beyond the control of the holder other than the payment of consideration and the compliance with administrative mechanics applicable to such conversion, exercise or exchange and (d) that were not converted into or exercised or exchanged for such Units during the period for which the calculation is being made; provided, however, that for purposes of determining the number of Outstanding Units on a Fully Diluted Basis when calculating whether the Subordination Period has ended or Subordinated Units are entitled to convert into Common Units pursuant to Section 5.7, such Partnership Securities, options, rights, warrants and appreciation rights shall be deemed to have been Outstanding Units only for the four Quarters that comprise the last four Quarters of the measurement period; and, provided further, that if consideration will be paid to any Group Member in connection with such conversion, exercise or exchange, the number of Units to be included in such calculation shall be that number equal to the difference between (i) the number of Units issuable upon such conversion, exercise or exchange and (ii) the number of Units that such consideration would purchase at the Current Market Price.
      “General Partner” means Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C., a Marshall Islands limited liability company, and its successors and permitted assigns that are admitted to the Partnership as general partner of the Partnership, in its capacity as general partner of the Partnership (except as the context otherwise requires).
      “General Partner Interest” means the ownership interest of the General Partner in the Partnership (in its capacity as a general partner and without reference to any Limited Partner Interest held by it) which is evidenced by General Partner Units, and includes any and all benefits to which the General Partner is entitled as provided in this Agreement, together with all obligations of the General Partner to comply with the terms and provisions of this Agreement.
      “General Partner Unit” means a fractional part of the General Partner Interest having the rights and obligations specified with respect to the General Partner Interest. A General Partner Unit is not a Unit.
      “Group” means a Person that with or through any of its Affiliates or Associates has any agreement, arrangement, understanding or relationship for the purpose of acquiring, holding, voting (except voting pursuant to a revocable proxy or consent given to such Person in response to a proxy or consent solicitation made to 10 or more Persons) or disposing of any Partnership Securities with any other Person that beneficially owns, or whose Affiliates or Associates beneficially own, directly or indirectly, Partnership Securities.
      “Group Member” means a member of the Partnership Group.
      “Group Member Agreement” means the partnership agreement of any Group Member, other than the Partnership, that is a limited or general partnership, the limited liability company agreement of any Group Member that is a limited liability company, the certificate of incorporation and bylaws (or similar organizational documents) of any Group Member that is a corporation, the joint venture agreement or similar governing document of any Group Member that is a joint venture and the governing or organizational or similar documents of any other Group Member that is a Person other than a limited or general partnership, limited liability company, corporation or joint venture, in each case as such may be amended, supplemented or restated from time to time.
      “Holder” as used in Section 7.12, has the meaning assigned to such term in Section 7.12(a).

A-5


 

      “Incentive Distribution Right” means a non-voting Limited Partner Interest issued to the General Partner, which Partnership Interest will confer upon the holder thereof only the rights and obligations specifically provided in this Agreement with respect to Incentive Distribution Rights (and no other rights otherwise available to or other obligations of a holder of a Partnership Interest). Notwithstanding anything in this Agreement to the contrary, the holder of an Incentive Distribution Right shall not be entitled to vote such Incentive Distribution Right on any Partnership matter except as may otherwise be required by law.
      “Incentive Distributions” means any amount of cash distributed to the holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights pursuant to Sections 6.3(a)(v), (vi) and (vii) and 6.3(b)(iii), (iv) and (v).
      “Indemnified Persons” has the meaning assigned to such term in Section 7.12(c).
      “Indemnitee” means (a) the General Partner, (b) any Departing General Partner, (c) any Person who is or was an Affiliate of the General Partner or any Departing General Partner, (d) any Person who is or was a member, partner, director, officer, fiduciary or trustee of any Person which any of the preceding clauses of this definition describes, (e) any Person who is or was serving at the request of the General Partner or any Departing General Partner or any Affiliate of the General Partner or any Departing General Partner as an officer, director, member, partner, fiduciary or trustee of another Person ( provided, however, that a Person shall not be an Indemnitee by reason of providing, on a fee-for-services basis, trustee, fiduciary or custodial services), and (f) any other Person the General Partner designates as an “Indemnitee” for purposes of this Agreement.
      “Initial Common Units” means the Common Units sold in the Initial Offering.
      “Initial Limited Partners” means Teekay Shipping Corporation and the General Partner (with respect to the Incentive Distribution Rights received by it pursuant to Section 5.1(b)), and the Underwriters, in each case upon being admitted to the Partnership in accordance with Section 10.1.
      “Initial Offering” means the initial offering and sale of Common Units to the public, as described in the Registration Statement.
      “Initial Unit Price” means (a) with respect to the Common Units and the Subordinated Units, the initial public offering price per Common Unit at which the Underwriters offered the Common Units to the public for sale as set forth on the cover page of the prospectus included as part of the Registration Statement and first issued at or after the time the Registration Statement first became effective or (b) with respect to any other class or series of Units, the price per Unit at which such class or series of Units is initially sold by the Partnership, as determined by the General Partner, in each case adjusted as the General Partner determines to be appropriate to give effect to any distribution, subdivision or combination of Units.
      “Interim Capital Transactions” means the following transactions if they occur prior to the Liquidation Date: (a) borrowings, refinancings or refundings of indebtedness (other than Working Capital Borrowings and other than for items purchased on open account in the ordinary course of business) by any Group Member and sales of debt securities of any Group Member; (b) sales of equity interests of any Group Member (including the Common Units sold to the Underwriters pursuant to the exercise of the Over-Allotment Option); (c) sales or other voluntary or involuntary dispositions of any assets of any Group Member other than (i) sales or other dispositions of inventory, accounts receivable and other assets in the ordinary course of business and (ii) sales or other dispositions of assets as part of normal retirements or replacements; (d) the termination of interest rate swap agreements; (e) capital contributions received; and (f) corporate reorganizations or restructurings.
      “Investment Capital Expenditures” means capital expenditures other than Maintenance Capital Expenditures or Expansion Capital Expenditures.
      “Issue Price” means the price at which a Unit is purchased from the Partnership, after reflecting any sales commission or underwriting discount charged to the Partnership.

A-6


 

      “Limited Partner” means, unless the context otherwise requires, the Organizational Limited Partner prior to its withdrawal from the Partnership, each Initial Limited Partner, each additional Person that becomes a Limited Partner pursuant to the terms of this Agreement and any Departing General Partner upon the change of its status from General Partner to Limited Partner pursuant to Section 11.3, in each case, in such Person’s capacity as a limited partner of the Partnership; provided, however , that when the term “Limited Partner” is used herein in the context of any vote or other approval, including Articles XIII and XIV, such term shall not, solely for such purpose, include any holder of an Incentive Distribution Right (solely with respect to its Incentive Distribution Rights and not with respect to any other Limited Partner Interest held by such Person) except as may otherwise be required by law. Limited Partners may include custodians, nominees or any other individual or entity in its own or any representative capacity.
      “Limited Partner Interest” means the ownership interest of a Limited Partner in the Partnership, which may be evidenced by Common Units, Subordinated Units, Incentive Distribution Rights or other Partnership Securities or a combination thereof or interest therein, and includes any and all benefits to which such Limited Partner is entitled as provided in this Agreement, together with all obligations of such Limited Partner to comply with the terms and provisions of this Agreement; provided, however , that when the term “Limited Partner Interest” is used herein in the context of any vote or other approval, including Articles XIII and XIV, such term shall not, solely for such purpose, include any Incentive Distribution Right except as may otherwise be required by law.
      “Liquidation Date” means (a) in the case of an event giving rise to the dissolution of the Partnership of the type described in clauses (a) and (b) of the first sentence of Section 12.2, the date on which the applicable time period during which the holders of Outstanding Units have the right to elect to continue the business of the Partnership has expired without such an election being made, and (b) in the case of any other event giving rise to the dissolution of the Partnership, the date on which such event occurs.
      “Liquidator” means one or more Persons selected by the General Partner to perform the functions described in Section 12.4.
      “Maintenance Capital Expenditures” means cash expenditures (including expenditures for the addition or improvement to the capital assets owned by any Group Member or for the acquisition of existing, or the construction of new, capital assets) if such expenditure is made to maintain the operating capacity or asset base of the Partnership Group. Maintenance Capital Expenditures shall not include (a) Expansion Capital Expenditures or (b) expenditures made solely for investment purposes (as opposed to maintenance purposes). Maintenance Capital Expenditures shall include interest (and related fees) on debt incurred and distributions on equity incurred, in each case, to finance the construction of a replacement asset and paid during the period beginning on the date that the Group Member enters into a binding obligation to commence constructing a replacement asset and ending on the earlier to occur of the date that such replacement asset Commences Commercial Service or the date that such replacement asset is abandoned or disposed of. Debt incurred to pay or equity issued to fund the construction period interest payments, or such construction period distributions on equity shall also be deemed to be debt or equity, as the case may be, incurred to finance the construction of a replacement asset.
      “Marshall Islands Act” means the Limited Partnership Act of The Republic of the Marshall Islands, as amended, supplemented or restated from time to time, and any successor to such statute.
      “Merger Agreement” has the meaning assigned to such term in Section 14.1.
      “Minimum Quarterly Distribution” means $0.35 per Unit per Quarter (or with respect to the period commencing on the Closing Date and ending on December 31, 2006, it means the product of $0.35 multiplied by a fraction of which the numerator is the number of days in such period and of which the denominator is the total number of days in the Quarter in which the Closing Date occurs), subject to adjustment in accordance with Sections 6.5.
      “National Securities Exchange” means an exchange registered with the Commission under Section 6(a) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, supplemented or restated from time to time, and any successor to such statute.

A-7


 

      “Net Agreed Value” means, (a) in the case of any Contributed Property, the Agreed Value of such property reduced by any liabilities either assumed by the Partnership upon such contribution or to which such property is subject when contributed, and (b) in the case of any property distributed to a Partner by the Partnership, the Agreed Value of such property, reduced by any indebtedness either assumed by such Partner upon such distribution or to which such property is subject at the time of distribution.
      “Notice of Election to Purchase” has the meaning assigned to such term in Section 15.1(b).
      “Operating Company” means Teekay Offshore Operating L.P., a Marshall Islands limited partnership, and any successors thereto.
      “Operating Company Agreement” means the First Amended and Restated Agreement of Limited Partnership of the Operating Company, as it may be amended, supplemented or restated from time to time.
      “Operating Expenditures” means all Partnership Group expenditures (or the Partnership’s proportionate share of expenditures in the case of Subsidiaries that are not wholly owned), including taxes, reimbursements of the General Partner, repayment of Working Capital Borrowings, debt service payments and capital expenditures, subject to the following:
        (a) repayment of Working Capital Borrowings deducted from Operating Surplus pursuant to clause (b)(iii) of the definition of Operating Surplus shall not constitute Operating Expenditures when actually repaid;
 
        (b) payments (including prepayments and prepayment penalties) of principal of and premium on indebtedness other than Working Capital Borrowings shall not constitute Operating Expenditures; and
 
        (c) Operating Expenditures shall not include (i) Expansion Capital Expenditures, Investment Capital Expenditures or actual Maintenance Capital Expenditures, but shall include Estimated Maintenance Capital Expenditures, (ii) payment of transaction expenses (including taxes) relating to Interim Capital Transactions or (iii) distributions to Partners.
 
        Where capital expenditures consist of both (x) Maintenance Capital Expenditures and (y) Expansion Capital Expenditures and/or Investment Capital Expenditures, the General Partner, with the concurrence of the Conflicts Committee, shall determine the allocation between the amounts paid for each.
      “Operating Surplus” means, with respect to any period ending prior to the Liquidation Date, on a cumulative basis and without duplication:
        (a) the sum of (i) $15 million, (ii) all cash receipts of the Partnership Group (or the Partnership’s proportionate share of cash receipts in the case of Subsidiaries that are not wholly owned) for the period beginning on the Closing Date and ending on the last day of such period, other than cash receipts from Interim Capital Transactions, (iii) all cash receipts of the Partnership Group (or the Partnership’s proportionate share of cash receipts in the case of Subsidiaries that are not wholly owned) after the end of such period but on or before the date of determination of Operating Surplus with respect to such period resulting from Working Capital Borrowings and (iv) the amount of distributions paid on equity issued in connection with the construction of a Capital Improvement or replacement asset and paid during the period beginning on the date that the Group Member enters into a binding obligation to commence construction of such Capital Improvement or replacement asset and ending on the earlier to occur of the date that such Capital Improvement or replacement asset Commences Commercial Service or the date that it is abandoned or disposed of (equity issued to fund the construction period interest payments on debt incurred (including periodic net payments under related interest rate swap agreements), or construction period distributions on equity issued, to finance the construction of a Capital Improvement or replacement asset shall also be deemed to be equity issued to finance the construction of a Capital Improvement or replacement asset for purposes of this clause (iv)), less

A-8


 

        (b) the sum of (i) Operating Expenditures for the period beginning on the Closing Date and ending on the last day of such period, (ii) the amount of cash reserves (or the Partnership’s proportionate share of cash reserves in the case of Subsidiaries that are not wholly owned) established by the General Partner to provide funds for future Operating Expenditures and (iii) all Working Capital Borrowings not repaid within twelve months after having been incurred; provided, however , that disbursements made (including contributions to a Group Member or disbursements on behalf of a Group Member) or cash reserves established, increased or reduced after the end of such period but on or before the date of determination of Available Cash with respect to such period shall be deemed to have been made, established, increased or reduced, for purposes of determining Operating Surplus, within such period if the General Partner so determines.
      Notwithstanding the foregoing, “Operating Surplus” with respect to the Quarter in which the Liquidation Date occurs and any subsequent Quarter shall equal zero.
      “Opinion of Counsel” means a written opinion of counsel (who may be regular counsel to the Partnership or the General Partner or any of its Affiliates) acceptable to the General Partner.
      “Option Closing Date” means the date or dates on which any Common Units are sold by the Partnership to the Underwriters upon exercise of the Over-Allotment Option.
      “Organizational Limited Partner” means Teekay Shipping Corporation in its capacity as the organizational limited partner of the Partnership pursuant to this Agreement.
      “Outstanding” means, with respect to Partnership Securities, all Partnership Securities that are issued by the Partnership and reflected as outstanding on the Partnership’s books and records as of the date of determination; provided, however , that if at any time any Person or Group (other than the General Partner or its Affiliates) beneficially owns 20% or more of the Outstanding Partnership Securities of any class then Outstanding, all Partnership Securities owned by such Person or Group shall not be voted on any matter and shall not be considered to be Outstanding when sending notices of a meeting of Limited Partners to vote on any matter (unless otherwise required by law), calculating required votes, determining the presence of a quorum or for other similar purposes under this Agreement, except that Partnership Securities so owned shall be considered to be Outstanding for purposes of Section 11.1(b)(iv) (such Partnership Securities shall not, however, be treated as a separate class of Partnership Securities for purposes of this Agreement); provided, further , that the foregoing limitation shall not apply to (i) any Person or Group who acquired 20% or more of the Outstanding Partnership Securities of any class then Outstanding directly from the General Partner or its Affiliates, (ii) any Person or Group who acquired 20% or more of any Outstanding Partnership Securities of any class then Outstanding directly or indirectly from a Person or Group described in clause (i) provided that the General Partner shall have notified such Person or Group in writing that such limitation shall not apply, or (iii) any Person or Group who acquired 20% or more of any Partnership Securities issued by the Partnership with the prior approval of the Board of Directors of the General Partner.
      “Over-Allotment Option” means the over-allotment option granted to the Underwriters by the Partnership pursuant to the Underwriting Agreement.
      “Partners” means the General Partner and the Limited Partners.
      “Partnership” means Teekay Offshore Partners L.P., a Marshall Islands limited partnership, and any successors thereto.
      “Partnership Group” means the Partnership and its Subsidiaries, including the Operating Company, treated as a single entity.
      “Partnership Interest” means an interest in the Partnership, which shall include the General Partner Interest and Limited Partner Interests.

A-9


 

      “Partnership Security” means any class or series of equity interest in the Partnership (but excluding any options, rights, warrants and appreciation rights relating to an equity interest in the Partnership), including Common Units, Subordinated Units and Incentive Distribution Rights.
      “Percentage Interest” means as of any date of determination (a) as to the General Partner with respect to General Partner Units and as to any Unitholder with respect to Units, the product obtained by multiplying (i) 100% less the percentage applicable to clause (b) below by (ii) the quotient obtained by dividing (A) the number of Units held by such Unitholder or the number of General Partner Units held by the General Partner, as the case may be, by (B) the total number of all Outstanding Units and General Partner Units, and (b) as to the holders of other Partnership Securities issued by the Partnership in accordance with Section 5.5, the percentage established as a part of such issuance. The Percentage Interest with respect to an Incentive Distribution Right shall at all times be zero.
      “Person” means an individual or a corporation, firm, limited liability company, partnership, joint venture, trust, unincorporated organization, association, governmental agency or political subdivision thereof or other entity.
      “Pro Rata” means (a) when used with respect to Units or any class thereof, apportioned equally among all designated Units in accordance with their relative Percentage Interests, (b) when used with respect to Partners or Record Holders, apportioned among all Partners or Record Holders in accordance with their relative Percentage Interests and (c) when used with respect to holders of Incentive Distribution Rights, apportioned equally among all holders of Incentive Distribution Rights in accordance with the relative number or percentage of Incentive Distribution Rights held by each such holder.
      “Purchase Date” means the date determined by the General Partner as the date for purchase of all Outstanding Limited Partner Interests of a certain class (other than Limited Partner Interests owned by the General Partner and its Affiliates) pursuant to Article XV.
      “Quarter” means, unless the context requires otherwise, a fiscal quarter, or, with respect to the first fiscal quarter including the Closing Date, the portion of such fiscal quarter after the Closing Date, of the Partnership.
      “Record Date” means the date established by the General Partner or otherwise in accordance with this Agreement for determining (a) the identity of the Record Holders entitled to notice of, or to vote at, any meeting of Limited Partners or entitled to vote by ballot or give approval of Partnership action in writing without a meeting or entitled to exercise rights in respect of any lawful action of Limited Partners or (b) the identity of Record Holders entitled to receive any report or distribution or to participate in any offer.
      “Record Holder” means (a) the Person in whose name a Common Unit is registered on the books of the Transfer Agent as of the opening of business on a particular Business Day, or (b) with respect to other Partnership Interests, the Person in whose name any such other Partnership Interest is registered on the books that the General Partner has caused to be kept as of the opening of business on such Business Day.
      “Registrar” means the Registrar of Corporations as defined in Section 4 of the Marshall Islands Business Corporation Act.
      “Registration Statement” means the Registration Statement on Form  F-1 (Registration No.  333-                     ) as it has been or as it may be amended or supplemented from time to time, filed by the Partnership with the Commission under the Securities Act to register the offering and sale of the Common Units in the Initial Offering.
      “Second Target Distribution” means $0.4375 per Unit per Quarter (or, with respect to the period commencing on the Closing Date and ending on December 31, 2006, it means the product of $0.4375 multiplied by a fraction of which the numerator is equal to the number of days in such period and of which the denominator is the total number of days in the Quarter in which the Closing Date occurs), subject to adjustment in accordance with Section 6.5.

A-10


 

      “Securities Act” means the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, supplemented or restated from time to time and any successor to such statute.
      “Special Approval” means approval by a majority of the members of the Conflicts Committee.
      “Subordination Period” means the period commencing on the Closing Date and ending on the first to occur of the following dates:
        (a) the first day of any Quarter beginning after December 31, 2009, in respect of which (i)(A) distributions of Available Cash from Operating Surplus on each of the Outstanding Common Units, Subordinated Units, General Partner Units and any other Outstanding Units that are senior or equal in right of distribution to the Subordinated Units equaled or exceeded the Minimum Quarterly Distribution during each of the three consecutive, non-overlapping four-Quarter periods immediately preceding such date and (B) the Adjusted Operating Surplus for each of the three consecutive, non-overlapping four-Quarter periods immediately preceding such date equaled or exceeded the sum of the Minimum Quarterly Distribution on all of the Common Units, Subordinated Units, General Partner Units and any other Units that are senior or equal in right of distribution to the Subordinated Units that were Outstanding during such periods on a Fully Diluted Basis with respect to each such period and (ii) there are no Cumulative Common Unit Arrearages; and
 
        (b) the date on which the General Partner is removed as general partner of the Partnership upon the requisite vote by holders of Outstanding Units under circumstances where Cause does not exist and no Units held by the General Partner and its Affiliates are voted in favor of such removal.
      For purposes of determining whether the test in subclause (a)(i)(B) above has been satisfied, Adjusted Operating Surplus will be adjusted upwards or downwards if the Conflicts Committee determines in good faith that the amount of Estimated Maintenance Capital Expenditures used in the determination of Adjusted Operating Surplus in subclause (a)(i)(B) was materially incorrect, based on circumstances prevailing at the time of original determination of Estimated Maintenance Capital Expenditures, for any one or more of the preceding three four-Quarter periods.
      “Subordinated Unit” means a Unit representing a fractional part of the Partnership Interests of all Limited Partners and having the rights and obligations specified with respect to Subordinated Units in this Agreement. The term “Subordinated Unit” does not include a Common Unit. A Subordinated Unit that is convertible into a Common Unit shall not constitute a Common Unit until such conversion occurs.
      “Subsidiary” means, with respect to any Person, (a) a corporation of which more than 50% of the voting power of shares entitled (without regard to the occurrence of any contingency) to vote in the election of directors or other governing body of such corporation is owned, directly or indirectly, at the date of determination, by such Person, by one or more Subsidiaries (as defined, but excluding subsection (d) of this definition) of such Person or a combination thereof, (b) a partnership (whether general or limited) in which such Person or a Subsidiary (as defined, but excluding subsection (d) of this definition) of such Person is, at the date of determination, a general or limited partner of such partnership, but only if more than 50% of the partnership interests of such partnership (considering all of the partnership interests of the partnership as a single class) is owned, directly or indirectly, at the date of determination, by such Person, by one or more Subsidiaries (as defined, but excluding subsection (d) of this definition) of such Person, or a combination thereof, (c) any other Person (other than a corporation or a partnership) in which such Person, one or more Subsidiaries (as defined, but excluding subsection (d) of this definition) of such Person, or a combination thereof, directly or indirectly, at the date of determination, has (i) at least a majority ownership interest or (ii) the power to elect or direct the election of a majority of the directors or other governing body of such Person, or (d) any other Person in which such Person, one or more Subsidiaries (as defined, but excluding subsection (d) of this definition) of such Person, or a combination thereof, directly or indirectly, at the date of determination, has (i) less than a majority ownership interest or (ii) less than the power to elect or direct the election of a majority of the directors or other governing body of such Person, provided that (A) such Person, one or more Subsidiaries (as defined, but excluding this subsection (d) of this definition) of such Person, or a

A-11


 

combination thereof, directly or indirectly, at the date of the determination, has at least a 20% ownership interest in such other Person, (B) such Person accounts for such other Person (under U.S. GAAP, as in effect on the later of the date of investment in such other Person or material expansion of the operations of such other Person) on a consolidated or equity accounting basis, (C) such Person has directly or indirectly material negative control rights regarding such other Person including over such other Person’s ability to materially expand its operations beyond that contemplated at the date of investment in such other Person, and (D) such other Person is (i) other than with respect to the Operating Company, formed and maintained for the sole purpose of owning or leasing, operating and chartering no more than 10 vessels for a period of no more than 40 years, and (ii) obligated under its constituent documents, or as a result of a unanimous agreement of its owners, to distribute to its owners all of its income on at least an annual basis (less any cash reserves that are approved by such Person).
      “Surviving Business Entity” has the meaning assigned to such term in Section 14.2(b).
      “Third Target Distribution” means $0.525 per unit per Quarter (or, with respect to the period commencing on the Closing Date and ending on December 31, 2006, it means the product of $0.525 multiplied by a fraction of which the numerator is equal to the number of days in such period and of which the denominator is the total number of days in the Quarter in which the Closing Date occurs), subject to adjustment in accordance with Section 6.5.
      “Trading Day” means, for the purpose of determining the Current Market Price of any class of Limited Partner Interests, a day on which the principal National Securities Exchange on which such class of Limited Partner Interests is listed is open for the transaction of business or, if Limited Partner Interests of a class are not listed on any National Securities Exchange, a day on which banking institutions in New York City generally are open.
      “transfer” has the meaning assigned to such term in Section 4.4(a).
      “Transfer Agent” means such bank, trust company or other Person (including the General Partner or one of its Affiliates) as shall be appointed from time to time by the Partnership to act as registrar and transfer agent for the Common Units; provided, however , that if no Transfer Agent is specifically designated for any other Partnership Securities, the General Partner shall act in such capacity.
      “Underwriter” means each Person named as an underwriter in Schedule I to the Underwriting Agreement who purchases Common Units pursuant thereto.
      “Underwriting Agreement” means the Underwriting Agreement dated                     , 2006 among the Underwriters, the Partnership, the General Partner, the Operating Company, and Teekay Shipping Corporation, providing for the purchase of Common Units by such Underwriters.
      “Unit” means a Partnership Security that is designated as a “Unit” and shall include Common Units and Subordinated Units but shall not include (i) General Partner Units (or the General Partner Interest represented thereby) or (ii) the Incentive Distribution Rights.
      “Unitholders” means the holders of Units.
      “Unit Majority” means, during the Subordination Period, at least a majority of the Outstanding Common Units (excluding Common Units owned by the General Partner and its Affiliates) voting as a class and at least a majority of the Outstanding Subordinated Units voting as a class, and after the end of the Subordination Period, at least a majority of the Outstanding Common Units.
      “Unit Register” means the register of the Partnership for the registration and transfer of Limited Partnership Interests as provided in Section 4.5.
      “Unrecovered Capital” means at any time, with respect to a Unit, the Initial Unit Price less the sum of all distributions constituting Capital Surplus theretofore made in respect of an Initial Common Unit and any distributions of cash (or the Net Agreed Value of any distributions in kind) in connection with the dissolution and liquidation of the Partnership theretofore made in respect of an Initial Common Unit,

A-12


 

adjusted as the General Partner determines to be appropriate to give effect to any distribution, subdivision or combination of such Units.
      “U.S. GAAP” means United States generally accepted accounting principles consistently applied.
      “Withdrawal Opinion of Counsel” has the meaning assigned to such term in Section 11.1(b).
      “Working Capital Borrowings” means borrowings used solely for working capital purposes or to pay distributions to Partners made pursuant to a credit facility, commercial paper facility or similar financing arrangement available to a Group Member, provided that when such borrowing is incurred it is the intent of the borrower to repay such borrowing within 12 months from other than additional Working Capital Borrowings.
      Section  1.2      Construction.
      Unless the context requires otherwise: (a) any pronoun used in this Agreement shall include the corresponding masculine, feminine or neuter forms, and the singular form of nouns, pronouns and verbs shall include the plural and vice versa; (b) references to Articles and Sections refer to Articles and Sections of this Agreement; (c) the term “include” or “includes” means includes, without limitation, and “including” means including, without limitation; and (d) the terms “hereof”, “herein” and “hereunder” refer to this Agreement as a whole and not to any particular provision of this Agreement. The table of contents and headings contained in this Agreement are for reference purposes only, and shall not affect in any way the meaning or interpretation of this Agreement.
ARTICLE II
ORGANIZATION
      Section  2.1      Formation.
      The General Partner and the Organizational Limited Partner have previously formed the Partnership as a limited partnership pursuant to the provisions of the Marshall Islands Act and hereby amend and restate the original Agreement of Limited Partnership of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. in its entirety. This amendment and restatement shall become effective on the date of this Agreement. Except as expressly provided to the contrary in this Agreement, the rights, duties (including fiduciary duties), liabilities and obligations of the Partners and the administration, dissolution and termination of the Partnership shall be governed by the Marshall Islands Act. All Partnership Interests shall constitute personal property of the owner thereof for all purposes and a Partner has no interest in specific Partnership property.
      Section  2.2      Name.
      The name of the Partnership shall be “Teekay Offshore Partners L.P.” The Partnership’s business may be conducted under any other name or names as determined by the General Partner, including the name of the General Partner. The words “Limited Partnership” or the letters “L.P.” or similar words or letters shall be included in the Partnership’s name where necessary for the purpose of complying with the laws of any jurisdiction that so requires. The General Partner may change the name of the Partnership at any time and from time to time and shall notify the Limited Partners of such change in the next regular communication to the Limited Partners.
      Section  2.3      Registered Office; Registered Agent; Principal Office; Other Offices.
      Unless and until changed by the General Partner, the registered office of the Partnership in The Marshall Islands shall be located at Trust Company Complex, Ajeltake Island, Ajeltake Road, Majuro, Marshall Islands MH 96960, and the registered agent for service of process on the Partnership in The Marshall Islands at such registered office shall be The Trust Company of The Marshall Islands, Inc. The principal office of the Partnership shall be located at Bayside House, Bayside Executive Park, West Bay Street and Blake Road, P.O. Box AP-59212, Nassau, Commonwealth of the Bahamas or such other place

A-13


 

as the General Partner may from time to time designate by notice to the Limited Partners. The Partnership may maintain offices at such other place or places within or outside The Marshall Islands as the General Partner determines to be necessary or appropriate. The address of the General Partner shall be Bayside House, Bayside Executive Park, West Bay Street and Blake Road, P.O. Box AP-59212, Nassau, Commonwealth of the Bahamas or such other place as the General Partner may from time to time designate by notice to the Limited Partners.
      Section  2.4      Purpose and Business.
      The purpose and nature of the business to be conducted by the Partnership shall be to (a) engage directly in, or enter into or form any corporation, partnership, joint venture, limited liability company or other arrangement to engage indirectly in, any business activity that is approved by the General Partner and that lawfully may be conducted by a limited partnership organized pursuant to the Marshall Islands Act and, in connection therewith, to exercise all of the rights and powers conferred upon the Partnership pursuant to the agreements relating to such business activity, and (b) do anything necessary or appropriate to the foregoing, including the making of capital contributions or loans to a Group Member. The General Partner shall have no duty or obligation to propose or approve, and may decline to propose or approve, the conduct by the Partnership of any business free of any fiduciary duty or obligation whatsoever to the Partnership, any Limited Partner and, in declining to so propose or approve, shall not be required to act in good faith or pursuant to any other standard imposed by this Agreement, any Group Member Agreement, any other agreement contemplated hereby or under the Marshall Islands Act or any other law, rule or regulation.
      Section  2.5      Powers.
      The Partnership shall be empowered to do any and all acts and things necessary and appropriate for the furtherance and accomplishment of the purposes and business described in Section 2.4 and for the protection and benefit of the Partnership.
      Section  2.6      Power of Attorney.
      (a) Each Limited Partner hereby constitutes and appoints the General Partner and, if a Liquidator shall have been selected pursuant to Section 12.3, the Liquidator (and any successor to the Liquidator by merger, transfer, assignment, election or otherwise) and each of their authorized officers and attorneys-in -fact, as the case may be, with full power of substitution, as his true and lawful agent and attorney-in -fact, with full power and authority in his name, place and stead, to:
        (i) execute, swear to, acknowledge, deliver, file and record in the appropriate public offices (A) all certificates, documents and other instruments (including this Agreement and the Certificate of Limited Partnership and all amendments or restatements hereof or thereof) that the General Partner or the Liquidator determines to be necessary or appropriate to form, qualify or continue the existence or qualification of the Partnership as a limited partnership (or a partnership in which the limited partners have limited liability) in the Marshall Islands and in all other jurisdictions in which the Partnership may conduct business or own property; (B) all certificates, documents and other instruments that the General Partner or the Liquidator determines to be necessary or appropriate to reflect, in accordance with its terms, any amendment, change, modification or restatement of this Agreement; (C) all certificates, documents and other instruments (including conveyances and a certificate of cancellation) that the General Partner or the Liquidator determines to be necessary or appropriate to reflect the dissolution and liquidation of the Partnership pursuant to the terms of this Agreement; (D) all certificates, documents and other instruments relating to the admission, withdrawal, removal or substitution of any Partner pursuant to, or other events described in, Articles IV, X, XI or XII; (E) all certificates, documents and other instruments relating to the determination of the rights, preferences and privileges of any class or series of Partnership Securities issued pursuant to Section 5.5; and (F) all certificates, documents and other instruments (including agreements and a certificate of merger) relating to a merger, consolidation or conversion of the Partnership pursuant to Article XIV; and

A-14


 

        (ii) execute, swear to, acknowledge, deliver, file and record all ballots, consents, approvals, waivers, certificates, documents and other instruments that the General Partner or the Liquidator determines to be necessary or appropriate to (A) make, evidence, give, confirm or ratify any vote, consent, approval, agreement or other action that is made or given by the Partners hereunder or is consistent with the terms of this Agreement or (B) effectuate the terms or intent of this Agreement; provided, however , that when required by Section 13.3 or any other provision of this Agreement that establishes a percentage of the Limited Partners or of the Limited Partners of any class or series required to take any action, the General Partner and the Liquidator may exercise the power of attorney made in this Section 2.6(a)(ii) only after the necessary vote, consent or approval of the Limited Partners or of the Limited Partners of such class or series, as applicable.
Nothing contained in this Section 2.6(a) shall be construed as authorizing the General Partner to amend this Agreement except in accordance with Article XIII or as may be otherwise expressly provided for in this Agreement.
      (b) The foregoing power of attorney is hereby declared to be irrevocable and a power coupled with an interest, and it shall survive and, to the maximum extent permitted by law, not be affected by the subsequent death, incompetency, disability, incapacity, dissolution, bankruptcy or termination of any Limited Partner and the transfer of all or any portion of such Limited Partner’s Partnership Interest and shall extend to such Limited Partner’s heirs, successors, assigns and personal representatives. Each such Limited Partner hereby agrees to be bound by any representation made by the General Partner or the Liquidator acting in good faith pursuant to such power of attorney; and each such Limited Partner, to the maximum extent permitted by law, hereby waives any and all defenses that may be available to contest, negate or disaffirm the action of the General Partner or the Liquidator taken in good faith under such power of attorney. Each Limited Partner shall execute and deliver to the General Partner or the Liquidator, within 15 days after receipt of the request therefor, such further designation, powers of attorney and other instruments as the General Partner or the Liquidator determines to be necessary or appropriate to effectuate this Agreement and the purposes of the Partnership.
      Section  2.7      Term.
      The term of the Partnership commenced upon the filing of the Certificate of Limited Partnership in accordance with the Marshall Islands Act and shall continue in existence until the dissolution of the Partnership in accordance with the provisions of Article XII. The existence of the Partnership as a separate legal entity shall continue until the cancellation of the Certificate of Limited Partnership as provided in the Marshall Islands Act.
      Section  2.8      Title to Partnership Assets.
      Title to Partnership assets, whether real, personal or mixed and whether tangible or intangible, shall be deemed to be owned by the Partnership as an entity, and no Partner, individually or collectively, shall have any ownership interest in such Partnership assets or any portion thereof. Title to any or all of the Partnership assets may be held in the name of the Partnership, the General Partner, one or more of its Affiliates or one or more nominees, as the General Partner may determine. The General Partner hereby declares and warrants that any Partnership assets for which record title is held in the name of the General Partner or one or more of its Affiliates or one or more nominees shall be held by the General Partner or such Affiliate or nominee for the use and benefit of the Partnership in accordance with the provisions of this Agreement; provided, however , that the General Partner shall use commercially reasonable efforts to cause record title to such assets (other than those assets in respect of which the General Partner determines that the expense and difficulty of conveyancing makes transfer of record title to the Partnership impracticable) to be vested in the Partnership as soon as reasonably practicable; and, provided further , that, prior to the withdrawal or removal of the General Partner or as soon thereafter as practicable, the General Partner shall use reasonable efforts to effect the transfer of record title to the Partnership and, prior to any such transfer, will provide for the use of such assets in a manner satisfactory to the General Partner. All Partnership assets shall be recorded as the property of the Partnership in its books and records, irrespective of the name in which record title to such Partnership assets is held.

A-15


 

ARTICLE III
RIGHTS OF LIMITED PARTNERS
      Section  3.1      Limitation of Liability.
      The Limited Partners shall have no liability under this Agreement except as expressly provided in this Agreement or the Marshall Islands Act.
      Section  3.2      Management of Business.
      No Limited Partner, in its capacity as such, shall participate in the operation, management or control (within the meaning of the Marshall Islands Act) of the Partnership’s business, transact any business in the Partnership’s name or have the power to sign documents for or otherwise bind the Partnership. Any action taken by any Affiliate of the General Partner or any officer, director, employee, manager, member, general partner, agent or trustee of the General Partner or any of its Affiliates, or any officer, director, employee, manager, member, general partner, agent or trustee of a Group Member, in its capacity as such, shall not be deemed to be participation in the control of the business of the Partnership by a limited partner of the Partnership (within the meaning of Section 30 of the Marshall Islands Act) and shall not affect, impair or eliminate the limitations on the liability of the Limited Partners under this Agreement.
      Section  3.3      Outside Activities of the Limited Partners.
      Subject to the provisions of Section 7.5, which shall continue to be applicable to the Persons referred to therein, regardless of whether such Persons shall also be Limited Partners, any Limited Partner shall be entitled to and may have business interests and engage in business activities in addition to those relating to the Partnership, including business interests and activities in direct competition with the Partnership Group. Neither the Partnership nor any of the other Partners shall have any rights by virtue of this Agreement in any business ventures of any Limited Partner.
      Section  3.4      Rights of Limited Partners.
      (a) In addition to other rights provided by this Agreement or by applicable law, and except as limited by Section 3.4(b), each Limited Partner shall have the right, for a purpose reasonably related to such Limited Partner’s interest as a Limited Partner in the Partnership, upon reasonable written demand and at such Limited Partner’s own expense, to:
        (i) obtain, promptly after becoming available, a copy of the Partnership’s financial statements or income tax returns, if applicable, for each year;
 
        (ii) have furnished to him a current list of the name and last known business, residence or mailing address of each Partner;
 
        (iii) obtain true and full information regarding the amount of cash and a description and statement of the Net Agreed Value of any other Capital Contribution by each Partner and which each Partner has agreed to contribute in the future, and the date on which each became a Partner;
 
        (iv) have furnished to him a copy of this Agreement and the Certificate of Limited Partnership and all amendments thereto, together with a copy of the executed copies of all powers of attorney pursuant to which this Agreement, the Certificate of Limited Partnership and all amendments thereto have been executed;
 
        (v) obtain true and full information regarding the status of the business and financial condition of the Partnership Group; and
 
        (vi) obtain such other information regarding the affairs of the Partnership as is just and reasonable.
      (b) The General Partner may keep confidential from the Limited Partners, for such period of time as the General Partner deems reasonable, (i) any information that the General Partner reasonably believes to be in the nature of trade secrets or (ii) other information the disclosure of which the General Partner in

A-16


 

good faith believes (A) is not in the best interests of the Partnership Group, (B) could damage the Partnership Group or (C) that any Group Member is required by law or by agreement with any third party to keep confidential (other than agreements with Affiliates of the Partnership the primary purpose of which is to circumvent the obligations set forth in this Section 3.4).
ARTICLE IV
CERTIFICATES; RECORD HOLDERS; TRANSFER OF PARTNERSHIP INTERESTS
      Section  4.1      Certificates.
      Upon the Partnership’s issuance of Common Units or Subordinated Units to any Person, the Partnership shall issue, upon the request of such Person, one or more Certificates in the name of such Person evidencing the number of such Units being so issued. In addition, (a) upon the General Partner’s request, the Partnership shall issue to it one or more Certificates in the name of the General Partner evidencing its General Partner Units and (b) upon the request of any Person owning Incentive Distribution Rights or any other Partnership Securities other than Common Units or Subordinated Units, the Partnership shall issue to such Person one or more certificates evidencing such Incentive Distribution Rights or other Partnership Securities other than Common Units or Subordinated Units. Certificates shall be executed on behalf of the Partnership by the Chairman of the Board, President or any Executive Vice President or Vice President and the Chief Financial Officer or the Secretary or any Assistant Secretary of the General Partner. No Common Unit Certificate shall be valid for any purpose until it has been countersigned by the Transfer Agent; provided, however , that if the General Partner elects to issue Common Units in global form, the Common Unit Certificates shall be valid upon receipt of a certificate from the Transfer Agent certifying that the Common Units have been duly registered in accordance with the directions of the Partnership. Subject to the requirements of Section 6.6(b), the Partners holding Certificates evidencing Subordinated Units may exchange such Certificates for Certificates evidencing Common Units on or after the date on which such Subordinated Units are converted into Common Units pursuant to the terms of Section 5.7.
      Section  4.2      Mutilated, Destroyed, Lost or Stolen Certificates.
      (a) If any mutilated Certificate is surrendered to the Transfer Agent, the appropriate officers of the General Partner on behalf of the Partnership shall execute, and the Transfer Agent shall countersign and deliver in exchange therefor, a new Certificate evidencing the same number and type of Partnership Securities as the Certificate so surrendered.
      (b) The appropriate officers of the General Partner on behalf of the Partnership shall execute and deliver, and the Transfer Agent shall countersign, a new Certificate in place of any Certificate previously issued if the Record Holder of the Certificate:
        (i) makes proof by affidavit, in form and substance satisfactory to the General Partner, that a previously issued Certificate has been lost, destroyed or stolen;
 
        (ii) requests the issuance of a new Certificate before the General Partner has notice that the Certificate has been acquired by a purchaser for value in good faith and without notice of an adverse claim;
 
        (iii) if requested by the General Partner, delivers to the General Partner a bond, in form and substance satisfactory to the General Partner, with surety or sureties and with fixed or open penalty as the General Partner may direct to indemnify the Partnership, the Partners, the General Partner and the Transfer Agent against any claim that may be made on account of the alleged loss, destruction or theft of the Certificate; and
 
        (iv) satisfies any other reasonable requirements imposed by the General Partner.
      If a Limited Partner fails to notify the General Partner within a reasonable period of time after he has notice of the loss, destruction or theft of a Certificate, and a transfer of the Limited Partner Interests

A-17


 

represented by the Certificate is registered before the Partnership, the General Partner or the Transfer Agent receives such notification, the Limited Partner shall be precluded from making any claim against the Partnership, the General Partner or the Transfer Agent for such transfer or for a new Certificate.
      (c) As a condition to the issuance of any new Certificate under this Section 4.2, the General Partner may require the payment of a sum sufficient to cover any tax or other governmental charge that may be imposed in relation thereto and any other expenses (including the fees and expenses of the Transfer Agent) reasonably connected therewith.
      Section  4.3      Record Holders.
      The Partnership shall be entitled to recognize the Record Holder as the Partner with respect to any Partnership Interest and, accordingly, shall not be bound to recognize any equitable or other claim to, or interest in, such Partnership Interest on the part of any other Person, regardless of whether the Partnership shall have actual or other notice thereof, except as otherwise provided by law or any applicable rule, regulation, guideline or requirement of any National Securities Exchange on which such Partnership Interests are listed or admitted to trading. Without limiting the foregoing, when a Person (such as a broker, dealer, bank, trust company or clearing corporation or an agent of any of the foregoing) is acting as nominee, agent or in some other representative capacity for another Person in acquiring and/or holding Partnership Interests, as between the Partnership on the one hand, and such other Persons on the other, such representative Person shall be the Record Holder of such Partnership Interest.
      Section  4.4      Transfer Generally.
      (a) The term “transfer,” when used in this Agreement with respect to a Partnership Interest, shall be deemed to refer to a transaction (i) by which the General Partner assigns its General Partner Interest to another Person or by which a holder of Incentive Distribution Rights assigns its Incentive Distribution Rights to another Person, and includes a sale, assignment, gift, pledge, encumbrance, hypothecation, mortgage, exchange or any other disposition by law or otherwise or (ii) by which the holder of a Limited Partner Interest (other than an Incentive Distribution Right) assigns such Limited Partner Interest to another Person who is or becomes a Limited Partner, and includes a sale, assignment, gift, exchange or any other disposition by law or otherwise, including any transfer upon foreclosure of any pledge, encumbrance, hypothecation or mortgage.
      (b) No Partnership Interest shall be transferred, in whole or in part, except in accordance with the terms and conditions set forth in this Article IV. Any transfer or purported transfer of a Partnership Interest not made in accordance with this Article IV shall be null and void.
      (c) Nothing contained in this Agreement shall be construed to prevent a disposition by any stockholder, member, partner or other owner of the General Partner of any or all of the shares of stock, membership interests, partnership interests or other ownership interests in the General Partner.
      Section  4.5      Registration and Transfer of Limited Partner Interests.
      (a) The General Partner shall keep or cause to be kept on behalf of the Partnership a register in which, subject to such reasonable regulations as it may prescribe and subject to the provisions of Section 4.5(b), the Partnership will provide for the registration and transfer of Limited Partner Interests. The Transfer Agent is hereby appointed registrar and transfer agent for the purpose of registering Common Units and transfers of such Common Units as herein provided. The Partnership shall not recognize transfers of Certificates evidencing Limited Partner Interests unless such transfers are effected in the manner described in this Section 4.5. Upon surrender of a Certificate for registration of transfer of any Limited Partner Interests evidenced by a Certificate, and subject to the provisions of Section 4.5(b), the appropriate officers of the General Partner on behalf of the Partnership shall execute and deliver, and in the case of Common Units, the Transfer Agent shall countersign and deliver, in the name of the holder or the designated transferee or transferees, as required pursuant to the holder’s instructions, one or more new Certificates evidencing the same aggregate number and type of Limited Partner Interests as was evidenced by the Certificate so surrendered.

A-18


 

      (b) The General Partner shall not recognize any transfer of Limited Partner Interests until the Certificates evidencing such Limited Partner Interests are surrendered for registration of transfer. No charge shall be imposed by the General Partner for such transfer; provided, however , that as a condition to the issuance of any new Certificate under this Section 4.5, the General Partner may require the payment of a sum sufficient to cover any tax or other governmental charge that may be imposed with respect thereto.
      (c) The General Partner and its Affiliates shall have the right at any time to transfer their Subordinated Units and Common Units (whether issued upon conversion of the Subordinated Units or otherwise) to one or more Persons.
      Section  4.6      Transfer of the General Partner’s General Partner Interest.
      (a) Subject to Section 4.6(c) below, prior to December 31, 2016, the General Partner shall not transfer all or any part of its General Partner Interest (represented by General Partner Units) to a Person unless such transfer (i) has been approved by the prior written consent or vote of the holders of at least a majority of the Outstanding Common Units (excluding Common Units held by the General Partner and its Affiliates) or (ii) is of all, but not less than all, of its General Partner Interest to (A) an Affiliate of the General Partner (other than an individual) or (B) another Person (other than an individual) in connection with (1) the merger or consolidation of the General Partner with or into such other Person or (2) the transfer by the General Partner of all or substantially all of its assets to such other Person.
      (b) Subject to Section 4.6(c) below, on or after December 31, 2016, the General Partner may transfer all or any of its General Partner Interest without Unitholder approval.
      (c) Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, no transfer by the General Partner of all or any part of its General Partner Interest to another Person shall be permitted unless (i) the transferee agrees to assume the rights and duties of the General Partner under this Agreement and to be bound by the provisions of this Agreement, (ii) the Partnership receives an Opinion of Counsel that such transfer would not result in the loss of limited liability of any Limited Partner or of any limited partner or member of any other Group Member and (iii) such transferee also agrees to purchase all (or the appropriate portion thereof, if applicable) of the partnership or membership interest of the General Partner as the general partner or managing member, if any, of each other Group Member. In the case of a transfer pursuant to and in compliance with this Section 4.6, the transferee or successor (as the case may be) shall, subject to compliance with the terms of Section 10.3, be admitted to the Partnership as the General Partner immediately prior to the transfer of the General Partner Interest, and the business of the Partnership shall continue without dissolution.
      Section  4.7      Transfer of Incentive Distribution Rights.
      Prior to December 31, 2016, a holder of Incentive Distribution Rights may transfer any or all of the Incentive Distribution Rights held by such holder without any consent of the Unitholders to (a) an Affiliate of such holder (other than an individual) or (b) another Person (other than an individual) in connection with (i) the merger or consolidation of such holder of Incentive Distribution Rights with or into such other Person or (ii) the transfer by such holder of all or substantially all of its assets to such other Person. Any other transfer of the Incentive Distribution Rights prior to December 31, 2016 shall require the prior approval of holders of at least a majority of the Outstanding Common Units (excluding Common Units held by the General Partner and its Affiliates). On or after December 31, 2016, the General Partner or any other holder of Incentive Distribution Rights may transfer any or all of its Incentive Distribution Rights without Unitholder approval. Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, no transfer of Incentive Distribution Rights to another Person shall be permitted unless the transferee agrees to be bound by the provisions of this Agreement. The General Partner and any transferee or transferees of the Incentive Distribution Rights may agree in a separate instrument as to the General Partner’s exercise of its rights with respect to the Incentive Distribution Rights under Section 11.3 hereof.

A-19


 

      Section  4.8      Restrictions on Transfers.
      (a) Except as provided in Section 4.8(c) below, but notwithstanding the other provisions of this Article IV, no transfer of any Partnership Interests shall be made if such transfer would (i) violate the then applicable U.S. federal or state securities laws or rules and regulations of the Commission, any state securities commission or any other governmental authority with jurisdiction over such transfer or (ii) terminate the existence or qualification of the Partnership or any Group Member under the laws of the jurisdiction of its formation.
      (b) The transfer of a Subordinated Unit that has converted into a Common Unit shall be subject to the restrictions imposed by Section 6.6(b).
      (c) Nothing contained in this Article IV, or elsewhere in this Agreement, shall preclude the settlement of any transactions involving Partnership Interests entered into through the facilities of any National Securities Exchange on which such Partnership Interests are listed or admitted to trading.
ARTICLE V
CAPITAL CONTRIBUTIONS AND ISSUANCE OF PARTNERSHIP INTERESTS
      Section  5.1      Organizational Contributions.
      (a) In connection with the formation of the Partnership under the Marshall Islands Act, the General Partner made an initial Capital Contribution to the Partnership in the amount of $20, for a 2% General Partner Interest in the Partnership and has been admitted as the General Partner of the Partnership, and the Organizational Limited Partner made an initial Capital Contribution to the Partnership in the amount of $980 for a 98% Limited Partner Interest in the Partnership and has been admitted as a Limited Partner of the Partnership.
      (b) Prior to the Closing Date (i) the General Partner contributed its 0.52% ownership interest in the Operating Company to the Partnership in exchange for (A) a continuation of its 2% General Partner Interest, (B) the Incentive Distribution Rights and (C) the assumption by the Partnership of a $[          ] note representing 2% of the total cash to be paid to Teekay Shipping Corporation from the proceeds of the Initial Offering, and (ii) Teekay Shipping Corporation contributed to the Partnership (A) all of its ownership interest in the general partner of the Operating Company and (B) a 25.47% limited partner interest in the Operating Company, in exchange for a continuation of its 98% limited partner interest in the Partnership and a $[          ] note representing 98% of the total cash to be paid to Teekay Shipping Corporation from the proceeds of the Initial Offering.
      Section  5.2      Initial Unit Issuances; General Partner Pre-emptive Rights.
      (a) On or prior to the Closing Date and pursuant to the Contribution Agreement, (i) Teekay Shipping Corporation’s 98% initial limited partner interest shall be converted into (A) 2,800,000 Common Units and (B) 9,800,000 Subordinated Units and (ii) the Partnership shall issue to the General Partner, for no additional consideration, 400,000 General Partner Units evidencing the General Partner’s 2% General Partner Interest.
      (b) Upon the issuance of any additional Limited Partner Interests by the Partnership (other than Common Units issued in the Initial Offering, including any Common Units issued pursuant to the Over-Allotment Option), the General Partner may, in exchange for a proportionate number of General Partner Units, make additional Capital Contributions in an amount equal to the product obtained by multiplying (i) the quotient determined by dividing (A) the General Partner’s Percentage Interest immediately prior to such issuance by (B) 100 less the General Partner’s Percentage Interest immediately prior to such issuance by (ii) the amount contributed to the Partnership by the Limited Partners in exchange for such additional Limited Partner Interests. The General Partner shall not be obligated to make any additional Capital Contributions to the Partnership.
      Section  5.3      Contributions by Initial Limited Partners and Distributions to the General Partner and its Affiliates.

A-20


 

      (a) On the Closing Date and pursuant to the Underwriting Agreement, each Underwriter shall contribute to the Partnership cash in an amount equal to the Issue Price per Initial Common Unit, multiplied by the number of Common Units specified in the Underwriting Agreement to be purchased by such Underwriter at the Closing Date. In exchange for such Capital Contributions by the Underwriters, the Partnership shall issue Common Units to each Underwriter on whose behalf such Capital Contribution is made in an amount equal to the number of Common Units specified in the Underwriting Agreement to be purchased by such Underwriter on the Closing Date.
      (b) Upon any exercise of the Over-Allotment Option, each Underwriter shall contribute to the Partnership cash in an amount equal to the Issue Price per Initial Common Unit, multiplied by the number of Common Units to be purchased by such Underwriter at the Option Closing Date. In exchange for such Capital Contributions by the Underwriters, the Partnership shall issue Common Units to each Underwriter on whose behalf such Capital Contribution is made in an amount equal to the quotient obtained by dividing (i) the cash contributions to the Partnership by or on behalf of such Underwriter by (ii) the Issue Price per Initial Common Unit. Upon receipt by the Partnership of the Capital Contributions from the Underwriters as provided in this Section 5.3(b), the Partnership shall use such cash to redeem from Teekay Shipping Corporation that number of Common Units equal to the number of Common Units issued to the Underwriters as provided in this Section 5.3(b).
      (c) No Limited Partner Interests will be issued or issuable as of or at the Closing Date other than (i) the Common Units issuable pursuant to subparagraph (a) of this Section 5.3 in aggregate number equal to 7,000,000, (ii) the “Option Units” as such term is used in the Underwriting Agreement in an aggregate number up to 1,050,000 issuable upon exercise of the Over-Allotment Option pursuant to subparagraph (c) hereof, (iii) the 9,800,000 Subordinated Units issuable to pursuant to Section 5.2 hereof, (iv) the 2,800,000 Common Units issuable pursuant to Section 5.2 hereof, and (v) the Incentive Distribution Rights.
      Section  5.4      Interest and Withdrawal.
      No interest shall be paid by the Partnership on Capital Contributions. No Partner shall be entitled to the withdrawal or return of its Capital Contribution, except to the extent, if any, that distributions made pursuant to this Agreement or upon termination of the Partnership may be considered and permitted as such by law and then only to the extent provided for in this Agreement. Except to the extent expressly provided in this Agreement, no Partner shall have priority over any other Partner either as to the return of Capital Contributions or as to profits, losses or distributions.
      Section  5.5      Issuances of Additional Partnership Securities.
      (a) The Partnership may issue additional Partnership Securities and options, rights, warrants and appreciation rights relating to the Partnership Securities for any Partnership purpose at any time and from time to time to such Persons for such consideration and on such terms and conditions as the General Partner shall determine, all without the approval of any Limited Partners.
      (b) Each additional Partnership Security authorized to be issued by the Partnership pursuant to Section 5.5(a) may be issued in one or more classes, or one or more series of any such classes, with such designations, preferences, rights, powers and duties (which may be senior to existing classes and series of Partnership Securities), as shall be fixed by the General Partner, including (i) the right to share in Partnership distributions; (ii) the rights upon dissolution and liquidation of the Partnership; (iii) whether, and the terms and conditions upon which, the Partnership may or shall be required to redeem the Partnership Security (including sinking fund provisions); (iv) whether such Partnership Security is issued with the privilege of conversion or exchange and, if so, the terms and conditions of such conversion or exchange; (v) the terms and conditions upon which each Partnership Security will be issued, evidenced by certificates and assigned or transferred; (vi) the method for determining the Percentage Interest as to such Partnership Security; and (vii) the right, if any, of each such Partnership Security to vote on Partnership matters, including matters relating to the relative rights, preferences and privileges of such Partnership Security.

A-21


 

      (c) The General Partner shall take all actions that it determines to be necessary or appropriate in connection with (i) each issuance of Partnership Securities and options, rights, warrants and appreciation rights relating to Partnership Securities pursuant to this Section 5.5, (ii) the conversion of the General Partner Interest (represented by General Partner Units) or any Incentive Distribution Rights into Units pursuant to the terms of this Agreement, (iii) the admission of additional Limited Partners and (iv) all additional issuances of Partnership Securities. The General Partner shall determine the relative rights, powers and duties of the holders of the Units or other Partnership Securities being so issued. The General Partner shall do all things necessary to comply with the Marshall Islands Act and is authorized and directed to do all things that it determines to be necessary or appropriate in connection with any future issuance of Partnership Securities or in connection with the conversion of the General Partner Interest or any Incentive Distribution Rights into Units pursuant to the terms of this Agreement, including compliance with any statute, rule, regulation or guideline of any federal, state or other governmental agency or any National Securities Exchange on which the Units or other Partnership Securities are listed or admitted to trading.
      Section  5.6      Limitations on Issuance of Additional Partnership Securities.
      The Partnership may issue an unlimited number of Partnership Securities (or options, rights, warrants or appreciation rights related thereto) pursuant to Section 5.5 without the approval of the Limited Partners; provided, however , that no fractional units shall be issued by the Partnership.
      Section  5.7      Conversion of Subordinated Units.
      (a) All of the Outstanding Subordinated Units will convert into Common Units on a one-for-one basis on the first day following the distribution of Available Cash to Partners pursuant to Section 6.2(a) in respect of any Quarter ending on or after December 31, 2006, in respect of which:
        (i) distributions of Available Cash from Operating Surplus under Section 6.3(a) on each of the Outstanding Common Units, Subordinated Units, General Partner Units and any other Outstanding Units that are senior or equal in right of distribution to the Subordinated Units equaled or exceeded the Third Target Distribution during the four-Quarter period immediately preceding such date;
 
        (ii) the Adjusted Operating Surplus for the four-Quarter period immediately preceding such date equaled or exceeded the sum of the Third Target Distribution on all of the Common Units, Subordinated Units, General Partner Units and any other Units that are senior or equal in right of distribution to the Subordinated Units that were Outstanding during such period on a Fully Diluted Basis with respect to such period; and
 
        (iii) there are no Cumulative Common Unit Arrearages.
      (b) If the Subordinated Units are not converted into Common Units pursuant to Sections 5.7(a), the Subordinated Units shall convert into Common Units on a one-for-one basis upon the expiration of the Subordination Period.
      (c) Notwithstanding any other provision of this Agreement, the Subordinated Units will automatically convert into Common Units on a one-for-one basis as set forth in, and pursuant to the terms of, Section 11.4.
      (d) A Subordinated Unit that has converted into a Common Unit shall be subject to the provisions of Section 6.6(b).
      Section  5.8      Limited Preemptive Right.
      Except as provided in this Section 5.8 and in Section 5.2(b), no Person shall have any preemptive, preferential or other similar right with respect to the issuance of any Partnership Security, whether unissued, held in the treasury or hereafter created. The General Partner shall have the right, which it may from time to time assign in whole or in part to any of its Affiliates, to purchase Partnership Securities from the Partnership whenever, and on the same terms that, the Partnership issues Partnership Securities to Persons other than the General Partner and its Affiliates, to the extent necessary to maintain the

A-22


 

Percentage Interests of the General Partner and its Affiliates equal to that which existed immediately prior to the issuance of such Partnership Securities.
      Section  5.9      Splits and Combinations.
      (a) Subject to Sections 5.9(d) and 6.5 (dealing with adjustments of distribution levels), the Partnership may make a Pro Rata distribution of Partnership Securities to all Record Holders or may effect a subdivision or combination of Partnership Securities so long as, after any such event, each Partner shall have the same Percentage Interest in the Partnership as before such event, and any amounts calculated on a per Unit basis (including any Common Unit Arrearage or Cumulative Common Unit Arrearage) or stated as a number of Units are proportionately adjusted.
      (b) Whenever such a distribution, subdivision or combination of Partnership Securities is declared, the General Partner shall select a Record Date as of which the distribution, subdivision or combination shall be effective and shall send notice thereof at least 20 days prior to such Record Date to each Record Holder as of a date not less than 10 days prior to the date of such notice. The General Partner also may cause a firm of independent public accountants selected by it to calculate the number of Partnership Securities to be held by each Record Holder after giving effect to such distribution, subdivision or combination. The General Partner shall be entitled to rely on any certificate provided by such firm as conclusive evidence of the accuracy of such calculation.
      (c) Promptly following any such distribution, subdivision or combination, the Partnership may issue Certificates to the Record Holders of Partnership Securities as of the applicable Record Date representing the new number of Partnership Securities held by such Record Holders, or the General Partner may adopt such other procedures that it determines to be necessary or appropriate to reflect such changes. If any such combination results in a smaller total number of Partnership Securities Outstanding, the Partnership shall require, as a condition to the delivery to a Record Holder of such new Certificate, the surrender of any Certificate held by such Record Holder immediately prior to such Record Date.
      (d) The Partnership shall not issue fractional Units upon any distribution, subdivision or combination of Units. If a distribution, subdivision or combination of Units would result in the issuance of fractional Units but for the provisions of this Section 5.9(d), each fractional Unit shall be rounded to the nearest whole Unit (and a 0.5 Unit shall be rounded to the next higher Unit).
      Section  5.10      Fully Paid and Non-Assessable Nature of Limited Partner Interests.
      All Limited Partner Interests issued pursuant to, and in accordance with the requirements of, this Article V shall be fully paid and non-assessable Limited Partner Interests in the Partnership, except as such non-assessability may be affected by the Marshall Islands Act.
ARTICLE VI
ALLOCATIONS AND DISTRIBUTIONS
      Section  6.1      Allocations.
      For purposes of the Marshall Islands Act, the Partnership’s items of income, gain, loss and deduction shall be allocated among the Partners in each taxable year (or portion thereof) as follows:
        (a) in a taxable year (or portion thereof) in which items of income and gain exceed items of loss and deduction, in a manner such that the allocations to the Partners (i) first reverse any allocations made to the Partners pursuant to Section 6.1(b)(ii) and (ii) thereafter, are in proportion to the distributions of Available Cash from Operating Surplus (actual or deemed) made to the Partners pursuant to Article VI and Section 12.4; and
 
        (b) in a taxable year (or portion thereof) in which items of loss and deduction exceed items of income and gain, in a manner such that the allocations to the Partners (i) first reverse any allocations

A-23


 

  made to the Partners pursuant to Section 6.1(a)(ii) and (ii) thereafter, are in proportion to the Partners’ Percentage Interests.

      Section  6.2      Requirement and Characterization of Distributions; Distributions to Record Holders.
      (a) Within 45 days following the end of each Quarter commencing with the Quarter ending on December 31, 2006, an amount equal to 100% of Available Cash with respect to such Quarter shall, subject to Section 51 of the Marshall Islands Act, be distributed in accordance with this Article VI by the Partnership to the Partners as of the Record Date selected by the General Partner. All amounts of Available Cash distributed by the Partnership on any date from any source shall be deemed to be Operating Surplus until the sum of all amounts of Available Cash theretofore distributed by the Partnership to the Partners pursuant to Section 6.3 equals the Operating Surplus from the Closing Date through the close of the immediately preceding Quarter. Any remaining amounts of Available Cash distributed by the Partnership on such date shall, except as otherwise provided in Section 6.4, be deemed to be “Capital Surplus.”
      (b) Notwithstanding Section 6.2(a), in the event of the dissolution and liquidation of the Partnership, all receipts received during or after the Quarter in which the Liquidation Date occurs, other than from borrowings described in (a)(ii) of the definition of Available Cash, shall be applied and distributed solely in accordance with, and subject to the terms and conditions of, Section 12.4.
      (c) Each distribution in respect of a Partnership Interest shall be paid by the Partnership, directly or through the Transfer Agent or through any other Person or agent, only to the Record Holder of such Partnership Interest as of the Record Date set for such distribution. Such payment shall constitute full payment and satisfaction of the Partnership’s liability in respect of such payment, regardless of any claim of any Person who may have an interest in such payment by reason of an assignment or otherwise.
      Section  6.3      Distributions of Available Cash from Operating Surplus.
      (a)  During Subordination Period. Available Cash with respect to any Quarter or portion thereof within the Subordination Period that is deemed to be Operating Surplus pursuant to the provisions of Sections 6.2 or 6.4 shall, subject to Section 51 of the Marshall Islands Act, be distributed as follows, except as otherwise contemplated by Section 5.5 in respect of other Partnership Securities issued pursuant thereto:
        (i) First, (x) to the General Partner in accordance with its Percentage Interest and (y) to all the Unitholders holding Common Units, Pro Rata, a percentage equal to 100% less the General Partner’s Percentage Interest, until there has been distributed in respect of each Common Unit then Outstanding an amount equal to the Minimum Quarterly Distribution for such Quarter;
 
        (ii) Second, (x) to the General Partner in accordance with its Percentage Interest and (y) to all Unitholders holding Common Units, Pro Rata, a percentage equal to 100% less the General Partner’s Percentage Interest, until there has been distributed in respect of each Common Unit then Outstanding an amount equal to the Cumulative Common Unit Arrearage existing with respect to such Quarter;
 
        (iii) Third, (x) to the General Partner in accordance with its Percentage Interest and (y) to all Unitholders holding Subordinated Units, Pro Rata, a percentage equal to 100% less the General Partner’s Percentage Interest, until there has been distributed in respect of each Subordinated Unit then Outstanding an amount equal to the Minimum Quarterly Distribution for such Quarter;
 
        (iv) Fourth, to the General Partner and all Unitholders, in accordance with their respective Percentage Interests, until there has been distributed in respect of each Unit then Outstanding an amount equal to the excess of the First Target Distribution over the Minimum Quarterly Distribution for such Quarter;
 
        (v) Fifth, (A) to the General Partner in accordance with its Percentage Interest; (B) 13% to the holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights, Pro Rata; and (C) to all Unitholders, Pro Rata, a percentage equal to 100% less the sum of the percentages applicable to subclauses (A) and (B) of

A-24


 

  this clause (v) until there has been distributed in respect of each Unit then Outstanding an amount equal to the excess of the Second Target Distribution over the First Target Distribution for such Quarter;
 
        (vi) Sixth, (A) to the General Partner in accordance with its Percentage Interest, (B) 23% to the holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights, Pro Rata; and (C) to all Unitholders, Pro Rata, a percentage equal to 100% less the sum of the percentages applicable to subclauses (A) and (B) of this subclause (vi), until there has been distributed in respect of each Unit then Outstanding an amount equal to the excess of the Third Target Distribution over the Second Target Distribution for such Quarter; and
 
        (vii) Thereafter, (A) to the General Partner in accordance with its Percentage Interest; (B) 48% to the holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights, Pro Rata; and (C) to all Unitholders, Pro Rata, a percentage equal to 100% less the sum of the percentages applicable to subclauses (A) and (B) of this clause (vii);

provided, however , that if the Minimum Quarterly Distribution, the First Target Distribution, the Second Target Distribution and the Third Target Distribution have been reduced to zero pursuant to the second sentence of Section 6.5, the distribution of Available Cash that is deemed to be Operating Surplus with respect to any Quarter will be made solely in accordance with Section 6.3(a)(vii).
      (b)  After Subordination Period. Available Cash with respect to any Quarter after the Subordination Period that is deemed to be Operating Surplus pursuant to the provisions of Sections 6.2 or 6.4, shall subject to Section 51 of the Marshall Islands Act, be distributed as follows, except as otherwise required by Section 5.5(b) in respect of additional Partnership Securities issued pursuant thereto:
        (i) First, 100% to the General Partner and the Unitholders in accordance with their respective Percentage Interests, until there has been distributed in respect of each Unit then Outstanding an amount equal to the Minimum Quarterly Distribution for such Quarter
 
        (ii) Second, 100% to the General Partner and the Unitholders in accordance with their respective Percentage Interests, until there has been distributed in respect of each Unit then Outstanding an amount equal to the excess of the First Target Distribution over the Minimum Quarterly Distribution for such Quarter;
 
        (iii) Third, (A) to the General Partner in accordance with its Percentage Interest; (B) 13% to the holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights, Pro Rata; and (C) to all Unitholders, Pro Rata, a percentage equal to 100% less the sum of the percentages applicable to subclauses (A) and (B) of this clause (iii), until there has been distributed in respect of each Unit then Outstanding an amount equal to the excess of the Second Target Distribution over the First Target Distribution for such Quarter;
 
        (iv Fourth, (A) to the General Partner in accordance with its Percentage Interest; (B) 23% to the holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights, Pro Rata; and (C) to all Unitholders, Pro Rata, a percentage equal to 100% less the sum of the percentages applicable to subclause (A) and (B) of this clause (iv), until there has been distributed in respect of each Unit then Outstanding an amount equal to the excess of the Third Target Distribution over the Second Target Distribution for such Quarter; and
 
        (v) Thereafter, (A) to the General Partner in accordance with its Percentage Interest; (B) 48% to the holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights, Pro Rata; and (C) to all Unitholders, Pro Rata, a percentage equal to 100% less the sum of the percentages applicable to subclauses (A) and (B) of this clause (v);
provided, however , that if the Minimum Quarterly Distribution, the First Target Distribution, the Second Target Distribution and the Third Target Distribution have been reduced to zero pursuant to the second sentence of Section 6.5, the distribution of Available Cash that is deemed to be Operating Surplus with respect to any Quarter will be made solely in accordance with Section 6.3(b)(v).

A-25


 

      Section  6.4      Distributions of Available Cash from Capital Surplus.
      Available Cash that is deemed to be Capital Surplus pursuant to the provisions of Section 6.2(a) shall, subject to Section 51 of the Marshall Islands Act, be distributed, unless the provisions of Section 6.2 require otherwise, 100% to the General Partner and the Unitholders in accordance with their respective Percentage Interests, until a hypothetical holder of a Common Unit acquired on the Closing Date has received with respect to such Common Unit, during the period since the Closing Date through such date, distributions of Available Cash that are deemed to be Capital Surplus in an aggregate amount equal to the Initial Unit Price. Available Cash that is deemed to be Capital Surplus shall then be distributed (a) to the General Partner in accordance with its Percentage Interest and (b) to all Unitholders holding Common Units their Pro Rata share of a percentage equal to 100% less the General Partner’s Percentage Interest, until there has been distributed in respect of each Common Unit then Outstanding an amount equal to the Cumulative Common Unit Arrearage. Thereafter, all Available Cash shall be distributed as if it were Operating Surplus and shall be distributed in accordance with Section 6.3.
      Section  6.5      Adjustment of Minimum Quarterly Distribution and Target Distribution Levels.
      The Minimum Quarterly Distribution, First Target Distribution, Second Target Distribution, Third Target Distribution, Common Unit Arrearages and Cumulative Common Unit Arrearages shall be proportionately adjusted in the event of any distribution, combination or subdivision (whether effected by a distribution payable in Units or otherwise) of Units or other Partnership Securities in accordance with Section 5.9. In the event of a distribution of Available Cash that is deemed to be from Capital Surplus, the then applicable Minimum Quarterly Distribution, First Target Distribution, Second Target Distribution and Third Target Distribution, shall be reduced in the same proportion that the distribution had to the fair market value of the Common Units prior to the announcement of the distribution. If the Common Units are publicly traded on a National Securities Exchange, the fair market value will be the Current Market Price before the ex-dividend date. If the Common Units are not publicly traded, the fair market value will be determined by the Board of Directors of the General Partner.
      Section  6.6      Special Provisions Relating to the Holders of Subordinated Units.
      (a) Except with respect to the right to vote on or approve matters requiring the vote or approval of a percentage of the holders of Outstanding Common Units and the right to participate in distributions made with respect to Common Units, the holder of a Subordinated Unit shall have all of the rights and obligations of a Unitholder holding Common Units hereunder; provided, however , that immediately upon the conversion of Subordinated Units into Common Units pursuant to Section 5.7, the Unitholder holding a Subordinated Unit shall possess all of the rights and obligations of a Unitholder holding Common Units hereunder, including the right to vote as a Common Unitholder and the right to participate in distributions made with respect to Common Units.
      (b) A Unitholder holding a Subordinated Unit that has converted into a Common Unit pursuant to Section 5.8 shall not be issued a Common Unit Certificate pursuant to Section 4.1, and shall not be permitted to transfer its converted Subordinated Units to a Person that is not an Affiliate of the holder until such time as the General Partner determines, based on advice of counsel, that a converted Subordinated Unit should have, as a substantive matter, like intrinsic economic and U.S. federal income tax characteristics, in all material respects, to the intrinsic economic and U.S. federal income tax characteristics of an Initial Common Unit.
      Section  6.7      Special Provisions Relating to the Holders of Incentive Distribution Rights.
      Notwithstanding anything to the contrary set forth in this Agreement, the holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights (a) shall possess the rights and obligations provided in this Agreement with respect to a Limited Partner pursuant to Articles III and VII and (b) shall not (i) be entitled to vote on any matters requiring the approval or vote of the holders of Outstanding Units, except as provided by law, or (ii) be entitled to any distributions other than as provided in Sections 6.3(a)(v), (vi) and (vii), 6.3(b)(iii), (iv) and (v), and 12.4.

A-26


 

ARTICLE VII
MANAGEMENT AND OPERATION OF BUSINESS
      Section  7.1      Management.
      (a) The General Partner shall conduct, direct and manage all activities of the Partnership. Except as otherwise expressly provided in this Agreement, all management powers over the business and affairs of the Partnership shall be exclusively vested in the General Partner, and no Limited Partner shall have any management power over the business and affairs of the Partnership. In addition to the powers now or hereafter granted a general partner of a limited partnership under applicable law or that are granted to the General Partner under any other provision of this Agreement, the General Partner, subject to Section 7.3, shall have full power and authority to do all things and on such terms as it determines to be necessary or appropriate to conduct the business of the Partnership, to exercise all powers set forth in Section 2.5 and to effectuate the purposes set forth in Section 2.4, including the following:
        (i) the making of any expenditures, the lending or borrowing of money, the assumption or guarantee of, or other contracting for, indebtedness and other liabilities, the issuance of evidences of indebtedness, including indebtedness that is convertible into Partnership Securities, and the incurring of any other obligations;
 
        (ii) the making of tax, regulatory and other filings, or rendering of periodic or other reports to governmental or other agencies having jurisdiction over the business or assets of the Partnership;
 
        (iii) the acquisition, disposition, mortgage, pledge, encumbrance, hypothecation or exchange of any or all of the assets of the Partnership or the merger, consolidation or other combination of the Partnership with or into another Person (the matters described in this clause (iii) being subject, however, to any prior approval that may be required by Section 7.3 and Article XIV);
 
        (iv) the use of the assets of the Partnership (including cash on hand) for any purpose consistent with the terms of this Agreement, including the financing of the conduct of the operations of the Partnership Group; subject to Section 7.6(a), the lending of funds to other Persons (including other Group Members); the repayment or guarantee of obligations of any Group Member; and the making of capital contributions to any Group Member;
 
        (v) the negotiation, execution and performance of any contracts, conveyances or other instruments (including instruments that limit the liability of the Partnership under contractual arrangements to all or particular assets of the Partnership, with the other party to the contract to have no recourse against the General Partner or its assets other than its interest in the Partnership, even if such non-recourse provision results in the terms of the transaction being less favorable to the Partnership than would otherwise be the case);
 
        (vi) the distribution of Partnership cash;
 
        (vii) the selection and dismissal of employees (including employees having titles such as “president,” “vice president,” “secretary” and “treasurer”) and agents, outside attorneys, accountants, consultants and contractors and the determination of their compensation and other terms of employment or hiring;
 
        (viii) the maintenance of insurance for the benefit of the Partnership Group, the Partners and Indemnitees;
 
        (ix) the formation of, or acquisition of an interest in, and the contribution of property and the making of loans to, any further limited or general partnerships, joint ventures, corporations, limited liability companies or other relationships (including the acquisition of interests in, and the contributions of property to, any Group Member from time to time) subject to the restrictions set forth in Section 2.4;

A-27


 

        (x) the control of any matters affecting the rights and obligations of the Partnership, including the bringing and defending of actions at law or in equity and otherwise engaging in the conduct of litigation, arbitration or mediation and the incurring of legal expenses and the settling of claims and litigation;
 
        (xi) the indemnification of any Person against liabilities and contingencies to the extent permitted by law;
 
        (xii) the entering into of listing agreements with any National Securities Exchange and the delisting of some or all of the Limited Partner Interests from, or requesting that trading be suspended on, any such exchange (subject to any prior approval that may be required under Section 4.8);
 
        (xiii) the purchase, sale or other acquisition or disposition of Partnership Securities, or the issuance of options, rights, warrants and appreciation rights relating to Partnership Securities;
 
        (xiv) the undertaking of any action in connection with the Partnership’s participation in any Group Member; and
 
        (xv) the entering into of agreements with any of its Affiliates to render services to a Group Member or to itself in the discharge of its duties as General Partner of the Partnership.
      (b) Notwithstanding any other provision of this Agreement, any Group Member Agreement, the Marshall Islands Act or any applicable law, rule or regulation, each of the Partners and each other Person who may acquire an interest in Partnership Securities hereby (i) approves, ratifies and confirms the execution, delivery and performance by the parties thereto of this Agreement, the Underwriting Agreement, the Contribution Agreement, any Group Member Agreement of any other Group Member and the other agreements described in or filed as exhibits to the Registration Statement that are related to the transactions contemplated by the Registration Statement; (ii) agrees that the General Partner (on its own or on behalf of the Partnership) is authorized to execute, deliver and perform the agreements referred to in clause (i) of this sentence and the other agreements, acts, transactions and matters described in or contemplated by the Registration Statement on behalf of the Partnership without any further act, approval or vote of the Partners or the other Persons who may acquire an interest in Partnership Securities; and (iii) agrees that the execution, delivery or performance by the General Partner, any Group Member or any Affiliate of any of them of this Agreement or any agreement authorized or permitted under this Agreement (including the exercise by the General Partner or any Affiliate of the General Partner of the rights accorded pursuant to Article XV) shall not constitute a breach by the General Partner of any duty that the General Partner may owe the Partnership or the Limited Partners or any other Persons under this Agreement (or any other agreements) or of any duty stated or implied by law or equity.
      Section  7.2      Certificate of Limited Partnership.
      The General Partner has caused the Certificate of Limited Partnership to be filed with the Registrar of Corporations of The Marshall Islands as required by the Marshall Islands Act. The General Partner shall use all commercially reasonable efforts to cause to be filed such other certificates or documents that the General Partner determines to be necessary or appropriate for the formation, continuation, qualification and operation of a limited partnership (or a partnership or other entity in which the limited partners have limited liability) in The Marshall Islands or any other jurisdiction in which the Partnership may elect to do business or own property. To the extent the General Partner determines such action to be necessary or appropriate, the General Partner shall file amendments to and restatements of the Certificate of Limited Partnership and do all things to maintain the Partnership as a limited partnership (or a partnership or other entity in which the limited partners have limited liability) under the laws of The Marshall Islands or of any other jurisdiction in which the Partnership may elect to do business or own property. Subject to the terms of Section 3.4(a), the General Partner shall not be required, before or after filing, to deliver or mail a copy of the Certificate of Limited Partnership, any qualification document or any amendment thereto to any Limited Partner.
      Section  7.3      Restrictions on the General Partner’s Authority.
      (a) Except as otherwise provided in this Agreement, the General Partner may not, without written approval of the specific act by holders of all of the Outstanding Limited Partner Interests or by other

A-28


 

written instrument executed and delivered by holders of all of the Outstanding Limited Partner Interests subsequent to the date of this Agreement, take any action in contravention of this Agreement .
      (b) Except as provided in Articles XII and XIV, the General Partner may not sell, exchange or otherwise dispose of all or substantially all of the assets of the Partnership Group, taken as a whole, in a single transaction or a series of related transactions (including by way of merger, consolidation, other combination or sale of ownership interests in the Partnership’s Subsidiaries) without the approval of holders of a Unit Majority; provided, however , that this provision shall not preclude or limit the General Partner’s ability to mortgage, pledge, hypothecate or grant a security interest in all or substantially all of the assets of the Partnership Group and shall not apply to any forced sale of any or all of the assets of the Partnership Group pursuant to the foreclosure of, or other realization upon, any such encumbrance. Without the approval of holders of a Unit Majority, the General Partner shall not, on behalf of the Partnership, except as permitted under Sections 4.6, 11.1 and 11.2, elect or cause the Partnership to elect a successor general partner of the Partnership.
      Section  7.4      Reimbursement of the General Partner.
      (a) Except as provided in this Section 7.4 and elsewhere in this Agreement, the General Partner shall not be compensated for its services as a general partner or managing member of any Group Member.
      (b) The General Partner shall be reimbursed on a monthly basis, or such other basis as the General Partner may determine, for (i) all direct and indirect expenses it incurs or payments it makes on behalf of the Partnership Group (including salary, bonus, incentive compensation and other amounts paid to any Person, including Affiliates of the General Partner, to perform services for the Partnership or for the General Partner in the discharge of its duties to the Partnership Group, which amounts shall also include reimbursement for any Common Units purchased to satisfy obligations of the Partnership under any of its equity compensation plans), and (ii) all other direct and indirect expenses allocable to the Partnership or otherwise incurred by the General Partner in connection with operating the Partnership Group’s business (including expenses allocated to the General Partner by its Affiliates). The General Partner shall determine the expenses that are allocable to the Partnership Group. Reimbursements pursuant to this Section 7.4 shall be in addition to any reimbursement to the General Partner as a result of indemnification pursuant to Section 7.7.
      (c) The General Partner and its Affiliates may charge any member of the Partnership Group a management fee to the extent necessary to allow the Partnership Group to reduce the amount of any U.S. federal, state or local or any non-U.S.  franchise or income tax or any other tax based upon the revenues or gross margin of any member of the Partnership Group if the tax benefit produced by the payment of such management fee or fees exceeds the amount of such fee or fees.
      (d) The General Partner, without the approval of the Limited Partners (who shall have no right to vote in respect thereof), may propose and adopt on behalf of the Partnership employee benefit plans, employee programs and employee practices (including plans, programs and practices involving the issuance of Partnership Securities or options to purchase or rights, warrants or appreciation rights relating to Partnership Securities), or cause the Partnership to issue Partnership Securities in connection with, or pursuant to, any employee benefit plan, employee program or employee practice maintained or sponsored by the General Partner or any of its Affiliates, in each case for the benefit of employees of the General Partner, any Group Member or any Affiliate thereof, or any of them, in respect of services performed, directly or indirectly, for the benefit of the Partnership Group. The Partnership agrees to issue and sell to the General Partner or any of its Affiliates any Partnership Securities that the General Partner or such Affiliates are obligated to provide to any employees pursuant to any such employee benefit plans, employee programs or employee practices. Expenses incurred by the General Partner in connection with any such plans, programs and practices (including the net cost to the General Partner or such Affiliates of Partnership Securities purchased by the General Partner or such Affiliates from the Partnership or in the open market to fulfill options or awards under such plans, programs and practices) shall be reimbursed in accordance with Section 7.4(b). Any and all obligations of the General Partner under any employee benefit plans, employee programs or employee practices adopted by the General Partner as permitted by

A-29


 

this Section 7.4(c) shall constitute obligations of the General Partner hereunder and shall be assumed by any successor General Partner approved pursuant to Section 11.1 or 11.2 or the transferee of or successor to all of the General Partner’s General Partner Interest pursuant to Section 4.6.
      Section  7.5      Outside Activities.
      (a) After the Closing Date, the General Partner, for so long as it is the General Partner of the Partnership (i) agrees that its sole business will be to act as a general partner or managing member, as the case may be, of the Partnership and any other partnership or limited liability company of which the Partnership is, directly or indirectly, a partner or member and to undertake activities that are ancillary or related thereto (including being a limited partner in the Partnership), and (ii) shall not engage in any business or activity or incur any debts or liabilities except in connection with or incidental to (A) its performance as general partner or managing member, if any, of one or more Group Members or as described in or contemplated by the Registration Statement or (B) the acquiring, owning or disposing of debt or equity securities in any Group Member.
      (b) Each Indemnitee (other than the General Partner) shall have the right to engage in businesses of every type and description and other activities for profit and to engage in and possess an interest in other business ventures of any and every type or description, whether in businesses engaged in or anticipated to be engaged in by any Group Member, independently or with others, including business interests and activities in direct competition with the business and activities of any Group Member, and none of the same shall constitute a breach of this Agreement or any duty expressed or implied by law to any Group Member or any Partner. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this Agreement, (i) the possessing of competitive interests and engaging in competitive activities by any Indemnitees (other than the General Partner) in accordance with the provisions of this Section 7.5 is hereby approved by the Partnership and all Partners and (ii) it shall be deemed not to be a breach of any fiduciary duty or any other obligation of any type whatsoever of the General Partner or of any Indemnitee for the Indemnitees (other than the General Partner) to engage in such business interests and activities in preference to or to the exclusion of the Partnership.
      (c) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this Agreement, the doctrine of corporate opportunity, or any analogous doctrine, shall not apply to an Indemnitee (including the General Partner) and no Indemnitee (including the General Partner) who acquires knowledge of a potential transaction, agreement, arrangement or other matter that may be an opportunity for the Partnership shall have any duty to communicate or offer such opportunity to the Partnership, and such Indemnitee (including the General Partner) shall not be liable to the Partnership, to any Limited Partner or any other Person for breach of any fiduciary or other duty by reason of the fact that such Indemnitee (including the General Partner) pursues or acquires such opportunity for itself, directs such opportunity to another Person or does not communicate such opportunity or information to the Partnership.
      (d) The General Partner and each of its Affiliates may acquire Units or other Partnership Securities in addition to those acquired on the Closing Date and, except as otherwise provided in this Agreement, shall be entitled to exercise, at their option, all rights relating to all Units or other Partnership Securities acquired by them. The term “Affiliates” as used in this Section 7.5(d) with respect to the General Partner shall not include any Group Member.
      Section  7.6      Loans from the General Partner; Loans or Contributions from the Partnership or Group Members.
      (a) The General Partner or any of its Affiliates may lend to any Group Member, and any Group Member may borrow from the General Partner or any of its Affiliates, funds needed or desired by the Group Member for such periods of time and in such amounts as the General Partner may determine; provided, however , that in any such case the lending party may not charge the borrowing party interest at a rate greater than the rate that would be charged the borrowing party or impose terms less favorable to the borrowing party than would be charged or imposed on the borrowing party by unrelated lenders on comparable loans made on an arms’-length basis (without reference to the lending party’s financial

A-30


 

abilities or guarantees), all as determined by the General Partner. The borrowing party shall reimburse the lending party for any costs (other than any additional interest costs) incurred by the lending party in connection with the borrowing of such funds. For purposes of this Section 7.6(a) and Section 7.6(b), the term “Group Member” shall include any Affiliate of a Group Member that is controlled by the Group Member.
      (b) The Partnership may lend or contribute to any Group Member, and any Group Member may borrow from the Partnership, funds on terms and conditions determined by the General Partner. No Group Member may lend funds to the General Partner or any of its Affiliates (other than another Group Member).
      (c) No borrowing by any Group Member or the approval thereof by the General Partner shall be deemed to constitute a breach of any duty, expressed or implied, of the General Partner or its Affiliates to the Partnership or the Limited Partners by reason of the fact that the purpose or effect of such borrowing is directly or indirectly to (i) enable distributions to the General Partner or its Affiliates (including in their capacities as Limited Partners) to exceed the General Partner’s Percentage Interest of the total amount distributed to all partners or (ii) hasten the expiration of the Subordination Period or the conversion of any Subordinated Units into Common Units.
      Section  7.7      Indemnification.
      (a) To the fullest extent permitted by law but subject to the limitations expressly provided in this Agreement, all Indemnitees shall be indemnified and held harmless by the Partnership from and against any and all losses, claims, damages, liabilities, joint or several, expenses (including legal fees and expenses), judgments, fines, penalties, interest, settlements or other amounts arising from any and all claims, demands, actions, suits or proceedings, whether civil, criminal, administrative or investigative, in which any Indemnitee may be involved, or is threatened to be involved, as a party or otherwise, by reason of its status as an Indemnitee; provided, however , that the Indemnitee shall not be indemnified and held harmless if there has been a final and non-appealable judgment entered by a court of competent jurisdiction determining that, in respect of the matter for which the Indemnitee is seeking indemnification pursuant to this Section 7.7, the Indemnitee acted in bad faith or engaged in fraud or willful misconduct or, in the case of a criminal matter, acted with knowledge that the Indemnitee’s conduct was unlawful; and, provided further , that no indemnification pursuant to this Section 7.7 shall be available to the General Partner or its Affiliates (other than a Group Member) with respect to its or their obligations incurred pursuant to the Underwriting Agreement or the Contribution Agreement (other than obligations incurred by the General Partner on behalf of the Partnership). Any indemnification pursuant to this Section 7.7 shall be made only out of the assets of the Partnership, it being agreed that the General Partner shall not be personally liable for such indemnification and shall have no obligation to contribute or loan any monies or property to the Partnership to enable it to effectuate such indemnification.
      (b) To the fullest extent permitted by law, expenses (including legal fees and expenses) incurred by an Indemnitee who is indemnified pursuant to Section 7.7(a) in defending any claim, demand, action, suit or proceeding shall, from time to time, be advanced by the Partnership prior to a determination that the Indemnitee is not entitled to be indemnified upon receipt by the Partnership of any undertaking by or on behalf of the Indemnitee to repay such amount if it shall be determined that the Indemnitee is not entitled to be indemnified as authorized in this Section 7.7.
      (c) The indemnification provided by this Section 7.7 shall be in addition to any other rights to which an Indemnitee may be entitled under any agreement, pursuant to any vote of the holders of Outstanding Limited Partner Interests, as a matter of law or otherwise, both as to actions in the Indemnitee’s capacity as an Indemnitee and as to actions in any other capacity, and shall continue as to an Indemnitee who has ceased to serve in such capacity and shall inure to the benefit of the heirs, successors, assigns and administrators of the Indemnitee.
      (d) The Partnership may purchase and maintain (or reimburse the General Partner or its Affiliates for the cost of) insurance, on behalf of the General Partner, its Affiliates and such other Persons as the

A-31


 

General Partner shall determine, against any liability that may be asserted against, or expense that may be incurred by, such Person in connection with the Partnership’s activities or such Person’s activities on behalf of the Partnership, regardless of whether the Partnership would have the power to indemnify such Person against such liability under the provisions of this Agreement.
      (e) For purposes of this Section 7.7, the Partnership shall be deemed to have requested an Indemnitee to serve as fiduciary of an employee benefit plan whenever the performance by the Indemnitee of its duties to the Partnership also imposes duties on, or otherwise involves services by, it to the plan or participants or beneficiaries of the plan; excise taxes assessed on an Indemnitee with respect to an employee benefit plan pursuant to applicable law shall constitute “fines” within the meaning of Section 7.7(a); and action taken or omitted by the Indemnitee with respect to any employee benefit plan in the performance of its duties for a purpose reasonably believed by it to be in the best interest of the participants and beneficiaries of the plan shall be deemed to be for a purpose that is in the best interests of the Partnership.
      (f) In no event may an Indemnitee subject the Limited Partners to personal liability by reason of the indemnification provisions set forth in this Agreement.
      (g) An Indemnitee shall not be denied indemnification in whole or in part under this Section 7.7 because the Indemnitee had an interest in the transaction with respect to which the indemnification applies if the transaction was otherwise permitted by the terms of this Agreement.
      (h) The provisions of this Section 7.7 are for the benefit of the Indemnitees, their heirs, successors, assigns and administrators and shall not be deemed to create any rights for the benefit of any other Persons.
      (i) No amendment, modification or repeal of this Section 7.7 or any provision hereof shall in any manner terminate, reduce or impair the right of any past, present or future Indemnitee to be indemnified by the Partnership, nor the obligations of the Partnership to indemnify any such Indemnitee under and in accordance with the provisions of this Section 7.7 as in effect immediately prior to such amendment, modification or repeal with respect to claims arising from or relating to matters occurring, in whole or in part, prior to such amendment, modification or repeal, regardless of when such claims may arise or be asserted.
      Section  7.8      Liability of Indemnitees.
      (a) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary set forth in this Agreement, no Indemnitee shall be liable for monetary damages to the Partnership, the Limited Partners or any other Persons who have acquired interests in the Partnership Securities, for losses sustained or liabilities incurred as a result of any act or omission of an Indemnitee unless there has been a final and non-appealable judgment entered by a court of competent jurisdiction determining that, in respect of the matter in question, the Indemnitee acted in bad faith or engaged in fraud or willful misconduct or, in the case of a criminal matter, acted with knowledge that the Indemnitee’s conduct was criminal.
      (b) Subject to its obligations and duties as General Partner set forth in Section 7.1(a), the General Partner may exercise any of the powers granted to it by this Agreement and perform any of the duties imposed upon it hereunder either directly or by or through its agents, and the General Partner shall not be responsible for any misconduct or negligence on the part of any such agent appointed by the General Partner in good faith.
      (c) To the extent that, at law or in equity, an Indemnitee has duties (including fiduciary duties) and liabilities relating thereto to the Partnership or to the Partners, the General Partner and any other Indemnitee acting in connection with the Partnership’s business or affairs shall not be liable to the Partnership or to any Partner for its good faith reliance on the provisions of this Agreement.
      (d) Any amendment, modification or repeal of this Section 7.8 or any provision hereof shall be prospective only and shall not in any way affect the limitations on the liability of the Indemnitees under this Section 7.8 as in effect immediately prior to such amendment, modification or repeal with respect to

A-32


 

claims arising from or relating to matters occurring, in whole or in part, prior to such amendment, modification or repeal, regardless of when such claims may arise or be asserted.
      Section  7.9      Resolution of Conflicts of Interest; Standards of Conduct and Modification of Duties.
      (a) Unless otherwise expressly provided in this Agreement or any Group Member Agreement, whenever a potential conflict of interest exists or arises between the General Partner or any of its Affiliates, on the one hand, and the Partnership, any Group Member or any Partner, on the other, any resolution or course of action by the General Partner or its Affiliates in respect of such conflict of interest shall be permitted and deemed approved by all Partners, and shall not constitute a breach of this Agreement, of any Group Member Agreement, of any agreement contemplated herein or therein, or of any duty stated or implied by law or equity, if the resolution or course of action in respect of such conflict of interest is (i) approved by Special Approval, (ii) approved by the vote of a majority of the Common Units (excluding Common Units owned by the General Partner and its Affiliates), (iii) on terms no less favorable to the Partnership than those generally being provided to or available from unrelated third parties or (iv) fair and reasonable to the Partnership, taking into account the totality of the relationships between the parties involved (including other transactions that may be particularly favorable or advantageous to the Partnership). The General Partner shall be authorized but not required in connection with its resolution of such conflict of interest to seek Special Approval of such resolution, and the General Partner may also adopt a resolution or course of action that has not received Special Approval. If Special Approval is not sought and the Board of Directors of the General Partner determines that the resolution or course of action taken with respect to a conflict of interest satisfies either of the standards set forth in clauses (iii) or (iv) above, then it shall be presumed that, in making its decision, the Board of Directors of the General Partner acted in good faith, and in any proceeding brought by any Limited Partner or by or on behalf of such Limited Partner or any other Limited Partner or the Partnership challenging such approval, the Person bringing or prosecuting such proceeding shall have the burden of overcoming such presumption. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this Agreement, the existence of the conflicts of interest described in the Registration Statement are hereby approved by all Partners.
      (b) Whenever the General Partner makes a determination or takes or declines to take any other action, or any of its Affiliates causes it to do so, in its capacity as the general partner of the Partnership as opposed to in its individual capacity, whether under this Agreement, any Group Member Agreement or any other agreement contemplated hereby or otherwise, then, unless another express standard is provided for in this Agreement, the General Partner, or such Affiliates causing it to do so, shall make such determination or take or decline to take such other action in good faith and shall not be subject to any other or different standards imposed by this Agreement, any Group Member Agreement, any other agreement contemplated hereby or under the Marshall Islands Act or any other law, rule or regulation or at equity. In order for a determination or other action to be in “good faith” for purposes of this Agreement, the Person or Persons making such determination or taking or declining to take such other action must reasonably believe that the determination or other action is in the best interests of the Partnership, unless the context otherwise requires.
      (c) Whenever the General Partner makes a determination or takes or declines to take any other action, or any of its Affiliates causes it to do so, in its individual capacity as opposed to in its capacity as the general partner of the Partnership, whether under this Agreement, any Group Member Agreement or any other agreement contemplated hereby or otherwise, then the General Partner, or such Affiliates causing it to do so, are entitled to make such determination or to take or decline to take such other action free of any fiduciary duty or obligation whatsoever to the Partnership or any Limited Partner, and the General Partner, or such Affiliates causing it to do so, shall not be required to act in good faith or pursuant to any other standard imposed by this Agreement, any Group Member Agreement, any other agreement contemplated hereby or under the Marshall Islands Act or any other law, rule or regulation or at equity. By way of illustration and not of limitation, whenever the phrase, “at the option of the General Partner,” or some variation of that phrase, is used in this Agreement, it indicates that the General Partner is acting in its individual capacity. For the avoidance of doubt, whenever the General Partner votes or transfers its Units, General Partner Interest or Incentive Distribution Rights, to the extent permitted under

A-33


 

this Agreement, or refrains from voting or transferring its Units, General Partner Units or Incentive Distribution Rights, as appropriate, it shall be acting in its individual capacity. The General Partner’s organizational documents may provide that determinations to take or decline to take any action in its individual, rather than representative, capacity may or shall be determined by its members, if the General Partner is a limited liability company, stockholders, if the General Partner is a corporation, or the members or stockholders of the General Partner’s general partner, if the General Partner is a limited partnership.
      (d) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this Agreement, the General Partner and its Affiliates shall have no duty or obligation, express or implied, to (i) sell or otherwise dispose of any asset of the Partnership Group other than in the ordinary course of business or (ii) permit any Group Member to use any facilities or assets of the General Partner and its Affiliates, except as may be provided in contracts entered into from time to time specifically dealing with such use. Any determination by the General Partner or any of its Affiliates to enter into such contracts shall be at its option.
      (e) Except as expressly set forth in this Agreement, neither the General Partner nor any other Indemnitee shall have any duties or liabilities, including fiduciary duties, to the Partnership or any Limited Partner and the provisions of this Agreement, to the extent that they restrict, eliminate or otherwise modify the duties and liabilities, including fiduciary duties, of the General Partner or any other Indemnitee otherwise existing at law or in equity, are agreed by the Partners to replace such other duties and liabilities of the General Partner or such other Indemnitee.
      (f) The Unitholders hereby authorize the General Partner, on behalf of the Partnership as a partner or member of a Group Member, to approve of actions by the general partner or managing member of such Group Member similar to those actions permitted to be taken by the General Partner pursuant to this Section 7.9.
      Section  7.10      Other Matters Concerning the General Partner.
      (a) The General Partner may rely and shall be protected in acting or refraining from acting upon any resolution, certificate, statement, instrument, opinion, report, notice, request, consent, order, bond, debenture or other paper or document believed by it to be genuine and to have been signed or presented by the proper party or parties.
      (b) The General Partner may consult with legal counsel, accountants, appraisers, management consultants, investment bankers and other consultants and advisers selected by it, and any act taken or omitted to be taken in reliance upon the advice or opinion (including an Opinion of Counsel) of such Persons as to matters that the General Partner reasonably believes to be within such Person’s professional or expert competence shall be conclusively presumed to have been done or omitted in good faith and in accordance with such advice or opinion.
      (c) The General Partner shall have the right, in respect of any of its powers or obligations hereunder, to act through any of its duly authorized officers, a duly appointed attorney or attorneys-in -fact or the duly authorized officers of the Partnership.
      Section  7.11      Purchase or Sale of Partnership Securities.
      The General Partner may cause the Partnership to purchase or otherwise acquire Partnership Securities; provided, however , that the General Partner may not cause any Group Member to purchase Subordinated Units during the Subordination Period. As long as Partnership Securities are held by any Group Member, such Partnership Securities shall not be considered Outstanding for any purpose, except as otherwise provided herein. The General Partner or any Affiliate of the General Partner may also purchase or otherwise acquire and sell or otherwise dispose of Partnership Securities for its own account, subject to the provisions of Articles IV and X.

A-34


 

      Section  7.12      Registration Rights of the General Partner and its Affiliates.
      (a) If (i) the General Partner or any Affiliate of the General Partner (including for purposes of this Section 7.12, any Person that is an Affiliate of the General Partner at the date hereof notwithstanding that it may later cease to be an Affiliate of the General Partner) holds Partnership Securities that it desires to sell and (ii) Rule 144 of the Securities Act (or any successor rule or regulation to Rule 144) or another exemption from registration is not available to enable such holder of Partnership Securities (the “Holder”) to dispose of the number of Partnership Securities it desires to sell at the time it desires to do so without registration under the Securities Act, then at the option and upon the request of the Holder, the Partnership shall file with the Commission as promptly as practicable after receiving such request, and use all commercially reasonable efforts to cause to become effective and remain effective for a period of not less than six months following its effective date or such shorter period as shall terminate when all Partnership Securities covered by such registration statement have been sold, a registration statement under the Securities Act registering the offering and sale of the number of Partnership Securities specified by the Holder; provided, however , that the Partnership shall not be required to effect more than three registrations pursuant to this Section 7.12(a); and, provided further , that if the Conflicts Committee determines in good faith that the requested registration would be materially detrimental to the Partnership and its Partners because such registration would (x) materially interfere with a significant acquisition, reorganization or other similar transaction involving the Partnership, (y) require premature disclosure of material information that the Partnership has a bona fide business purpose for preserving as confidential or (z) render the Partnership unable to comply with requirements under applicable securities laws, then the Partnership shall have the right to postpone such requested registration for a period of not more than six months after receipt of the Holder’s request, such right pursuant to this Section 7.12(a) not to be utilized more than once in any 12-month period. Except as provided in the preceding sentence, the Partnership shall be deemed not to have used all commercially reasonable efforts to keep the registration statement effective during the applicable period if it voluntarily takes any action that would result in Holders of Partnership Securities covered thereby not being able to offer and sell such Partnership Securities at any time during such period, unless such action is required by applicable law. In connection with any registration pursuant to the immediately preceding sentence, the Partnership shall (i) promptly prepare and file (A) such documents as may be necessary to register or qualify the securities subject to such registration under the securities laws of such states as the Holder shall reasonably request ( provided, however , that no such qualification shall be required in any jurisdiction where, as a result thereof, the Partnership would become subject to general service of process or to taxation or qualification to do business as a foreign corporation or partnership doing business in such jurisdiction solely as a result of such registration), and (B) such documents as may be necessary to apply for listing or to list the Partnership Securities subject to such registration on such National Securities Exchange as the Holder shall reasonably request, and (ii) do any and all other acts and things that may be necessary or appropriate to enable the Holder to consummate a public sale of such Partnership Securities in such states. Except as set forth in Section 7.12(c), all costs and expenses of any such registration and offering (other than the underwriting discounts and commissions) shall be paid by the Partnership, without reimbursement by the Holder.
      (b) If the Partnership shall at any time propose to file a registration statement under the Securities Act for an offering of Partnership Securities for cash (other than an offering relating solely to an employee benefit plan), the Partnership shall use all commercially reasonable efforts to include such number or amount of Partnership Securities held by any Holder in such registration statement as the Holder shall request; provided, however , that the Partnership is not required to make any effort or take any action to so include the Partnership Securities of the Holder once the registration statement becomes or is declared effective by the Commission, including any registration statement providing for the offering from time to time of Partnership Securities pursuant to Rule 415 of the Securities Act. If the proposed offering pursuant to this Section 7.12(b) shall be an underwritten offering, then, in the event that the managing underwriter or managing underwriters of such offering advise the Partnership and the Holder in writing that in their opinion the inclusion of all or some of the Holder’s Partnership Securities would adversely and materially affect the success of the offering, the Partnership shall include in such offering only that

A-35


 

number or amount, if any, of Partnership Securities held by the Holder that, in the opinion of the managing underwriter or managing underwriters, will not so adversely and materially affect the offering. Except as set forth in Section 7.12(c), all costs and expenses of any such registration and offering (other than the underwriting discounts and commissions) shall be paid by the Partnership, without reimbursement by the Holder.
      (c) If underwriters are engaged in connection with any registration referred to in this Section 7.12, the Partnership shall provide indemnification, representations, covenants, opinions and other assurance to the underwriters in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to such underwriters. Further, in addition to and not in limitation of the Partnership’s obligation under Section 7.7, the Partnership shall, to the fullest extent permitted by law, indemnify and hold harmless the Holder, its officers, directors and each Person who controls the Holder (within the meaning of the Securities Act) and any agent thereof (collectively, “Indemnified Persons”) from and against any and all losses, claims, demands, actions, causes of action, assessments, damages, liabilities (joint or several), costs and expenses (including interest, penalties and reasonable attorneys’ fees and disbursements), resulting to, imposed upon, or incurred by the Indemnified Persons, directly or indirectly, under the Securities Act or otherwise (hereinafter referred to in this Section 7.12(c) as a “claim” and in the plural as “claims”) based upon, arising out of or resulting from any untrue statement or alleged untrue statement of any material fact contained in any registration statement under which any Partnership Securities were registered under the Securities Act or any state securities or Blue Sky laws, in any preliminary prospectus or issuer free writing prospectus as defined in Rule 433 of the Securities Act (if used prior to the effective date of such registration statement), or in any summary or final prospectus or in any amendment or supplement thereto (if used during the period the Partnership is required to keep the registration statement current), or arising out of, based upon or resulting from the omission or alleged omission to state therein a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary to make the statements made therein not misleading; provided, however , that the Partnership shall not be liable to any Indemnified Person to the extent that any such claim arises out of, is based upon or results from an untrue statement or alleged untrue statement or omission or alleged omission made in such registration statement, such preliminary, summary or final prospectus or such amendment or supplement, in reliance upon and in conformity with written information furnished to the Partnership by or on behalf of such Indemnified Person specifically for use in the preparation thereof.
      (d) The provisions of Section 7.12(a) and Section 7.12(b) shall continue to be applicable with respect to the General Partner (and any of the General Partner’s Affiliates) after it ceases to be a general partner of the Partnership, during a period of two years subsequent to the effective date of such cessation and for so long thereafter as is required for the Holder to sell all of the Partnership Securities with respect to which it has requested during such two-year period inclusion in a registration statement otherwise filed or that a registration statement be filed; provided, however , that the Partnership shall not be required to file successive registration statements covering the same Partnership Securities for which registration was demanded during such two-year period. The provisions of Section 7.12(c) shall continue in effect thereafter.
      (e) The rights to cause the Partnership to register Partnership Securities pursuant to this Section 7.12 may be assigned (but only with all related obligations) by a Holder to a transferee or assignee of such Partnership Securities, provided (i) the Partnership is, within a reasonable time after such transfer, furnished with written notice of the name and address of such transferee or assignee and the Partnership Securities with respect to which such registration rights are being assigned, and (ii) such transferee or assignee agrees in writing to be bound by and subject to the terms set forth in this Section 7.12.
      (f) Any request to register Partnership Securities pursuant to this Section 7.12 shall (i) specify the Partnership Securities intended to be offered and sold by the Person making the request, (ii) express such Person’s present intent to offer such Partnership Securities for distribution, (iii) describe the nature or method of the proposed offer and sale of Partnership Securities, and (iv) contain the undertaking of such Person to provide all such information and materials and take all action as may be required in order to

A-36


 

permit the Partnership to comply with all applicable requirements in connection with the registration of such Partnership Securities.
      Section  7.13      Reliance by Third Parties.
      Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this Agreement, any Person dealing with the Partnership shall be entitled to assume that the General Partner and any officer of the General Partner authorized by the General Partner to act on behalf of and in the name of the Partnership has full power and authority to encumber, sell or otherwise use in any manner any and all assets of the Partnership and to enter into any authorized contracts on behalf of the Partnership, and such Person shall be entitled to deal with the General Partner or any such officer as if it were the Partnership’s sole party in interest, both legally and beneficially. Each Limited Partner hereby waives any and all defenses or other remedies that may be available against such Person to contest, negate or disaffirm any action of the General Partner or any such officer in connection with any such dealing. In no event shall any Person dealing with the General Partner or any such officer or its representatives be obligated to ascertain that the terms of this Agreement have been complied with or to inquire into the necessity or expedience of any act or action of the General Partner or any such officer or its representatives. Each and every certificate, document or other instrument executed on behalf of the Partnership by the General Partner, its officers or its representatives shall be conclusive evidence in favor of any and every Person relying thereon or claiming thereunder that (a) at the time of the execution and delivery of such certificate, document or instrument, this Agreement was in full force and effect, (b) the Person executing and delivering such certificate, document or instrument was duly authorized and empowered to do so for and on behalf of the Partnership and (c) such certificate, document or instrument was duly executed and delivered in accordance with the terms and provisions of this Agreement and is binding upon the Partnership.
ARTICLE VIII
BOOKS, RECORDS, ACCOUNTING AND REPORTS
      Section  8.1      Records and Accounting.
      The General Partner shall keep or cause to be kept at the principal office of the Partnership appropriate books and records with respect to the Partnership’s business, including all books and records necessary to provide to the Limited Partners any information required to be provided pursuant to Section 3.4(a). Any books and records maintained by or on behalf of the Partnership in the regular course of its business, including the record of the Record Holders of Units or other Partnership Securities, books of account and records of Partnership proceedings, may be kept on, or be in the form of, computer disks, hard drives, punch cards, magnetic tape, photographs, micrographics or any other information storage device; provided, however , that the books and records so maintained are convertible into clearly legible written form within a reasonable period of time. The books of the Partnership shall be maintained, for financial reporting purposes, on an accrual basis in accordance with U.S. GAAP.
      Section  8.2      Fiscal Year.
      The fiscal year of the Partnership shall be a fiscal year ending December 31.
      Section  8.3      Reports.
      (a) As soon as practicable, but in no event later than 120 days after the close of each fiscal year of the Partnership, the General Partner shall cause to be mailed or made available, by any reasonable means (including posting on the Partnership’s website), to each Record Holder of a Unit as of a date selected by the General Partner, an annual report containing financial statements of the Partnership for such fiscal year of the Partnership, presented in accordance with U.S. GAAP, including a balance sheet and statements of operations, Partnership equity and cash flows, such statements to be audited by a firm of independent public accountants selected by the General Partner.

A-37


 

      (b) As soon as practicable, but in no event later than 90 days after the close of each Quarter except the last Quarter of each fiscal year, the General Partner shall cause to be mailed or made available, by any reasonable means (including posting on the Partnership’s website), to each Record Holder of a Unit, as of a date selected by the General Partner, a report containing unaudited financial statements of the Partnership and such other information as may be required by applicable law, regulation or rule of any National Securities Exchange on which the Units are listed or admitted to trading, or as the General Partner determines to be necessary or appropriate.
ARTICLE IX
TAX MATTERS
      Section  9.1      Tax Elections and Information.
      (a) The Partnership has elected to be treated as an association taxable as a corporation for United States federal income tax purposes. Except as otherwise provided herein, the General Partner shall determine whether the Partnership should make any other elections permitted by the Code.
      (b) The tax information reasonably required by Record Holders generally for United States federal and state income tax reporting purposes with respect to a taxable year shall be furnished to them within 90 days of the close of the calendar year in which the Partnership’s taxable year ends.
      Section  9.2      Withholding.
      Notwithstanding any other provision of this Agreement, the General Partner is authorized to take any action that may be required to cause the Partnership and other Group Members to comply with any withholding requirements established under the Code or any other U.S. federal, state or local or any non-U.S.  law including pursuant to Sections 1441, 1442 and 1445 of the Code. To the extent that the Partnership is required or elects to withhold and pay over to any taxing authority any amount resulting from the distribution of income to any Partner, the General Partner may treat the amount withheld as a distribution of cash pursuant to Section 6.2 in the amount of such withholding from such Partner.
      Section  9.3      Conduct of Operations.
      The General Partner shall use commercially reasonable efforts to conduct the business of the Partnership and its Affiliates in a manner that does not require a holder of Common Units to file a tax return in any jurisdiction with which the holder has no contact other than through ownership of Common Units.
      For greater certainty, the General Partner shall conduct the affairs and governance of the Partnership so that the General Partner and the Partnership are not residents of Canada for purposes of Canada’s tax legislation and neither the General Partner nor the Partnership is carrying on business in Canada for purposes of such legislation.
ARTICLE X
ADMISSION OF PARTNERS
      Section  10.1      Admission of Initial Limited Partners.
      Upon the issuance by the Partnership of Common Units, Subordinated Units and Incentive Distribution Rights to the General Partner, Teekay Shipping Corporation and the Underwriters as described in Sections 5.1(b), 5.2 and 5.3, the General Partner shall admit such parties to the Partnership as Initial Limited Partners in respect of the Common Units, Subordinated Units or Incentive Distribution Rights issued to them.

A-38


 

      Section  10.2      Admission of Additional Limited Partners.
      (a) By acceptance of the transfer of any Limited Partner Interests in accordance with Article IV or the acceptance of any Limited Partner Interests issued pursuant to Article V or pursuant to a merger or consolidation pursuant to Article XIV, each transferee of, or other such Person acquiring, a Limited Partner Interest (including any nominee holder or an agent or representative acquiring such Limited Partner Interests for the account of another Person) (i) shall be admitted to the Partnership as a Limited Partner with respect to the Limited Partner Interests so transferred or issued to such Person when any such transfer, issuance or admission is reflected in the books and records of the Partnership and such Limited Partner becomes the Record Holder of the Limited Partner Interests so transferred, (ii) shall become bound by the terms of this Agreement, (iii) represents that the transferee has the capacity, power and authority to enter into this Agreement, (iv) grants the powers of attorney set forth in this Agreement and (v) makes the consents and waivers contained in this Agreement, all with or without execution of this Agreement by such Person. The transfer of any Limited Partner Interests and the admission of any new Limited Partner shall not constitute an amendment to this Agreement. A Person may become a Limited Partner or Record Holder of a Limited Partner Interest without the consent or approval of any of the Partners. A Person may not become a Limited Partner until such Person acquires a Limited Partner Interest and such Person is reflected in the books and records of the Partnership as the Record Holder of such Limited Partner Interest.
      (b) The name and mailing address of each Limited Partner shall be listed on the books and records of the Partnership maintained for such purpose by the Partnership or the Transfer Agent. The General Partner shall update the books and records of the Partnership from time to time as necessary to reflect accurately the information therein (or shall cause the Transfer Agent to do so, as applicable). A Limited Partner Interest may be represented by a Certificate, as provided in Section 4.1 hereof.
      (c) Any transfer of a Limited Partner Interest shall not entitle the transferee to receive distributions or to any other rights to which the transferor was entitled until the transferee becomes a Limited Partner pursuant to Section 10.1(a).
      Section  10.3      Admission of Successor General Partner.
      A successor General Partner approved pursuant to Section 11.1 or 11.2 or the transferee of or successor to all of the General Partner Interest (represented by General Partner Units) pursuant to Section 4.6 who is proposed to be admitted as a successor General Partner shall be admitted to the Partnership as the General Partner, effective immediately prior to the withdrawal or removal of the predecessor or transferring General Partner, pursuant to Section 11.1 or 11.2 or the transfer of the General Partner Interest (represented by General Partner Units) pursuant to Section 4.6; provided, however , that no such successor shall be admitted to the Partnership until compliance with the terms of Section 4.6 has occurred and such successor has executed and delivered such other documents or instruments as may be required to effect such admission. Any such successor shall, subject to the terms hereof, carry on the business of the members of the Partnership Group without dissolution.
      Section  10.4      Amendment of Agreement and Certificate of Limited Partnership.
      To effect the admission to the Partnership of any Partner, the General Partner shall take all steps necessary or appropriate under the Marshall Islands Act to amend the records of the Partnership to reflect such admission and, if necessary, to prepare as soon as practicable an amendment to this Agreement and, if required by law, the General Partner shall prepare and file an amendment to the Certificate of Limited Partnership and the General Partner may for this purpose, among others, exercise the power of attorney granted pursuant to Section 2.6.

A-39


 

ARTICLE XI
WITHDRAWAL OR REMOVAL OF PARTNERS
      Section  11.1      Withdrawal of the General Partner.
      (a) The General Partner shall be deemed to have withdrawn from the Partnership upon the occurrence of any one of the following events (each such event herein referred to as an “Event of Withdrawal”):
        (i) The General Partner voluntarily withdraws from the Partnership by giving written notice to the other Partners;
 
        (ii) The General Partner transfers all of its rights as General Partner pursuant to Section 4.6;
 
        (iii) The General Partner is removed pursuant to Section 11.2;
 
        (iv) The General Partner (A) makes a general assignment for the benefit of creditors; (B) files a voluntary petition in bankruptcy; (C) files a petition or answer seeking for itself a liquidation, dissolution or similar relief (but not a reorganization) under any law; (D) files an answer or other pleading admitting or failing to contest the material allegations of a petition filed against the General Partner in a proceeding of the type described in clauses (A), (B) or (C) of this Section 11.1(a)(iv); or (E) seeks, consents to or acquiesces in the appointment of a trustee, receiver or liquidator of the General Partner or of all or any substantial part of its properties;
 
        (v) The General Partner is adjudged bankrupt or insolvent, or has entered against it an order for relief in any bankruptcy or insolvency proceeding;
 
        (vi) (A) in the event the General Partner is a corporation, the filing of a certificate of dissolution, or its equivalent, for the corporation or the revocation of its charter and the expiration of ninety (90) days after the date of notice to the corporation of revocation without a reinstatement of its charter; (B) in the event the General Partner is a partnership or a limited liability company, the dissolution and commencement of winding up of the General Partner; (C) in the event the General Partner is acting in such capacity by virtue of being a trustee of a trust, the termination of the trust; (D) in the event the General Partner is a natural person, his death or adjudication of incompetency; and (E) otherwise in the event of the termination of the General Partner.
If an Event of Withdrawal specified in Section 11.1(a)(iv), (v) or (vi)(A), (B), (C) or (E) occurs, the withdrawing General Partner shall give notice to the Limited Partners within 30 days after such occurrence. The Partners hereby agree that only the Events of Withdrawal described in this Section 11.1 shall result in the withdrawal of the General Partner from the Partnership.
      (b) Withdrawal of the General Partner from the Partnership upon the occurrence of an Event of Withdrawal shall not constitute a breach of this Agreement under the following circumstances: (i) at any time during the period beginning on the Closing Date and ending at 12:00 midnight, prevailing Eastern Time, on December 31, 2016, the General Partner voluntarily withdraws by giving at least 90 days’ advance notice of its intention to withdraw to the Limited Partners; provided, however , that prior to the effective date of such withdrawal, the withdrawal is approved by Unitholders holding at least a majority of the Outstanding Common Units (excluding Common Units held by the General Partner and its Affiliates) and the General Partner delivers to the Partnership an Opinion of Counsel (“Withdrawal Opinion of Counsel”) that such withdrawal (following the selection of the successor General Partner) would not result in the loss of the limited liability of any Limited Partner or any Group Member; (ii) at any time after 12:00 midnight, prevailing Eastern Time, on December 31, 2016, the General Partner voluntarily withdraws by giving at least 90 days’ advance notice to the Unitholders, such withdrawal to take effect on the date specified in such notice; (iii) at any time that the General Partner ceases to be the General Partner pursuant to Section 11.1(a)(ii) or is removed pursuant to Section 11.2; or (iv) notwithstanding clause (i) of this sentence, at any time that the General Partner voluntarily withdraws by giving at least 90 days’ advance notice of its intention to withdraw to the Limited Partners, such withdrawal to take effect

A-40


 

on the date specified in the notice, if at the time such notice is given one Person and its Affiliates (other than the General Partner and its Affiliates) own beneficially or of record or control at least 50% of the Outstanding Units. The withdrawal of the General Partner from the Partnership upon the occurrence of an Event of Withdrawal shall also constitute the withdrawal of the General Partner as general partner or managing member, if any, to the extent applicable, of the other Group Members. If the General Partner gives a notice of withdrawal pursuant to Section 11.1(a)(i), the holders of a Unit Majority, may, prior to the effective date of such withdrawal, elect a successor General Partner. The Person so elected as successor General Partner shall automatically become the successor general partner or managing member, to the extent applicable, of the other Group Members of which the General Partner is a general partner or a managing member. If, prior to the effective date of the General Partner’s withdrawal, a successor is not selected by the Unitholders as provided herein or, if applicable, the Partnership does not receive a Withdrawal Opinion of Counsel, the Partnership shall be dissolved in accordance with Section 12.1. Any successor General Partner elected in accordance with the terms of this Section 11.1 shall be subject to the provisions of Section 10.3.
      Section  11.2      Removal of the General Partner.
      The General Partner may be removed if such removal is approved by the Unitholders holding at least 66 2 / 3 % of the Outstanding Units (including Units held by the General Partner and its Affiliates voting as a single class). Any such action by such holders for removal of the General Partner must also provide for the election of a successor General Partner by the Unitholders holding a majority of the outstanding Common Units voting as a class and a majority of the outstanding Subordinated Units voting as a class (including Units held by the General Partner and its Affiliates). Such removal shall be effective immediately following the admission of a successor General Partner pursuant to Section 10.3. The removal of the General Partner shall also automatically constitute the removal of the General Partner as general partner or managing member, to the extent applicable, of the other Group Members of which the General Partner is a general partner or a managing member. If a Person is elected as a successor General Partner in accordance with the terms of this Section 11.2, such Person shall, upon admission pursuant to Section 10.3, automatically become a successor general partner or managing member, to the extent applicable, of the other Group Members of which the General Partner is a general partner or a managing member. The right of the holders of Outstanding Units to remove the General Partner shall not exist or be exercised unless the Partnership has received an Opinion of Counsel opining as to the matters covered by a Withdrawal Opinion of Counsel. Any successor General Partner elected in accordance with the terms of this Section 11.2 shall be subject to the provisions of Section 10.3.
      Section  11.3      Interest of Departing General Partner and Successor General Partner.
      (a) In the event of (i) withdrawal of the General Partner under circumstances where such withdrawal does not violate this Agreement or (ii) removal of the General Partner by the holders of Outstanding Units under circumstances where Cause does not exist, if the successor General Partner is elected in accordance with the terms of Section 11.1 or 11.2, the Departing General Partner shall have the option, exercisable prior to the effective date of the departure of such Departing General Partner, to require its successor to purchase its General Partner Interest (represented by General Partner Units) and its general partner interest (or equivalent interest), if any, in the other Group Members and all of the Incentive Distribution Rights (collectively, the “Combined Interest”) in exchange for an amount in cash equal to the fair market value of such Combined Interest, such amount to be determined and payable as of the effective date of its departure. If the General Partner is removed by the Unitholders under circumstances where Cause exists or if the General Partner withdraws under circumstances where such withdrawal violates this Agreement, and if a successor General Partner is elected in accordance with the terms of Section 11.1 or 11.2 (or if the business of the Partnership is continued pursuant to Section 12.2 and the successor General Partner is not the former General Partner), such successor shall have the option, exercisable prior to the effective date of the departure of such Departing General Partner (or, in the event the business of the Partnership is continued, prior to the date the business of the Partnership is continued), to purchase the Combined Interest for such fair market value of such Combined Interest of the Departing General Partner. In either event, the Departing General Partner shall be entitled to receive

A-41


 

all reimbursements due such Departing General Partner pursuant to Section 7.4, including any employee-related liabilities (including severance liabilities), incurred in connection with the termination of any employees employed by the Departing General Partner for the benefit of the Partnership or the other Group Members.
      For purposes of this Section 11.3(a), the fair market value of the Departing General Partner’s Combined Interest shall be determined by agreement between the Departing General Partner and its successor or, failing agreement within 30 days after the effective date of such Departing General Partner’s departure, by an independent investment banking firm or other independent expert selected by the Departing General Partner and its successor, which, in turn, may rely on other experts, and the determination of which shall be conclusive as to such matter. If such parties cannot agree upon one independent investment banking firm or other independent expert within 45 days after the effective date of such departure, then the Departing General Partner shall designate an independent investment banking firm or other independent expert, the Departing General Partner’s successor shall designate an independent investment banking firm or other independent expert, and such firms or experts shall mutually select a third independent investment banking firm or independent expert, which third independent investment banking firm or other independent expert shall determine the fair market value of the Combined Interest of the Departing General Partner. In making its determination, such third independent investment banking firm or other independent expert may consider the then current trading price of Units on any National Securities Exchange on which Units are then listed or admitted to trading, the value of the Partnership’s assets, the rights and obligations of the Departing General Partner and other factors it may deem relevant.
      (b) If the Combined Interest is not purchased in the manner set forth in Section 11.3(a), the Departing General Partner (or its transferee) shall become a Limited Partner and its Combined Interest shall be converted into Common Units pursuant to a valuation made by an investment banking firm or other independent expert selected pursuant to Section 11.3(a), without reduction in such Partnership Interest (but subject to proportionate dilution by reason of the admission of its successor). Any successor General Partner shall indemnify the Departing General Partner (or its transferee) as to all debts and liabilities of the Partnership arising on or after the date on which the Departing General Partner (or its transferee) becomes a Limited Partner. For purposes of this Agreement, conversion of the Combined Interest of the Departing General Partner to Common Units will be characterized as if the Departing General Partner (or its transferee) contributed its Combined Interest to the Partnership in exchange for the newly issued Common Units.
      (c) If a successor General Partner is elected in accordance with the terms of Section 11.1 or 11.2 (or if the Partnership is continued pursuant to Section 12.2 and the successor General Partner is not the former General Partner) and the option described in Section 11.3(a) is not exercised by the party entitled to do so, the successor General Partner shall, at the effective date of its admission to the Partnership, contribute to the Partnership cash in the amount equal to the product of the Percentage Interest of the Departing General Partner and the Net Agreed Value of the Partnership’s assets on such date. In such event, such successor General Partner shall, subject to the following sentence, be entitled to its Percentage Interest of all Partnership allocations and distributions to which the Departing General Partner was entitled. In addition, the successor General Partner shall cause this Agreement to be amended to reflect that, from and after the date of such successor General Partner’s admission, the successor General Partner’s interest in all Partnership distributions and allocations shall be its Percentage Interest.
      Section  11.4      Termination of Subordination Period, Conversion of Subordinated Units and Extinguishment of Cumulative Common Unit Arrearages.
      Notwithstanding any provision of this Agreement, if the General Partner is removed as general partner of the Partnership under circumstances where Cause does not exist and no Units held by the General Partner and its Affiliates are voted in favor of such removal, (i) the Subordination Period will end and all Outstanding Subordinated Units will immediately and automatically convert into Common Units on a one-for-one basis, (ii) all Cumulative Common Unit Arrearages on the Common Units will be extinguished and (iii) the General Partner will have the right to convert its General Partner Interest

A-42


 

(represented by General Partner Units) and its Incentive Distribution Rights into Common Units or to receive cash in exchange therefor, as provided in Section 11.3.
      Section  11.5      Withdrawal of Limited Partners.
      No Limited Partner shall have any right to withdraw from the Partnership; provided, however , that when a transferee of a Limited Partner’s Limited Partner Interest becomes a Record Holder of the Limited Partner Interest so transferred, such transferring Limited Partner shall cease to be a Limited Partner with respect to the Limited Partner Interest so transferred.
ARTICLE XII
DISSOLUTION AND LIQUIDATION
      Section  12.1      Dissolution.
      The Partnership shall not be dissolved by the admission of additional Limited Partners or by the admission of a successor General Partner in accordance with the terms of this Agreement. Upon the removal or withdrawal of the General Partner, if a successor General Partner is elected pursuant to Sections 11.1 or 11.2, the Partnership shall not be dissolved and such successor General Partner shall continue the business of the Partnership. The Partnership shall dissolve, and (subject to Section 12.2) its affairs shall be wound up, upon:
        (a) an election to dissolve the Partnership by the General Partner that is approved by the holders of a Unit Majority;
 
        (b) at any time there are no Limited Partners, unless the Partnership is continued without dissolution in accordance with the Marshall Islands Act;
 
        (c) the entry of a decree of judicial dissolution of the Partnership pursuant to the provisions of the Marshall Islands Act; or
 
        (d) an Event of Withdrawal of the General Partner as provided in Section 11.1(a) (other than Section 11.1(a)(ii)), unless a successor is elected and an Opinion of Counsel is received as provided in Sections 11.1(b) or 11.2 and such successor is admitted to the Partnership pursuant to Section 10.3.
      Section  12.2      Continuation of the Business of the Partnership After Dissolution.
      Upon (a) dissolution of the Partnership following an Event of Withdrawal caused by the withdrawal or removal of the General Partner as provided in Sections 11.1(a)(i) or (iii) and the failure of the Partners to select a successor to such Departing General Partner pursuant to Sections 11.1 or 11.2, then within 90 days thereafter, or (b) dissolution of the Partnership upon an event constituting an Event of Withdrawal as defined in Sections 11.1(a)(iv), (v) or (vi), then, to the maximum extent permitted by law, within 180 days thereafter, the holders of a Unit Majority may elect to continue the business of the Partnership on the same terms and conditions set forth in this Agreement by appointing as a successor General Partner a Person approved by the holders of a Unit Majority. Unless such an election is made within the applicable time period as set forth above, the Partnership shall conduct only activities necessary to wind up its affairs. If such an election is so made, then:
        (i) the Partnership shall continue without dissolution unless earlier dissolved in accordance with this Article XII;
 
        (ii) if the successor General Partner is not the former General Partner, then the interest of the former General Partner shall be treated in the manner provided in Section 11.3; and
 
        (iii) the successor General Partner shall be admitted to the Partnership as General Partner, effective as of the Event of Withdrawal, by agreeing in writing to be bound by this Agreement; provided, however , that the right of the holders of a Unit Majority to approve a successor General

A-43


 

  Partner and to reconstitute and to continue the business of the Partnership shall not exist and may not be exercised unless the Partnership has received an Opinion of Counsel that the exercise of the right would not result in the loss of limited liability of any Limited Partner.

      Section  12.3      Liquidator.
      Upon dissolution of the Partnership, unless the business of the Partnership is continued pursuant to Section 12.2, the General Partner shall select one or more Persons to act as Liquidator. The Liquidator (if other than the General Partner) shall be entitled to receive such compensation for its services as may be approved by holders of at least a majority of the Outstanding Common Units and Subordinated Units voting as a single class. The Liquidator (if other than the General Partner) shall agree not to resign at any time without 15 days’ prior notice and may be removed at any time, with or without cause, by notice of removal approved by holders of at least a majority of the Outstanding Common Units and Subordinated Units voting as a single class. Upon dissolution, removal or resignation of the Liquidator, a successor and substitute Liquidator (who shall have and succeed to all rights, powers and duties of the original Liquidator) shall within 30 days thereafter be approved by holders of at least a majority of the Outstanding Common Units and Subordinated Units voting as a single class. The right to approve a successor or substitute Liquidator in the manner provided herein shall be deemed to refer also to any such successor or substitute Liquidator approved in the manner herein provided. Except as expressly provided in this Article XII, the Liquidator approved in the manner provided herein shall have and may exercise, without further authorization or consent of any of the parties hereto, all of the powers conferred upon the General Partner under the terms of this Agreement (but subject to all of the applicable limitations, contractual and otherwise, upon the exercise of such powers, other than the limitation on sale set forth in Section 7.3(b)) necessary or appropriate to carry out the duties and functions of the Liquidator hereunder for and during the period of time required to complete the winding up and liquidation of the Partnership as provided for herein.
      Section  12.4      Liquidation.
      The Liquidator shall proceed to dispose of the assets of the Partnership, discharge its liabilities, and otherwise wind up its affairs in such manner and over such period as determined by the Liquidator, subject to Section 60 of the Marshall Islands Act and the following:
        (a) The assets may be disposed of by public or private sale or by distribution in kind to one or more Partners on such terms as the Liquidator and such Partner or Partners may agree. If any property is distributed in kind, the Partner receiving the property shall be deemed for purposes of Section 12.4(c) to have received cash equal to its fair market value, and contemporaneously therewith, appropriate cash distributions must be made to the other Partners. The Liquidator may defer liquidation or distribution of the Partnership’s assets for a reasonable time if it determines that an immediate sale or distribution of all or some of the Partnership’s assets would be impractical or would cause undue loss to the Partners. The Liquidator may distribute the Partnership’s assets, in whole or in part, in kind if it determines that a sale would be impractical or would cause undue loss to the Partners.
 
        (b) Liabilities of the Partnership include amounts owed to the Liquidator as compensation for serving in such capacity (subject to the terms of Section 12.3) and amounts to Partners otherwise than in respect of their distribution rights under Article VI. With respect to any liability that is contingent, conditional or unmatured or is otherwise not yet due and payable, the Liquidator shall either settle such claim for such amount as it thinks appropriate or establish a reserve of cash or other assets to provide for its payment. When paid, any unused portion of the reserve shall be distributed as additional liquidation proceeds.

A-44


 

        (c) All property and all cash in excess of that required to discharge liabilities as provided in Section 12.4(b) shall be distributed as follows:
        (i) If the Current Market Price of the Common Units as of the date three trading days prior to the announcement of the proposed liquidation exceeds the Unrecovered Capital for a Common Unit plus the Cumulative Common Unit Arrearage:
        (A) First, (x) to the General Partner in accordance with its Percentage Interest and (y) to all the Unitholders holding Common Units, Pro Rata, a percentage equal to 100% less the General Partner’s Percentage Interest, until there has been distributed in respect of each Common Unit then Outstanding an amount equal to such Current Market Price of a Common Unit;
 
        (B) Second (x) to the General Partner in accordance with its Percentage Interest and (y) to all Unitholders holding Subordinated Units, Pro Rata, a percentage equal to 100% less the General Partner’s Percentage Interest, until there has been distributed in respect of each Subordinated Unit then Outstanding an amount equal to such Current Market Price of a Common Unit; and
 
        (C) Thereafter (x) to the General Partner in accordance with its Percentage Interest; (y) 48% to the holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights, Pro Rata; and (z) to all Unitholders, Pro Rata, a percentage equal to 100% less the sum of the percentages applicable to subclauses (x) and (y) of this clause (i)(C);
        (ii) If the Current Market Price of the Common Units as of the date three trading days prior to the announcement of the proposed liquidation is equal to or less than the Unrecovered Capital for a Common Unit plus the Cumulative Common Unit Arrearage:
        (A) First, (x) to the General Partner in accordance with its Percentage Interest and (y) to all the Unitholders holding Common Units, Pro Rata, a percentage equal to 100% less the General Partner’s Percentage Interest, until there has been distributed in respect of each Common Unit then Outstanding an amount equal to the Unrecovered Capital for a Common Unit;
 
        (B) Second, (x) to the General Partner in accordance with its Percentage Interest and (y) to all Unitholders holding Common Units, Pro Rata, a percentage equal to 100% less the General Partner’s Percentage Interest, until there has been distributed in respect of each Common Unit then Outstanding an amount equal to the Cumulative Common Unit Arrearage;
 
        (C) Third, (x) to the General Partner in accordance with its Percentage Interest and (y) to all Unitholders holding Subordinated Units, Pro Rata, a percentage equal to 100% less the General Partner’s Percentage Interest, until there has been distributed in respect of each Subordinated Unit then Outstanding an amount equal to the Unrecovered Capital for a Common Unit (as calculated prior to the distribution specified in clause (ii)(A) above); and
 
        (D) Thereafter, (x) to the General Partner in accordance with its Percentage Interest; (y) 48% to the holders of the Incentive Distribution Rights, Pro Rata; and (z) to all Unitholders, Pro Rata, a percentage equal to 100% less the sum of the percentages applicable to subclauses (x) and (y) of this clause (ii)(D);
      Section  12.5      Cancellation of Certificate of Limited Partnership.
      Upon the completion of the distribution of Partnership cash and property as provided in Section 12.4 in connection with the liquidation of the Partnership, the Certificate of Limited Partnership and all qualifications of the Partnership as a foreign limited partnership in jurisdictions other than the Marshall

A-45


 

Islands shall be canceled and such other actions as may be necessary to terminate the Partnership shall be taken.
      Section  12.6      Return of Contributions.
      The General Partner shall not be personally liable for, and shall have no obligation to contribute or loan any monies or property to the Partnership to enable it to effectuate, the return of the Capital Contributions of the Limited Partners or Unitholders, or any portion thereof, it being expressly understood that any such return shall be made solely from Partnership assets.
      Section  12.7      Waiver of Partition.
      To the maximum extent permitted by law, each Partner hereby waives any right to partition of the Partnership property.
ARTICLE XIII
AMENDMENT OF PARTNERSHIP AGREEMENT; MEETINGS; RECORD DATE
      Section  13.1      Amendments to be Adopted Solely by the General Partner.
      Each Partner agrees that the General Partner, without the approval of any Partner, may amend any provision of this Agreement and execute, swear to, acknowledge, deliver, file and record whatever documents may be required in connection therewith, to reflect:
        (a) a change in the name of the Partnership, the location of the principal place of business of the Partnership, the registered agent of the Partnership or the registered office of the Partnership;
 
        (b) admission, substitution, withdrawal or removal of Partners in accordance with this Agreement;
 
        (c) a change that the General Partner determines to be necessary or appropriate to qualify or continue the qualification of the Partnership as a limited partnership or a partnership in which the Limited Partners have limited liability under the laws of The Marshall Islands or to ensure that the Group Members will not be treated as associations taxable as corporations or otherwise taxed as entities for Marshall Islands income tax purposes;
 
        (d) a change that the General Partner determines (i) does not adversely affect the Limited Partners (including any particular class of Partnership Interests as compared to other classes of Partnership Interests) in any material respect, (ii) to be necessary or appropriate to (A) satisfy any requirements, conditions or guidelines contained in any opinion, directive, order, ruling or regulation of any Marshall Islands authority (including the Marshall Islands Act) or (B) facilitate the trading of the Units (including the division of any class or classes of Outstanding Units into different classes to facilitate uniformity of tax consequences within such classes of Units) or comply with any rule, regulation, guideline or requirement of any National Securities Exchange on which the Units are or will be listed, (iii) to be necessary or appropriate in connection with action taken by the General Partner pursuant to Section 5.10 or (iv) is required to effect the intent expressed in the Registration Statement or the intent of the provisions of this Agreement or is otherwise contemplated by this Agreement;
 
        (e) a change in the fiscal year or taxable year of the Partnership and any other changes that the General Partner determines to be necessary or appropriate as a result of a change in the fiscal year or taxable year of the Partnership including, if the General Partner shall so determine, a change in the definition of “Quarter” and the dates on which distributions are to be made by the Partnership;
 
        (f) an amendment that is necessary, in the Opinion of Counsel, to prevent the Partnership, or the General Partner or its directors, officers, trustees or agents from in any manner being subjected to the provisions of the U.S. Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended, the U.S. Investment Advisers Act of 1940, as amended, or “plan asset” regulations adopted under the U.S. Employee

A-46


 

  Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended, regardless of whether such regulations are substantially similar to plan asset regulations currently applied or proposed by the United States Department of Labor;
 
        (g) an amendment that the General Partner determines to be necessary or appropriate in connection with the authorization of issuance of any class or series of Partnership Securities pursuant to Section 5.5;
 
        (h) any amendment expressly permitted in this Agreement to be made by the General Partner acting alone;
 
        (i) an amendment effected, necessitated or contemplated by a Merger Agreement approved in accordance with Section 14.3;
 
        (j) an amendment that the General Partner determines to be necessary or appropriate to reflect and account for the formation by the Partnership of, or investment by the Partnership in, any corporation, partnership, joint venture, limited liability company or other Person, in connection with the conduct by the Partnership of activities permitted by the terms of Section 2.4;
 
        (k) a conversion, merger or conveyance pursuant to Section 14.3(d); or
 
        (l) any other amendments substantially similar to the foregoing.

      Section  13.2      Amendment Procedures.
      Except as provided in Sections 13.1 and 13.3, all amendments to this Agreement shall be made in accordance with the following requirements. Amendments to this Agreement may be proposed only by the General Partner; provided, however , that the General Partner shall have no duty or obligation to propose any amendment to this Agreement and may decline to do so free of any fiduciary duty or obligation whatsoever to the Partnership or any Limited Partner and, in declining to propose an amendment, to the fullest extent permitted by applicable law shall not be required to act in good faith or pursuant to any other standard imposed by this Agreement, any Group Member Agreement, any other agreement contemplated hereby or under the Marshall Islands Act or any other law, rule or regulation. A proposed amendment shall be effective upon its approval by the General Partner and the holders of a Unit Majority, unless a greater or different percentage is required under this Agreement or by the Marshall Islands Act. Each proposed amendment that requires the approval of the holders of a specified percentage of Outstanding Units shall be set forth in a writing that contains the text of the proposed amendment. If such an amendment is proposed, the General Partner shall seek the written approval of the requisite percentage of Outstanding Units or call a meeting of the Unitholders to consider and vote on such proposed amendment. The General Partner shall notify all Record Holders upon final adoption of any such proposed amendments.
      Section  13.3      Amendment Requirements.
      (a) Notwithstanding the provisions of Sections 13.1 and 13.2, no provision of this Agreement that establishes a percentage of Outstanding Units (including Units deemed owned by the General Partner) required to take any action shall be amended, altered, changed, repealed or rescinded in any respect that would have the effect of reducing such voting percentage unless such amendment is approved by the written consent or the affirmative vote of holders of Outstanding Units whose aggregate Outstanding Units constitute not less than the voting requirement sought to be reduced.
      (b) Notwithstanding the provisions of Sections 13.1 and 13.2, no amendment to this Agreement may (i) enlarge the obligations of any Limited Partner without its consent, unless such enlargement shall be deemed to have occurred as a result of an amendment approved pursuant to Section 13.3(c), (ii) enlarge the obligations of, restrict in any way any action by or rights of, or reduce in any way the amounts distributable, reimbursable or otherwise payable to, the General Partner or any of its Affiliates without its consent, which consent may be given or withheld at the General Partner’s option, (iii) change

A-47


 

Section 12.1(a), or (iv) change the term of the Partnership or, except as set forth in Section 12.1(a), give any Person the right to dissolve the Partnership.
      (c) Except as provided in Section 14.3, and without limitation of the General Partner’s authority to adopt amendments to this Agreement without the approval of any Partners as contemplated in Section 13.1, any amendment that would have a material adverse effect on the rights or preferences of any class of Partnership Interests in relation to other classes of Partnership Interests must be approved by the holders of not less than a majority of the Outstanding Partnership Interests of the class affected.
      (d) Notwithstanding any other provision of this Agreement, except for amendments pursuant to Section 13.1 and except as otherwise provided by Section 14.3(b), no amendments shall become effective without the approval of the holders of at least 90% of the Outstanding Units voting as a single class unless the Partnership obtains an Opinion of Counsel to the effect that such amendment will not affect the limited liability of any Limited Partner under applicable law.
      (e) Except as provided in Section 13.1, this Section 13.3 shall only be amended with the approval of the holders of at least 90% of the Outstanding Units.
      Section  13.4      Special Meetings.
      All acts of Limited Partners to be taken pursuant to this Agreement shall be taken in the manner provided in this Article XIII. Special meetings of the Limited Partners may be called by the General Partner or by Limited Partners owning 20% or more of the Outstanding Units of the class or classes for which a meeting is proposed. Limited Partners shall call a special meeting by delivering to the General Partner one or more requests in writing stating that the signing Limited Partners wish to call a special meeting and indicating the general or specific purposes for which the special meeting is to be called. Within 60 days after receipt of such a call from Limited Partners or within such greater time as may be reasonably necessary for the Partnership to comply with any statutes, rules, regulations, listing agreements or similar requirements governing the holding of a meeting or the solicitation of proxies for use at such a meeting, the General Partner shall send a notice of the meeting to the Limited Partners either directly or indirectly through the Transfer Agent. A meeting shall be held at a time and place determined by the General Partner on a date not less than 10 days nor more than 60 days after the mailing of notice of the meeting. Limited Partners shall not vote on matters that would cause the Limited Partners to be deemed to be taking part in the management and control of the business and affairs of the Partnership so as to jeopardize the Limited Partners’ limited liability under the Marshall Islands Act or the law of any other jurisdiction in which the Partnership is qualified to do business.
      Section  13.5      Notice of a Meeting.
      Notice of a meeting called pursuant to Section 13.4 shall be given to the Record Holders of the class or classes of Units for which a meeting is proposed in writing by mail or other means of written communication in accordance with Section 16.1. The notice shall be deemed to have been given at the time when deposited in the mail or sent by other means of written communication.
      Section  13.6      Record Date.
      For purposes of determining the Limited Partners entitled to notice of or to vote at a meeting of the Limited Partners or to give approvals without a meeting as provided in Section 13.11, the General Partner may set a Record Date, which shall not be less than 10 nor more than 60 days before (a) the date of the meeting (unless such requirement conflicts with any rule, regulation, guideline or requirement of any National Securities Exchange on which the Units are listed or admitted to trading, in which case the rule, regulation, guideline or requirement of such National Securities Exchange shall govern) or (b) in the event that approvals are sought without a meeting, the date by which Limited Partners are requested in writing by the General Partner to give such approvals. If the General Partner does not set a Record Date, then (a) the Record Date for determining the Limited Partners entitled to notice of or to vote at a meeting of the Limited Partners shall be the close of business on the day next preceding the day on which notice is given, and (b) the Record Date for determining the Limited Partners entitled to give approvals

A-48


 

without a meeting shall be the date the first written approval is deposited with the Partnership in care of the General Partner in accordance with Section 13.11.
      Section  13.7      Adjournment.
      When a meeting is adjourned to another time or place, notice need not be given of the adjourned meeting and a new Record Date need not be fixed, if the time and place thereof are announced at the meeting at which the adjournment is taken, unless such adjournment shall be for more than 45 days. At the adjourned meeting, the Partnership may transact any business which might have been transacted at the original meeting. If the adjournment is for more than 45 days or if a new Record Date is fixed for the adjourned meeting, a notice of the adjourned meeting shall be given in accordance with this Article XIII.
      Section  13.8      Waiver of Notice; Approval of Meeting; Approval of Minutes.
      The transactions of any meeting of Limited Partners, however called and noticed, and whenever held, shall be as valid as if it had occurred at a meeting duly held after regular call and notice, if a quorum is present either in person or by proxy. Attendance of a Limited Partner at a meeting shall constitute a waiver of notice of the meeting, except when the Limited Partner attends the meeting for the express purpose of objecting, at the beginning of the meeting, to the transaction of any business because the meeting is not lawfully called or convened; and except that attendance at a meeting is not a waiver of any right to disapprove the consideration of matters required to be included in the notice of the meeting, but not so included, if the disapproval is expressly made at the meeting.
      Section  13.9      Quorum and Voting.
      The holders of a majority of the Outstanding Units of the class or classes for which a meeting has been called (including Outstanding Units deemed owned by the General Partner) represented in person or by proxy shall constitute a quorum at a meeting of Limited Partners of such class or classes unless any such action by the Limited Partners requires approval by holders of a greater percentage of such Units, in which case the quorum shall be such greater percentage. At any meeting of the Limited Partners duly called and held in accordance with this Agreement at which a quorum is present, the act of Limited Partners holding Outstanding Units that in the aggregate represent a majority of the Outstanding Units entitled to vote and be present in person or by proxy at such meeting shall be deemed to constitute the act of all Limited Partners, unless a greater or different percentage is required with respect to such action under the provisions of this Agreement, in which case the act of the Limited Partners holding Outstanding Units that in the aggregate represent at least such greater or different percentage shall be required. The Limited Partners present at a duly called or held meeting at which a quorum is present may continue to transact business until adjournment, notwithstanding the withdrawal of enough Limited Partners to leave less than a quorum, if any action taken (other than adjournment) is approved by the required percentage of Outstanding Units specified in this Agreement (including Outstanding Units deemed owned by the General Partner). In the absence of a quorum, any meeting of Limited Partners may be adjourned from time to time by the affirmative vote of holders of at least a majority of the Outstanding Units entitled to vote at such meeting (including Outstanding Units deemed owned by the General Partner) represented either in person or by proxy, but no other business may be transacted, except as provided in Section 13.7.
      Section  13.10      Conduct of a Meeting.
      The General Partner shall have full power and authority concerning the manner of conducting any meeting of the Limited Partners or solicitation of approvals in writing, including the determination of Persons entitled to vote, the existence of a quorum, the satisfaction of the requirements of Section 13.4, the conduct of voting, the validity and effect of any proxies and the determination of any controversies, votes or challenges arising in connection with or during the meeting or voting. The General Partner shall designate a Person to serve as chairman of any meeting and shall further designate a Person to take the minutes of any meeting. All minutes shall be kept with the records of the Partnership maintained by the General Partner. The General Partner may make such other regulations consistent with applicable law and this Agreement as it may deem advisable concerning the conduct of any meeting of the Limited Partners or solicitation of approvals in writing, including regulations in regard to the appointment of proxies, the

A-49


 

appointment and duties of inspectors of votes and approvals, the submission and examination of proxies and other evidence of the right to vote, and the revocation of approvals in writing.
      Section  13.11      Action Without a Meeting.
      If authorized by the General Partner, any action that may be taken at a meeting of the Limited Partners may be taken without a meeting if an approval in writing setting forth the action so taken is signed by Limited Partners owning not less than the minimum percentage of the Outstanding Units (including Units deemed owned by the General Partner) that would be necessary to authorize or take such action at a meeting at which all the Limited Partners were present and voted (unless such provision conflicts with any rule, regulation, guideline or requirement of any National Securities Exchange on which the Units are listed or admitted to trading, in which case the rule, regulation, guideline or requirement of such National Securities Exchange shall govern). Prompt notice of the taking of action without a meeting shall be given to the Limited Partners who have not approved the action in writing. The General Partner may specify that any written ballot submitted to Limited Partners for the purpose of taking any action without a meeting shall be returned to the Partnership within the time period, which shall be not less than 20 days, specified by the General Partner. If a ballot returned to the Partnership does not vote all of the Units held by the Limited Partners, the Partnership shall be deemed to have failed to receive a ballot for the Units that were not voted. If approval of the taking of any action by the Limited Partners is solicited by any Person other than by or on behalf of the General Partner, the written approvals shall have no force and effect unless and until (a) they are deposited with the Partnership in care of the General Partner, (b) approvals sufficient to take the action proposed are dated as of a date not more than 90 days prior to the date sufficient approvals are deposited with the Partnership and (c) an Opinion of Counsel is delivered to the General Partner to the effect that the exercise of such right and the action proposed to be taken with respect to any particular matter (i) will not cause the Limited Partners to be deemed to be taking part in the management and control of the business and affairs of the Partnership so as to jeopardize the Limited Partners’ limited liability, and (ii) is otherwise permissible under the applicable statutes then governing the rights, duties and liabilities of the Partnership and the Partners.
      Section  13.12      Right to Vote and Related Matters.
      (a) Only those Record Holders of the Units on the Record Date set pursuant to Section 13.6 (and also subject to the limitations contained in the definition of “Outstanding”) shall be entitled to notice of, and to vote at, a meeting of Limited Partners or to act with respect to matters as to which the holders of the Outstanding Units have the right to vote or to act. All references in this Agreement to votes of, or other acts that may be taken by, the Outstanding Units shall be deemed to be references to the votes or acts of the Record Holders of such Outstanding Units.
      (b) With respect to Units that are held for a Person’s account by another Person (such as a broker, dealer, bank, trust company or clearing corporation, or an agent of any of the foregoing), in whose name such Units are registered, such other Person shall, in exercising the voting rights in respect of such Units on any matter, and unless the arrangement between such Persons provides otherwise, vote such Units in favor of, and at the direction of, the Person who is the beneficial owner, and the Partnership shall be entitled to assume it is so acting without further inquiry. The provisions of this Section 13.12(b) (as well as all other provisions of this Agreement) are subject to the provisions of Section 4.3.
ARTICLE XIV
MERGER
      Section  14.1      Authority.
      The Partnership may merge or consolidate with or into one or more corporations, limited liability companies, statutory trusts or associations, real estate investment trusts, common law trusts or unincorporated businesses, including a partnership (whether general or limited (including a limited liability partnership)), formed under the laws of The Marshall Islands or the state of Delaware or any other state

A-50


 

of the United States, pursuant to a written agreement of merger or consolidation (“Merger Agreement”) in accordance with this Article XIV.
      Section  14.2      Procedure for Merger or Consolidation.
      Merger or consolidation of the Partnership pursuant to this Article XIV requires the prior consent of the General Partner; provided, however , that, to the fullest extent permitted by law, the General Partner shall have no duty or obligation to consent to any merger or consolidation of the Partnership and may decline to do so free of any fiduciary duty or obligation whatsoever to the Partnership or any Limited Partner and, in declining to consent to a merger or consolidation, shall not be required to act in good faith or pursuant to any other standard imposed by this Agreement, any Group Member Agreement, any other agreement contemplated hereby or under the Marshall Islands Act or any other law, rule or regulation or at equity. If the General Partner shall determine to consent to the merger or consolidation, the General Partner shall approve the Merger Agreement, which shall set forth:
        (a) the names and jurisdictions of formation or organization of each of the business entities proposing to merge or consolidate;
 
        (b) the name and jurisdiction of formation or organization of the business entity that is to survive the proposed merger or consolidation (the “Surviving Business Entity”);
 
        (c) the terms and conditions of the proposed merger or consolidation;
 
        (d) the manner and basis of exchanging or converting the equity securities of each constituent business entity for, or into, cash, property or interests, rights, securities or obligations of the Surviving Business Entity; and (i) if any general or limited partner interests, securities or rights of any constituent business entity are not to be exchanged or converted solely for, or into, cash, property or interests, rights, securities or obligations of the Surviving Business Entity, the cash, property or general or limited partner interests, rights, securities or obligations of any general or limited partnership, corporation, trust, limited liability company, unincorporated business or other Person (other than the Surviving Business Entity) which the holders of such interests, securities or rights are to receive in exchange for, or upon conversion of their interests, securities or rights, and (ii) in the case of securities represented by certificates, upon the surrender of such certificates, which cash, property or interests, rights, securities or obligations of the Surviving Business Entity or any general or limited partnership, corporation, trust, limited liability company, unincorporated business or other Person (other than the Surviving Business Entity), or evidences thereof, are to be delivered;
 
        (e) a statement of any changes in the constituent documents or the adoption of new constituent documents (the articles or certificate of incorporation, articles of trust, declaration of trust, certificate or agreement of limited partnership or other similar charter or governing document) of the Surviving Business Entity to be effected by such merger or consolidation;
 
        (f) the effective time of the merger, which may be the date of the filing of the certificate of merger pursuant to Section 14.4 or a later date specified in or determinable in accordance with the Merger Agreement (provided, that if the effective time of the merger is to be later than the date of the filing of such certificate of merger, the effective time shall be fixed at a date or time certain at or prior to the time of the filing of such certificate of merger and stated therein); and
 
        (g) such other provisions with respect to the proposed merger or consolidation that the General Partner determines to be necessary or appropriate.
      Section  14.3      Approval by Limited Partners of Merger or Consolidation.
      (a) Except as provided in Sections 14.3(d) and 14.3(e), the General Partner, upon its approval of the Merger Agreement, shall direct that the Merger Agreement be submitted to a vote of Limited Partners, whether at a special meeting or by written consent, in either case in accordance with the requirements of Article XIII. A copy or a summary of the Merger Agreement shall be included in or enclosed with the notice of a special meeting or the written consent.

A-51


 

      (b) Except as provided in Sections 14.3(d) and 14.3(e), the Merger Agreement shall be approved upon receiving the affirmative vote or consent of the holders of a Unit Majority.
      (c) Except as provided in Sections 14.3(d) and 14.3(e), after such approval by vote or consent of the Limited Partners, and at any time prior to the filing of the certificate of merger pursuant to Section 14.4, the merger or consolidation may be abandoned pursuant to provisions therefor, if any, set forth in the Merger Agreement.
      (d) Notwithstanding anything else contained in this Article XIV or in this Agreement, the General Partner is permitted, without Limited Partner approval, to convert the Partnership or any Group Member into a new limited liability entity, to merge the Partnership or any Group Member into, or convey all of the Partnership’s assets to, another limited liability entity which shall be newly formed and shall have no assets, liabilities or operations at the time of such conversion, merger or conveyance other than those it receives from the Partnership or other Group Member if (i) the General Partner has received an Opinion of Counsel that the conversion, merger or conveyance, as the case may be, would not result in the loss of the limited liability of any Limited Partner, (ii) the sole purpose of such conversion, merger or conveyance is to effect a mere change in the legal form of the Partnership into another limited liability entity and (iii) the governing instruments of the new entity provide the Limited Partners and the General Partner with the same rights and obligations as are herein contained.
      (e) Additionally, notwithstanding anything else contained in this Article XIV or in this Agreement, the General Partner is permitted, without Limited Partner approval, to merge or consolidate the Partnership with or into another entity if (i) the General Partner has received an Opinion of Counsel that the merger or consolidation, as the case may be, would not result in the loss of the limited liability of any Limited Partner, (ii) the merger or consolidation would not result in an amendment to this Agreement, other than any amendments that could be adopted pursuant to Section 13.1, (iii) the Partnership is the Surviving Business Entity in such merger or consolidation, (iv) each Unit outstanding immediately prior to the effective date of the merger or consolidation is to be an identical Unit of the Partnership after the effective date of the merger or consolidation, and (v) the number of Partnership Securities to be issued by the Partnership in such merger or consolidation does not exceed 20% of the Partnership Securities Outstanding immediately prior to the effective date of such merger or consolidation.
      Section  14.4      Certificate of Merger.
      Upon the required approval by the General Partner and the Unitholders of a Merger Agreement, a certificate of merger shall be executed and filed in conformity with the requirements of the Marshall Islands Act.
      Section  14.5      Amendment of Partnership Agreement.
      Pursuant to Section 20(2) of the Marshall Islands Act, an agreement of merger or consolidation approved in accordance with Section 20(2) of the Marshall Islands Act may (a) effect any amendment to this Agreement or (b) effect the adoption of a new partnership agreement for a limited partnership if it is the Surviving Business Entity. Any such amendment or adoption made pursuant to this Section 14.5 shall be effective at the effective time or date of the merger or consolidation.
      Section  14.6      Effect of Merger.
      (a) At the effective time of the certificate of merger:
        (i) all of the rights, privileges and powers of each of the business entities that has merged or consolidated, and all property, real, personal and mixed, and all debts due to any of those business entities and all other things and causes of action belonging to each of those business entities, shall be vested in the Surviving Business Entity and after the merger or consolidation shall be the property of the Surviving Business Entity to the extent they were of each constituent business entity;
 
        (ii) the title to any real property vested by deed or otherwise in any of those constituent business entities shall not revert and is not in any way impaired because of the merger or consolidation;

A-52


 

        (iii) all rights of creditors and all liens on or security interests in property of any of those constituent business entities shall be preserved unimpaired; and
 
        (iv) all debts, liabilities and duties of those constituent business entities shall attach to the Surviving Business Entity and may be enforced against it to the same extent as if the debts, liabilities and duties had been incurred or contracted by it.
      (b) A merger or consolidation effected pursuant to this Article shall not be deemed to result in a transfer or assignment of assets or liabilities from one entity to another.
ARTICLE XV
RIGHT TO ACQUIRE LIMITED PARTNER INTERESTS
      Section  15.1      Right to Acquire Limited Partner Interests.
      (a) Notwithstanding any other provision of this Agreement, if at any time the General Partner and its Affiliates hold more than 80% of the total Limited Partner Interests of any class then Outstanding, the General Partner shall then have the right, which right it may assign and transfer in whole or in part to the Partnership or any Affiliate of the General Partner, exercisable at its option, to purchase all, but not less than all, of such Limited Partner Interests of such class then Outstanding held by Persons other than the General Partner and its Affiliates, at the greater of (x) the Current Market Price as of the date three days prior to the date that the notice described in Section 15.1(b) is mailed and (y) the highest price paid by the General Partner or any of its Affiliates for any such Limited Partner Interest of such class purchased during the 90-day period preceding the date that the notice described in Section 15.1(b) is mailed.
      (b) If the General Partner, any Affiliate of the General Partner or the Partnership elects to exercise the right to purchase Limited Partner Interests granted pursuant to Section 15.1(a), the General Partner shall deliver to the Transfer Agent notice of such election to purchase (the “Notice of Election to Purchase”) and shall cause the Transfer Agent to mail a copy of such Notice of Election to Purchase to the Record Holders of Limited Partner Interests of such class (as of a Record Date selected by the General Partner) at least 10, but not more than 60, days prior to the Purchase Date. Such Notice of Election to Purchase shall also be published for a period of at least three consecutive days in at least two daily newspapers of general circulation printed in the English language and published in the Borough of Manhattan, New York. The Notice of Election to Purchase shall specify the Purchase Date and the price (determined in accordance with Section 15.1(a)) at which Limited Partner Interests will be purchased and state that the General Partner, its Affiliate or the Partnership, as the case may be, elects to purchase such Limited Partner Interests, upon surrender of Certificates representing such Limited Partner Interests in exchange for payment, at such office or offices of the Transfer Agent as the Transfer Agent may specify, or as may be required by any National Securities Exchange on which such Limited Partner Interests are listed. Any such Notice of Election to Purchase mailed to a Record Holder of Limited Partner Interests at his address as reflected in the records of the Transfer Agent shall be conclusively presumed to have been given regardless of whether the owner receives such notice. On or prior to the Purchase Date, the General Partner, its Affiliate or the Partnership, as the case may be, shall deposit with the Transfer Agent cash in an amount sufficient to pay the aggregate purchase price of all of such Limited Partner Interests to be purchased in accordance with this Section 15.1. If the Notice of Election to Purchase shall have been duly given as aforesaid at least 10 days prior to the Purchase Date, and if on or prior to the Purchase Date the deposit described in the preceding sentence has been made for the benefit of the holders of Limited Partner Interests subject to purchase as provided herein, then from and after the Purchase Date, notwithstanding that any Certificate shall not have been surrendered for purchase, all rights of the holders of such Limited Partner Interests (including any rights pursuant to Articles IV, V, VI and XII) shall thereupon cease, except the right to receive the applicable purchase price (determined in accordance with Section 15.1(a)) for Limited Partner Interests therefor, without interest, upon surrender to the Transfer Agent of the Certificates representing such Limited Partner Interests, and such Limited Partner Interests shall thereupon be deemed to be transferred to the General Partner, its Affiliate or the

A-53


 

Partnership, as the case may be, on the record books of the Transfer Agent and the Partnership, and the General Partner or any Affiliate of the General Partner, or the Partnership, as the case may be, shall be deemed to be the owner of all such Limited Partner Interests from and after the Purchase Date and shall have all rights as the owner of such Limited Partner Interests (including all rights as owner of such Limited Partner Interests pursuant to Articles IV, V, VI and XII).
      (c) At any time from and after the Purchase Date, a holder of an Outstanding Limited Partner Interest subject to purchase as provided in this Section 15.1 may surrender his Certificate evidencing such Limited Partner Interest to the Transfer Agent in exchange for payment of the amount described in Section 15.1(a), without interest thereon.
ARTICLE XVI
GENERAL PROVISIONS
      Section  16.1      Addresses and Notices.
      Any notice, demand, request, report or proxy materials required or permitted to be given or made to a Partner under this Agreement shall be in writing and shall be deemed given or made when delivered in person or when sent by first class United States mail or by other means of written communication to the Partner at the address described below. Any notice, payment or report to be given or made to a Partner hereunder shall be deemed conclusively to have been given or made, and the obligation to give such notice or report or to make such payment shall be deemed conclusively to have been fully satisfied, upon sending of such notice, payment or report to the Record Holder of such Partnership Securities at his address as shown on the records of the Transfer Agent or as otherwise shown on the records of the Partnership, regardless of any claim of any Person who may have an interest in such Partnership Securities by reason of any assignment or otherwise. An affidavit or certificate of making of any notice, payment or report in accordance with the provisions of this Section 16.1 executed by the General Partner, the Transfer Agent or the mailing organization shall be prima facie evidence of the giving or making of such notice, payment or report. If any notice, payment or report addressed to a Record Holder at the address of such Record Holder appearing on the books and records of the Transfer Agent or the Partnership is returned by the United States Postal Service marked to indicate that the United States Postal Service is unable to deliver it, such notice, payment or report and any subsequent notices, payments and reports shall be deemed to have been duly given or made without further mailing (until such time as such Record Holder or another Person notifies the Transfer Agent or the Partnership of a change in his address) if they are available for the Partner at the principal office of the Partnership for a period of one year from the date of the giving or making of such notice, payment or report to the other Partners. Any notice to the Partnership shall be deemed given if received by the General Partner at the principal office of the Partnership designated pursuant to Section 2.3. The General Partner may rely and shall be protected in relying on any notice or other document from a Partner or other Person if believed by it to be genuine.
      Section  16.2      Further Action.
      The parties shall execute and deliver all documents, provide all information and take or refrain from taking action as may be necessary or appropriate to achieve the purposes of this Agreement.
      Section  16.3      Binding Effect.
      This Agreement shall be binding upon and inure to the benefit of the parties hereto and their respective heirs, executors, administrators, successors, legal representatives and permitted assigns.
      Section  16.4      Integration.
      This Agreement constitutes the entire agreement among the parties hereto pertaining to the subject matter hereof and supersedes all prior agreements and understandings pertaining thereto.

A-54


 

      Section  16.5      Creditors.
      None of the provisions of this Agreement shall be for the benefit of, or shall be enforceable by, any creditor of the Partnership.
      Section  16.6      Waiver.
      No failure by any party to insist upon the strict performance of any covenant, duty, agreement or condition of this Agreement or to exercise any right or remedy consequent upon a breach thereof shall constitute waiver of any such breach of any other covenant, duty, agreement or condition.
      Section  16.7      Counterparts.
      This Agreement may be executed in counterparts, all of which together shall constitute an agreement binding on all the parties hereto, notwithstanding that all such parties are not signatories to the original or the same counterpart. Each party shall become bound by this Agreement immediately upon affixing its signature hereto or, in the case of a Person acquiring a Limited Partner Interest, pursuant to Section 10.2(a) without execution hereof.
      Section  16.8      Applicable Law.
      This Agreement shall be construed in accordance with and governed by the laws of The Republic of the Marshall Islands, without regard to the principles of conflicts of law.
      Section  16.9      Invalidity of Provisions.
      If any provision of this Agreement is or becomes invalid, illegal or unenforceable in any respect, the validity, legality and enforceability of the remaining provisions contained herein shall not be affected thereby.
      Section  16.10      Consent of Partners.
      Each Partner hereby expressly consents and agrees that, whenever in this Agreement it is specified that an action may be taken upon the affirmative vote or consent of less than all of the Partners, such action may be so taken upon the concurrence of less than all of the Partners and each Partner shall be bound by the results of such action.
      Section  16.11      Facsimile Signatures.
      The use of facsimile signatures affixed in the name and on behalf of the transfer agent and registrar of the Partnership on certificates representing Common Units is expressly permitted by this Agreement.
      Section  16.12      Third-Party Beneficiaries.
      Each Partner agrees that any Indemnitee shall be entitled to assert rights and remedies hereunder as a third-party beneficiary hereto with respect to those provisions of this Agreement affording a right, benefit or privilege to such Indemnitee.
[REMAINDER OF THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK]

A-55


 

      IN WITNESS WHEREOF , the parties hereto have executed this First Amended and Restated Agreement of Limited Partnership as a Deed as of the date first written above.
  GENERAL PARTNER:
 
  Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C.
  By: 
 
 
  Name: 
  Title:
 
  ORGANIZATIONAL LIMITED PARTNER:
 
  Teekay Shipping Corporation
  By: 
 
 
  Name: 
  Title:
 
  LIMITED PARTNERS:
 
  All Limited Partners now and hereafter admitted as Limited Partners of the Partnership, pursuant to powers of attorney now and hereafter executed in favor of, and granted and delivered to the General Partner.
 
  Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C.
  By: 
 
 
  Name: 
  Title:

A-56


 

EXHIBIT A
to the First Amended and Restated
Agreement of Limited Partnership of
Teekay Offshore Partners L.P.
Certificate Evidencing Common Units
Representing Limited Partner Interests in
Teekay Offshore Partners L.P.
         
No. 
              Common Units  
      In accordance with Section 4.1 of the First Amended and Restated Agreement of Limited Partnership of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P., as amended, supplemented or restated from time to time (the “Partnership Agreement” ), Teekay Offshore Partners L.P., a Marshall Islands limited partnership (the “Partnership” ), hereby certifies that                     (the “Holder” ) is the registered owner of Common Units representing limited partner interests in the Partnership (the “Common Units” ) transferable on the books of the Partnership, in person or by duly authorized attorney, upon surrender of this Certificate properly endorsed. The rights, preferences and limitations of the Common Units are set forth in, and this Certificate and the Common Units represented hereby are issued and shall in all respects be subject to the terms and provisions of, the Partnership Agreement. Copies of the Partnership Agreement are on file at, and will be furnished without charge on delivery of written request to the Partnership at, the principal office of the Partnership located at Bayside House, Bayside Executive Park, West Bay Street and Blake Road, P.O. Box AP-59212, Nassau, Commonwealth of the Bahamas. Capitalized terms used herein but not defined shall have the meanings given them in the Partnership Agreement.
      The Holder, by accepting this Certificate, is deemed to have (i) requested admission as, and agreed to become, a Limited Partner and to have agreed to comply with and be bound by and to have executed the Partnership Agreement, (ii) represented and warranted that the Holder has all right, power and authority and, if an individual, the capacity necessary to enter into the Partnership Agreement, (iii) granted the powers of attorney provided for in the Partnership Agreement and (iv) made the waivers and given the consents and approvals contained in the Partnership Agreement.
      This Certificate shall not be valid for any purpose unless it has been countersigned and registered by the Transfer Agent and Registrar.
     
Dated: 
  Teekay Offshore Partners L.P.
 
Countersigned and Registered by:
  By: Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C.,
     its General Partner
 
    By: 
     
as Transfer Agent and Registrar
       Title:
 
By: 
  By: 
     
Authorized Signature
  Secretary

A-57


 

[Reverse of Certificate]
ABBREVIATIONS
      The following abbreviations, when used in the inscription on the face of this Certificate, shall be construed as follows according to applicable laws or regulations:
             
TEN COM
    as tenants in common   UNIF GIFT/TRANSFERS MIN ACT
                                     Custodian
TEN ENT
    as tenants by the entireties   (Cust)                                (Minor)
JT TEN
    as joint tenants with right of survivorship and not as tenants in common   under Uniform Gifts /Transfers to CD Minors Act (State)
Additional abbreviations, though not in the above list, may also be used.
ASSIGNMENT OF COMMON UNITS
in
TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS L.P.
FOR VALUE RECEIVED,                                         hereby assigns, conveys, sells and transfers unto
     
     
(Please print or typewrite name and address of Assignee)   (Please insert Social Security or other identifying number of Assignee)
                      Common Units representing limited partner interests evidenced by this Certificate, subject to the Partnership Agreement, and does hereby irrevocably constitute and appoint                     as its attorney-in -fact with full power of substitution to transfer the same on the books of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P.
         
 
Date: 
 
  NOTE:   The signature to any endorsement hereon must correspond with the name as written upon the face of this Certificate in every particular, without alteration, enlargement or change.
THE SIGNATURE(S) MUST BE
       
GUARANTEED BY AN ELIGIBLE
     
 
GUARANTOR INSTITUTION (BANKS,       (Signature)
STOCKBROKERS, SAVINGS AND LOAN ASSOCIATIONS AND CREDIT UNIONS        
WITH MEMBERSHIP IN AN APPROVED      
 
SIGNATURE GUARANTEE MEDALLION
      (Signature)
PROGRAM), PURSUANT TO
       
S.E.C. RULE 17Ad-15
       
      No transfer of the Common Units evidenced hereby will be registered on the books of the Partnership, unless the Certificate evidencing the Common Units to be transferred is surrendered for registration or transfer.

A-58


 

APPENDIX B
GLOSSARY OF TERMS
Adjusted operating surplus: For any period, operating surplus generated during that period is adjusted to:
 
(a) Decrease operating surplus by:
 
          (1) any net increase in working capital borrowings (including our proportionate share of any changes in working capital borrowings by certain subsidiaries we do not wholly own, including OPCO) with respect to that period; and
 
          (2) any net reduction in cash reserves for operating expenditures (including our proportionate share of such cash reserves of certain subsidiaries we do not wholly own) with respect to that period not relating to an operating expenditure made with respect to that period; and
 
(b) increase operating surplus by:
 
          (1) any net decrease in working capital borrowings (including our proportionate share of any changes in working capital borrowings of certain subsidiaries we do not wholly own) with respect to that period; and
 
          (2) any net increase in cash reserves for operating expenditures (including our proportionate share of such cash reserves of certain subsidiaries we do not wholly own) with respect to that period required by any debt instrument for the repayment of principal, interest or premium.
 
Adjusted operating surplus does not include that portion of operating surplus included in clause (a)(1) of the definition of operating surplus.
 
Aframax tanker: An oil tanker generally between 75,000 and 119,999 dwt in size. Certain external statistical compilations define an “Aframax tanker” slightly differently, some going as high as 125,000 dwt and others as low at 70,000 dwt. External data used in this prospectus has been adjusted so that the definition is consistent throughout.
 
Available cash: For any quarter ending prior to liquidation:
 
(a) the sum of:
 
          (1) all cash and cash equivalents of Teekay Offshore Partners and its subsidiaries on hand at the end of that quarter (including our proportionate share of cash on hand of certain subsidiaries we do not wholly own, including OPCO); and
 
          (2) all additional cash and cash equivalents of Teekay Offshore Partners and its subsidiaries on hand (including our proportionate share of cash on hand of certain subsidiaries we do not wholly own) on the date of determination of available cash for that quarter resulting from working capital borrowings made after the end of that quarter;

B-1


 

(b) less the amount of cash reserves (including our proportionate share of cash reserves of certain subsidiaries we do not wholly own) established by our general partner to:
 
          (1) provide for the proper conduct of the business of Teekay Offshore Partners and its subsidiaries (including reserves for future capital expenditures and for future credit needs of Teekay Offshore Partners and its subsidiaries) after that quarter;
 
          (2) comply with applicable law or any debt instrument or other agreement or obligation to which Teekay Offshore Partners or any of its subsidiaries is a party or its assets are subject; and
 
          (3) provide funds for minimum quarterly distributions and cumulative common unit arrearages for any one or more of the next four quarters;
 
provided, however, that our general partner may not establish cash reserves for distributions to the subordinated units unless our general partner has determined that the establishment of reserves will not prevent Teekay Offshore Partners from distributing the minimum quarterly distribution on all common units and any cumulative common unit arrearages thereon for the next four quarters; and
 
provided, further, that disbursements made by Teekay Offshore Partners or any of its subsidiaries or cash reserves established, increased or reduced after the end of that quarter but on or before the date of determination of available cash for that quarter shall be deemed to have been made, established, increased or reduced, for purposes of determining available cash, within that quarter if our general partner so determines.
 
Bareboat charter: A charter in which the customer (the charterer) pays a fixed daily rate for a fixed period of time for the full use of the vessel and becomes responsible for all crewing, management and navigation of the vessel and the expenses therefor.
 
Bunker fuel: Any hydrocarbon mineral oil used or intended to be used for the operation or propulsion of a ship.
 
Capital surplus: All available cash distributed by us from any source will be treated as distributed from operating surplus until the sum of all available cash distributed since the closing of the initial public offering equals the operating surplus as of the end of the quarter before that distribution. Any excess available cash will be deemed to be capital surplus.
 
Charter: The hiring of a vessel, or use of its carrying capacity, for either (1) a specified period of time or (2) a specific voyage or set of voyages.
 
Chartered-in: Vessels to which the operator has access pursuant to a charter. Also commonly referred to as “in-chartered” vessels.
 
CLC: International Convention on Civil Liability for Oil Pollution Damage, 1969, as amended.
 
Closing price: The last sale price on a day, regular way, or in case no sale takes place on that day, the average of the closing bid and asked prices on

B-2


 

that day, regular way, as reported in the principal consolidated transaction reporting system for securities listed on the principal national securities exchange on which the units of that class are listed. If the units of that class are not listed on any national securities exchange, the last quoted price on that day. If no quoted price exists, the average of the high bid and low asked prices on that day in the over-the -counter market, as reported by the NASDAQ Global Market or any other system then in use. If on any day the units of that class are not quoted by any organization of that type, the average of the closing bid and asked prices on that day as furnished by a professional market maker making a market in the units of the class selected by our general partner. If on that day no market maker is making a market in the units of that class, the fair value of the units on that day as determined reasonably and in good faith by our general partner.
 
Contract of affreightment: A contract where the vessel operator commits to be available to transport the quantity of cargo requested by the customer from time to time over a specified trade route within a given period of time.
 
COFR: Certificates of financial responsibility sufficient to meet potential liabilities under OPA 90 and CERCLA, which owners and operators of vessels, including crude oil tankers, must establish and maintain with the United States Coast Guard.
 
Common unit arrearage: The amount by which the minimum quarterly distribution for a quarter during the subordination period exceeds the distribution of available cash from operating surplus actually made for that quarter on a common unit, cumulative for that quarter and all prior quarters during the subordination period.
 
Deepwater: Water with depths of more than 1,000 feet.
 
Current market price: For any class of units listed on any national securities exchange as of any date, the average of the daily closing prices for the 20 consecutive trading days immediately prior to that date.
 
Double hull: Hull construction technique by which a ship has an inner and outer hull, separated by void space, usually several feet in width.
 
Dynamic positioning system: Also referred to as “DP,” these computerized steering and positioning systems allow shuttle tankers to remain in position in open seas, even in harsh environmental conditions. These systems monitor wind, currents, swells and tide changes and control the possibility of the vessel through variable pitch propellers and lateral thrusters on the vessel, and are classed as DP1 or DP2, depending upon the equipment redundancy and the vessel’s capability to maintain its position. The type of system used is determined by the weather conditions in the region and requirements of the field operator.
 
Dwt: Deadweight, a measure of oil tanker carrying capacity, usually in tons, based upon weight of cargo and other items necessary to submerge the vessel to its maximum permitted draft.
 
EBITDA: Earnings before interest, taxes, depreciation and amortization.
 
Estimated maintenance capital expenditures: An estimate made by the board of directors of our general partner, with the concurrence of the conflicts committee, of the average quarterly maintenance capital expenditures that Teekay Offshore

B-3


 

Partners will incur over the long-term. The estimate will be made annually and whenever an event occurs that is likely to result in a material adjustment to the amount of maintenance capital expenditures on a long-term basis.
 
Expansion capital expenditures: Cash capital expenditures for acquisitions or capital improvements. Expansion capital expenditures include the cash cost of equity and debt capital during construction of a capital asset. Expansion capital expenditures do not include maintenance capital expenditures or investment capital expenditures.
 
Export system: The system for exporting oil from a storage or production facility.
 
FPSO unit: Floating production, storage and offloading unit. An FPSO unit is a type of floating tank system designed to process and store crude oil. An FPSO unit typically has onboard the capability to carry out the oil separation process, obviating the need for such facilities to be located on the fixed platform. The processed oil is periodically offloaded onto shuttle tankers or ocean-going barges for transport to shore.
 
FSO unit: Floating storage and offtake unit. An FSO unit is an oil tanker that has been moored in an oil field and modified to store oil.
 
GAAP: Accounting principles generally accepted in the United States.
 
General and administrative expenses: General and administrative expenses consist of employment costs of shoreside staff and cost of facilities, as well as legal, audit and other administrative costs.
 
Hire Rate: The agreed sum or rate to be paid by the charterer for the use of the vessel.
 
IMO: International Maritime Organization, a United Nations agency that issues international trade standards for shipping.
 
Incentive distribution right: A non-voting limited partner partnership interest issued to the general partner. The partnership interest will confer upon its holder only the rights and obligations specifically provided in the partnership agreement for incentive distribution rights.
 
Incentive distributions: The distributions of available cash from operating surplus initially made to the general partner that are in excess of our general partner’s aggregate 2.0% general partner interest.
 
Interim capital transactions: The following transactions if they occur prior to liquidation:
 
(a) Borrowings, refinancings or refundings of indebtedness and sales of debt securities (other than for working capital borrowings and other than for items purchased on open account in the ordinary course of business) by Teekay Offshore Partners or any of its subsidiaries;
 
(b) sales of equity interests by Teekay Offshore Partners or any of its subsidiaries;
 
(c) sales or other voluntary or involuntary dispositions of any assets of Teekay Offshore Partners or any of its subsidiaries (other than sales or other dispositions of inventory, accounts receivable and other assets in the ordinary course of business, and sales or other

B-4


 

dispositions of assets as a part of normal retirements or replacements);
 
(d) the termination of interest rate swap agreements;
 
(e) capital contributions; or
 
(f) corporate reorganizations or restructurings.
 
Investment capital expenditures: Capital expenditures other than Maintenance Capital Expenditures or Expansion Capital Expenditures.
 
ISM Code: International Safety Management Code for the Safe Operation of Ships and for Pollution Prevention, which, among other things, requires vessel owners to obtain a safety management certification for each vessel they manage.
 
ISPS: International Security Code for Ports and Ships, which enacts measures to detect and prevent security threats to ships and ports.
 
Life of field contract: A contract with a duration that lasts during the useful life of an oil field.
 
Long-term charter: A charter for a term greater than five years.
 
Maintenance capital expenditure: Cash capital expenditures (including expenditures for the addition or improvement to our capital assets or for the acquisition of existing, or the construction of new, capital assets) if such expenditure is made to maintain over the long term the operating capacity of or the revenue generated by Teekay Offshore Partners’ capital assets, as such assets existed at the time of such expenditure. Maintenance capital expenditures include the cash cost of equity and debt capital during construction of a capital asset. Maintenance capital expenditures do not include expansion capital expenditures or investment capital expenditures.
 
Newbuilding: A new vessel under construction.
 
Off-hire: The time during which a vessel is not available for service.
 
Off-field: The time during which a vessel is not utilized in an oil field.
 
Offshore loading system: A system on a shuttle tanker by which liquid cargo is transferred in open waters from either a fixed or floating platform or installation. The system is located on the bow or the keel of the vessel and connects with an export system.
 
OPA 90: The United States Oil Pollution Act of 1990, as amended.
 
OPCO: Teekay Offshore Operating L.P., a limited partnership organized in the Marshall Islands.
 
Operating expenditures: All cash expenditures of Teekay Offshore Partners and its subsidiaries (including our proportionate share of cash expenditures of certain subsidiaries we do not wholly own, including OPCO), including, but not limited to, taxes, reimbursements of the general partner,

B-5


 

repayment of working capital borrowings, debt service payments and capital expenditures, subject to the following:
 
(a) Payments (including prepayments and prepayment penalties) of principal of and premium on indebtedness, other than working capital borrowings will not constitute operating expenditures.
 
(b) Operating expenditures will not include expansion capital expenditures or actual maintenance capital expenditures or investment capital expenditures, but will include estimated maintenance capital expenditures.
 
(c) Operating expenditures will not include:
 
          (1) Payment of transaction expenses (including taxes) relating to interim capital transactions; or
 
          (2) Distributions to partners.
 
Where capital expenditures consist of both maintenance capital expenditures and expansion capital expenditures, the general partner, with the concurrence of the conflicts committee, shall determine the allocation between the portion consisting of maintenance capital expenditures and the portion consisting of expansion capital expenditures, and the period over which the maintenance capital expenditures will be deducted as an operating expenditure in calculating operating surplus.
 
Operating surplus: For any period prior to liquidation, on a cumulative basis and without duplication:
 
(a) the sum of
 
          (1) $15.0 million;
 
          (2) all cash receipts of Teekay Offshore Partners and its subsidiaries (including our proportionate share of cash receipts for certain subsidiaries we do not wholly own, including OPCO) for the period beginning on the closing date of the initial public offering and ending with the last day of that period, other than cash receipts from interim capital transactions;
 
          (3) all cash receipts of Teekay Offshore Partners and its subsidiaries after the end of that period but on or before the date of determination of operating surplus for the period resulting from working capital borrowings (including our proportionate share of working capital borrowings by certain subsidiaries we do not wholly own);
 
          (4) interest paid on debt incurred (including periodic net payments under related interest rate swap agreements) and cash distributions paid on equity securities issued, in each case (and including our proportionate share of such interest and cash distributions paid by certain subsidiaries we do not wholly own), to finance all or any portion of the construction of a capital improvement or replacement asset and paid during the period prior to the earlier of the completion of construction or being abandoned or disposed of; and

B-6


 

          (5) interest paid on debt incurred (including periodic net payments under related interest rate swap agreements) and cash distributions on equity securities issued, in each case (and including our proportionate share of such interest and cash distributions paid by certain subsidiaries we do not wholly own), to pay the construction period interest, or to pay construction period distributions or equity issued to finance all or any portion of the construction of a capital improvement or replacement asset as described in (4) above, less
 
(b) the sum of:
 
          (1) operating expenditures (including our proportionate share of operating expenditures by certain subsidiaries we do not wholly own) for the period beginning on the closing date of the initial public offering and ending with the last day of that period, including estimated maintenance capital expenditures and the repayment of working capital borrowings, but not (x) the repayment of other borrowings or (y) expenditures incurred in connection with the expansion or increase in the transportation capacity of our fleet or investment capital expenditures; and
 
          (2) the amount of cash reserves (including our proportionate share of cash reserves of certain subsidiaries we do not wholly own) established by our general partner to provide funds for future operating expenditures; provided, however , that disbursements made (including contributions to a member of Teekay Offshore Partners and its subsidiaries or disbursements on behalf of a member of Teekay Offshore Partners and its subsidiaries) or cash reserves established, increased or reduced after the end of that period but on or before the date of determination of available cash for that period shall be deemed to have been made, established, increased or reduced for purposes of determining operating surplus, within that period if the general partner so determines.
 
Shallow water: Water with depths less than 1,000 feet.
 
Short-term charter: A charter for a term less than five years.
 
Shuttle tanker: A dynamically-positioned vessel generally between 80,000 and 150,000 dwt in size that contains sophisticated equipment designed to transport oil from offshore production platforms or FPSO units or FSO units to onshore storage and refinery facilities, often in harsh weather conditions.
 
SOLAS: International Convention for Safety of Life at Sea, which provides, among other things, rules for the construction and equipment of commercial vessels.
 
Spot market: The market for chartering a vessel for single voyages.

B-7


 

Subordination period: The subordination period will generally extend from the closing of the initial public offering until the first to occur of:
 
(a) the first day of any quarter beginning after December 31, 2009 for which:
 
          (1) distributions of available cash from operating surplus on each of the outstanding common units and subordinated units equaled or exceeded the sum of the minimum quarterly distributions on all of the outstanding common units and subordinated units for each of the three consecutive, non-overlapping four-quarter periods immediately preceding that date;
 
          (2) the adjusted operating surplus generated during each of the three consecutive, non-overlapping four-quarter periods immediately preceding that date equaled or exceeded the sum of the minimum quarterly distributions on all of the common units and subordinated units that were outstanding during those periods on a fully diluted basis, and the related distribution on the general partner interest in Teekay Offshore Partners; and
 
          (3) there are no outstanding cumulative common unit arrearages.
 
(b) the date on which the general partner is removed as general partner of Teekay Offshore Partners upon the requisite vote by the limited partners under circumstances where cause does not exist and units held by our general partner and its affiliates are not voted in favor of the removal;
 
provided, however, that subordinated units may convert into common units before December 31, 2009 as described in “How We Make Cash Distributions — Subordination Period.”
 
Taut hawser operation: A shuttle tanker operation in which a cable or rope, sometimes supported by a tug vessel, is connected to the vessel’s export system, pulling the tanker backwards until taut.
 
Time charter: A charter in which the charterer pays for the use of a ship’s cargo capacity for a specified period of time. The owner provides the ship with crew, stores and provisions, ready in all aspects to load cargo and proceed on a voyage as directed by the charterer. The charterer usually pays for bunkering and all voyage-related expenses, including canal tolls and port charges.
 
VOC: Volatile Organic Compounds. The common term for vaporized crude oil that is formed and emitted during offshore loading operations involving shuttle tankers.

B-8


 

Voyage charter: A charter in which the charterer pays for the use of a ship’s cargo capacity for one, or sometimes more than one, voyage between specified ports. Under this type of charter, the ship owner pays all the operating costs of the ship (including bunker fuel, canal and port charges, pilotage, towage and ship’s agency) while payment for cargo handling charges are subject of agreement between the parties. Freight is generally paid per unit of cargo, such as a ton, based on an agreed quantity, or as a lump sum irrespective of the quantity loaded.
 
Working capital borrowings: Borrowings used exclusively for working capital purposes or to pay distributions to partners made pursuant to a credit facility, commercial paper facility or other similar financing arrangement; provided that when incurred it is the intent of the borrower to repay such borrowings within 12 months from other than additional working capital borrowings.

B-9


 



7,000,000 Common Units
Representing Limited Partner Interests
Teekay Offshore Partners L.P.
(TEEKAY LOGO)
 
PROSPECTUS
                    , 2006
 
                                          Citigroup Merrill Lynch & Co.                                   
 
Morgan Stanley
A.G. Edwards
Deutsche Bank Securities
Raymond James
Simmons & Company
International
DnB NOR Markets
Fortis Securities
 
        Until                     , 2007 (25 days after the date of this prospectus), all dealers that buy, sell or trade our common units, whether or not participating in this offering, may be required to deliver a prospectus. This is in addition to the dealers’ obligation to deliver a prospectus when acting as underwriters with respect to their unsold allotments or subscriptions.



 

PART II
INFORMATION NOT REQUIRED IN PROSPECTUS
Item 6. Indemnification of Directors and Officers
      The section of the prospectus entitled “The Partnership Agreement — Indemnification” discloses that we will generally indemnify officers, directors and affiliates of the general partner to the fullest extent permitted by applicable law against all losses, claims, damages or similar events and is incorporated herein by this reference. Reference is made to the Underwriting Agreement to be filed as Exhibit 1.1 to this registration statement in which Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. and its affiliates will agree to indemnify the underwriters against certain liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and to contribute to payments that may be required to be made in respect of these liabilities.
Item 7. Recent Sales of Unregistered Securities
      On August 31, 2006, in connection with the formation of the partnership, Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. issued to (a) Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C. the 2% general partner interest in the partnership for $20 and (b) to Teekay Shipping Corporation the 98% limited partner interest in the partnership for $980 in an offering exempt from registration under Section 4(2) of the Securities Act.
      There have been no other sales of unregistered securities within the past three years.
Item 8. Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules
      (a)  Exhibits.
             
Exhibit        
Number       Description
         
  1 .1     Form of Underwriting Agreement*
 
  3 .1     Certificate of Limited Partnership of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P.
 
  3 .2     Form of First Amended and Restated Agreement of Limited Partnership of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. (included as Appendix A to the Prospectus)
 
  3 .3     Certificate of Formation of Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C.
 
  3 .4     Form of Amended and Restated Limited Liability Company Agreement of Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C.
 
  3 .5     Certificate of Limited Partnership of Teekay Offshore Operating L.P.
 
  3 .6     Form of Agreement of Limited Partnership of Teekay Offshore Operating L.P.
 
  3 .7     Certificate of Formation of Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C.
 
  3 .8     Form of Amended and Restated Limited Liability Company Agreement of Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C.
 
  5 .1     Opinion of Watson, Farley & Williams (New York) LLP, as to the legality of the securities being registered
 
  8 .1     Opinion of Perkins Coie LLP relating to tax matters
 
  8 .2     Opinion of Watson, Farley & Williams (New York) LLP relating to tax matters
 
  10 .1     Form of Contribution, Conveyance and Assumption Agreement
 
  10 .2     Form of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. 2006 Long-Term Incentive Plan
 
  10 .3     Form of Omnibus Agreement
 
  10 .4     Form of Administrative Services Agreement with Teekay Shipping Limited*
 
  10 .5     Form of Advisory, Strategic Consulting, Technical and Administrative Services Agreement*
 
  10 .6     Amended Revolving Credit Agreement
 
  10 .7     New Revolving Credit Agreement
 
  10 .8     Petrojarl ASA Joint Venture Agreement

II-1


 

             
Exhibit        
Number       Description
         
 
  21 .1     List of Subsidiaries of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P.
 
  23 .1     Consent of Ernst & Young LLP
 
  23 .2     Consent of Watson, Farley & Williams (New York) LLP (contained in Exhibit 5.1)
 
  23 .3     Consent of Perkins Coie LLP (contained in Exhibit 8.1)
 
  23 .4     Consent of Clarkson Research Studies, Inc.
 
  23 .5     Consent of Douglas-Westwood Ltd.
 
  23 .6     Consent of Wood Mackenzie Ltd.
 
  23 .7     Consent of International Maritime Associates
 
  23 .8     Consent of R.S. Platou Shipbrokers
 
  24 .1     Powers of Attorney (contained on page II-3)
  99 .1     Consent of Director Nominee David L. Lemmon
  99 .2     Consent of Director Nominee Carl Mikael L.L. von Mentzer
  99 .3     Consent of Director Nominee John J. Peacock
 
To be filed by amendment.
      (b)  Financial Statement Schedules.
      All supplemental schedules are omitted because of the absence of conditions under which they are required or because the information is shown in the financial statements or notes thereto.
Item 9. Undertakings
      The undersigned registrant hereby undertakes to provide to the underwriters at the closing specified in the underwriting agreement certificates in such denominations and registered in such names as required by the underwriters to permit prompt delivery to each purchaser.
      Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act of 1933 may be permitted to directors, officers and controlling persons of the registrant pursuant to the foregoing provisions, or otherwise, the registrant has been advised that in the opinion of the Securities and Exchange Commission such indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act and is, therefore, unenforceable. In the event that a claim for indemnification against such liabilities (other than the payment by the registrant of expenses incurred or paid by a director, officer or controlling person of the registrant in the successful defense of any action, suit or proceeding) is asserted by such director, officer or controlling person in connection with the securities being registered, the registrant will, unless in the opinion of its counsel the matter has been settled by controlling precedent, submit to a court of appropriate jurisdiction the question whether such indemnification by it is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act and will be governed by the final adjudication of such issue.
      The undersigned registrant hereby undertakes that:
        (1) For purposes of determining any liability under the Securities Act of 1933, the information omitted from the form of prospectus filed as part of this registration statement in reliance upon Rule 430A and contained in a form of prospectus filed by the registrant pursuant to Rule 424(b)(1) or (4) or 497(h) under the Securities Act shall be deemed to be part of this registration statement as of the time it was declared effective.
 
        (2) For the purpose of determining any liability under the Securities Act of 1933, each post-effective amendment that contains a form of prospectus shall be deemed to be a new registration statement relating to the securities offered therein, and the offering of such securities at that time shall be deemed to be the initial bona fide offering thereof.

II-2


 

SIGNATURES
      Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, the registrant certifies that it has reasonable grounds to believe that it meets all of the requirements for filing on Form  F-1 and has duly caused this Registration Statement to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Southport, State of Connecticut, United States of America, on December 4, 2006.
  TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS L.P.
  By:  Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C., its General Partner
 
  By:  /s/ Peter Evensen
 
 
  Name: Peter Evensen
  Title: Chief Executive Officer and
Chief Financial Officer
POWER OF ATTORNEY
      Each person whose signature appears below appoints Bjorn Moller and Peter Evensen, and each of them, either of whom may act without the joinder of the other, as his true and lawful attorneys-in -fact and agents, with full power of substitution and resubstitution, for him and in his name, place and stead, in any and all capacities, to sign any and all amendments (including post-effective amendments) to this Registration Statement and any Registration Statement (including any amendments thereto) for this offering that is to be effective upon filing pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and to file the same, with all exhibits thereto, and all other documents in connection therewith, with the Securities and Exchange Commission, granting unto said attorneys-in -fact and agents, and each of them, full power and authority to do and perform each and every act and thing requisite and necessary to be done, as fully to all intents and purposes as he or she might or would do in person, hereby ratifying and confirming all that said attorneys-in -fact and agents or any of them or their or his or her substitute and substitutes, may lawfully do or cause to be done by virtue hereof.
      Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, this Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and the dates indicated.
             
Signature   Title   Date
         
 
/s/ Peter Evensen
 
Peter Evensen
  Chief Executive Officer and
Chief Financial Officer
(Principal Executive, Financial and
Accounting Officer), Director and
Authorized Representative in the United States
  December 4, 2006
 
/s/ C. Sean Day
 
C. Sean Day
  Chairman   December 4, 2006
 
/s/ Bjorn Moller
 
Bjorn Moller
  Vice Chairman   December 4, 2006

II-3


 

EXHIBIT INDEX
             
Exhibit        
Number       Description
         
  1 .1     Form of Underwriting Agreement*
 
  3 .1     Certificate of Limited Partnership of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P.
 
  3 .2     Form of First Amended and Restated Agreement of Limited Partnership of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. (included as Appendix A to the Prospectus)
 
  3 .3     Certificate of Formation of Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C.
 
  3 .4     Form of Amended and Restated Limited Liability Company Agreement of Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C.
 
  3 .5     Certificate of Limited Partnership of Teekay Offshore Operating L.P.
 
  3 .6     Form of Agreement of Limited Partnership of Teekay Offshore Operating L.P.
 
  3 .7     Certificate of Formation of Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C.
 
  3 .8     Form of Amended and Restated Limited Liability Company Agreement of Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C.
 
  5 .1     Opinion of Watson, Farley & Williams (New York) LLP, as to the legality of the securities being registered
 
  8 .1     Opinion of Perkins Coie LLP relating to tax matters
 
  8 .2     Opinion of Watson, Farley & Williams (New York) LLP relating to tax matters
 
  10 .1     Form of Contribution, Conveyance and Assumption Agreement
 
  10 .2     Form of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. 2006 Long-Term Incentive Plan
 
  10 .3     Form of Omnibus Agreement
 
  10 .4     Form of Administrative Services Agreement with Teekay Shipping Limited*
 
  10 .5     Form of Advisory, Strategic Consulting, Technical and Administrative Services Agreement*
 
  10 .6     Amended Revolving Credit Agreement
 
  10 .7     New Revolving Credit Agreement
 
  10 .8     Petrojarl ASA Joint Venture Agreement
 
  21 .1     List of Subsidiaries of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P.
 
  23 .1     Consent of Ernst & Young LLP
 
  23 .2     Consent of Watson, Farley & Williams (New York) LLP (contained in Exhibit 5.1)
 
  23 .3     Consent of Perkins Coie LLP (contained in Exhibit 8.1)
 
  23 .4     Consent of Clarkson Research Studies, Inc.
 
  23 .5     Consent of Douglas-Westwood Ltd.
 
  23 .6     Consent of Wood Mackenzie Ltd.
 
  23 .7     Consent of International Maritime Associates
 
  23 .8     Consent of R.S. Platou Shipbrokers
 
  24 .1     Powers of Attorney (contained on page II-3)
  99 .1     Consent of Director Nominee David L. Lemmon
  99 .2     Consent of Director Nominee Carl Mikael L.L. von Mentzer
  99 .3     Consent of Director Nominee John J. Peacock
 
To be filed by amendment.

II-4

EXHIBIT 3.1

CERTIFICATE OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP
PURSUANT TO SECTION 10 OF PART III, DIVISION 2, OF THE
ASSOCIATIONS LAW OF THE REPUBLIC OF THE MARSHALL ISLANDS
(LIMITED PARTNERSHIP ACT)

Pursuant to the provisions of the Marshall Islands Limited Partnership Act, the undersigned desires to form a Limited Partnership and certifies the following:

1. The name of the Limited Partnership is Teekay Offshore Partners L.P.
(the "LIMITED PARTNERSHIP").

2. The registered address of the Limited Partnership in the Marshall Islands is: Trust Company Complex, Ajeltake Island, Ajeltake Road, Majuro, Marshall Islands MH96960. The name of the Limited Partnership's Registered Agent in the Marshall Islands upon whom process may be served at such address is: The Trust Company of the Marshall Islands, Inc.

3. The name and the business, residence or mailing address of the sole general partner is:

Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C.

c/o Teekay Shipping Limited

Bayside House, Bayside Executive Park West Bay Street & Blake Road P.O. Box AP- 59212
Nassau, Bahamas

4. The name and title of the person authorized to sign this Certificate of Limited Partnership for the general partner is:

Arthur Bensler
Attorney-in-Fact

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the undersigned has executed this Certificate of Limited Partnership on this 30th day of August, 2006.

TEEKAY OFFSHORE GP L.L.C.
By: Teekay Shipping Corporation, its Sole Member

By:      /s/ Arthur Bensler
         ----------------------
         Arthur Bensler
         Attorney-in-Fact
         (Authorized Signatory)


EXHIBIT 3.3

CERTIFICATE OF FORMATION
OF
TEEKAY OFFSHORE GP L.L.C.
UNDER SECTION 9 OF THE MARSHALL ISLANDS LIMITED LIABILITY COMPANY ACT

1. The name of the Limited Liability Company is: Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C.

2. The address of its registered agent in the Marshall Islands is Trust Company Complex, Ajeltake Islands, Ajeltake Road, Majuro, Marshall Islands MH 96960. The name of its registered agent at such address is The Trust Company of the Marshall Islands, Inc.

3. The formation date of the Limited Liability Company is the date of the filing of this Certificate of Formation with the Registrar of Corporations.

WHEREFORE, the undersigned has executed this Certificate of Formation on the 25th day of August, 2006.

/s/ Leo Chang
-----------------
Leo Chang
Authorized Person


EXHIBIT 3.4


AMENDED AND RESTATED
LIMITED LIABILITY COMPANY AGREEMENT

OF

TEEKAY OFFSHORE GP L.L.C.

A MARSHALL ISLANDS LIMITED LIABILITY COMPANY


Dated: as of [_____], 2006


TABLE OF CONTENTS

1 DEFINITIONS .............................................................    1

   1.1 Defined Terms ......................................................    1
   1.2 Number and Gender ..................................................    4

2 ORGANIZATION ............................................................    4

   2.1 Formation ..........................................................    4
   2.2 Name ...............................................................    4
   2.3 Purposes ...........................................................    4
   2.4 Registered Office; Registered Agent ................................    4
   2.5 Principal Office ...................................................    5
   2.6 Term ...............................................................    5
   2.7 LLC Certificate; Transfer of Ownership Interest; Pledge of
       Ownership Interest .................................................    5

3 CAPITAL CONTRIBUTIONS ...................................................    6

   3.1 Initial Capital Contributions ......................................    6
   3.2 Additional Capital Contributions ...................................    6
   3.3 Liability Limited to Capital Contributions .........................    6

4 MANAGEMENT ..............................................................    6

   4.1 Board of Directors .................................................    6
   4.2 Board Membership ...................................................    8
   4.3 Meetings, Quorum, Voting, Etc ......................................    8
   4.4 Delegation of Authority and Duties .................................   11
   4.5 Execution of Documents .............................................   12
   4.6 Compensation of Directors and Officers .............................   13
   4.7 Indemnification ....................................................   13
   4.8 Liability of Indemnitees ...........................................   15
   4.9 Actions Required by Member .........................................   16

5 DISTRIBUTIONS ...........................................................   18

   5.1 Distributions/Available Cash .......................................   18

6 BOOKS AND RECORDS; FISCAL YEAR; BANK ACCOUNTS; TAX MATTERS ..............   18

   6.1 Books and Records ..................................................   18
   6.2 Fiscal Year ........................................................   19
   6.3 Bank Accounts ......................................................   19
   6.4 Tax Matters ........................................................   19

7 MISCELLANEOUS ...........................................................   19

   7.1 Complete Agreement .................................................   19
   7.2 Governing Law ......................................................   19
   7.3 Headings ...........................................................   20
   7.4 Severability .......................................................   20
   7.5 No Third Party Beneficiary .........................................   20
   7.6 Amendment ..........................................................   20

Exhibits:

Exhibit 1: Certificate of Formation
Exhibit 2: LLC Certificate

i

AMENDED AND RESTATED
LIMITED LIABILITY COMPANY AGREEMENT
TEEKAY OFFSHORE GP L.L.C.

This Amended and Restated Limited Liability Company Agreement of TEEKAY OFFSHORE GP L.L.C., a Marshall Islands limited liability company (the "COMPANY"), is made and entered into effective as of the [_____] day of [_____], 2006, by TEEKAY SHIPPING CORPORATION, a Marshall Islands corporation ("TSC").

RECITALS

WHEREAS, TSC formed the Company on August 25, 2006 pursuant to the Act, subject to a Limited Liability Company Agreement dated as of August 25, 2006 (the "LIMITED LIABILITY COMPANY AGREEMENT") entered into by TSC as the sole Member of the Company; and

WHEREAS, TSC now desires to amend and restate the Limited Liability Company Agreement in its entirety upon the terms and conditions stated below.

NOW, THEREFORE, the Limited Liability Company Agreement is hereby amended and restated in its entirety as follows:

1 DEFINITIONS

1.1 Defined Terms.

When used in this Agreement, the following terms shall have the meanings set forth below:

(a) "ACT" means the Marshall Islands Limited Liability Company Act of the Republic of The Marshall Islands Associations Law, as the same may be amended from time to time.

(b) "AGREEMENT" means this Amended and Restated Limited Liability Company Agreement, as the same may be further amended, modified, supplemented or restated from to time in accordance with its terms.

(c) "AFFILIATE" means, with respect to any Person, any other Person that directly or indirectly through one or more intermediaries controls, is controlled by or is under common control with, the Person in question. As used in the foregoing definition, the term "CONTROL" means the possession, direct or indirect, of the power to direct or cause the direction of the


management and policies of a Person, whether through ownership of voting securities, by contract or otherwise.

(d) "BOARD OF DIRECTORS" shall have the meaning set forth in Section 4.1 of this Agreement.

(e) "BUSINESS" means the acquisition of a general partnership interest in the Limited Partnership, and acting as the general partner of the Limited Partnership.

(f) "CANADIAN TAX ACT" means the Income Tax Act (Canada), R.S.C. 1985, 5th Supplement, c.1, as amended from time to time.

(g) "CAPITAL CONTRIBUTIONS" means the total amount of cash and/or assets which a Member contributes to the Company as capital pursuant to this Agreement.

(h) "CERTIFICATE" means the Certificate of Formation in the form of Exhibit 1 hereto to be filed pursuant to the Act with the Republic of The Marshall Islands Registrar of Corporations pursuant to which the Company will be formed as a Marshall Islands limited liability company.

(i) "CLOSING DATE" means the first date on which limited partnership interests are sold by the Limited Partnership pursuant to the provisions of the Underwriting Agreement.

(j) "COMMON UNITS" means a Partnership Security representing a fractional part of the limited partnership interests of all limited partners of the Limited Partnership.

(k) "DIRECTORS" means the members of the Board of Directors.

(l) "GROUP MEMBER" means a member of the Partnership Group.

(m) "INCENTIVE DISTRIBUTION RIGHT" means a non-voting limited partnership interest in the Limited Partnership issued to the Company.

(n) "INDEMNITEE" means (i) any Person who is or was a Member, (ii) any Person who is or was an Affiliate of any Member, (iii) any Person who is or was a Director or Officer, or a fiduciary or trustee, of the Company, (iv) any Person who is or was a member, shareholder, partner, director, officer, fiduciary or trustee of any Member or an Affiliate of any Member, (v) any Person who is or was serving at the request of the Company, any Member or any

2

Affiliate of any Member as an officer, director, member, partner, fiduciary or trustee of another Person, provided that such Person shall not be an Indemnitee by reason of providing, on a fee-for-services basis, trustee, fiduciary or custodial services, and (vi) any Person the Company designates as an "Indemnitee" for purposes of this Agreement.

(o) "INITIAL DIRECTORS" shall have the meaning set forth in Section 4.1 of this Agreement.

(p) "LIMITED PARTNERSHIP" means Teekay Offshore Partners L.P., a Marshall Islands limited partnership.

(q) "LIMITED PARTNERSHIP AGREEMENT" means the First Amended and Restated Agreement of Limited Partnership of the Limited Partnership.

(r) "LLC CERTIFICATE" shall have the meaning set forth in Section 2.7(a) of this Agreement.

(s) "MEMBER" means TSC and any Person who, at the time of reference thereto, has been admitted to the Company as a Member in accordance with this Agreement, including any Transferee, and shall have the same meaning as the term "Member" under the Act, but shall not include any Person who has ceased to be a Member of the Company.

(t) "NYSE" means the New York Stock Exchange.

(u) "OFFICERS" shall have the meaning set forth in Section 4.4(a) of this Agreement.

(v) "PARTNERSHIP GROUP" means the Limited Partnership and its subsidiaries.

(w) "PARTNERSHIP SECURITY" means any class or series of equity interest in the Limited Partnership (but excluding any options, rights, warrants and appreciation rights relating to an equity interest in the Limited Partnership).

(x) "PERSON" means a natural person, corporation, partnership, joint venture, trust, estate, unincorporated association, limited liability company, or any other juridical entity.

(y) "TRANSFEREE" shall have the meaning set forth in Section 2.7(b) of this Agreement.

(z) "UNDERWRITERS" means each Person named as an underwriter in the Underwriting Agreement.

3

(aa) "UNDERWRITING AGREEMENT" means the Underwriting Agreement to be executed among, inter alia, the Underwriters, the Limited Partnership and the Company, providing for the purchase of limited partnership interests in the Limited Partnership by the Underwriters.

1.2 Number and Gender.

As the context requires, all words used herein in the singular number shall extend to and include the plural, all words used in the plural number shall extend to and include the singular, and all words used in any gender shall extend to and include the other gender or be neutral.

2 ORGANIZATION

2.1 Formation.

The Company was formed on August 25, 2006 as a Marshall Islands limited liability company upon the filing of the Certificate pursuant to the Act with the Republic of The Marshall Islands Registrar of Corporations.

2.2 Name.

The name of the Company is "Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C." and all Company business shall be conducted in that name or such other names that comply with applicable law as the Board of Directors may from time to time designate.

2.3 Purposes.

The purposes for which the Company is established is to engage in any lawful activity permitted by the Act, including, without limitation, the carrying on of the Business.

2.4 Registered Office; Registered Agent.

The registered office of the Company required by the Act to be maintained in the Republic of The Marshall Islands shall be the office of the initial registered agent named in the Certificate or such other office as the Board of Directors may designate from time to time in the manner provided by law. The registered agent of the Company required by the Act to be maintained in the Republic of The Marshall Islands shall be the initial registered agent named in the Certificate or such other

4

person or persons as the Board of Directors may designate from time to time in the manner provided by law.

2.5 Principal Office.

The principal office of the Company shall be Bayside House, Bayside Executive Park, West Bay Street & Blake Road, P.O. Box AP- 59212, Nassau, Bahamas.

2.6 Term.

The Company commenced on August 25, 2006 and shall have perpetual existence, unless the Company is dissolved in accordance with the Act.

2.7 LLC Certificate; Transfer of Ownership Interest; Pledge of Ownership Interest.

(a) A Member's ownership of its limited liability company interest in the Company shall be evidenced by a certificate of limited liability interest ("LLC CERTIFICATE") substantially in the form of Exhibit 2 hereto.

(b) Subject to the provisions of Section 2.7(c) herein, upon the endorsement by a Member on such LLC Certificate (or on a separate transfer power) in favor of a third party (a "TRANSFEREE") and the delivery of such Certificate (and such separate power, if applicable) to such Transferee, such Member shall be deemed to have assigned and transferred all its right, title and interest in the Company and in this Agreement to such Transferee and all references in this Agreement to such Member shall be deemed to refer to such Transferee, in each case effective as of the date of such Certificate delivery. A Member's right, title and interest in the Company shall not be transferred other than as provided in this Section 2.7(b).

(c) The pledge of, or granting of a security interest, lien or other encumbrance in or against, any or all of the limited liability company interest of a Member in the Company shall not cause such Member to cease to be a Member until the secured party shall have lawfully exercised its remedies under the security agreement and completed the endorsement in favor of a Transferee. Until the exercise of such remedies, the secured party shall not have the power to exercise any rights or powers of a Member.

5

3 CAPITAL CONTRIBUTIONS

3.1 Initial Capital Contributions.

TSC has made an initial capital contribution of U.S.$1,000 to the Company and in consideration thereof, an LLC Certificate has been issued in favor of TSC as provided for in Section 2.7 above.

3.2 Additional Capital Contributions.

A Member may contribute such additional sums and/or assets, if any, as it shall determine in its sole discretion.

3.3 Liability Limited to Capital Contributions.

No Member shall have any obligation to contribute money to the Company with respect to any liability or obligation of the Company. No Member shall be liable for the debts, obligations or liabilities of the Company, including, without limitation, under a judgment, decree or order of a court.

4 MANAGEMENT

4.1 Board of Directors.

Except for decisions or actions requiring the approval of the Members, as provided in this Agreement (including Section 4.9) or by non-waivable provisions of the Act or applicable law, the powers of the Company shall be exercised by or under the authority of, and the business and affairs of the Company shall be managed under the direction of, a board of directors (the "BOARD OF DIRECTORS") comprised of no less than three (3) and no more than nine (9) Directors. Subject to such limitations, the exact number of Directors shall be fixed from time to time by resolution of the Board of Directors and such number may be increased or decreased from time to time by vote of a majority of the Directors then in office; provided, however, that the Board of Directors initially shall be comprised of two Directors (the "INITIAL DIRECTORS"), who shall be appointed by TSC. No decrease in the number of Directors shall have the effect of shortening the term of any incumbent Director. Subject to Section 4.9, the Board of Directors may make all decisions and take all actions for the Company as in its sole discretion it shall deem necessary or appropriate to enable the Company to carry out the

6

purposes for which the Company was formed and to further the interests of the Members, including, without limitation, the following:

(a) adopting, by written consent or otherwise, resolutions in the name and on behalf of the Company (either for the Company itself or for the Company in its capacity as the general partner of the Limited Partnership) authorizing any decisions or actions taken pursuant to this Section 4.1;

(b) entering into, making and performing such contracts, agreements, undertakings and financial guarantees in the name and on behalf of the Company;

(c) setting aside reserves, opening and maintaining bank and investment accounts and arrangements, drawing checks and other orders for the payment of money, and designating individuals with authority to sign or give instructions with respect to those accounts and arrangements;

(d) collecting sums due to the Company;

(e) selecting, removing, and changing the authority and responsibility of lawyers, auditors and other advisers and consultants;

(f) (i) creating such committees of the Board of Directors as the Board of Directors may deem necessary, appropriate or advisable, in its sole discretion, to carry on the affairs of the Company, including, without limitation, a conflicts committee, an audit committee, a pricing committee and a corporate governance committee, (ii) selecting and removing (with or without cause, upon the affirmative vote of a majority of all of the Directors then in office) the members of such committees (provided, however, that such committees shall be comprised only of Directors and shall have only as many members as the Board of Directors deems appropriate, subject to any rules of the NYSE applicable to the Company), and (iii) changing the authority and responsibilities of such committees; and

(g) granting signatory authority to and issuing Powers of Attorney in favor of such persons as it may deem necessary or appropriate to carry out and implement any decisions or actions taken pursuant to this Section 4.1.

7

Notwithstanding anything in this Agreement to the contrary, the Board of Directors shall conduct the affairs and governance of the Company so that (i) the Company is not a resident of Canada for purposes of the Canadian Tax Act and
(ii) neither the Company nor the Limited Partnership is carrying on business in Canada for purposes of the Canadian Tax Act.

4.2 Board Membership.

(a) The Members shall have full authority unilaterally to appoint, by majority vote, such individuals to be Directors as they shall choose in their sole discretion, and to remove and replace, by majority vote, any Director they appoint to the Board of Directors, with or without cause, at any time and for any reason, and to fill, by majority vote, any positions created on the Board of Directors as a result of an increase in the size of the Board of Directors; provided, however, that (i) each Director shall be a natural person and (ii) at all times a majority of the Directors shall be persons who are not residents of Canada for the purposes of the Canadian Tax Act (except in the case of (A) the Initial Directors, where not more than one director may be a resident of Canada for purposes of the Canadian Tax Act and (B) the death, resignation or dismissal of one or more Directors who are not residents of Canada for purposes of the Canadian Tax Act, provided that within 21 days of any such death, resignation or dismissal either (1) the Members shall appoint one or more new non-resident Directors to replace each non-resident Director who died, resigned or was dismissed, or (2) one or more Directors who are residents of Canada for purposes of the Canadian Tax Act shall resign to achieve the required non-resident majority).

(b) Each Director shall be appointed to serve until his or her successor shall be appointed and shall qualify or until his or her earlier resignation or removal.

(c) The Members shall designate one Director to hold the title of Chairman and one to hold the title of Vice-Chairman. The Vice-Chairman shall report to, and be subject to the direction of, the Chairman in respect of his duties for the Company.

4.3 Meetings, Quorum, Voting, Etc.

(a) Meetings of the Board of Directors shall be called by the Secretary of the Company, or in the absence of the Secretary, by the Chairman of the Board of Directors, upon request of any Director. Notice of the date, time and place of each meeting of the Board of Directors shall

8

be given to each Director at least forty-eight hours prior to such meeting, unless the notice is given orally or delivered in person, in which case it shall be given at least twenty-four hours prior to such meeting. For the purpose of this Section 4.3(a), notice shall be deemed to be duly given to a Director if given to him or her personally (including by telephone) or if such notice be delivered to such Director by courier service, mail, email, telegraph, cable, telex, or facsimile, to his or her last known address. Notice of a meeting need not be given to any Director who submits a signed waiver of notice, whether before or after the meeting, or who attends the meeting without protesting, prior to the conduct of any voting thereat, the lack of notice to him or her. All meetings of the Board of Directors shall take place outside of Canada.

(b) At all meetings of the Board of Directors, a quorum for the transaction of business shall be a majority of the Directors then in office; provided, however, that such quorum shall be properly constituted only if a majority of the Directors included in such quorum are not residents of Canada for purposes of the Canadian Tax Act.

(c) Directors may participate in a meeting of the Board of Directors or a meeting of any committee of the Board of Directors by means of conference call or any similar communications equipment by means of which all Directors participating in the meeting can hear each other, and participation in a meeting pursuant to this provision shall constitute presence in person at such meeting. A meeting of the Board of Directors or a meeting of any committee of the Board of Directors by means of such a call or any similar communication shall take place only by means of such a call or communication originated outside of Canada, shall be properly constituted only if a majority of the Directors participating in the meeting in person or by such call or communication are not residents of Canada for purposes of the Canadian Tax Act and a majority of the Directors participating in the meeting in person or by such call participate from or at a location outside Canada, and shall be deemed held at the place from where such call or communication originated.

(d) All decisions to be made and actions to be taken by the Board of Directors or a committee of the Board of Directors shall be determined by the vote of a majority of the Directors in attendance at a meeting at which a quorum is present.

9

(e) Any action which may be taken at a meeting of the Board of Directors or a meeting of any committee of the Board of Directors may be taken without a meeting if a consent in writing, setting forth the action so taken, is signed by all of the Directors then in office. The action taken by any unanimous consent in writing shall be deemed to have occurred when the last Director executing such consent shall have signed the consent; provided, however, that the last Director to execute such consent shall not have done so while in Canada and each such consent shall include the location and the date of such execution.

(f) Unless the Board of Directors shall otherwise provide, any committee of the Board of Directors may hold meetings at any place outside Canada and make rules for the conduct of its business as such committee shall from time to time deem necessary. At all meetings of a committee of the Board of Directors, a quorum for the transaction of business shall be a majority of the members then in office. Each committee shall keep a record of its proceedings and report the same to the Board of Directors when required. No committee shall have the power to fill vacancies in the Board of Directors, or to change the membership of or to fill vacancies in, any other committee created by the Board of Directors, or to amend or repeal this Agreement or adopt a new limited liability company agreement, or to submit to the Member any action requiring its authorization, or to amend or repeal any resolution of the Board of Directors which by its terms shall not be amendable or repealable. All meetings of any committee of the Board of Directors shall be held outside Canada. Directors may participate in a meeting of a committee of the Board of Directors by means of conference call or any similar communications equipment by means of which all Directors participating in the meeting can hear each other, and participation in a meeting pursuant to this provision shall constitute presence in person at such meeting. A meeting of a committee of the Board of Directors by means of such a call or any similar communication shall take place only by means of such a call or communication originated outside of Canada and shall be deemed held at the place from where such call or communication originated; provided however, if a majority of the members of the Conflicts Committee or the Corporate Governance Committee, as the case may be, are residents of Canada for purposes of the Canadian Tax Act., that committee shall not meet by means of conference call or any similar communications equipment unless a majority of the members of such committee who are residents of Canada for the purposes of the Canadian Tax Act are situate outside of Canada at the time of such meeting; and provided further, if a majority of the members of the Audit

10

Committee are residents of Canada for purposes of the Canadian Tax Act, that committee shall ensure that a majority of its meetings in any calendar year are physical meetings held outside of Canada.

4.4 Delegation of Authority and Duties.

(a) The Board of Directors may, from time to time as it deems advisable, appoint and elect (as well as remove or replace at any time with or without cause for any reason) (i) a Chief Executive Officer, (ii) a Chief Financial Officer, (iii) a Secretary and (iv) such other officer positions assigned to individuals as it may elect (collectively, the "OFFICERS"). Each Officer shall be a natural person who is not a resident of Canada for purposes of the Canadian Tax Act, and shall be authorized to, and shall, act in such capacity only outside of Canada. Any two or more offices may be held by the same person. If so appointed by the Board of Directors, the Officers shall have the authority and duties as may from time to time be assigned to them.

(b) In addition, the Board of Directors may, from time to time as it deems advisable, delegate to one or more natural persons (inclusive of any Director) such authority and duties as the Board of Directors is granted under this Agreement and not made subject to the approval of the Members by this Agreement, and the Board of Directors may assign in writing such titles to any such person as it deems appropriate. Any such person to whom such authority and duties are delegated by the Board of Directors shall not, during the time that such authority or duties are delegated, be a resident of Canada for purposes of the Canadian Tax Act and shall be authorized to, and shall, act in such capacity only outside of Canada. Any delegation pursuant to this Section 4.4(b) may be revoked at any time by the Board of Directors with or without cause for any reason.

(c) Unless the Board of Directors decides otherwise, if the title of any person authorized to act on behalf of the Company under this Section 4.4 is one commonly used for officers of a business corporation formed under the Marshall Islands Business Corporation Act, the assignment of such title shall constitute the delegation to such person of the authority and duties that are normally associated with that office, subject to any specific delegation of, or restriction on, authority and duties made pursuant to this Section 4.4. Any delegation or restriction pursuant to this Section 4.4(c) may be revoked at any time by the Board of

11

Directors, with or without cause for any reason, provided that the Board of Directors will not be entitled to revoke any restriction relating to the residence of any person as set out in this Section 4.4.

(d) Unless authorized to do so by this Agreement or by the Board of Directors, no Director, Officer, agent or employee of the Company shall have any power or authority to bind the Company in any way, to pledge its credit, or to render it liable pecuniarily for any purpose. However, the Company may act by an attorney-in-fact authorized by the Board of Directors, provided that no such attorney-in-fact shall, while having such authority, be a resident of Canada for purposes of the Canadian Tax Act and shall not be authorized to, and shall not, exercise such authority in Canada.

4.5 Execution of Documents.

(a) Any agreements, contracts or other documents or correspondence executed on behalf of the Company, including an LLC Certificate, shall show the place of execution (which shall be outside of Canada) and be signed by the individual executing same as follows:

TEEKAY OFFSHORE GP L.L.C.

By:
Name
Title

(b) Any agreements, contracts or other documents or correspondence executed by TSC, in its capacity as sole Member of the Company, including an LLC Certificate, shall be signed by TSC as follows:

TEEKAY OFFSHORE GP L.L.C.

By: TEEKAY SHIPPING CORPORATION,
its Sole Member

By:
(Authorized Signatory)

(c) Any agreements, contracts or other documents or correspondence executed by the Company, either on its own behalf or in its capacity as the general partner of the Limited Partnership, shall be executed only outside of Canada.

12

4.6 Compensation of Directors and Officers.

(a) Members of the Board of Directors shall receive such compensation for their services to the Company as the Board of Directors or any compensation committee appointed by the Board of Directors shall determine. In addition, the Board of Directors or any compensation committee appointed by the Board of Directors may, from time to time, authorize the reimbursement by the Company of such expenses (including travel expenses) as may be incurred by Directors in the performance of their duties hereunder (including attendance at meetings of the Board of Directors).

(b) The Officers shall serve with or without such compensation for their services to the Company as the Board of Directors or any compensation committee appointed by the Board of Directors thereof shall determine.

4.7 Indemnification.

(a) To the fullest extent permitted by law but subject to the limitations expressly provided in this Agreement, all Indemnitees shall be indemnified and held harmless by the Company from and against any and all losses, claims, damages, liabilities, joint or several, expenses (including legal fees and expenses), judgments, fines, penalties, interest, settlements or other amounts arising from any and all claims, demands, actions, suits or proceedings, whether civil, criminal, administrative or investigative, in which any Indemnitee may be involved, or is threatened to be involved, as a party or otherwise, by reason of its status as an Indemnitee; provided, that the Indemnitee shall not be indemnified and held harmless if there has been a final and non-appealable judgment entered by a court of competent jurisdiction determining that, in respect of the matter for which the Indemnitee is seeking indemnification pursuant to this Section 4.7, the Indemnitee acted in bad faith or engaged in fraud, willful misconduct or gross negligence or, in the case of a criminal matter, acted with knowledge that the Indemnitee's conduct was unlawful; provided, further, that no indemnification pursuant to this Section 4.7 shall be available to TSC or its Affiliates with respect to its or their obligations incurred pursuant to the Underwriting Agreement (other than obligations incurred by TSC on behalf of the Company). Any indemnification pursuant to this Section 4.7 shall be made only out of the assets of the Company, it being agreed that the Members shall not be personally liable for such indemnification and shall have no obligation to contribute or loan any monies or property to the Company to enable it to effectuate such indemnification.

13

(b) To the fullest extent permitted by law, expenses (including legal fees and expenses) incurred by an Indemnitee who is indemnified pursuant to this
Section 4.7 in defending any claim, demand, action, suit or proceeding shall, from time to time, be advanced by the Company prior to a determination that the Indemnitee is not entitled to be indemnified upon receipt by the Company of any undertaking by or on behalf of the Indemnitee to repay such amount if it shall be determined that the Indemnitee is not entitled to be indemnified as authorized in this Section 4.7.

(c) The indemnification provided by this section 4.7 shall be in addition to any other rights to which an Indemnitee may be entitled under any agreement, as a matter of law or otherwise, both as to actions in the Indemnitee's capacity as an Indemnitee and as to actions in any other capacity (including any capacity under the Underwriting Agreement), and shall continue as to an Indemnitee who has ceased to serve in such capacity and shall inure to the benefit of the heirs, successors, assigns and administrators of the Indemnitee.

(d) The Company may purchase and maintain (or reimburse any Member or its Affiliates for the cost of) insurance, on behalf of any Member, its Affiliates and such other Persons as the Board of Directors shall determine, against any liability that may be asserted against, or expense that may be incurred by, such Person in connection with the Company's activities or such Person's activities on behalf of the Company, regardless of whether the Company would have the power to indemnify such Person against such liability under the provisions of this Agreement.

(e) For purposes of this Section 4.7, the Company shall be deemed to have requested an Indemnitee to serve as fiduciary of an employee benefit plan whenever the performance by it of its duties to the Company also imposes duties on, or otherwise involves services by, it to the plan or participants or beneficiaries of the plan; excise taxes assessed on an Indemnitee with respect to an employee benefit plan pursuant to applicable law shall constitute "fines" within the meaning of Section 4.7(a); and action taken or omitted by it with respect to any employee benefit plan in the performance of its duties for a purpose reasonably believed by it to be in the best interest of the participants and beneficiaries of the plan shall be deemed to be for a purpose that is in the best interests of the Company.

14

(f) In no event may an Indemnitee subject any of the Members to personal liability by reason of the indemnification provisions set forth in this Agreement.

(g) An Indemnitee shall not be denied indemnification in whole or in part under this Section 4.7 because the Indemnitee had an interest in the transaction with respect to which the indemnification applies if the transaction was otherwise permitted by the terms of this Agreement.

(h) The provisions of this Section 4.7 are for the benefit of the Indemnitees, their heirs, successors, assigns and administrators and shall not be deemed to create any rights for the benefit of any other Persons.

(i) No amendment, modification or repeal of this Section 4.7 or any provision hereof shall in any manner terminate, reduce or impair the right of any past, present or future Indemnitee to be indemnified by the Company, nor the obligations of the Company to indemnify any such Indemnitee under and in accordance with the provisions of this Section 4.7 as in effect immediately prior to such amendment, modification or repeal with respect to claims arising from or relating to matters occurring, in whole or in part, prior to such amendment, modification or repeal, regardless of when such claims may arise or be asserted.

4.8 Liability of Indemnitees.

(a) No Indemnitee shall be personally liable for the debts and obligations of the Company.

(b) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary set forth in this Agreement, no Indemnitee shall be liable for monetary damages to the Company for losses sustained or liabilities incurred as a result of any act or omission of an Indemnitee unless there has been a final and non-appealable judgment entered by a court of competent jurisdiction determining that, in respect of the matter in question, the Indemnitee acted in bad faith or engaged in fraud, willful misconduct or gross negligence or, in the case of a criminal matter, acted with knowledge that the Indemnitee's conduct was criminal.

(c) To the full extent that the Act permits the limitation or elimination of liability of Directors, a Director shall not be liable to the Company or its Members for monetary damages for breach of fiduciary duty as a Director.

15

(d) Any amendment, modification or repeal of this Section 4.8 or any provision hereof shall be prospective only and shall not in any way affect the limitations on the liability of the Indemnitees under this Section 4.8 as in effect immediately prior to such amendment, modification or repeal with respect to claims arising from or relating to matters occurring, in whole or in part, prior to such amendment, modification or repeal, regardless of when such claims may arise or be asserted.

4.9 Actions Required by Member.

(a) Notwithstanding herein to the contrary, the Board of Directors will not take any action without approval of the Member with respect to an extraordinary matter that would have, or would reasonably be expected to have, a material effect, directly or indirectly, on the Member's interests in the Company. The type of extraordinary matter referred to in the prior sentence which requires approval of the Member shall include, but not be limited to, the following: (i) commencement of any action relating to bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization or relief of debtors by the Company, the Limited Partnership or a material subsidiary of any such entity; (ii) a merger, consolidation, recapitalization or similar transaction involving the Company, the Limited Partnership or a material subsidiary of any such entity; (iii) a sale, exchange or other transfer not in the ordinary course of business of a substantial portion of the assets of the Limited Partnership or a material subsidiary, viewed in each case on a consolidated basis, in one or a series of related transactions; (iv) dissolution or liquidation of the Company or the Limited Partnership; (v) a material amendment of the Limited Partnership Agreement; and (vi) a material change in the amount of the quarterly distribution made on the Common Units or the payment of a material extraordinary distribution by the Limited Partnership. An extraordinary matter will be deemed approved by the Member if the Board of Directors receives a written, facsimile or electronic instruction evidencing such approval from the Member or if a majority of the Directors that do not meet the independence and experience requirements as set forth most recently by the NYSE because of their affiliation with the Member approve such matter. To the fullest extent permitted by law, a Director, acting as such, shall have no duty, responsibility or liability to the Member with respect to any action by the Board of Directors approved as required above by the Member.

16

(b) Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, the Member shall have exclusive authority over the business and affairs of the Company that do not relate to management and control of the Limited Partnership. The matters referred to in the immediately preceding sentence where the Member shall have exclusive authority shall include but not be limited to (i) the amount and timing of distributions paid by the Company, (ii) the issuance or repurchase of any equity interests in the Company, (iii) the prosecution, settlement or management of any claim made directly against the Company, (iv) whether to sell, convey, transfer or pledge any asset of the Company, (v) whether to amend, modify or waive any rights relating to the assets of the Company (including the decision to amend or forego distributions by the Limited Partnership in respect of the Incentive Distribution Rights), and (vi) whether to enter into any agreement to incur an obligation of the Company other than an agreement entered into for and on behalf of the Limited Partnership for which the Company is liable exclusively by virtue of its capacity as general partner of the Limited Partnership.

(c) Without limiting the authority granted by Section 4.9(b), the Member shall have exclusive authority to cause the Company to exercise the rights of the Company, as general partner of the Limited Partnership, provided in the following provisions of the Limited Partnership Agreement:

(i) Section 2.4 ("Purpose and Business"), with respect to decisions to propose or approve the conduct by the Limited Partnership of any business;

(ii) Sections 4.6(a) and (b) ("Transfer of the General Partner's General Partner Interest") and Section 4.7 ("Transfer of Incentive Distribution Rights"), solely with respect to the decision by the Company to transfer its general partner interest in the Limited Partnership or its Incentive Distribution Rights;

(iii) Section 5.2 (b) ("Contributions by the General Partner and its Affiliates"), solely with respect to the decision to make additional capital contributions to the Limited Partnership;

(iv) Section 5.8 ("Limited Preemptive Right");

(v) Section 7.5(d) (relating to the right of the Company and its Affiliates to purchase Partnership Securities and exercise rights related thereto) and Section 7.11

17

("Purchase and Sale of Partnership Securities"), solely with respect to decisions by the Company to purchase or otherwise acquire and sell Partnership Securities for its own account;

(vi) Section 7.6(a) ("Loans from the General Partner; Loans or Contributions from the Partnership or Group Members"), solely with respect to the decision by the Company to lend funds to a Group Member, subject to the provisions of Section 7.9 of the Limited Partnership Agreement;

(vii) Section 7.7 ("Indemnification"), solely with respect to any decision by the Company to exercise its rights as an "Indemnitee;"

(viii) Section 7.12 ("Registration Rights of the General Partner and its Affiliates"), solely with respect to any decision to exercise registration rights;

(ix) Section 11.1 ("Withdrawal of the General Partner"), solely with respect to the decision by the Company to withdraw as general partner of the Limited Partnership and to giving notices required thereunder;

(x) Section 11.3(a) and (b) ("Interest of Departing General Partner and Successor General Partner"); and

(xi) Section 15.1 ("Right to Acquire Limited Partner Interests").

5 DISTRIBUTIONS

5.1 Distributions/Available Cash.

The Board of Directors shall in its sole discretion determine from time to time to what extent (if any) the Company's cash on hand exceeds the current and anticipated needs of the Company. To the extent any such excess exists, the Board of Directors may make distributions to the Members, subject to the Act.

6 BOOKS AND RECORDS; FISCAL YEAR; BANK ACCOUNTS; TAX MATTERS

6.1 Books and Records.

18

The books and records of the Company shall, at the cost and expense of the Company, be kept by the Company at the principal office of the Company or at such other location outside Canada as the Board of Directors may from time to time determine.

6.2 Fiscal Year.

Unless otherwise determined by the Board of Directors, the Company's books and records shall be kept on a December 31 calendar year basis and shall reflect all Company transactions and be appropriate and adequate for conducting the Company's affairs.

6.3 Bank Accounts.

All funds of the Company will be deposited in its name in an account or accounts maintained outside Canada with such bank or banks selected by the Board of Directors. Checks shall be drawn upon the Company account or accounts only for the purposes of the Company and may be signed by such persons (none of whom are residents of Canada) as may be designated by the Board of Directors.

6.4 Tax Matters.

TSC intends and acknowledges that, for so long as it remains the sole Member of the Company, the Company shall be disregarded as a separate entity from TSC for U.S. federal income tax purposes and TSC shall file such elections with the U.S. federal tax authorities as may be required to assure such tax status.

7 MISCELLANEOUS

7.1 Complete Agreement.

This Agreement and the exhibits hereto constitute the complete and exclusive statement of the agreement regarding the operation of the Company and replace and supersede all prior agreements regarding the operation of the Company.

7.2 Governing Law.

This Agreement and the rights of the parties hereunder will be governed by, interpreted, and enforced in accordance with the laws of the Marshall Islands without giving regard to principles of conflicts of law.

19

7.3 Headings.

All headings herein are inserted only for convenience and ease of reference and are not to be considered in the construction or interpretation of any provision of this Agreement.

7.4 Severability.

If any provision of this Agreement is held to be illegal, invalid or unenforceable under the present or future laws effective during the term of this Agreement, such provision will be fully severable; this Agreement shall be construed and enforced as if such illegal, invalid or unenforceable provision had never comprised a part of this Agreement; and the remaining provisions of this Agreement shall remain in full force and effect and shall not be affected by the illegal, invalid or unenforceable provision or by its severance from this Agreement. Furthermore, in lieu of such illegal, invalid or unenforceable provision, there will be added automatically as a part of this Agreement a provision as similar in terms to such illegal, invalid or unenforceable provision as may be possible and be legal, valid and enforceable.

7.5 No Third Party Beneficiary.

This Agreement is made solely and specifically for the benefit of the Members and their successors and assigns and no other Persons shall have any rights, interest or claims hereunder or be entitled to any benefits under or on account of this Agreement as a third party beneficiary or otherwise.

7.6 Amendment.

All amendments to this Agreement must be in writing and signed by all of the Members.

20

WHEREFORE, this Amended and Restated Limited Liability Company Agreement has been executed by a duly authorized representative of TSC, as sole Member, as of the date first set forth above.

TEEKAY SHIPPING CORPORATION

By:

Arthur Bensler Attorney-in-Fact

21

Exhibit 1

CERTIFICATE OF FORMATION

OF

TEEKAY OFFSHORE GP L.L.C.

UNDER SECTION 9 OF THE MARSHALL ISLANDS LIMITED LIABILITY COMPANY ACT

1. The name of the Limited Liability Company is: Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C.

2. The address of its registered agent in the Marshall Islands is Trust Company Complex, Ajeltake Islands, Ajeltake Road, Majuro, Marshall Islands MH 96960. The name of its registered agent at such address is The Trust Company of the Marshall Islands, Inc.

3. The formation date of the Limited Liability Company is the date of the filing of this Certificate of Formation with the Registrar of Corporations.

WHEREFORE, the undersigned has executed this Certificate of Formation on the [_____] day of August, 2006.

/s/ Leo Chang
----------------------------------------
Authorized Person


Exhibit 2

CERTIFICATE OF LIMITED LIABILITY INTEREST

OF

TEEKAY OFFSHORE GP L.L.C.

FORMED UNDER THE LAWS OF THE REPUBLIC OF THE MARSHALL ISLANDS

This Certificate evidences the ownership of [_____] of [_____]% of the limited liability company interests in Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C. (the "COMPANY") subject to the Certificate of Formation and the Amended and Restated Limited Liability Company Agreement of the Company.

Witness, the signature of the Company.

Dated: [_____]                          TEEKAY OFFSHORE GP L.L.C.


                                        By:
                                            ------------------------------------
                                        Name:
                                              ----------------------------------
                                        Title:
                                               ---------------------------------


For value Received, the undersigned hereby sells, assigns and transfers unto ____________________ all of its limited liability company ownership interest in TEEKAY OFFSHORE GP L.L.C. as is represented by the within Certificate.

Dated: [_____]

By:

In Presence of

EXHIBIT 3.5

CERTIFICATE OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP
PURSUANT TO SECTION 10 OF PART III, DIVISION 2, OF THE
ASSOCIATIONS LAW OF THE REPUBLIC OF THE MARSHALL ISLANDS
(LIMITED PARTNERSHIP ACT)

Pursuant to the provisions of the Marshall Islands Limited Partnership Act, the undersigned desires to form a Limited Partnership and certifies the following:

1. The name of the Limited Partnership is Teekay Offshore Operating L.P.
(the "LIMITED PARTNERSHIP").

2. The registered address of the Limited Partnership in the Marshall Islands is: Trust Company Complex, Ajeltake Island, Ajeltake Road, Majuro, Marshall Islands MH96960. The name of the Limited Partnership's Registered Agent in the Marshall Islands upon whom process may be served at such address is: The Trust Company of the Marshall Islands, Inc.

3. The name and the business, residence or mailing address of the sole general partner is:

Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C.

c/o Teekay Shipping Limited

Bayside House, Bayside Executive Park West Bay Street & Blake Road P.O. Box AP- 59212
Nassau, Bahamas

4. The name and title of the person authorized to sign this Certificate of Limited Partnership for the general partner is:

Arthur Bensler
Executive Vice President, General Counsel and Secretary

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the undersigned has executed this Certificate of Limited Partnership on this 22nd day of September, 2006.

TEEKAY OFFSHORE OPERATING GP L.L.C.
By: Teekay Shipping Corporation, its Sole Member

By:  /s/ Arthur Bensler
     -----------------------------------------------------------
         Arthur Bensler
         Executive Vice President, General Counsel and Secretary


EXHIBIT 3.6


AMENDED AND RESTATED

AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP

OF

TEEKAY OFFSHORE OPERATING L.P.

DATED: AS OF ____________ __, 2006



AMENDED AND RESTATED
AGREEMENT OF
LIMITED PARTNERSHIP
OF
TEEKAY OFFSHORE OPERATING L.P.

THIS AMENDED AND RESTATED AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP OF TEEKAY OFFSHORE OPERATING L.P., dated as of ___________ __, 2006, is entered into and executed by TEEKAY OFFSHORE OPERATING GP L.L.C., a Marshall Islands limited liability company, as General Partner, and TEEKAY SHIPPING CORPORATION, a Marshall Islands corporation, and TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS L.P., a Marshall Islands limited partnership, as Limited Partners.

RECITALS

WHEREAS, the Partnership was formed on September 25, 2006 pursuant to the Act, subject to an Agreement of Limited Partnership dated as of September 25, 2006 entered into by Teekay Shipping Corporation as limited partner and the General Partner as general partner.

WHEREAS, Teekay Shipping Corporation has transferred portions of its limited partner interest in the Partnership to Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. and Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C. and its interest in the General Partner to Teekay Offshore Partners L.P., and Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C. has transferred its interest in the Partnership to Teekay Offshore Partners L.P.

WHEREAS, the General Partner and Limited Partners now desire to amend and restate the Agreement of Limited Partnership in its entirety upon the terms and conditions stated below.

NOW, THEREFORE, the Agreement of Limited Partnership is hereby amended and restated in its entirety as follows:

ARTICLE I

DEFINITIONS

The following definitions shall for all purposes, unless otherwise clearly indicated to the contrary, apply to the terms used in this Agreement.

"Act" means the Marshall Islands Limited Partnership Act, as amended from time to time, and any successor to such act.

2

TEEKAY OFFSHORE OPERATING L.P.
AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP


"Affiliate" means, with respect to any Person, any other Person that directly or indirectly through one or more intermediaries controls, is controlled by or is under common control with, the Person in question. As used herein, the term "control" means the possession, direct or indirect, of the power to direct or cause the direction of the management and policies of a Person, whether through ownership of voting securities, by contract or otherwise.

"Agreement" means this Amended and Restated Agreement of Limited Partnership of Teekay Offshore Operating L.P., as it may be amended, supplemented or restated from time to time. This Agreement shall constitute a "partnership agreement" as such term is defined in the Act.

"Certificate of Limited Partnership" means the Certificate of Limited Partnership filed with the Registrar of Corporations of the Republic of the Marshall Islands as described in the first sentence of Section 2.5, as amended or restated from time to time.

"Code" means the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, and in effect from time to time. Any reference herein to a specific section or sections of the Code shall be deemed to include a reference to any corresponding provision of any successor law.

"General Partner" means Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C., a Marshall Islands limited liability company, in its capacity as the general partner of the Partnership, and any successor to Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C., as the general partner of the Partnership.

"Indemnitee" means (a) the General Partner, (b) any former General Partner,
(c) any Person who is or was an Affiliate of the General Partner or any former General Partner, (d) any Person who is or was a member, partner, director, officer, fiduciary or trustee of any Person which any of the preceding clauses of this definition describes, (e) any Person who is or was serving at the request of the General Partner or any former General Partner or any Affiliate of the General Partner or any former General Partner as an officer, director, member, partner, fiduciary or trustee of another Person, (provided, however, that that Person shall not be an Indemnitee by reason of providing, on a fee-for-services basis, trustee, fiduciary or custodial services), and (f)

3

TEEKAY OFFSHORE OPERATING L.P.
AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP


any other Person the General Partner designates as an "Indemnitee" for purposes of this Agreement.

"Limited Partner" means the Persons listed as Limited Partners on Schedule I, as it may be updated, amended, supplemented or restated from time to time by the General Partner, and any other limited partner admitted to the Partnership from time to time following the date of this Agreement.

"Partner" means the General Partner or any Limited Partner.

"Partnership" means Teekay Offshore Operating L.P., a Marshall Islands limited partnership.

"Percentage Interest" means, with respect to any Partner, the percentage set forth on Schedule I next to such Partner's name under the heading "Percentage Interest."

"Person" or "person" means an individual or a corporation, firm, limited liability company, partnership, joint venture, trust, unincorporated organization, association, governmental agency or political subdivision thereof or other entity.

ARTICLE II

ORGANIZATIONAL MATTERS

Section 2.1 Formation. Subject to the provisions of this Agreement, the General Partner and Teekay Shipping Corporation as the initial limited partner formed the Partnership as a limited partnership pursuant to the provisions of the Act. The General Partner and the Limited Partners hereby enter into this Agreement to set forth the rights and obligations of the Partners and certain matters related thereto. Except as otherwise provided herein, the rights and obligations of the Partners and the administration, dissolution and termination of the Partnership shall be governed by the Act.

Section 2.2 Name. The name of the Partnership shall be, and the business of the Partnership shall be conducted under the name of, "Teekay Offshore Operating L.P."

4

TEEKAY OFFSHORE OPERATING L.P.
AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP


Section 2.3 Principal Office; Registered Office.

(a) The principal office of the Partnership shall be at Bayside House, Bayside Executive Park, West Bay Street & Blake Road, P.O. Box AP-59212, Nassau, Bahamas, c/o Teekay Shipping Limited, or such other place as the General Partner may from time to time designate. The Partnership may maintain offices at such other places as the General Partner deems advisable.

(b) Unless and until changed by the General Partner, the address of the Partnership's registered office in the Marshall Islands is Trust Company Complex, Ajeltake Island, Ajeltake Road, Majuro, Marshall Islands MH96960, and the name of the Partnership's registered agent for service of process at such address shall be The Trust Company of the Marshall Islands, Inc.

Section 2.4 Term. The Partnership shall continue in existence until an election by the General Partner to dissolve the Partnership.

Section 2.5 Organizational Certificate. A Certificate of Limited Partnership of the Partnership has been filed by the General Partner with the Registrar of Corporations of The Marshall Islands as required by the Act. The General Partner shall cause to be filed such other certificates or documents as may be required for the formation, operation and qualification of a limited partnership in the Marshall Islands and any jurisdiction in which the Partnership may elect to do business. The General Partner shall thereafter file any necessary amendments to the Certificate of Limited Partnership and any such other certificates and documents and do all things requisite to the maintenance of the Partnership as a limited partnership (or as a partnership in which the Limited Partners have limited liability) under the laws of the Marshall Islands and any jurisdiction in which the Partnership may elect to do business.

Section 2.6 Fiscal Year. The fiscal year of the Partnership shall be January 1 to December 31.

5

TEEKAY OFFSHORE OPERATING L.P.
AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP


ARTICLE III

PURPOSE

The purpose and business of the Partnership shall be to engage in any lawful activity for which limited partnerships may be organized under the Act.

ARTICLE IV

CAPITAL CONTRIBUTIONS; PERCENTAGE INTERESTS

No Partner shall have the obligation to make any additional capital contribution to the Partnership. The Percentage Interests of the Partners are set forth on Schedule I, as such schedule may be updated, amended, supplemented or restated from time to time.

ARTICLE V

CAPITAL ACCOUNTS ALLOCATIONS

Section 5.1 Capital Accounts. The Partnership shall maintain a capital account for each of the Partners in accordance with the regulations issued pursuant to Section 704 of the Code and as determined by the General Partner as consistent therewith.

Section 5.2 Allocations. For U.S. federal income tax purposes, each item of income, gain, loss, deduction and credit of the Partnership shall be allocated among the Partners in accordance with their Percentage Interests, except that the General Partner shall have the authority to make such other allocations as are necessary and appropriate to comply with Section 704 of the Code and the regulations issued pursuant thereto.

Section 5.3 Reserves and Distributions. From time to time, but not less often than quarterly, the General Partner shall review the Partnership's accounts and determine the amount of the Partnership's available cash and appropriate reserves (including cash reserves for future maintenance capital expenditures, working capital and other matters), and the Partnership shall make a distribution to the Partners of the available cash, subject to the reserves. The General Partner's determination of the amount of distributions and reserves shall be made on its behalf by its sole member, Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. The General Partner may make such cash

6

TEEKAY OFFSHORE OPERATING L.P.
AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP


distributions as it may determine and without being limited to current or accumulated income or gains from any Partnership funds, including, without limitation, Partnership revenues, capital contributions or borrowed funds; provided that no such distribution shall be made if, after giving effect thereto, the liabilities of the Partnership exceed the fair market value of the assets of the Partnership. In its sole discretion, the General Partner may, subject to the foregoing proviso, also distribute to the Partners other Partnership property or other securities of the Partnership or other entities. All distributions, including distributions in liquidation of the Partnership, shall be made in accordance with the Percentage Interests of the Partners.

ARTICLE VI

MANAGEMENT AND OPERATIONS OF BUSINESS

Section 6.1 General Partners Authority; Reimbursement. Except as otherwise expressly provided in this Agreement, all powers to control and manage the business and affairs of the Partnership shall be vested exclusively in the General Partner; and the Limited Partners shall not have any power to control or manage the Partnership. The General Partner shall be reimbursed on a basis as the General Partner may determine for (i) all direct and indirect expenses it incurs or payments it makes on behalf of the Partnership (including salary, bonus, incentive compensation and other amounts paid to any Person, including Affiliates of the General Partner, to perform services for the Partnership or for the General Partner in the discharge of its duties to the Partnership) and
(ii) all other direct and indirect expenses allocable to the Partnership or otherwise incurred by the General Partner in connection with operating the Partnership's business (including expenses allocated to the General Partner by its Affiliates). The General Partner shall determine the expenses that are allocable to the Partnership. Reimbursements pursuant to this Section 6.1 shall be in addition to any reimbursement to the General Partner as a result of indemnification pursuant to Section 6.4. The General Partner may be removed or replaced only with the written consent of the General Partner and Limited Partners having at least 75% of the Percentage Interests.

Section 6.2 Approval Required for Certain Action. In addition to matters set forth in Section 5.2, the General Partner shall not cause the Partnership to, and the Partnership shall not, take any of the following actions without the approval or consent of the sole member of the

7

TEEKAY OFFSHORE OPERATING L.P.
AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP


General Partner, Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. (which consent may be made categorically or by policy):

- effecting any merger or consolidation involving the Partnership;

- effecting any sale or exchange of all or substantially all of Partnership's assets;

- dissolving or liquidating the Partnership;

- creating or causing to exist any consensual restriction on the ability of the Partnership or its subsidiaries to make distributions, pay any indebtedness, make loans or advances or transfer assets to its Limited Partners or their subsidiaries;

- settling or compromising any claim, dispute or litigation directly against, or otherwise relating to indemnification by the Partnership of, any of the directors or officers of the General Partner; or

- issuing additional interests in the Partnership.

Section 6.3 Conflict Committee Approval of Certain Actions. Without the approval or consent of the conflicts committee of the board of directors of the general partner of the sole member of the General Partner, Teekay Offshore Partners L.P., the General Partner may not (a) amend the limited liability company agreement of the General Partner or (b) amend this Agreement.

Section 6.4 Indemnification.

(a) To the fullest extent permitted by law but subject to the limitations expressly provided in this Agreement, all Indemnitees shall be indemnified and held harmless by the Partnership from and against any and all losses, claims, damages, liabilities, joint or several, expenses (including legal fees and expenses), judgments, fines, penalties, interest, settlements or other amounts arising from any and all claims, demands, actions, suits or proceedings, whether civil, criminal, administrative or investigative, in which any Indemnitee may be involved, or is threatened to be

8

TEEKAY OFFSHORE OPERATING L.P.
AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP


involved, as a party or otherwise, by reason of its status as an Indemnitee; provided, that the Indemnitee shall not be indemnified and held harmless if there has been a final and non-appealable judgment entered by a court of competent jurisdiction determining that, in respect of the matter for which the Indemnitee is seeking indemnification pursuant to this Section 6.4, the Indemnitee acted in bad faith or engaged in fraud or willful misconduct or, in the case of a criminal matter, acted with knowledge that the Indemnitee's conduct was unlawful. Any indemnification pursuant to this Section 6.4 shall be made only out of the assets of the Partnership, it being agreed that the Partners shall not be personally liable for such indemnification and shall have no obligation to contribute or loan any monies or property to the Partnership to enable it to effectuate such indemnification.

(b) To the fullest extent permitted by law, expenses (including legal fees and expenses) incurred by an Indemnitee who is indemnified pursuant to this Section 6.4 in defending any claim, demand, action, suit or proceeding shall, from time to time, be advanced by the Partnership prior to a determination that the Indemnitee is not entitled to be indemnified upon receipt by the Partnership of any undertaking by or on behalf of the Indemnitee to repay such amount if it shall be determined that the Indemnitee is not entitled to be indemnified as authorized in this Section 6.4.

(c) The indemnification provided by this Section 6.4 shall be in addition to any other rights to which an Indemnitee may be entitled under any agreement, as a matter of law or otherwise, both as to actions in the Indemnitee's capacity as an Indemnitee and as to actions in any other capacity, and shall continue as to an Indemnitee who has ceased to serve in such capacity and shall inure to the benefit of the heirs, successors, assigns and administrators of the Indemnitee.

(d) The Partnership may purchase and maintain (or reimburse any Partner or its Affiliates for the cost of) insurance, on behalf of any Partner, its Affiliates and such other Persons as the General Partner shall determine, against any liability that may be asserted against, or expense that may be incurred by, such Person in connection

9

TEEKAY OFFSHORE OPERATING L.P.
AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP


with the Partnership's activities or such Person's activities on behalf of the Partnership, regardless of whether the Partnership would have the power to indemnify such Person against such liability under the provisions of this Agreement.

(e) For purposes of this Section 6.4, the Partnership shall be deemed to have requested an Indemnitee to serve as fiduciary of an employee benefit plan whenever the performance by it of its duties to the Partnership also imposes duties on, or otherwise involves services by, it to the plan or participants or beneficiaries of the plan; excise taxes assessed on an Indemnitee with respect to an employee benefit plan pursuant to applicable law shall constitute "fines" within the meaning of Section 6.4(a); and action taken or omitted by it with respect to any employee benefit plan in the performance of its duties for a purpose reasonably believed by it to be in the best interest of the participants and beneficiaries of the plan shall be deemed to be for a purpose that is in the best interests of the Partnership.

(f) In no event may an Indemnitee subject any of the Partners to personal liability by reason of the indemnification provisions set forth in this Agreement.

(g) An Indemnitee shall not be denied indemnification in whole or in part under this Section 6.4 because the Indemnitee had an interest in the transaction with respect to which the indemnification applies if the transaction was otherwise permitted by the terms of this Agreement.

(h) The provisions of this Section 6.4 are for the benefit of the Indemnitees, their heirs, successors, assigns and administrators and shall not be deemed to create any rights for the benefit of any other Persons.

(i) No amendment, modification or repeal of this Section 6.4 or any provision hereof shall in any manner terminate, reduce or impair the right of any past, present or future Indemnitee to be indemnified by the Partnership, nor the obligations of the Partnership to indemnify any such Indemnitee under and in accordance with the

10

TEEKAY OFFSHORE OPERATING L.P.
AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP


provisions of this Section 6.4 as in effect immediately prior to such amendment, modification or repeal with respect to claims arising from or relating to matters occurring, in whole or in part, prior to such amendment, modification or repeal, regardless of when such claims may arise or be asserted.

Section 6.5 Liability of Indemnitees.

(a) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary set forth in this Agreement, no Indemnitee shall be liable for monetary damages to the Partnership for losses sustained or liabilities incurred as a result of any act or omission of an Indemnitee unless there has been a final and non-appealable judgment entered by a court of competent jurisdiction determining that, in respect of the matter in question, the Indemnitee acted in bad faith or engaged in fraud or willful misconduct or, in the case of a criminal matter, acted with knowledge that the Indemnitee's conduct was criminal.

(b) Any amendment, modification or repeal of this Section 6.5 or any provision hereof shall be prospective only and shall not in any way affect the limitations on the liability of the Indemnitees under this
Section 6.5 as in effect immediately prior to such amendment, modification or repeal with respect to claims arising from or relating to matters occurring, in whole or in part, prior to such amendment, modification or repeal, regardless of when such claims may arise or be asserted.

Section 6.6 Loans or Contributions from the Partnership. The Partnership may lend or contribute to any Affiliate or Limited Partner, and any Affiliate or Limited Partner may borrow from the Partnership, funds on terms and conditions determined by the General Partner.

ARTICLE VII

RIGHTS AND OBLIGATIONS OF LIMITED PARTNERS

The Limited Partners shall have no liability under this Agreement.

ARTICLE VIII

DISSOLUTION AND LIQUIDATION

11

TEEKAY OFFSHORE OPERATING L.P.
AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP


The Partnership shall be dissolved, and its affairs shall be wound up, upon the expiration of its term as provided in Section 2.4.

ARTICLE IX

AMENDMENT OF PARTNERSHIP AGREEMENT

Subject to Section 6.3, the General Partner may amend any provision of this Agreement with the consent of the Limited Partners having at least 75% of the Percentage Interests, and may execute, swear to, acknowledge, deliver, file and record whatever documents may be required in connection therewith.

ARTICLE X

GENERAL PROVISIONS

Section 10.1 Addresses and Notices. Any notice to the Partnership shall be deemed given if received by it in writing at the principal office of the Partnership designated pursuant to Section 2.3(a). Any notice to the General Partner or a Limited Partner shall be deemed given if received by it in writing at the address designated in Schedule I, or such other place as the General Partner or Limited Partner may from time to time designate.

Section 10.2 Binding Effect. This Agreement shall be binding upon and inure to the benefit of the parties hereto and their successors and assigns.

Section 10.3 Integration. This Agreement constitutes the entire agreement among the parties pertaining to the subject matter hereof and supersedes all prior agreements and understandings pertaining thereto.

Section 10.4 Severability. If any provision of this Agreement is or becomes invalid, illegal or unenforceable in any respect, the validity, legality and enforceability of the remaining provisions hereof, or of such provision in other respects, shall not be affected thereby.

Section 10.5 Applicable Law. This Agreement shall be governed by and construed and enforced in accordance with the laws of the Marshall Islands.

12

TEEKAY OFFSHORE OPERATING L.P.
AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP


Section 10.6 No Third Party Beneficiary. This Agreement is made solely and specifically for the benefit of the Partners and their successors and assigns and no other Persons shall have any rights, interest or claims hereunder or be entitled to any benefits under or on account of this Agreement as a third party beneficiary or otherwise. None of the provisions of this Agreement shall be for the benefit of, or shall be enforceable by, any creditor of the Partnership.

[Remainder of Page Intentionally Left Blank]

13

TEEKAY OFFSHORE OPERATING L.P.
AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP


WHEREFORE, this Amended and Restated Agreement of Limited Partnership has been duly executed by the General Partner and the Limited Partners as of the date first above written.

GENERAL PARTNER:

TEEKAY OFFSHORE OPERATING GP L.L.C.

By: Teekay Offshore Partners L.P., its
Sole Member
By: Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C., its
General Partner

By:

Peter Evensen Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer

Place of execution:

LIMITED PARTNERS:

TEEKAY SHIPPING CORPORATION

By:

Arthur Bensler Executive Vice President, General Counsel and Secretary

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS L.P.

By: Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C., its
General Partner

By:

Peter Evensen Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer

Place of execution:

SIGNATURE PAGE

TEEKAY OFFSHORE OPERATING L.P.
AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP


SCHEDULE I

As of __________, 2006

LIMITED PARTNER NAME AND ADDRESS:                 PERCENTAGE INTEREST:
---------------------------------                 --------------------
Teekay Shipping Corporation                       74.0%

Bayside House, Bayside Executive Park
West Bay Street & Blake Road, P.O. Box AP-59212
Nassau, Bahamas

Teekay Offshore Partners L.P.                     25.99%

Bayside House, Bayside Executive Park
West Bay Street & Blake Road, P.O. Box AP-59212
Nassau, Bahamas
c/o Teekay Shipping Limited

GENERAL PARTNER NAME AND ADDRESS:                 PERCENTAGE INTEREST:
---------------------------------                 --------------------
Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C.               0.01%

Bayside House, Bayside Executive Park
West Bay Street & Blake Road, P.O. Box AP-59212
Nassau, Bahamas
c/o Teekay Shipping Limited

SIGNATURE PAGE

TEEKAY OFFSHORE OPERATING L.P.
AGREEMENT OF LIMITED PARTNERSHIP


EXHIBIT 3.7

CERTIFICATE OF FORMATION
OF
TEEKAY OFFSHORE OPERATING GP L.L.C.
UNDER SECTION 9 OF THE MARSHALL ISLANDS LIMITED LIABILITY COMPANY ACT

1. The name of the Limited Liability Company is: Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C.

2. The address of its registered agent in the Marshall Islands is Trust Company Complex, Ajeltake Islands, Ajeltake Road, Majuro, Marshall Islands MH 96960. The name of its registered agent at such address is The Trust Company of the Marshall Islands, Inc.

3. The formation date of the Limited Liability Company is the date of the filing of this Certificate of Formation with the Registrar of Corporations.

WHEREFORE, the undersigned has executed this Certificate of Formation on the 22nd day of September, 2006.

/s/ Daniel C. Rodgers
---------------------
Authorized Person


EXHIBIT 3.8


AMENDED AND RESTATED

LIMITED LIABILITY COMPANY AGREEMENT

OF

TEEKAY OFFSHORE OPERATING GP L.L.C.

A MARSHALL ISLANDS LIMITED LIABILITY COMPANY


Dated: as of __________, 2006


TABLE OF CONTENTS

1 DEFINITIONS..............................................................    1
   1.1 Defined Terms.......................................................    1
   1.2 Number and Gender...................................................    3

2 ORGANIZATION.............................................................    3
   2.1 Formation...........................................................    3
   2.2 Name................................................................    4
   2.3 Purposes............................................................    4
   2.4 Registered Office; Registered Agent.................................    4
   2.5 Principal Office....................................................    4
   2.6 Term................................................................    4
   2.7 LLC Certificate;  Transfer of Ownership Interest;  Pledge of
       Ownership Interest..................................................    4

3 CAPITAL CONTRIBUTIONS....................................................    5
   3.1 Initial Capital Contributions.......................................    5
   3.2 Additional Capital Contributions....................................    5
   3.3 Liability Limited to Capital Contributions..........................    5

4 MANAGEMENT...............................................................    6
   4.1 Board of Directors..................................................    6
   4.2 Board Membership....................................................    7
   4.3 Meetings, Quorum, Voting, Etc.......................................    8
   4.4 Delegation of Authority and Duties..................................   10
   4.5 Execution of Documents..............................................   11
   4.6 Compensation of Directors and Officers..............................   12
   4.7 Indemnification.....................................................   12
   4.8 Liability of Indemnitees............................................   14
   4.9 Actions Required by Member and Conflicts Committee of the
       Member's General Partner............................................   15

5 DISTRIBUTIONS............................................................   15
   5.1 Distributions/Available Cash........................................   15

6 BOOKS AND RECORDS; FISCAL YEAR; BANK ACCOUNTS; TAX MATTERS...............   16
   6.1 Books and Records...................................................   16
   6.2 Fiscal Year.........................................................   16
   6.3 Bank Accounts.......................................................   16
   6.4 Tax Matters.........................................................   16

7 MISCELLANEOUS............................................................   16

i

7.1 Complete Agreement..................................................   16
7.2 Governing Law.......................................................   17
7.3 Headings............................................................   17
7.4 Severability........................................................   17
7.5 No Third Party Beneficiary..........................................   17
7.6 Amendment...........................................................   17

Exhibits:

Exhibit 1: Certificate of Formation
Exhibit 2: LLC Certificate

ii

AMENDED AND RESTATED

LIMITED LIABILITY COMPANY AGREEMENT OF

TEEKAY OFFSHORE OPERATING GP L.L.C.

This Amended and Restated Limited Liability Company Agreement (this "AGREEMENT") is made and entered into effective as of the ___ day of ______, 2006, by TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS L.P., a Marshall Islands limited partnership (the "TKO").

RECITALS

WHEREAS, the Company was formed on September 25, 2006 pursuant to the Act, subject to a Limited Liability Company Agreement dated as of September 22, 2006 entered into by Teekay Shipping Corporation ("TSC") as its sole member.

WHEREAS, TSC has transferred its entire membership interest to TKO and TKO, as the sole Member, now desires to amend and restate the Limited Liability Company Agreement in its entirety upon the terms and conditions stated below.

NOW, THEREFORE, the Limited Liability Company Agreement is hereby amended and restated in its entirety as follows:

1 DEFINITIONS

1.1 Defined Terms.

When used in this Agreement, the following terms shall have the meanings set forth below:

(a) "ACT" means the Marshall Islands Limited Liability Company Act (of the Republic of The Marshall Islands Associations Law), as the same may be amended from time to time.

(b) "AGREEMENT" means this Limited Liability Company Agreement, as amended, modified, supplemented or restated from to time in accordance with its terms.

(c) "AFFILIATE" means, with respect to any Person, any other Person that directly or indirectly through one or more intermediaries controls, is controlled by or is under


common control with, the Person in question. As used in the foregoing definition, the term "CONTROL" means the possession, direct or indirect, of the power to direct or cause the direction of the management and policies of a Person, whether through ownership of voting securities, by contract or otherwise.

(d) "BOARD OF DIRECTORS" shall have the meaning set forth in Section 4.1 of this Agreement.

(e) "CANADIAN TAX ACT" means the Income Tax Act (Canada), R.S.C. 1985, 5th Supplement, c.1, as amended from time to time.

(f) "CAPITAL CONTRIBUTIONS" means the total amount of cash and/or assets a Member contributes to the Company as capital pursuant to this Agreement.

(g) "CERTIFICATE" means the Certificate of Formation in the form of Exhibit 1 hereto to be filed pursuant to the Act with the Republic of The Marshall Islands Registrar of Corporations pursuant to which the Company was formed as a Marshall Islands limited liability company.

(h) "COMPANY" means Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C., a Marshall Islands limited liability company.

(i) "DIRECTORS" means the members of the Board of Directors.

(j) "INDEMNITEE" means (i) any Person who is or was a Member, (ii) any Person who is or was an Affiliate of any Member, (iii) any Person who is or was a Director or Officer, or a fiduciary or trustee, of the Company, (iv) any Person who is or was a member, shareholder, partner, director, officer, fiduciary or trustee of any Member or an Affiliate of any Member, (v) any Person who is or was serving at the request of the Company, any Member or any Affiliate of any Member as an officer, director, member, partner, fiduciary or trustee of another Person, provided that such Person shall not be an Indemnitee by reason of providing, on a fee-for-services basis, trustee, fiduciary or custodial services, and (vi) any Person the Company designates as an "Indemnitee" for purposes of this Agreement.

(k) "INITIAL DIRECTORS" shall have the meaning set forth in Section 4.1 of this Agreement.

2

(l) "LLC CERTIFICATE" shall have the meaning set forth in Section 2.7(a) of this Agreement.

(m) "MEMBER" means TKO and any Person who, at the time of reference thereto, has been admitted to the Company as a Member in accordance with this Agreement, including any Transferee, and shall have the same meaning as the term "Member" under the Act, but shall not include any Person who has ceased to be a Member of the Company.

(n) "OFFICERS" shall have the meaning set forth in Section 4.4(a) of this Agreement.

(o) "TOO PARTNERSHIP AGREEMENT" means the Amended and Restated Agreement of Limited Partnership of Teekay Offshore Operating L.P., as it may be amended, supplemented or restated from time to time.

(p) "PERSON" means a natural person, corporation, partnership, joint venture, trust, estate, unincorporated association, limited liability company, or any other juridical entity.

(q) "TOO" means Teekay Offshore Operating L.P.

(r) "TRANSFEREE" shall have the meaning set forth in Section 2.7(b) of this Agreement.

1.2 Number and Gender.

As the context requires, all words used herein in the singular number shall extend to and include the plural, all words used in the plural number shall extend to and include the singular, and all words used in any gender shall extend to and include the other gender or be neutral.

2 ORGANIZATION

2.1 Formation.

The Company was formed on September 25, 2006 as a Marshall Islands limited liability company by the filing of the Certificate pursuant to the Act with The Republic of The Marshall Islands Registrar of Corporations.

3

2.2 Name.

The name of the Company is "Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C." and all Company business shall be conducted in that name or such other names that comply with applicable law as the Board of Directors may from time to time designate.

2.3 Purposes.

The purposes for which the Company is established is to engage in any lawful activity permitted by the Act.

2.4 Registered Office; Registered Agent.

The registered office of the Company required by the Act to be maintained in the Republic of the Marshall Islands shall be the office of the initial registered agent named in the Certificate or such other office as the Board of Directors may designate from time to time in the manner provided by law. The registered agent of the Company required by the Act to be maintained in The Republic of Marshall Islands shall be the initial registered agent named in the Certificate or such other person or persons as the Board of Directors may designate from time to time in the manner provided by law.

2.5 Principal Office.

The principal office of the Company shall be Bayside House, Bayside Executive Park, West Bay Street & Blake Road, P.O. Box AP-59213, Nassau, Bahamas.

2.6 Term.

The Company commenced on the date the Certificate was accepted for filing by the Republic of the Marshall Islands Registrar of Corporations and shall have perpetual existence, unless the Company is dissolved in accordance with the Act.

2.7 LLC Certificate; Transfer of Ownership Interest; Pledge of Ownership Interest.

(a) A Member's ownership of its limited liability company interest in the Company shall be evidenced by a certificate of limited liability interest ("LLC CERTIFICATE") substantially in the form of Exhibit 2 hereto.

4

(b) Subject to the provisions of Section 2.7(c) herein, upon the endorsement by a Member on such LLC Certificate (or on a separate transfer power) in favor of a third party (a "TRANSFEREE") and the delivery of such LLC Certificate (and such separate power, if applicable) to such Transferee, such Member shall be deemed to have assigned and transferred all its right, title and interest in the Company and in this Agreement to such Transferee and all references in this Agreement to such Member shall be deemed to refer to such Transferee, in each case effective as of the date of such LLC Certificate delivery. A Member's right, title and interest in the Company shall not be transferred other than as provided in this
Section 2.7(b).

(c) The pledge of, or granting of a security interest, lien or other encumbrance in or against, any or all of the limited liability company interest of a Member in the Company shall not cause such Member to cease to be a Member until the secured party shall have lawfully exercised its remedies under the security agreement and completed the endorsement in favor of a Transferee. Until the exercise of such remedies, the secured party shall not have the power to exercise any rights or powers of a Member.

3 CAPITAL CONTRIBUTIONS

3.1 Initial Capital Contributions.

On or near the date of the Company's formation, an initial capital contribution of U.S.$1,000 to the Company was made by TSC as the initial member.

3.2 Additional Capital Contributions.

A Member may contribute such additional sums and/or assets, if any, as it shall determine in its sole discretion.

3.3 Liability Limited to Capital Contributions.

No Member shall have any obligation to contribute money to the Company with respect to any liability or obligation of the Company. No Member shall be liable for the debts, obligations or liabilities of the Company, including, without limitation, under a judgment, decree or order of a court.

5

4 MANAGEMENT

4.1 Board of Directors.

Except for decisions or actions requiring the approval of the Members, as provided in this Agreement (including Section 4.9) or by non-waivable provisions of the Act or applicable law, the powers of the Company shall be exercised by or under the authority of, and the business and affairs of the Company shall be managed under the direction of, a board of directors (the "BOARD OF DIRECTORS") comprised of no less than three (3) and no more than nine (9) Directors. Subject to such limitations, the exact number of Directors shall be fixed from time to time by resolution of the Board of Directors and such number may be increased or decreased from time to time by vote of a majority of the Directors then in office; provided, however, that the Board of Directors initially shall be comprised of three Directors (the "INITIAL DIRECTORS"). No decrease in the number of Directors shall have the effect of shortening the term of any incumbent Director. The Board of Directors may make all decisions and take all actions for the Company as in its sole discretion it shall deem necessary or appropriate to enable the Company to carry out the purposes for which the Company was formed and to further the interests of the Members, including, without limitation, the following:

(a) Adopting, by written consent or otherwise, resolutions in the name and on behalf of the Company (either for the Company itself or for the Company in its capacity as the general partner of any limited partnership) authorizing any decisions or actions taken pursuant to this Section 4.1;

(b) entering into, making and performing such contracts, agreements, undertakings and financial guarantees in the name and on behalf of the Company;

(c) setting aside reserves, opening and maintaining bank and investment accounts and arrangements, drawing checks and other orders for the payment of money, and designating individuals with authority to sign or give instructions with respect to those accounts and arrangements;

(d) collecting sums due to the Company;

(e) selecting, removing, and changing the authority and responsibility of lawyers, auditors and other advisers and consultants;

6

(f) (i) creating such committees of the Board of Directors as the Board of Directors may deem necessary, appropriate or advisable, in its sole discretion, to carry on the affairs of the Company, (ii) selecting and removing (with or without cause, upon the affirmative vote of a majority of all of the Directors then in office) the members of such committees (provided, however, that such committees shall be comprised only of Directors and shall have only as many members as the Board of Directors deems appropriate), and (iii) changing the authority and responsibilities of such committees; and

(g) granting signatory authority to and issuing Powers of Attorney in favor of such persons as they may deem necessary or appropriate to carry out and implement any decisions or actions taken pursuant to this Section 4.1.

Notwithstanding anything in this Agreement to the contrary, the Board of Directors shall conduct the affairs and governance of the Company so that (i) the Company is not a resident of Canada for purposes of the Canadian Tax Act and
(ii) neither the Company nor the Partnership is carrying on business in Canada for purposes of the Canadian Tax Act.

4.2 Board Membership.

(a) The Members shall have full authority unilaterally to appoint, by majority vote, such individuals to be Directors as they shall choose in their sole discretion, and to remove and replace, by majority vote, any Director they appoint to the Board of Directors, with or without cause, at any time and for any reason, and to fill, by majority vote, any positions created on the Board of Directors as a result of an increase in the size of the Board of Directors; provided, however, that (i) each Director shall be a natural person and (ii) at all times a majority of the Directors shall be persons who are not residents of Canada for the purposes of the Canadian Tax Act (except in the case of (A) the Initial Directors, where not more than one director may be a resident of Canada for purposes of the Canadian Tax Act and (B) the death, resignation or dismissal of one or more Directors who are not residents of Canada for purposes of the Canadian Tax Act, provided that within 21 days of any such death, resignation or dismissal either
(1) the Members shall appoint one or more new non-resident Directors to replace each non-resident Director who died, resigned or was dismissed, or (2) one or more Directors who

7

are residents of Canada for purposes of the Canadian Tax Act shall resign to achieve the required non-resident majority).

(b) Each Director shall be appointed to serve until his or her successor shall be appointed and shall qualify or until his or her earlier resignation or removal.

(c) The Members shall designate one Director to hold the title of Chairman.

4.3 Meetings, Quorum, Voting, Etc.

(a) Meetings of the Board of Directors shall be called by the Secretary of the Company, or in the absence of the Secretary, by the Chairman of the Board of Directors, upon request of any Director. Notice of the date, time and place of each meeting of the Board of Directors shall be given to each Director at least forty-eight hours prior to such meeting, unless the notice is given orally or delivered in person, in which case it shall be given at least twenty-four hours prior to such meeting. For the purpose of this Section 4.3(a), notice shall be deemed to be duly given to a Director if given to him or her personally (including by telephone) or if such notice be delivered to such Director by courier service, mail, email, telegraph, cable, telex, or facsimile, to his or her last known address. Notice of a meeting need not be given to any Director who submits a signed waiver of notice, whether before or after the meeting, or who attends the meeting without protesting, prior to the conduct of any voting thereat, the lack of notice to him or her. All meetings of the Board of Directors shall take place outside of Canada.

(b) At all meetings of the Board of Directors, a quorum for the transaction of business shall be a majority of the Directors then in office; provided, however, that such quorum shall be properly constituted only if a majority of the Directors included in such quorum are not residents of Canada for purposes of the Canadian Tax Act.

(c) Directors may participate in a meeting of the Board of Directors or a meeting of any committee of the Board of Directors by means of conference call or any similar communications equipment by means of which all Directors participating in the meeting can hear each other, and participation in a meeting pursuant to this provision shall constitute presence in person at such meeting. A meeting of the Board of Directors or a meeting of any committee of the Board of Directors by means of such a call or any

8

similar communication shall take place only by means of such a call or communication originated outside of Canada, shall be properly constituted only if a majority of the Directors participating in the meeting in person or by such call or communication are not residents of Canada for purposes of the Canadian Tax Act and a majority of the Directors participating in the meeting in person or by such call participate from or at a location outside Canada, and shall be deemed held at the place from where such call or communication originated.

(d) All decisions to be made and actions to be taken by the Board of Directors or a committee of the Board of Directors shall be determined by the vote of a majority of the Directors in attendance at a meeting at which a quorum is present.

(e) Any action which may be taken at a meeting of the Board of Directors or a meeting of any committee of the Board of Directors may be taken without a meeting if a consent in writing, setting forth the action so taken, is signed by all of the Directors then in office. The action taken by any unanimous consent in writing shall be deemed to have occurred when the last Director executing such consent shall have signed the consent; provided, however, that the last Director to execute such consent shall not have done so while in Canada and each such consent shall include the location and the date of such execution.

(f) Unless the Board of Directors shall otherwise provide, any committee of the Board of Directors may hold meetings at any place outside Canada and make rules for the conduct of its business as such committee shall from time to time deem necessary. Each committee shall keep a record of its proceedings and report the same to the Board of Directors when required. No committee shall have the power to fill vacancies in the Board of Directors, or to change the membership of or to fill vacancies in, any other committee created by the Board of Directors, or to amend or repeal this Agreement or adopt a new limited liability company agreement, or to submit to the Member any action requiring its authorization, or to amend or repeal any resolution of the Board of Directors which by its terms shall not be amendable or repealable. All meetings of any committee of the Board of Directors shall be held outside Canada. Directors may participate in a meeting of a committee of the Board of Directors by means of conference call or any similar communications equipment by means of which all Directors participating in the meeting can hear each other, and participation in a meeting

9

pursuant to this provision shall constitute presence in person at such meeting. A meeting of a committee of the Board of Directors by means of such a call or any similar communication shall take place only by means of such a call or communication originated outside of Canada and shall be deemed held at the place from where such call or communication originated.

4.4 Delegation of Authority and Duties.

(a) The Board of Directors may, from time to time as it deems advisable, appoint and elect (as well as remove or replace at any time with or without cause for any reason) (i) a Chief Executive Officer, (ii) a Chief Financial Officer, (iii) a Secretary and (iv) such other officer positions assigned to individuals (collectively, the "OFFICERS"). Each Officer shall be a natural person who is not a resident of Canada for purposes of the Canadian Tax Act, and shall be authorized to, and shall, act in such capacity only outside of Canada. Any two or more offices may be held by the same person. If so appointed by the Board of Directors, the Officers shall have the authority and duties as may from time to time be assigned to them.

(b) In addition, the Board of Directors may, from time to time as it deems advisable, delegate to one or more natural persons (inclusive of any Director) such authority and duties as the Board of Directors is granted under this Agreement and not made subject to the approval of the Members by this Agreement, and the Board of Directors may assign in writing such titles to any such person as it deems appropriate. Any such person to whom such authority and duties are delegated by the Board of Directors shall not, during the time that such authority or duties are delegated, be a resident of Canada for purposes of the Canadian Tax Act and shall be authorized to, and shall, act in such capacity only outside of Canada. Any delegation pursuant to this
Section 4.4(b) may be revoked at any time by the Board of Directors with or without cause for any reason.

(c) Unless the Board of Directors decides otherwise, if the title of any person authorized to act on behalf of the Company under this Section 4.4 is one commonly used for officers of a business corporation formed under the Marshall Islands Business Corporation Act, the assignment of such title shall constitute the delegation to such person of the authority and duties that are normally associated with that office, subject to any specific

10

delegation of, or restriction on, authority and duties made pursuant to this Section 4.4. Any delegation or restriction pursuant to this
Section 4.4(c) may be revoked at any time by the Board of Directors, with or without cause for any reason; provided that the Board of Directors will not be entitled to revoke any restriction relating to the residence of any person as set out in this Section 4.4.

(d) Unless authorized to do so by this Agreement or by the Board of Directors, no Director, Officer, agent or employee of the Company shall have any power or authority to bind the Company in any way, to pledge its credit, or to render it liable pecuniarily for any purpose. However, the Company may act by an attorney-in-fact authorized by the Board of Directors, provided that no such attorney-in-fact shall, while having such authority, be a resident of Canada for purposes of the Canadian Tax Act and shall not be authorized to, and shall not, exercise such authority in Canada.

4.5 Execution of Documents.

(a) Any agreements, contracts or other documents or correspondence executed by the Company, including an LLC Certificate, shall show the place of execution (which shall be outside of Canada) and be signed by the individual executing same as follows:

TEEKAY OFFSHORE OPERATING GP L.L.C.

By:
Name:
Title:

(b) Any agreements, contracts or other documents or correspondence executed on behalf of the Company by the sole Member of the Company, including an LLC Certificate, shall be signed by such sole Member as follows:

TEEKAY OFFSHORE OPERATING GP L.L.C.

By: TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS L.P., its Sole Member

By: TEEKAY OFFSHORE GP L.L.C., its General Partner

By:

(Authorized Signatory)

11

(c) Any agreements, contracts or other documents or correspondence executed by the Company, either on its own behalf or in its capacity as the general partner of the Limited Partnership, shall be executed only outside of Canada.

4.6 Compensation of Directors and Officers.

(a) Members of the Board of Directors shall not receive compensation for their services to the Company as the Board of Directors or any compensation committee appointed by the Board of Directors. The Board of Directors or any compensation committee appointed by the Board of Directors may, from time to time, authorize the reimbursement by the Company of such expenses (including travel expenses) as may be incurred by Directors in the performance of their duties hereunder (including attendance at meetings of the Board of Directors).

(b) The Officers shall serve with or without such compensation for their services to the Company as the Board of Directors or any compensation committee appointed by the Board of Directors thereof shall determine.

4.7 Indemnification.

(a) To the fullest extent permitted by law but subject to the limitations expressly provided in this Agreement, all Indemnitees shall be indemnified and held harmless by the Company from and against any and all losses, claims, damages, liabilities, joint or several, expenses (including legal fees and expenses), judgments, fines, penalties, interest, settlements or other amounts arising from any and all claims, demands, actions, suits or proceedings, whether civil, criminal, administrative or investigative, in which any Indemnitee may be involved, or is threatened to be involved, as a party or otherwise, by reason of its status as an Indemnitee; provided, that the Indemnitee shall not be indemnified and held harmless if there has been a final and non-appealable judgment entered by a court of competent jurisdiction determining that, in respect of the matter for which the Indemnitee is seeking indemnification pursuant to this
Section 4.7, the Indemnitee acted in bad faith or engaged in fraud, willful misconduct or gross negligence or, in the case of a criminal matter, acted with knowledge that the Indemnitee's conduct was unlawful. Any indemnification pursuant to this Section 4.7 shall be made only out of the assets of the Company, it being agreed that the Members

12

shall not be personally liable for such indemnification and shall have no obligation to contribute or loan any monies or property to the Company to enable it to effectuate such indemnification.

(b) To the fullest extent permitted by law, expenses (including legal fees and expenses) incurred by an Indemnitee who is indemnified pursuant to this Section 4.7 in defending any claim, demand, action, suit or proceeding shall, from time to time, be advanced by the Company prior to a determination that the Indemnitee is not entitled to be indemnified upon receipt by the Company of any undertaking by or on behalf of the Indemnitee to repay such amount if it shall be determined that the Indemnitee is not entitled to be indemnified as authorized in this Section 4.7.

(c) The indemnification provided by this section 4.7 shall be in addition to any other rights to which an Indemnitee may be entitled under any agreement, as a matter of law or otherwise, both as to actions in the Indemnitee's capacity as an Indemnitee and as to actions in any other capacity, and shall continue as to an Indemnitee who has ceased to serve in such capacity and shall inure to the benefit of the heirs, successors, assigns and administrators of the Indemnitee.

(d) The Company may purchase and maintain (or reimburse any Member or its Affiliates for the cost of) insurance, on behalf of any Member, its Affiliates and such other Persons as the Board of Directors shall determine, against any liability that may be asserted against, or expense that may be incurred by, such Person in connection with the Company's activities or such Person's activities on behalf of the Company, regardless of whether the Company would have the power to indemnify such Person against such liability under the provisions of this Agreement.

(e) For purposes of this Section 4.7, the Company shall be deemed to have requested an Indemnitee to serve as fiduciary of an employee benefit plan whenever the performance by it of its duties to the Company also imposes duties on, or otherwise involves services by, it to the plan or participants or beneficiaries of the plan; excise taxes assessed on an Indemnitee with respect to an employee benefit plan pursuant to applicable law shall constitute "fines" within the meaning of Section 4.7(a); and action taken or omitted by it with respect to any employee benefit plan in the performance of its duties for a purpose

13

reasonably believed by it to be in the best interest of the participants and beneficiaries of the plan shall be deemed to be for a purpose that is in the best interests of the Company.

(f) In no event may an Indemnitee subject any of the Members to personal liability by reason of the indemnification provisions set forth in this Agreement.

(g) An Indemnitee shall not be denied indemnification in whole or in part under this Section 4.7 because the Indemnitee had an interest in the transaction with respect to which the indemnification applies if the transaction was otherwise permitted by the terms of this Agreement.

(h) The provisions of this Section 4.7 are for the benefit of the Indemnitees, their heirs, successors, assigns and administrators and shall not be deemed to create any rights for the benefit of any other Persons.

(i) No amendment, modification or repeal of this Section 4.7 or any provision hereof shall in any manner terminate, reduce or impair the right of any past, present or future Indemnitee to be indemnified by the Company, nor the obligations of the Company to indemnify any such Indemnitee under and in accordance with the provisions of this Section 4.7 as in effect immediately prior to such amendment, modification or repeal with respect to claims arising from or relating to matters occurring, in whole or in part, prior to such amendment, modification or repeal, regardless of when such claims may arise or be asserted.

4.8 Liability of Indemnitees.

(a) No Indemnitee shall be personally liable for the debts and obligations of the Company.

(b) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary set forth in this Agreement, no Indemnitee shall be liable for monetary damages to the Company for losses sustained or liabilities incurred as a result of any act or omission of an Indemnitee unless there has been a final and non-appealable judgment entered by a court of competent jurisdiction determining that, in respect of the matter in question, the Indemnitee acted in bad faith or engaged in fraud, willful misconduct or gross negligence or, in the case of a criminal matter, acted with knowledge that the Indemnitee's conduct was criminal.

14

(c) To the full extent that the Act permits the limitation or elimination of liability of Directors, a Director shall not be liable to the Company or its Members for monetary damages for breach of fiduciary duty as a Director.

(d) Any amendment, modification or repeal of this Section 4.8 or any provision hereof shall be prospective only and shall not in any way affect the limitations on the liability of the Indemnitees under this
Section 4.8 as in effect immediately prior to such amendment, modification or repeal with respect to claims arising from or relating to matters occurring, in whole or in part, prior to such amendment, modification or repeal, regardless of when such claims may arise or be asserted.

4.9 Actions Required by Member and Conflicts Committee of the Member's General Partner.

(a) The following actions may only be taken or determined by the Member:

- The determination of the amount of TOO's distributions and reserves in accordance with Section 5.3 of the TOO Partnership Agreement; and

- The Company's taking any action with respect to TOO and referred to in Section 6.2 of the TOO Partnership Agreement.

(b) The Company shall not without the approval or consent of the conflicts committee of the board of directors of the general partner of the Member:

- Amend the TOO Partnership Agreement; or

- Amend this Agreement.

5 DISTRIBUTIONS

5.1 Distributions/Available Cash.

The Board of Directors shall in its sole discretion determine from time to time to what extent (if any) the Company's cash on hand exceeds the current and anticipated needs of the Company. To the extent any such excess exists, the Board of Directors may make distributions to the Member(s), subject to the Act.

15

6 BOOKS AND RECORDS; FISCAL YEAR; BANK ACCOUNTS; TAX MATTERS

6.1 Books and Records.

The books and records of the Company shall, at the cost and expense of the Company, be kept by the Company at the principal office of the Company or at such other location outside Canada as the Board of Directors may from time to time determine.

6.2 Fiscal Year.

Unless otherwise determined by the Board of Directors, the Company's books and records shall be kept on a December 31 calendar year basis and shall reflect all Company transactions and be appropriate and adequate for conducting the Company's affairs.

6.3 Bank Accounts.

All funds of the Company will be deposited in its name in an account or accounts maintained outside Canada with such bank or banks selected by the Board of Directors. Checks shall be drawn upon the Company account or accounts only for the purposes of the Company and may be signed by such persons (none of whom are residents of Canada) as may be designated by the Board of Directors.

6.4 Tax Matters.

TKO intends and acknowledges that, for so long as it remains the sole Member of the Company, the Company shall be disregarded as a separate entity from TKO for U.S. federal income tax purposes and TKO shall file such elections with the U.S. federal tax authorities as may be required to assure such tax status.

7 MISCELLANEOUS

7.1 Complete Agreement.

This Agreement and the exhibits hereto constitute the complete and exclusive statement of the agreement regarding the operation of the Company and replace and supersede all prior agreements regarding the operation of the Company.

16

7.2 Governing Law.

This Agreement and the rights of the parties hereunder will be governed by, interpreted, and enforced in accordance with the laws of the Marshall Islands without giving regard to principles of conflicts of law.

7.3 Headings.

All headings herein are inserted only for convenience and ease of reference and are not to be considered in the construction or interpretation of any provision of this Agreement.

7.4 Severability.

If any provision of this Agreement is held to be illegal, invalid or unenforceable under the present or future laws effective during the term of this Agreement, such provision will be fully severable; this Agreement shall be construed and enforced as if such illegal, invalid or unenforceable provision had never comprised a part of this Agreement; and the remaining provisions of this Agreement shall remain in full force and effect and shall not be affected by the illegal, invalid or unenforceable provision or by its severance from this Agreement. Furthermore, in lieu of such illegal, invalid or unenforceable provision, there will be added automatically as a part of this Agreement a provision as similar in terms to such illegal, invalid or unenforceable provision as may be possible and be legal, valid and enforceable.

7.5 No Third Party Beneficiary.

This Agreement is made solely and specifically for the benefit of the Member and its successors and assigns and no other Persons shall have any rights, interest or claims hereunder or be entitled to any benefits under or on account of this Agreement as a third party beneficiary or otherwise.

7.6 Amendment.

All amendments to this Agreement must be in writing and signed by all of the Member(s).

17

WHEREFORE, this Amended and Restated Limited Liability Company Agreement has been executed by a duly authorized representative of TKO as of the date first set forth above.

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS L.P.

By: Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C., its
General Partner

By:

Peter Evensen Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer

Place of execution:

18

Exhibit 1

CERTIFICATE OF FORMATION

OF

TEEKAY OFFSHORE OPERATING GP L.L.C.

UNDER SECTION 9 OF THE MARSHALL ISLANDS LIMITED LIABILITY COMPANY ACT

1. The name of the Limited Liability Company is: Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C.

2. The address of its registered agent in the Marshall Islands is Trust Company Complex, Ajeltake Islands, Ajeltake Road, Majuro, Marshall Islands MH 96960. The name of its registered agent at such address is The Trust Company of the Marshall Islands, Inc.

3. The formation date of the Limited Liability Company is the date of the filing of this Certificate of Formation with the Registrar of Corporations.

WHEREFORE, the undersigned has executed this Certificate of Formation on the 22nd day of September, 2006.

/s/ Daniel C. Rodgers
-------------------------------------
Authorized Person


Exhibit 2

CERTIFICATE OF LIMITED LIABILITY INTEREST

OF

TEEKAY OFFSHORE OPERATING GP L.L.C.

ORGANIZED UNDER THE LAWS OF THE REPUBLIC OF THE MARSHALL ISLANDS

This Certificate evidences the ownership of [_____] of [_____]% of the limited liability interests in Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C. (the "COMPANY") subject to the Certificate of Formation and Limited Liability Company Agreement of the Company.

Witness the signature of the Company.

Dated:

TEEKAY OFFSHORE OPERATING GP L.L.C.

By:

Name:
Title:

For value Received, the undersigned hereby sells, assigns and transfers unto ____________________ all of its limited liability company ownership interest in Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C. represented by the within Certificate.

Dated:

By:

In Presence of

EXHIBIT 5.1

WATSON, FARLEY & WILLIAMS (NEW YORK) LLP
100 Park Avenue
New York, New York 10017
Tel (212) 922 2200
Fax (212) 922 1512

December 4, 2006

Teekay Offshore Partners L.P.
Bayside House, Bayside Executive Park
West Bay Street and Blake Road
Nassau, Commonwealth of the Bahamas

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS L.P. - REGISTRATION STATEMENT ON FORM F-1

Dear Sirs:

We have acted as special counsel as to matters of the law of the Republic of The Marshall Islands ("MARSHALL ISLANDS LAW") for Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. (the "PARTNERSHIP") in connection with the preparation of a Registration Statement on Form F-1 (the "REGISTRATION STATEMENT") to be filed by the Partnership with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the "SEC") pursuant to the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the "ACT"), and the rules and regulations thereunder, with respect to the issuance and sale by the Partnership of up to 7,000,000 common units (the "COMMON UNITS") of the Partnership.

In so acting, we have examined originals, or copies, certified to our satisfaction, of (i) the form of the First Amended and Restated Agreement of Limited Partnership (the "PARTNERSHIP AGREEMENT") of the Partnership, (ii) the form of the Company's Registration Statement and the prospectus (the "PROSPECTUS") included therein, (iii) the form of the underwriting agreement (the "UNDERWRITING AGREEMENT") to be executed among the Partnership, the representatives of the underwriters named therein, Teekay Shipping Corporation, Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C. (the "GENERAL PARTNER"), Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C. and Teekay Offshore Operating L.P. relating to the issuance and sale of the Common Units, and (iv) originals, or copies certified to our satisfaction, of all such records of the Partnership, agreements and other documents, certificates of public officials, officers and representatives of the Partnership, the General Partner and other appropriate persons, and such other documents as we have deemed necessary as a basis for the opinions hereinafter expressed. In such examinations, we have assumed without independent investigation, (a) the genuineness of all signatures, the authenticity of all documents submitted to us as originals, the conformity to original documents of all documents submitted to us as photostatic or facsimile copies, and the authenticity of the originals of such copies and (b) the accuracy of the factual representations made to us by officers and other representatives of the Partnership and the General Partner, whether evidenced by certificates or otherwise. In addition, for purposes of our opinion below, we have assumed due execution and delivery of the Partnership Agreement and the Underwriting Agreement by the parties


Teekay Offshore Partners L.P.
December 4, 2006 Page 2

thereto substantially in the form examined by us, the filing by the Company with the SEC of the Registration Statement and Prospectus substantially in the form examined by us, and the declaration by the SEC of the effectiveness of such Registration Statement.

This opinion is limited to Marshall Islands Law and is as of the effective date of the Registration Statement.

Based on the foregoing and having regard to legal considerations which we deem relevant, we are of the opinion that when issued and delivered against payment therefor in accordance with the terms of the Partnership Agreement, the Underwriting Agreement and the Registration Statement and Prospectus, the Common Units will be duly authorized, validly issued, fully paid and non-assessable.

We consent to the filing of this opinion as an exhibit to the Registration Statement and to the reference to our name in the Prospectus. In giving such consent, we do not admit that we are in the category of persons whose consent is required under Section 7 of the Act.

Very truly yours,

/s/  Watson, Farley & Williams (New York) LLP
---------------------------------------------
WATSON, FARLEY & WILLIAMS (NEW YORK) LLP


Exhibit 8.1

December 4, 2006

Teekay Offshore Partners L.P.
Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C.
Bayside House, Bayside Executive Park
West Bay Street and Blake Road
P.O. Box AP-59212
Nassau, Commonwealth of the Bahamas

RE: REGISTRATION STATEMENT ON FORM F-1

Ladies and Gentlemen:

We have acted as counsel for Teekay Offshore Partners L.P., a Republic of the Marshall Islands limited partnership (the "Partnership"), and Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C., a Republic of the Marshall Islands limited liability company (the "General Partner"), in connection with the issuance and sale of common units representing limited partner interests in the Partnership (the "Offering"). This opinion is being delivered in connection with the Registration Statement on Form F-1 relating to the Offering (the "Registration Statement") filed with the United States Securities and Exchange Commission (the "Commission") under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the "Securities Act"), to which this opinion appears as an exhibit.

You have requested our opinion regarding certain United States federal income tax considerations that may be relevant to prospective unitholders. In rendering our opinion, we have examined and relied upon the truth, accuracy, and completeness of the facts, statements and representations contained in (i) the Registration Statement, (ii) that certain First Amended and Restated Agreement of Limited Partnership of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P., as set forth in Appendix A of the Registration Statement, entered into by and between the General Partner, as the general partner, and the Teekay Shipping Corporation, a Republic of The Marshall Islands corporation ("TSC"), as the organizational limited partner, together with any other persons who become partners (the "Partnership Agreement"), (iii) the certificate of the Partnership, the General Partner, TSC and certain affiliates of TSC ("Tax Certificate"), and (iv) such other documents, certificates, records and factual representations made by the Partnership as we have deemed necessary or appropriate as a basis for the opinion set forth below. We have not, however, undertaken an independent investigation of any factual matters set forth in any of the foregoing.

In addition, we have assumed, with your permission, (i) that the Partnership will operate in full compliance with the terms of the Partnership Agreement without waiver or breach of any material provision thereof, (ii) that the statements concerning the Partnership and its operations contained in the Registration Statement, and the representations made by the Partnership, the General Partner, TSC, and certain affiliates of TSC in the Tax Certificate, are true, correct and complete and will remain true, correct and complete at all relevant times, (iii) the authenticity of the original documents submitted to use, the conformity to the originals of documents submitted to use as copies, and the due and valid execution and delivery of all such documents where due execution and delivery are a


Teekay Offshore Partners L.P.
Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C.
December 4, 2006

Page 2

prerequisite to the effectiveness thereof and (iv) that any representation or statement made in the Tax Certificate with the qualification "to the knowledge of" or "based on the belief of" the Partnership, the General Partner, TSC or certain affiliates of TSC or other similar qualification, is true, correct and complete and will remain true, correct and complete at all relevant times, in each case without such qualification.

Based upon the foregoing and subject to the limitations, qualifications, assumptions and caveats set forth herein, we hereby confirm our opinion set forth in the discussion contained in the Registration Statement under the caption "Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Considerations."

This opinion addresses only the matters of the United States federal income taxation specifically described under the heading "Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Considerations" in the Registration Statement. This opinion does not address any other United States federal tax consequences or any state, local or foreign tax consequences that may result form the Offering or any other transaction undertaken in connection with or in contemplation of thereof.

We hereby consent to the discussion of this opinion in the Registration Statement, to the filing of this opinion as an exhibit to the Registration Statement and to the use of our name under the captions "Legal Matters" and "Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Considerations" in the Registration Statement. In giving this consent, we do not thereby admit that we are in the category of persons whose consent is required under Section 7 of the Securities Act, nor do we admit that we are experts with respect to any part of the Registration Statement within the meaning of the term "expert" as used in the Securities Act or the rules and regulations of the Commission promulgated thereunder.

Very truly yours,

/s/ Perkins Coie LLP
Perkins Coie LLP


EXHIBIT 8.2

WATSON, FARLEY & WILLIAMS (NEW YORK) LLP
100 Park Avenue
New York, New York 10017
Tel (212) 922 2200
Fax (212) 922 1512

December 4, 2006

Teekay Offshore Partners L.P.
Bayside House, Bayside Executive Park
West Bay Street and Blake Road
Nassau, Commonwealth of the Bahamas

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS L.P. - REGISTRATION STATEMENT ON FORM F-1

Dear Sirs:

We have acted as special counsel as to matters of the law of the Republic of The Marshall Islands ("MARSHALL ISLANDS LAW") for Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. (the "PARTNERSHIP") in connection with the preparation of a Registration Statement on Form F-1 (such Registration Statement, as amended at the effective date thereof, being referred to herein as the "REGISTRATION STATEMENT") filed by the Partnership with the Securities and Exchange Commission pursuant to the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the "ACT"), and the rules and regulations thereunder, with respect to the issuance and sale by the Partnership of up to 7,000,000 common units (the "COMMON UNITS") of the Partnership.

In so acting, we have examined originals, or copies, certified to our satisfaction, of the Registration Statement and the prospectus (the "PROSPECTUS") included therein, and originals, or copies certified to our satisfaction, of all such records of the Partnership, agreements and other documents, certificates of public officials, officers and representatives of the Partnership, Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C. (the "GENERAL PARTNER"), and other appropriate persons, and such other documents as we have deemed necessary as a basis for the opinions hereinafter expressed. In such examinations, we have assumed without independent investigation, (a) the genuineness of all signatures, the authenticity of all documents submitted to us as originals, the conformity to original documents of all documents submitted to us as photostatic or facsimile copies, and the authenticity of the originals of such copies and
(b) the accuracy of the factual representations made to us by officers and other representatives of the Partnership and the General Partner, whether evidenced by certificates or otherwise.

This opinion is limited to Marshall Islands Law and is as of the effective date of the Registration Statement.

Based on the foregoing and having regard to legal considerations which we deem relevant, we are of the opinion that the statements in the Prospectus under the captions "Business - Taxation of the

London o Athens o Paris o New York o Singapore o Bangkok o Rome o Hamburg

Watson, Farley & Williams (New York) LLP is a limited liability partnership registered in England and Wales with registered number OC312253. It is regulated by the Law Society of England and Wales and its members are solicitors or registered foreign lawyers. A list of members of Watson, Farley & Williams (New York) LLP and their professional qualifications is open to inspection at the above address. Any reference to a 'partner' in relation to Watson, Farley & Williams (New York) LLP means a member, partner, consultant or employee of Watson, Farley & Williams (New York) LLP or an affiliated undertaking.

Watson, Farley & Williams (New York) LLP or an affiliated undertaking has an office in each of the cities listed above.


Teekay Offshore Partners L.P.
December 4, 2006 Page 2

Partnership - Marshall Islands Taxation" and "Non-United States Tax Consequences
- Marshall Islands Tax Consequences", insofar as such statements constitute summaries of the legal matters referred to therein, fairly present the information expected to be relevant to holders of the Common Units offered pursuant to the Prospectus and fairly summarize the matters referred to therein.

We consent to the filing of this opinion as an exhibit to the Registration Statement and to the reference to our name in the Prospectus under the captions "Business - Taxation of the Partnership - Marshall Islands Taxation" and "Non-United States Tax Consequences - Marshall Islands Tax Consequences". In giving such consent, we do not admit that we are in the category of persons whose consent is required under Section 7 of the Act.

Very truly yours,

/s/ WATSON, FARLEY & WILLIAMS (NEW YORK) LLP

Watson, Farley & Williams (New York) LLP


EXHIBIT 10.1

CONTRIBUTION, CONVEYANCE AND ASSUMPTION
AGREEMENT

THIS CONTRIBUTION, CONVEYANCE AND ASSUMPTION AGREEMENT (this "Agreement") is entered into as of December __, 2006, effective as of the Effective Times referred to below, among Teekay Shipping Corporation, a Marshall Islands corporation ("Teekay"); Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C., a Marshall Islands limited liability company ("MLP GP"); Teekay Offshore Partners L.P., a Marshall Islands limited partnership ("MLP"); Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C. , a Marshall Islands limited liability company ("OPCO GP"); Teekay Offshore Operating L.P., a Marshall Islands limited partnership ("OPCO"); and Teekay Offshore Holdings L.L.C., a Marshall Islands limited liability company ("TOH"). The foregoing shall be referred to individually as a "Party" and collectively as the "Parties." Certain capitalized terms have the meanings assigned to them in Article I hereof.

RECITALS

A. Teekay and MLP GP have formed MLP pursuant to the Marshall Islands Limited Partnership Act for the purpose of, among other things, acquiring, owning and operating a 26% interest in substantially all the assets of certain subsidiaries of Teekay used in the offshore oil transportation, processing and storage sectors. The respective Board's of Directors of Teekay, MLP GP and OPCO GP have prior to this Agreement authorized the Parties to effect the actions set forth below at the times and in the order set forth below.

B. To accomplish the objectives and purposes in the preceding recital, the following actions have been taken prior to the date hereof:

1. Teekay formed MLP GP under the terms of the Marshall Islands Limited Liability Company Act (the "Marshall Islands LLC Act") and contributed $1,000 in exchange for all of the member interests in MLP GP.

2. MLP GP and Teekay formed MLP under the terms of the Marshall Islands Limited Partnership Act (the "Marshall Islands LP Act"), to which MLP GP contributed $20 and Teekay contributed $980 in exchange for a 2.0% general partner interest and 98.0% limited partner interest, respectively.

Page 1

3. MLP made an election to be classified as an association taxable as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes, effective as of formation.

4. Teekay formed OPCO GP pursuant to the Marshall Islands LLC Act and contributed $1,000 in exchange for all of the member interests in OPCO GP.

5. OPCO GP made an election to be classified as disregarded entity for U.S. federal income tax purposes, effective as of formation.

6. OPCO GP and Teekay formed OPCO, to which OPCO GP contributed $0.10 and Teekay contributed $999.90 in exchange for a 0.01% general partner interest and 99.99% limited partner interest, respectively.

7. OPCO made an election to be classified as a partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes, effective as of formation.

8. (a) Teekay conveyed a 0.01% undivided interest in the stock of, or beneficial interest in, Teekay Navion Offshore Loading Pte. Ltd. (directly or through indirect ownership), Norsk Teekay Holding Ltd., Teekay Offshore Australia Trust, Pattani Spirit L.L.C. and Teekay Nordic Holdings Inc. (collectively, the "Initial TKO Assets") to OPCO GP as a capital contribution;

(b) Teekay conveyed a 99.99% undivided interest in the Initial TKO Assets to OPCO as a capital contribution; and

(c) OPCO GP conveyed its 0.01% interest in the Initial TKO Assets to OPCO as a capital contribution.

C. Effective _______, 2006, Teekay conveys a 0.52% limited partner interest in OPCO to MLP GP in part as a capital contribution and in part in exchange for a $_________ note to Teekay from MLP GP (which represents 2.0% of the total cash to be paid to Teekay from the IPO Proceeds) (the "GP Interest Note").

D. Effective _________, 2006, each of the following transactions occur in the following order in accordance with this Agreement:

1. Each of the entities listed on Schedule A files an election to be disregarded for United States federal tax purposes.

Page 2

2. (a) MLP GP conveys the 0.52% limited partner interest in OPCO to MLP
(a) as an additional capital contribution to continue its 2.0% MLP general partner interest; and (b) in exchange for (i) the Incentive Distribution Rights and (ii) the assumption of the GP Interest Note by MLP; and

(b) Teekay conveys its entire interest in OPCO GP and a 25.47% limited partner interest in OPCO to MLP (a) as an additional capital contribution to continue its 98.0% MLP limited partner interest and
(b) in exchange for a $___ million note (which represents 98.0% of the total cash to be paid to Teekay from the IPO Proceeds) (the "LP Interest Note," and together with the GP Interest Note, the "Notes").

3. Teekay transfers all of its interests in MLP GP, MLP and OPCO after the foregoing to TOH.

E. Effective _______, 2006, each of the following transactions occur in accordance with this Agreement (or, with respect to E.2., an Underwriting Agreement with respect to the Offering, dated December __, 2006, among MLP, the underwriters of the Offering (the "Underwriters") and the other parties thereto):

1. TOH's limited partner interest in MLP is converted to (a) 2,800,000 Common Units, representing a 14% limited partner interest, and (b) 9,800,000 Subordinated Units, representing a 49.0% limited partner interest, for an aggregate 63.0% limited partner interest, and MLP GP is issued 400,000 General Partner Units to represent its 2.0% MLP general partner interest.

2. The public, through the Underwriters, contributes $_________ million (the "IPO Proceeds") in cash to MLP in exchange for 7,000,000 Common Units in MLP, representing a 35.0% limited partner interest.

3. MLP uses the IPO Proceeds (a) to pay the underwriting discounts and commissions of $________ and (b) to pay other transaction expenses incurred by MLP in connection with the Offering of approximately $____ million and (c) with respect to the remaining IPO Proceeds to repay the Notes.

4. The agreements of limited partnership and the limited liability company agreements of the aforementioned entities are amended and restated to the extent necessary to reflect the applicable matters set forth above and in Article II and Article III of this Agreement.

Page 3

AGREEMENT

NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of their mutual undertakings and agreements hereunder, the Parties undertake and agree as follows:

ARTICLE I
DEFINITIONS; RECORDATION

1.1 DEFINITIONS. In addition to terms defined above or elsewhere in this Agreement, the following capitalized terms have the meanings given below.

"Acts" shall mean collectively the Marshall Islands LP Act and the Marshall Islands LLC Act.

"Assets" means the assets, rights and interests contributed and conveyed (or intended so to be) as reflected in this Agreement.

"Common Units" has the meaning assigned to such term in the Partnership Agreement.

"Effective Time" means the time when the transactions contemplated by this Agreement are deemed to have been consummated.

"Incentive Distribution Rights" has the meaning assigned to such term in the Partnership Agreement.

"Laws" means any and all laws, statutes, ordinances, rules or regulations promulgated by a governmental authority, orders of a governmental authority, judicial decisions, decisions of arbitrators or determinations of any governmental authority or court.

"Offering" means the initial public offering and transfer of title of 7,000,000 Common Units by MLP to the public.

"Omnibus Agreement" means the Amended and Restated Omnibus Agreement dated of even date herewith, among Teekay, Teekay GP L.L.C., Teekay LNG Partners L.P. and Teekay LNG Operating L.L.C., and MLP GP, MLP, OPCO GP and OPCO.

"Partnership Agreement" means the First Amended and Restated Agreement of Limited Partnership of MLP, as it may be amended from time to time.

"Registration Statement" means the registration statement on Form F-1 (File No. 333-___________) filed by MLP relating to the Offering, as may be amended.

Page 4

"Subordinated Units" has the meaning assigned to such term in the Partnership Agreement.

ARTICLE II
THE STRUCTURAL CONTRIBUTIONS

2.1 The Parties acknowledge and agree that the following actions hereby occur effective ______, 2006.

2.1.1 CONTRIBUTION BY TEEKAY TO MLP GP OF A PARTIAL INTEREST IN OPCO. Teekay's conveys a 0.52% limited partner interest in OPCO to MLP GP in part as a capital contribution and in part in exchange for the issuance to Teekay of the GP Interest Note by MLP GP.

2.2 The Parties acknowledge and agree that the following actions hereby occur in the following order effective ______, 2006.

2.2.1 CONTRIBUTION BY MLP GP TO MLP OF ITS INTEREST IN OPCO. MLP GP contributes its 0.52% limited partner interest in OPCO to MLP (a) as an additional contribution to the capital of MLP to continue its 2.0% general partner interest in MLP and (b) in exchange for (i) the Incentive Distribution Rights in MLP and (ii) the assumption of the GP Interest Note by MLP.

2.2.2 CONTRIBUTION BY TEEKAY TO MLP OF ITS OPCO GP INTEREST AND CERTAIN LIMITED PARTNER INTERESTS IN OPCO. Teekay contributes its entire interest in OPCO GP and a 25.47% limited partner interest in OPCO to MLP
(a) as an additional contribution to the capital of MLP to continue its 98.0% limited partner interest in MLP and (b) in exchange for the issuance of the LP Interest Note by MLP.

2.2.3 CONTRIBUTION BY TEEKAY TO TOH OF ALL OF ITS REMAINING INTEREST. Teekay contributes its entire remaining interests in MLP GP, MLP and OPCO to TOH.

ARTICLE III
THE OFFERING AND CONCURRENT TRANSACTIONS

The Parties acknowledge and agree that each of the following transactions hereby occur on ________, 2006 and concurrently with the closing of the Offering.

3.1 CONVERSION OF TEEKAY'S LIMITED PARTNER INTEREST. MLP converts TOH's limited partner interest in MLP into (a) 2,800,000 Common Units and

Page 5

(b) 9,800,000 Subordinated Units, and MLP issues MLP GP 400,000 General Partner Units to represent MLP GP's 2.0% MLP general partner interest.

3.2 MLP RECEIPT OF CASH CONTRIBUTION. The Parties acknowledge MLP's issuance of 7,000,000 Common Units in exchange for the IPO Proceeds in cash as a capital contribution to MLP, and MLP's use of the IPO Proceeds (a) to pay the Underwriters' discounts and commissions of $_________ (which may be withheld by the Underwriters from the IPO Proceeds as payment thereof), (b) to pay other Offering expenses incurred by MLP of approximately $__ million and (c) with respect to the remaining IPO Proceeds, to repay the Notes.

ARTICLE IV
ASSUMPTION OF CERTAIN LIABILITIES

Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in this Agreement, none of the Parties shall be deemed to have assumed, and none of the Assets have been or are being contributed subject to, (a) any liens or security interests securing consensual indebtedness covering any of the Assets or (b) any of the liabilities covered by the indemnities set forth in the Omnibus Agreement to the extent such liabilities are covered by such indemnities.

ARTICLE V
ADDITIONAL TRANSACTION

5.1 EXERCISE OF THE OVER-ALLOTMENT OPTION. The Parties agree that if the Underwriters exercise their over-allotment option with respect to the Offering, MLP shall redeem Common Units from TOH with the net proceeds therefrom after the Underwriters' discount and commissions but before other expenses; the number of Common Units redeemed equal to the number of Common Units for which the Underwriters exercise their over-allotment option.

ARTICLE VI
TITLE MATTERS

6.1 ENCUMBRANCES.

(a) Except to the extent provided in Article IV or any other document executed in connection with this Agreement or the Offering, including, without limitation, the Omnibus Agreement, the contribution and conveyance (by operation of law or otherwise) of the various Assets are made expressly subject to all Laws of

Page 6

governmental authorities or tribunals having or asserting jurisdiction over the Assets and operations conducted thereon or therewith, in each case to the extent the same are valid and enforceable and affect the Assets.

(b) To the extent that certain jurisdictions in which the Assets are located or deemed to be located may require that documents be recorded in order to evidence the transfers of title reflected in this Agreement, then the provisions set forth in Section 6.1(a) immediately above shall also be applicable to the conveyances under such documents.

6.2 DISCLAIMER OF WARRANTIES; SUBROGATION; WAIVER OF BULK SALES LAWS.

(a) EXCEPT TO THE EXTENT PROVIDED IN ANY OTHER DOCUMENT EXECUTED OR DELIVERED IN CONNECTION WITH THIS AGREEMENT OR THE OFFERING, INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, THE OMNIBUS AGREEMENT, THE PARTIES ACKNOWLEDGE AND AGREE THAT NONE OF THE PARTIES HAS MADE, DOES NOT MAKE, AND EACH SUCH PARTY SPECIFICALLY NEGATES AND DISCLAIMS, ANY REPRESENTATIONS, WARRANTIES, PROMISES, COVENANTS, AGREEMENTS OR GUARANTIES OF ANY KIND OR CHARACTER WHATSOEVER, WHETHER EXPRESS, IMPLIED OR STATUTORY, ORAL OR WRITTEN, PAST OR PRESENT, REGARDING (A) THE VALUE, NATURE, QUALITY OR CONDITION OF THE ASSETS, INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, THE ENVIRONMENTAL CONDITION OF THE ASSETS GENERALLY, INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, THE PRESENCE OR LACK OF HAZARDOUS SUBSTANCES OR OTHER MATTERS ON THE ASSETS, (B) THE INCOME TO BE DERIVED FROM THE ASSETS, (C) THE SUITABILITY OF THE ASSETS FOR ANY AND ALL ACTIVITIES AND USES THAT MAY BE CONDUCTED THEREON OR THEREWITH, (D) THE COMPLIANCE OF OR BY THE ASSETS OR THEIR OPERATION WITH ANY LAWS (INCLUDING WITHOUT LIMITATION ANY ZONING, ENVIRONMENTAL PROTECTION, POLLUTION OR LAND USE LAWS, RULES, REGULATIONS, ORDERS OR REQUIREMENTS), OR (E) THE HABITABILITY, MERCHANTABILITY, MARKETABILITY, PROFITABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE OF THE ASSETS. EXCEPT TO THE EXTENT PROVIDED IN ANY OTHER DOCUMENT EXECUTED OR DELIVERED IN CONNECTION WITH THIS AGREEMENT OR THE OFFERING INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, THE OMNIBUS AGREEMENT, EACH PARTY ACKNOWLEDGES AND AGREES THAT SUCH PARTY HAS HAD THE OPPORTUNITY TO INSPECT THE RESPECTIVE ASSETS, AND SUCH PARTY IS RELYING SOLELY ON ITS OWN INVESTIGATION OF THE RESPECTIVE ASSETS AND NOT ON ANY INFORMATION PROVIDED OR TO

Page 7

BE PROVIDED BY ANY OF THE OTHER PARTIES. EXCEPT TO THE EXTENT PROVIDED IN ANY OTHER DOCUMENT EXECUTED OR DELIVERED IN CONNECTION WITH THIS AGREEMENT OR THE OFFERING, INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, THE OMNIBUS AGREEMENT, NONE OF THE PARTIES IS LIABLE OR BOUND IN ANY MANNER BY ANY VERBAL OR WRITTEN STATEMENTS, REPRESENTATIONS OR INFORMATION PERTAINING TO THE ASSETS FURNISHED BY ANY AGENT, EMPLOYEE, SERVANT OR THIRD PARTY. EXCEPT TO THE EXTENT PROVIDED IN ANY OTHER DOCUMENT EXECUTED OR DELIVERED IN CONNECTION WITH THIS AGREEMENT OR THE OFFERING, INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, THE OMNIBUS AGREEMENT, EACH OF THE PARTIES ACKNOWLEDGES THAT TO THE MAXIMUM EXTENT PERMITTED BY LAW, THE CONTRIBUTION OF THE ASSETS AS PROVIDED FOR HEREIN IS MADE IN AN "AS IS," "WHERE IS" CONDITION WITH ALL FAULTS, AND THE ASSETS ARE CONTRIBUTED AND CONVEYED SUBJECT TO ALL OF THE MATTERS CONTAINED IN THIS SECTION. THIS SECTION SHALL SURVIVE SUCH CONTRIBUTION AND CONVEYANCE OR THE TERMINATION OF THIS AGREEMENT. THE PROVISIONS OF THIS SECTION HAVE BEEN NEGOTIATED BY THE PARTIES AFTER DUE CONSIDERATION AND ARE INTENDED TO BE A COMPLETE EXCLUSION AND NEGATION OF ANY REPRESENTATIONS OR WARRANTIES, WHETHER EXPRESS, IMPLIED OR STATUTORY, WITH RESPECT TO THE ASSETS THAT MAY ARISE PURSUANT TO ANY LAW NOW OR HEREAFTER IN EFFECT, OR OTHERWISE, EXCEPT AS SET FORTH IN THIS AGREEMENT OR ANY OTHER DOCUMENT EXECUTED OR DELIVERED IN CONNECTION WITH THIS AGREEMENT OR THE OFFERING, INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, THE OMNIBUS AGREEMENT.

(b) To the extent that certain jurisdictions in which the Assets are located or deemed to be located may require that documents be recorded in order to evidence the transfers of title reflected in this Agreement, then the disclaimers set forth in Section 6.2(a) immediately above shall also be applicable to the conveyances under such documents.

(c) The contributions of the Assets made under this Agreement are made with full rights of substitution and subrogation of the respective Parties receiving such contributions, and all persons claiming by, through and under such Parties, to the extent assignable, in and to all covenants and warranties by the predecessors-in-title of the Parties contributing the Assets, and with full subrogation of all rights accruing under applicable statutes of limitation and all rights of action of warranty against all former owners of the Assets.

Page 8

(d) Each of the Parties agrees that the disclaimers contained in this
Section 6.2 are "conspicuous" disclaimers. Any covenants implied by Law by the use of the words "grant," "convey," "bargain," "sell," "assign," "transfer," "deliver," or "set over" or any of them, or any other words used in this Agreement or any exhibits hereto, are hereby expressly disclaimed, waived and negated.

(e) Each of the Parties hereby waives compliance with any applicable bulk sales law or any similar law in any applicable jurisdiction in respect of the transactions contemplated by this Agreement.

ARTICLE VII
FURTHER ASSURANCES

7.1 FURTHER ASSURANCES. From time to time after the date hereof, and without any further consideration, the Parties agree to execute, acknowledge and deliver all such additional deeds, assignments, bills of sale, conveyances, instruments, notices, releases, acquittances and other documents, and will do all such other acts and things, all in accordance with applicable Law, as may be necessary or appropriate (a) more fully to assure that the applicable Parties own all of the properties, rights, titles, interests, estates, remedies, powers and privileges granted by this Agreement, or which are intended to be so granted, (b) more fully and effectively to vest in the applicable Parties and their respective successors and assigns beneficial and record title to the interests contributed and assigned by this Agreement or intended so to be and
(c) to more fully and effectively carry out the purposes and intent of this Agreement.

7.2 POWER OF ATTORNEY. Each Party that has conveyed any Assets (the "Conveyed Assets") as reflected by this Agreement (collectively, the "Conveying Parties") hereby constitutes and appoints MLP GP (the "Attorney-in-Fact") its true and lawful attorney-in-fact with full power of substitution for it and in its name, place and stead or otherwise on behalf of the applicable Conveying Party and its successors and assigns, and for the benefit of the Attorney-in-Fact to demand and receive from time to time the Conveyed Assets contributed and conveyed by this Agreement (or intended so to be) and to execute in the name of the applicable Conveying Party and its successors and assigns instruments of conveyance, instruments of further assurance and to give receipts and releases in respect of the same, and from time to time to institute and prosecute in the name of the applicable Conveying Party for the benefit of the Attorney-in-Fact, any and all proceedings at law, in equity or otherwise which the Attorney-in-Fact may deem proper in order to (a) collect, assert or enforce any claims, rights or titles of any kind in and to the Conveyed Assets, (b) defend and compromise any and all actions, suits or proceedings in respect of any of the Conveyed Assets, and (c) do any and all such acts and things in furtherance of this

Page 9

Agreement as the Attorney-in-Fact shall deem advisable. Each Conveying Party hereby declares that the appointment hereby made and the powers hereby granted are coupled with an interest and are and shall be irrevocable and perpetual and shall not be terminated by any act of any Conveying Party or its successors or assigns or by operation of law.

7.3 OTHER ASSURANCES. From time to time after the date hereof, and without any further consideration, each of the Parties shall execute, acknowledge and deliver all such additional instruments, notices and other documents, and will do all such other acts and things, all in accordance with applicable Law, as may be necessary or appropriate to more fully and effectively carry out the purposes and intent of this Agreement. It is the express intent of the Parties that MLP or its subsidiaries own all assets necessary to operate the Assets that are identified in this Agreement and in the Registration Statement. To the extent any assets were not identified but are necessary to the operation of such Assets that were identified, then the intent of the Parties is that all such unidentified assets are intended to be conveyed to the appropriate Parties to this Agreement or their subsidiaries. To the extent such assets are identified at a later date, the Parties shall take the appropriate actions required in order to convey all such assets to the appropriate Parties to this Agreement or their subsidiaries. Likewise, to the extent that assets are identified at a later date that were not intended by the parties to be conveyed as reflected in this Agreement or the Registration Statement, the Parties shall take the appropriate actions required in order to convey all such assets to the appropriate party.

ARTICLE VIII
MISCELLANEOUS

8.1 ORDER OF COMPLETION OF TRANSACTIONS. The transactions provided for in Articles II, III and V of this Agreement shall be completed on the dates specified in this Agreement and in the following order:

First, the transactions provided for in Article II shall be completed in the order set forth therein;

Second, the transactions provided for in Article III shall be completed in the order set forth therein; and

Fourth, the transactions provided for in Article V shall be completed in the order, if any, set forth therein.

8.2 CONSENTS; RESTRICTION ON ASSIGNMENT. If there are prohibitions against or conditions to the contribution and conveyance of one or more of the Assets without the prior written consent of third parties, including, without limitation, governmental

Page 10

agencies (other than consents of a ministerial nature which are normally granted in the ordinary course of business), which if not satisfied would result in a breach of such prohibitions or conditions or would give an outside party the right to terminate rights of the Party to whom the applicable Assets were intended to be conveyed (the "Beneficial Owner") with respect to such portion of the Assets (herein called a "Restriction"), then any provision contained in this Agreement to the contrary notwithstanding, the transfer of title to or interest in each such portion of the Assets (herein called the "Restriction Asset") pursuant to this Agreement shall not become effective unless and until such Restriction is satisfied, waived or no longer applies. When and if such a Restriction is so satisfied, waived or no longer applies, to the extent permitted by applicable Law and any applicable contractual provisions, the assignment of the Restriction Asset subject thereto shall become effective automatically as of the Effective Time (in the appropriate order indicated by
Section 8.1), without further action on the part of any Party. Each of the applicable Parties that were involved with the conveyance of a Restriction Asset agree to use commercially reasonable efforts to obtain on a timely basis satisfaction of any Restriction applicable to any Restriction Asset conveyed by or acquired by any of them. The description of any portion of the Assets as a "Restriction Asset" shall not be construed as an admission that any Restriction exists with respect to the transfer of such portion of the Assets. In the event that any Restriction Asset exists, the applicable Party agrees to continue to hold such Restriction Asset in trust for the exclusive benefit of the applicable Party to whom such Restriction Asset was intended to be conveyed and to otherwise use commercially reasonable efforts to provide such other Party with the benefits thereof, and the party holding such Restriction Asset will enter into other agreements, or take such other action as it may deem necessary, in order to ensure that the applicable Party to whom such Restriction Asset was intended to be conveyed has the assets and concomitant rights necessary to enable the applicable Party to operate such Restriction Asset in all material respects as it was operated prior to the Effective Time. Furthermore, in such event the applicable Party to whom such Restriction Asset was intended to be conveyed agrees to assume such liabilities and perform such obligations relating to such Restriction Asset as if it had been conveyed at the Effective Time.

8.3 COSTS. MLP shall pay any and all sales, use and similar taxes arising out of the contributions, conveyances and deliveries to be made hereunder, and shall pay all documentary, filing, recording, transfer, deed, and conveyance taxes and fees required in connection therewith. In addition, MLP shall be responsible for all costs, liabilities and expenses (including, without limitation, court costs and reasonable attorneys' fees) incurred in connection with the satisfaction or waiver of any Restriction pursuant to Section 8.2 to the extent such Restriction was disclosed to MLP on or before the date of this Agreement.

Page 11

8.4 HEADINGS; REFERENCES; INTERPRETATION. All Article and Section headings in this Agreement are for convenience only and shall not be deemed to control or affect the meaning or construction of any of the provisions hereof. The words "hereof," "herein" and "hereunder" and words of similar import, when used in this Agreement, shall refer to this Agreement as a whole and not to any particular provision of this Agreement. All references herein to Articles and Sections shall, unless the context requires a different construction, be deemed to be references to the Articles and Sections of this Agreement, respectively. All personal pronouns used in this Agreement, whether used in the masculine, feminine or neuter gender, shall include all other genders, and the singular shall include the plural and vice versa. The use herein of the word "including" following any general statement, term or matter shall not be construed to limit such statement, term or matter to the specific items or matters set forth immediately following such word or to similar items or matters, whether or not non-limiting language (such as "without limitation," "but not limited to," or words of similar import) is used with reference thereto, but rather shall be deemed to refer to all other items or matters that could reasonably fall within the broadest possible scope of such general statement, term or matter.

8.5 SUCCESSORS AND ASSIGNS. The Agreement shall be binding upon and inure to the benefit of the Parties and their respective successors and assigns.

8.6 NO THIRD PARTY RIGHTS. The provisions of this Agreement are intended to bind the Parties as to each other and are not intended to and do not create rights in any other person or confer upon any other person any benefits, rights or remedies and no person is or is intended to be a third party beneficiary of any of the provisions of this Agreement.

8.7 COUNTERPARTS. This Agreement may be executed in any number of counterparts, all of which together shall constitute one agreement binding on the parties hereto.

8.8 GOVERNING LAW. This Agreement shall be governed by, and construed in accordance with, the laws of the state of New York, United States of America, applicable to contracts made and to be performed wholly within such jurisdiction without giving effect to conflict of law principles thereof other than Section 5-1401 of the New York General Obligations Law, except to the extent that it is mandatory that the law of some other jurisdiction, wherein the Assets are located, shall apply.

8.9 SEVERABILITY. If any of the provisions of this Agreement are held by any court of competent jurisdiction to contravene, or to be invalid under, the laws of any governmental body having jurisdiction over the subject matter hereof, such contravention or invalidity shall not invalidate the entire Agreement. Instead, this

Page 12

Agreement shall be construed as if it did not contain the particular provision or provisions held to be invalid, and an equitable adjustment shall be made and necessary provision added so as to give effect, as nearly as possible, to the intention of the Parties as expressed in this Agreement at the time of execution of this Agreement.

8.10 DEED; BILL OF SALE; ASSIGNMENT. To the extent required and permitted by applicable Law, this Agreement shall also constitute a "deed," "bill of sale" or "assignment" of the Assets.

8.11 AMENDMENT OR MODIFICATION. This Agreement may be amended or modified from time to time only by the written agreement of all the Parties hereto.

8.12 INTEGRATION. This Agreement and the instruments referenced herein supersede all previous understandings or agreements among the Parties, whether oral or written, with respect to its subject matter hereof. This Agreement and such instruments contain the entire understanding of the Parties with respect to the subject matter hereof and thereof. No understanding, representation, promise or agreement, whether oral or written, is intended to be or shall be included in or form part of this Agreement unless it is contained in a written amendment hereto executed by the Parties hereto after the date of this Agreement.

[Remainder of Page Intentionally Left Blank]

Page 13

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, this Contribution, Conveyance and Assumption Agreement has been duly executed by the parties set forth below.

TEEKAY SHIPPING CORPORATION, a
Marshall Islands corporation

By: ________________________________________
Name: Peter Evensen
Title: Executive Vice President and Chief
Financial Officer

TEEKAY OFFSHORE GP L.L.C., a
Marshall Islands limited liability company

By: ________________________________________
Name: Peter Evensen
Title: Chief Executive Officer and Chief
Financial Officer

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS L.P., a
Marshall Islands limited partnership

By: Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C., its general
partner

By: ________________________________________
Name: Peter Evensen
Title: Chief Executive Officer and Chief
Financial Officer

TEEKAY OFFSHORE OPERATING GP
L.L.C., a Marshall Islands limited liability
company

By: Teekay Shipping Corporation, its sole
member (before its contribution to MLP)

By: ________________________________________
Name: Peter Evensen
Title: Executive Vice President and Chief
Financial Officer

Page 14

TEEKAY OFFSHORE OPERATING GP
L.L.C., a Marshall Islands limited liability
company

By: Teekay Offshore Partners L.P., its sole
member (after its contribution to MLP)

By: Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C., its general
partner

By: ________________________________________
Name: Peter Evensen
Title: Chief Executive Officer and Chief
Financial Officer

TEEKAY OFFSHORE OPERATING L.P.,
a Marshall Islands limited partnership

By: Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C., its general
partner

By: Teekay Shipping Corporation, its sole
member (before its contribution to MLP)

By: ________________________________________
Name: Peter Evensen
Title: Executive Vice President and Chief
Financial Officer

Page 15

TEEKAY OFFSHORE OPERATING L.P.,
a Marshall Islands limited partnership

By: Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C., its general
partner

By: Teekay Offshore Partners L.P., its sole
member (after its contribution to MLP)

By: Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C., its general
partner

By: ________________________________________
Name: Peter Evensen
Title: Chief Executive Officer and Chief
Financial Officer

TEEKAY OFFSHORE HOLDINGS L.L.C.,
a Marshall Islands limited liability company

By: Teekay Shipping Corporation, its sole
member

By: ________________________________________
Name: Peter Evensen
Title: Executive Vice President and Chief
Financial Officer

Page 16

EXHIBIT 10.2

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS L.P.
2006 LONG-TERM INCENTIVE PLAN

SECTION 1. PURPOSE OF THE PLAN

The Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. 2006 Long-Term Incentive Plan (the "PLAN") is intended to promote the interests of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P., a Marshall Islands limited partnership (the "PARTNERSHIP"), by providing incentive awards to employees, consultants, and directors of Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C., a Marshall Islands limited liability company (the "COMPANY"), and its Affiliates who perform services for the Partnership or its subsidiaries. The Plan is also contemplated to enhance the ability of the Company and its Affiliates to attract and retain the services of individuals who are essential for the growth and profitability of the Partnership and to encourage them to devote their best efforts to advancing the business of the Partnership and its subsidiaries.

SECTION 2. DEFINITIONS

As used in the Plan, the following terms shall have the meanings set forth below:

"ACQUISITION PRICE" means the higher of (a) the highest reported sales price, regular way, of a Unit in any transaction reported on the New York Stock Exchange Composite Tape or other national exchange on which the Units are listed or on Nasdaq during the 60-day period prior to and including the date of a Change of Control or (b) if the Change of Control is the result of a tender or exchange offer or a negotiated acquisition of Units, the highest price per Unit paid in such tender or exchange offer or acquisition. To the extent that the consideration paid in any such transaction described above consists all or in part of securities or other noncash consideration, the value of such securities or other noncash consideration shall be determined by the Board in its sole discretion.

"AFFILIATE" means, with respect to any Person, any other Person that directly or indirectly through one or more intermediaries controls, is controlled by or is under common control with, the Person in question. As used herein, the term "CONTROL" means the possession, direct or indirect, of the power to direct or cause the direction of the management and policies of a Person, whether through ownership of voting securities, by contract or otherwise.

"AWARD" means an Option, Restricted Unit, Phantom Unit, Unit Appreciation Right, cash-based award or other incentive payable in cash or in Units as may be designated by the Committee from time to time, and shall include any tandem DERs granted with respect to a Phantom Unit.

"AWARD AGREEMENT" means the written agreement by which an Award shall be evidenced.

"BOARD" means the Board of Directors of the Company.

"CAUSE" unless otherwise defined in the instrument evidencing the Award or in a written employment, services or other agreement between the Participant and the Company or its


Affiliate, means dishonesty, fraud, serious misconduct, unauthorized use or disclosure of confidential information or trade secrets, or conduct prohibited by criminal law (except minor violations), in each case as determined by the Committee, whose determination shall be conclusive and binding.

"CHANGE OF CONTROL" means, and shall be deemed to have occurred upon the consummation of one or more of the following events: (i) any sale, lease, exchange or other transfer (in one transaction or a series of related transactions) of all or substantially all of the assets of the Partnership or the Company to any Person and/or its Affiliates, other than to the Partnership, the Company and/or any of their Affiliates; (ii) the consolidation, reorganization, merger or other transaction pursuant to which more than 50% of the combined voting power of the outstanding equity interests in the Company cease to be owned by the Persons who own such interests as of [_________]; or
(iii) the general partner (whether the Company or any other Person) of the Partnership ceases to be an Affiliate of Teekay or (iv) a "Change in Control" or a "Company Transaction" that is not a "Related Party Transaction," as provided in the Teekay Shipping Corporation 2003 Equity Incentive Plan.

"CODE" means the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended from time to time.

"COMMITTEE" means the Corporate Governance Committee of the Board or such other committee of the Board appointed by the Board to administer the Plan, which shall be composed of two or more directors, each of whom shall be a "non-employee director" within the meaning of Rule 16b-3(b)(3) promulgated under the Exchange Act, or any successor rule.

"CONSULTANT" means an individual who performs services for the Partnership or its subsidiaries and is not an Employee or a Director.

"DER" means a contingent right, granted in tandem with a specific Phantom Unit, to receive an amount in cash equal to, and at the same time as, the cash distributions made by the Partnership with respect to a Unit during the period such Phantom Unit is outstanding.

"DIRECTOR" means a member of the Board who is not an Employee.

"DISABILITY" unless otherwise defined by the Committee or in the instrument evidencing the Award or in a written employment, services or other agreement between the Participant and the Company or its Affiliate, means a mental or physical impairment of the Participant that is expected to result in death or that has lasted or is expected to last for a continuous period of 12 months or more and that causes the Participant to be unable to perform his or her material duties for the Company or its Affiliate and to be engaged in any substantial gainful activity, in each case as determined by the Committee, whose determination shall be conclusive and binding.

"EMPLOYEE" means any employee of the Company or an Affiliate who performs services for the Partnership or its subsidiaries.

"EXCHANGE ACT" means the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.

-2-

"FAIR MARKET VALUE" means the closing sales price of a Unit on the date of determination (or if there is no trading in the Units on such date, on the next preceding date on which there was trading) as reported in The Wall Street Journal (or other reporting service approved by the Committee). In the event Units are not publicly traded at the time a determination of Fair Market Value is required to be made hereunder, the determination of Fair Market Value shall be made in good faith by the Committee.

"GOOD REASON" unless otherwise defined by the Committee or in the instrument evidencing the Award or in a written employment, services or other agreement between the Participant and the Company or its Affiliate, means the Participant's voluntary resignation following any of the following events or conditions and the failure of the Successor Company to cure such event or condition within 30 days after receipt of written notice from the Participant:
(a) a change in the Participant's position which materially reduces the Participant's level of responsibility; (b) a reduction in the Participant's level of compensation (including base salary, fringe benefits or participation in any corporate performance based bonus or incentive programs) by more than 15%; or (c) a relocation of the Participant's place of employment by more than 50 miles; provided and only if such change, reduction or relocation is effected without the Participant's consent.

"OPTION" means an option to purchase Units granted under the Plan.

"PARTICIPANT" means any Employee, Consultant or Director granted an Award under the Plan.

"PERSON" means an individual or a corporation, limited liability company, partnership, joint venture, trust, unincorporated organization, association, government agency or political subdivision thereof or other entity.

"PHANTOM UNIT" means a phantom (notional) Unit granted under the Plan which upon vesting entitles the Participant to receive a Unit or an amount of cash equal to the Fair Market Value of a Unit, as determined by the Committee in its discretion.

"RESTRICTED PERIOD" means the period established by the Committee with respect to an Award during which the Award remains subject to forfeiture and is either not exercisable by or payable to the Participant, as the case may be.

"RESTRICTED UNIT" means a Unit granted under the Plan that is subject to a Restricted Period.

"RETIREMENT" unless otherwise defined in the instrument evidencing the Award or in a written employment, services or other agreement between the Participant and the Company or its Affiliate, means "RETIREMENT" as defined for purposes of the Plan by the Committee or, if not so defined, means Termination of Service on or after the date the Participant reaches the Company's normal retirement age.

"RULE 16B-3" means Rule 16b-3 promulgated under the Exchange Act, or any successor rule or regulation thereto as in effect from time to time.

-3-

"SEC" means the Securities and Exchange Commission, or any successor thereto.

"SUCCESSOR COMPANY" means the surviving company or the successor company, as applicable, in connection with a Change of Control.

"TEEKAY" means Teekay Shipping Corporation, a Marshall Islands corporation.

"TERMINATION OF SERVICE" means a termination of employment or service relationship with the Company or its Affiliates for any reason, whether voluntary or involuntary, including by reason of death, Disability or Retirement. Any question as to whether and when there has been a Termination of Service for the purposes of an Award and the cause of such Termination of Service shall be determined by the Committee, whose determination shall be conclusive and binding. Transfer of a Participant's employment or service relationship between the Company and any Affiliate shall not be considered a Termination of Service for purposes of an Award. Unless the Committee determines otherwise, a Termination of Service shall be deemed to occur if the Participant's employment or service relationship is with an entity that has ceased to be an Affiliate.

"UDR" means a distribution made by the Partnership with respect to a Restricted Unit.

"UNIT" means a Common Unit of the Partnership.

"UNIT APPRECIATION RIGHT" means an Award that, upon exercise, entitles the holder to receive the excess of the Fair Market Value of a Unit on the exercise date over the base price established for such Unit Appreciation Right. Such excess may be paid in cash and/or in Units, as determined by the Committee in its discretion.

SECTION 3. ADMINISTRATION

The Plan shall be administered by the Committee. A majority of the Committee shall constitute a quorum, and the acts of a majority of the members of the Committee who are present at any meeting thereof at which a quorum is present, or acts unanimously approved by the members of the Committee in writing, shall be the acts of the Committee. Subject to the following and any applicable law, the Committee, in its sole discretion, may delegate any or all of its powers and duties under the Plan, including the power to grant Awards under the Plan, to the Chief Executive Officer of the Company, subject to such limitations on such delegated powers and duties as the Committee may impose, if any. Upon any such delegation all references in the Plan to the "COMMITTEE", other than in Section 8, shall be deemed to include the Chief Executive Officer; provided, however, that such delegation shall not limit the Chief Executive Officer's right to receive Awards under the Plan. Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Chief Executive Officer may not grant Awards to, or take any action with respect to any Award previously granted to, himself or herself or to any other person who would be subject to Rule 16b-3 or who is a member of the Board. Subject to the terms of the Plan and applicable law, and in addition to other express powers and authorizations conferred on the Committee by the Plan, the Committee shall have full power and authority to: (i) designate Participants;
(ii) determine the type or types of Awards to be granted to a Participant; (iii) determine the number of Units to be covered by Awards; (iv) determine the terms and conditions of any Award; (v) determine whether, to what extent, and under what circumstances Awards may be

-4-

settled, exercised, canceled, or forfeited; (vi) interpret and administer the Plan and any instrument or agreement relating to an Award made under the Plan;
(vii) establish, amend, suspend, or waive such rules and regulations and appoint such agents as it shall deem appropriate for the proper administration of the Plan; and (viii) make any other determination and take any other action that the Committee deems necessary or desirable for the administration of the Plan. Unless otherwise expressly provided in the Plan, all designations, determinations, interpretations, and other decisions under or with respect to the Plan or any Award shall be within the sole discretion of the Committee, may be made at any time and shall be final, conclusive, and binding upon all Persons, including the Company, the Partnership, any Affiliate of the Company or the Partnership, any Participant, and any beneficiary of any Award.

SECTION 4. UNITS

(a) LIMITS ON UNITS DELIVERABLE

Subject to adjustment as provided in Section 4(c), the number of Units available for delivery under the Plan is 1,000,000. There shall not be any limitation on the number of Awards that may be granted and paid in cash. If any Award is forfeited or otherwise terminates or is canceled without the delivery of Units, then the Units covered by such Award, to the extent of such forfeiture, termination, or cancellation, shall again be Units with respect to which Awards may be granted.

(b) SOURCES OF UNITS DELIVERABLE UNDER AWARDS

Any Units delivered pursuant to an Award shall consist, in whole or in part, of Units acquired in the open market, from any Affiliate, the Partnership or any other Person, or any combination of the foregoing.

(c) ADJUSTMENTS

In the event any distribution (other than a normal cash dividend), recapitalization, split, reverse split, reorganization, merger, consolidation, split-up, spin-off, combination, repurchase, or exchange of Units or other securities of the Partnership, or other similar transaction or event results in
(i) the outstanding Units, or any securities exchanged therefor or received in their place, being exchanged for a different number or kind of securities of the Partnership or any other company or (ii) new, different or additional securities of the Partnership or any other company being received by the holders of Units, then the Committee shall, in such manner as it may deem equitable, adjust any or all of (1) the number and type of Units (or other securities or property) with respect to which Awards may be granted, (2) the number and type of Units (or other securities or property) subject to outstanding Awards, and (3) the grant or exercise price with respect to any Award or, if deemed appropriate, make provision for a cash payment to the holder of an outstanding Award; provided, that the number of Units subject to any Award shall always be a whole number.

Notwithstanding the foregoing, the issuance by the Partnership of Units, or securities convertible into Units, for cash or property, or for labor or services rendered, either upon direct sale or upon the exercise of rights or warrants to subscribe therefor, or upon conversion of Units or obligations of the Partnership convertible into such Units or other securities, shall not affect,

-5-

and no adjustment by reason thereof shall be made with respect to, outstanding Awards. Also notwithstanding the foregoing, a Change of Control shall not be governed by this Section 4(c) but shall be governed by Section 7.

SECTION 5. ELIGIBILITY

Any Employee, Consultant or Director shall be eligible to be designated a Participant and receive an Award under the Plan.

SECTION 6. AWARDS

(a) OPTIONS

The Committee shall have the authority to determine the Employees, Consultants and Directors to whom Options shall be granted, the number of Units to be covered by each Option, the purchase price therefor and the conditions and limitations applicable to the exercise of the Option, including the following terms and conditions and such additional terms and conditions, as the Committee shall determine, that are not inconsistent with the provisions of the Plan.

(i) Exercise Price. The exercise price per Unit purchasable under an Option shall be determined by the Committee at the time the Option is granted and may be equal to or more than the Fair Market Value of a Unit as of the date of grant.

(ii) Time and Method of Exercise. The Committee shall determine the Restricted Period, i.e., the time or times at which an Option may be exercised in whole or in part, which may include, without limitation, accelerated vesting upon the achievement of specified performance goals, and the method or methods by which payment of the exercise price with respect thereto may be made or deemed to have been made, which may include, without limitation, (1) cash, (2) check acceptable to the Company, (3) to the extent permitted by law, a "broker-assisted cashless exercise" through procedures approved by the Company,
(4) tendering Units owned by the Participant for at least six months (or any shorter period necessary to avoid a charge for financial reporting purposes), other securities or other property, or (5) any combination thereof, having a Fair Market Value on the exercise date equal to the relevant exercise price.

(iii) Termination of Service. The Committee shall establish and set forth in each instrument that evidences an Option whether the Option shall continue to be exercisable, and the terms and conditions of such exercise, after a Termination of Service, any of which provisions may be waived or modified by the Committee at any time. If not so established in the instrument evidencing the Option, the Option shall be exercisable according to the following terms and conditions, which may be waived or modified by the Committee at any time:

(A) Any portion of an Option that is not vested and exercisable on the date of a Participant's Termination of Service shall expire on such date.

(B) Any portion of an Option that is vested and exercisable on the date of a Participant's Termination of Service shall expire on the earliest to occur of

-6-

(1) if the Participant's Termination of Service occurs for reasons other than Cause, Retirement, Disability or death, the date that is three months after such Termination of Service;

(2) if the Participant's Termination of Service occurs by reason of Retirement or Disability, the five-year anniversary of such Termination of Service;

(3) if the Participant's Termination of Service occurs by reason of death, the two-year anniversary of such Termination of Service; and

(4) the last day of the maximum term of the Option (the "OPTION EXPIRATION DATE").

Notwithstanding the foregoing, if a Participant dies after his or her Termination of Service but while an Option is otherwise exercisable, the portion of the Option that is vested and exercisable on the date of such Termination of Service shall expire upon the earlier to occur of (y) the Option Expiration Date and (z) the two-year anniversary of the date of death, unless the Committee determines otherwise.

Also notwithstanding the foregoing, in case a Participant's Termination of Service occurs for Cause, all Options granted to the Participant shall automatically expire upon first notification to the Participant of such termination, unless the Committee determines otherwise. If a Participant's employment or service relationship with the Company is suspended pending an investigation of whether the Participant shall be terminated for Cause, all the Participant's rights under any Option shall likewise be suspended during the period of investigation. If any facts that would constitute termination for Cause are discovered after a Participant's Termination of Service, any Option then held by the Participant may be immediately terminated by the Committee, in its sole discretion.

(C) A Participant's change in status from an employee to a consultant, advisor or independent contractor or a change in status from a consultant, advisor or independent contractor to an employee shall not be considered a Termination of Service for purposes of this Section 6(a)(iii).

(b) RESTRICTED UNITS AND PHANTOM UNITS

The Committee shall have the authority to determine the Employees, Consultants and Directors to whom Restricted Units or Phantom Units shall be granted, the number of Restricted Units or Phantom Units to be granted to each such Participant, the duration of the Restricted Period, the conditions under which the Restricted Units or Phantom Units may become vested or forfeited, which may include, without limitation, the accelerated vesting upon the achievement of specified performance goals, and such other terms and conditions as the Committee may establish with respect to such Awards, including whether DERs are granted with respect to the Phantom Units and whether UDRs are attached to the Restricted Units.

(i) DERs. To the extent provided by the Committee, in its discretion, a grant of Phantom Units may include a tandem DER grant, which may provide that such DERs shall be paid directly to the Participant, be credited to a bookkeeping account (with or without interest in

-7-

the discretion of the Committee) subject to the same vesting restrictions as the tandem Phantom Unit Award, or be subject to such other provisions or restrictions as determined by the Committee in its discretion.

(ii) UDRs. To the extent provided by the Committee, in its discretion, a grant of Restricted Units may provide that distributions made by the Partnership with respect to the Restricted Units shall be subject to the same forfeiture and other restrictions as the Restricted Unit and, if restricted, such distributions shall be held, without interest, until the Restricted Unit vests or is forfeited with the UDR being paid or forfeited at the same time, as the case may be. Absent such a restriction on the UDRs in the grant agreement, UDRs shall be paid to the holder of the Restricted Unit without restriction.

(iii) Lapse of Restrictions

(A) Phantom Units. Unless a different payment time is specified in the Award Agreement, upon or as soon as reasonably practical following the vesting of each Phantom Unit, subject to the provisions of Section 9(b), the Participant shall be entitled to receive from the Company one Unit or cash equal to the Fair Market Value of a Unit, as determined by the Committee in its discretion.

(B) Restricted Units. Upon or as soon as reasonably practical following the vesting of each Restricted Unit, subject to the provisions of
Section 9(b), the Participant shall be entitled to have the restrictions removed from his or her Unit certificate or book entry so that the Participant then holds an unrestricted Unit.

(c) UNIT APPRECIATION RIGHTS

The Committee shall have the authority to determine the Employees, Consultants and Directors to whom Unit Appreciation Rights shall be granted, the number of Units to be covered by each grant, the base price thereof and the conditions and limitations applicable to the exercise of the Unit Appreciation Right, including the following terms and conditions and such additional terms and conditions, as the Committee shall determine, that are not inconsistent with the provisions of the Plan.

(i) Base Price. The base price per Unit Appreciation Right shall be determined by the Committee at the time the Unit Appreciation Right is granted and may be equal to or more than the Fair Market Value of a Unit as of the date of grant.

(ii) Time of Exercise. The Committee shall determine the Restricted Period, i.e., the time or times at which a Unit Appreciation Right may be exercised in whole or in part, which may include, without limitation, accelerated vesting upon the achievement of specified performance goals.

(d) OTHER UNIT OR CASH-BASED AWARDS

Subject to the terms of the Plan and such other terms and conditions as the Committee deems appropriate, the Committee may grant other incentives payable in cash or in Units under the Plan.

-8-

(e) GENERAL

(i) Awards May Be Granted Separately or Together. Awards may, in the discretion of the Committee, be granted either alone or in addition to, in tandem with, or in substitution for any other Award granted under the Plan or any award granted under any other plan of the Company or any Affiliate. Awards granted in addition to or in tandem with other Awards or awards granted under any other plan of the Company or any Affiliate may be granted either at the same time as or at a different time from the grant of such other Awards or awards.

(ii) Limits on Transfer of Awards

(A) Except as provided in (C) below or as provided in the Award Agreement, each Option and Unit Appreciation Right shall be exercisable only by the Participant during the Participant's lifetime, or by the person to whom the Participant's rights shall pass by will or by the applicable laws of descent and distribution.

(B) Except as provided in (C) below, no Award and no right under any such Award may be assigned, alienated, pledged, attached, sold or otherwise transferred or encumbered by a Participant otherwise than by will or by the applicable laws of descent and distribution.

(C) To the extent specifically provided by the Committee with respect to an Option or Unit Appreciation Right grant, an Option or Unit Appreciation Right may be transferred by a Participant without consideration to immediate family members or related family trusts, limited partnerships or similar entities or on such terms and conditions as the Committee may from time to time establish.

(iii) Term of Awards. The term of each Award shall be for such period as may be determined by the Committee

(iv) Unit Certificates/Book Entry. All certificates for Units or other securities of the Partnership delivered under the Plan pursuant to any Award or the exercise thereof shall be subject to such stop transfer orders and other restrictions as the Committee may deem advisable under the Plan or the rules, regulations, and other requirements of the SEC, any stock exchange upon which such Units or other securities are then listed, and any applicable federal or state laws, and the Committee may cause a legend or legends to be put on any such certificates to make appropriate reference to such restrictions. In lieu of delivering certificates for Units, the Committee may, in its sole discretion, effect the issuance of Units under the Plan in book entry.

(v) Consideration for Grants. Awards may be granted for such consideration, including services, as the Committee determines.

(vi) Delivery of Units or other Securities and Payment by Participant of Consideration. Notwithstanding anything in the Plan or any grant agreement to the contrary, delivery of Units pursuant to the exercise or vesting of an Award may be deferred for any period during which, in the good faith determination of the Committee, the Company is not reasonably able to obtain Units to deliver pursuant to such Award without violating the rules or regulations of any applicable law or securities exchange. No Units or other securities shall be delivered

-9-

pursuant to any Award until payment in full of any amount required to be paid pursuant to the Plan or the applicable Award Agreement (including, without limitation, any exercise price or tax withholding) is received by the Company.

SECTION 7. CHANGE OF CONTROL

(a) EFFECT OF A CHANGE OF CONTROL

Notwithstanding any other provision of the Plan to the contrary, unless the Committee shall determine otherwise at the time of grant with respect to a particular Award, in the event of a Change of Control:

(i) All outstanding Awards shall become fully and immediately vested and exercisable, and all applicable deferral and restriction limitations shall lapse immediately prior to the Change of Control, unless such Awards are converted, assumed, or replaced by the Successor Company. Notwithstanding the foregoing, with respect to Options or Unit Appreciation Rights, the Committee, in its sole discretion, may instead provide that a Participant's outstanding Options and Unit Appreciation Rights shall terminate upon consummation of such Change of Control and that each such Participant shall receive, in exchange therefor, a cash payment equal to the amount (if any) by which (a) the Acquisition Price multiplied by the number of Units subject to such outstanding Options or Unit Appreciation Rights (whether or not then exercisable) exceeds
(b) the aggregate exercise price for such Options or Unit Appreciation Rights.

(ii) For the purposes of this Section 7(a), an Award shall be considered converted, assumed or replaced by the Successor Company if following the Change of Control the option or right confers the right to purchase or receive, for each Unit subject to the Award immediately prior to the Change of Control, the consideration (whether units, cash, or other securities or property) received in the Change of Control by holders of Units for each Unit held on the effective date of the Change of Control (and if holders were offered a choice of consideration, the type of consideration chosen by the holders of a majority of the outstanding Units); provided, however, that if such consideration received in the Change of Control is not solely equity of the Successor Company, the Committee may, with the consent of the Successor Company, provide for the consideration to be received upon the exercise of the Option or the vesting of the right, for each Unit subject thereto, to be solely equity of the Successor Company substantially equal in fair market value to the per Unit consideration received by holders of Units in the Change of Control. The determination of such substantial equality of value of consideration shall be made by the Committee and its determination shall be conclusive and binding.

(b) CHANGE OF CONTROL CASH-OUT

Notwithstanding any other provision of the Plan, during the 60-day period from and after a Change of Control (the "EXERCISE PERIOD"), if the Committee shall so determine at, or at any time after, the time of grant, a Participant holding an Option or Unit Appreciation Right shall have the right, whether or not the Option or Unit Appreciation Right is fully exercisable and in lieu of the payment of the purchase price for the Units being purchased under the Option, and by giving notice to the Company, to elect to surrender all or part of the Option or Unit Appreciation

-10-

Right to the Company and to receive cash, within 30 days of such notice, in an amount equal to the amount by which the Acquisition Price per Unit on the date of such election shall exceed the exercise price per Unit under the Option or Unit Appreciation Right multiplied by the number of Units granted under the Option or Unit Appreciation Right as to which the right granted under this
Section 7(b) shall have been exercised.

(c) ACCELERATION AND EXERCISE FOLLOWING A CHANGE OF CONTROL

If following a Change of Control, a Participant's employment is subsequently terminated without Cause or for Good Reason within 24 months of the Change of Control, any such Awards that remain unvested shall become fully and immediately vested and exercisable upon the date of the Participant's termination, all applicable deferral and restriction limitations shall lapse, and an Award that is an Option or a Unit Appreciation Right shall remain exercisable until the later of the date five years after the date of such termination and the date the Award would have expired by its terms if the Participant's employment had not been terminated.

SECTION 8. AMENDMENT AND TERMINATION

Except to the extent prohibited by applicable law:

(a) AMENDMENTS TO THE PLAN

Except as required by the rules of the principal securities exchange on which the Units are traded, the Board or the Committee may amend, alter, suspend, discontinue, or terminate the Plan in any manner, including increasing the number of Units available for Awards under the Plan, without the consent of any partner, Participant, other holder or beneficiary of an Award, or other Person.

(b) AMENDMENTS TO AWARDS

The Committee may waive any conditions or rights under, amend any terms of, or alter any Award theretofore granted, provided no change, other than pursuant to Section 8(c), in any Award shall materially reduce the benefit to Participant without the consent of such Participant.

(c) ADJUSTMENT OF AWARDS UPON THE OCCURRENCE OF CERTAIN UNUSUAL OR NONRECURRING EVENTS

The Committee is hereby authorized to make adjustments in the terms and conditions of, and the criteria included in, Awards theretofore granted (i) in recognition of unusual or nonrecurring events (including, without limitation, the events described in Section 4(c) of the Plan) affecting the Partnership or the financial statements of the Partnership, or of changes in applicable laws, regulations, or accounting principles or (ii) to ensure that an Award is not subject to additional taxes under Section 409A of the Code.

-11-

SECTION 9. GENERAL PROVISIONS

(a) NO RIGHTS TO AWARD

No Person shall have any claim to be granted any Award under the Plan, and there is no obligation for uniformity of treatment of Participants. The terms and conditions of Awards need not be the same with respect to each recipient.

(b) TAX WITHHOLDING

The Company or any Affiliate is authorized to withhold from any Award, from any payment due or transfer made under any Award or from any compensation or other amount owing to a Participant the amount (in cash, Units, other securities, Units that would otherwise be issued pursuant to such Award or other property) of any applicable taxes payable in respect of the grant of an Award, its exercise, the lapse of restrictions thereon, or any payment or transfer under an Award or under the Plan and to take such other action as may be necessary in the opinion of the Company to satisfy its withholding obligations for the payment of such taxes.

(c) NO RIGHT TO EMPLOYMENT OR SERVICES

The grant of an Award shall not be construed as giving a Participant the right to be retained in the employ of the Company or any Affiliate, to continue as a Consultant, or to remain on the Board, as applicable. Further, the Company or an Affiliate may at any time dismiss a Participant from employment or terminate a consulting relationship, free from any liability or any claim under the Plan, unless otherwise expressly provided in the Plan, any Award Agreement or other agreement.

(d) GOVERNING LAW

The validity, construction, and effect of the Plan and any rules and regulations relating to the Plan shall be determined in accordance with the laws of the Republic of the Marshall Islands without regard to its conflict of laws principles.

(e) SEVERABILITY

If any provision of the Plan or any award is or becomes or is deemed to be invalid, illegal, or unenforceable in any jurisdiction or as to any Person or Award, or would disqualify the Plan or any award under any law deemed applicable by the Committee, such provision shall be construed or deemed amended to conform to the applicable laws, or if it cannot be construed or deemed amended without, in the determination of the Committee, materially altering the intent of the Plan or the Award, such provision shall be stricken as to such jurisdiction, person or award and the remainder of the Plan and any such Award shall remain in full force and effect.

(f) OTHER LAWS

The Committee may refuse to issue or transfer any Units or other consideration under an Award if, in its sole discretion, it determines that the issuance or transfer of such Units or such other consideration might violate any applicable law or regulation, the rules of the principal

-12-

securities exchange on which the Units are then traded, or entitle the Partnership or an Affiliate to recover the same under Section 16(b) of the Exchange Act, and any payment tendered to the Company by a Participant, other holder or beneficiary in connection with the exercise of such Award shall be promptly refunded to the relevant Participant, holder or beneficiary.

(g) NO TRUST OR FUND CREATED

Neither the Plan nor any award shall create or be construed to create a trust or separate fund of any kind or a fiduciary relationship between the Company or any participating Affiliate and a Participant or any other Person. To the extent that any Person acquires a right to receive payments from the Company or any participating Affiliate pursuant to an Award, such right shall be no greater than the right of any general unsecured creditor of the Company or any participating Affiliate.

(h) NO FRACTIONAL UNITS

No fractional Units shall be issued or delivered pursuant to the Plan or any Award, and the Committee shall determine whether cash, other securities, or other property shall be paid or transferred in lieu of any fractional Units or whether such fractional Units or any rights thereto shall be canceled, terminated, or otherwise eliminated.

(i) HEADINGS

Headings are given to the Sections and subsections of the Plan solely as a convenience to facilitate reference. Such headings shall not be deemed in any way material or relevant to the construction or interpretation of the Plan or any provision thereof.

(j) FACILITY PAYMENT

Any amounts payable hereunder to any person under legal disability or who, in the judgment of the Committee, is unable to properly manage his financial affairs, may be paid to the legal representative of such person, or may be applied for the benefit of such person in any manner which the Committee may select, and the Company and its Affiliates shall be relieved of any further liability for payment of such amounts.

(k) PARTICIPATION BY AFFILIATES

In making Awards to Consultants and Employees employed by an entity other than by the Company, the Committee shall be acting on behalf of the Affiliate, and to the extent the Partnership has an obligation to reimburse the Company for compensation paid to Consultants and Employees for services rendered for the benefit of the Partnership, such payments or reimbursement payments may be made by the Partnership directly to the Affiliate, and, if made to the Company, shall be received by the Company as agent for the Affiliate.

(l) GENDER AND NUMBER

Words in the masculine gender shall include the feminine gender, the plural shall include the singular and the singular shall include the plural.

-13-

SECTION 10. TERM OF THE PLAN

The Plan shall be effective on the date of its approval by the Board and shall continue until the earlier of (a) the date terminated by the Board and (b) the date Units are no longer available for the payment of Awards under the Plan. However, unless otherwise expressly provided in the Plan or in an applicable Award Agreement, any Award granted prior to such termination, and the authority of the Board or the Committee to amend, alter, adjust, suspend, discontinue, or terminate any such Award or to waive any conditions or rights under such Award, shall extend beyond such termination date.

-14-

EXHIBIT 10.3

AMENDED AND RESTATED

OMNIBUS AGREEMENT

AMONG

TEEKAY SHIPPING CORPORATION,

AND

TEEKAY GP L.L.C.,

TEEKAY LNG PARTNERS L.P. AND

TEEKAY LNG OPERATING L.L.C.

AND

TEEKAY OFFSHORE GP L.L.C.,

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS L.P.,

TEEKAY OFFSHORE OPERATING GP L.L.C. AND

TEEKAY OFFSHORE OPERATING L.P.


AMENDED AND RESTATED OMNIBUS AGREEMENT

THIS AMENDED AND RESTATED OMNIBUS AGREEMENT is entered into on, and effective as of, the Offshore Closing Date (as defined herein), among Teekay Shipping Corporation, a Marshall Islands corporation ("Teekay"), Teekay GP L.L.C., a Marshall Islands limited liability company (including any permitted successors and assigns under the Teekay LNG MLP Agreement (as defined herein), "Teekay LNG General Partner"), for itself and on behalf of Teekay LNG MLP in its capacity as general partner, Teekay LNG Operating L.L.C., a Marshall Islands limited liability company ("Teekay LNG OLLC"), Teekay LNG Partners L.P., a Marshall Islands limited partnership ("Teekay LNG MLP"), Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C., a Marshall Islands limited liability company (including any permitted successors and assigns under the Teekay Offshore MLP Agreement (as defined herein), "Teekay Offshore General Partner"), for itself and on behalf of the Teekay Offshore MLP in its capacity as general partner, Teekay Offshore Partners L.P., a Marshall Islands limited partnership ("Teekay Offshore MLP"), Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C., a Marshall Islands limited liability company ("Teekay Offshore Operating General Partner"), for itself and on behalf of Teekay Offshore OLP in its capacity as general partner, and Teekay Offshore Operating L.P., a Marshall Islands limited partnership ("Teekay Offshore OLP").

R E C I T A L S:

1. Teekay, Teekay LNG General Partner, Teekay LNG OLLC and Teekay LNG MLP are parties to the Omnibus Agreement dated as of May 10, 2005 (the "Original Agreement") entered into in connection with the initial public offering of common units by Teekay LNG MLP and pursuant to which such parties evidenced their understandings with respect to various matters set forth therein.

2. Teekay Offshore MLP proposes to undertake an initial public offering of its common units and the Parties desire to enter into this Agreement to evidence their understanding with respect to the various matters set forth herein.

3. The Conflicts Committee (as defined herein) of the board of directors of Teekay LNG General Partner and the boards of directors of Teekay, Teekay LNG General Partner and Teekay Offshore General Partner have approved the amendment and restatement of the Original Agreement as set forth in this Agreement.

4. The Parties desire by their execution of this Agreement to evidence their understanding, as more fully set forth in Articles II, III and V, with respect to (a) those business opportunities that the Teekay Entities (as defined herein) will not pursue during the term of this Agreement and (b) the procedures whereby such business opportunities are to be offered to the LNG Partnership Group (as defined herein) or the Offshore Partnership Group (as defined herein), as applicable, and accepted or declined.

AMENDED AND RESTATED OMNIBUS AGREEMENT


5. The Parties desire by their execution of this Agreement to evidence their understanding, as more fully set forth in Articles II, IV and V, with respect to (a) those business opportunities that the Offshore Partnership Group will not pursue during the term of this Agreement and (b) the procedures whereby such business opportunities are to be offered to Teekay or the LNG Partnership Group, as applicable, and accepted or declined.

6. The Parties desire by their execution of this Agreement to evidence their understanding, as more fully set forth in Articles III, IV and V, with respect to (a) those business opportunities that the LNG Partnership Group will not pursue during the term of this Agreement and (b) the procedures whereby such business opportunities are to be offered to Teekay or the Offshore Partnership Group, as applicable, and accepted or declined.

7. The Parties desire by their execution of this Agreement to evidence their understanding, as more fully set forth in Article VI, with respect to (a) Teekay's right of first offer relating to certain Crude Oil Assets (as defined herein), (b) Teekay LNG MLP's right of first offer relating to certain LNG Assets (as defined herein) and (c) Teekay Offshore MLP's right of first offer relating to certain Offshore Assets (as defined herein).

8. The Parties desire by their execution of this Agreement to evidence their understanding, as more fully set forth in Article VII, with respect to certain indemnification obligations of Teekay.

In consideration of the premises and the covenants, conditions, and agreements contained herein, and for other good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the parties hereto hereby agree as follows:

ARTICLE I
DEFINITIONS

1.1 DEFINITIONS.

As used in this Agreement, the following terms shall have the respective meanings set forth below:

"Affiliate" means, with respect to any Person, any other Person that directly or indirectly through one or more intermediaries controls, is controlled by or is under common control with, the Person in question. As used herein, the term "control" means the possession, direct or indirect, of the power to direct or cause the direction of the management and policies of a Person, whether through ownership of voting securities, by contract or otherwise.

"Aframax Assets" means the Aframax tankers included in Teekay Offshore OLP as of the Offshore Closing Date and any Replacement Aframax Assets relating to such original Aframax tankers.

AMENDED AND RESTATED OMNIBUS AGREEMENT

-2-

"Agreement" means this Amended and Restated Omnibus Agreement, as it may be amended, modified, or supplemented from time to time in accordance with
Section 8.6 hereof.

"Acquiring Party" has the meaning given such term in Section 5.1(a).

"Bid LNG Assets" has the meaning given such term in Section 2.2(b).

"Bid Offshore Assets" has the meaning given such term in Section 3.2(c).

"Break-up Costs" means the aggregate amount of any and all additional taxes and other similar costs to (a) the Teekay Entities or the Offshore Partnership Group, as applicable, that would be required to transfer LNG Assets acquired by the Teekay Entities or the Offshore Partnership Group as part of a larger transaction to an LNG Partnership Group Member pursuant to Section 2.2(a), (b) the LNG Partnership Group or the Offshore Partnership Group, as applicable, that would be required to transfer Crude Oil Assets acquired by the LNG Partnership Group or the Offshore Partnership Group as part of a larger transaction to a Teekay Entity pursuant to Section 4.2(c) or (c) the Teekay Entities or the LNG Partnership Group, as applicable, that would be required to transfer Offshore Assets acquired by the Teekay Entities or the LNG Partnership Group as part of a larger transaction to an Offshore Partnership Group Member pursuant to Section 3.2(b).

"Change of Control" means, with respect to any Person (the "Applicable Person"), any of the following events: (a) any sale, lease, exchange or other transfer (in one transaction or a series of related transactions) of all or substantially all of the Applicable Person's assets to any other Person, unless immediately following such sale, lease, exchange or other transfer such assets are owned, directly or indirectly, by the Applicable Person; (b) the consolidation or merger of the Applicable Person with or into another Person pursuant to a transaction in which the outstanding Voting Securities of the Applicable Person are changed into or exchanged for cash, securities or other property, other than any such transaction where (i) the outstanding Voting Securities of the Applicable Person are changed into or exchanged for Voting Securities of the surviving Person or its parent and (ii) the holders of the Voting Securities of the Applicable Person immediately prior to such transaction own, directly or indirectly, not less than a majority of the outstanding Voting Securities of the surviving Person or its parent immediately after such transaction; and (c) a "person" or "group" (within the meaning of Sections 13(d) or 14(d)(2) of the Exchange Act) (other than Teekay or its Affiliates, with respect to Teekay LNG General Partner, Teekay Offshore General Partner or Teekay Offshore OLP), being or becoming the "beneficial owner" (as defined in Rules 13d-3 and 13d-5 under the Exchange Act) of more than 50% of all of the then outstanding Voting Securities of the Applicable Person, except in a merger or consolidation which would not constitute a Change of Control under clause (b) above.

"Conflicts Committee" means the Conflicts Committee of the board of directors of Teekay LNG General Partner or Teekay Offshore General Partner, as applicable.

AMENDED AND RESTATED OMNIBUS AGREEMENT

-3-

"Contribution Assets" means the LNG Contribution Assets or the Offshore Contribution Assets, as applicable.

"control" means the possession, direct or indirect, of the power to direct or cause the direction of the management and policies of a Person, whether through ownership of voting securities, by contract or otherwise.

"Covered Environmental Losses" means all environmental and toxic tort Losses suffered or incurred by the LNG Partnership Group or the Offshore Partnership Group, as applicable, by reason of or arising out of:

(i) any violation or correction of violation of Environmental Laws; or

(ii) any event or condition associated with ownership or operation by the Teekay Entities of the LNG Contribution Assets, with respect to the LNG Partnership Group, or the Offshore Contribution Assets, with respect to the Offshore Partnership Group (including, without limitation, the presence of Hazardous Substances on, under, about or migrating to or from the LNG Contribution Assets or the Offshore Contribution Assets or the disposal or release of Hazardous Substances generated by operation of the LNG Contribution Assets or the Offshore Contribution Assets, as applicable), including, without limitation, (A) the cost and expense of any investigation, assessment, evaluation, monitoring, containment, cleanup, repair, restoration, remediation or other corrective action required or necessary under Environmental Laws, (B) the cost or expense of the preparation and implementation of any closure, remedial, corrective action or other plans required or necessary under Environmental Laws and (C) the cost and expense for any environmental or toxic tort pre-trial, trial or appellate legal or litigation support work;

but only to the extent that such violation complained of under clause (i), or such events or conditions included in clause (ii), occurred before the LNG Closing Date, with respect to the LNG Contribution Assets, or the Offshore Closing Date, with respect to the Offshore Contribution Assets; and provided that in no event shall Losses to the extent arising from a change in any Environmental Law after the LNG Closing Date or the Offshore Closing Date, as applicable, be deemed "Covered Environmental Losses."

"Crude Oil Assets" means crude oil tankers and related charters, excluding any crude oil tankers and related charters that constitute Offshore Assets.

"Crude Oil Restricted Business" has the meaning given such term in
Section 4.1.

"Environmental Laws" means all U.S. federal, state and local and all foreign laws, statutes, rules, regulations, orders, judgments and ordinances relating to protection of health and safety and the environment, including, without limitation, the United States federal Comprehensive Environmental Response, Compensation and Liability Act, the Resource Conservation and Recovery Act, the Clean Air Act, the Clean Water Act, the Safe Drinking Water Act, the Toxic Substances Control Act, the Oil Pollution Act of 1990, the Hazardous

AMENDED AND RESTATED OMNIBUS AGREEMENT

-4-

Materials Transportation Act, the Marine Mammal Protection Act, the Endangered Species Act, the National Environmental Policy Act, and other environmental conservation and protection laws, each as amended through the LNG Closing Date or the Offshore Closing Date, as applicable.

"Event of Loss" means any of the following events: (a) the actual or constructive total loss of a Suezmax Asset or an Aframax Asset or the agreed or compromised total loss of a Suezmax Asset or an Aframax Asset; (b) the destruction of a Suezmax Asset or an Aframax Asset; (c) the damage to a Suezmax Asset or an Aframax Asset to an extent, determined in good faith by Teekay LNG General Partner's Conflicts Committee, with respect to a Suezmax Asset, or Teekay Offshore General Partner's Conflicts Committee, with respect to an Aframax Asset, within 90 days after the occurrence of such damage, as shall make repair thereof uneconomical or shall render such Suezmax Asset or Aframax Asset permanently unfit for normal use (other than obsolescence); or (d) the condemnation, confiscation, requisition, seizure, forfeiture or other taking of title to or use of a Suezmax Asset or an Aframax Asset that shall not be revoked within six months. An Event of Loss shall be deemed to have occurred: (i) in the event of the destruction or other actual total loss of a Suezmax Asset or an Aframax Asset, on the date of such loss; (ii) in the event of a constructive, agreed or compromised total loss of a Suezmax Asset or an Aframax Asset, on the date of determination of such total loss pursuant to the relevant insurance policy; (iii) in the case of any event referred to in clause (c) above, upon such determination by the applicable Conflicts Committee; or (iv) in the case of any event referred in clause (d) above, on the date six months after the occurrence of such event.

"Exchange Act" means the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.

"Existing Offshore Project Assets" means the following Offshore Assets:
two conventional crude oil tankers (the Navion Bergen and the Navion Gothenburg) that Teekay currently is converting to shuttle tankers and one floating storage and offtake unit (the Dampier Spirit) currently being upgraded.

"First Offer Negotiation Period" has the meaning given such term in
Section 6.2.

"Fully-Built-Up Cost"" means, with respect to an LNG Asset or an Offshore Asset to be acquired or leased (pursuant to a capitalized lease obligation) by an LNG Partnership Group Member or an Offshore Partnership Group Member, respectively, the aggregate amount of all expenditures incurred (or to be incurred prior to delivery to the LNG Partnership Group Member or the Offshore Partnership Group Member) to acquire, construct and/or convert and bring such LNG Asset or Offshore Asset to the condition and location necessary for its intended use by the LNG Partnership Group Member or the Offshore Partnership Group Member, as applicable, plus a reasonable allocation of overhead costs related to the development of such project and other projects that would have been subject to the offer rights set forth in this Agreement but were not completed; provided, however, that in determining the Fully-Built-Up Cost of an Offshore Asset that is constructed or converted using a hull from Teekay's fleet (including the Existing Offshore Project Assets), such hull shall be valued at its fair market value at the time of the vessel's

AMENDED AND RESTATED OMNIBUS AGREEMENT

-5-

transfer by Teekay and the Fully-Built-Up Cost of such Offshore Asset (other than the hull) shall be determined as otherwise set forth in this definition.

"Hazardous Substances" means (a) substances which contain substances defined in or regulated under applicable Environmental Laws; (b) petroleum and petroleum products, including crude oil and any fractions thereof; (c) natural gas, synthetic gas and any mixtures thereof; (d) any substances with respect to which a federal, state, foreign or local agency requires environmental investigation, monitoring, reporting or remediation; (e) any hazardous waste or solid waste, within the meaning of any Environmental Law; (f) any solid, hazardous, dangerous or toxic chemical, material, waste or substance, within the meaning of and regulated by any Environmental Law; (g) any radioactive material; and (h) any asbestos-containing materials that represent a health hazard.

"LNG" means liquefied natural gas.

"LNG Assets" means LNG carriers and related time charters.

"LNG Closing Date" means May 10, 2005, the date of the closing of the initial public offering of common units representing limited partner interests in Teekay LNG MLP.

"LNG Contribution Agreement" means that certain Contribution, Conveyance and Assumption Agreement, dated as of May 10, 2005, among Teekay, Teekay LNG General Partner, Teekay LNG MLP, Teekay LNG OLLC and Teekay Shipping Spain, S.L., together with the additional conveyance documents and instruments contemplated or referenced thereunder.

"LNG Contribution Assets" means the assets of the Teekay LNG Partnership Group as of the LNG Closing Date.

"LNG Partnership Entities" means Teekay LNG General Partner, Teekay LNG MLP, Teekay LNG OLLC and any Person controlled by any such entity.

"LNG Partnership Group" means Teekay LNG MLP, Teekay LNG OLLC and any Person controlled by any such entity.

"LNG Partnership Group Member" means any Person in the LNG Partnership Group.

"LNG Restricted Business" has the meaning given such term in Section 2.1.

"Losses" means losses, damages, liabilities, claims, demands, causes of action, judgments, settlements, fines, penalties, costs and expenses (including, without limitation, court costs and reasonable attorneys' and experts' fees) of any and every kind or character; provided, however, that such term shall not include any special, indirect, incidental or consequential damages.

AMENDED AND RESTATED OMNIBUS AGREEMENT

-6-

"Offer" has the meaning given such term in Section 5.1(b).

"Offered Assets" has the meaning given such term in Section 5.1(a).

"Offeree" has the meaning given such term in Section 5.1(a).

"Offer Period" has the meaning given such term in Section 5.1(e).

"Offshore Assets" means (a) dynamically-positioned shuttle tankers (excluding dynamically-positioned shuttle tankers that operate in conventional crude oil tanker trades under Qualifying Contracts), (b) floating storage and offtake units, (c) floating production, storage and offloading units and (d) related time charters or contracts of affreightment.

"Offshore Closing Date" means the date of the closing of the initial public offering of common units representing limited partner interests in Teekay Offshore MLP.

"Offshore Contribution Agreement" means that certain Contribution, Conveyance and Assumption Agreement, dated as of the Offshore Closing Date, among Teekay, Teekay Offshore General Partner, Teekay Offshore MLP, Teekay Offshore OLP and Teekay Offshore Operating General Partner, together with the additional conveyance documents and instruments contemplated or referenced thereunder.

"Offshore Contribution Assets" means the assets of Teekay Offshore OLP as of the Offshore Closing Date.

"Offshore Partnership Entities" means Teekay Offshore General Partner, Teekay Offshore MLP, Teekay Offshore Operating General Partner, Teekay Offshore OLP and any Person controlled by any such entity.

"Offshore Partnership Group" means Teekay Offshore MLP, Teekay Offshore Operating General Partner, Teekay Offshore OLP and any Person controlled by any such Person.

"Offshore Partnership Group Member" means any Person in the Offshore Partnership Group.

"offshore project" means any project involving the marine transportation, production, processing or storage of crude oil using Offshore Assets.

"Offshore Restricted Business" has the meaning given such term in
Section 3.1.

"Original Agreement" is defined in the recitals to this Agreement.

"Parties" means the parties to this Agreement and their successors and permitted assigns.

AMENDED AND RESTATED OMNIBUS AGREEMENT

-7-

"Petrojarl" means Petrojarl ASA, a Norwegian company of which Teekay owns a majority of its outstanding capital stock as of the date of this Agreement.

"Petrojarl Excluded Assets" has the meaning given such term in Section 3.2(h).

"Petrojarl Joint Venture Agreement" means the Joint Venture Partners' Agreement dated June 14, 2006 among Petrojarl JV AS, Teekay Petrojarl Offshore Holdings L.L.C. and Teekay Petrojarl GP L.L.C., as it may be amended, modified, or supplemented from time to time.

"Person" means an individual, corporation, partnership, joint venture, trust, limited liability company, unincorporated organization or any other entity.

"Potential Transferee" has the meaning given such term in Section 6.2.

"Qualifying Contract" means a time charter or contract of affreightment with a remaining duration, excluding any extension options, of at least three years. For purposes of this definition, the duration of any life-of-field contract of affreightment shall be deemed to equal the expected remaining life of the relevant oil field as determined by Wood Mackenzie Ltd., or, if Wood Mackenzie is not available, another reasonably suitable independent entity qualified to estimate the remaining life of the relevant oil field.

"Qualifying Petrojarl Joint Venture Offshore Projects" means projects subject to the Petrojarl Joint Venture Agreement that involve Offshore Assets that are subject to a Qualifying Contract.

"Re-Charter" means the chartering-out of an LNG Asset, an Offshore Asset or a Crude Oil Asset pursuant to a Qualifying Contract in the event that its existing charter or contract of affreightment expires or is terminated early (including, without limitation, the chartering of any Replacement Suezmax Asset or Replacement Aframax Asset but only if the charter party for the Replacement Suezmax Asset or Replacement Aframax Asset, as applicable, is not the same charter party (or an Affiliate of such charter party) as for the replaced Suezmax Asset or Aframax Asset).

"Replacement Aframax Assets" means any Aframax tankers that replace any Afraxmax Assets upon (a) an Event of Loss or (b) the replacement of a time-charter arrangement existing as of the Offshore Closing Date where the original Aframax Asset which was subject to such time charter has been sold or transferred due to the exercise by the charter party of its right under the time charter to cause such sale or transfer.

AMENDED AND RESTATED OMNIBUS AGREEMENT

-8-

"Replacement Suezmax Assets" means any Suezmax tankers that replace any Suezmax Assets upon (a) an Event of Loss or (b) the replacement of a time-charter arrangement existing as of the LNG Closing Date where the original Suezmax Asset which was subject to such time charter has been sold or transferred due to the exercise by the charter party of its right under the time charter to cause such sale or transfer.

"Restricted Business" means, as applicable, the LNG Restricted Business, the Offshore Restricted Business or the Crude Oil Restricted Business.

"Retained Assets" means all right, title and interest in and to assets other than (a) the LNG Contribution Assets or (b) the Offshore Contribution Assets, as applicable.

"Retained Liabilities" means any and all liabilities and obligations of any and every kind or character not assumed by (a) the LNG Partnership Group pursuant to the LNG Contribution Agreement or (b) the Offshore Partnership Group pursuant to the Offshore Contribution Agreement, as applicable.

"Sale Assets" has the meaning given such term in Section 6.2.

"Suezmax Assets" means the Suezmax tankers included in the LNG Contribution Assets and any Replacement Suezmax Assets relating to such original Suezmax tankers.

"Teekay" is defined in the introduction to this Agreement.

"Teekay Entities" means Teekay and any Person controlled, directly or indirectly, by Teekay other than the LNG Partnership Entities and the Offshore Partnership Entities.

"Teekay LNG General Partner" is defined in the introduction to this Agreement.

"Teekay LNG MLP" is defined in the introduction to this Agreement.

"Teekay LNG MLP Agreement" means the First Amended and Restated Agreement of Limited Partnership of the Teekay LNG MLP, dated as of May 10, 2005, as amended by Amendment No. 1 dated as of May 31, 2006, as such agreement is in effect on the Offshore Closing Date, to which reference is hereby made for all purposes of this Agreement. No amendment or modification to the Teekay LNG MLP Agreement subsequent to the Offshore Closing Date shall be given effect for purposes of this Agreement unless consented to by each of the Parties to this Agreement.

"Teekay LNG OLLC" is defined in the introduction to this Agreement.

"Teekay Offshore General Partner" is defined in the introduction to this Agreement.

"Teekay Offshore MLP" is defined in the introduction to this Agreement.

AMENDED AND RESTATED OMNIBUS AGREEMENT

-9-

"Teekay Offshore MLP Agreement" means the First Amended and Restated Agreement of Limited Partnership of the Teekay Offshore MLP, dated as of the Offshore Closing Date, as such agreement is in effect on the Offshore Closing Date, to which reference is hereby made for all purposes of this Agreement. No amendment or modification to the Teekay Offshore MLP Agreement subsequent to the Offshore Closing Date shall be given effect for purposes of this Agreement unless consented to by each of the Parties to this Agreement.

"Teekay Offshore OLP" is defined in the introduction to this Agreement.

"Teekay Offshore Operating General Partner" is defined in the introduction to this Agreement.

"Transfer" means any transfer, assignment, sale or other disposition of
(a) any LNG Assets by a Teekay Entity or an Offshore Partnership Group Member,
(b) any Offshore Assets by a Teekay Entity or an LNG Partnership Group Member, or (c) any Crude Oil Assets by an LNG Partnership Group Member or an Offshore Partnership Group Member; provided, however, that such term shall not include:
(i) transfers, assignments, sales or other dispositions from a Teekay Entity to another Teekay Entity, from an LNG Partnership Group Member to another LNG Partnership Group Member or from an Offshore Partnership Group Member to another Offshore Partnership Group Member; (ii) transfers, assignments, sales or other dispositions pursuant to the terms of any related charter, contract of affreightment or other agreement with a charter party or the party to the contract of affreightment, as applicable; (iii) transfers, assignments, sales or other dispositions pursuant to Article II, III or IV of this Agreement; (iv) grants of security interests in or mortgages or liens on such LNG Assets, Offshore Assets or Crude Oil Assets in favor of a bona fide third-party lender (but not the foreclosing of any such security interest, mortgage or lien); or
(v) transfers, assignments, sales or other dispositions by a Teekay Entity (other than Petrojarl or any Person controlled thereby) of any Offshore Assets it owns as of the date of this agreement if, at the time of the proposed transfer, assignment, sale or other disposition, the applicable Offshore Asset is not subject to a Qualifying Contract.

"Transfer Notice" has the meaning given such term in Section 6.2.

"Transferring Party" has the meaning given such term in Section 6.2.

"Voting Securities" means securities of any class of Person entitling the holders thereof to vote in the election of members of the board of directors or other similar governing body of the Person.

ARTICLE II
LNG RESTRICTED BUSINESS OPPORTUNITIES

2.1 LNG RESTRICTED BUSINESSES. Subject to Section 8.4 and except as permitted by Section 2.2, each of the Teekay Entities and the Offshore Partnership Group Members shall

AMENDED AND RESTATED OMNIBUS AGREEMENT

-10-

be prohibited from engaging in or acquiring or investing in any business that owns, operates or charters LNG Assets (each an "LNG Restricted Business").

2.2 PERMITTED EXCEPTIONS. Notwithstanding any provision of Section 2.1 to the contrary, the Teekay Entities and the Offshore Partnership Group Members may engage in the following activities under any of the following circumstances:

(a) the ownership, operation and/or chartering of any LNG Assets that they acquire after the date of this Agreement if:

(i) such LNG Assets are acquired as part of a business or package of assets in a transaction in which the fair market value of such LNG Assets represents less than a majority of the fair market value of the total assets or business acquired (fair market value as determined in good faith by the board of directors of Teekay or Teekay Offshore General Partner's Conflicts Committee, as applicable); and

(ii) the Teekay Entity or the Offshore Partnership Group Member has offered Teekay LNG General Partner the opportunity for any of the Teekay LNG Partnership Group Members to purchase such LNG Assets in accordance with the procedures set forth in Section 5.1 and Teekay LNG General Partner, with the approval of Teekay LNG General Partner's Conflicts Committee, has elected not to cause any Teekay LNG Partnership Group Member to purchase such LNG Assets;

(b) the ownership, operation and/or chartering of LNG Assets that (i) are subject to an offer to purchase by a Teekay Entity or an Offshore Partnership Group Member as described in Section 2.2(a)(ii) or (ii) subject to
Section 5.1, relate to a tender, bid or award for a proposed LNG project that a Teekay Entity has submitted or received (or hereafter submits or receives) (such LNG Assets in clause (ii) being referred to herein as "Bid LNG Assets"), in each case pending the applicable offer of such LNG Assets to Teekay LNG General Partner and Teekay LNG General Partner's determination pursuant to Section 5.1 whether to purchase the LNG Assets and, if Teekay LNG General Partner's Conflicts Committee determines to cause a Teekay LNG Partnership Group Member to purchase such LNG Assets, pending the closing of such purchase;

(c) the provision by Teekay Entities of ship management services relating to an LNG Restricted Business;

(d) the acquisition of up to a 9.9% equity ownership, voting or profit participation interest in any publicly traded Person (other than Teekay LNG MLP) that engages in an LNG Restricted Business;

(e) the ownership, operation and/or chartering of any LNG Assets with respect to which Teekay LNG General Partner has advised Teekay or Teekay Offshore General Partner, as applicable, that Teekay LNG General Partner has elected, with the approval of Teekay LNG

AMENDED AND RESTATED OMNIBUS AGREEMENT

-11-

General Partner's Conflicts Committee, not to cause a Teekay LNG Partnership Group Member to acquire (or seek to acquire); or

(f) the ownership, operation and/or chartering by Teekay Entities of the LNG Assets subject to the Nakilat Share Purchase Agreement dated as of May 10, 2005, between Teekay and Teekay LNG MLP if the Teekay LNG MLP fails to perform its obligations to purchase (or to cause other Teekay LNG Partnership Group Members to purchase) such LNG Assets under such agreement.

ARTICLE III
OFFSHORE RESTRICTED BUSINESS OPPORTUNITIES

3.1 OFFSHORE RESTRICTED BUSINESSES. Subject to Section 8.4 and except as permitted by Section 3.2, each of the Teekay Entities and the LNG Partnership Group Members shall be prohibited from engaging in or acquiring or investing in any business that owns, operates or charters Offshore Assets (each an "Offshore Restricted Business"); provided, however, that, subject to Section 6.1, nothing in this Agreement shall prohibit the LNG Partnership Group Members from owning, operating or chartering any Suezmax Assets that are hereafter converted into Offshore Assets.

3.2 PERMITTED EXCEPTIONS. Notwithstanding any provision of Section 3.1 to the contrary, the Teekay Entities and the LNG Partnership Group Members may engage in the following activities under any of the following circumstances:

(a) the ownership, operation and/or chartering of Offshore Assets that are not subject to a Qualifying Contract;

(b) the ownership, operation and/or chartering of any Offshore Assets that they acquire after the date of this Agreement if:

(i) such Offshore Assets are acquired as part of a business or package of assets in a transaction in which the fair market value of such Offshore Assets represents less than a majority of the fair market value of the total assets or business acquired (fair market value as determined in good faith by the board of directors of Teekay or Teekay LNG General Partner's Conflicts Committee, as applicable); and

(ii) the Teekay Entity or the LNG Partnership Group Member has offered Teekay Offshore General Partner the opportunity for any of the Teekay Offshore Partnership Group Members to purchase such Offshore Assets in accordance with the procedures set forth in Section 5.1 and Teekay Offshore General Partner, with the approval of Teekay Offshore General Partner's Conflicts Committee, has elected not to cause any Teekay Offshore Partnership Group Member to purchase such Offshore Assets;

AMENDED AND RESTATED OMNIBUS AGREEMENT

-12-

(c) the ownership, operation and/or chartering of Offshore Assets that (i) are subject to an offer to purchase by a Teekay Entity or an LNG Partnership Group Member as described in Section 3.2(b)(ii), or (ii) subject to
Section 5.1, relate to a tender, bid or award for a proposed offshore project that a Teekay Entity has submitted or received (or hereafter submits or receives), including Qualifying Petrojarl Joint Venture Offshore Projects and the Existing Offshore Project Assets (such Offshore Assets in clause (ii) being referred to herein as "Bid Offshore Assets"), in each case pending the applicable offer of such Offshore Assets to Teekay Offshore General Partner and Teekay Offshore General Partner's determination pursuant to Section 5.1 whether to purchase the Offshore Assets and, if Teekay Offshore General Partner's Conflicts Committee determines to cause a Teekay Offshore Partnership Group Member to purchase such Offshore Assets, pending the closing of such purchase;

(d) the provision by Teekay Entities of ship management services relating to an Offshore Restricted Business;

(e) the acquisition of up to a 9.9% equity ownership, voting or profit participation interest in any publicly traded Person that engages in an Offshore Restricted Business;

(f) the ownership, operation and/or chartering of any Offshore Assets with respect to which Teekay Offshore General Partner has advised Teekay or Teekay LNG General Partner, as applicable, that Teekay Offshore General Partner has elected, with the approval of Teekay Offshore General Partner's Conflicts Committee, not to cause a Teekay Offshore Partnership Group Member to acquire (or seek to acquire);

(g) the ownership by Teekay Entities of (i) a limited partnership interest in Teekay Offshore OLP, (ii) interests in Teekay Offshore MLP and (iii), subject to Section 3.2(h), interests in Petrojarl;

(h) (i) prior to Teekay Entities owning 100% of Petrojarl, the ownership, operation and/or chartering by Petrojarl or its controlled affiliates of (A) the Offshore Assets owned, operated and/or chartered by Petrojarl or its controlled affiliates as of the Offshore Closing Date ("Petrojarl Excluded Assets") or (B) interests in Qualifying Petrojarl Joint Venture Offshore Projects and (ii) subject to Section 5.1, following the acquisition by the Teekay Entities of 100% of Petrojarl, the ownership, operation and/or chartering by Petrojarl or its controlled affiliates of Offshore Assets then subject to Qualifying Contracts (including interests in Qualifying Petrojarl Joint Venture Offshore Projects) pending the applicable offer of such Offshore Assets to Teekay Offshore General Partner and Teekay Offshore General Partner's determination pursuant to Section 5.1 whether to purchase such Offshore Assets and, if Teekay Offshore General Partner's Conflicts Committee determines to cause an Offshore Partnership Group Member to purchase such Offshore Assets, pending the closing of such purchase.

AMENDED AND RESTATED OMNIBUS AGREEMENT

-13-

ARTICLE IV
CRUDE OIL RESTRICTED BUSINESS OPPORTUNITIES

4.1 CRUDE OIL RESTRICTED BUSINESSES. Subject to Section 8.4 and except as permitted by Section 4.2, each LNG Partnership Group Member and each Offshore Partnership Group Member shall be prohibited from engaging in or acquiring or investing in any business that owns, operates or charters Crude Oil Assets (each a "Crude Oil Restricted Business").

4.2 PERMITTED EXCEPTIONS. Notwithstanding any provision of Section 4.1 to the contrary, the LNG Partnership Group Members and the Offshore Partnership Group Members may engage in the following activities under any of the following circumstances:

(a) the LNG Partnership Group Members may engage in the ownership, operation and/or chartering of any of the Suezmax Assets, including any Replacement Suezmax Assets;

(b) the Offshore Partnership Group Members may engage in the ownership, operation and/or chartering of any of the Aframax Assets, including any Replacement Aframax Assets;

(c) the ownership, operation and/or chartering of any Crude Oil Assets that it acquires after the date of this Agreement if:

(i) such Crude Oil Assets are acquired as part of a business or package of assets in a transaction in which the fair market value of such Crude Oil Assets represents less than a majority of the fair market value of the total assets or business acquired (fair market value as determined in good faith by the Conflicts Committee of the board of directors of Teekay LNG General Partner or Teekay Offshore General Partner, as applicable); and

(ii) the LNG Partnership Group Member or Offshore Partnership Group Member, as applicable, has offered Teekay the opportunity for Teekay or any other Teekay Entity to purchase such Crude Oil Assets in accordance with the procedures set forth in Section 5.1 and Teekay has elected not to purchase and not to cause another Teekay Entity to purchase such Crude Oil Assets;

(d) the ownership, operation and/or chartering of Crude Oil Assets that are subject to an offer by an LNG Partnership Group Member or an Offshore Partnership Group Member as described in Section 4.2(c) pending Teekay's determination whether to purchase the Crude Oil Assets and, if Teekay determines to cause a Teekay Entity to purchase such Crude Oil Assets, pending the closing of such purchase;

(e) the acquisition of up to a 9.9% equity ownership, voting or profit participation interest in any publicly traded Person that engages in a Crude Oil Restricted Business; or

AMENDED AND RESTATED OMNIBUS AGREEMENT

-14-

(f) the ownership, operation and/or chartering by an LNG Partnership Group Member or an Offshore Partnership Group Member of any Crude Oil Assets with respect to which Teekay has previously advised Teekay LNG General Partner or Teekay Offshore General Partner, as applicable, that Teekay has elected not to cause a Teekay Entity to acquire (or seek to acquire).

ARTICLE V
BUSINESS OPPORTUNITIES PROCEDURES

5.1 PROCEDURES. (a) In the event that (i) an LNG Partnership Group Member or an Offshore Partnership Group Member acquires Crude Oil Assets as part of a larger transaction in accordance with Section 4.2(c), (ii) a Teekay Entity or an Offshore Partnership Group Member acquires LNG Assets as part of a larger transaction in accordance with Section 2.2(a), (iii) a Teekay Entity or an LNG Partnership Group Member acquires Offshore Assets as part of a larger transaction in accordance with Section 3.2(b), (iv) a Teekay Entity is awarded a contract for the transportation requirements for all or any portion of any proposed LNG project or offshore project for which a Teekay Entity has tendered or submitted a bid (and, with respect to Offshore Assets, the contract is a Qualifying Contract), including, without limitation, the projects to be served by the Existing Offshore Project Assets, (v) the Teekay Entities acquire 100% ownership of Petrojarl or (vi) a Teekay Entity proposes to Re-Charters any LNG Assets or Offshore Assets (including any Petrojarl Excluded Assets once the Teekay entities acquire 100% ownership of Petrojarl), then:

(x) in the case of clause (i), (ii), (iii), (v) or (vi) above, not later than 30 days after the consummation of the acquisition or the proposed Re-Chartering of any Offshore Assets; provided, however, that such period shall be 365 days for acquisitions of Offshore Assets by any Teekay Entities or any LNG Partnership Group Members or the acquisition of 100% ownership of Petrojarl by any Teekay Entities; or

(y) in the case of clause (iv) above, not later than 180 days before the scheduled delivery date of the relevant Bid LNG Asset or 365 days after the delivery date of the relevant Bid Offshore Asset,

such acquiring party or such party proposing to Re-Charter the LNG Assets or Offshore Assets (as applicable, the "Acquiring Party") shall notify (A) Teekay, in the case of an acquisition by an LNG Partnership Group Member or an Offshore Partnership Group Member of Crude Oil Assets, (B) Teekay LNG General Partner, in the case of (x) an acquisition by a Teekay Entity or an Offshore Partnership Group Member of LNG Assets, (y) a proposed acquisition of Bid LNG Assets or (z) the proposed Re-Chartering by a Teekay Entity of LNG Assets or (C) Teekay Offshore General Partner, in the case of (w) an acquisition by a Teekay Entity or an LNG Partnership Group Member of Offshore Assets, (x) a proposed acquisition of Bid Offshore Assets, (y) the acquisition of 100% ownership of Petrojarl or (z) the proposed Re-Chartering by a Teekay Entity of Offshore Assets, in each case of such acquisition (or proposed acquisition) or proposed Re-Chartering, and offer such party to be notified (each an "Offeree") the opportunity

AMENDED AND RESTATED OMNIBUS AGREEMENT

-15-

for the Offeree (or, in the case of Teekay, Teekay LNG General Partner or Teekay Offshore General Partner, any other Teekay Entity, LNG Partnership Group Member or Teekay Offshore Partnership Group Member, respectively) to purchase such Crude Oil Assets, LNG Assets, Bid LNG Assets, Bid Offshore Assets or Offshore Assets, including, with respect to Petrojarl, Offshore Assets subject to Qualifying Contracts at the time Teekay acquires 100% ownership of Petrojarl (including any Petrojarl interest in a joint venture that owns, operates or charters an Offshore Asset subject to a Qualifying Contract), as applicable (the "Offered Assets").

(b) The purchase price for any Offered Assets pursuant to
Section 5.1(a) above shall be (i) the Offered Assets' fair market value (plus any Break-up Costs), in the case of Section 5.1(a)(i), (ii), (iii), (v) or (vi) or (ii) the Offered Assets' Fully-Built-Up Cost, in the case of Section 5.1(a)(iv) or for Existing Offshore Project Assets, in each case on commercially reasonable terms in accordance with this Section (the "Offer").

(c) The Offer shall set forth the Acquiring Party's proposed terms relating to the purchase of the Offered Assets by the Offeree (or, in the case of Teekay, Teekay LNG General Partner or Teekay Offshore General Partner, any other Teekay Entity, LNG Partnership Group Member or Offshore Partnership Group Member, respectively), including any liabilities to be assumed by the Offeree as part of the Offer.

(d) As soon as practicable after the Offer is made, the Acquiring Party will deliver to the Offeree all information prepared by or on behalf of or in the possession of such Acquiring Party relating to the Offered Assets and reasonably requested by the Offeree. As soon as practicable, but in any event, within 90 days after receipt of such notification (30 days in the case of a proposed Re-Chartering of LNG Assets or Offshore Assets), the Offeree shall notify the Acquiring Party in writing that either:

(i) the Offeree (with the concurrence of the applicable Conflicts Committee if the Offeree is Teekay LNG General Partner or Teekay Offshore General Partner) has elected not to purchase (or not to cause any of its permitted Affiliates to purchase) such Offered Assets, in which event the Acquiring Party and its Affiliates shall, subject to the other terms of this Agreement (including, without limitation, this Section 5.1 and Article VI in connection with any subsequently proposed Re-Chartering by a Teekay Entity of any LNG Assets or Offshore Assets), be forever free to continue to own, operate and charter such Offered Assets or, with respect to any proposed Re-Chartering of LNG Assets or Offshore Assets, be free to Re-Charter the LNG Assets or Offshore Assets in such instance as provided in Article VI; or

(ii) the Offeree (with the concurrence of the applicable Conflicts Committee if the Offeree is Teekay LNG General Partner or Teekay Offshore General Partner) has elected to purchase (or to cause any of its permitted Affiliates to purchase) such Offered Assets, in which event the procedures set forth in Section 5.1(e) below shall be followed.

AMENDED AND RESTATED OMNIBUS AGREEMENT

-16-

(e) In the event of a proposed purchase pursuant to Section 5.1(d)(ii):

(i) After the receipt of the Offer by the Offeree, the Acquiring Party and the Offeree shall determine the fair market value (and any Break-up Costs) or the Fully-Built-Up Cost, as applicable, of the Offered Assets that are subject to the Offer and the other terms of the Offer on which the Offered Assets will be sold to the Offeree. If the Acquiring Party and the Offeree agree (with the concurrence of the applicable Conflicts Committee) on the fair market value (and any Break-up Costs) or the Fully-Built-Up Cost, as applicable, of the Offered Assets that are subject to the Offer and the other terms of the Offer during the 30-day period after receipt by the Acquiring Party of the Offeree's election to purchase (or to cause any permitted Affiliate of the Offeree to purchase) the Offered Assets (the "Offer Period"), the Offeree shall purchase (or cause any of its permitted Affiliates to purchase) the Offered Assets on such terms as soon as commercially practicable after such agreement has been reached.

(ii) If the Acquiring Party and the Offeree are unable to agree on the fair market value (and any Break-up Costs) or the Fully-Built-Up Cost, as applicable, of the Offered Assets that are subject to the Offer or on any other terms of the Offer during the Offer Period, the Acquiring Party and the Offeree will engage an independent ship broker and/or an independent investment banking firm prior to the end of the Offer Period to determine the fair market value (and any Break-up Costs) or the Fully-Built-Up Cost, as applicable, of the Offered Assets and/or the other terms on which the Acquiring Party and the Offeree are unable to agree. In determining the fair market value or the Fully-Built-Up Cost of the Offered Assets and other terms on which the Offered Assets are to be sold, the ship broker or investment banking firm, as applicable, will have access to the proposed sale and purchase values and terms for the Offer submitted by the Acquiring Party and the Offeree, respectively, and to all information prepared by or on behalf of the Acquiring Party relating to the Offered Assets and reasonably requested by such ship broker or investment banking firm. Such ship broker or investment banking firm will determine the fair market value (and any Break-up Costs) or Fully-Built-Up Cost of the Offered Assets and/or the other terms on which the Acquiring Party and the Offeree are unable to agree within 60 days of its engagement and furnish the Acquiring Party and the Offeree its determination. The fees and expenses of the ship broker or investment banking firm, as applicable, will be divided equally between the Acquiring Party and the Offeree. Upon receipt of such determination, the Offeree will have the option, but not the obligation, to (with the concurrence of the applicable Conflicts Committee if the Offeree is Teekay LNG General Partner or Teekay Offshore General Partner):

(x) purchase the Offered Assets for the fair market value (and any Break-up Costs) or Fully-Built-Up Cost, as applicable, and on the other terms determined by the ship broker or investment banking firm, as soon as commercially practicable after determinations have been made; or

AMENDED AND RESTATED OMNIBUS AGREEMENT

-17-

(y) elect not to purchase such Offered Assets, in which event the Acquiring Party and its Affiliates shall, subject to the other terms of this Agreement (including, without limitation, this Section 5.1 and Article VI in connection with any subsequently proposed Re-Chartering by a Teekay Entity of any LNG Assets or Offshore Assets), be forever free to continue to own, operate and/or charter such Offered Assets or, with respect to any proposed Re-Chartering of LNG Assets or Offshore Assets, be free to Re-Charter the LNG Assets or Offshore Assets in such instance as provided in Article VI.

5.2 SCOPE OF PROHIBITION. If any Party or its Affiliates engages in a Restricted Business pursuant to any of the exceptions described in Section 2.2, 3.2 or 4.2, as applicable, the Party and its Affiliates may not subsequently expand that portion of their business other than pursuant to the exceptions contained in such Sections 2.2, 3.2 or 4.2. Except as otherwise provided in this Agreement, the Teekay LNG MLP Agreement and the Teekay Offshore MLP Agreement, each Party and its Affiliates shall be free to engage in any business activity whatsoever, including those that may be in direct competition with the Teekay Entities, the LNG Partnership Group or the Offshore Partnership Group.

5.3 ENFORCEMENT. Each Party agrees and acknowledges that the other Parties do not have an adequate remedy at law for the breach by any such Party of its covenants and agreements set forth in this Article V, and that any breach by any such Party of its covenants and agreements set forth in this Article V would result in irreparable injury to such other Parties. Each Party further agrees and acknowledges that any other Party may, in addition to the other remedies which may be available to such other Party, file a suit in equity to enjoin such Party from such breach, and consent to the issuance of injunctive relief to enforce the provisions of this Article V of this Agreement.

ARTICLE VI
RIGHTS OF FIRST OFFER

6.1 RIGHTS OF FIRST OFFER.

(a) The LNG Partnership Group hereby grants (i) Teekay a right of first offer on any proposed Transfer or Re-Charter by any LNG Partnership Group Member of any Crude Oil Assets owned or acquired by any LNG Partnership Group Member and (ii) Teekay Offshore MLP a right of first offer on any proposed Transfer or Re-Charter by any LNG Partnership Group Member of any Offshore Assets owned or acquired by any LNG Partnership Group Member. The Offshore Partnership Group hereby grants (i) Teekay a right of first offer on any proposed Transfer or Re-Charter by any Offshore Partnership Group Member of any Crude Oil Assets owned or acquired by any Offshore Partnership Group Member and
(ii) Teekay LNG General Partner a right of first offer on any proposed Transfer or Re-Charter by any Offshore Partnership Group Member of any LNG Assets owned or acquired by any Offshore Partnership Group Member. The Teekay Entities hereby grant (i) Teekay LNG MLP a right of first offer on any proposed Transfer or, subject to Section 5.1, Re-Charter of any LNG Assets owned or

AMENDED AND RESTATED OMNIBUS AGREEMENT

-18-

acquired by any Teekay Entity and (ii) Teekay Offshore MLP a right of first offer on any proposed Transfer or, subject to Section 5.1, Re-Charter of any Offshore Assets owned or acquired by any Teekay Entity.

(b) The Parties acknowledge that all potential Transfers or Re-Charters of Crude Oil Assets, LNG Assets or Offshore Assets pursuant to this Article VI are subject to obtaining any and all written consents of governmental authorities and other non-affiliated third parties and to the terms of all existing agreements in respect of such Crude Oil Assets, LNG Assets or Offshore Assets, as applicable.

6.2 PROCEDURES FOR RIGHTS OF FIRST OFFER. In the event that an LNG
Partnership Group Member, an Offshore Partnership Group Member or a Teekay Entity (as applicable, the "Transferring Party") proposes to Transfer or Re-Charter any Crude Oil Assets, LNG Assets or Offshore Assets, as applicable (the "Sale Assets"), prior to engaging in any negotiation for such Transfer or Re-Charter with any non-affiliated third party or otherwise offering to Transfer or Re-Charter the Sale Assets to any non-affiliated third party, such Transferring Party shall give Teekay, Teekay LNG MLP or Teekay Offshore MLP, as applicable (the "Potential Transferee"), written notice setting forth all material terms and conditions (including, without limitation, the purchase price (in the event of a Transfer) or the terms of the charter agreement (in the event of a Re-Charter) and a description of the Sale Asset(s) on which such Transferring Party desires to Transfer or Re-Charter the Sale Assets (the "Transfer Notice"). The material terms set forth in the Transfer Notice shall have been approved, in any case where an LNG Partnership Group Member or an Offshore Partnership Group Member is the Transferring Party, by the applicable Conflicts Committee of Teekay LNG General Partner or Teekay Offshore General Partner. Subject to Section 5.1 with respect to any proposed Re-Charter by a Teekay Entity of any LNG Assets or Offshore Assets, the Transferring Party then shall be obligated to negotiate in good faith for a 30-day period following the delivery by the Transferring Party of the Transfer Notice (the "First Offer Negotiation Period") to reach an agreement for the Transfer or Re-Charter of such Sale Assets to the Potential Transferee or any of its Affiliates on the terms and conditions set forth in the Transfer Notice. Subject to Section 5.1 with respect to any proposed Re-Charter by a Teekay Entity of any LNG Assets or Offshore Assets, if no such agreement with respect to the Sale Assets is reached during the First Offer Negotiation Period, and the Transferring Party has not Transferred or Re-Chartered, or agreed in writing to Transfer or Re-Charter, such Sale Assets to a third party within 180 days after the end of the First Offer Negotiation Period on terms generally no less favorable to the Transferring Party than those included in the Transfer Notice, then the Transferring Party shall not thereafter Transfer or Re-Charter any of the Sale Assets without first offering such assets to the applicable Potential Transferee in the manner provided above.

AMENDED AND RESTATED OMNIBUS AGREEMENT

-19-

ARTICLE VII
INDEMNIFICATION

7.1 TEEKAY INDEMNIFICATION. Subject to the provisions of Section 7.2 and Section 7.3, Teekay shall indemnify, defend and hold harmless the LNG Partnership Group and the Offshore Partnership Group, respectively, from and against: (a) any Covered Environmental Losses relating to the applicable Contribution Assets and events, circumstances or conditions existing prior to or on the LNG Closing Date or the Offshore Closing Date, respectively, to the extent that Teekay is notified by Teekay LNG General Partner or Teekay Offshore General Partner of any such Covered Environmental Losses within five (5) years after the LNG Closing Date or the Offshore Closing Date, as applicable; (b) Losses to the Teekay LNG Partnership Group or the Teekay Offshore Partnership Group, as applicable, arising from (i) the failure of (A) the LNG Partnership Group, immediately after the LNG Closing Date, or (B) the Offshore Partnership Group, immediately after the Offshore Closing Date, to be the owner of such valid leasehold interests or fee ownership interests in and to the applicable Contribution Assets as are necessary to enable the LNG Partnership Entities or the Offshore Partnership Entities to own and operate such Contribution Assets in substantially the same manner that such Contribution Assets were owned and operated by the Teekay Entities immediately prior to the LNG Closing Date or the Offshore Closing Date, as applicable, or (ii) the failure of (A) the LNG Partnership Entities to have on the LNG Closing Date or (B) the Offshore Partnership Entities to have on the Offshore Closing Date, as applicable, any consent or governmental permit necessary to allow the LNG Partnership Entities or the Offshore Partnership Entities, as applicable, to own or operate the applicable Contribution Assets in substantially the same manner that such Contribution Assets were owned and operated by the Teekay Entities immediately prior to the LNG Closing Date or the Offshore Closing Date, as applicable, in each of clauses (i) and (ii) above, to the extent that Teekay is notified by Teekay LNG General Partner or Teekay Offshore General Partner of such Losses within three (3) years after the LNG Closing Date or the Offshore Closing Date, as applicable; (c) all U.S. federal, state and local and all foreign income tax liabilities attributable to the operation of the applicable Contribution Assets prior to the LNG Closing Date or the Offshore Closing Date, as applicable, including any such income tax liabilities of the Teekay Entities that may result from the consummation of the formation transactions for the LNG Partnership Group and Teekay LNG General Partner or the Offshore Partnership Group and Teekay Offshore General Partner, as applicable, but excluding any U.S. federal, state and local and any foreign income taxes reserved on the books of the LNG Partnership Group on the LNG Closing Date or of the Offshore Partnership Group as of the Offshore Closing Date; (d) any events or conditions attributable to or associated with ownership or operation of the Retained Assets, whether occurring before or after the LNG Closing Date or the Offshore Closing Date; and (e) any Retained Liabilities.

7.2 LIMITATION REGARDING INDEMNIFICATION.

(a) The aggregate liability of Teekay under Section 7.1(a) above in connection with the LNG Partnership Group and the LNG Contribution Assets shall not exceed $10 million.

AMENDED AND RESTATED OMNIBUS AGREEMENT

-20-

Furthermore, no claim may be made against Teekay for indemnification pursuant to
Section 7.1(a) in connection with the LNG Partnership Group and the LNG Contribution Assets unless the aggregate dollar amount of all claims for indemnification by the LNG Partnership Group pursuant to such section shall exceed $500,000, in which case Teekay shall be liable for claims for indemnification only to the extent such aggregate amount exceeds $500,000.

(b) The aggregate liability of Teekay under Section 7.1(a) above in connection with the Offshore Partnership Group and the Offshore Contribution Assets shall not exceed $10 million. Furthermore, no claim may be made against Teekay for indemnification pursuant to Section 7.1(a) in connection with the Offshore Partnership Group and the Offshore Contribution Assets unless the aggregate dollar amount of all claims for indemnification by the Offshore Partnership Group pursuant to such section shall exceed $500,000, in which case Teekay shall be liable for claims for indemnification only to the extent such aggregate amount exceeds $500,000.

7.3 INDEMNIFICATION PROCEDURES.

(a) The LNG Partnership Group Members and the Offshore Partnership Group Members agree that within a reasonable period of time after they become aware of facts giving rise to a claim for indemnification pursuant to Section 7.1, they will provide notice thereof in writing to Teekay specifying the nature of and specific basis for such claim.

(b) Teekay shall have the right to control all aspects of the defense of (and any counterclaims with respect to) any claims of third parties brought against the LNG Partnership Group or the Offshore Partnership Group that are covered by the indemnification set forth in Section 7.1, including, without limitation, the selection of counsel, determination of whether to appeal any decision of any court and the settling of any such matter or any issues relating thereto; provided, however, that no such settlement shall be entered into without the consent (which consent shall not be unreasonably withheld) of Teekay LNG General Partner, on behalf of the LNG Partnership Group, or Teekay Offshore General Partner, on behalf of the Offshore Partnership Group, as applicable (with the concurrence of the applicable Conflicts Committee), unless it includes a full release of the LNG Partnership Group or the Offshore Partnership Group, as applicable, from such matter or issues, as the case may be.

(c) The LNG Partnership Group Members and the Offshore Partnership Group Members agree to cooperate fully with Teekay with respect to all aspects of the defense of any claims covered by the indemnification set forth in Section 7.1, including, without limitation, the prompt furnishing to Teekay of any correspondence or other notice relating thereto that the LNG Partnership Group or the Offshore Partnership Group may receive, permitting the names of the members of the LNG Partnership Group or the Offshore Partnership Group, as applicable, to be utilized in connection with such defense, the making available to Teekay of any files, records or other information of the LNG Partnership Group or the Offshore Partnership Group that Teekay considers relevant to such defense and the making available to Teekay of any employees of the LNG Partnership Group or the Offshore Partnership Group, as applicable; provided, however, that in connection therewith Teekay agrees to use reasonable efforts to minimize the impact

AMENDED AND RESTATED OMNIBUS AGREEMENT

-21-

thereof on the operations of the LNG Partnership Group and the Offshore Partnership Group and further agrees to maintain the confidentiality of all files, records and other information furnished by an LNG Partnership Group Member or an Offshore Partnership Group Member pursuant to this Section 7.3. In no event shall the obligation of the LNG Partnership Group or the Offshore Partnership Group, as applicable, to cooperate with Teekay as set forth in the immediately preceding sentence be construed as imposing upon the LNG Partnership Group or the Offshore Partnership Group an obligation to hire and pay for counsel in connection with the defense of any claims covered by the indemnification set forth in this Article VII; provided, however, that the LNG Partnership Group Members and the Offshore Partnership Group Members, respectively, may, at their own option, cost and expense, hire and pay for counsel in connection with any such defense. Teekay agrees to keep any such counsel hired by the LNG Partnership Group or the Offshore Partnership Group reasonably informed as to the status of any such defense (including providing such counsel with such information related to any such defense as such counsel may reasonably request) but Teekay shall have the right to retain sole control over such defense.

(d) In determining the amount of any Loss for which any of the members of the LNG Partnership Group or the Offshore Partnership Group, as applicable, are entitled to indemnification under this Agreement, the gross amount of the indemnification will be reduced by (i) any insurance proceeds realized by the LNG Partnership Group or the Offshore Partnership Group, as applicable, and such correlative insurance benefit shall be net of any incremental insurance premium that becomes due and payable by the LNG Partnership Group or the Offshore Partnership Group as a result of such claim, and (ii) all amounts recovered by the LNG Partnership Group or the Offshore Partnership Group, as applicable, under contractual indemnities from third Persons. Teekay LNG MLP and Teekay Offshore MLP each hereby agrees to use commercially reasonable efforts to realize any applicable insurance proceeds or amounts recoverable under such contractual indemnities; provided, however, that the costs and expenses (including, without limitation, court costs and reasonable attorneys' fees) of the LNG Partnership Group or the Offshore Partnership Group, as applicable, in connection with such efforts shall be promptly reimbursed by Teekay in advance of any determination of whether such insurance proceeds or other amounts will be recoverable.

ARTICLE VIII
MISCELLANEOUS

8.1 CHOICE OF LAW; SUBMISSION TO JURISDICTION. This Agreement shall be subject to and governed by the laws of the State of New York, excluding any conflicts-of-law rule or principle that might refer the construction or interpretation of this Agreement to the laws of another jurisdiction. Each party hereby submits to the jurisdiction of the state and federal courts located in the State of New York and to venue in New York, New York.

8.2 NOTICE. All notices or requests or consents provided for or permitted to be given pursuant to this Agreement must be in writing and must be given by depositing same in the mail,

AMENDED AND RESTATED OMNIBUS AGREEMENT

-22-

addressed to the Person to be notified, postpaid, and registered or certified with return receipt requested or by delivering such notice in person or by private-courier, prepaid, or by telecopier to such party. Notice given by personal delivery or mail shall be effective upon actual receipt. Couriered notices shall be deemed delivered on the date the courier represents that delivery will occur. Notice given by telecopier shall be effective upon actual receipt if received during the recipient's normal business hours, or at the beginning of the recipient's next business day after receipt if not received during the recipient's normal business hours. All notices to be sent to a party pursuant to this Agreement shall be sent to or made at the address set forth below such party's signature to this Agreement, or at such other address as such party may stipulate to the other parties in the manner provided in this Section.

8.3 ENTIRE AGREEMENT. This Agreement constitutes the entire agreement of the parties relating to the matters contained herein, superseding all prior contracts or agreements, whether oral or written, relating to the matters contained herein, including, without limitation, the Original Agreement.

8.4 TERMINATION. The provisions of Articles II, III, IV, V and VI of this Agreement (but not less than all of such Articles) may be terminated by (a) Teekay, with respect to all Teekay Entities, upon notice to the other Parties upon a Change of Control of Teekay, (b) Teekay LNG General Partner, with respect to the Teekay LNG Partnership Group, upon notice to the other Parties upon a Change of Control of Teekay LNG General Partner, and (c) Teekay Offshore General Partner, with respect to the Teekay Offshore Partnership Group, upon notice to the other Parties upon a Change of Control of Teekay Offshore General Partner.

8.5 WAIVER; EFFECT OF WAIVER OR CONSENT. Any party hereto may (a) extend the time for the performance of any obligation or other act of any other party hereto or (b) waive compliance with any agreement or condition contained herein. Except as otherwise specifically provided herein, any such extension or waiver shall be valid only if set forth in a written instrument duly executed by the party or parties to be bound thereby; provided, however, that (x) Teekay LNG MLP and Teekay LNG OLLC may not, without the prior approval of Teekay LNG General Partner's Conflicts Committee, agree to any extension or waiver of this Agreement that, in the reasonable discretion of Teekay LNG General Partner, will adversely affect the holders of common units of Teekay LNG MLP and (y) Teekay Offshore MLP, Teekay Offshore Operating General Partner and Teekay Offshore OLP may not, without the prior approval of Teekay Offshore General Partner's Conflicts Committee, agree to any extension or waiver of this Agreement that, in the reasonable discretion of Teekay Offshore General Partner, will adversely affect the holders of common units of Teekay Offshore MLP. No waiver or consent, express or implied, by any party of or to any breach or default by any Person in the performance by such Person of its obligations hereunder shall be deemed or construed to be a waiver or consent of or to any other breach or default in the performance by such Person of the same or any other obligations of such Person hereunder. Failure on the part of a party to complain of any act of any Person or to declare any Person in default, irrespective of how long such failure continues, shall

AMENDED AND RESTATED OMNIBUS AGREEMENT

-23-

not constitute a waiver by such party of its rights hereunder until the applicable statute of limitations period has run.

8.6 AMENDMENT OR MODIFICATION. This Agreement may be amended or modified from time to time only by the written agreement of all the parties hereto; provided, however, that (a) Teekay LNG MLP and Teekay LNG OLLC may not, without the prior approval of Teekay LNG General Partner's Conflicts Committee, agree to any amendment or modification of this Agreement that, in the reasonable discretion of Teekay LNG General Partner, will adversely affect the holders of common units of Teekay LNG MLP, and (b) Teekay Offshore MLP, Teekay Offshore Operating General Partner and Teekay Offshore OLP may not, without the prior approval of Teekay Offshore General Partner's Conflicts Committee, agree to any amendment or modification of this Agreement that, in the reasonable discretion of Teekay Offshore General Partner, will adversely affect the holders of common units of Teekay Offshore MLP.

8.7 ASSIGNMENT. No party shall have the right to assign its rights or obligations under this Agreement without the consent of the other parties hereto.

8.8 COUNTERPARTS. This Agreement may be executed in any number of counterparts with the same effect as if all signatory parties had signed the same document. All counterparts shall be construed together and shall constitute one and the same instrument.

8.9 SEVERABILITY. If any provision of this Agreement or the application thereof to any Person or circumstance shall be held invalid or unenforceable to any extent, the remainder of this Agreement and the application of such provision to other Persons or circumstances shall not be affected thereby and shall be enforced to the greatest extent permitted by law.

8.10 GENDER, PARTS, ARTICLES AND SECTIONS. Whenever the context requires, the gender of all words used in this Agreement shall include the masculine, feminine and neuter, and the number of all words shall include the singular and plural. All references to Article numbers and Section numbers refer to Articles and Sections of this Agreement.

8.11 FURTHER ASSURANCES. In connection with this Agreement and all transactions contemplated by this Agreement, each signatory party hereto agrees to execute and deliver such additional documents and instruments and to perform such additional acts as may be necessary or appropriate to effectuate, carry out and perform all of the terms, provisions and conditions of this Agreement and all such transactions.

8.12 WITHHOLDING OR GRANTING OF CONSENT. Each party may, with respect to any consent or approval that it is entitled to grant pursuant to this Agreement, grant or withhold such consent or approval in its sole and uncontrolled discretion, with or without cause, and subject to such conditions as it shall deem appropriate.

8.13 LAWS AND REGULATIONS. Notwithstanding any provision of this Agreement to the contrary, no party to this Agreement shall be required to take any act, or fail to take any act,

AMENDED AND RESTATED OMNIBUS AGREEMENT

-24-

under this Agreement if the effect thereof would be to cause such party to be in violation of any applicable law, statute, rule or regulation.

8.14 NEGOTIATION OF RIGHTS OF TEEKAY, LIMITED PARTNERS, ASSIGNEES, AND THIRD PARTIES. The provisions of this Agreement are enforceable solely by the parties to this Agreement, and no shareholder of Teekay and no limited partner, member, assignee or other Person of Teekay LNG MLP, Teekay LNG OLLC, Teekay Offshore MLP, Teekay Offshore Operating General Partner or Teekay Offshore OLP shall have the right, separate and apart from Teekay, Teekay LNG MLP, Teekay LNG OLLC, Teekay Offshore MLP, Teekay Offshore Operating General Partner or Teekay Offshore OLP, to enforce any provision of this Agreement or to compel any party to this Agreement to comply with the terms of this Agreement.

[SIGNATURE PAGE FOLLOWS]

AMENDED AND RESTATED OMNIBUS AGREEMENT

-25-

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Parties have executed this Amended and Restated Omnibus Agreement on, and effective as of, the Offshore Closing Date.

TEEKAY SHIPPING CORPORATION

By:

Name: Peter Evensen Title: Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer

Address for Notice:

Bayside House, Bayside Executive Park
West Bay Street and Blake Road
P.O. Box AP-59213
Nassau, Commonwealth of the Bahamas
Phone: (242) 502-8820

TEEKAY GP L.L.C.

By:

Name: Peter Evensen Title: Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer

Address for Notice:

Bayside House, Bayside Executive Park
West Bay Street and Blake Road
P.O. Box AP-59213
Nassau, Commonwealth of the Bahamas
Phone: (242) 502-8820

AMENDED AND RESTATED OMNIBUS AGREEMENT
SIGNATURE PAGE


TEEKAY LNG OPERATING L.L.C.

By: Teekay LNG Partners L.P.,
its sole member

By: Teekay GP L.L.C.,
its general partner

By:

Name: Peter Evensen Title: Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer

Address for Notice:

Bayside House, Bayside Executive Park
West Bay Street and Blake Road
P.O. Box AP-59213
Nassau, Commonwealth of the Bahamas
Phone: (242) 502-8820

TEEKAY LNG PARTNERS L.P.

By: Teekay GP L.L.C., its general partner

By:

Name: Peter Evensen Title: Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer

Address for Notice:

Bayside House, Bayside Executive Park
West Bay Street and Blake Road
P.O. Box AP-59213
Nassau, Commonwealth of the Bahamas
Phone: (242) 502-8820

AMENDED AND RESTATED OMNIBUS AGREEMENT
SIGNATURE PAGE


TEEKAY OFFSHORE GP L.L.C.

By:

Name: Peter Evensen Title: Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer

Address for Notice:

Bayside House, Bayside Executive Park
West Bay Street and Blake Road
P.O. Box AP-59213
Nassau, Commonwealth of the Bahamas
Phone: (242) 502-8820

TEEKAY OFFSHORE OPERATING GP L.L.C.

By: Teekay Offshore Partners L.P.,
its sole member

By: Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C.,
its general partner

By:

Name: Peter Evensen Title: Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer

Address for Notice:

Bayside House, Bayside Executive Park
West Bay Street and Blake Road
P.O. Box AP-59213
Nassau, Commonwealth of the Bahamas
Phone: (242) 502-8820

AMENDED AND RESTATED OMNIBUS AGREEMENT
SIGNATURE PAGE


TEEKAY OFFSHORE OPERATING L.P.

By: Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C.,
its general partner

By: Teekay Offshore Partners L.P.,
its sole member

By: Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C.,
its general partner

By:

Name: Peter Evensen Title: Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer

Address for Notice:

Bayside House, Bayside Executive Park
West Bay Street and Blake Road
P.O. Box AP-59213
Nassau, Commonwealth of the Bahamas
Phone: (242) 502-8820

TEEKAY OFFSHORE PARTNERS L.P.

By: Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C.,
its general partner

By:

Name: Peter Evensen Title: Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer

Address for Notice:

Bayside House, Bayside Executive Park
West Bay Street and Blake Road
P.O. Box AP-59213
Nassau, Commonwealth of the Bahamas
Phone: (242) 502-8820

AMENDED AND RESTATED OMNIBUS AGREEMENT
SIGNATURE PAGE


Exhibit 10.6

FURTHER AMENDED AND RESTATED LOAN FACILITY AGREEMENT

DATED: 26 JUNE 2003

BETWEEN:-

(1) NORSK TEEKAY HOLDINGS LTD which is a company incorporated according to the law of the Marshall Islands with its registered office at c/o Trust Company Complex, Ajeltake Road, Ajeltake Island, Majuro, Marshall Islands MH-96960 and its principal place of business at Bayside House, Bayside Executive Park West Bay Street & Blake Road, Nassau, The Bahamas ("THE BORROWER"); and

(2) the banks and financial institutions listed in Schedule 1, each acting through its office at the address indicated against its name in Schedule 1 (together "THE BANKS" and each a "BANK"); and

(3) DNB NOR BANK ASA, acting as facility agent and security trustee (in that capacity "THE AGENT"); and

(4) CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED, DNB NOR BANK ASA and NORDEA BANK FINLAND PLC, NEW YORK BRANCH each acting as a mandated lead arranger through its office and at the address indicated against its name in Schedule 7 (together "THE ARRANGERS" and each "AN ARRANGER"); and

(5) CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED and DNB NOR BANK ASA each acting as a joint book runner through its office and at the address indicated against its name in Schedule 7 (together "THE BOOK RUNNERS").

WHEREAS:-

Each of the Banks has agreed to advance to the Borrower its respective Commitment of an aggregate principal amount not exceeding four hundred and fifty five million Dollars ($455,000,000) in respect of an initial secured reducing facility of five hundred and fifty million Dollars ($550,000,000) which originally assisted the Borrower in refinancing the Bridge Facility and all other sums due and payable under or pursuant to the Bridge Facility Agreement and is now for the Borrower's other general corporate purposes.

IT IS AGREED as follows:-


1 DEFINITIONS AND INTERPRETATION

1.1 DEFINITIONS

In this Agreement:-

1.1.1 "THE ADDRESS FOR SERVICE" means c/o Teekay Shipping (UK) Ltd of 2nd Floor, 86 Jermyn Street, London SW1Y 6JD, England or, in relation to any of the Security Parties, such other address in England and Wales as that Security Party may from time to time designate by no fewer than ten Business Days' written notice to the Agent.

1.1.2 the "ADVANCE DATE", in relation to any Drawing, means the date on which that Drawing is advanced by the Banks to the Borrower pursuant to Clause 2.

1.1.3 "APPROVED BROKERS" means H. Clarkson & Co. Ltd, Simpson Spence & Young Shipbrokers Ltd, Fearnley AS, R. S. Platou AS and P. Bassoe AS.

1.1.4 "ASSIGNMENT" means the deed of assignment of Intercompany Indebtedness referred to in Clause 8.1.1.

1.1.5 "BAREBOAT CHARTERER" means TNOL in its capacity as bareboat charterer of the TNOL Vessels and/or any other bareboat charterer of the Vessels who is acceptable to the Majority Banks.

1.1.6 "THE BORROWER'S OBLIGATIONS" means all of the liabilities and obligations of the Borrower to the Finance Parties under or pursuant to the Borrower's Security Documents, whether actual or contingent, present or future, and whether incurred alone or jointly or jointly and severally with any other and in whatever currency, including (without limitation) interest, commission and all other charges and expenses.

1.1.7 "THE BORROWER'S SECURITY DOCUMENTS" means those of the Security Documents to which the Borrower is or is to be a party.

1.1.8 "BREAK COSTS" means all documented costs, losses, premiums or penalties incurred by any of the Finance Parties in the circumstances contemplated by Clause 17.4 or as a result of any of them receiving any

2

prepayment of all or any part of the Facility (whether pursuant to Clause 5.2 or otherwise) or any other payment under or in relation to the Security Documents on a day other than the due date for payment of the sum in question, and includes (without limitation) any losses or costs incurred in liquidating or re-employing deposits from third parties acquired to effect or maintain the Facility, and any liabilities, expenses or losses incurred by any of the Finance Parties in terminating or reversing, or otherwise in connection with, any interest rate and/or currency swap, transaction or arrangement entered into by any of the Finance Parties to hedge any exposure arising under this Agreement, or in terminating or reversing, or otherwise in connection with, any open position arising under this Agreement.

1.1.9 "BRIDGE FACILITY" means the five hundred million Dollar ($500,000,000) short term facility made available by the Bridge Lenders to the Borrower pursuant to the Bridge Facility Agreement.

1.1.10 "BRIDGE FACILITY AGREEMENT" means the USD500,000,000 Revolving Credit Facility Agreement dated 27 March 2003 made between the Borrower as borrower, the Bridge Lenders, and the Agent as agent on behalf of the Bridge Lenders pursuant to which the Bridge Lenders made the Bridge Facility available to the Borrower subject to and upon the terms and conditions contained therein

1.1.11 "BRIDGE LENDERS" means the banks listed in Exhibit 1 of the Bridge Facility Agreement.

1.1.12 "BUSINESS DAY" means a day on which banks are open for the transaction of business of the nature contemplated by this Agreement (and not authorised by law to close) in New York City, United States of America; London, England; Oslo, Norway; and any other financial centre which the Agent may consider appropriate for the operation of the provisions of this Agreement.

1.1.13 "CHANGE OF CONTROL" means that TSC and the Guarantor between them shall cease, for any reason whatsoever, to own or control directly or indirectly, all of the shares of Navion, NOL and/or TNOL.

3

1.1.14 "COMMISSION RATE" means thirty two point five per cent (32.5%) of the Margin, per annum.

1.1.15 "COMMITMENT" means, in relation to each Bank, the amount of the Facility which that Bank agrees to advance to the Borrower as its several liability as indicated against the name of that Bank in Schedule 1, as reduced from time to time in accordance with Clause 2.4, or, where the context permits, the amount of the Facility advanced by that Bank and remaining outstanding.

1.1.16 "COMMITMENT COMMISSION" means the commitment commission to be paid by the Borrower to the Agent on behalf of the Banks pursuant to Clause 7.2.

1.1.17 "COMMITMENT TERMINATION DATE" means the date falling one month prior to the Termination Date.

1.1.18 a "COMMUNICATION" means any notice, approval, demand, request or other communication from one party to this Agreement to any other party to this Agreement.

1.1.19 "THE COMMUNICATIONS ADDRESS" means c/o Teekay Shipping (Canada) Ltd, Suite 2000, Bentall 5, 550 Burrard Street, Vancouver, B.C., Canada V6C 2K2, fax no: +604 681 3011 marked for the attention of Director, Finance.

1.1.20 "COVENANTING GROUP" means the Borrower and its Subsidiaries,
NOL and TNOL.

1.1.21 "CURRENCY OF ACCOUNT" means, in relation to any payment to be made to a Finance Party pursuant to any of the Security Documents, the currency in which that payment is required to be made by the terms of the relevant Security Document.

1.1.22 "DEFAULT RATE" means the rate which is the aggregate of (i) two per centum (2%) per annum (ii) the Margin (iii) LIBOR and (iv) the Mandatory Cost.

4

1.1.23 "DOLLARS" and "$" each means available and freely transferable and convertible funds in lawful currency of the United States of America.

1.1.24 "DRAWDOWN NOTICE" means a notice complying with Clause 2.3.

1.1.25 "DRAWING" means a part (or, if requested and available, all) of the Facility advanced by the Banks to the Borrower in accordance with Clause 2.

1.1.26 "EARNINGS", in relation to a Vessel, means all hires including (without limitation) all time charter hire and bareboat charter hire, freights, pool income and other sums payable to or for the account of the Owner or Bareboat Charterer in respect of that Vessel including (without limitation) all remuneration for salvage and towage services, demurrage and detention moneys, contributions in general average, compensation in respect of any requisition for hire and damages and other payments (whether awarded by any court or arbitral tribunal or by agreement or otherwise) for breach, termination or variation of any contract for the operation, employment or use of that Vessel.

1.1.27 "ENCUMBRANCE" means any mortgage, charge, pledge, lien, assignment, hypothecation, preferential right, option, title retention or trust arrangement or any other agreement or arrangement which, in any of the aforementioned instances, has the effect of creating security.

1.1.28 "EVENT OF DEFAULT" means any of the events set out in Clause 12.2.

1.1.29 "EXECUTION DATE" means the date on which this Agreement is executed by each of the parties hereto.

1.1.30 "FACILITY" means the reducing revolving credit facility made available by the Banks to the Borrower pursuant to this Agreement.

1.1.31 "THE FACILITY OUTSTANDINGS" at any time means the total of all Drawings made at that time, to the extent not reduced by repayments, prepayments and voluntary reductions.

1.1.32 "THE FACILITY PERIOD" means the period beginning on the Execution Date and ending on the date when the whole of the Indebtedness has

5

been repaid in full and the Borrower has ceased to be under any further actual or contingent liability to the Finance Parties under or in connection with the Security Documents.

1.1.33 "THE FEE LETTERS" means the letters from the Agent, the Arrangers and the Book Runners as agreed and accepted by the Borrower and/or the Guarantor setting out certain fees, commissions and other sums payable by the Borrower and/or the Guarantor in connection with the Facility.

1.1.34 "THE FINANCE PARTIES" means the Banks, the Agent, the Arrangers and the Book Runners.

1.1.35 "FIRST QUALIFYING SECURITY ASSIGNMENT" means the deed of assignment of the First Qualifying Security Documents dated 30 September 2004 executed by (inter alios) the Borrower, NOL and the Intercompany Agent in favour of the Agent.

1.1.36 "FIRST QUALIFYING SECURITY DOCUMENTS" means the NOL Guarantee and the Mortgages.

1.1.37 "FIRST REDUCTION DATE" means the earlier to occur of (i) six months after the first Advance Date to occur after 30 September 2006 and (ii) 30 April 2007.

1.1.38 "FREE LIQUIDITY", means cash, cash equivalents and marketable securities of maturities less than one (1) year to which the Guarantor Group shall have free, immediate and direct access each as reflected in the Guarantor's most recent quarterly management accounts forming part of the Guarantor's Accounts.

1.1.39 "GAAP" means the generally accepted accounting principles in the United States of America.

1.1.40 "THE GUARANTEE" means the guarantee and indemnity of the Guarantor in respect of the Borrower's Obligations referred to in Clause 8.2.3.

1.1.41 "GUARANTOR GROUP" means the Guarantor and each of its Subsidiaries (including but not limited to the Borrower).

6

1.1.42 "GUARANTOR" means Teekay Offshore Operating L.P., a limited partnership formed under the laws of the Marshall Islands and with its registered office at Trust Company Complex, Ajeltake Island, PO Box 1405, Majuro, Marshall Islands MH-196960.

1.1.43 "GUARANTOR'S ACCOUNTS" means either the annual consolidated financial statements of the Guarantor prepared in accordance with GAAP comprising a profit and loss account, balance sheet and cash flow statement and audited by Ernst & Young or such other first class firm of accountants as may be acceptable to the Agent or (as the context may require) the quarterly consolidated financial statements of the Guarantor which shall be unaudited but shall also be prepared in accordance with GAAP.

1.1.44 "THE INDEBTEDNESS" means the Facility Outstandings; all other sums of any nature including costs (together with all interest on any of those sums) which from time to time may be payable by the Borrower to the Finance Parties pursuant to the Security Documents; any damages payable as a result of any breach by the Borrower of any of the Security Documents; and any damages or other sums payable as a result of any of the obligations of the Borrower under or pursuant to any of the Security Documents being disclaimed by a liquidator or any other person, or, where the context permits, the amount thereof for the time being outstanding.

1.1.45 "INSURANCES", in relation to a Vessel, means all policies and contracts of insurance (including but not limited to hull and machinery, all entries in protection and indemnity or war risks associations) which are from time to time taken out or entered into in respect of or in connection with that Vessel or her increased value and (where the context permits) all benefits thereof, including all claims of any nature and returns of premium.

1.1.46 "INTERCOMPANY AGENT" means DnB NOR Bank ASA in its capacity as agent under the Intercompany Loan Agreement.

7

1.1.47 "INTERCOMPANY BORROWER" means Norsk Teekay AS being a company incorporated according to the laws of Norway with Enterprise No. 985 030 235.

1.1.48 "INTERCOMPANY INDEBTEDNESS" means that portion of the Facility on lent by the Borrower to the Intercompany Borrower upon the terms and conditions of the Intercompany Loan Agreement.

1.1.49 "INTERCOMPANY LOAN AGREEMENT" means the agreement dated 26 June 2003 as amended and restated by an agreement dated 30 September 2004 and as further amended and restated by an agreement dated 5 October 2006 each made between the Borrower as lender, the Intercompany Borrower and the Intercompany Agent under which the Borrower has lent the Intercompany Indebtedness to the Intercompany Borrower.

1.1.50 "INTEREST PAYMENT DATE" means each date for the payment of interest in accordance with Clause 6.

1.1.51 "INTEREST PERIOD" means each interest period selected by the Borrower or agreed by the Agent pursuant to Clause 6.

1.1.52 "LAW" means any law, statute, treaty, convention, regulation, instrument or other subordinate legislation or other legislative or quasi-legislative rule or measure, or any order or decree of any government, judicial or public or other body or authority, or any directive, code of practice, circular, guidance note or other direction issued by any competent authority or agency (whether or not having the force of law).

1.1.53 "LIBOR" means the rate, rounded to the nearest four decimal places downwards (if the digit displayed in the fifth decimal place is 1,2,3 or 4) or upwards (if the digit displayed in the fifth decimal place is 5,6,7,8 or 9) displayed on Reuters page LIBOR 01 (or such other page or pages which replace(s) such page for the purposes of displaying offered rates of leading banks, for deposits in Dollars of amounts equal to the amount of the relevant Drawing for a period equal in length to the relevant Interest Period or if there is no such display rate then available for Dollars for an amount comparable to the Drawing, the arithmetic mean

8

(rounded upwards, if necessary, to the nearest whole multiple of one-sixteenth per centum (1/16%)) of the respective rates notified to the Agent by each of the Reference Banks as the rate at which it is offered deposits in Dollars and for the required period by prime banks in the London Interbank Market.

1.1.54 "MAJORITY BANKS" means any one or more Banks whose combined Proportionate Shares exceed sixty six and two thirds per centum (66 2/3%).

1.1.55 "MANDATORY COST" means for each Bank to which it applies, the cost imputed to that Bank of compliance with the mandatory liquid asset requirements of the Bank of England and/or the banking supervision or other costs imposed by the Financial Services Authority, determined in accordance with Schedule 6 (CALCULATION OF THE MANDATORY COST).

1.1.56 "MARGIN" means nought point six two five (0.625) per cent per annum.

1.1.57 "MATERIAL SUBSIDIARY" means:

any Subsidiary of the Guarantor whose assets, as determined in accordance with GAAP and as shown from the most recent financial statements available to the Agent relating to it, as multiplied by the Relevant Percentage in respect of such Subsidiary, equal or exceed 10% of the aggregate value of the assets of the Guarantor Group as determined in accordance with GAAP and as shown from the most recently available financial statements of the Guarantor Group,

provided that:

(i) in respect of any Subsidiary of the Guarantor, only the value of its assets as multiplied by the Relevant Percentage in respect of such Subsidiary shall be taken into account in the computation of the value of the assets of the Guarantor Group; and

(ii) a statement by the auditors of the Guarantor to the effect that, in their opinion, a Subsidiary of the Guarantor is or is not or was or was not at any particular time a Material Subsidiary shall, in the

9

absence of manifest error, be conclusive and binding on each of the parties to this Agreement.

1.1.58 "THE MAXIMUM FACILITY AMOUNT" means the amount of the aggregate Commitments (stated in Dollars) subject to any reductions effected in accordance with Clauses 2.4, 15.7 and 15.8.

1.1.59 "MORTGAGES" means the first priority statutory ship mortgages over the Vessels each dated 30 September 2004 together with deeds of covenants collateral thereto made between NOL and the Borrower or NOL, the Borrower and the Intercompany Agent, as the case may be.

1.1.60 "NAVION" means Teekay Norway AS (formerly known as Navion ASA with Enterprise No. 979199325) of Verven 4, N-4014 Stavanger, Norway.

1.1.61 "NAVION GROUP" means the Borrower, TNOL, the Intercompany Borrower, Navion and Navion's Subsidiaries.

1.1.62 "NOL" means Navion Offshore Loading AS being a company incorporated according to the laws of Norway with Enterprise No. 984 837 771.

1.1.63 "NOL GUARANTEE" means the guarantee and indemnity dated 30 September 2004 executed by NOL in favour of the Intercompany Agent.

1.1.64 "OWNER" means NOL and/or any other owner of a Vessel which is acceptable to the Majority Banks and which secures all or any part of the Indebtedness.

1.1.65 "PERMITTED LIENS" means (i) any Encumbrance which has the prior written approval of the Agent acting upon the instructions of all the Banks or (ii) any Encumbrance arising either by operation of law or in the ordinary course of the business of the relevant Security Party which is discharged in the ordinary course of business or (iii) any Encumbrance over assets acquired subject to that Encumbrance, provided the Encumbrance is discharged within three (3) months of the date of acquisition of the asset.

10

1.1.66 "POTENTIAL EVENT OF DEFAULT" means any event which, with the giving of notice and/or the passage of time and/or the satisfaction of any materiality test, would constitute an Event of Default.

1.1.67 "PRO RATA INSURANCE PROCEEDS AMOUNT" means, in respect of each Vessel, a figure equal to (x) a fraction in which (i) the numerator is the amount of the insurance proceeds payable in respect of such Vessel in the event of a Total Loss and (ii) the denominator is the aggregate market value of all the Vessels (based on the Valuations) multiplied by (y) the Maximum Facility Amount.

1.1.68 "PROCEEDINGS" means any suit, action or proceedings begun by any of the Finance Parties arising out of or in connection with the Security Documents.

1.1.69 "PROPORTIONATE SHARE" means, for each Bank, the percentage indicated against the name of that Bank in Schedule 1, as amended by any Transfer Certificate executed from time to time.

1.1.70 "QUALIFYING SECURITY" means together the First Qualifying Security Documents and any other security granted in respect of the Intercompany Indebtedness which is assigned to the Agent as security for the Indebtedness.

1.1.71 "QUALIFYING SECURITY PARTIES" means any party who grants Qualifying Security.

1.1.72 "REFERENCE BANKS" means DnB Nor Bank ASA, Citibank N.A. and Nordea Bank Norge ASA.

1.1.73 "RELEVANT PERCENTAGE" means, in respect of any Subsidiary of the Guarantor at any time, the percentage of the equity share capital or the partnership capital, as the case may be, of such Subsidiary which is beneficially owned (free from Encumbrances) by the Guarantor at such time.

1.1.74 "REQUISITION COMPENSATION", in relation to a Vessel, means all compensation or other money which may from time to time be payable to an Owner and/or a Bareboat Charterer as a result of that Vessel being

11

requisitioned for title or in any other way compulsorily acquired (other than by way of requisition for hire).

1.1.75 "THE SECURITY DOCUMENTS" means this Agreement, the Shares Charge, the Assignment, the First Qualifying Security Assignment, the Guarantee, the TNOL Assignment and Subordination Agreements, or (where the context permits) any one or more of them, and any other agreement or document which may at any time be executed as security for the payment of all or any part of the Indebtedness.

1.1.76 "SECURITY PARTIES" means, at any relevant time, the Borrower, the Intercompany Borrower, the Guarantor, TNOL, NOL and any other party who may at any time during the Facility Period be liable for, or provide security for, all or any part of the Indebtedness, and "SECURITY PARTY" means any one of them.

1.1.77 "SHARES CHARGE" means the assignment of the charge over the issued share capital of Navion referred to in Clause 8.1.2.

1.1.78 "SUBSEQUENT REDUCTION DATES" means each date falling at consecutive six monthly intervals after the previous Subsequent Reduction Date which in the case of the first Subsequent Reduction Date shall be six months after the First Reduction Date.

1.1.79 "SUBORDINATED DEBT" means (based on the Borrower's Accounts) any inter-company loan (including interest thereon) which has a term beyond the Termination Date and which shall be treated as equity in Navion for financial covenant test purposes.

1.1.80 "SUBSIDIARY" means a subsidiary undertaking, as defined in section 736 Companies Act 1985 or any analogous definition under any other relevant system of law.

1.1.81 "TAXES" means all taxes, levies, imposts, duties, charges, fees, deductions and withholdings (including any related interest and penalties) and any restrictions or conditions resulting in any charge, other than taxes on the overall net income of a Finance Party or branch thereof, and "TAX" and "TAXATION" shall be interpreted accordingly.

12

1.1.82 "THE TERMINATION DATE" means 31 October 2014.

1.1.83 "TKO" means Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. a master limited partnership formed or to be formed according to the laws of The Marshall Islands and to be publicly listed.

1.1.84 "TNOL" means Teekay Navion Offshore Loading PTE Ltd being a company incorporated according to the laws of Singapore.

1.1.85 "TNOL ASSIGNMENT AND SUBORDINATION AGREEMENTS" means the deeds of assignment of Insurances and Earnings and subordination of rights in relation to the TNOL Vessels each dated 28 January 2005 and made between TNOL, NOL and the Agent.

1.1.86 "TNOL BAREBOAT CHARTERS" means the bareboat charterparties dated 28 January 2005 and entered into between NOL as owner and TNOL as Bareboat Charterer in respect of the TNOL Vessels.

1.1.87 "TNOL VESSELS" means the Vessels listed in Schedule 3.

1.1.88 "TOTAL DEBT" means the aggregate of:-

(a) the amount calculated in accordance with GAAP shown as each of "long term debt", "short term debt" and "current portion of long term debt" on the latest consolidated balance sheet of the Guarantor; and

(b) the amount of any liability in respect of any lease or hire purchase contract entered into by the Guarantor or any of its Subsidiaries which would, in accordance with GAAP, be treated as a finance or capital lease (excluding any amounts applicable to leases to the extent that the lease obligations are secured by a security deposit which is held on the balance sheet under "RESTRICTED CASH").

1.1.89 "TOTAL LOSS", in relation to a Vessel means:-

(a) an actual, constructive, arranged, agreed or compromised total loss of that Vessel; or

13

(b) the requisition for title, compulsory acquisition, nationalisation or expropriation of that Vessel by or on behalf of any government or other authority (other than by way of requisition for hire); or

(c) the capture, seizure, arrest, detention or confiscation of that Vessel, unless the Vessel is released and returned to the possession of its Owner or Bareboat Charterer (as the case may be) within two months after the capture, seizure, arrest, detention or confiscation in question.

1.1.90 "TRANSACTION DOCUMENTS" means together the Intercompany Loan Agreement, the Security Documents, the Qualifying Security and the TNOL Bareboat Charters.

1.1.91 "TRANSFER CERTIFICATE" means a certificate materially in the form set forth in Schedule 4 signed by a Bank and a Transferee whereby:-

(a) such Bank seeks to procure the transfer to such Transferee of all or a part of such Bank's rights and obligations under this Agreement upon and subject to the terms and conditions set out in Clause 14; and

(b) such Transferee undertakes to perform the obligations it will assume as a result of delivery of such certificate to the Agent as is contemplated in Clause 14.

1.1.92 "TRANSFER DATE" means, in relation to any Transfer Certificate, the date for the making of the transfer specified in the schedule to such Transfer Certificate.

1.1.93 "TRANSFEREE" means a bank or other financial institution to which a Bank seeks to transfer all or part of such Bank's rights and obligations under this Agreement.

1.1.94 "THE TRUST PROPERTY" means:-

(a) the benefit of Clause 8 and the covenants contained in Clause 9.3; and

14

(b) all benefits arising under (including, without limitation, all proceeds of the enforcement of) each of the Security Documents (other than this Agreement), with the exception of any benefits arising solely for the benefit of the Agent).

1.1.95 "TSC" means Teekay Shipping Corporation being a corporation incorporated according to the laws of the Marshall Islands.

1.1.96 "VALUATION" means in relation to a Vessel, the arithmetic mean of the written valuations of that Vessel expressed in Dollars prepared by two of the Approved Brokers (or such other firms of reputable independent shipbrokers as may be acceptable to the Majority Banks), one appointed by the Agent and the other appointed by the Borrower, unless either the Agent or the Borrower disagrees with such arithmetic average, in which event the two shipbrokers shall appoint a third firm of Approved Brokers (or such other firm of reputable independent shipbrokers as may be acceptable to the Majority Banks) and the valuation of the Vessel shall be the arithmetic mean of all three such valuations. Such valuations shall be prepared at the Borrower's expense, without a physical inspection, on the basis of a sale for prompt delivery for cash at arm's length between a willing buyer and a willing seller without the benefit of any charterparty or other engagement.

1.1.97 "THE VESSELS" means the vessels listed in Schedule 2, and any other vessel which is used as security for the Indebtedness and everything now or in the future belonging to them on board and ashore (each a "VESSEL").

1.2 INTERPRETATION

In this Agreement:-

1.2.1 words denoting the plural number include the singular and vice versa;

1.2.2 words denoting persons include corporations, partnerships, associations of persons (whether incorporated or not) or governmental or quasi-governmental bodies or authorities and vice versa;

15

1.2.3 references to Recitals, Clauses, Schedules and Appendices are references to recitals and clauses of, and schedules and appendices to, this Agreement;

1.2.4 references to this Agreement include the Recitals, the Schedules and the Appendices;

1.2.5 the headings and contents page(s) are for the purpose of reference only, have no legal or other significance, and shall be ignored in the interpretation of this Agreement;

1.2.6 references to any document (including, without limitation, to all or any of the Transaction Documents) are, unless the context otherwise requires, references to that document as amended, supplemented, novated, reconfirmed, amended and restated or replaced from time to time;

1.2.7 references to statutes or provisions of statutes are references to those statutes, or those provisions, as from time to time amended, replaced or re-enacted;

1.2.8 references to any of the Finance Parties include its successors, transferees and assignees; and

1.2.9 references to times of day are to Oslo time.

2 THE FACILITY AND ITS PURPOSE

2.1 AGREEMENT TO LEND Subject to the terms and conditions of this Agreement, and in reliance on each of the representations and warranties made or to be made in or in accordance with each of the Security Documents, each of the Banks agrees to advance to the Borrower its Commitment of an aggregate principal amount not exceeding the Maximum Facility Amount to be used by the Borrower for the purposes referred to in the Recital.

2.2 DRAWINGS Subject to satisfaction by the Borrower of the conditions set out in Clause 3.1 (in respect of the first Drawing), Clause 3.3 (in respect of all subsequent Drawings), and subject to Clause 2.3, and provided that the maximum aggregate amount of the Facility Outstandings at any given time during the Facility Period shall not exceed the Maximum Facility Amount, each Drawing

16

shall be advanced to the Borrower, in each case by the Agent transferring the amount of the Drawing to such account of the Borrower as the Borrower shall notify to the Agent in the relevant Drawdown Notice by such same day method of funds transfer as the Agent shall select.

2.3 ADVANCE OF DRAWINGS Each Drawing shall be advanced in Dollars. Each Drawing shall be advanced on a Business Day, provided that the Borrower shall have given to the Agent not more than ten and not fewer than four Business Days' notice in writing materially in the form set out in Schedule 5 of the required Advance Date of the Drawing in question and provided that the requested Drawing would not cause a breach of Clause 2.5. Each Drawdown Notice once given shall be irrevocable and shall constitute a warranty by the Borrower that:-

2.3.1 all conditions precedent to the advance of the Drawing requested in that Drawdown Notice will have been satisfied on or before the Advance Date requested;

2.3.2 no Event of Default or Potential Event of Default has occurred or will then have occurred; and

2.3.3 no Event of Default or Potential Event of Default will result from the advance of the Drawing in question.

The Agent shall promptly notify each Bank of the receipt of each Drawdown Notice, following which each Bank will make its Proportionate Share of the amount of the requested Drawing available to the Borrower through the Agent on the Advance Date requested.

2.4 FACILITY REDUCTION

2.4.1 The amount of the Facility available to the Borrower for drawing under this Agreement shall be four hundred and fifty five million Dollars ($455,000,000) (reduced from the initial Facility of five hundred and fifty million Dollars $550,000,000) which shall be available for drawing from 5 October 2006 until the First Reduction Date. On the First Reduction Date and on each of the fifteen Subsequent Reduction Dates the amount of the Facility available for drawing shall be reduced in accordance with the schedule of reductions set forth in Schedule 8. In the event of a Change of Control the amount of the Facility available for drawing shall

17

be reduced to zero and any outstanding Drawings shall be immediately repayable. On the Termination Date the Facility available shall be reduced to zero. The mandatory reductions in the amount of the Facility available for drawing required pursuant to this Clause will be made in the amounts and at the times specified whether or not the Maximum Facility Amount is reduced pursuant to Clause 2.4.3, Clause 2.4.4, Clause 2.4.5, Clause 5.2, Clause 15.7 or Clause 15.8. Any mandatory reductions pursuant to Clause 2.4.3 (sale) or Clause 2.4.4 (Total Loss) shall be applied to the remaining mandatory reductions hereunder on a pro rata basis.

2.4.2 The Borrower may voluntarily cancel the Maximum Facility Amount in whole or in part in integral multiples of five million Dollars ($5,000,000), provided that it has first given to the Agent not fewer than five (5) Business Days' prior written notice expiring on a Business Day of its desire to reduce the Maximum Facility Amount. Any such reduction in the Maximum Facility Amount shall not be reversed. Any voluntary reduction in the Maximum Facility Amount pursuant to this Clause shall be applied to the remaining mandatory reductions under Clause 2.4.1 on a pro rata basis.

2.4.3 In the event of a sale or disposal of a Vessel or the sale or disposal of any other asset owned by any member of the Navion Group as at the date hereof or which is the subject of Qualifying Security and where the net sales proceeds of such sales of other assets in any twelve (12) month period exceeds five million Dollars ($5,000,000) (or the equivalent in any other currency), the Maximum Facility Amount shall be reduced on the date of receipt of such proceeds by the amount of such net sale or disposal proceeds (which in the case of a Vessel must be proceeds received from a commercial sale or disposal at arms length for full consideration) (the "NET PROCEEDS") unless either:-

(i) the Vessel or asset in question remains owned by a member of the Navion Group; or

(ii) the Vessel or asset in question is replaced within one hundred and twenty (120) days of the sale with a similar vessel or asset being

18

in all respects acceptable to all of the Finance Parties in their absolute discretion,

and in either case any security held by the Agent (whether directly or indirectly) over such Vessel or asset is reconstituted immediately after the sale to the new owner or over the replacement asset (as the case may be) in substantially identical form, and the Agent obtains favourable legal opinions in respect of such reconstituted security. For any period commencing on the date of the sale or disposal of a Vessel or other relevant asset and ending on the earlier of (a) the date falling one hundred and twenty (120) days thereafter and (b) the date on which a replacement Vessel or asset is acquired in accordance with the provisions of this Clause, then, at the Borrower's option, either:-

(a) the Net Proceeds shall be placed in such account as the Agent may reasonably specify and the Borrower shall execute and deliver or cause to be executed and delivered (as the case may be) a first priority charge over the Net Proceeds in favour of the Agent on behalf of the Finance Parties or, if applicable, in favour of the Intercompany Agent who will assign such charge to the Agent, in each case in such form as the Agent may reasonably specify and the Net Proceeds and the said deed of charge would (subject to no Event of Default or Potential Event of Default then being in existence) be released at the end of such period; or

(b) a part of the Maximum Facility Amount equivalent to the Net Proceeds (the "UNAVAILABLE PORTION") shall be unavailable for drawing. If the aggregate Drawings then advanced exceed the Maximum Facility Amount less the Unavailable Portion, the Borrower shall promptly make such prepayment as may be required to ensure that the aggregate Drawings then advanced are equal to or less than the Maximum Facility Amount less the Unavailable Portion. For the avoidance of doubt, Commitment Commission shall continue to accrue on the Unavailable Portion for such period.

19

2.4.4 In the event that any Vessel becomes a Total Loss, on the earlier to occur of (a) the date of receipt of the proceeds of the Total Loss and (b) the date falling one hundred and eighty
(180) days after the occurrence of the Total Loss (the "REDUCTION DATE"), the Maximum Facility Amount shall (subject to the proviso hereto) reduce by the Pro Rata Insurance Proceeds Amount in respect of such Vessel. Any such reductions in the Maximum Facility Amount shall not be reversed. If, as a result of any reduction in the Maximum Facility Amount pursuant to this Clause the Facility Outstandings exceed the Maximum Facility Amount, the Borrower shall, on the earlier to occur of (a) the one hundred and eightieth day after the date of such Total Loss occurring and
(b) the date on which the relevant Owner or the Bareboat Charterer (as the case may be) receives the proceeds of such Total Loss, prepay such amount of the Facility Outstandings as will ensure that the Facility Outstandings are not greater than the Maximum Facility Amount. Any such prepayment shall not be reborrowed and Clause 5.3 shall apply to any such prepayment. PROVIDED ALWAYS that if there is an investment in a substitute vessel acceptable to all of the Banks within one hundred and twenty (120) days of the Reduction Date, and security over such substitute vessel acceptable to all of the Banks is also executed and delivered within one hundred and twenty (120) days of the Reduction Date, then the reduction in the Maximum Facility Amount shall not apply.

2.4.5 If at any time during the Facility Period TSC ceases to own a minimum of fifty one per cent (51%) of the voting rights of Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C, the general partner of TKO which will, following the public listing of, and offering for TKO, own a minimum of fifty one per cent (51%) of the voting rights of Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C, the Maximum Facility Amount shall be immediately reduced to zero and the Borrower shall immediately prepay the Indebtedness. The provisions of Clause 5.3 shall apply to any prepayment made under or pursuant to this Clause. Any reduction in the Maximum Facility Amount pursuant to this Clause shall be permanent and non reversible.

2.4.6 To the extent that repayments or prepayments made by the Borrower to the Agent in accordance with this Agreement reduce the Facility Outstandings to less than the Maximum Facility Amount, the Borrower

20

shall again be entitled to make Drawings up to the Commitment Termination Date in accordance with and subject to the terms of this Agreement. Any part of the Facility which is undrawn on the Commitment Termination Date shall be automatically cancelled.

2.4.7 Simultaneously with each reduction of the Maximum Facility Amount in accordance with Clause 2.4.1, Clause 2.4.2, Clause 2.4.3, Clause 2.4.4 or Clause 2.4.5 (as the case may be), the Commitment of each Bank will reduce so that the Commitments of the Banks in respect of the reduced Maximum Facility Amount remain in accordance with their respective Proportionate Shares.

2.5 RESTRICTIONS ON DRAWINGS The Borrower shall not be entitled to make more than one Drawing on any Business Day and no more than seven (7) Drawings may be outstanding at any one time during the Facility Period. Each Drawing shall be of an amount of not less than ten million Dollars ($10,000,000) and in integral multiples of five million Dollars ($5,000,000) or the undrawn balance of the Facility. If at any time during the Facility Period the Facility Outstandings exceed the Maximum Facility Amount then available or if a proposed Drawing added to the Facility Outstandings would result in the Maximum Facility Amount being exceeded then the Borrower shall immediately pay to the Agent on behalf of the Banks such amounts as will ensure that the Facility Outstandings are equal to or less than the Maximum Facility Amount then available.

2.6 TERMINATION DATE No Bank shall be under any obligation to advance all or any part of its Commitment after the Commitment Termination Date.

2.7 SEVERAL OBLIGATIONS The obligations of the Banks under this Agreement are several. The failure of a Bank to perform its obligations under this Agreement shall not affect the obligations of the Borrower to any Finance Party nor shall any Finance Party be liable for the failure of another Bank to perform any of its obligations under or in connection with this Agreement.

2.8 APPLICATION OF FACILITY Without prejudice to the obligations of the Borrower under this Agreement, no Finance Party shall be obliged to concern itself with the application of the Facility by the Borrower.

21

2.9 LOAN FACILITY AND CONTROL ACCOUNTS The Agent will open and maintain such loan facility account or such other control accounts as the Agent shall in its discretion consider necessary or desirable in connection with the Facility.

3 CONDITIONS PRECEDENT AND SUBSEQUENT

3.1 CONDITIONS PRECEDENT - FIRST DRAWING Before any Bank shall have any obligation to advance the first Drawing under the Facility, the Borrower shall pay to the Agent the relevant fees referred to in Clause 7 and the Fee Letter and deliver or cause to be delivered to or to the order of the Agent the following documents and evidence:-

3.1.1 EVIDENCE OF INCORPORATION Such evidence as the Agent may reasonably require that each Security Party was duly incorporated in its country of incorporation and remains in existence and, where appropriate, in good standing, with power to enter into, and perform its obligations under, those of the Security Documents to which it is, or is intended to be, a party, including (without limitation) a copy, certified by a director or an officer of the Security Party in question as true, complete, accurate and unamended, of all documents establishing or limiting the constitution of each Security Party.

3.1.2 CORPORATE AUTHORITIES A copy, certified by a director or the secretary of the Security Party in question as true, complete, accurate and neither amended nor revoked, of a resolution of the directors and a resolution of the shareholders of each Security Party (together, where appropriate, with signed waivers of notice of any directors' or shareholders' meetings) approving, and authorising or ratifying the execution of, those of the Security Documents and each Drawdown Notice to which that Security Party is or is intended to be a party and all matters incidental thereto.

3.1.3 OFFICER'S CERTIFICATE A certificate (i) signed by a duly authorised officer of each of the Security Parties setting out the names of the directors, officers and shareholders of that Security Party and (ii) issued by each Security Party's company registry confirming due incorporation and valid existence and (when such information is maintained by the registry) the names of its directors and shareholders.

22

3.1.4 POWER OF ATTORNEY The power of attorney (notarially attested and legalised, if necessary, for registration purposes) of each of the Security Parties under which any documents are to be executed or transactions undertaken by that Security Party.

3.1.5 THE SECURITY DOCUMENTS The Security Documents, together with all notices and other documents required by any of them, duly executed.

3.1.6 DRAWDOWN NOTICE A Drawdown Notice.

3.1.7 PROCESS AGENT A letter from Teekay Shipping (UK) Ltd accepting their appointment by each of the Security Parties as agent for service of Proceedings pursuant to the Security Documents.

3.1.8 FEE LETTER A fee letter countersigned on behalf of the Borrower by way of acceptance of its terms.

3.1.9 LEGAL OPINIONS Confirmation satisfactory to the Agent that all legal opinions required by the Agent on behalf of the Finance Parties will be given substantially in the form required by the Agent on behalf of the Finance Parties.

3.1.10 ACCOUNTS The Borrower's Accounts for its fiscal quarter just ended, certified, by a director or an officer of the Borrower, as fair and accurate.

3.1.11 CORPORATE STRUCTURE Evidence of the capital structure and financial condition of the Navion Group (based on the Borrower's Accounts) confirming (inter alia) that within the Navion Group there is available two hundred million Dollars ($200,000,000) of equity or Subordinated Debt and twenty million Dollars ($20,000,000) of Free Liquidity.

3.1.12 INTERCOMPANY LOAN AGREEMENT A copy of the Intercompany Loan Agreement duly executed by the parties thereto and certified as a true and complete copy by the Borrower together with evidence that all conditions precedent required under the Intercompany Loan Agreement have been satisfied.

23

3.1.13 NAVION Evidence that any charges or other security granted and/or registered against Navion or on or over all or any of its vessels has been discharged.

3.1.14 SHARE CHARGE DOCUMENTS Any documents required by the Shares Charge.

3.1.15 BRIDGE FACILITY Evidence that the Bridge Facility and any other sums due and payable by the Borrower to the Bridge Lenders and the Agent under the Bridge Facility Agreement will following application of the first Drawing hereunder have been irrevocably repaid in full and that any security granted by any of the Security Parties as security for the Bridge Facility shall be released forthwith upon repayment of the Bridge Facility.

3.1.16 NEGATIVE PLEDGE an undertaking in form and content acceptable to the Agent duly executed and delivered by Navion covenanting not to create or permit to arise or continue any Encumbrance on or over all or any part of its assets or undertakings except for Permitted Liens.

3.2 CONDITIONS SUBSEQUENT The Borrower undertakes to deliver or to cause to be delivered to the Agent on, or as soon as practicable after, the first Advance Date, the following additional documents and evidence:-

3.2.1 LEGAL OPINIONS Such legal opinions as the Agent on behalf of the Banks shall require pursuant to Clause 3.1.9.

3.2.2 COMPANIES ACT REGISTRATIONS Evidence that the prescribed particulars of the Security Documents have been delivered to the Registrar of Companies of England and Wales and any other relevant authorities within the statutory time limit.

3.3 CONDITIONS PRECEDENT - SUBSEQUENT DRAWINGS Before any Bank shall have any obligation to advance any subsequent Drawings under the Facility, the Borrower shall deliver or cause to be delivered to the order of the Agent, a Drawdown Notice, in addition to the documents and evidence referred to in Clause 3.1 where such documents and evidence have not already been delivered to and received by the Agent.

24

3.4 NO WAIVER If the Banks in their sole discretion agree to advance any part of the Facility to the Borrower before all of the documents and evidence required by Clause 3.1 or Clause 3.3 (as the case may be) have been delivered to or to the order of the Agent, the Borrower undertakes to deliver all outstanding documents and evidence to or to the order of the Agent no later than the date specified by the Agent, and the advance of any part of the Facility shall not be taken as a waiver of the Agent's right to require production of all the documents and evidence required by Clause 3.1 or Clause 3.3 (as the case may be).

3.5 FORM AND CONTENT All documents and evidence delivered to the Agent pursuant to this Clause shall:-

3.5.1 be in form and substance acceptable to the Agent;

3.5.2 be accompanied, if required by the Agent, by translations into the English language, certified in a manner acceptable to the Agent;

3.5.3 if required for registration purposes, be certified, notarised, legalised or attested in a manner acceptable to the Agent.

3.6 EVENT OF DEFAULT No Bank shall be under any obligation to advance any part of its Commitment nor to act on any Drawdown Notice if, at the date of the Drawdown Notice or at the date on which the advance of a Drawing is requested in the Drawdown Notice, an Event of Default or Potential Event of Default shall have occurred, or if an Event of Default or Potential Event of Default would result from the advance of the Drawing in question.

4 REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES

The Borrower represents and warrants to each of the Finance Parties at the date of this Agreement and (by reference to the facts and circumstances then pertaining) at the date of each Drawdown Notice, at each Advance Date and at each Interest Payment Date as follows except that the representation and warranty contained at Clause 4.6 shall only be made on the first Advance Date:-

4.1 INCORPORATION AND CAPACITY Each of the Security Parties is a body corporate duly constituted, organised and validly existing and (where applicable) in good standing under the law of its country of incorporation, in each case with perpetual corporate existence and the power to sue and be sued, to own its assets and to

25

carry on its business, and all of the corporate shareholders (if any) of each Security Party are duly constituted and existing under the laws of their countries of incorporation with perpetual corporate existence and the power to sue and be sued, to own their assets and to carry on their business and are acting on their own account.

4.2 SOLVENCY None of the Security Parties or the Qualifying Security Parties is insolvent or in liquidation or administration or subject to any other insolvency procedure, and no receiver, administrative receiver, administrator, liquidator, trustee or analogous officer has been appointed in respect of any of the Security Parties or the Qualifying Security Parties or all or any part of their assets. For this purpose a Security Party or a Qualifying Security Party (as the case may be) will be deemed insolvent if it is unable to pay its debts within the meaning of S.123 of the Insolvency Act 1986.

4.3 BINDING OBLIGATIONS The Security Documents and the Qualifying Security when duly executed and delivered will constitute the legal, valid and binding obligations of the Security Parties and the Qualifying Security Parties (as the case may be) enforceable in accordance with their respective terms subject to applicable laws regarding creditors' rights in general.

4.4 SATISFACTION OF CONDITIONS All acts, conditions and things required to be done and satisfied and to have happened prior to the execution and delivery of the Security Documents and the Qualifying Security in order to constitute the Security Documents and the Qualifying Security the legal, valid and binding obligations of the Security Parties and the Qualifying Security Parties (as the case may be) in accordance with their respective terms have been done, satisfied and have happened in compliance with all applicable laws.

4.5 REGISTRATIONS AND CONSENTS With the exception only of the registrations referred to in Clauses 3.2 all (if any) consents, licences, approvals and authorisations of, or registrations with or declarations to, any governmental authority, bureau or agency which may be required in connection with the execution, delivery, performance, validity or enforceability of the Security Documents and the Qualifying Security have been obtained or made and remain in full force and effect and the Borrower is not aware of any event or circumstance which could reasonably be expected adversely to affect the right of any of the Security Parties

26

or the Qualifying Security Parties (as the case may be) to hold and/or obtain renewal of any such consents, licences, approvals or authorisations.

4.6 DISCLOSURE OF MATERIAL FACTS The Borrower is not aware of any material facts or circumstances which have not been disclosed to the Agent and which might, if disclosed, have reasonably been expected to adversely affect the decision of a person considering whether or not to make loan facilities of the nature contemplated by this Agreement available to the Borrower.

4.7 NO MATERIAL LITIGATION Except for those matters disclosed in writing to the Agent, there is no action, suit, arbitration or administrative proceeding nor any contemplated action, suit, arbitration or administrative proceeding pending or to its knowledge about to be pursued before any court, tribunal or governmental or other authority which would, or would be likely to, have a materially adverse effect on the business, assets, financial condition or creditworthiness of the Navion Group.

4.8 NO BREACH OF LAW OR CONTRACT The execution, delivery and performance of the Security Documents will not contravene any contractual restriction or any law binding on any of the Security Parties or on any shareholder (whether legal or beneficial) of any of the Security Parties, or the constitutional documents of any of the Security Parties, nor result in the creation of, nor oblige any of the Security Parties to create, any Encumbrance over all or any of its assets, with the exception of the Encumbrances created by or pursuant to the Security Documents.

4.9 NO DEDUCTIONS Except as disclosed to the Agent in writing, that to the best of their knowledge belief and without undue enquiry, none of the Security Parties is required to make any deduction or withholding from any payment which it may be obliged to make to any of the Finance Parties under or pursuant to the Security Documents.

4.10 USE OF FACILITY The Facility will be used for the purposes specified in the Recital.

4.11 MATERIAL ADVERSE CHANGE There has been no material adverse change in the business, assets, operations, condition (financial or otherwise) or prospects of any company within the Navion Group or the Guarantor or in the facts and information regarding such entities as represented to date. In this clause material adverse change means, in the reasonable opinion of the Banks, a material adverse

27

affect on (i) the ability of the Borrower to repay Drawings or perform its obligations under this Agreement or (ii) the ability of any Security Party to perform its material obligations under any document related to the Facility or (iii) the business, property, assets, liabilities, operations, condition (financial or otherwise) or prospects of any Security Party.

4.12 INTERCOMPANY LOAN AGREEMENT The Intercompany Loan Agreement delivered to the Agent constitutes the entire agreement between the Borrower and the Intercompany Borrower in relation to the Intercompany Indebtedness and there are no side letters, security documents or other related agreements nor fees payable in connection therewith which have not been disclosed to the Agent.

5 REPAYMENT AND PREPAYMENT

5.1 REPAYMENT Each Drawing shall be repaid by the Borrower to the Agent on behalf of the Banks on the last day of its Interest Period unless the Borrower selects a further Interest Period for that Drawing in accordance with Clause 6, provided that the Borrower shall not be permitted to select such further Interest Period if an Event of Default or Potential Event of Default has occurred and shall then be obliged to repay such Drawing on the last day of its then current Interest Period. The Borrower shall on the Termination Date repay to the Agent as agent for the Banks all Facility Outstandings.

5.2 PREPAYMENT The Borrower may prepay the Facility Outstandings in whole or in part in integral multiples of five million Dollars ($5,000,000) (or as otherwise may be agreed by the Agent) provided that it has first given to the Agent not fewer than five (5) Business Days' prior written notice expiring on a Business Day of its intention to do so. Any notice pursuant to this Clause 5.2 once given shall be irrevocable and shall oblige the Borrower to make the prepayment referred to in the notice on the Business Day specified in the notice, together with all interest accrued on the amount prepaid up to and including that Business Day.

5.3 PREPAYMENT INDEMNITY If the Borrower shall, subject always to Clause 5.2, make a prepayment on a Business Day other than the last day of an Interest Period, it shall pay to the Agent on behalf of the Banks any amount which is necessary to compensate the Banks for any Break Costs incurred by the Agent or any of the Banks as a result of the prepayment in question.

28

5.4 APPLICATION OF PREPAYMENTS Any prepayment in an amount less than the Indebtedness shall be applied in satisfaction or reduction first of any costs and other expenses outstanding; secondly of all interest accrued with respect to the outstanding Drawings; and thirdly of the outstanding Drawings as the Borrower may specify.

5.5 REBORROWING OF PREPAYMENTS Any amount prepaid pursuant to this Agreement may be reborrowed in accordance with Clause 2.4.

6 INTEREST

6.1 INTEREST PERIODS The period during which any Drawing shall be outstanding pursuant to this Agreement shall be divided into consecutive Interest Periods of one, three or six months' duration, as selected by the Borrower by written notice to the Agent not later than 11.00 a.m. on the fourth Business Day before the beginning of the Interest Period in question, or such other duration as may be agreed by the Banks in their discretion. No more than five one (1) month Interest Periods may be selected by the Borrower in each calendar year during the Facility Period.

6.2 BEGINNING AND END OF INTEREST PERIODS The first Interest Period in respect of each Drawing shall begin on the Advance Date of that Drawing and shall end on the last day of the Interest Period selected in accordance with Clause 6.1. Any subsequent Interest Period selected in respect of each Drawing shall commence on the day following the last day of its previous Interest Period and shall end on the last day of its current Interest Period selected in accordance with Clause 6.1. However, in respect of any Drawings outstanding on the Termination Date, the Interest Period applicable to such Drawings shall end on the Termination Date.

6.3 INTEREST RATE During each Interest Period, interest shall accrue on each Drawing at the rate determined by the Agent to be the aggregate of (a) the Margin (b) LIBOR and (c), if applicable, the Mandatory Cost determined at or about 11.00 a.m. (London time) on the second Business Day prior to the beginning of the Interest Period relating to that Drawing.

6.4 ACCRUAL AND PAYMENT OF INTEREST During the Facility Period, interest shall accrue from day to day, shall be calculated on the basis of a 360 day year and the actual number of days elapsed (or, in any circumstance where market practice

29

differs, in accordance with the prevailing market practice) and shall be paid by the Borrower to the Agent on behalf of the Banks on the last day of each Interest Period and additionally, during any Interest Period exceeding three months, on the last day of each successive three month period after the beginning of that Interest Period.

6.5 ENDING OF INTEREST PERIODS If any Interest Period would end on a day which is not a Business Day, that Interest Period shall end on the next succeeding Business Day (unless the next succeeding Business Day falls in the next calendar month, in which event the Interest Period in question shall end on the next preceding Business Day).

6.6 DEFAULT RATE If an Event of Default shall occur, the whole of the Indebtedness shall, from the date of the occurrence of the Event of Default, bear interest up to the date of actual payment (both before and after judgment) at the Default Rate, compounded at such intervals as the Agent shall in its reasonable discretion determine, which interest shall be payable from time to time by the Borrower to the Agent on behalf of the Banks on demand.

6.7 DETERMINATIONS CONCLUSIVE Each determination of an interest rate made by the Agent in accordance with Clause 6 shall (save in the case of manifest error or on any question of law) be final and conclusive.

7 FEES

7.1 FEE LETTERS The Borrower shall pay to or to the order of the Agent, the Arrangers or the Book Runners (as the case may be), the fees, commissions and other sums referred to in the relevant Fee Letters in the amounts and on the dates set out in the relevant Fee Letters.

7.2 COMMITMENT COMMISSION The Borrower shall pay to the Agent Commitment Commission in Dollars at the Commission Rate on any undrawn and uncancelled part of the Facility. The Commitment Commission will accrue from day to day on the basis of a 360 day year and the actual number of days elapsed and shall be paid quarterly in arrears from 30 September 2006 until the Commitment Termination Date with a pro rata payment being due and payable on the Commitment Termination Date.

30

8 SECURITY DOCUMENTS

8.1 As security for the repayment of the Indebtedness, the Borrower executed and delivered to the Agent or caused to be executed and delivered to the Agent, on or before the first Advance Date, the following Security Documents in such forms and containing such terms and conditions as the Agent required:-

8.1.1 THE ASSIGNMENT a deed of assignment of the Intercompany Indebtedness;

8.1.2 SHARES CHARGE an assignment by the Borrower of a charge over the issued share capital of Navion entered into by the Intercompany Borrower as security for its obligations under the Intercompany Loan Agreement.

8.2 As further security for the repayment of the Indebtedness, the Borrower has caused to be executed and delivered to the Agent the following Security Documents:-

8.2.1 THE FIRST QUALIFYING SECURITY ASSIGNMENT a deed of assignment of the First Qualifying Security Documents;

8.2.2 THE TNOL ASSIGNMENT AND SUBORDINATION AGREEMENTS the deeds of assignment and subordination in relation to the TNOL Vessels; and

8.2.3 THE GUARANTEE the guarantee and indemnity of the Guarantor in respect of the Borrower's Obligations.

9 AGENCY AND TRUST

9.1 APPOINTMENT Each of the Banks and each of the Arrangers appoints the Agent its agent for the purpose of administering the Facility and the Security Documents and authorises the Agent and its directors, officers, employees and agents acting on the instructions from time to time of the Majority Banks, and subject to Clauses 9.4 and 9.19, to execute the Security Documents on its behalf and to exercise all rights, powers, discretions and remedies vested in the Banks under or pursuant to the Security Documents, together with all powers reasonably incidental to them.

9.2 AUTHORITY Each of the Banks and the Arrangers irrevocably authorises the Agent, acting on the instructions from time to time of the Majority Banks (save where the

31

terms of any Security Document expressly require the instructions of all of the Banks):-

9.2.1 to give or withhold any consents or approvals; and

9.2.2 to exercise, or refrain from exercising, any discretions; and

9.2.3 to collect, receive, release or pay any money;

under or pursuant to any of the Security Documents. The Agent shall have no duties or responsibilities as agent or as security trustee other than those expressly conferred on it by the Security Documents and shall not be obliged to act on any instructions if to do so would, in the opinion of the Agent, be contrary to any provision of the Security Documents or to any law, or would expose the Agent to any actual or potential liability to any third party.

9.3 TRUST The Agent agrees and declares, and each of the Banks acknowledges, that, subject to the terms and conditions of this Clause, the Agent holds the Trust Property on trust for the Banks, in accordance with their respective Proportionate Shares, absolutely. Each of the Banks agrees that the obligations, rights and benefits vested in the Agent in its capacity as security trustee shall be performed and exercised in accordance with this Clause. The Agent in its capacity as security trustee shall have the benefit of all of the provisions of this Agreement benefiting it in its capacity as agent for the Banks, and all the powers and discretions conferred on trustees by the Trustee Act 1925 (to the extent not inconsistent with this Agreement). In addition:-

9.3.1 the Agent (and any attorney, agent or delegate of the Agent) may indemnify itself or himself out of the Trust Property against all liabilities, costs, fees, damages, charges, losses and expenses sustained or incurred by it or him in relation to the taking or holding of any of the Trust Property or in connection with the exercise or purported exercise of the rights, trusts, powers and discretions vested in the Agent or any other such person by or pursuant to the Security Documents or in respect of anything else done or omitted to be done in any way relating to the Security Documents; and

9.3.2 the Banks acknowledge that the Agent shall be under no obligation to insure any property nor to require any other person to insure any

32

property and shall not be responsible for any loss which may be suffered by any person as a result of the lack or insufficiency of any insurance; and

9.3.3 the Agent and the Banks agree that the perpetuity period applicable to the trusts declared by this Agreement shall be the period of eighty years from the Execution Date.

9.4 LIMITATIONS ON AUTHORITY Except with the prior written consent of each of the Banks, the Agent shall not be entitled to :-

9.4.1 release or vary any security given for the Borrower's obligations under this Agreement; nor

9.4.2 except as otherwise provided in this Agreement, agree to waive the payment of any sum of money payable by any of the Security Parties under the Security Documents; nor

9.4.3 change the meaning of the expression "MAJORITY BANKS"; nor

9.4.4 exercise, or refrain from exercising, any discretion, or give or withhold any consent, the exercise or giving of which is, by the terms of this Agreement, expressly reserved to the Banks; nor

9.4.5 extend the due date for the payment of any sum of money payable by any of the Security Parties under the Security Documents; nor

9.4.6 take or refrain from taking any step if the effect of such action or inaction may lead to the increase of the obligations of a Bank under any of the Security Documents; nor

9.4.7 agree to change the currency in which any sum is payable under the Security Documents; nor

9.4.8 agree to amend this Clause 9.4; nor

9.4.9 agree to amend the definition of "MARGIN".

9.5 LIABILITY Neither the Agent nor any of its directors, officers, employees or agents shall be liable to the Banks or the Arrangers for anything done or omitted to be

33

done by the Agent under or in connection with the Security Documents unless as a result of the Agent's wilful misconduct or gross negligence.

9.6 ACKNOWLEDGEMENT Each of the Banks and the Arrangers acknowledges that:-

9.6.1 it has not relied on any representation made by the Agent or any of the Agent's directors, officers, employees or agents or by any other person acting or purporting to act on behalf of the Agent to induce it to enter into any of the Security Documents;

9.6.2 it has made and will continue to make without reliance on the Agent, and based on such documents and other evidence as it considers appropriate, its own independent investigation of the financial condition and affairs of the Security Parties in connection with the making and continuation of the Facility;

9.6.3 it has made its own appraisal of the creditworthiness of the Security Parties;

9.6.4 the Agent shall not have any duty or responsibility at any time to provide it with any credit or other information relating to any of the Security Parties unless that information is received by the Agent pursuant to the express terms of the Security Documents.

Each of the Banks and the Arrangers agrees that it will not assert nor seek to assert against any director, officer, employee or agent of the Agent or against any other person acting or purporting to act on behalf of the Agent any claim which it might have against them in respect of any of the matters referred to in this Clause.

9.7 LIMITATIONS ON RESPONSIBILITY The Agent shall have no responsibility to any of the Security Parties or to the Banks or to the Arrangers on account of:-

9.7.1 the failure of a Bank or of any of the Security Parties to perform any of their respective obligations under the Security Documents;

9.7.2 the financial condition of any of the Security Parties;

9.7.3 the completeness or accuracy of any statements, representations or warranties made in or pursuant to any of the Security Documents, or in

34

or pursuant to any document delivered pursuant to or in connection with any of the Security Documents;

9.7.4 the negotiation, execution, effectiveness, genuineness, validity, enforceability, admissibility in evidence or sufficiency of any of the Security Documents or of any document executed or delivered pursuant to or in connection with any of the Security Documents.

9.8 THE AGENT'S RIGHTS The Agent may:-

9.8.1 assume that all representations or warranties made or deemed repeated by any of the Security Parties in or pursuant to any of the Security Documents are true and complete, unless, in its capacity as the Agent, it has acquired actual knowledge to the contrary; and

9.8.2 assume that no Event of Default or Potential Event of Default has occurred unless, in its capacity as the Agent, it has acquired actual knowledge to the contrary; and

9.8.3 rely on any document or Communication believed by it to be genuine; and

9.8.4 rely as to legal or other professional matters on opinions and statements of any legal or other professional advisers selected or approved by it; and

9.8.5 rely as to any factual matters which might reasonably be expected to be within the knowledge of any of the Security Parties on a certificate signed by or on behalf of that Security Party; and

9.8.6 refrain from exercising any right, power, discretion or remedy unless and until instructed to exercise that right, power, discretion or remedy and as to the manner of its exercise by the Banks (or, where applicable, by the Majority Banks) and unless and until the Agent has received from the Banks any payment which the Agent may require on account of, or any security which the Agent may require for, any costs, claims, expenses (including legal and other professional fees) and liabilities which it considers it may incur or sustain in complying with those instructions.

35

9.9 THE AGENT'S DUTIES The Agent shall:-

9.9.1 if requested in writing to do so by a Bank, make enquiry and advise the Banks as to the performance or observance of any of the provisions of the Security Documents by any of the Security Parties or as to the existence of an Event of Default; and

9.9.2 inform the Banks promptly of any Event of Default of which the Agent has actual knowledge; and

9.9.3 inform the Banks promptly of any disclosures in writing received by the Agent pursuant to Clause 4.7.

9.10 NO DEEMED KNOWLEDGE The Agent shall not be deemed to have actual knowledge of the falsehood or incompleteness of any representation or warranty made or deemed repeated by any of the Security Parties or actual knowledge of the occurrence of any Event of Default or Potential Event of Default unless a Bank or any of the Security Parties shall have given written notice thereof to the Agent.

9.11 OTHER BUSINESS The Agent may, without any liability to account to the Banks or the Arrangers, generally engage in any kind of banking or trust business with any of the Security Parties or any of their respective Subsidiaries or associated companies or with a Bank as if it were not the Agent.

9.12 INDEMNITY The Banks shall, promptly on the Agent's request, reimburse the Agent in their respective Proportionate Shares, for, and keep the Agent fully indemnified in respect of:-

9.12.1 all amounts payable by the Borrower to the Agent pursuant to Clause 17 (other than under Clauses 17.3 and 17.4) to the extent that those amounts are not paid by the Borrower;

9.12.2 all liabilities, damages, costs and claims sustained or incurred by the Agent in connection with the Security Documents, or the performance of its duties and obligations, or the exercise of its rights, powers, discretions or remedies under or pursuant to any of the Security Documents; or in connection with any action taken or omitted by the Agent under or pursuant to any of the Security Documents, unless in

36

any case those liabilities, damages, costs or claims arise solely from the Agent's wilful misconduct or gross negligence.

9.13 EMPLOYMENT OF AGENTS In performing its duties and exercising its rights, powers, discretions and remedies under or pursuant to the Security Documents, the Agent shall be entitled to employ and pay agents to do anything which the Agent is empowered to do under or pursuant to the Security Documents (including the receipt of money and documents and the payment of money) and to act or refrain from taking action in reliance on the opinion of, or advice or information obtained from, any lawyer, banker, broker, accountant, valuer or any other person believed by the Agent in good faith to be competent to give such opinion, advice or information.

9.14 DISTRIBUTION OF PAYMENTS The Agent shall pay promptly to the order of each of the Banks that Bank's Proportionate Share of every sum of money received by the Agent pursuant to the Security Documents (with the exception of any amounts payable pursuant to Clause 7.1 and/or the Fee Letters and any amounts which, by the terms of the Security Documents, are paid to the Agent for the account of the Agent alone or specifically for the account of one or more Banks, the Arrangers or the Book Runners) and until so paid such amount shall be held by the Agent on trust absolutely for that Bank or the Arrangers (or as the case may be).

9.15 REIMBURSEMENT The Agent shall have no liability to pay any sum to a Bank or to the Arrangers until it has itself received payment of that sum. If, however, the Agent does pay any sum to a Bank or to the Arrangers on account of any amount prospectively due to it pursuant to Clause 9.14 before it has itself received payment of that amount, and the Agent does not in fact receive payment within five Business Days after the date on which that payment was required to be made by the terms of the Security Documents or the Mortgagees' Insurances, the recipient will, on demand by the Agent, refund to the Agent an amount equal to the amount received by it, together with an amount sufficient to reimburse the Agent for any amount which the Agent may certify that it has been required to pay by way of interest on money borrowed to fund the amount in question during the period beginning on the date on which that amount was required to be paid by the terms of the Security Documents or the Mortgagees' Insurances and ending on the date on which the Agent receives reimbursement.

37

9.16 REDISTRIBUTION OF PAYMENTS Unless otherwise agreed between the Finance Parties, if at any time a Bank receives or recovers by way of set-off, the exercise of any lien or otherwise (other than from any assignee or transferee of or sub-participant in that Bank's Commitment), an amount greater than that Bank's Proportionate Share of any sum due from any of the Security Parties under the Security Documents (the amount of the excess being referred to in this Clause as the "EXCESS AMOUNT") then:-

9.16.1 that Bank shall promptly notify the Agent (which shall promptly notify each other Bank);

9.16.2 that Bank shall pay to the Agent an amount equal to the Excess Amount within ten days of its receipt or recovery of the Excess Amount; and

9.16.3 the Agent shall treat that payment as if it were a payment by the Security Party in question on account of the sum owed to the Banks as aforesaid and shall account to the Banks in respect of the Excess Amount in accordance with the provisions of this Clause.

9.17 However, if a Bank has commenced any Proceedings to recover sums owing to it under the Security Documents and, as a result of, or in connection with, those Proceedings has received an Excess Amount, the Agent shall not distribute any of that Excess Amount to any other Bank which had been notified of the Proceedings and had the legal right to, but did not, join those Proceedings or commence and diligently prosecute separate Proceedings to enforce its rights in the same or another court.

9.18 RESCISSION OF EXCESS AMOUNT If all or any part of any Excess Amount is rescinded or must otherwise be restored to any of the Security Parties or to any other third party, the Banks which have received any part of that Excess Amount by way of distribution from the Agent pursuant to Clause 9.16 shall repay to the Agent for the account of the Bank which originally received or recovered the Excess Amount, the amount which shall be necessary to ensure that the Banks share rateably in accordance with their Proportionate Shares in the amount of the receipt or payment retained, together with interest on that amount at a rate equivalent to that (if any) paid by the Bank receiving or recovering the Excess Amount to the person to whom that Bank is liable to make payment in respect of such amount, and Clause 9.16.3 shall apply only to the retained amount.

38

9.19 PROCEEDINGS Each of the Finance Parties shall notify one another of the proposed commencement of any Proceedings under any of the Security Documents prior to their commencement. No such Proceedings may be commenced without the prior written consent of the Majority Banks.

9.20 INSTRUCTIONS Where the Agent is authorised or directed to act or refrain from acting in accordance with the instructions of the Banks or of the Majority Banks each of the Banks shall provide the Agent with instructions within seven Business Days of the Agent's written request. If a Bank does not provide the Agent with instructions within that period, (i) that Bank shall be bound by the decision of the Agent, (ii) that Bank shall have no vote for the purposes of this Clause and (iii) the combined Proportionate Shares of the other Banks who provided such instructions shall be deemed to contribute 100%. Nothing in this Clause shall limit the right of the Agent to take, or refrain from taking, any action without obtaining the instructions of the Banks if the Agent in its discretion considers it necessary or appropriate to take, or refrain from taking, such action in order to preserve the rights of the Banks under or in connection with the Security Documents. In that event, the Agent will notify the Banks of the action taken by it as soon as reasonably practicable, and the Banks agree to ratify any action taken by the Agent pursuant to this Clause.

9.21 COMMUNICATIONS Any Communication under this Clause shall be given, delivered, made or served, in the case of the Agent (in its capacity as Agent or as one of the Banks), and in the case of the other Banks, at the address indicated in Schedule 1 or such other addresses as shall be duly notified in writing to the Agent on behalf of the Banks.

9.22 PAYMENTS All amounts payable to a Bank under this Clause shall be paid to such account at such bank as that Bank may from time to time direct in writing to the Agent.

9.23 RETIREMENT Subject to a successor being appointed in accordance with this Clause, the Agent may retire as agent and/or security trustee at any time without assigning any reason by giving to the Borrower and the other Finance Parties notice of its intention to do so, in which event the following shall apply:-

9.23.1 with the consent of the Borrower, not to be unreasonably withheld, the other Finance Parties may within thirty days after the date of the Agent's

39

notice appoint a successor to act as agent and/or security trustee or, if they fail to do so with the consent of the Borrower, not to be unreasonably withheld, the Agent may appoint any other bank or financial institution as its successor;

9.23.2 the resignation of the Agent shall take effect simultaneously with the appointment of its successor on written notice of that appointment being given to the Borrower and the other Finance Parties;

9.23.3 the Agent shall thereupon be discharged from all further obligations as agent and/or security trustee but shall remain entitled to the benefit of the provisions of this Clause;

9.23.4 the Agent's successor and each of the other parties to this Agreement shall have the same rights and obligations amongst themselves as they would have had if that successor had been a party to this Agreement.

9.24 NO FIDUCIARY RELATIONSHIP Except as provided in Clauses 9.3 and 9.14, the Agent shall not have any fiduciary relationship with or be deemed to be a trustee of or for a Bank or the Arrangers and nothing contained in any of the Security Documents shall constitute a partnership between any two or more Banks or between the Agent and any Bank or the Arrangers.

9.25 THE AGENT AS A BANK The expression "THE BANKS" when used in the Security Documents includes the Agent in its capacity as one of the Banks. The Agent shall be entitled to exercise its rights, powers, discretions and remedies under or pursuant to the Security Documents in its capacity as one of the Banks in the same manner as any other Bank and as if it were not also the Agent.

9.26 THE AGENT AS SECURITY TRUSTEE Unless the context otherwise requires, the expression "THE AGENT" when used in the Security Documents includes the Agent acting in its capacities both as agent and security trustee.

10 COVENANTS

The Borrower covenants with the Finance Parties in the following terms.

40

10.1 NEGATIVE COVENANTS

The Borrower will not and will procure that no member of the Covenanting Group will:-

10.1.1 NO THIRD PARTY RIGHTS without the Majority Banks' prior written consent, create or permit to arise or continue any Encumbrance on or over all or any part of the Vessels or their Earnings or Insurances except for Permitted Liens or Encumbrances arising in connection with the financing of the organic compound equipment provided on a non-recourse basis to the Borrower; nor

10.1.2 NO OTHER BUSINESS materially change the nature of its business from that carried on as at the Execution Date (and for the purpose of this Clause, a change of business shall be deemed "material" if the turnover of any new or changed business constitutes seven point five per cent (7.5%) or more of the aggregate turnover of the relevant entity within the Covenanting Group); nor

10.1.3 MERGER OR AMALGAMATION without the prior written consent of the Majority Banks, permit any merger or amalgamation with a company outside the Navion Group provided that the Borrower shall notify the Agent, in the case of a merger or amalgamation within the Navion Group; nor

10.1.4 QUALIFYING SECURITY without the prior written consent of the Banks, make or cause to be made any amendment, variation, supplement or release to, or transfer or novation of, the Qualifying Security.

10.2 POSITIVE COVENANTS

10.2.1 FINANCIAL STATEMENTS The Borrower will supply to the Agent, without request, the Guarantor's Accounts for each financial year of the Guarantor ending during the Facility Period, containing (amongst other things) the Guarantor's profit and loss account for, and balance sheet at the end of, each such financial year, in each case within one hundred and fifty days of the end of the financial year to which they relate and the Guarantor's quarterly unaudited management accounts within 90 days of the end of the quarter to which they relate, and such financial

41

statements shall accurately and fairly represent the financial condition of the Guarantor.

10.2.2 OTHER INFORMATION The Borrower will promptly supply to the Agent such information and explanations as the Majority Banks may from time to time reasonably require in connection with the operation of the Vessels and the Guarantor Group's profit and liquidity, and will procure that the Agent be given the like information and explanations relating to all other Security Parties and the Qualifying Security Parties.

10.2.3 INSPECTION OF RECORDS The Borrower will permit the inspection of its financial records and accounts on reasonable notice from time to time during business hours by the Agent or its nominee.

10.2.4 NOTIFICATION OF EVENT OF DEFAULT The Borrower will immediately notify the Agent in writing of the occurrence of any Event of Default or Potential Event of Default or any event which will materially adversely affect the Borrower's or the Guarantor's ability to perform its obligations under the Security Documents to which it is a party or the ability of any of the other Security Parties to perform any of their material obligations under any of the Security Documents to which they are a party or may become a party to.

10.2.5 PARI PASSU The Borrower shall ensure that its respective obligations under this Agreement shall at all times rank at least pari passu with all of its other present and future unsecured and unsubordinated indebtedness with the exception of any obligations which are mandatorily preferred by any applicable laws to companies generally and not by contract.

10.2.6 CORPORATE EXISTENCE Save as permitted by Clause 10.1.3, the Borrower shall ensure that throughout the Facility Period each of the Security Parties and the Qualifying Security Parties shall
(i) remain duly formed and validly existing under the laws of its respective jurisdiction of incorporation (ii) remain authorised to do business in the jurisdiction in which it transacts its business (iii) continue to have the power to carry on its business as it is now being conducted and to enter into and perform its obligations under the Transaction Documents to which it is a

42

party and (iv) continue to comply with all laws, statutory, regulatory and other requirements relative to its business which could reasonably be expected to have a material adverse effect on its business, assets or operations, financial or otherwise.

10.2.7 ADMISSIBILITY IN EVIDENCE The Borrower shall on the request of the Agent obtain all necessary authorisations, consents, approvals, licences, exemptions, filings, registrations, recordings and notarisations required or advisable in connection with the admissibility in evidence of the Security Documents or any of them in Proceedings in England or any other jurisdiction in which Proceedings have been commenced.

10.3 VALUATIONS Deliver to the Agent a Valuation of each of the Vessels on the due date for delivery of the financial statements of the Guarantor and on such other occasions as the Agent may reasonably request.

10.4 GUARANTOR'S FINANCIAL COVENANTS At any time during the Facility Period, the Borrower shall procure that on a consolidated basis:-

10.4.1 the Guarantor Group maintains Free Liquidity and undrawn committed revolving credit lines (including under this Agreement but excluding committed revolving credit lines with less than six months to maturity) of not less than seventy five million Dollars ($75,000,000) in aggregate; and

10.4.2 the aggregate of the Free Liquidity of the Guarantor Group and undrawn committed revolving credit lines (including under this Agreement but excluding committed revolving credit lines with less than 6 months to maturity) shall not be less than five per cent (5%) of its Total Debt.

10.5 DIVIDENDS Provided that the Intercompany Indebtedness shall at all times be equal to or greater than the Indebtedness and no Event of Default has occurred and is continuing (but not otherwise) the Borrower may:-

10.5.1 pay any dividends or make any other distributions to shareholders; and/or

10.5.2 make any loan or other similar financial support available to any third party or any member of the Navion Group.

43

10.6 INTERCOMPANY LOAN Upon the written request of the Agent, the Borrower shall deliver a certificate to the Agent confirming the amount outstanding under the Intercompany Loan Agreement, which shall at all times be at least equal to the aggregate of the Facility Outstandings and all unpaid interest, costs and expenses under this Agreement.

11 EARNINGS

REMITTANCE OF EARNINGS Immediately upon the occurrence of an Event of Default, the Borrower shall procure that all Earnings are paid to such account(s) as the Agent shall from time to time specify by notice in writing to the Borrower.

12 EVENTS OF DEFAULT

12.1 THE AGENT'S RIGHTS If any of the events set out in Clause 12.2 occurs, the Agent may at its discretion (and, on the instructions of the Majority Banks, will) by notice to the Borrower declare the Banks to be under no further obligation to the Borrower under or pursuant to this Agreement and may (and, on the instructions of the Majority Banks, will) declare all or any part of the Indebtedness (including such unpaid interest as shall have accrued) to be immediately payable, whereupon the Indebtedness (or the part of the Indebtedness referred to in the Agent's notice) shall immediately become due and payable without any further demand or notice of any kind.

12.2 EVENTS OF DEFAULT The events referred to in Clause 12.1 are:-

12.2.1 PAYMENT DEFAULT if the Borrower defaults in the payment of any part of the Indebtedness when due PROVIDED ALWAYS that if the Borrower can demonstrate to the reasonable satisfaction of the Agent that it has given all necessary instructions to effect payment and the non-receipt thereof is attributable to an error in the banking system, such Event of Default shall only occur (i) three (3) Business Days after such payment fell due if it relates to principal, (ii) five (5) Business Days after such payment fell due if it relates to a scheduled payment which is not principal and (iii) ten Business Days after such payment fell due if it relates to a payment on demand; or

12.2.2 OTHER DEFAULT if any of the Security Parties or the Qualifying Security Parties fails to observe or perform any of the covenants, conditions,

44

undertakings, agreements or obligations (other than those relating to Insurances) on its part contained in any of the Transaction Documents (other than a TNOL Bareboat Charter) or shall in any other way be in breach of or do or cause to be done any act repudiating or evidencing an intention to repudiate any of the Transaction Documents (other than a TNOL Bareboat Charter) and such default (if in the reasonable opinion of the Majority Banks capable of remedy) is not remedied within thirty (30) days after notice of the default has been given to the Borrower; or

12.2.3 MISREPRESENTATION OR BREACH OF WARRANTY if any representation, warranty or statement made, deemed to be made, or repeated under any of the Security Documents or in any accounts, certificate, notice instrument, written statement or opinion delivered by a Security Party under or in connection with any Security Document is incorrect or misleading in any material respect when made, deemed to be made or repeated; or

12.2.4 EXECUTION if a distress or execution or other process of a court or authority is levied on any of the property of any of the Security Parties or any other member of the Navion Group before or after final judgment or by order of any competent court or authority for an amount in excess of five million Dollars ($5,000,000) or its equivalent in any other currency and is not satisfied or stayed (with a view to being contested in good faith) within fourteen days of levy or any other applicable cure period (if longer); or

12.2.5 INSOLVENCY EVENTS if any of the Security Parties:-

(a) resolves to appoint, or applies for, or consents to the appointment of, a receiver, administrative receiver, trustee, administrator or liquidator of itself or of all or part of its assets other than for the purposes of a merger or amalgamation pursuant to Clause 10.1.3; or

(b) is unable or admits its inability to pay its debts as they fall due; or

(c) makes a general assignment for the benefit of creditors; or

(d) ceases trading or threatens to cease trading; or

45

(e) has appointed an Inspector under the Companies Act 1985 or any statutory provision which the Agent in its discretion considers analogous thereto; or

12.2.6 INSOLVENCY PROCEEDINGS if any proceedings are commenced or threatened, or any order or judgment is given by any court, for the bankruptcy, liquidation, winding up, administration or re-organisation of any of the Security Parties or any other member of the Navion Group or for the appointment of a receiver, administrative receiver, administrator, liquidator or trustee of any of the Security Parties or any other member of the Navion Group or of all or any material part of the assets of any of the Security Parties or any other member of the Navion Group, or if any person appoints or purports to appoint such receiver, administrative receiver, administrator, liquidator or trustee which proceeding is not discharged within thirty (30) days of its commencement; or

12.2.7 IMPOSSIBILITY OR ILLEGALITY unless covered by Clause 15.7, if any event occurs which would, or would with the passage of time, render performance of any of the Security Documents impossible, unlawful or unenforceable by the Banks or the Agent; or

12.2.8 CONDITIONS SUBSEQUENT if any of the conditions set out in Clause 3.2 is not satisfied within the time reasonably required by the Agent; or

12.2.9 REVOCATION OR MODIFICATION OF CONSENTS ETC. if any material consent, licence, approval or authorisation which is now or which at any time during the Facility Period becomes necessary to enable any of the Security Parties to comply with any of their obligations in or pursuant to any of the Security Documents is revoked, withdrawn or withheld, or modified in a manner which the Agent reasonably considers is, or may be, prejudicial to the interests of the Banks in a material manner, or any material consent, licence, approval or authorisation ceases to remain in full force and effect; or

12.2.10 CURTAILMENT OF BUSINESS if the business of any of the Security Parties is wholly or materially curtailed by any intervention by or under authority of any government, or if all or a substantial part of the undertaking,

46

property or assets of any of the Security Parties is seized, nationalised, expropriated or compulsorily acquired by or under authority of any government or any Security Party disposes or threatens to dispose of a substantial part of its business or assets; or

12.2.11 ACCELERATION OF OTHER INDEBTEDNESS if any other indebtedness of any Security Party or any Material Subsidiary is not paid when due (or within any applicable grace period) or any indebtedness of any Security Party or any Material Subsidiary is declared to be or otherwise becomes due and payable prior to its specified maturity where (in either case) the aggregate of all such unpaid or accelerated indebtedness (i) of the Guarantor is equal to or greater than fifty million Dollars ($50,000,000) or its equivalent in any other currency; or (ii) of the Borrower, or any Material Subsidiary is equal to or greater than twenty five million Dollars ($25,000,000) or its equivalent in any other currency; or

12.2.12 REDUCTION OF CAPITAL if any of the members of the Navion Group reduces its authorised or issued or subscribed capital except reductions effected in compliance with Clause 10.1.3; or

12.2.13 CHALLENGE TO REGISTRATION if the registration of any Vessel or any Mortgage becomes void or voidable or liable to cancellation or termination; or

12.2.14 WAR if the country of registration of any Vessel becomes involved in war (whether or not declared) or civil war or is occupied by any other power and the Agent reasonably considers that, as a result, the security conferred by the Security Documents is materially prejudiced; or

12.2.15 NOTICE OF TERMINATION if the Guarantor gives notice to the Agent to determine its obligations under the Guarantee; or

12.2.16 MATERIAL ADVERSE CHANGE if at any time there shall occur a change in the business or operations of a Security Party or a change in the financial condition of any Security Party which, in the reasonable opinion of the Majority Banks, materially impairs such Security Party's ability to discharge its obligations under the Security Documents in the manner provided therein and such change, if capable of remedy, is not

47

so remedied within 15 days of the delivery of a notice confirming such change by the Agent to the relevant Security Party; or

12.2.17 FINAL JUDGEMENTS if any of the Security Parties fails to comply with any non appealable court order or fails to pay a final unappealable judgment against it, in either case, in excess of one million Dollars ($1,000,000) which remains unsettled for fourteen (14) days; or

12.2.18 INTERCOMPANY LOAN AGREEMENT if any default (other than on the part of the Intercompany Agent) occurs under the Intercompany Loan Agreement or if the Intercompany Agent is removed (or steps are taken to try to remove it) from its position as agent thereunder or if the Borrower (i) obstructs the Intercompany Agent from performance of its delegated duties or (ii) attempts to revoke the authority and discretion it has granted to the Intercompany Agent, under clause 10.3(b) of the Intercompany Loan Agreement; or

12.2.19 QUALIFYING SECURITY if any amendment, variation, supplement, release, transfer or novation is made or effected in relation to the Qualifying Security without the prior written consent of the Banks; or

12.2.20 TNOL BAREBOAT CHARTERS if the TNOL Bareboat Charters or any of them are terminated prior to the Termination Date without the prior written consent of the Agent; or

12.2.21 INSURANCES if any Security Party fails to effect or maintain the Insurances in the manner required by the relevant Security Documents or the First Qualifying Security Documents (as the case may be).

13 SET-OFF AND LIEN

13.1 SET-OFF The Borrower irrevocably authorises each of the Finance Parties at any time after all or any part of the Indebtedness shall have become due and payable to set off without notice any liability of the Borrower to any of the Finance Parties (whether present or future, actual or contingent, and irrespective of the branch or office, currency or place of payment) against any credit balance from time to time standing on any account of the Borrower (whether current or otherwise and whether or not subject to notice) with any branch of any of the Finance Parties in or towards satisfaction of the Indebtedness and, in the name of that Finance Party

48

or the Borrower, to do all acts (including, without limitation, converting or exchanging any currency) and execute all documents which may be required to effect such application.

13.2 LIEN If an Event of Default has occurred and is continuing, each Finance Party shall have a lien on and be entitled to retain and realise as additional security for the repayment of the Indebtedness any cheques, drafts, bills, notes or negotiable or non-negotiable instruments and any stocks, shares or marketable or other securities and property of any kind of the Borrower (or of that Finance Party as agent or nominee of the Borrower) from time to time held by that Finance Party, whether for safe custody or otherwise.

13.3 RESTRICTIONS ON WITHDRAWAL Despite any term to the contrary in relation to any deposit or credit balance at any time on any account of the Borrower with any of the Finance Parties, no such deposit or balance shall be repayable or capable of being assigned, mortgaged, charged or otherwise disposed of or dealt with by the Borrower after an Event of Default has occurred and while such Event of Default is continuing, but any Finance Party may from time to time permit the withdrawal of all or any part of any such deposit or balance without affecting the continued application of this Clause.

13.4 APPLICATION Whilst an Event of Default is continuing, the Borrower irrevocably authorises the Agent to apply all sums which the Agent may receive:-

13.4.1 pursuant to a sale or other disposition of a Vessel or any right, title or interest in a Vessel; or

13.4.2 by way of payment to the Agent of any sum in respect of the Insurances, Earnings or Requisition Compensation of a Vessel; or

13.4.3 otherwise arising under or in connection with any of the Security Documents

in or towards satisfaction, or by way of retention on account, of the Indebtedness, in such manner as the Agent may in its discretion determine.

49

14 ASSIGNMENT AND SUB-PARTICIPATION

14.1 RIGHT TO ASSIGN Each of the Banks may assign or transfer all or any of its rights under or pursuant to the Security Documents or grant sub-participations in all or any part of its Commitment to any other branch of that Bank or (with the prior written consent of the Borrower which shall not be unreasonably withheld and which shall be deemed given if the Borrower fails to respond to any written request under this provision within a period of ten (10) Business Days) to any other bank or financial institution, provided that such assignment or transfer or sub-participation does not result in the Borrower being subject to any additional Tax or other financial or legal obligations other than those contemplated by the terms of this Agreement at the time of such assignment, transfer or sub-participation.

14.2 BORROWER'S CO-OPERATION The Borrower will co-operate fully with the Banks in connection with any assignment, transfer or sub-participation pursuant to Clause 14.1; will execute and procure the execution of such documents as the Banks may require in connection therewith; and irrevocably authorises each of the Finance Parties to disclose to any proposed assignee, transferee or sub-participant (whether before or after any assignment, transfer or sub-participation and whether or not any assignment, transfer or sub-participation shall take place) all information relating to the Security Parties, the Facility or the Security Documents which each such Finance Party may in its discretion consider necessary or desirable (subject to any duties of confidentiality applicable to the Banks generally).

14.3 RIGHTS OF ASSIGNEE Any assignee, transferee or sub-participant of a Bank shall (unless limited by the express terms of the assignment, transfer or sub-participation) take the full benefit of every provision of the Security Documents benefiting that Bank.

14.4 TRANSFER CERTIFICATES If any Bank wishes to transfer all or any of its Commitment as contemplated in Clause 14.1 then such transfer may be effected by the delivery to the Agent of a duly completed and duly executed Transfer Certificate in which event, on the later of the Transfer Date specified in such Transfer Certificate and the fifth Business Day after the date of delivery of such Transfer Certificate to the Agent:

50

14.4.1 to the extent that in such Transfer Certificate the Bank which is a party thereto seeks to transfer its Commitment in whole, the Borrower and such Bank shall be released from further obligations towards each other under this Agreement and their respective rights against each other shall be cancelled other than existing claims against such Bank for breach of this Agreement (such rights, benefits and obligations being referred to in this Clause 14.4 as "DISCHARGED RIGHTS AND OBLIGATIONS");

14.4.2 the Borrower and the Transferee which is a party thereto shall assume obligations towards one another and/or acquire rights against one another which differ from such discharged rights and obligations only insofar as the Borrower and such Transferee have assumed and/or acquired the same in place of the Borrower and such Bank; and

14.4.3 the Agent, the Arrangers, the Transferee and the other Banks shall acquire the same rights and benefits and assume the same obligations between themselves as they would have acquired and assumed had such Transferee been an original party to this Agreement as a Bank with the rights, benefits and/or obligations acquired or assumed by it as a result of such transfer.

14.5 POWER OF ATTORNEY In order to give effect to each Transfer Certificate the Finance Parties and the Borrower each hereby irrevocably and unconditionally appoint the Agent as its true and lawful attorney with full power to execute on their respective behalves each Transfer Certificate delivered to the Agent pursuant to Clause 14.4 without the Agent being under any obligation to take any further instructions from or give any prior notice to, any of the Finance Parties or, subject to the Borrower's rights under Clause 14.1, the Borrower before doing so and the Agent shall so execute each such Transfer Certificate on behalf of the other Finance Parties and the Borrower immediately on its receipt of the same pursuant to Clause 14.4.

14.6 NOTIFICATION The Agent shall promptly notify the other Finance Parties, the Transferee and the Borrower on the execution by it of any Transfer Certificate together with details of the amount transferred, the Transfer Date and the parties to such transfer.

51

15 PAYMENTS, MANDATORY PREPAYMENT, RESERVE REQUIREMENTS AND ILLEGALITY

15.1 PAYMENTS All amounts payable by the Borrower under or pursuant to any of the Security Documents shall be paid to such accounts at such banks as the Agent may from time to time direct to the Borrower and shall be paid in Dollars in same day funds (or such funds as are required by the authorities in the United States of America for settlement of international payments for immediate value). Payments shall be deemed to have been received by the Agent on the date on which the Agent receives authenticated advice of receipt, unless that advice is received by the Agent on a day other than a Business Day or at a time of day (whether on a Business Day or not) when the Agent in its reasonable discretion considers that it is impossible or impracticable for the Agent to utilise the amount received for value that same day, in which event the payment in question shall be deemed to have been received by the Agent on the Business Day next following the date of receipt of advice by the Agent.

15.2 NO DEDUCTIONS OR WITHHOLDINGS All payments (whether of principal or interest or otherwise) to be made by the Borrower pursuant to the Security Documents shall, subject only to Clause 15.3, be made free and clear of and without deduction for or on account of any Taxes or other deductions, withholdings, restrictions, conditions or counterclaims of any nature, and the Borrower will not claim any equity in respect of any payment due from it to the Banks or to the Agent under or in relation to any of the Security Documents.

15.3 GROSSING-UP If at any time any law requires (or is interpreted to require) the Borrower to make any deduction or withholding from any payment, or to change the rate or manner in which any required deduction or withholding is made, the Borrower will promptly notify the Agent and, simultaneously with making that payment, will pay to the Agent whatever additional amount (after taking into account any additional Taxes on, or deductions or withholdings from, or restrictions or conditions on, that additional amount) is necessary to ensure that, after making the deduction or withholding, the Agent and the Banks receive a net sum equal to the sum which they would have received had no deduction or withholding been made.

15.4 EVIDENCE OF DEDUCTIONS If at any time the Borrower is required by law to make any deduction or withholding from any payment to be made by it pursuant to any

52

of the Security Documents, the Borrower will pay the amount required to be deducted or withheld to the relevant authority within the time allowed under the applicable law and will, no later than thirty days after making that payment, deliver to the Agent an original receipt issued by the relevant authority, or other evidence reasonably acceptable to the Agent, evidencing the payment to that authority of all amounts required to be deducted or withheld. If the Borrower makes any deduction or withholding from any payment under or pursuant to any of the Security Documents, and a Bank subsequently receives a refund or allowance from any tax authority which that Bank at its sole discretion identifies as being referable to that deduction or withholding, that Bank shall, as soon as reasonably practicable, pay to the Borrower an amount equal to the amount of the refund or allowance received, if and to the extent that it may do so without prejudicing its right to retain that refund or allowance and without putting itself in any worse financial position than that in which it would have been had the deduction or withholding not been required to have been made. Nothing in this Clause shall be interpreted as imposing any obligation on any Bank unless requested by the Borrower to apply for any refund or allowance nor as restricting in any way the manner in which any Bank organises its tax affairs, nor as imposing on any Bank any obligation to disclose to the Borrower any information regarding its tax affairs or tax computations. All costs and expenses incurred by any Bank in obtaining or seeking to obtain a refund or allowance from any tax authority pursuant to this Clause shall be for the Borrower's account.

15.5 ADJUSTMENT OF DUE DATES If any payment to be made under any of the Security Documents, other than a payment of interest on the Facility, shall be due on a day which is not a Business Day, that payment shall be made on the next succeeding Business Day (unless the next succeeding Business Day falls in the next calendar month in which event the payment shall be made on the next preceding Business Day). Any such variation of time shall be taken into account in computing any interest in respect of that payment.

15.6 CHANGE IN LAW If, by reason of the introduction of any law, or any change in any law, or the interpretation or administration of any law, or in compliance with any request or requirement from any central bank or any fiscal, monetary or other authority:-

53

15.6.1 any Finance Party (or the holding company of any Finance Party) shall be subject to any Tax with respect to payments of all or any part of the Indebtedness; or

15.6.2 the basis of Taxation of payments to any Finance Party in respect of all or any part of the Indebtedness shall be changed; or

15.6.3 any reserve requirements shall be imposed, modified or deemed applicable against assets held by or deposits in or for the account of or loans by any branch of any Finance Party or its direct or indirect holding company; or

15.6.4 any ratio (whether cash, capital adequacy, liquidity or otherwise) which any Finance Party or its direct or indirect holding company is required or requested to maintain shall be affected; or

15.6.5 there is imposed on any Finance Party (or on the direct or indirect holding company of any Finance Party) any other condition in relation to the Indebtedness or the Security Documents;

and the result of any of the above shall be to increase the cost to any Bank (or to the direct or indirect holding company of any Bank) of that Bank making or maintaining its Commitment or its Drawing, or to cause any Finance Party to suffer (in its reasonable opinion) a material reduction in the rate of return on its overall capital below the level which it reasonably anticipated at the date of this Agreement and which it would have been able to achieve but for its entering into this Agreement and/or performing its obligations under this Agreement, the Finance Party affected shall notify the Agent and, on demand to the Borrower by the Agent, the Borrower shall from time to time pay to the Agent for the account of the Finance Party affected the amount which shall compensate that Finance Party or the Agent (or the relevant holding company) for such additional cost or reduced return. A certificate signed by an authorised signatory of the Agent or of the Finance Party affected setting out the amount of that payment and the basis of its calculation shall be submitted to the Borrower and shall be conclusive evidence of such amount save for manifest error or on any question of law.

15.7 ILLEGALITY AND IMPRACTICALITY Notwithstanding anything contained in the Security Documents, the obligations of a Bank to advance or maintain its

54

Commitment shall terminate in the event that a change in any law or in the interpretation of any law by any authority charged with its administration shall make it unlawful for that Bank to advance or maintain its Commitment. In such event the Bank affected shall notify the Agent and the Agent shall, by written notice to the Borrower, declare that Bank's obligations to be immediately terminated. If all or any part of the Facility shall have been advanced by the Banks to the Borrower, the portion of the Indebtedness (including all accrued interest) advanced by the Bank so affected shall be prepaid within thirty days from the date of such notice. Clause 5.3 shall apply to that prepayment if it is made on a day other than the last day of an Interest Period. During that period, the affected Bank shall negotiate in good faith with the Borrower to find an alternative method or lending base in order to maintain the Facility.

15.8 CHANGES IN MARKET CIRCUMSTANCES If at any time a Bank determines (which determination shall be final and conclusive and binding on the Borrower) that, by reason of changes affecting the London Interbank market, adequate and fair means do not exist for ascertaining the rate of interest on the Facility or any part thereof pursuant to this Agreement:-

15.8.1 that Bank shall give notice to the Agent and the Agent shall give notice to the Borrower of the occurrence of such event; and

15.8.2 the Agent shall as soon as reasonably practicable certify to the Borrower in writing the effective cost to that Bank of maintaining its Commitment for such further period as shall be selected by that Bank and the rate of interest payable by the Borrower for that period; or, if that is not acceptable to the Borrower,

15.8.3 the Agent in accordance with instructions from that Bank and subject to that Bank's approval of any agreement between the Agent and the Borrower, will negotiate with the Borrower in good faith with a view to modifying this Agreement to provide a substitute basis for that Bank's Commitment which is financially a substantial equivalent to the basis provided for in this Agreement.

If, within thirty days of the giving of the notice referred to in Clause 15.8.1, the Borrower and the Agent fail to agree in writing on a substitute basis for such Bank's Commitment the Borrower will immediately prepay the amount of such

55

Bank's Commitment and the Maximum Facility Amount will automatically decrease by the amount of such Commitment and such decrease shall not be reversed. Clause 5.3 shall apply to that prepayment if it is made on a day other than the last day of an Interest Period.

15.9 NON-AVAILABILITY OF CURRENCY If a Bank is for any reason unable to obtain Dollars in the London Interbank market and is, as a result, or as a result of any other contingency affecting the London Interbank market, unable to advance or maintain its Commitment in Dollars, that Bank shall give notice to the Agent and the Agent shall give notice to the Borrower and that Bank's obligations to make the Facility available shall immediately cease. In that event, if all or any part of the Facility shall have been advanced by that Bank to the Borrower, the Agent in accordance with instructions from that Bank and subject to that Bank's approval of any agreement between the Agent and the Borrower, will negotiate with the Borrower in good faith with a view to establishing a mutually acceptable basis for funding the Facility or relevant part thereof from an alternative source. If the Agent and the Borrower have failed to agree in writing on a basis for funding the Facility or relevant part thereof from an alternative source by 11.00 a.m. on the second Business Day prior to the end of the then current relevant Interest Period, the Borrower will (without prejudice to its other obligations under or pursuant to this Agreement, including, without limitation, its obligation to pay interest on the Facility, arising on the expiry of the then relevant Interest Period) prepay the Indebtedness (or relevant part thereof) to the Agent on behalf of that Bank on the expiry of the then current relevant Interest Period.

16 COMMUNICATIONS

16.1 METHOD Except for Communications pursuant to Clause 9, which shall be made or given in accordance with Clause 9.20, any Communication may be given, delivered, made or served (as the case may be) under or in relation to this Agreement by letter or fax and shall be in the English language and sent addressed:-

16.1.1 in the case of any of the Finance Parties to the Agent at its address at the head of this Agreement (fax no: + 47 22 482 894) marked for the attention of: Credit Administration Shipping; and

56

16.1.2 in the case of the Borrower and/or the Guarantor to the Communications Address;

or to such other address or fax number as the Agent or the Borrower may designate for themselves by written notice to the others.

16.2 TIMING A Communication shall be deemed to have been duly given, delivered, made or served to or on, and received by a party to this Agreement:-

16.2.1 in the case of a fax when the sender receives one or more transmission reports showing the whole of the Communication to have been transmitted to the correct fax number;

16.2.2 if delivered to an officer of the relevant party or (in the case of the Borrower) left at the Communications Address at the time of delivery or leaving; or

16.2.3 if posted, at 9.00 a.m. on the third Business Day after posting by prepaid first class post.

Any Communication by fax shall be promptly confirmed in writing by post or hand delivery.

17 GENERAL INDEMNITIES

17.1 CURRENCY In the event of any Finance Party receiving or recovering any amount payable under any of the Security Documents in a currency other than the Currency of Account, and if the amount received or recovered is insufficient when converted into the Currency of Account at the date of receipt to satisfy in full the amount due, the Borrower shall, on the Agent's written demand, pay to the Agent such further amount in the Currency of Account as is sufficient to satisfy in full the amount due and that further amount shall be due to the Agent on behalf of the Finance Parties as a separate debt under this Agreement.

17.2 COSTS AND EXPENSES The Borrower will, within fourteen days of the Agent's written demand, reimburse the Agent (on behalf of each of the Finance Parties) for all reasonable out of pocket expenses including internal and external legal costs (including stamp duty, Value Added Tax or any similar or replacement tax if applicable) of and incidental to:-

57

17.2.1 the negotiation, syndication, preparation, execution and registration of the Security Documents (whether or not any of the Security Documents are actually executed or registered and whether or not all or any part of the Facility is advanced);

17.2.2 any amendments, addenda or supplements to any of the Security Documents (whether or not completed);

17.2.3 any other documents which may at any time be required by any Finance Party to give effect to any of the Security Documents or which any Finance Party is entitled to call for or obtain pursuant to any of the Security Documents; and

17.2.4 the exercise of the rights, powers, discretions and remedies of the Finance Parties under or pursuant to the Security Documents.

17.3 EVENTS OF DEFAULT The Borrower shall indemnify the Finance Parties from time to time on demand against all losses and costs incurred or sustained by any Finance Party as a consequence of any Event of Default, including (without limitation) any Break Costs.

17.4 FUNDING COSTS The Borrower shall indemnify the Finance Parties from time to time on demand against all losses and costs incurred or sustained by any Finance Party if, for any reason due to a default or other action by the Borrower, any Drawing is not advanced to the Borrower after the relevant Drawdown Notice has been given to the Agent, or is advanced on a date other than that requested in the Drawdown Notice, including (without limitation) any Break Costs.

17.5 PROTECTION AND ENFORCEMENT The Borrower shall indemnify the Finance Parties from time to time on demand against all losses, costs and liabilities which any Finance Party may from time to time sustain, incur or become liable for in or about the protection, maintenance or enforcement of the rights conferred on the Finance Parties by the Security Documents or in or about the exercise or purported exercise by the Finance Parties of any of the rights, powers, discretions or remedies vested in them under or arising out of the Security Documents, including (without limitation) any losses, costs and liabilities which any Finance Party may from time to time sustain, incur or become liable for by reason of any Finance Party being mortgagees of any Vessel, assignees of any Mortgage and/or

58

a lender to the Borrower, or by reason of any Finance Party being deemed by any court or authority to be an operator or controller, or in any way concerned in the operation or control, of any Vessel. No such indemnity will be given to a Finance Party where any such loss, cost or liability has occurred due to gross negligence or wilful misconduct on the part of that Finance Party; however this shall not affect the right of any other Finance Party to receive any such indemnity.

17.6 LIABILITIES OF FINANCE PARTIES The Borrower will from time to time reimburse the Finance Parties on demand for all sums which any Finance Party may pay on account of any of the Security Parties or in connection with any Vessel (whether alone or jointly or jointly and severally with any other person) including (without limitation) all sums which any Finance Party may pay or guarantees which any Finance Party may give in respect of the Insurances, any expenses incurred by any Finance Party in connection with the maintenance or repair of any Vessel or in discharging any lien, bond or other claim relating in any way to any Vessel, and any sums which any Finance Party may pay or guarantees which they may give to procure the release of any Vessel from arrest or detention.

17.7 TAXES The Borrower shall pay all Taxes to which all or any part of the Indebtedness or any of the Security Documents may be at any time subject and shall indemnify the Finance Parties on demand against all liabilities, costs, claims and expenses incurred in connection therewith, including but not limited to any such liabilities, costs, claims and expenses resulting from any omission to pay or delay in paying any such Taxes. The indemnity contained in this Clause shall survive the repayment of the Indebtedness.

18 MISCELLANEOUS

18.1 WAIVERS No failure or delay on the part of any Finance Party in exercising any right, power, discretion or remedy under or pursuant to any of the Security Documents, nor any actual or alleged course of dealing between any Finance Party and any of the Security Parties, shall operate as a waiver of, or acquiescence in, any default on the part of any Security Party, unless expressly agreed to do so in writing by the Agent, nor shall any single or partial exercise by any Finance Party of any right, power, discretion or remedy preclude any other or further exercise of that right, power, discretion or remedy, or the exercise by a Finance Party of any other right, power, discretion or remedy.

59

18.2 NO ORAL VARIATIONS No variation or amendment of any of the Security Documents shall be valid unless in writing and signed on behalf of the Agent and the relevant Security Party.

18.3 SEVERABILITY If at any time any provision of any of the Security Documents is invalid, illegal or unenforceable in any respect that provision shall be severed from the remainder and the validity, legality and enforceability of the remaining provisions shall not be affected or impaired in any way.

18.4 SUCCESSORS ETC. The Security Documents shall be binding on the Security Parties and on their successors and permitted transferees and assignees, and shall inure to the benefit of the Finance Parties and their respective successors, transferees and assignees. The Borrower may not assign or transfer any of its rights or duties under or pursuant to any of the Security Documents without the prior written consent of the Banks.

18.5 FURTHER ASSURANCE If any provision of the Security Documents shall be invalid or unenforceable in whole or in part by reason of any present or future law or any decision of any court, or if the documents at any time held by the Finance Parties on their behalf are considered by the Banks for any reason insufficient to carry out the terms of this Agreement, then from time to time the Borrower will promptly, on demand by the Agent, execute or procure the execution of such further documents as in the reasonable opinion of the Banks are necessary to provide adequate security for the repayment of the Indebtedness.

18.6 OTHER ARRANGEMENTS The Finance Parties may, without prejudice to their rights under or pursuant to the Security Documents, at any time and from time to time, on such terms and conditions as they may in their discretion determine, and without notice to the Borrower, grant time or other indulgence to, or compound with, any other person liable (actually or contingently) to the Finance Parties or any of them in respect of all or any part of the Indebtedness, and may release or renew negotiable instruments and take and release securities and hold funds on realisation or suspense account without affecting the liabilities of the Borrower or the rights of the Finance Parties under or pursuant to the Security Documents.

18.7 ADVISERS The Borrower irrevocably authorises the Agent, at any time and from time to time during the Facility Period, to consult insurance advisers on any matters relating to the Insurances, including, without limitation, the collection of

60

insurance claims, and from time to time to consult or retain advisers or consultants to monitor or advise on any other claims relating to the Vessels. The Borrower will provide such advisers and consultants with all information and documents which they may from time to time reasonably require and will reimburse the Agent on demand for all reasonable costs and expenses incurred by the Agent in connection with the consultation or retention of such advisers or consultants.

18.8 DELEGATION The Finance Parties may at any time and from time to time delegate to any person any of their rights, powers, discretions and remedies pursuant to the Security Documents, other than rights relating to actions to be taken by the Majority Banks or the Banks as a group on such terms as they may consider appropriate (including the power to sub-delegate).

18.9 RIGHTS ETC. CUMULATIVE Every right, power, discretion and remedy conferred on the Finance Parties under or pursuant to the Security Documents shall be cumulative and in addition to every other right, power, discretion or remedy to which they may at any time be entitled by law or in equity. The Finance Parties may exercise each of their rights, powers, discretions and remedies as often and in such order as they deem appropriate subject to obtaining the prior written consent of the Majority Banks. The exercise or the beginning of the exercise of any right, power, discretion or remedy shall not be interpreted as a waiver of the right to exercise any other right, power, discretion or remedy either simultaneously or subsequently.

18.10 NO ENQUIRY The Finance Parties shall not be concerned to enquire into the powers of the Security Parties or of any person purporting to act on behalf of any of the Security Parties, even if any of the Security Parties or any such person shall have acted in excess of their powers or if their actions shall have been irregular, defective or informal, whether or not any Finance Parties had notice thereof.

18.11 CONTINUING SECURITY The security constituted by the Security Documents shall be continuing and shall not be satisfied by any intermediate payment or satisfaction until the Indebtedness shall have been repaid in full and none of the Finance Parties shall be under any further actual or contingent liability to any third party in relation to the Vessels, the Insurances, Earnings or Requisition Compensation or any other matter referred to in the Security Documents.

61

18.12 SECURITY CUMULATIVE The security constituted by the Security Documents shall be in addition to any other security now or in the future held by the Finance Parties or any of them for or in respect of all or any part of the Indebtedness, and shall not merge with or prejudice or be prejudiced by any such security or any other contractual or legal rights of any of the Finance Parties, nor affected by any irregularity, defect or informality, or by any release, exchange or variation of any such security. Section 93 of the Law of Property Act 1925 and all provisions which the Agent considers analogous thereto under the law of any other relevant jurisdiction shall not apply to the security constituted by the Security Documents.

18.13 RE-INSTATEMENT If any Finance Party takes any steps to exercise any of its rights, powers, remedies or discretions pursuant to the Security Documents and the result shall be adverse to the Finance Parties, the Borrower and the Finance Parties shall be restored to their former positions as if no such steps had been taken.

18.14 NO LIABILITY None of the Finance Parties, nor any agent or employee of any Finance Party, nor any receiver and/or manager appointed by the Agent, shall be liable for any losses which may be incurred in or about the exercise of any of the rights, powers, discretions or remedies of the Finance Parties under or pursuant to the Security Documents nor liable as mortgagee in possession for any loss on realisation or for any neglect or default of any nature for which a mortgagee in possession might otherwise be liable unless such Finance Party's action constitutes gross negligence or wilful misconduct.

18.15 RESCISSION OF PAYMENTS ETC. Any discharge, release or reassignment by any of the Finance Parties of any of the security constituted by, or any of the obligations of any Security Party contained in, any of the Security Documents shall be (and be deemed always to have been) void if any act (including, without limitation, any payment) as a result of which such discharge, release or reassignment was given or made is subsequently wholly or partially rescinded or avoided by operation of any law, unless such Finance Party's action constitutes gross negligence or wilful misconduct.

18.16 SUBSEQUENT ENCUMBRANCES If the Agent receives notice of any subsequent Encumbrance (other than any Encumbrance permitted by the terms of this Agreement) affecting any Vessel or all or any part of the Insurances, Earnings or Requisition Compensation, the Agent may open a new account in its books for the

62

Borrower. If the Agent does not open a new account, then (unless the Encumbrance is permitted by the terms of this Agreement or the Agent gives written notice to the contrary to the Borrower) as from the time of receipt by the Agent of notice of such subsequent Encumbrance, all payments made to the Agent shall be treated as having been credited to a new account of the Borrower and not as having been applied in reduction of the Indebtedness.

18.17 RELEASES If any Finance Party shall at any time in its discretion release any party from all or any part of any of the Security Documents or from any term, covenant, clause, condition or obligation contained in any of the Security Documents, the liability of any other party to the Security Documents shall not be varied or diminished.

18.18 CERTIFICATES Any certificate or statement signed by an authorised signatory of the Agent purporting to show the amount of the Indebtedness (or any part of the Indebtedness) or any other amount referred to in any of the Security Documents shall, save for manifest error or on any question of law, be conclusive evidence as against the Borrower of that amount.

18.19 SURVIVAL OF REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES The representations and warranties on the part of the Borrower contained in this Agreement shall survive the execution of this Agreement and the advance of the Facility or any part thereof.

18.20 COUNTERPARTS This Agreement may be executed in any number of counterparts each of which shall be original but which shall together constitute the same instrument.

18.21 THIRD PARTY RIGHTS Notwithstanding the provisions of the Contracts (Rights of Third Parties) Act 1999, no term of this Agreement is enforceable by a person who is not a party to it.

19 LAW AND JURISDICTION

19.1 GOVERNING LAW This Agreement shall in all respects be governed by and interpreted in accordance with English law.

19.2 JURISDICTION For the exclusive benefit of the Finance Parties, the parties to this Agreement irrevocably agree that the courts of England are to have jurisdiction to settle any disputes which may arise out of or in connection with this Agreement

63

and that any Proceedings may be brought in those courts. The Borrower irrevocably waives any objection which it may now or in the future have to the laying of the venue of any Proceedings in any court referred to in this Clause, and any claim that those Proceedings have been brought in an inconvenient or inappropriate forum.

19.3 ALTERNATIVE JURISDICTIONS Nothing contained in this Clause shall limit the right of the Finance Parties to commence any Proceedings against the Borrower in any other court of competent jurisdiction nor shall the commencement of any Proceedings against the Borrower in one or more jurisdictions preclude the commencement of any Proceedings in any other jurisdiction, whether concurrently or not.

19.4 SERVICE OF PROCESS Without prejudice to the right of the Finance Parties to use any other method of service permitted by law, the Borrower irrevocably agrees that any writ, notice, judgment or other legal process shall be sufficiently served on it if addressed to it and left at or sent by post to the Address for Service, and in that event shall be conclusively deemed to have been served at the time of leaving or, if posted, at 9.00 a.m. on the third Business Day after posting by prepaid first class registered post.

IN WITNESS of which the parties to this Agreement have executed this Agreement the day and year first before written.

64

SIGNED by )
duly authorised for and on behalf )

of DNB NOR BANK ASA               )
(as the Agent)                    )
in the presence of:-              )


SIGNED by                         )
duly authorised for and on behalf )
of CITIBANK N.A.                  )
(as a Bank)                       )
in the presence of:-              )


SIGNED by                         )
duly authorised for and on behalf )
of DNB NOR BANK ASA               )
(as a Bank)                       )
in the presence of:-              )


SIGNED by                         )
duly authorised for and on behalf )
of FORTIS CAPITAL CORP            )
(as a Bank)                       )
in the presence of:-              )


SIGNED by                         )
duly authorised for and on behalf )
of THE GOVERNOR AND COMPANY       )
OF THE BANK OF SCOTLAND           )
(as a Bank)                       )
in the presence of:-              )


SIGNED by                         )

duly authorised for and on behalf )
of HSBC BANK PLC )
(as a Bank) )
in the presence of:- )

65

SIGNED by )
duly authorised for and on behalf )

of HSH NORDBANK AG                )
(as a Bank)                       )
in the presence of:-              )


SIGNED by                         )
duly authorised for and on behalf )
of ING BANK N.V.                  )
(as a Bank)                       )
in the presence of:-              )


SIGNED by                         )
duly authorised for and on behalf )
of LLOYDS TSB BANK PLC            )
(as a Bank)                       )
in the presence of:-              )


SIGNED by                         )
duly authorised for and on behalf )
of NIBC BANK N.V.                 )
(as a Bank)                       )
in the presence of:-              )


SIGNED by                         )
duly authorised for and on behalf )
of NORDEA BANK NORGE ASA          )
GRAND CAYMAN BRANCH               )
(as a Bank)                       )
in the presence of:-              )


SIGNED by                         )

duly authorised for and on behalf )
of SCOTIABANK EUROPE PLC )
(as a Bank) )
in the presence of:- )

66

SIGNED by )
duly authorised for and on behalf )

of CALYON CORPORATE AND           )
INVESTMENT BANK                   )
(as a Bank)                       )
in the presence of:-              )


SIGNED by                         )
duly authorised for and on behalf )
of DANISH SHIP FINANCE A/S        )
(as a Bank)                       )
in the presence of:-              )


SIGNED by                         )
duly authorised for and on behalf )
of BAYERISCHE HYPO-UND            )
VEREINSBANK AG                    )
(as a Bank)                       )
in the presence of:-              )


SIGNED by                         )
duly authorised for and on behalf )
of DNB NOR BANK ASA               )
(as an Arranger)                  )
in the presence of:-              )


SIGNED by                         )
duly authorised for and on behalf )
of CITIGROUP GLOBAL               )
MARKETS LIMITED                   )
(as an Arranger)                  )
in the presence of:-              )

67

SIGNED by )
duly authorised for and on behalf )

of NORDEA BANK FINLAND PLC,       )
NEW YORK BRANCH                   )
(as an Arranger)                  )
in the presence of:-              )


SIGNED by                         )
duly authorised for and on behalf )
of DNB NOR BANK ASA               )
(as a Book Runner)                )
in the presence of:-              )


SIGNED by                         )
duly authorised for and on behalf )
of CITIGROUP GLOBAL               )
MARKETS LIMITED                   )
(as a Book Runner)                )
in the presence of:-              )


SIGNED by                         )

duly authorised for and on behalf )
of NORSK TEEKAY HOLDINGS LTD )
in the presence of:- )

68

(This is the form of the amended and restated facility agreement dated 26 June 2003 as further amended and restated on the Effective Date (as defined in the deed of consent and amendment and restatement dated 5 October 2006 to which this is an appendix)

DATED 26 JUNE 2003

NORSK TEEKAY HOLDINGS LTD
(AS BORROWER)

- AND -

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED
DNB NOR BANK ASA
AND
NORDEA BANK FINLAND PLC, NEW YORK BRANCH
(AS MANDATED LEAD ARRANGERS)

- AND -

DNB NOR BANK ASA
AND OTHERS
(AS BANKS)

- AND -

CITIGROUP GLOBAL MARKETS LIMITED
AND
DNB NOR BANK ASA
(AS BOOK RUNNERS)

- AND -

DNB NOR BANK ASA
(AS FACILITY AGENT AND SECURITY TRUSTEE)


FURTHER AMENDED AND RESTATED
US$550,000,000 SECURED
REDUCING REVOLVING LOAN
FACILITY AGREEMENT


STEPHENSON HARWOOD
ONE, ST. PAUL'S CHURCHYARD
LONDON EC4M 8SH
TEL: 020 7329 4422
FAX: 020 7329 7100
REF: 819/822


CONTENTS

                                                                            PAGE
                                                                            ----
1  Definitions and Interpretation........................................     2
2  The Facility and its Purpose..........................................    16
3  Conditions Precedent and Subsequent...................................    22
4  Representations and Warranties........................................    25
5  Repayment and Prepayment..............................................    28
6  Interest..............................................................    29
7  Fees..................................................................    30
8  Security Documents....................................................    31
9  Agency and Trust......................................................    31
10 Covenants.............................................................    40
11 Earnings..............................................................    44
12 Events Of Default.....................................................    44
13 Set-Off and Lien......................................................    48
14 Assignment and Sub-Participation......................................    50
15 Payments, Mandatory Prepayment, Reserve Requirements and Illegality...    52
16 Communications........................................................    56
17 General Indemnities...................................................    57
18 Miscellaneous.........................................................    59
19 Law and Jurisdiction..................................................    63

SCHEDULE 1...............................................................    65
   The Banks, the Commitments and the Proportionate Shares...............    65

SCHEDULE 2...............................................................    68
   The Vessels...........................................................    68


SCHEDULE 3...............................................................    69
   TNOL Vessels..........................................................    69

SCHEDULE 4...............................................................    70
   Form of Transfer Certificate..........................................    70

SCHEDULE 5...............................................................    72
   Form of Drawdown Notice...............................................    72

SCHEDULE 6...............................................................    73
   Calculation of the Mandatory Cost.....................................    73

SCHEDULE 7...............................................................    76
   The Arrangers.........................................................    76

SCHEDULE 8...............................................................    77
   Schedule of Reductions................................................    77


Exhibit 10.7

LOAN AGREEMENT

DATED: 2ND OCTOBER 2006

BETWEEN:

(1) TEEKAY OFFSHORE OPERATING L.P., a limited partnership formed and existing under the laws of the Republic of the Marshall Islands whose registered office is at The Trust Company Complex, Ajeltake Island, PO Box 1405 Majuro, The Marshall Islands, MH96960 (the "BORROWER"); and

(2) the banks listed in Schedule 1, each acting through its office at the address indicated against its name in Schedule 1 (together the "LENDERS" and each a "LENDER"); and

(3) DNB NOR BANK ASA, acting as agent (in that capacity the "AGENT");

(4) DNB NOR BANK ASA, NORDEA BANK NORGE ASA, NEW YORK BRANCH and FORTIS CAPITAL CORP. acting as mandated lead arrangers (in that capacity each an "MLA" and together the "MLAS");

(5) DNB NOR BANK ASA and NORDEA BANK NORGE ASA, NEW YORK BRANCH acting as bookrunners (in that capacity each a "BOOKRUNNER" and together the "BOOKRUNNERS"); and

(6) DEUTSCHE SCHIFFSBANK AKTIENGESELLSCHAFT acting as security agent (in that capacity the "SECURITY AGENT").

WHEREAS:

Each of the Lenders has agreed to advance to the Borrower its Commitment (aggregating, with all the other Commitments, a revolving credit facility of up to nine hundred and forty million Dollars $940,000,000) for the general corporate purposes of the Borrower (including but not limited to the making of intercompany loans to its shareholders and/or unitholders and Subsidiaries).

IT IS AGREED as follows:

1 DEFINITIONS AND INTERPRETATION

1.1 In this Agreement:


"ADMINISTRATION" has the meaning given to it in paragraph 1.1.3 of the ISM Code.

"AFFILIATE" means, in relation to any entity, a Subsidiary of that entity, a Holding Company of that entity or any other Subsidiary of that Holding Company.

"APPROVED BROKERS" means H. Clarkson & Co. Ltd, Simpson Spence & Young Shipbrokers Ltd, Fearnley AS, R.S. Platou AS and P.F. Bassoe AS.

"ASSIGNMENTS" means the deeds of assignment of Insurances, Earnings and Requisition Compensation, the Charter Rights (if applicable) and of the benefit of any relevant Charterer's Assignment, in respect of each of the Vessels referred to in Clause 10.1.2 (each an "ASSIGNMENT").

"AUTHORISATION" means an authorisation, consent, approval, resolution, licence, exemption, filing, notarisation or registration.

"BAREBOAT CHARTERS" means the bareboat charters identified in Schedule 7 for certain of the Vessels only on the terms and subject to the conditions of which the relevant Charterer will bareboat charter its Vessel to the Bareboat Charterer.

"BAREBOAT CHARTERER" means in respect of certain Vessels either (i) FIC and Transpetro or (ii) Petrojarl Production as identified against the names of the relevant Vessels in Schedule 7.

"BORROWER'S ACCOUNTS" means the consolidated financial accounts of the Borrower to be provided to the Agent pursuant to Clause 12.1.

"BREAK COSTS" means all sums payable by the Borrower from time to time under Clause 8.3.

"BUSINESS DAY" means a day on which banks are open for business of a nature contemplated by this Agreement (and not authorised by law to close) in New York, London and any other financial centre which the Agent may reasonably consider appropriate for the operation of the provisions of this Agreement.

"CHARTER RIGHTS" in relation to a Vessel means all rights and benefits accruing to the Charterer of that Vessel under or pursuant to the relevant Bareboat Charter and not forming part of the Earnings.

2

"CHARTERER" in respect of certain Vessels only means either UNS or TKN as identified against the names of the relevant Vessels in Schedule 7.

"CHARTERER'S ASSIGNMENTS" means, in respect of NORDIC STAVANGER, NORDIC BRASILIA and NORDIC SPIRIT only, assignments by the relevant Charterer to the Owner of the Earnings and Charter Rights.

"COMMITMENT" means, in relation to a Lender, the aggregate amount of the Loan which that Lender agrees to advance to the Borrower as its several liability as indicated against the name of that Lender in Schedule 1 and/or, where the context permits, the amount of the Loan advanced by that Lender and remaining outstanding and "COMMITMENTS" means more than one of them.

"COMMITMENT COMMISSION" means the commitment commission to be paid by the Borrower to the Agent on behalf of the Lenders pursuant to Clause 9.1.

"COMMITMENT TERMINATION DATE" means the date being one (1) month before the Maturity Date or such later date as the Lenders may in their discretion agree.

"COMPLETION OF SYNDICATION" means that the Commitments have been fully syndicated in a manner acceptable to the MLAs, as conclusively certified in writing by the Agent.

"COMPLIANCE CERTIFICATE" means a certificate substantially in the form set out in Schedule 6.

"CURRENCY OF ACCOUNT" means, in relation to any payment to be made to a Finance Party under a Finance Document, the currency in which that payment is required to be made by the terms of that Finance Document.

"DEEDS OF COVENANTS" means the deeds of covenants referred to in Clause 10.1.1. (each a "DEED OF COVENANT").

"DEFAULT" means an Event of Default or any event or circumstance specified in Clause 13.1 which would (with the expiry of a grace period, the giving of notice, the making of any determination under the Finance Documents or any combination of any of the foregoing) be an Event of Default.

3

"DOC" means, in relation to the ISM Company, a valid Document of Compliance issued for the ISM Company by the Administration under paragraph 13.2 of the ISM Code.

"DOLLARS", "US$" and "$" each means available and freely transferable and convertible funds in lawful currency of the United States of America.

"DRAWDOWN DATE" means the date on which a Drawing is advanced under Clause 4.

"DRAWDOWN NOTICE" means a notice substantially in the form set out in Schedule 4.

"DRAWING" means any one amount advanced or to be advanced pursuant to a Drawdown Notice or, where the context permits, the amount advanced and for the time being outstanding and "DRAWINGS" means more than one of them.

"EARNINGS" in relation to a Vessel means all hires, freights, pool income and other sums payable to or for the account of the Owner or the relevant Charterer in respect of that Vessel including (without limitation) all remuneration for salvage and towage services, demurrage and detention moneys, contributions in general average, compensation in respect of any requisition for hire, and damages and other payments (whether awarded by any court or arbitral tribunal or by agreement or otherwise) for breach, termination or variation of any contract for the operation, employment or use of that Vessel.

"ENCUMBRANCE" means a mortgage, charge, assignment, pledge, lien, or other security interest securing any obligation of any person or any other agreement or arrangement having a similar effect.

"ENVIRONMENTAL AFFILIATE" means an agent or employee of the Owner or a person in a contractual relationship with the Owner in respect of the Vessel owned by it (including without limitation, the operation of or the carriage of cargo of such Vessel).

"ENVIRONMENTAL APPROVALS" means any present or future permit, licence, approval, ruling, variance, exemption or other authorisation required under the applicable Environmental Laws.

4

"ENVIRONMENTAL CLAIM" means any and all enforcement, clean-up, removal, administrative, governmental, regulatory or judicial actions, orders, demands or investigations instituted or completed pursuant to any Environmental Laws or Environmental Approvals together with any claims made by any third person relating to damage, contribution, loss or injury resulting from any Environmental Incident.

"ENVIRONMENTAL INCIDENT" means:

(a) any release of Environmentally Sensitive Material from a Vessel; or

(b) any incident in which Environmentally Sensitive Material is released from a vessel other than a Vessel and which involves a collision between a Vessel and such other vessel or some other incident of navigation or operation, in either case, in connection with which the relevant Vessel is actually or potentially liable to be arrested, attached, detained or injuncted and/or where any guarantor, any manager (or any sub-manager of such Vessel) or any of its officers, employees or other persons retained or instructed by it (or such sub-manager) are at fault or allegedly at fault or otherwise liable to any legal or administrative action; or

(c) any other incident in which Environmentally Sensitive Material is released otherwise than from such Vessel and in connection with which that Vessel is actually or potentially liable to be arrested and/or where any guarantor, any manager (or any sub-manager of the relevant Vessel) or any of its officers, employees or other persons retained or instructed by it (or such sub-manager) are at fault or allegedly at fault or otherwise liable to any legal or administrative action.

"ENVIRONMENTAL LAWS" means all present and future laws, regulations, treaties and conventions of any applicable jurisdiction which:

(a) have as a purpose or effect the protection of, and/or prevention of harm or damage to, the environment;

(b) relate to the carriage of Environmentally Sensitive Material or to actual or threatened releases of Environmentally Sensitive Material;

5

(c) provide remedies or compensation for harm or damage to the environment; or

(d) relate to Environmentally Sensitive Materials or health or safety matters.

"ENVIRONMENTALLY SENSITIVE MATERIAL" means (i) oil and oil products and (ii) any other waste, pollutant, contaminant or other substance (including any liquid, solid, gas, ion, living organism or noise) that may be harmful to human health or other life or the environment or a nuisance to any person or that may make the enjoyment, ownership or other territorial control of any affected land, property or waters more costly for such person to a material degree.

"EVENT OF DEFAULT" means any of the events or circumstances set out in Clause 13.1.

"EXECUTION DATE" means the date on which this Agreement is executed by each of the parties hereto.

"FACILITY" means the reducing revolving credit facility made available by the Lenders to the Borrower pursuant to this Agreement.

"FACILITY OUTSTANDINGS" means the total of all Drawings made at that time, to the extent not reduced by repayments, prepayments and voluntary reductions.

"FACILITY PERIOD" means the period beginning on the date of this Agreement and ending on the date when the whole of the Indebtedness has been repaid in full and the Security Parties have ceased to be under any further actual or contingent liability to the Finance Parties under or in connection with the Finance Documents.

"FEE LETTER" means the letters dated 30 August 2006 between the Borrower and the Agent and/or the Bookrunners and/or the MLAs as applicable setting out any of the fees referred to in Clause 9.

"FIC" means Fronape International Company of P.O. Box 714, Georgetown, Grand Cayman, Cayman Islands.

6

"FINANCE DOCUMENTS" means this Agreement, the Security Documents, any Fee Letter and any other document designated as such by the Agent and the Borrower and "FINANCE DOCUMENT" means any one of them.

"FINANCE PARTIES" means the Agent, the Security Agent, the MLAs, the Bookrunners and the Lenders and "FINANCE PARTY" means any one of them.

"FIRST DRAWDOWN DATE" means the date on which the first Drawing is advanced under Clause 4.

"FREE LIQUIDITY" means cash, cash equivalents and marketable securities of maturities less than one (1) year to which the Group shall have free, immediate and direct access each as reflected in the Borrower's most recent quarterly management accounts forming part of the Borrower's Accounts.

"GAAP" means generally accepted accounting principles in the United States of America.

"GROUP" means the Borrower and each of its Subsidiaries.

"GUARANTEE" means the guarantee and indemnity referred to in Clause 10.1.3.

"GUARANTOR" means the Owner and/or (where the context permits) any other person who shall at any time during the Facility Period give to the Lenders or to the Security Agent on their behalf a guarantee and/or indemnity for the repayment of all or part of the Indebtedness.

"HEAD CHARTER", in respect of NORDIC STAVANGER, NORDIC BRASILIA and NORDIC SPIRIT only, means the charter between the Owner and the relevant Charterer.

"HOLDING COMPANY" means, in relation to any entity, any other entity in respect of which it is a Subsidiary.

"INDEBTEDNESS" means the aggregate from time to time of: the amount of the Loan outstanding; all accrued and unpaid interest on the Loan; and all other sums of any nature (together with all accrued and unpaid interest on any of those sums) which from time to time may be payable by the Borrower to any of the Finance Parties under all or any of the Finance Documents.

7

"INITIAL VESSELS" means the Vessels listed in Schedule 7 Part 1 and everything now or in the future belonging to them on board and ashore (each an "INITIAL VESSEL").

"INSURANCES" in relation to a Vessel means all policies and contracts of insurance (including all entries in protection and indemnity or war risks associations) which are from time to time taken out or entered into in respect of or in connection with that Vessel or her increased value and (where the context permits) all benefits under such contracts and policies, including all claims of any nature and returns of premium.

"INTEREST PAYMENT DATE" means each date for the payment of interest in accordance with Clause 7.7.

"INTEREST PERIOD" means each period for the payment of interest selected by the Borrower or agreed by the Agent pursuant to Clause 7.

"ISM CODE" means the International Management Code for the Safe Operation of Ships and for Pollution Prevention.

"ISM COMPANY" means, at any given time, the company responsible for a Vessel's compliance with the ISM Code under paragraph 1.1.2 of the ISM Code.

"ISPS" CODE" means the International Ship and Port Facility Security Code.

"ISPS COMPANY" means, at any given time, the company responsible for a Vessel's compliance with the ISPS Code.

"ISSC" means a valid international ship security certificate for a Vessel issued under the ISPS Code.

"LAW" or "LAW" means any law, statute, treaty, convention, regulation, instrument or other subordinate legislation or other legislative or quasi-legislative rule or measure, or any order or decree of any government, judicial or public or other body or authority, or any directive, code of practice, circular, guidance note or other direction issued by any competent authority or agency (whether or not having the force of law).

"LIBOR" means:

8

(a) the applicable Screen Rate; or

(b) (if no Screen Rate is available for any Interest Period) the arithmetic mean of the rates (rounded upwards to four decimal places) as supplied to the Agent at its request quoted by the Reference Banks (or by two of them if one is unable to quote) to leading banks in the London interbank market,

at 11.00 a.m. London time two (2) Business Days before the first day of the relevant Interest Period for the offering of deposits in Dollars in an amount comparable to the Loan (or any relevant part of the Loan) and for a period comparable to the relevant Interest Period.

"LOAN" means the aggregate amount advanced or to be advanced by the Lenders to the Borrower under Clause 4 or, where the context permits, the amount advanced and for the time being outstanding.

"MAJORITY LENDERS" means a Lender or Lenders whose Commitments aggregate more than sixty six and two thirds per cent (66 2/3%) of the aggregate of all the Commitments.

"MANAGEMENT AGREEMENT" means any agreement(s) for the commercial and/or technical management of the Vessels entered into between the Owner and a company which is not controlled either by Teekay Shipping Corporation or the Borrower.

"MANAGERS" in relation to each Vessel means a management company which is controlled by Teekay Shipping Corporation or such other commercial and/or technical managers of the Vessels nominated by the Borrower as the Agent acting on the instructions of the Majority Lenders may approve such approval not to be unreasonably withheld or delayed.

"MANDATORY COST" means the percentage rate per annum calculated by the Agent in accordance with Schedule 3.

"MARGIN" means nought point six two five per cent (0.625%) per annum.

"MATERIAL ADVERSE EFFECT" means a material adverse change in, or a material adverse effect on:

9

(a) the financial condition, assets, prospects or business of any Security Party or on the consolidated financial condition, assets, prospects or business of the Group;

(b) the ability of any Security Party to perform and comply with its obligations under any Security Document or to avoid any Event of Default;

(c) the validity, legality or enforceability of any Security Document; or

(d) the validity, legality or enforceability of any security expressed to be created pursuant to any Security Document or the priority and ranking of any such security,

provided that, in determining whether any of the forgoing circumstances shall constitute such a material adverse change or material adverse effect for the purposes of this definition, the Finance Parties shall consider such circumstance in the context of (x) the Group taken as a whole and (y) the ability of the Borrower and the Guarantor to perform each of their obligations under the Security Documents.

"MATURITY DATE" means the earlier of (i) the date falling ninety six
(96) months after the First Drawdown Date and (ii) 31 October 2014.

"MATERIAL SUBSIDIARY" means:

any Subsidiary of the Borrower whose assets, as determined in accordance with GAAP and as shown from the most recent financial statements available to the Agent relating to it, as multiplied by the Relevant Percentage in respect of such Subsidiary, equal or exceed 10% of the aggregate value of the assets of the Group as determined in accordance with GAAP and as shown from the most recently available financial statements of the Group,

provided that:

(i) in respect of any Subsidiary of the Borrower, only the value of its assets as multiplied by the Relevant Percentage in respect of such

10

Subsidiary shall be taken into account in the computation of the value of the assets of the Group;

(ii) a statement by the auditors of the Borrower to the effect that, in their opinion, a Subsidiary of the Borrower is or is not or was or was not at any particular time a Material Subsidiary shall, in the absence of manifest error, be conclusive and binding on each of the parties to this Agreement.

"MAXIMUM AMOUNT" means

(i) prior to the Step-up Date, five hundred and twenty million Dollars ($520,000,000); and

(ii) on or after the Step-up Date, nine hundred and forty million Dollars ($940,000,000),

as reduced from time to time in accordance with Clause 3.4 and/or Clause 7.9.5.

THE "MLP" means Teekay Offshore Partners L.P.

"MORTGAGES" means the statutory mortgages referred to in Clause 10.1.1 together with the Deeds of Covenants.

"NECESSARY AUTHORISATIONS" means all Authorisations of any person including any government or other regulatory authority required by applicable Law to enable it to:

(a) lawfully enter into and perform its obligations under the Security Documents to which it is party;

(b) ensure the legality, validity, enforceability or admissibility in evidence in England and, if different, its jurisdiction of incorporation, of such Security Documents to which it is party; and

(c) carry on its business from time to time.

"OWNER" means Teekay Navion Offshore Loading Pte Ltd, a company incorporated according to the law of Singapore with company registration no.

11

20041820N whose registered office is at 8 Shenton Way, #44-04 Temasek Tower, Singapore 068811 at all times to be a Subsidiary of the Borrower.

"PETROATLANTIC" means Petroatlantic L.L.C. of Trust Company Complex, Ajeltake Road, Ajeltake Island, Majuro, The Marshall Islands, MH96960.

"PETROL GEO" means Petroleum Geo Services ASA of Strandveien 50, Postboks 89, N-1324 Lysaker.

"PETROJARL PRODUCTION" means Petrojarl Production AS of Beddingen 16, 7405 Trondheim, Norway (formerly known as Golar-Nor Offshore AS).

"PETROJARL" means Petrojarl ASA of Beddingen 16, 7405 Trondheim, Norway.

"PETRONORDIC" means Petronordic LLC of Trust Company Complex, Ajelktake Road, Ajeltake Island, Majuro, The Marshall Islands, MH96960.

"PERMITTED ENCUMBRANCE" means (i) any Encumbrance which has the prior written approval of the Agent acting on the instructions of all the Lenders or (ii), or any liens for current crews' wages and salvage and liens incurred in the ordinary course of trading a Vessel up to an aggregate amount at any time not exceeding ten million Dollars ($10,000,000).

"PRE-APPROVED CLASSIFICATION SOCIETY" means any of Det norske Veritas, Lloyds Register, American Bureau of Shipping (ABS), Germanischer Lloyd or Bureau Veritas or such other classification society acceptable to the Majority Lenders.

"PRE-APPROVED FLAG" means Marshall Islands, Norwegian International Ship Registry, Liberia, Panama, Isle of Man, Cayman Islands, Bermuda, Bahamas, Singapore or (in the case of "NAVION STAVANGER", "NORDIC BRASILIA", "NORDIC SPIRIT" and any other Vessels on charter to Transpetro) Registro Especial Brasileiro

"PROPORTIONATE SHARE" means, at any time, the proportion which a Lender's Commitment (whether or not advanced) then bears to the aggregate Commitments of all the Lenders (whether or not advanced) being on the Execution Date the percentage indicated against the name of that Lender in Schedule 1.

12

"QUIET ENJOYMENT LETTERS" means those letters between the Agent and the Bareboat Charterer relating to those Vessels subject to Bareboat Charters.

"REDUCTION DATE" means each date falling at consecutive six monthly intervals after the earlier to occur of (i) the First Drawdown Date and (ii) 31 October 2006.

"REFERENCE BANKS" means, in relation to LIBOR, the principal London offices of each of the MLAs or such other banks as may be appointed by the Agent in consultation with the Borrower.

"RELEVANT DOCUMENTS" means the Finance Documents, the Bareboat Charters, the Charterer's Assignments, the Quiet Enjoyment Letters and the Management Agreements.

"RELEVANT PERCENTAGE" means, in respect of any Subsidiary of the Borrower at any time, the percentage of the equity share capital or the partnership capital, as the case may be, of such Subsidiary which is beneficially owned (free from Encumbrances) by the Borrower at such time.

"RELEVANT REDUCTION AMOUNT" means, in respect of each Vessel, a figure equal to (x) a fraction in which (i) the numerator is the market value of such Vessel (based on the most recent Valuation) and (ii) the denominator is the aggregate market value of all the Vessels (based on the most recent Valuations) multiplied by (y) the Maximum Amount.

"REPLACEMENT VESSEL" means a vessel acceptable to the Agent acting on the instructions of the Majority Lenders.

"REQUISITION COMPENSATION" in relation to a Vessel means all compensation or other money which may from time to time be payable to the Owner as a result of that Vessel being requisitioned for title or in any other way compulsorily acquired (other than by way of requisition for hire).

"SAME DAY DRAWING", means, in respect of the first drawing only, a Drawing requested by the Borrower prior to 1600 hours (New York time) on the day before the First Drawdown Date and made by the Lenders on the First Drawdown Date.

"SCREEN RATE" means in relation to LIBOR, the British Bankers' Association Interest Settlement Rate for the relevant currency and period displayed on the

13

appropriate page of the Reuters page LIBOR 01 (or such other page or pages which replace(s) such page for the purposes of displaying offered rates of leading banks, for deposits in Dollars of amounts equal to the amount of the relevant Drawing for a period equal in length to the relevant Interest Period.

"SECURITY DOCUMENTS" means the Mortgages, the Deeds of Covenants, the Assignments, the Guarantee, or (where the context permits) any one or more of them and any other agreement or document which may at any time be executed by any person as security for the payment of all or any part of the Indebtedness and "SECURITY DOCUMENT" means any one of them.

"SECURITY PARTIES" means at any relevant time, the Borrower, the Guarantor and any other person who may at any time during the Facility Period be liable for, or provide security for, all or any part of the Indebtedness (but for the avoidance of doubt shall not include the Charterer or Bareboat Charterer), and "SECURITY PARTY" means any one of them.

"SMC" means a valid safety management certificate issued for a Vessel by or on behalf of the Administration under paragraph 13.7 of the ISM Code.

"SMS" means a safety management system for a Vessel developed and implemented in accordance with the ISM Code.

"STEP-UP DATE" means the date on which the Agent confirms that both
(i) all of the conditions set out in Part III of Schedule 2 have been satisfied and (ii) Completion of Syndication has occurred.

"STEP-UP VESSELS" means the Vessels listed in Schedule 7 Part II and everything now or in the future belonging to them on board and ashore (each a "STEP-UP VESSEL").

"SUBSIDIARY" means a subsidiary undertaking, as defined in section 736 Companies Act 1985 or any analogous definition under any other relevant system of law.

"TAX" means any tax, levy, impost, duty or other charge or withholding of a similar nature (including any penalty or interest payable in connection with any

14

failure to pay or any delay in paying any of the same) and "TAXATION" shall be interpreted accordingly.

"TKN" means Teekay Norway AS of Verven 4, N-4014, P.O. Box 8035, N-4068, Stavanger, Norway.

"TOTAL DEBT" means the aggregate of:-

(a) the amount calculated in accordance with GAAP shown as each of "long term debt", "short term debt" and "current portion of long term debt" on the latest consolidated balance sheet of the Borrower; and

(b) the amount of any liability in respect of any lease or hire purchase contract entered into by the Borrower or any of its Subsidiaries which would, in accordance with GAAP, be treated as a finance or capital lease (excluding any amounts applicable to leases to the extent that the lease obligations are secured by a security deposit which is held on the balance sheet under "RESTRICTED CASH").

"TOTAL LOSS" in relation to a Vessel means:

(a) an actual, constructive, arranged, agreed or compromised total loss of that Vessel; or

(b) the requisition for title or compulsory acquisition, nationalisation or expropriation of that Vessel by or on behalf of any government or other authority (other than by way of requisition for hire); or

(c) the capture, seizure, arrest, detention or confiscation of that Vessel unless the Vessel is released and returned to the possession of the Owner within ninety (90) days after the capture, seizure, arrest, detention or confiscation in question.

"TRANSFER CERTIFICATE" means a certificate substantially in the form set out in Schedule 5 or any other form agreed between the Agent and the Borrower.

"TRANSFER DATE" means, in relation to any Transfer Certificate, the date for the making of the Transfer specified in the schedule to such Transfer Certificate.

15

"TRANSPETRO" means Petrobras Transporte S.A. - Transpetro of Av Presidente Vargas, 328, 20091-060 Rio de Janeiro, R.J. Brazil.

"TRUST PROPERTY" means:

(a) all benefits derived by the Security Agent from Clause 10; and

(b) all benefits arising under (including, without limitation, all proceeds of the enforcement of) each of the Security Documents,

with the exception of any benefits arising solely for the benefit of the Security Agent.

"UNS" means Ugland Nordic Shipping AS of P.O. Box 54, 3201 Sandefjord, Norway a company formed by the merger under Norwegian law of Ugland Nordic Investment AS and Ugland Nordic Shipping AS.

"VALUATION" means in relation to a Vessel or a Replacement Vessel, the written valuation of that Vessel or Replacement Vessel expressed in Dollars prepared by one of the Approved Brokers (or such other firm of reputable independent shipbrokers as may be acceptable to the Majority Lenders) to be nominated by the Borrower, such nomination to be subject to the approval of the Agent. Such valuations shall be prepared at the Borrower's expense, without a physical inspection, on the basis of a sale for prompt delivery for cash at arm's length between a willing buyer and a willing seller without the benefit of any charterparty or other engagement.

"VESSELS" means the vessels listed in Schedule 7 (comprising the Initial Vessels and the Step-up Vessels and including any Replacement Vessel) and everything now or in the future belonging to them on board and ashore (each a "VESSEL)".

"WSJ PRIME RATE" means the "Prime Rate" as published in the printed copy of the Wall Street Journal on any particular day as the same may be adjusted from time to time.

1.2 In this Agreement:

1.2.1 words denoting the plural number include the singular and vice versa;

16

1.2.2 words denoting persons include corporations, partnerships, associations of persons (whether incorporated or not) or governmental or quasi-governmental bodies or authorities and vice versa;

1.2.3 references to Recitals, Clauses and Schedules are references to recitals, clauses and schedules to or of this Agreement;

1.2.4 references to this Agreement include the Recitals and the Schedules;

1.2.5 the headings and contents page(s) are for the purpose of reference only, have no legal or other significance, and shall be ignored in the interpretation of this Agreement;

1.2.6 references to any document (including, without limitation, to all or any of the Relevant Documents) are, unless the context otherwise requires, references to that document as amended, supplemented, novated or replaced from time to time;

1.2.7 references to statutes or provisions of statutes are references to those statutes, or those provisions, as from time to time amended, replaced or re-enacted;

1.2.8 references to any Finance Party include its successors, transferees and assignees;

1.2.9 a time of day (unless otherwise specified) is a reference to New York time.

1.3 OFFER LETTER

This Agreement supersedes the terms and conditions contained in any correspondence relating to the subject matter of this Agreement exchanged between any Finance Party and the Borrower or their representatives prior to the date of this Agreement.

17

2 THE LOAN AND ITS PURPOSES

2.1 AMOUNT Subject to the terms of this Agreement, each of the Lenders agrees to make available to the Borrower its Commitment of a revolving credit in an aggregate amount not exceeding the Maximum Amount at any one time.

2.2 FINANCE PARTIES' OBLIGATIONS The obligations of each Finance Party under the Finance Documents are several. Failure by a Finance Party to perform its obligations under the Finance Documents does not affect the obligations of any other party to the Finance Documents. No Finance Party is responsible for the obligations of any other Finance Party under the Finance Documents.

2.3 PURPOSES The Borrower shall apply the Loan for the purpose referred to in the Recital.

2.4 MONITORING No Finance Party is bound to monitor or verify the application of any amount borrowed under this Agreement.

3 CONDITIONS OF UTILISATION

3.1 CONDITIONS PRECEDENT Before any Lender shall have any obligation to advance any Drawing under the Facility the Borrower shall deliver or cause to be delivered to or to the order of the Agent all of the documents and other evidence listed in Part I of Schedule 2.

3.2 FURTHER CONDITIONS PRECEDENT The Lenders will only be obliged to advance a Drawing if on the date of the Drawdown Notice and on the proposed Drawdown Date:

3.2.1 no Default is continuing or would result from the advance of that Drawing; and

3.2.2 the representations made by the Borrower under Clause 11 are true in all material respects.

3.3 DRAWING LIMIT The Lenders will only be obliged to advance a Drawing if:

3.3.1 no other Drawing has been made on the same Business Day;

18

3.3.2 that Drawing will not result in there being more than seven Drawings outstanding at any one time;

3.3.3 that Drawing is not less than five million Dollars ($5,000,000) and in an integral multiple of one million Dollars ($1,000,000); and

3.3.4 that Drawing will not increase the outstanding amount of the Loan to a sum in excess of the Maximum Amount.

The First Drawdown Date must occur on or before 31 October 2006 or such later date as the Majority Lenders shall agree.

3.4 FACILITY REDUCTION

3.4.1 The amount of the Facility available to the Borrower for drawing under this Agreement shall, subject to the provisions of Clause 3.4.5, be five hundred and twenty million Dollars ($520,000,000) prior to the Step-up Date and nine hundred and forty million Dollars ($940,000,000) during the period from the Step-up Date until the first Reduction Date. On the Reduction Dates the amount of the Facility available for drawing shall be reduced by the amounts set out in Schedule 8 (the "INITIAL REDUCTION AMOUNTS"). On the Maturity Date the Facility available shall be reduced to zero. Subject to the proviso hereto, the mandatory reductions in the amount of the Facility available for drawing required pursuant to this Clause will be made in the amounts and at the times specified whether or not the Maximum Amount is reduced pursuant to Clause 3.4.2, Clause 3.4.3, Clause 3.4.4, Clause 6.1 or Clause 7.9. PROVIDED ALWAYS THAT any reductions pursuant to Clause 3.4.2 (voluntary reductions), Clause 3.4.3 (sale) or Clause 3.4.4 (Total Loss) shall be applied to the remaining mandatory reductions hereunder on a pro rata basis.

3.4.2 The Borrower may voluntarily cancel the Maximum Amount in whole or in part in an amount of not less than five million Dollars ($5,000,000) such amount to be in integral multiples of one million Dollars ($1,000,000) (or as otherwise may be agreed by the Agent), provided that it has first given to the Agent not fewer than five (5) Business Days' prior written notice expiring on a Business Day (the "CANCELLATION DATE") of

19

its desire to reduce the Maximum Amount; such notice once received by the Agent shall be irrevocable and shall oblige the Borrower to make payment of all interest and Commitment Commission accrued on the amount so cancelled up to and including the Cancellation Date together with any Break Costs in respect of such cancelled amount if the Cancellation Date is not the final day of an Interest Period. Any such reduction in the Maximum Amount shall not be reversed. If, as a result of any such cancellation, the Loan outstanding would exceed the Maximum Amount, the Borrower shall, on the Cancellation Date, prepay such amount of the Loan as will ensure that the Loan outstanding is not greater than the Maximum Amount.

3.4.3 In the event of a sale or disposal of a Vessel or the Agent having received not less than 5 Business Days' notice from the Borrower requesting that the security relating to a Vessel be released and discharged (a "RELEASED VESSEL"), the Maximum Amount shall be reduced by the Relevant Reduction Amount applicable to that Vessel, such reduction to be applied on a pro rata basis against the Initial Reduction Amounts as reduced from time to time in accordance with this clause 3.4. Such reduction shall be made in the case of a sale or disposal of such Vessel on the date of such sale or disposal and in the case of a Released Vessel on the date proposed by the Borrower for release and discharge of the security relating to that Vessel unless the Vessel or Released Vessel in question is replaced on or prior to the sale, disposal or release with a Replacement Vessel and in such case of replacement any security held by the Agent (whether directly or indirectly) from the Owner and over such Vessel or Released Vessel is reconstituted immediately after the sale to the new owner or after the release and discharge of security (as the case may be) or over the Replacement Vessel in substantially identical form, and the Agent obtains favourable legal opinions in respect of such reconstituted security. If, as a result of any reduction in the Maximum Amount pursuant to this Clause, the Loan outstanding would exceed the Maximum Amount, the Borrower shall, on the date of the sale, disposal or replacement, prepay such amount of the Loan as will ensure that the Loan outstanding is not greater than the Maximum Amount. Any such prepayment shall oblige the Borrower to

20

make payment of all interest and Commitment Commission accrued on the amount so reduced up to and including the date of reduction together with any Break Costs in respect of such reduced amount if the date of such reduction is not the final day of an Interest Period. Any such reduction in the Maximum Amount shall not be reversed.

3.4.4 In the event that any Vessel becomes a Total Loss, on the earlier to occur of (a) the date of receipt of the proceeds of the Total Loss and (b) the date falling one hundred and eighty
(180) days after the occurrence of the Total Loss (the "REDUCTION DATE"), the Maximum Amount shall (subject to the proviso hereto) be reduced by the Relevant Reduction Amount in respect of such Vessel. Any such reductions in the Maximum Amount shall not be reversed. If, as a result of any reduction in the Maximum Amount pursuant to this Clause the Loan outstanding would exceed the Maximum Amount, the Borrower shall, on the earlier to occur of
(i) the date on which the Owner receives the proceeds of such Total Loss and (ii) the one hundred and eightieth day after the date of such Total Loss occurring, prepay such amount of the Loan as will ensure that the Loan outstanding is equal to or less than the Maximum Amount. Any such prepayment shall not be reborrowed and Clause 8.3 shall apply to any such prepayment. PROVIDED ALWAYS that if there is an investment in a Replacement Vessel on or prior to the Reduction Date, and a guarantee from the owner of the Replacement Vessel (in substantially the same form as the Guarantee or such other form as the Majority Lenders may require at that time) and security over such Replacement Vessel acceptable to the Majority Lenders in their absolute discretion is also executed and delivered either prior to or on the Reduction Date, then the reduction in the Maximum Amount shall not apply.

3.4.5 To the extent that repayments or prepayments made by the Borrower to the Agent in accordance with this Agreement reduce the Loan outstanding to less than the Maximum Amount, the Borrower shall again be entitled to make Drawings up to the Commitment Termination Date in accordance with and subject to the terms of this Agreement. Any part of the Facility which is undrawn on the Commitment Termination Date shall be automatically cancelled.

21

3.4.6 Simultaneously with each reduction of the Maximum Amount in accordance with Clause 3.4.1, Clause 3.4.2, Clause 3.4.3 or Clause 3.4.4 (as the case may be), the Commitment of each Lender will reduce so that the Commitments of the Lenders in respect of the reduced Maximum Amount remain in accordance with their respective Proportionate Shares.

3.5 TERMINATION DATE No Lender shall be under any obligation to advance all or any part of its Commitment after the Commitment Termination Date.

3.6 CONDITIONS SUBSEQUENT The Borrower undertakes to deliver or to cause to be delivered to the Agent:

3.6.1 on, or as soon as practicable after, the First Drawdown Date the additional documents and other evidence listed in Part II of Schedule 2; and

3.6.2 on, or as soon as practicable after, the Step-up Date the additional documents and other evidence listed in Part IV of Schedule 2.

3.7 NO WAIVER If the Lenders in their sole discretion agree to advance a Drawing to the Borrower before all of the documents and evidence required by Clause 3.1 have been delivered to or to the order of the Agent, the Borrower undertakes to deliver all outstanding documents and evidence to or to the order of the Agent no later than the date specified by the Agent.

The advance of all or any part of the Loan under this Clause 3.7 shall not be taken as a waiver of the Lenders' right to require production of all the documents and evidence required by Clause 3.1.

3.8 FORM AND CONTENT All documents and evidence delivered to the Agent under this Clause 3 shall:

3.8.1 be in form and substance reasonably acceptable to the Agent; and

3.8.2 if reasonably required by the Agent, be certified, notarised, legalised or attested in a manner acceptable to the Agent.

22

4 ADVANCE

4.1 DRAWDOWN REQUEST The Borrower may request a Drawing to be advanced in one amount on any Business Day prior to the Commitment Termination Date by delivering to the Agent a duly completed Drawdown Notice not more than ten (10) and not fewer than three (3) Business Days before the proposed Drawdown Date save in respect of a Same Day Drawing.

4.2 LENDERS' PARTICIPATION Subject to Clauses 2 and 3, the Agent shall promptly notify each Lender of the receipt of a Drawdown Notice, following which each Lender shall advance its Proportionate Share of the relevant Drawing to the Borrower through the Agent on the relevant Drawdown Date.

5 REPAYMENT

5.1 REPAYMENT OF EACH DRAWING The Borrower agrees to repay each Drawing to the Agent for the account of the Lenders on the last day of the Interest Period in respect of that Drawing unless the Borrower selects a further Interest Period for that Drawing in accordance with Clause 7 provided that the Borrower shall not be permitted to select such a further Interest Period if a Default has occurred and shall then be obliged to repay such Drawing on the last day of its then current Interest Period. The Borrower shall on the Maturity Date repay to the Agent as agent for the Lenders all Facility Outstandings.

5.2 REBORROWING Amounts of the Loan which are repaid or prepaid shall be available for reborrowing in accordance with Clause 3 prior to the Commitment Termination Date.

6 PREPAYMENT

6.1 ILLEGALITY If it becomes unlawful in any jurisdiction for a Lender to fund or maintain its Commitment as contemplated by this Agreement or to fund or maintain the Loan:

6.1.1 that Lender shall promptly notify the Agent of that event;

6.1.2 upon the Agent notifying the Borrower, the Commitment of that Lender (to the extent not already advanced) will be immediately cancelled; and

23

6.1.3 the Borrower shall repay that Lender's Proportionate Share of any Drawing on the last day of its current Interest Period or, if earlier, the date specified by that Lender in the notice delivered to the Agent and notified by the Agent to the Borrower (being no earlier than the last day of any applicable grace period permitted by law) and the Maximum Amount shall be reduced by the amount of that Lender's Commitment in the Loan. Prior to the date on which repayment is required to be made under this Clause 6.1.3 the affected Lender shall negotiate in good faith with the Borrower to find an alternative method or lending base in order to maintain the Facility.

6.2 VOLUNTARY PREPAYMENT OF LOAN The Borrower may prepay the whole or any part of a Drawing (but, if in part, being an amount that reduces that Drawing by a minimum amount of five million Dollars ($5,000,000)) provided that it gives the Agent not less than three (3) Business Days' prior notice.

6.3 RESTRICTIONS Any notice of prepayment given under this Clause 6 shall be irrevocable and, unless a contrary indication appears in this Agreement, shall specify the date or dates upon which the relevant prepayment is to be made and the amount of that prepayment.

Any prepayment under this Agreement shall be made together with accrued interest on the amount prepaid and, subject to any Break Costs, without premium or penalty.

If the Agent receives a notice under this Clause 6 it shall promptly forward a copy of that notice to the Borrower or the Lenders, as appropriate.

6.4 MANDATORY PREPAYMENT If at any time the Facility Outstandings shall exceed the Maximum Amount the Borrower shall immediately prepay to the Agent on behalf of the Lenders such amounts as will ensure that the Facility Outstandings do not exceed the Maximum Amount and shall pay to the Lenders all interest accrued on the amount prepaid up to and including the date on which such prepayment occurred.

24

7 INTEREST

7.1 INTEREST PERIODS The period during which each Drawing shall be outstanding under this Agreement shall be an Interest Period of one, three or six months' duration, as selected by the Borrower in the Drawdown Notice in respect of the Drawing in question, or such other duration as may be agreed by the Agent (acting on the instructions of all the Lenders). Not more than five one (1) month Interest Periods may be selected by the Borrower in each twelve (12) month period.

7.2 BEGINNING AND END OF INTEREST PERIODS The first Interest Period in respect of each Drawing shall begin on the Drawdown Date of that Drawing and shall end on the last day of the Interest Period selected in accordance with Clause 7.1. Any subsequent Interest Period selected in respect of each Drawing shall commence on the day following the last day of its previous Interest Period and shall end on the last day of its current Interest Period selected in accordance with Clause 7.1.

7.3 INTEREST PERIODS TO MEET MATURITY DATE If an Interest Period for a Drawing would otherwise expire after the Maturity Date, the Interest Period for that Drawing shall expire on the Maturity Date.

7.4 NON-BUSINESS DAYS If an Interest Period would otherwise end on a day which is not a Business Day, that Interest Period will instead end on the next Business Day in that calendar month (if there is one) or the preceding Business Day (if there is not).

7.5 INTEREST RATE During each Interest Period interest shall accrue on the relevant Drawing at the rate determined by the Agent to be

(i) the WSJ Prime Rate in the case of a Same Day Drawing; or

(ii) in all other cases the aggregate of (a) the Margin, (b) LIBOR and
(c) the Mandatory Cost, if applicable.

7.6 FAILURE TO SELECT INTEREST PERIOD If the Borrower at any time fails to select or agree an Interest Period in accordance with Clause 7.1, the interest rate applicable shall be three (3) months.

25

7.7 ACCRUAL AND PAYMENT OF INTEREST Interest shall accrue from day to day, shall be calculated on the basis of a 360 day year and the actual number of days elapsed (or, in any circumstance where market practice differs, in accordance with the prevailing market practice) and shall be paid by the Borrower to the Agent for the account of the Lenders on the last day of each Interest Period and, if the Interest Period is longer than three months, on the dates falling at three monthly intervals after the first day of that Interest Period.

7.8 DEFAULT INTEREST If the Borrower fails to pay any amount payable by it under a Finance Document on its due date, interest shall accrue on the overdue amount from the due date, subject to any applicable grace period, up to the date of actual payment (both before and after judgment) at a rate which is one point five per cent (1.5%) higher than the rate which would have been payable if the overdue amount had, during the period of non-payment, constituted a Drawing for successive Interest Periods, each selected by the Agent (acting reasonably). Any interest accruing under this Clause 7.8 shall be immediately payable by the Borrower on demand by the Agent. If unpaid, any such interest will be compounded with the overdue amount at the end of each Interest Period applicable to that overdue amount but will remain immediately due and payable.

7.9 CHANGES IN MARKET CIRCUMSTANCES If at any time the Agent determines (which determination shall be final and conclusive and binding on the Borrower) that, by reason of changes affecting the London interbank market, adequate and fair means do not exist for determining the rate of interest on a Drawing for any Interest Period:

7.9.1 the Agent shall give notice to the Lenders and the Borrower of the occurrence of such event; and

7.9.2 the rate of interest on each Lender's Commitment in the relevant Drawing for that Interest Period shall be the rate per annum which is the sum of:

(a) the Margin; and

(b) the rate notified to the Agent by that Lender as soon as practicable, and in any event before interest is due to be paid in respect of that Interest Period, to be that which expresses as a

26

percentage rate per annum the cost to that Lender of funding its Commitment in the relevant Drawing from whatever source it may reasonably select; and

(c) the Mandatory Cost, if any, applicable to that Lender's Commitment,

PROVIDED THAT if the resulting rate of interest on any Commitment is not acceptable to the Borrower:

7.9.3 the Agent on behalf of the Lenders will negotiate with the Borrower in good faith with a view to modifying this Agreement to provide a substitute basis for determining the rate of interest which is financially a substantial equivalent to the basis provided for in this Agreement;

7.9.4 any substitute basis agreed pursuant to Clause 7.9.3 shall be binding on all the parties to this Agreement and shall apply to all Commitments in the relevant Drawing; and

7.9.5 if, within thirty (30) days of the giving of the notice referred to in Clause 7.9.1, the Borrower and the Agent fail to agree in writing on a substitute basis for determining the rate of interest in respect of the relevant Drawing, the relevant Lender shall cease to be obliged to advance its Proportionate Share of that Drawing, but, if it has already been advanced, the Borrower will immediately prepay that Proportionate Share of that Drawing, together with any Break Costs, and the Maximum Amount shall be reduced by the amount of that Lender's Proportionate Share of that Drawing.

7.10 DETERMINATIONS CONCLUSIVE The Agent shall promptly notify the Borrower of the determination of a rate of interest under this Clause 7 and each such determination shall (save in the case of manifest error) be final and conclusive.

8 INDEMNITIES

8.1 TRANSACTION EXPENSES The Borrower will, within fourteen (14) days of the Agent's written demand, pay the Agent (for the account of the Finance Parties) the amount of all reasonable out of pocket costs and expenses (including legal fees

27

and Value Added Tax or any similar or replacement tax if applicable) reasonably incurred by the Finance Parties or any of them in connection with:

8.1.1 the negotiation, preparation, printing, execution and registration of the Finance Documents (whether or not any Finance Document is actually executed or registered and whether or not a Drawing is advanced);

8.1.2 any amendment, addendum or supplement to any Finance Document (whether or not completed); and

8.1.3 any other document which may at any time be required by a Finance Party to give effect to any Finance Document or which a Finance Party is entitled to call for or obtain under any Finance Document.

8.2 FUNDING COSTS The Borrower shall indemnify each Finance Party, by payment to the Agent (for the account of that Finance Party) on the Agent's written demand, against all losses and costs incurred or sustained by that Finance Party if, for any reason due to a default or other action by the Borrower, a Drawing is not advanced to the Borrower after the relevant Drawdown Notice has been given to the Agent, or is advanced on a date other than that requested in the Drawdown Notice.

8.3 BREAK COSTS The Borrower shall indemnify each Finance Party, by payment to the Agent (for the account of that Finance Party) on the Agent's written demand, against all documented costs, losses, premiums or penalties incurred by that Finance Party as a result of its receiving any prepayment of all or any part of a Drawing (whether pursuant to Clause 6 or otherwise) on a day other than the last day of an Interest Period for that Drawing, or any other payment under or in relation to the Finance Documents on a day other than the due date for payment of the sum in question, including (without limitation) any losses or costs incurred in liquidating or re-employing deposits from third parties acquired to effect or maintain all or any part of a Drawing, and any liabilities, expenses or losses incurred by that Finance Party in terminating or reversing, or otherwise in connection with, any interest rate and/or currency swap, transaction or arrangement entered into by that Finance Party with any member of the Group to hedge any exposure arising under this Agreement, or in terminating or reversing, or otherwise in connection with, any open position arising under this Agreement.

28

8.4 CURRENCY INDEMNITY In the event of a Finance Party receiving or recovering any amount payable under a Finance Document in a currency other than the Currency of Account, and if the amount received or recovered is insufficient when converted into the Currency of Account at the date of receipt to satisfy in full the amount due, the Borrower shall, on the Agent's written demand, pay to the Agent for the account of the relevant Finance Party such further amount in the Currency of Account as is sufficient to satisfy in full the amount due and that further amount shall be due to the Agent on behalf of the relevant Finance Party as a separate debt under this Agreement.

8.5 INCREASED COSTS (SUBJECT TO CLAUSE 8.6) If, by reason of the introduction of any law, or any change in any law, or any change in the interpretation or administration of any law, or compliance with any request or requirement from any central bank or any fiscal, monetary or other authority occurring after the date of this Agreement:

8.5.1 a Finance Party (or the holding company of a Finance Party) shall be subject to any Tax with respect to payment of all or any part of the Indebtedness (other than Tax on overall net income); or

8.5.2 the basis of Taxation of payments to a Finance Party in respect of all or any part of the Indebtedness shall be changed; or

8.5.3 any reserve requirements shall be imposed, modified or deemed applicable against assets held by or deposits in or for the account of or loans by any branch of a Finance Party; or

8.5.4 the manner in which a Finance Party allocates capital resources to its obligations under this Agreement or any ratio (whether cash, capital adequacy, liquidity or otherwise) which a Finance Party is required or requested to maintain shall be affected; or

8.5.5 there is imposed on a Finance Party (or on the holding company of a Finance Party) any other condition in relation to the Indebtedness or the Finance Documents;

and the result of any of the above shall be to increase the cost to a Finance Party (or to the holding company of a Finance Party) of that Finance Party making or

29

maintaining its Commitment, or to cause a Finance Party to suffer (in its opinion) a material reduction in the rate of return on its overall capital below the level which it reasonably anticipated at the date of this Agreement and which it would have been able to achieve but for its entering into this Agreement and/or performing its obligations under this Agreement, then, subject to Clause 8.6, the Finance Party affected shall notify the Agent and the Borrower shall from time to time pay to the Agent on demand for the account of that Finance Party the amount which shall compensate that Finance Party (or the relevant holding company) for such additional cost or reduced return. A certificate signed by an authorised signatory of that Finance Party setting out the amount of that payment and the basis of its calculation shall be submitted to the Borrower and shall be conclusive evidence of such amount save for manifest error or on any question of law.

8.6 EXCEPTIONS TO INCREASED COSTS Clause 8.5 does not apply to the extent any additional cost or reduced return referred to in that Clause is:

8.6.1 compensated for by a payment made under Clause 8.10; or

8.6.2 compensated for by a payment made under Clause 17.3; or

8.6.3 compensated for by the payment of the Mandatory Cost; or

8.6.4 attributable to the wilful breach by the relevant Finance Party (or the holding company of that Finance Party) of any law or regulation.

8.7 EVENTS OF DEFAULT The Borrower shall indemnify each Finance Party from time to time, by payment to the Agent (for the account of that Finance Party) on the Agent's written demand, against all losses and costs incurred or sustained by that Finance Party as a consequence of any Event of Default.

8.8 ENFORCEMENT COSTS The Borrower shall pay to the Agent (for the account of each Finance Party) on the Agent's written demand the amount of all costs and expenses (including legal fees) incurred by a Finance Party in connection with the enforcement of, or the preservation of any rights under, any Finance Document including (without limitation) any losses, costs and expenses which that Finance Party may from time to time sustain, incur or become liable for by reason of that Finance Party being mortgagee of a Vessel and/or a lender to the Borrower, or by reason of that Finance Party being deemed by any court or authority to be an

30

operator or controller, or in any way concerned in the operation or control, of a Vessel. No such indemnity will be given where any such loss or cost has occurred due to gross negligence or wilful misconduct on the part of that Finance Party; however, this shall not effect the right of any other Finance Party to receive such indemnity.

8.9 OTHER COSTS The Borrower shall pay to the Agent (for the account of each Finance Party) on the Agent's written demand the amount of all sums which a Finance Party may pay or become actually or contingently liable for on account of the Borrower in connection with a Vessel (whether alone or jointly or jointly and severally with any other person) including (without limitation) all sums which that Finance Party may pay or guarantees which it may give in respect of the Insurances, any expenses incurred by that Finance Party in connection with the maintenance or repair of a Vessel or in discharging any lien, bond or other claim relating in any way to a Vessel, and any sums which that Finance Party may pay or guarantees which it may give to procure the release of a Vessel from arrest or detention.

8.10 TAXES The Borrower shall pay all Taxes to which all or any part of the Indebtedness or any Finance Document may be at any time subject (other than Tax on a Finance Party's overall net income) and shall indemnify the Finance Parties, by payment to the Agent (for the account of the Finance Parties) on the Agent's written demand, against all liabilities, costs, claims and expenses resulting from any omission to pay or delay in paying any such Taxes.

9 FEES

9.1 COMMITMENT FEE The Borrower shall pay to the Agent (for the account of the Lenders in proportion to their Commitments) a fee computed at the rate of thirty two point five per cent (32.5%) of the Margin on the undrawn and uncancelled amount of the Maximum Amount from time to time from the date of this Agreement until the Commitment Termination Date. The accrued commitment fee is payable on the last day of each successive period of three months from the Execution Date and on the Commitment Termination Date.

9.2 OTHER FEES The Borrower shall pay to the Agent the fees in the amount and at the times agreed in a Fee Letter.

31

10 SECURITY AND APPLICATION OF MONEYS

10.1 SECURITY DOCUMENTS As security for the payment of the Indebtedness, the Borrower shall execute and deliver to the Security Agent or cause to be executed and delivered to the Security Agent the following documents in such forms and containing such terms and conditions as the Security Agent shall require:

10.1.1 a first priority statutory mortgage over each of the Vessels together with a collateral deed of covenants;

10.1.2 a first priority deed or deeds of assignment of the Insurances, Earnings, Charter Rights (if applicable) and Requisition Compensation of each of the Vessels, and of the benefit of any relevant Charterer's Assignment; and

10.1.3 an on demand guarantee and indemnity from the Guarantor;

10.2 REMITTANCE OF EARNINGS Immediately upon the occurrence of an Event of Default the Borrower shall procure that all Earnings are paid to such account(s) as the Agent shall from time to time specify by notice in writing to the Borrower.

10.3 GENERAL APPLICATION OF MONEYS Whilst an Event of Default is continuing unremedied and unwaived the Borrower irrevocably authorises the Agent and the Security Agent to apply all sums which either of them may receive:

10.3.1 pursuant to a sale or other disposition of a Vessel or any right, title or interest in the Vessel; or

10.3.2 by way of payment of any sum in respect of the Insurances, Earnings, Charter Rights or Requisition Compensation; or

10.3.3 otherwise arising under or in connection with any Security Document,

in accordance with Clause 3.4.3 or Clause 3.4.4 (if relevant) or otherwise in or towards satisfaction, or by way of retention on account, of the Indebtedness, as follows:-

(i) first in payment of all outstanding fees and expenses of the Agent and the Security Agent;

32

(ii) secondly in or towards payment of all outstanding interest hereunder;

(iii) thirdly in or towards payment of all outstanding principal hereunder;

(iv) fourthly in or towards payment of all other Indebtedness hereunder;

(v) fifthly the balance, if any, shall be remitted to the Borrower or whoever may be entitled thereto.

11 REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES

The Borrower represents and warrants to each of the Finance Parties at the Execution Date and (by reference to the facts and circumstances then pertaining) at the date of each Drawdown Notice, at each Drawdown Date and at each Interest Payment Date as follows (except that the representation and warranty contained at Clause 11.6 shall only be made on the First Drawdown Date and that the representations and warranties contained at Clause 11.2 and 11.21 shall only be made on the Execution Date):-

11.1 STATUS AND DUE AUTHORISATION Each of the Security Parties is a corporation or limited partnership duly incorporated or formed under the laws of its jurisdiction of incorporation, organisation or formation (as the case may be) with power to enter into the Security Documents and to exercise its rights and perform its obligations under the Security Documents and all corporate and other action required to authorise its execution of the Security Documents and its performance of its obligations thereunder has been duly taken.

11.2 NO DEDUCTIONS OR WITHHOLDING Under the laws of the Security Parties' respective jurisdictions of incorporation or formation in force at the date hereof, none of the Security Parties will be required to make any deduction or withholding from any payment it may make under any of the Security Documents.

11.3 CLAIMS PARI PASSU Under the laws of the Security Parties' respective jurisdictions of incorporation or formation in force at the date hereof, the Indebtedness will, to the extent that it exceeds the realised value of any security granted in respect of the Indebtedness, rank at least pari passu with all the Security Parties' other unsecured indebtedness save that which is preferred solely by any bankruptcy, insolvency or other similar laws of general application.

33

11.4 NO IMMUNITY In any proceedings taken in any of the Security Parties' respective jurisdictions of incorporation or formation in relation to any of the Security Documents, none of the Security Parties will be entitled to claim for itself or any of its assets immunity from suit, execution, attachment or other legal process.

11.5 GOVERNING LAW AND JUDGMENTS In any proceedings taken in any of the Security Parties' jurisdiction of incorporation or formation in relation to any of the Security Documents in which there is an express choice of the law of a particular country as the governing law thereof, that choice of law and any judgment or (if applicable) arbitral award obtained in that country will be recognised and enforced.

11.6 VALIDITY AND ADMISSIBILITY IN EVIDENCE As at the date hereof, all acts, conditions and things required to be done, fulfilled and performed in order (a) to enable each of the Security Parties lawfully to enter into, exercise its rights under and perform and comply with the obligations expressed to be assumed by it in the Security Documents, (b) to ensure that the obligations expressed to be assumed by each of the Security Parties in the Security Documents are legal, valid and binding and (c) to make the Security Documents admissible in evidence in the jurisdictions of incorporation or formation of each of the Security Parties, have been done, fulfilled and performed.

11.7 NO FILING OR STAMP TAXES Under the laws of the Security Parties' respective jurisdictions of incorporation or formation in force at the date hereof, it is not necessary that any of the Security Documents be filed, recorded or enrolled with any court or other authority in its jurisdiction of incorporation or formation (other than the Registrar of Companies for England and Wales or the relevant maritime registry, to the extent applicable) or that any stamp, registration or similar tax be paid on or in relation to any of the Security Documents.

11.8 BINDING OBLIGATIONS The obligations expressed to be assumed by each of the Security Parties in the Security Documents are legal and valid obligations, binding on each of them in accordance with the terms of the Security Documents and no limit on any of their powers will be exceeded as a result of the borrowings, granting of security or giving of guarantees contemplated by the Security Documents or the performance by any of them of any of their obligations thereunder.

34

11.9 NO WINDING-UP Neither the Borrower, the Guarantor nor any Material Subsidiary have taken any corporate or limited partnership action nor have any other steps been taken or legal proceedings been started or (to the best of the Borrower's knowledge and belief) threatened against the Borrower, the Guarantor or any Material Subsidiary for its winding-up, dissolution, administration or reorganisation or for the appointment of a receiver, administrator, administrative receiver, trustee or similar officer of it or of any or all of its assets or revenues which might have a material adverse effect on the business or financial condition of the Group taken as a whole.

11.10 SOLVENCY

11.10.1 Neither the Borrower, the Guarantor nor the Group taken as a whole is unable, or admits or has admitted its inability, to pay its debts or has suspended making payments in respect of any of its debts.

11.10.2 Neither the Borrower, the Guarantor nor any Material Subsidiary by reason of actual or anticipated financial difficulties, has commenced, or intends to commence, negotiations with one or more of its creditors with a view to rescheduling any of its indebtedness.

11.10.3 The value of the assets of each of the Borrower, the Guarantor and the Group taken as a whole is not less than the liabilities of such entity or the Group taken as a whole (as the case may be) (taking into account contingent and prospective liabilities).

11.10.4 No moratorium has been, or may, in the reasonably foreseeable future be, declared in respect of any indebtedness of the Borrower, the Guarantor or any Material Subsidiary.

11.11 NO MATERIAL DEFAULTS

11.11.1 Without prejudice to Clause 11.11.2, neither the Borrower, the Guarantor nor any Material Subsidiary is in breach of or in default under any agreement to which it is a party or which is binding on it or any of its assets to an extent or in a manner which might have a material adverse effect on the business or financial condition of the Group taken as a whole.

35

11.11.2 No Event of Default is continuing or might reasonably be expected to result from the advance of any Drawing.

11.12 NO MATERIAL PROCEEDINGS No action or administrative proceeding of or before any court, arbitral body or agency which is not covered by adequate insurance or which might have a material adverse effect on the business or financial condition of the Group taken as a whole has been started or is reasonably likely to be started.

11.13 BORROWER'S ACCOUNTS All financial statements relating to the Group required to be delivered under Clause 12.1, were each prepared in accordance with GAAP, give (in conjunction with the notes thereto) a true and fair view of (in the case of annual financial statements) or fairly represent (in the case of quarterly accounts) the financial condition of the Group at the date as of which they were prepared and the results of the Group's operations during the financial period then ended.

11.14 NO MATERIAL ADVERSE CHANGE Since the publication of the last financial statements relating to the Group delivered pursuant to Clause 12.1, there has been no change that has a Material Adverse Effect.

11.15 NO UNDISCLOSED LIABILITIES As at the date to which the Borrower's Accounts were prepared neither the Borrower, the Guarantor nor any Material Subsidiary had any material liabilities (contingent or otherwise) which were not disclosed thereby (or by the notes thereto) or reserved against therein nor any unrealised or anticipated losses arising from commitments entered into by it which were not so disclosed or reserved against therein.

11.16 NO OBLIGATION TO CREATE SECURITY The execution of the Security Documents by the Security Parties and their exercise of their rights and performance of their obligations thereunder will not result in the existence of nor oblige the Borrower or the Guarantor to create any Encumbrance over all or any of their present or future revenues or assets, other than pursuant to the Security Documents.

11.17 NO BREACH The execution of the Security Documents by each of the Security Parties and their exercise of their rights and performance of their obligations under any of the Security Documents do not constitute and will not result in any breach of any agreement or treaty to which any of them is a party.

36

11.18 SECURITY Each of the Security Parties is the legal and beneficial owner of all assets and other property which it purports to charge, mortgage, pledge, assign or otherwise secure pursuant to each Security Document and those Security Documents to which it is a party create and give rise to valid and effective security having the ranking expressed in those Security Documents.

11.19 NECESSARY AUTHORISATIONS The Necessary Authorisations required by each Security Party, are in full force and effect, and each Security Party is in compliance with the material provisions of each such Necessary Authorisation relating to it and, to the best of its knowledge, none of the Necessary Authorisations relating to it are the subject of any pending or threatened proceedings or revocation.

11.20 MONEY LAUNDERING Any amount borrowed hereunder, and the performance of the obligations of the Security Parties under the Security Documents, will be for the account of members of the Group and will not involve any breach by any of them of any law or regulatory measure relating to "money laundering" as defined in Article 1 of the Directive (91/308/EEC) of the Council of the European Communities.

11.21 DISCLOSURE OF MATERIAL FACTS The Borrower is not aware of any material facts or circumstances which have not been disclosed to the Agent and which might, if disclosed, have reasonably been expected to adversely affect the decision of a person considering whether or not to make loan facilities of the nature contemplated by this Agreement available to the Borrower.

11.22 USE OF FACILITY The Facility will be used for the purposes specified in the Recital.

11.23 REPRESENTATIONS LIMITED The representation and warranties of the Borrower in this Clause 11 are subject to:

11.23.1 the principle that equitable remedies are remedies which may be granted or refused at the discretion of the court;

11.23.2 the limitation of enforcement by laws relating to bankruptcy, insolvency, liquidation, reorganisation, court schemes, moratoria, administration and other laws generally affecting or limiting the rights of creditors;

37

11.23.3 the time barring of claims under any applicable limitation acts;

11.23.4 the possibility that a court may strike out provisions for a contract as being invalid for reasons of oppression, undue influence or similar; and

11.23.5 any other reservations or qualifications of law expressed in any legal opinions obtained by the Agent in connection with the Facility.

12 UNDERTAKINGS AND COVENANTS

The undertakings and covenants in this Clause 12 remain in force for the duration of the Facility Period.

12.1 GENERAL UNDERTAKINGS

12.1.1 FINANCIAL STATEMENTS The Borrower shall supply to the Agent as soon as the same become available, but in any event within one hundred and fifty (150) days after the end of each of its financial years, its audited consolidated financial statements for that financial year, together with a Compliance Certificate, signed by a duly authorised representative of the Borrower, setting out computations as to compliance with Clause 12.2 as at the date as at which those financial statements were drawn up.

12.1.2 REQUIREMENTS AS TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS Each set of financial statements delivered by the Borrower under Clause 12.1.1:

(a) shall be certified by an authorised signatory of the Borrower as fairly representing its financial condition as at the date as at which those financial statements were drawn up; and

(b) shall be prepared in accordance with GAAP.

12.1.3 INTERIM FINANCIAL STATEMENTS The Borrower shall supply to the Agent as soon as the same become available, but in any event within ninety (90) days after the end of each quarter during each of its financial years, its unaudited consolidated quarterly financial statements for that quarter together with a Compliance Certificate, signed by a duly authorised representative of the Borrower, setting out computations as to compliance with Clause 12.2 as at the date such financial statements were drawn up.

38

12.1.4 MAINTENANCE OF LEGAL VALIDITY The Borrower shall obtain, comply with the terms of and do all that is necessary to maintain in full force and effect all authorisations, approvals, licences and consents required in or by the laws and regulations of its jurisdiction of formation and all other applicable jurisdictions, to enable it lawfully to enter into and perform its obligations under the Security Documents and to ensure the legality, validity, enforceability or admissibility in evidence of the Security Documents in its jurisdiction of incorporation or organisation and all other applicable jurisdictions.

12.1.5 NOTIFICATION OF DEFAULT The Borrower shall promptly, upon becoming aware of the same, inform the Agent in writing of the occurrence of any Event of Default and, upon receipt of a written request to that effect from the Agent, confirm to the Agent that, save as previously notified to the Agent or as notified in such confirmation, no Event of Default has occurred.

12.1.6 CLAIMS PARI PASSU The Borrower shall ensure that at all times the claims of the Finance Parties against it under the Security Documents rank at least pari passu with the claims of all its other unsecured creditors save those whose claims are preferred by any bankruptcy, insolvency, liquidation, winding-up or other similar laws of general application.

12.1.7 MANAGEMENT OF VESSELS The Borrower shall procure that the Owner shall ensure that each of the Vessels is at all times technically and commercially managed by a management company controlled by Teekay Shipping Corporation or the Borrower or such other management company as may be acceptable to the Agent acting on the instructions of the Majority Lenders.

12.1.8 CLASSIFICATION The Borrower shall procure that the Owner shall ensure that each of the Vessels maintains the highest classification required for the purpose of the relevant trade of such Vessel which shall be with a Pre-Approved Classification Society, in each case, free from any overdue recommendations and conditions affecting that Vessel's class.

39

12.1.9 CERTIFICATE OF FINANCIAL RESPONSIBILITY The Borrower shall procure that the Owner shall obtain and maintain a certificate of financial responsibility in relation to any Vessel which is to call at the United States of America.

12.1.10 NEGATIVE PLEDGE The Borrower shall procure that the Owner does not create, or permit to subsist, any Encumbrance (other than pursuant to the Security Documents) over all or any part of the Vessels or the Insurances other than a Permitted Encumbrance.

12.1.11 REGISTRATION The Borrower shall procure that for the duration of the Facility Period the Owner shall not change or permit a change to the flag of the Vessels other than to a Pre-Approved Flag or under such other flag as may be approved by the Agent acting on the instructions of the Majority Lenders, such approval not to be unreasonably withheld or delayed.

12.1.12 ISM AND ISPS COMPLIANCE The Borrower shall procure that the Owner shall ensure that the relevant Company complies in all material respects with the ISM Code and the ISPS Code or any replacements thereof and in particular (without prejudice to the generality of the foregoing) shall procure that the Owner shall ensure that the Company holds (i) a valid and current Document of Compliance issued pursuant to the ISM Code, (ii) a valid and current SMC issued in respect of each Vessel pursuant to the ISM Code, and (iii) an ISSC in respect of each Vessel, and the Borrower shall promptly, upon request, supply the Agent with copies of the same.

12.1.13 NECESSARY AUTHORISATIONS Without prejudice to Clause 12.1.12 or any other specific provision of the Security Documents relating to an Authorisation, the Borrower shall (i) obtain, comply with and do all that is necessary to maintain in full force and effect all Necessary Authorisations if a failure to do the same may cause a Material Adverse Effect; and (ii) promptly upon request, supply certified copies to the Agent of all Necessary Authorisations.

40

12.1.14 COMPLIANCE WITH APPLICABLE LAWS The Borrower shall comply with all applicable laws to which it may be subject if a failure to do the same may have a Material Adverse Effect.

12.1.15 LOANS AND GUARANTEES The Borrower shall be permitted to make loans and grant credit upon such terms as it may determine to any other member of the Group or to any of the Borrower's shareholders or unitholders and may otherwise give any guarantee or indemnity to procure financing for other members of the Group, but shall not otherwise make any loans or grant any credit (save in the ordinary course of business) or give any guarantee or indemnity (except pursuant to the Security Documents); Provided that the Borrower shall not make any such loans following the occurrence of an Event of Default which is continuing unremedied or unwaived.

12.1.16 FURTHER ASSURANCE The Borrower shall at its own expense, promptly take all such action as the Agent may reasonably require for the purpose of perfecting or protecting any Finance Party's rights with respect to the security created or evidenced (or intended to be created or evidenced) by the Security Documents.

12.1.17 OTHER INFORMATION The Borrower will promptly supply to the Agent such information and explanations as the Majority Lenders may from time to time reasonably require in connection with the operation of the Vessels and any reasonable financial information in connection with the Borrower, and will procure that the Agent be given the like information and explanations relating to all other Security Parties.

12.1.18 INSPECTION OF RECORDS The Borrower will permit the inspection of its financial records and accounts on reasonable notice from time to time during business hours by the Agent or its nominee.

12.1.19 VALUATIONS The Borrower will deliver to the Agent a Valuation of each of the Vessels (i) on the due date for delivery of the annual Borrower's Accounts pursuant to Clause 12.1 (ii) on a sale or Total Loss of any Vessel to determine the Relevant Reduction Amount for the purposes of clauses 3.4.3 and 3.4.4 respectively and (iii) following the occurrence of

41

an Event of Default which is continuing unremedied and unwaived on such other occasions as the Agent may request.

12.1.20 INSURANCE The Borrower shall procure that the Owner shall ensure at its own expense throughout the Facility Period that the Vessels are insured and operated in accordance with the provisions set out in the relevant Security Documents.

12.1.21 CHANGE OF CONTROL The Borrower shall procure that throughout the Facility Period:

(a) Teekay Shipping Corporation owns a minimum of fifty one percent (51%) of the voting rights in Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C, the general partner in the MLP;

(b) Teekay Shipping Corporation or the MLP owns a minimum of fifty one percent (51%) of the voting rights in Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C., the general partner in the Borrower;

(c) there is no change in the legal or beneficial ownership of the Guarantor from that advised to the Agent at the date of this Agreement without the Agent's prior written consent provided that the Agent's consent shall not be required if the change of Guarantor shareholding arises from a corporate reorganisation of the Group and the legal and beneficial ownership of the Guarantor remains wholly owned within the Group following such re-organisation.

12.1.22 "KNOW YOUR CUSTOMER" CHECKS If:

(a) the introduction of or any change in (or in the interpretation, administration or application of) any law or regulation made after the date of this Agreement;

(b) any change in the status of the Borrower after the date of this Agreement; or

42

(c) a proposed assignment or transfer by a Lender of any of its rights and obligations under this Agreement to a party that is not a Lender prior to such assignment or transfer,

obliges the Agent or any Lender (or, in the case of (c) above, any prospective new Lender) to comply with "know your customer" or similar identification procedures in circumstances where the necessary information is not already available to it, the Borrower shall promptly upon the request of the Agent or any Lender supply, or procure the supply of, such documentation and other evidence as is reasonably requested by the Agent (for itself or on behalf of any Lender) or any Lender for itself (or, in the case of (c) above, on behalf of any prospective new Lender) in order for the Agent or that Lender (or, in the case of
(c) above, any prospective new Lender) to carry out and be satisfied it has complied with all necessary "know your customer" or other similar checks under all applicable laws and regulations pursuant to the transactions contemplated in the Finance Documents.

12.1.23 INTERCOMPANY BORROWINGS The Borrower will only borrow from other members of the Group on a subordinated and unsecured basis.

12.2 FINANCIAL COVENANTS

Throughout the Facility Period the Group shall:-

12.2.1 maintain a Free Liquidity together with undrawn committed revolving credit lines available to the Group (including under this Agreement but excluding undrawn committed revolving credit lines with less than six (6) months to maturity) of not less than seventy five million Dollars ($75,000,000); and

12.2.2 ensure that the aggregate of the Free Liquidity and undrawn committed revolving credit lines available to be drawn by members of the Group (including under this Agreement, but excluding undrawn committed revolving credit lines with less than six (6) months to maturity) will not be less than five per cent (5%) of the Total Debt of the Group.

43

PROVIDED THAT following any change in the applicable accounting policies for the Borrower from GAAP the Agent (acting on the instructions of the Majority Lenders and in consultation with the Borrower) may require an amendment to this Clause 12.2 as the Agent deems logical and necessary having regard to the nature of such changes in policy and the intended substance of this Clause 12.2.

13 EVENTS OF DEFAULT

13.1 EVENTS OF DEFAULT Each of the events or circumstances set out in this Clause 13.1 is an Event of Default.

13.1.1 BORROWER'S FAILURE TO PAY UNDER THIS AGREEMENT The Borrower fails to pay any amount of principal due from it under this Agreement at the time, in the currency and otherwise in the manner specified herein provided that, if the Borrower can demonstrate to the reasonable satisfaction of the Agent that all necessary instructions were given to effect such payment and the non-receipt thereof is attributable solely to an error in the banking system, such payment shall instead be deemed to be due, solely for the purposes of this paragraph, within three (3) Business Days of the date on which it actually fell due under this Agreement (if a payment of principal), five (5) Business Days (if a payment of interest) or ten (10) Business Days (if a sum payable on demand); or

13.1.2 MISREPRESENTATION Any representation or statement made by any Security Party in any Security Document to which it is a party or in any notice or other document, certificate or statement delivered by it pursuant thereto or in connection therewith is or proves to have been incorrect or misleading in any material respect, where the circumstances causing the same give rise to a Material Adverse Effect; or

13.1.3 SPECIFIC COVENANTS A Security Party fails duly to perform or comply with any of the obligations expressed to be assumed by or procured by the Borrower under Clauses 12.1.4, 12.1.6, 12.1.10 or 12.1.21; or

44

13.1.4 FINANCIAL COVENANTS The Borrower is in breach of the Borrower's financial covenants set out in Clause 12.2 at any time; or

13.1.5 OTHER OBLIGATIONS A Security Party fails duly to perform or comply with any of the obligations expressed to be assumed by it in any Security Document (other than those referred to in Clause 13.1.3 or Clause 13.1.4) and such failure is not remedied within 30 days after the Agent has given notice thereof to the Borrower; or

13.1.6 CROSS DEFAULT Any indebtedness of any Security Party or any Material Subsidiary is not paid when due (or within any applicable grace period) or any indebtedness of any Security Party or any Material Subsidiary is declared to be or otherwise becomes due and payable prior to its specified maturity where (in either case) the aggregate of all such unpaid or accelerated indebtedness (i) of the Borrower is equal to or greater than fifty million Dollars ($50,000,000) or its equivalent in any other currency; or (ii) of the Guarantor, or any Material Subsidiary is equal to or greater than twenty five million Dollars ($25,000,000) or its equivalent in any other currency; or

13.1.7 INSOLVENCY AND RESCHEDULING A Security Party or a Material Subsidiary is unable to pay its debts as they fall due, commences negotiations with any one or more of its creditors with a view to the general readjustment or rescheduling of its indebtedness or makes a general assignment for the benefit of its creditors or a composition with its creditors; or

13.1.8 WINDING-UP A Security Party or a Material Subsidiary takes any corporate action or other steps are taken or legal proceedings are started for its winding-up, dissolution, administration or re-organisation or for the appointment of a liquidator, receiver, administrator, administrative receiver, conservator, custodian, trustee or similar officer of it or of any or all of its revenues or assets or any moratorium is declared or sought in respect of any of its indebtedness; or

45

13.1.9 EXECUTION OR DISTRESS

(a) Any Security Party or a Material Subsidiary fails to comply with or pay any sum due from it (within 30 days of such amount falling due) under any final judgment or any final order made or given by any court or other official body of a competent jurisdiction in an aggregate (i) in respect of the Borrower equal to or greater than fifty million Dollars ($50,000,000) or its equivalent in any other currency; or
(ii) in respect of the Guarantor or a Material Subsidiary equal to or greater than twenty five million Dollars ($25,000,000) or its equivalent in any other currency, being a judgment or order against which there is no right of appeal or if a right of appeal exists, where the time limit for making such appeal has expired.

(b) Any execution or distress is levied against, or an encumbrancer takes possession of, the whole or any part of, the property, undertaking or assets of a Security Party or a Material Subsidiary in an aggregate amount (i) in respect of the Borrower equal to or greater than fifty million Dollars ($50,000,000) or its equivalent in any other currency; or
(ii) in respect of the Guarantor or a Material Subsidiary equal to or greater than twenty five million Dollars ($25,000,000) or its equivalent in any other currency, other than any execution or distress which is being contested in good faith and which is either discharged within 30 days or in respect of which adequate security has been provided within 30 days to the relevant court or other authority to enable the relevant execution or distress to be lifted or released.

(c) Notwithstanding the foregoing paragraphs of this Clause 13.1.9, any levy of any distress on or any arrest, condemnation, confiscation, requisition for title or use, compulsory acquisition, seizure, detention or forfeiture of a Vessel (or any part thereof) or any exercise or purported exercise of any lien or claim on or against a Vessel where the release of or discharge the lien or

46

claim on or against such Vessel has not been procured within 30 days; or

13.1.10 SIMILAR EVENT Any event occurs which, under the laws of any jurisdiction, has a similar or analogous effect to any of those events mentioned in Clauses 13.1.7, 13.1.8 and 13.1.9; or

13.1.11 INSURANCES Insurance is not maintained in respect of any Vessel in accordance with the terms of the relevant Security Document in respect of that Vessel; or

13.1.12 CLASS A Vessel has its classification withdrawn by the relevant classification society PROVIDED THAT if such withdrawal is (in the opinion of the Agent in its absolute discretion) capable of remedy such Event of Default shall only occur if the Vessel's classification is not reinstated to the satisfaction of the Agent within twenty one (21) days; or

13.1.13 ENVIRONMENTAL MATTERS

(a) Any Environmental Claim is pending or made against the Owner or any of the Owner's Environmental Affiliates or in connection with a Vessel, where such Environmental Claim has a Material Adverse Effect.

(b) Any actual Environmental Incident occurs in connection with a Vessel, where such Environmental Incident has a Material Adverse Effect; or

13.1.14 REPUDIATION Any Security Party repudiates any Security Document to which it is a party or does or causes to be done any act or thing evidencing an intention to repudiate any such Security Document; or

13.1.15 VALIDITY AND ADMISSIBILITY At any time any act, condition or thing required to be done, fulfilled or performed in order:

(a) to enable any Security Party lawfully to enter into, exercise its rights under and perform the respective obligations expressed to be assumed by it in the Security Documents;

47

(b) to ensure that the obligations expressed to be assumed by each of the Security Parties in the Security Documents are legal, valid and binding; or

(c) to make the Security Documents admissible in evidence in any applicable jurisdiction

is not done, fulfilled or performed within 30 days after notification from the Agent to the relevant Security Party requiring the same to be done, fulfilled or performed; or

13.1.16 ILLEGALITY At any time it is or becomes unlawful for any Security Party to perform or comply with any or all of its obligations under the Security Documents to which it is a party or any of the obligations of the Borrower hereunder are not or cease to be legal, valid and binding and such illegality is not remedied or mitigated to the satisfaction of the Agent within thirty (30) days after it has given notice thereof to the relevant Security Party; or

13.1.17 MATERIAL ADVERSE CHANGE At any time there shall occur a change in the business or operations of a Security Party or a change in the financial condition of any Security Party which, in the reasonable opinion of the Majority Lenders, materially impairs such Security Party's ability to discharge its obligations under the Security Documents in the manner provided therein and such change, if capable of remedy, is not so remedied within 15 days of the delivery of a notice confirming such change by the Agent to the relevant Security Party; or

13.1.18 QUALIFICATIONS OF FINANCIAL STATEMENTS The auditors of the Group qualify their report on any audited consolidated financial statements of the Group in any regard which, in the reasonable opinion of the Agent, has a Material Adverse Effect; or

13.1.19 CONDITIONS SUBSEQUENT if any of the conditions set out in Clause 3.6 is not satisfied within thirty (30) days or such other time period specified by the Agent in its discretion; or

48

13.1.20 REVOCATION OR MODIFICATION OF CONSENTS ETC. if any Necessary Authorisation which is now or which at any time during the Facility Period becomes necessary to enable any of the Security Parties to comply with any of their obligations in or pursuant to any of the Security Documents is revoked, withdrawn or withheld, or modified in a manner which the Agent reasonably considers is, or may be, prejudicial to the interests of a Finance Party in a material manner, or if such Necessary Authorisation ceases to remain in full force and effect; or

13.1.21 CURTAILMENT OF BUSINESS if the business of any of the Security Parties is wholly or materially curtailed by any intervention by or under authority of any government, or if all or a substantial part of the undertaking, property or assets of any of the Security Parties is seized, nationalised, expropriated or compulsorily acquired by or under authority of any government or any Security Party disposes or threatens to dispose of a substantial part of its business or assets; or

13.1.22 REDUCTION OF CAPITAL if the Borrower reduces its committed or subscribed capital; or

13.1.23 CHALLENGE TO REGISTRATION if the registration of any Vessel or any Mortgage becomes void or voidable or liable to cancellation or termination; or

13.1.24 WAR if the country of registration of any Vessel becomes involved in war (whether or not declared) or civil war or is occupied by any other power and the Agent reasonably considers that, as a result, the security conferred by the Security Documents is materially prejudiced; or

13.1.25 NOTICE OF TERMINATION if the Guarantor gives notice to the Agent to determine its obligations under the Guarantee.

13.2 ACCELERATION If an Event of Default is continuing unremedied or unwaived the Agent may (with the consent of the Majority Lenders) and shall (at the request of the Majority Lenders) by notice to the Borrower cancel any part of the Maximum Amount not then advanced and:

49

13.2.1 declare that the Loan, together with accrued interest, and all other amounts accrued or outstanding under the Finance Documents are immediately due and payable, whereupon they shall become immediately due and payable; and/or

13.2.2 declare that the Loan is payable on demand, whereupon it shall immediately become payable on demand by the Agent; and/or

13.2.3 declare the Commitments terminated and the Maximum Amount reduced to zero.

14 ASSIGNMENT AND SUB-PARTICIPATION

14.1 LENDERS' RIGHTS A Lender may assign any of its rights under this Agreement or transfer by novation any of its rights and obligations under this Agreement to any other branch or Affiliate of that Lender or (subject to the prior written consent of the Borrower, such consent not to be unreasonably withheld but not to be required at any time after an Event of Default which is continuing unremedied and unwaived) to any other bank or financial institution, and may grant sub-participations in all or any part of its Commitment.

14.2 BORROWER'S CO-OPERATION The Borrower will co-operate fully with a Lender in connection with any assignment, transfer or sub-participation by that Lender; will execute and procure the execution of such documents as that Lender may require in that connection; and irrevocably authorises any Finance Party to disclose to any proposed assignee, transferee or sub-participant (whether before or after any assignment, transfer or sub-participation and whether or not any assignment, transfer or sub-participation shall take place) all information relating to the Security Parties, the Loan, the Relevant Documents and the Vessels which any Finance Party may in its discretion consider necessary or desirable (subject to any duties of confidentiality applicable to the Lenders generally). Additionally, (but subject to the same duties of confidentiality), any Lender may disclose the size and term of the Facility and the names of each Security Party to any investor or potential investor in a securitisation (or similar transaction of broadly equivalent economic effect) of that Lender's rights and obligations under the Finance Documents.

50

14.3 RIGHTS OF ASSIGNEE Any assignee of a Lender shall (unless limited by the express terms of the assignment) take the full benefit of every provision of the Finance Documents benefitting that Lender PROVIDED THAT an assignment will only be effective on notification by the Agent to that Lender and the assignee that the Agent is satisfied it has complied with all necessary "Know your customer" or other similar checks under all applicable laws and regulations in relation to the assignment to the assignee.

14.4 TRANSFER CERTIFICATES If a Lender wishes to transfer any of its rights and obligations under or pursuant to this Agreement, it may do so by delivering to the Agent a duly completed Transfer Certificate, in which event on the Transfer Date:

14.4.1 to the extent that that Lender seeks to transfer its rights and obligations, the Borrower (on the one hand) and that Lender (on the other) shall be released from all further obligations towards the other;

14.4.2 the Borrower (on the one hand) and the transferee (on the other) shall assume obligations towards the other identical to those released pursuant to Clause 14.4.1; and

14.4.3 the Agent, each of the Lenders and the transferee shall have the same rights and obligations between themselves as they would have had if the transferee had been an original party to this Agreement as a Lender

PROVIDED THAT the Agent shall only be obliged to execute a Transfer Certificate once:

(a) it is satisfied it has complied with all necessary "know your customer" or other similar checks under all applicable laws and regulations in relation to the transfer to the transferee; and

(b) the transferee has paid to the Agent for its own account a transfer fee of three thousand Dollars.

The Agent shall, as soon as reasonably practicable after it has executed a Transfer Certificate, send to the Borrower a copy of that Transfer Certificate.

14.5 FINANCE DOCUMENTS Unless otherwise expressly provided in any Finance Document or otherwise expressly agreed between a Lender and any proposed

51

transferee and notified by that Lender to the Agent on or before the relevant Transfer Date, there shall automatically be assigned to the transferee with any transfer of a Lender's rights and obligations under or pursuant to this Agreement the rights of that Lender under or pursuant to the Finance Documents (other than this Agreement) which relate to the portion of that Lender's rights and obligations transferred by the relevant Transfer Certificate.

14.6 NO ASSIGNMENT OR TRANSFER BY THE BORROWER The Borrower may not assign any of its rights or transfer any of its rights or obligations under the Finance Documents.

14.7 TRANSFER OF THE LOAN AGREEMENT BY KFW. Notwithstanding the provisions of Clause 14.1 KfW may transfer all its rights and obligations under this Agreement to a KfW Subsidiary with effect from 1 January 2008 or any later date. By signing this Agreement the Borrower consents to such a transfer. KfW or the KfW Subsidiary will inform the Borrower of the date on which the transfer of KfW's rights and obligations to the KfW Subsidiary takes effect. In this connection the following will apply:

14.7.1 DEDUCTIONS AND INCREASED COSTS. If, by reason of circumstances already existing at the transfer date, the Borrower would be obliged to make a payment to the KfW Subsidiary under Clauses 8.5, 17.2 or 17.3, it need pay the KfW Subsidiary only such an amount as it would have been obliged to pay KfW if the transfer had not occurred.

14.7.2 COSTS. KfW will pay all costs incurred as a result of or in connection with such transfer.

For the purposes of this Clause KfW Subsidiary means a company which within the meaning of section 15 ff. German Stock Corporation Act (Aktiengesetz) is directly or indirectly (i) majority owned (im Mehrheitsbesitz) by KfW or (ii) controlled (abhangig) by KfW.

14.8 DISCLOSURE OF INFORMATION. In connection with any transfer under Clause 14.7 KfW may disclose confidential information to the KfW Subsidiary or its agents or its legal advisors.

52

14.9 MITIGATION If a transfer is to take place under Clause 14.7 then, without in any way limiting the rights of KfW under Clauses 8.5, 17.2 or 17.3, KfW shall take reasonable steps to mitigate any circumstances which arise and which would result in any amount becoming payable under or pursuant to Clauses 8.5, 17.2 or 17.3 and it shall co-operate in completing any procedural formalities necessary for the Borrower to obtain authorisation to make any payment under Clauses 8.5, 17.2 or 17.3 without a deduction or withholding.

15 THE AGENT, THE SECURITY AGENT AND THE LENDERS

15.1 APPOINTMENT

15.1.1 Each Lender appoints the Agent to act as its agent under and in connection with the Finance Documents and each Lender and the Agent appoints the Security Agent to act as its security agent for the purpose of the Security Documents.

15.1.2 Each Lender authorises the Agent and each Lender and the Agent authorises the Security Agent to exercise the rights, powers, authorities and discretions specifically given to the Agent or the Security Agent (as the case may be) under or in connection with the Finance Documents together with any other incidental rights, powers, authorities and discretions.

15.1.3 Except where the context otherwise requires, references in this Clause 15 to the "AGENT" shall mean the Agent and the Security Agent individually and collectively.

15.2 AUTHORITY Each Lender irrevocably authorises the Security Agent (in the case of Clause 15.2.1) and the Agent (in the case of Clauses 15.2.2, 15.2.3 and 15.2.4) (in each case subject to Clauses 15.4 and 15.18):

15.2.1 to execute any Finance Document (other than this Agreement) on its behalf;

15.2.2 to collect, receive, release or pay any money on its behalf;

15.2.3 acting on the instructions from time to time of the Majority Lenders (save where the terms of any Security Document expressly provide otherwise)

53

to give or withhold any waivers, consents or approvals under or pursuant to any Finance Document; and

15.2.4 acting on the instructions from time to time of the Majority Lenders (save where the terms of any Security Document expressly provide otherwise) to exercise, or refrain from exercising, any rights, powers, authorities or discretions under or pursuant to any Finance Document.

The Agent shall have no duties or responsibilities as agent or as security agent other than those expressly conferred on it by the Finance Documents and shall not be obliged to act on any instructions from the Lenders or the Majority Lenders if to do so would, in the opinion of the Agent, be contrary to any provision of the Finance Documents or to any law, or would expose the Agent to any actual or potential liability to any third party.

15.3 TRUST The Security Agent agrees and declares, and each of the other Finance Parties acknowledges, that, subject to the terms and conditions of this Clause 15.3, the Security Agent holds the Trust Property on trust for the Finance Parties absolutely. Each of the other Finance Parties agrees that the obligations, rights and benefits vested in the Security Agent shall be performed and exercised in accordance with this Clause 15.3. The Security Agent shall have the benefit of all of the provisions of this Agreement benefiting it in its capacity as security agent for the Finance Parties, and all the powers and discretions conferred on trustees by the Trustee Act 1925 (to the extent not inconsistent with this Agreement). In addition:

15.3.1 the Security Agent and any attorney, agent or delegate of the Security Agent may indemnify itself or himself out of the Trust Property against all liabilities, costs, fees, damages, charges, losses and expenses sustained or incurred by it or him in relation to the taking or holding of any of the Trust Property or in connection with the exercise or purported exercise of the rights, trusts, powers and discretions vested in the Security Agent or any other such person by or pursuant to the Security Documents or in respect of anything else done or omitted to be done in any way relating to the Security Documents other than as a result of its gross negligence or wilful misconduct;

54

15.3.2 the other Finance Parties acknowledge that the Security Agent shall be under no obligation to insure any property nor to require any other person to insure any property and shall not be responsible for any loss which may be suffered by any person as a result of the lack or insufficiency of any insurance; and

15.3.3 the Finance Parties agree that the perpetuity period applicable to the trusts declared by this Agreement shall be the period of eighty years from the date of this Agreement.

15.4 LIMITATIONS ON AUTHORITY Except with the prior written consent of all the Lenders, the Agent shall not be entitled to:

15.4.1 release or vary any security given for the Borrower's obligations under this Agreement; nor

15.4.2 waive the payment of any sum of money payable by any Security Party under the Finance Documents; nor

15.4.3 change the meaning of the expressions "MAJORITY LENDERS",
"MARGIN", "COMMITMENT COMMISSION" or "DEFAULT RATE"; nor

15.4.4 exercise, or refrain from exercising, any right, power, authority or discretion, or give or withhold any consent, the exercise or giving of which is, by the terms of this Agreement, expressly reserved to the Lenders; nor

15.4.5 extend the due date for the payment of any sum of money payable by any Security Party under any Finance Document; nor

15.4.6 take or refrain from taking any step if the effect of such action or inaction may lead to the increase of the obligations of a Lender under any Finance Document; nor

15.4.7 agree to change the currency in which any sum is payable under any Finance Document (other than in accordance with the terms of the relevant Finance Document); nor

15.4.8 agree to amend this Clause 15.4.

55

15.5 LIABILITY Neither the Agent nor any of its directors, officers, employees or agents shall be liable to the Lenders for anything done or omitted to be done by the Agent under or in connection with any of the Relevant Documents unless as a result of the Agent's gross negligence or wilful misconduct.

15.6 ACKNOWLEDGEMENT Each Lender acknowledges that:

15.6.1 it has not relied on any representation made by the Agent or any of the Agent's directors, officers, employees or agents or by any other person acting or purporting to act on behalf of the Agent to induce it to enter into any Finance Document;

15.6.2 it has made and will continue to make without reliance on the Agent, and based on such documents and other evidence as it considers appropriate, its own independent investigation of the financial condition and affairs of the Security Parties in connection with the making and continuation of the Loan;

15.6.3 it has made its own appraisal of the creditworthiness of the Security Parties; and

15.6.4 the Agent shall not have any duty or responsibility at any time to provide it with any credit or other information relating to any Security Party unless that information is received by the Agent pursuant to the express terms of a Finance Document.

Each Lender agrees that it will not assert nor seek to assert against any director, officer, employee or agent of the Agent or against any other person acting or purporting to act on behalf of the Agent any claim which it might have against them in respect of any of the matters referred to in this Clause 15.6.

15.7 LIMITATIONS ON RESPONSIBILITY The Agent shall have no responsibility to any Security Party or to any Lender on account of:

15.7.1 the failure of a Lender or of any Security Party to perform any of its obligations under a Finance Document; nor

15.7.2 the financial condition of any Security Party; nor

56

15.7.3 the completeness or accuracy of any statements, representations or warranties made in or pursuant to any Finance Document, or in or pursuant to any document delivered pursuant to or in connection with any Finance Document; nor

15.7.4 the negotiation, execution, effectiveness, genuineness, validity, enforceability, admissibility in evidence or sufficiency of any Finance Document or of any document executed or delivered pursuant to or in connection with any Finance Document.

15.8 THE AGENT'S RIGHTS The Agent may:

15.8.1 assume that all representations or warranties made or deemed repeated by any Security Party in or pursuant to any Finance Document are true and complete, unless, in its capacity as the Agent, it has acquired actual knowledge to the contrary;

15.8.2 assume that no Default has occurred unless, in its capacity as the Agent, it has acquired actual knowledge to the contrary;

15.8.3 rely on any document or notice believed by it to be genuine;

15.8.4 rely as to legal or other professional matters on opinions and statements of any legal or other professional advisers selected or approved by it;

15.8.5 rely as to any factual matters which might reasonably be expected to be within the knowledge of any Security Party on a certificate signed by or on behalf of that Security Party; and

15.8.6 refrain from exercising any right, power, discretion or remedy unless and until instructed to exercise that right, power, discretion or remedy and as to the manner of its exercise by the Lenders (or, where applicable, by the Majority Lenders) and unless and until the Agent has received from the Lenders any payment which the Agent may require on account of, or any security which the Agent may require for, any costs, claims, expenses (including legal and other professional fees) and liabilities which it considers it may incur or sustain in complying with those instructions.

57

15.9 THE AGENT'S DUTIES The Agent shall:

15.9.1 if requested in writing to do so by a Lender, make enquiry and advise the Lenders as to the performance or observance of any of the provisions of any Finance Document by any Security Party or as to the existence of an Event of Default; and

15.9.2 inform the Lenders promptly of any Event of Default of which the Agent has actual knowledge.

15.10 NO DEEMED KNOWLEDGE The Agent shall not be deemed to have actual knowledge of the falsehood or incompleteness of any representation or warranty made or deemed repeated by any Security Party or actual knowledge of the occurrence of any Default unless a Lender or a Security Party shall have given written notice thereof to the Agent in its capacity as the Agent. Any information acquired by the Agent other than specifically in its capacity as the Agent shall not be deemed to be information acquired by the Agent in its capacity as the Agent.

15.11 OTHER BUSINESS The Agent may, without any liability to account to the Lenders, generally engage in any kind of banking or trust business with a Security Party or with a Security Party's subsidiaries or associated companies or with a Lender as if it were not the Agent.

15.12 INDEMNITY The Lenders shall, promptly on the Agent's request, reimburse the Agent in their respective Proportionate Shares, for, and keep the Agent fully indemnified in respect of all liabilities, damages, costs and claims sustained or incurred by the Agent in connection with the Finance Documents, or the performance of its duties and obligations, or the exercise of its rights, powers, discretions or remedies under or pursuant to any Finance Document, to the extent not paid by the Security Parties and not arising solely from the Agent's gross negligence or wilful misconduct.

15.13 EMPLOYMENT OF AGENTS In performing its duties and exercising its rights, powers, discretions and remedies under or pursuant to the Finance Documents, the Agent shall be entitled to employ and pay agents to do anything which the Agent is empowered to do under or pursuant to the Finance Documents (including the receipt of money and documents and the payment of money) and to act or

58

refrain from taking action in reliance on the opinion of, or advice or information obtained from, any lawyer, banker, broker, accountant, valuer or any other person believed by the Agent in good faith to be competent to give such opinion, advice or information.

15.14 DISTRIBUTION OF PAYMENTS The Agent shall pay promptly to the order of each Lender that Lender's Proportionate Share of every sum of money received by the Agent pursuant to the Finance Documents (with the exception of any amounts payable pursuant to Clause 9 and/or any Fee Letter and any amounts which, by the terms of the Finance Documents, are paid to the Agent for the account of the Agent alone or specifically for the account of one or more Lenders) and until so paid such amount shall be held by the Agent on trust absolutely for that Lender.

15.15 REIMBURSEMENT The Agent shall have no liability to pay any sum to a Lender until it has itself received payment of that sum. If, however, the Agent does pay any sum to a Lender on account of any amount prospectively due to that Lender pursuant to Clause 15.14 before it has itself received payment of that amount, and the Agent does not in fact receive payment within five (5) Business Days after the date on which that payment was required to be made by the terms of the Finance Documents, that Lender will, on demand by the Agent, refund to the Agent an amount equal to the amount received by it, together with an amount sufficient to reimburse the Agent for any amount which the Agent may certify that it has been required to pay by way of interest on money borrowed to fund the amount in question during the period beginning on the date on which that amount was required to be paid by the terms of the Finance Documents and ending on the date on which the Agent receives reimbursement.

15.16 REDISTRIBUTION OF PAYMENTS Unless otherwise agreed between the Lenders and the Agent, if at any time a Lender receives or recovers by way of set-off, the exercise of any lien or otherwise from any Security Party, an amount greater than that Lender's Proportionate Share of any sum due from that Security Party to the Lenders under the Finance Documents (the amount of the excess being referred to in this Clause 15.16 and in Clause 15.17 as the "EXCESS AMOUNT") then:

15.16.1that Lender shall promptly notify the Agent (which shall promptly notify each other Lender);

59

15.16.2 that Lender shall pay to the Agent an amount equal to the Excess Amount within ten (10) days of its receipt or recovery of the Excess Amount; and

15.16.3 the Agent shall treat that payment as if it were a payment by the Security Party in question on account of the sum due from that Security Party to the Lenders and shall account to the Lenders in respect of the Excess Amount in accordance with the provisions of this Clause 15.16.

However, if a Lender has commenced any legal proceedings to recover sums owing to it under the Finance Documents and, as a result of, or in connection with, those proceedings has received an Excess Amount, the Agent shall not distribute any of that Excess Amount to any other Lender which had been notified of the proceedings and had the legal right to, but did not, join those proceedings or commence and diligently prosecute separate proceedings to enforce its rights in the same or another court.

15.17 RESCISSION OF EXCESS AMOUNT If all or any part of any Excess Amount is rescinded or must otherwise be restored to any Security Party or to any other third party, the Lenders which have received any part of that Excess Amount by way of distribution from the Agent pursuant to Clause 15.16 shall repay to the Agent for the account of the Lender which originally received or recovered the Excess Amount, the amount which shall be necessary to ensure that the Lenders share rateably in accordance with their Proportionate Shares in the amount of the receipt or payment retained, together with interest on that amount at a rate equivalent to that (if any) paid by the Lender receiving or recovering the Excess Amount to the person to whom that Lender is liable to make payment in respect of such amount, and Clause 15.16.3 shall apply only to the retained amount.

15.18 INSTRUCTIONS Where the Agent is authorised or directed to act or refrain from acting in accordance with the instructions of the Lenders or of the Majority Lenders each of the Lenders shall provide the Agent with instructions within three (3) Business Days of the Agent's request (which request may be made orally or in writing). If a Lender does not provide the Agent with instructions within that period, that Lender shall be bound by the decision of the Agent. Nothing in this Clause 15.18 shall limit the right of the Agent to take, or refrain from taking, any action without obtaining the instructions of the Lenders or the Majority Lenders if the Agent in its discretion considers it necessary or appropriate to take, or refrain

60

from taking, such action in order to preserve the rights of the Lenders under or in connection with the Finance Documents. In that event, the Agent will notify the Lenders of the action taken by it as soon as reasonably practicable, and the Lenders agree to ratify any action taken by the Agent pursuant to this Clause 15.18.

15.19 PAYMENTS All amounts payable to a Lender under this Clause 15 shall be paid to such account at such bank as that Lender may from time to time direct in writing to the Agent.

15.20 "KNOW YOUR CUSTOMER" CHECKS Each Lender shall promptly upon the request of the Agent supply, or procure the supply of, such documentation and other evidence as is reasonably requested by the Agent (for itself) in order for the Agent to carry out and be satisfied it has complied with all necessary "know your customer" or other similar checks under all applicable laws and regulations pursuant to the transactions contemplated in the Finance Documents.

15.21 RESIGNATION Subject to a successor being appointed in accordance with this Clause 15.21, the Agent may resign as agent and/or the Security Agent may resign as security agent at any time without assigning any reason by giving to the Borrower and the Lenders notice of its intention to do so, in which event the following shall apply:

15.21.1 with the consent of the Borrower not to be unreasonably withheld (but such consent not to be required at any time after an Event of Default which is continuing unremedied and unwaived) the Lenders may within thirty (30) days after the date of the notice from the Agent or the Security Agent (as the case may be) appoint a successor to act as agent and/or security agent or, if they fail to do so with the consent of the Borrower, not to be unreasonably withheld (but such consent not to be required at any time after an Event of Default which is continuing unremedied and unwaived), the Agent or the Security Agent (as the case may be) may appoint any other bank or financial institution as its successor;

15.21.2 the resignation of the Agent or the Security Agent (as the case may be) shall take effect simultaneously with the appointment of its successor on

61

written notice of that appointment being given to the Borrower and the Lenders;

15.21.3 the Agent or the Security Agent (as the case may be) shall thereupon be discharged from all further obligations as agent and/or security agent but shall remain entitled to the benefit of the provisions of this Clause 15; and

15.21.4 the successor of the Agent or the Security Agent (as the case may be) and each of the other parties to this Agreement shall have the same rights and obligations amongst themselves as they would have had if that successor had been a party to this Agreement.

15.22 NO FIDUCIARY RELATIONSHIP Except as provided in Clauses 15.3 and 15.14, the Agent shall not have any fiduciary relationship with or be deemed to be a trustee of or for any other person and nothing contained in any Finance Document shall constitute a partnership between any two or more Lenders or between the Agent and any other person.

16 SET-OFF

A Finance Party may set off any matured obligation due from the Borrower under any Finance Document (to the extent beneficially owned by that Finance Party) against any matured obligation owed by that Finance Party to the Borrower, regardless of the place of payment, booking branch or currency of either obligation. If the obligations are in different currencies, that Finance Party may convert either obligation at a market rate of exchange in its usual course of business for the purpose of the set-off.

17 PAYMENTS

17.1 PAYMENTS Each amount payable by the Borrower under a Finance Document shall be paid to such account at such bank as the Agent may from time to time direct to the Borrower in the Currency of Account and in such funds as are customary at the time for settlement of transactions in the relevant currency in the place of payment. Payment shall be deemed to have been received by the Agent on the date on which the Agent receives authenticated advice of receipt, unless that advice is received by the Agent on a day other than a Business Day or at a time of day (whether on a Business Day or not) when the Agent in its reasonable discretion considers that it is impossible or impracticable for the Agent to utilise

62

the amount received for value that same day, in which event the payment in question shall be deemed to have been received by the Agent on the Business Day next following the date of receipt of advice by the Agent.

17.2 NO DEDUCTIONS OR WITHHOLDINGS Each payment (whether of principal or interest or otherwise) to be made by the Borrower under a Finance Document shall, subject only to Clause 17.3, be made free and clear of and without deduction for or on account of any Taxes or other deductions, withholdings, restrictions, conditions or counterclaims of any nature.

17.3 GROSSING-UP If at any time any law requires (or is interpreted to require) the Borrower to make any deduction or withholding from any payment, or to change the rate or manner in which any required deduction or withholding is made, the Borrower will promptly notify the Agent and, simultaneously with making that payment, will pay to the Agent whatever additional amount (after taking into account any additional Taxes on, or deductions or withholdings from, or restrictions or conditions on, that additional amount) is necessary to ensure that, after making the deduction or withholding, the relevant Finance Parties receive a net sum equal to the sum which they would have received had no deduction or withholding been made.

17.4 EVIDENCE OF DEDUCTIONS If at any time the Borrower is required by law to make any deduction or withholding from any payment to be made by it under a Finance Document, the Borrower will pay the amount required to be deducted or withheld to the relevant authority within the time allowed under the applicable law and will, no later than thirty (30) days after making that payment, deliver to the Agent an original receipt issued by the relevant authority, or other evidence reasonably acceptable to the Agent, evidencing the payment to that authority of all amounts required to be deducted or withheld.

17.5 REBATE If the Borrower pays any additional amount under Clause 17.3, and a Finance Party subsequently receives a refund or allowance from any tax authority which that Finance Party identifies as being referable to that increased amount so paid by the Borrower, that Finance Party shall, as soon as reasonably practicable, pay to the Borrower an amount equal to the amount of the refund or allowance received, if and to the extent that it may do so without prejudicing its right to retain that refund or allowance and without putting itself in any worse financial

63

position than that in which it would have been had the relevant deduction or withholding not been required to have been made. Nothing in this Clause 17.5 shall be interpreted as imposing any obligation on any Finance Party to apply for any refund or allowance nor as restricting in any way the manner in which any Finance Party organises its tax affairs, nor as imposing on any Finance Party any obligation to disclose to the Borrower any information regarding its tax affairs or tax computations.

17.6 ADJUSTMENT OF DUE DATES If any payment or transfer of funds to be made under a Finance Document, other than a payment of interest on a Drawing, shall be due on a day which is not a Business Day, that payment shall be made on the next succeeding Business Day (unless the next succeeding Business Day falls in the next calendar month in which event the payment shall be made on the next preceding Business Day). Any such variation of time shall be taken into account in computing any interest in respect of that payment.

17.7 CONTROL ACCOUNT The Agent shall open and maintain on its books a control account in the name of the Borrower showing the advance of the Loan and the computation and payment of interest and all other sums due under this Agreement. The Borrower's obligations to repay the Loan and to pay interest and all other sums due under this Agreement shall be evidenced by the entries from time to time made in the control account opened and maintained under this Clause 17.7 and those entries will, in the absence of manifest error, be conclusive and binding.

18 NOTICES

18.1 COMMUNICATIONS IN WRITING Any communication to be made under or in connection with this Agreement shall be made in writing and, unless otherwise stated, may be made by fax or letter or (subject to Clause 18.6) electronic mail.

18.2 ADDRESSES The address and fax number (and the department or officer, if any, for whose attention the communication is to be made) of each party to this Agreement for any communication or document to be made or delivered under or in connection with this Agreement are:

64

18.2.1 in the case of the Borrower, c/o Teekay Shipping (Canada) Ltd Suite 2000, Bentall 5, 550 Burrard Street, Vancouver, B.C., Canada V6C 2K2 (fax no: +1 604 681 3011) marked for the attention of Director Finance;

18.2.2 in the case of each Lender, those appearing opposite its name in Schedule 1;

18.2.3 in the case of the Agent, 200 Park Avenue, 31st Floor, New York, New York 10166-0396, United States of America (fax no: +1 212 681 3900) marked for the attention of Credit, Sanjiv Nayer/Erlend Bryn; and

18.2.4 in the case of the Security Agent, Domshof 17, 28195 Bremen, Federal Republic of Germany (fax no: + 49 421 3609 329) marked for the attention of Credit Department;

or any substitute address, fax number, department or officer as any party may notify to the Agent (or the Agent may notify to the other parties, if a change is made by the Agent) by not less than five (5) Business Days' notice.

18.3 DELIVERY Any communication or document made or delivered by one party to this Agreement to another under or in connection this Agreement will only be effective:

18.3.1 if by way of fax, when received in legible form; or

18.3.2 if by way of letter, when it has been left at the relevant address or five (5) Business Days after being deposited in the post postage prepaid in an envelope addressed to it at that address; or

18.3.3 if by way of electronic mail, in accordance with Clause 18.6;

and, if a particular department or officer is specified as part of its address details provided under Clause 18.2, if addressed to that department or officer.

Any communication or document to be made or delivered to the Agent will be effective only when actually received by the Agent.

All notices from or to the Borrower shall be sent through the Agent.

65

18.4 NOTIFICATION OF ADDRESS AND FAX NUMBER Promptly upon receipt of notification of an address, fax number or change of address, pursuant to Clause 18.2 or changing its own address or fax number, the Agent shall notify the other parties to this Agreement.

18.5 ENGLISH LANGUAGE Any notice given under or in connection with this Agreement must be in English. All other documents provided under or in connection with this Agreement must be:

18.5.1 in English; or

18.5.2 if not in English, and if so required by the Agent, accompanied by a certified English translation and, in this case, the English translation will prevail unless the document is a constitutional, statutory or other official document.

18.6 ELECTRONIC COMMUNICATION

(a) Any communication to be made in connection with this Agreement may be made by electronic mail or other electronic means, if the Borrower and the relevant Finance Party:

(i) agree that, unless and until notified to the contrary, this is to be an accepted form of communication;

(ii) notify each other in writing of their electronic mail address and/or any other information required to enable the sending and receipt of information by that means; and

(iii) notify each other of any change to their address or any other such information supplied by them.

(b) Any electronic communication made between the Borrower and the relevant Finance Party will be effective only when actually received in readable form and acknowledged by the recipient (it being understood that any system generated responses do not constitute an acknowledgement) and in the case of any electronic communication made by the Borrower to a Finance Party only if it is addressed in such a manner as the Finance Party shall specify for this purpose.

66

19 PARTIAL INVALIDITY

If, at any time, any provision of a Finance Document is or becomes illegal, invalid or unenforceable in any respect under any law of any jurisdiction, neither the legality, validity or enforceability of the remaining provisions nor the legality, validity or enforceability of such provision under the law of any other jurisdiction will in any way be affected or impaired.

20 REMEDIES AND WAIVERS

No failure to exercise, nor any delay in exercising, on the part of any Finance Party, any right or remedy under a Finance Document shall operate as a waiver, nor shall any single or partial exercise of any right or remedy prevent any further or other exercise or the exercise of any other right or remedy. The rights and remedies provided in this Agreement are cumulative and not exclusive of any rights or remedies provided by law.

21 MISCELLANEOUS

21.1 NO ORAL VARIATIONS No variation or amendment of a Finance Document shall be valid unless in writing and signed on behalf of all the Finance Parties.

21.2 FURTHER ASSURANCE If any provision of a Finance Document shall be invalid or unenforceable in whole or in part by reason of any present or future law or any decision of any court, or if the documents at any time held by or on behalf of the Finance Parties or any of them are considered by the Lenders for any reason insufficient to carry out the terms of this Agreement, then from time to time the Borrower will promptly, on demand by the Agent, execute or procure the execution of such further documents as in the opinion of the Lenders are necessary to provide adequate security for the repayment of the Indebtedness.

21.3 RESCISSION OF PAYMENTS ETC. Any discharge, release or reassignment by a Finance Party of any of the security constituted by, or any of the obligations of a Security Party contained in, a Finance Document shall be (and be deemed always to have been) void if any act (including, without limitation, any payment) as a result of which such discharge, release or reassignment was given or made is subsequently wholly or partially rescinded or avoided by operation of any law.

67

21.4 CERTIFICATES Any certificate or statement signed by an authorised signatory of the Agent purporting to show the amount of the Indebtedness (or any part of the Indebtedness) or any other amount referred to in any Finance Document shall, save for manifest error or on any question of law, be conclusive evidence as against the Borrower of that amount.

21.5 COUNTERPARTS This Agreement may be executed in any number of counterparts each of which shall be original but which shall together constitute the same instrument.

21.6 CONTRACTS (RIGHTS OF THIRD PARTIES) ACT 1999 A person who is not a party to this Agreement has no right under the Contracts (Rights of Third Parties) Act 1999 to enforce or to enjoy the benefit of any term of this Agreement.

21.7 DISCLOSURE OF INFORMATION The Borrower authorises each Lender to disclose any information and/or document(s) concerning its relationship with such Lender (i) to authorities in any other countries where such Lender or any Affiliate is represented and/or where any Lender or any Affiliate may be requested information by any regulatory authority, when this shall be deemed necessary in order for such Lender or any Affiliate to meet its requirements for the contribution to reduction or prevention of money laundering, terrorism and corruption, and (ii) to any Affiliate of that Lender making it possible to consolidate the client's total commitments and offer the client any other products offered by that Lender or any Affiliate, subject always to the duties of confidentiality on the Lenders set out herein.

22 LAW AND JURISDICTION

22.1 GOVERNING LAW This Agreement shall in all respects be governed by and interpreted in accordance with English law.

22.2 JURISDICTION For the exclusive benefit of the Finance Parties, the parties to this Agreement irrevocably agree that the courts of England are to have jurisdiction to settle any disputes which may arise out of or in connection with this Agreement and that any proceedings may be brought in those courts.

22.3 ALTERNATIVE JURISDICTIONS Nothing contained in this Clause 22 shall limit the right of the Finance Parties to commence any proceedings against the Borrower in

68

any other court of competent jurisdiction nor shall the commencement of any proceedings against the Borrower in one or more jurisdictions preclude the commencement of any proceedings in any other jurisdiction, whether concurrently or not.

22.4 WAIVER OF OBJECTIONS The Borrower irrevocably waives any objection which it may now or in the future have to the laying of the venue of any proceedings in any court referred to in this Clause 22, and any claim that those proceedings have been brought in an inconvenient or inappropriate forum, and irrevocably agrees that a judgment in any proceedings commenced in any such court shall be conclusive and binding on it and may be enforced in the courts of any other jurisdiction.

22.5 SERVICE OF PROCESS Without prejudice to any other mode of service allowed under any relevant law, the Borrower:

22.5.1 irrevocably appoints Teekay Shipping (UK) Ltd of 2nd Floor, 86 Jermyn Street, London SW1Y 6JD England as its agent for service of process in relation to any proceedings before the English courts in connection with this Agreement; and

22.5.2 agrees that failure by a process agent to notify the Borrower of the process will not invalidate the proceedings concerned.

69

IN WITNESS of which the parties to this Agreement have executed this Agreement the day and year first before written.

SIGNED by                           )  -----------------------------------------
duly authorised for and on behalf   )  [signed]
of TEEKAY OFFSHORE                  )
OPERATING L.P.                      )


SIGNED by                           )  -----------------------------------------
duly authorised for and on behalf   )  [signed]
of DNB NOR BANK ASA (as a Lender)   )


SIGNED by                           )  -----------------------------------------
duly authorised for and on behalf   )  [signed]
of NORDEA BANK NORGE ASA            )
(as a Lender)                       )


SIGNED by                           )  -----------------------------------------
duly authorised for and on behalf   )  [signed]
of FORTIS CAPITAL CORP.             )
(as a Lender)                       )


SIGNED by                           )  -----------------------------------------
duly authorised for and on behalf   )  [signed]
of DEUTSCHE SCHIFFSBANK             )

AKTIENGESELLSCHAFT
(as a Lender) )

70

SIGNED by                           )  -----------------------------------------
duly authorised for and on behalf   )  [signed]
of LANDESBANK HESSEN-THURINGEN      )
GIROZENTRALE                        )
(as a Lender)                       )


SIGNED by                           )  -----------------------------------------
duly authorised for and on behalf   )  [signed]
of DNB NOR BANK ASA (as the Agent)  )


SIGNED by                           )  -----------------------------------------
duly authorised for and on behalf   )  [signed]
of DEUTSCHE SCHIFFSBANK             )
AKTIENGESELLSCHAFT                  )
(as the Security Agent)             )


SIGNED by                           )  -----------------------------------------
duly authorised for and on behalf   )  [signed]
of DNB NOR BANK ASA (as an MLA)     )


SIGNED by                           )  -----------------------------------------
duly authorised for and on behalf   )  [signed]
of NORDEA BANK NORGE ASA            )
(as an MLA)                         )


SIGNED by                           )  -----------------------------------------
duly authorised for and on behalf   )  [signed]
of FORTIS CAPITAL CORP.             )
(as an MLA)                         )

71

SIGNED by                           )  -----------------------------------------
duly authorised for and on behalf   )  [signed]
of DNB NOR BANK ASA                 )
(as a bookrunner)                   )


SIGNED by                           )  -----------------------------------------
duly authorised for and on behalf   )  [signed]
of NORDEA BANK NORGE ASA            )
(as a bookrunner)                   )

72

CONFORMED COPY

DATED 2ND OCTOBER 2006

TEEKAY OFFSHORE OPERATING L.P.
(AS BORROWER)

- AND -

DNB NOR BANK ASA
NORDEA BANK NORGE ASA
FORTIS CAPITAL CORP.

AND OTHERS
(AS LENDERS)

- AND -

DNB NOR BANK ASA
(AS AGENT)

- AND -

DEUTSCHE SCHIFFSBANK AKTIENGESELLSCHAFT
(AS SECURITY AGENT)

- AND -

DNB NOR BANK ASA
NORDEA BANK NORGE ASA
FORTIS CAPITAL CORP.
(AS MANDATED LEAD ARRANGERS)

- AND -

DNB NOR BANK ASA
NORDEA BANK NORGE ASA
(AS BOOKRUNNERS)


US$940,000,000 SECURED
LOAN AGREEMENT


STEPHENSON HARWOOD
ONE ST. PAUL'S CHURCHYARD
LONDON EC4M 8SH
TEL: 020 7329 4422
FAX: 020 7329 7100
REF: 819/1138


CONTENTS

                                                                            PAGE
                                                                            ----
1  Definitions and Interpretation .......................................     1

2  The Loan and its Purposes ............................................    18

3  Conditions of Utilisation ............................................    18

4  Advance ..............................................................    23

5  Repayment ............................................................    23

6  Prepayment ...........................................................    23

7  Interest .............................................................    25

8  Indemnities ..........................................................    27

9  Fees .................................................................    31

10 Security and Application of Moneys ...................................    32

11 Representations and Warranties .......................................    33

12 Undertakings and Covenants ...........................................    38

13 Events of Default ....................................................    44

14 Assignment and Sub-Participation .....................................    50

15 The Agent, the Security Agent and the Lenders ........................    53

16 Set-Off ..............................................................    62

17 Payments .............................................................    62

18 Notices ..............................................................    64

19 Partial Invalidity ...................................................    67

20 Remedies and Waivers .................................................    67


21 Miscellaneous ........................................................    67

22 Law and Jurisdiction .................................................    68

SCHEDULE 1: The Lenders and the Commitments .............................    70

SCHEDULE 2: Conditions Precedent and Subsequent .........................    71
   Part I: Conditions precedent to the First Drawdown Date ..............    71
   Part II: Conditions subsequent to the First Drawdown Date ............    74
   Part III: Conditions precedent to the Step-up Date ...................    75
   Part IV: Conditions subsequent to the Step-up Date ...................    77

SCHEDULE 3: Calculation of Mandatory Cost ...............................    78
SCHEDULE 4: Form of Drawdown Notice .....................................    80

SCHEDULE 5: Form of Transfer Certificate ................................    81

SCHEDULE 6: Form of Compliance Certificate ..............................    84

SCHEDULE 7: The Vessels .................................................    85
   Part I: The Initial Vessels ..........................................    85
   Part II: The Step-up Vessels .........................................    86

SCHEDULE 8: Reductions ..................................................    87


EXHIBIT 10.8

DATED: 14 JUNE 2006

BETWEEN:

(1) PETROJARL JV AS having its registered office at Strandveien 4, PO Box 89, N-1325 Lysaker, Norway ("PETROJARL");

(2) TEEKAY PETROJARL OFFSHORE HOLDINGS L.L.C., a limited liability company formed in the Marshall Islands with its registered office at Trust Company Complex, Ajeltake Road, Ajeltake Island, Majuro, Marshall Islands MH96960 and having a business address at Bayside House, Bayside Executive Park, West Bay Street and Blake Road, Nassau, The Bahamas ("TEEKAY"); and

(3) TEEKAY PETROJARL GP L.L.C. having its principal place of business at Bayside House, Bayside Executive Park, West Bay Street and Blake Road, PO Box AP-59212, Nassau, Bahamas (the "GP").

PRELIMINARY

A. Teekay Shipping Corporation and Petrojarl entered into a Heads of Agreement dated 20 February, 2006 whereby they agreed to establish a joint venture (the "Joint Venture"), either directly or through their respective nominees, that will primarily focus on the business of owning and operating FPSO's, FSO's and other mobile production solutions for the oil industry worldwide.

B. Teekay Shipping Corporation wishes to pursue the Joint Venture through its wholly owned subsidiary Teekay Petrojarl Offshore Holdings L.L.C..

C. On or about 29 June 2006, Petrojarl will become a wholly owned subsidiary of Petrojarl ASA (the "Demerger").

D. Teekay Petrojarl GP L.L.C. (the "GP") was formed on 13 June 2006 under the Limited Liability Company Act as a limited liability company and has, as the date of this Agreement, an authorised share capital of one thousand Dollars (USD1,000) divided into one thousand shares of one Dollar (USD1) each.

E. Teekay Petrojarl Offshore L.P. (the "LP") was formed on 13 June 2006 under the Limited Partnership Act as a limited partnership, with GP as its general partner.


E. Petrojarl and Teekay propose jointly (a) to own and operate FPSOs, FSOs and other mobile production solutions for the oil industry worldwide, (b) that those activities should be carried out through the GP and (c) that they will hold the issued membership interests in the GP equally, and limited partnership interests in the LP equally, all in the manner and on the terms set out below.

1 DEFINITIONS AND INTERPRETATION

In this Agreement unless inconsistent with the context or otherwise defined:

1.1 the following expressions have the following meanings:

"ADDRESS FOR SERVICE"                 :   for Petrojarl means C/O SH
                                          Process Agents Limited, One
                                          St Paul's Churchyard, London
                                          EC4M 8SH and for Teekay
                                          means C/O Teekay Shipping
                                          (UK) Limited, 2nd Floor, 86
                                          Jermyn Street, London SW1Y
                                          6JD;

"AFFILIATE"                               any other entity directly or
                                          indirectly controlling or
                                          controlled by or under
                                          direct or indirect common
                                          control of a party. For the
                                          purposes of this definition,
                                          "control" (including, with
                                          correlative meanings
                                          "controlling", "controlled
                                          by", and "under common
                                          control with") means the
                                          power to direct or cause the
                                          direction of the management
                                          and policies of such party,
                                          directly or indirectly,
                                          whether through the
                                          ownership of voting
                                          securities, by contract or
                                          otherwise, it being
                                          understood and agreed that
                                          with respect to a
                                          corporation, limited
                                          liability company or
                                          partnership, control shall
                                          mean direct or indirect
                                          ownership of more than 50%
                                          of the voting stock, or
                                          limited liability company
                                          interest, general
                                          partnership interest or
                                          voting interest in any

2

                                          such corporation, limited
                                          liability company or
                                          partnership;

"THIS AGREEMENT"                      :   this agreement (and the
                                          schedules to it), as varied
                                          from time to time pursuant
                                          to its terms;

"AUDITORS"                            :   Ernst & Young;

"BOARD"                               :   the board of directors of
                                          the GP, from time to time;

"BUDGET"                              :   the annual capital
                                          expenditure and operating
                                          budget of the LP, the first
                                          such budget, in respect of
                                          the period ending 31
                                          December 2006, being in the
                                          form set out in schedule 5;

"BUSINESS"                            :   the business to be
                                          transacted by the GP from
                                          time to time as referred to
                                          in schedule 2;

"CEDR"                                :   Centre for Effective Dispute
                                          Resolution;

"CHANGE OF CONTROL"                   :   occurs in relation to a
                                          Joint Venture Partner if:

                                          (a)  the ultimate Holding
                                               Company of the Joint
                                               Venture Partner as at
                                               the date it acquired
                                               its Joint Venture
                                               Interest ceases to have
                                               directly or indirectly,
                                               the right or power to
                                               direct or cause the
                                               direction of the
                                               management policies of
                                               a person either by
                                               contract or through
                                               ownership of interests
                                               or securities carrying
                                               a majority of the votes
                                               ordinarily exercisable
                                               by the holders of such
                                               interests or securities
                                               (unless

3

                                               such interests or
                                               securities have been
                                               acquired by or on
                                               behalf of the other
                                               Joint Venture Partner)
                                               or through the ability
                                               to appoint the majority
                                               of the directors or
                                               other governing
                                               officers of a person or
                                               through ownership of
                                               interests or other
                                               securities which carry
                                               the right to receive
                                               the greater part of the
                                               income of such person
                                               (if all its income were
                                               to be distributed)
                                               PROVIDED ALWAYS that
                                               the Demerger shall not
                                               constitute a Change of
                                               Control and Petrojarl
                                               ASA shall thereafter be
                                               considered the ultimate
                                               Holding Company of
                                               Petrojarl; or

                                          (b)  any action is taken to
                                               appoint a receiver,
                                               manager, liquidator or
                                               similar officer in
                                               respect of any assets
                                               of a Joint Venture
                                               Partner where such
                                               assets include the
                                               Joint Venture Interest
                                               held by the Joint
                                               Venture Partner;

"DISPOSE"                             :   (a)  any sale, transfer or
                                               other disposal or
                                               alienation of any
                                               entitlement to or
                                               legal, beneficial
                                               interest or right in,
                                               any Joint Venture
                                               Interest (including by
                                               way of gift, trust,
                                               grant or option or
                                               creation of any
                                               Encumbrance);

                                          (b)  any agreement for such
                                               sale, transfer or
                                               disposal;

                                          (c)  any act or thing, or
                                               series of acts or
                                               things which has the
                                               same or a

4

                                               substantially similar
                                               economic effect as
                                               anything in (a) or (b)
                                               above;

"DOLLARS" and "USD"                   :   means the lawful currency
                                          for the time being of the
                                          United States of America;

"ENCUMBRANCE"                         :   means an interest or power:

                                          (a)  reserved in or over an
                                               interest in any asset
                                               including, but not
                                               limited to, any
                                               retention of title; or

                                          (b)  created or otherwise
                                               arising in or over any
                                               interest in any asset
                                               under a bill of sale,
                                               mortgage, charge, lien,
                                               pledge, trust or power;

                                          (c)  by way of security for
                                               the payment of a debt
                                               or any other monetary
                                               obligation or the
                                               performance of any
                                               other obligation and
                                               includes any agreement
                                               to grant or create any
                                               of the above;

"DUE PROPORTIONS"                     :   in relation to the time
                                          when, as the case may be,
                                          any liability referred to in
                                          clause 6 arises or any
                                          finance referred to in
                                          clause 7 is required to be
                                          provided, such proportions
                                          as the nominal value of
                                          partnership interests held
                                          by each Shareholder bears to
                                          the aggregate nominal value
                                          of partnership interests
                                          issued but for the avoidance
                                          of doubt the proportion of
                                          shareholding between the
                                          Shareholders shall initially
                                          be 50:50;

"FAIR MARKET VALUE"                   :   in relation to a Project
                                          (including the relevant
                                          Unit) means the fair market
                                          value

5

                                          of that Project (including
                                          the relevant Unit) based
                                          upon what a knowledgeable
                                          and financially capable
                                          arm's length purchaser
                                          acting reasonably would be
                                          prepared to pay for the
                                          Project (including the
                                          relevant Unit) as a whole as
                                          if it were an orderly sale
                                          in the ordinary course of
                                          business. The valuation
                                          shall take into
                                          consideration the Project's
                                          past performance and its
                                          future prospects, and such
                                          other circumstances as the
                                          person carrying out the
                                          valuation considers
                                          relevant. The valuation
                                          shall be carried out by the
                                          firm that is the auditor for
                                          the time being of the Joint
                                          Venture, or if such person
                                          is not available for any
                                          reason, a valuator appointed
                                          by the auditors of the Joint
                                          Venture, and Fair Market
                                          Value shall be determined as
                                          of the date on which any
                                          option is exercised under
                                          Clause 7.11 to acquire a
                                          Project and the relevant
                                          Unit. In so acting the
                                          valuator is instructed to
                                          act as an expert and not as
                                          an arbitrator and the
                                          decision of the valuator
                                          shall (save in respect of
                                          manifest error) be final and
                                          binding on the Joint Venture
                                          Partners;

"FPSOS"                               :   floating production, storage
                                          and offloading facilities;

"FSOS"                                :   floating storage and
                                          offloading facilities;

"GROUP"                               :   in relation to a company,
                                          the group of companies
                                          comprising that company and
                                          any company which is from
                                          time to time a holding
                                          company of that company or a

6

                                          subsidiary of that company
                                          or of such holding company;

"GUARANTEES"                          :   all guarantees, indemnities
                                          and covenants of the nature
                                          referred to in clause 6.1 as
                                          varied, extended or renewed;

"INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY RIGHTS         :   means:

                                          (a)  patents (including
                                               continuations,
                                               reissues, and
                                               extensions), trade
                                               marks, service marks,
                                               rights (registered or
                                               unregistered) in any
                                               designs, applications
                                               and rights to apply for
                                               any of the foregoing,
                                               trade or business
                                               names, internet domain
                                               names and e-mail
                                               addresses, unregistered
                                               trade marks and service
                                               marks, brand names,
                                               copyrights (including
                                               rights in computer
                                               software), database
                                               rights, know-how,
                                               rights in designs and
                                               inventions, software
                                               (object and source code
                                               and any related
                                               documentation),
                                               business methods and
                                               trade secrets;

                                          (b)  rights under licences,
                                               consents, orders,
                                               statutes or otherwise
                                               in relation to a right
                                               or asset in paragraph
                                               (a);

                                          (c)  applications for all
                                               rights and assets in
                                               paragraph (a); and

7

                                          (d)  rights and means of the
                                               same or similar effect
                                               or nature as or to
                                               those in paragraphs (a)
                                               and (b),

                                          in each case in any
                                          jurisdiction, and which in
                                          the case of Petrojarl shall
                                          include but not be limited
                                          to those described in
                                          Schedule 7;

"JOINT VENTURE"                       :   the joint venture created by
                                          the Joint Venture Partners,
                                          and includes the Joint
                                          Venture Entities;

"JOINT VENTURE ENTITIES"              :   all legal entities
                                          established for the purpose
                                          of pursuing the Business and
                                          jointly owned by the Joint
                                          Venture Partners and any
                                          subsidiaries of such legal
                                          entities including but not
                                          limited to the GP, the LP,
                                          the Service Co, and wholly
                                          or partially owned
                                          subsidiary companies of any
                                          of them;

"JOINT VENTURE INTEREST"              :   100% of the interest of a
                                          Joint Venture Partner in the
                                          Joint Venture however
                                          represented, including all
                                          issued shares or units in
                                          the capital of the Joint
                                          Venture, the GP, the Service
                                          Co and the Joint Venture
                                          Entities from time to time
                                          (of whatever class);

"JOINT VENTURE PARTNER"               :   Petrojarl or Teekay as the
                                          case may be;

"LIMITED LIABILITY COMPANY ACT"           means the Limited Liability
                                          Company Act of the Republic
                                          of the Marshall Islands;

"LIMITED PARTNERSHIP ACT"             :   means the Limited
                                          Partnership Act of the
                                          Republic of the Marshall
                                          Islands;

"LIMITED LIABILITY COMPANY AGREEMENT"     means the limited liability
                                          company agreement of the GP
                                          in the form set out in

8

                                          schedule 1, Part B as
                                          amended from time to time;

"LIMITED PARTNERSHIP AGREEMENT"           means the limited
                                          partnership agreement of the
                                          LP in the form set out in
                                          schedule 1, Part A as
                                          amended from time to time;

"MAJOR DECISION"                      :   any decision which may not
                                          be delegated by the Board or
                                          the GP, as provided by
                                          clause 12.1 and more fully
                                          described in Schedule 3;

"PARTIES"                             :   the parties to this
                                          Agreement; and "Party" means
                                          any one of them;

"PETROJARL FPSOS"                     :   those FPSOs currently
                                          operated by entities within
                                          the Petrojarl Group and
                                          listed in Schedule 6(A);

"PETROJARL GROUP"                     :   (i) prior to the Demerger,
                                          PGS Production ASA and its
                                          related bodies corporate
                                          (but excluding the Joint
                                          Venture and the Joint
                                          Venture Entities); and (ii)
                                          after the Demerger Petrojarl
                                          ASA and its related bodies
                                          corporate (but excluding the
                                          Joint Venture and the Joint
                                          Venture Entities) and MEMBER
                                          OF THE PETROJARL GROUP has a
                                          corresponding meaning;

"PROJECTS"                            :   any opportunity to tender
                                          for the provision of mobile
                                          production solutions to the
                                          oil industry;

"SERVICE CO"                          :   Teekay Petrojarl Services
                                          AS, a company incorporated
                                          under the laws of Norway;

"SHAREHOLDERS"                        :   Petrojarl and Teekay and any
                                          other person who, as a
                                          transferee of partnership
                                          interests in the LP, is
                                          required to enter into a

9

                                          covenant to comply with the
                                          terms of this Agreement
                                          pursuant to clause 11.6, for
                                          so long as such persons are
                                          holders of partnership
                                          interests; and "Shareholder"
                                          means any one of them;

"SUPPORT SERVICES"                    :   engineering, design,
                                          technical, computer,
                                          commercial, accounting,
                                          legal, personnel,
                                          procurement and other
                                          management and specialist
                                          services and equipment
                                          required by the GP from
                                          third parties (including the
                                          Shareholders) for the
                                          purpose of carrying on the
                                          Business;

"TEEKAY FSOS"                         :   those FSOs currently
                                          operated by entities within
                                          the Teekay Group and listed
                                          in Schedule 6(B);

"TEEKAY GROUP"                        :   Teekay Shipping Corporation
                                          and its related bodies
                                          corporate (but excluding the
                                          Joint Venture and the Joint
                                          Venture Entities) and MEMBER
                                          OF THE TEEKAY GROUP has a
                                          corresponding meaning;

"UK"                                  :   the United Kingdom of Great
                                          Britain and Northern
                                          Ireland;

"UNIT"                                :   any FPSO, FSO or other
                                          equipment marketed by the
                                          Joint Venture;

"WORKING DAY"                         :   any day (except Saturdays
                                          and Sundays) on which banks
                                          are open for general
                                          business in Oslo and New
                                          York City.

1.2 references to clauses and the schedules are to clauses of and the schedules to this Agreement;

1.3 words importing gender include each gender;

10

1.4 references to persons include bodies corporate, firms and unincorporated associations;

1.5 the singular includes the plural and vice versa;

1.6 clause headings are included for the convenience of the Parties only and do not affect its interpretation; and

1.7 references to all or any part of any statute or statutory instrument include any statutory amendment, modification or re-enactment in force from time to time and references to any statute include any statutory instrument or regulations made under it.

2 PRELIMINARY FORMALITIES

Forthwith following signature of this Agreement, the Joint Venture Partners shall take, or cause to be taken, such steps as are necessary to procure that the following provisions of this clause and clause 3, in so far as such provisions have not already been implemented, are implemented.

2.1 The Joint Venture Partners will:

2.1.1 each become a member of the GP, execute the Limited Liability Company Agreement in substantially the form attached in Schedule 1 hereof, and make initial capital contributions as provided therein in cash;

2.1.2 each become a limited partner of the LP, execute the Limited Partnership Agreement in substantially the form attached in Schedule 1 hereof, and make initial capital contributions as provided therein in cash;

2.1.3 procure that the GP shall become the general partner of the LP, execute the Limited Partnership Agreement in substantially the form attached in Schedule 1 hereof, and make initial capital contributions as provided therein in cash;

2.1.4 each subscribe for an equal number of shares in the Service Co at par and in cash.

11

2.2 The GP will own the capital assets of the Joint Venture, either directly or indirectly provided however that a Joint Venture Partner shall be entitled to warehouse its interest in a Project in a member of its Group during the project development phase and subsequently transfer it to the GP or as it may direct when the Project begins to generate revenue.

2.3 The GP will manage assets and operations through the LP as general partner of the LP.

2.4 Teekay Petrojarl Services AS will provide services to the Joint Venture, predominantly during the project tendering phase but also during the operation phase as determined by the Board.

2.5 The Joint Venture Partners intend to structure and operate the Joint Venture so as to minimize, to the extent reasonably commercially possible, the tax payable by the Joint Venture.

3 BOARD OF DIRECTORS OF GP

3.1 APPOINTMENT AND REMOVAL OF DIRECTORS

3.1.1 The Board of Directors shall be appointed and removed in accordance with the Limited Liability Company Agreement. In their capacity as Members of the GP, each Joint Venture Partner shall appoint as directors persons who are in good standing in the community, of good repute, who have the power to act on behalf of the Joint Venture Partner, and who will enhance the reputation and prospects of the Joint Venture.

3.1.2 Any appointor removing a director shall be responsible for and shall indemnify and hold harmless the other Shareholder and the GP against any claim for unfair or wrongful dismissal or otherwise arising out of such removal.

3.2 DIRECTORS DUTIES

Although a director shall act in the best interests of the GP, a director appointed by a Joint Venture Partner may have regard to and represent the interests of that Joint Venture Partner and act on the wishes of that Joint Venture Partner in performing

12

any of his or her duties or in exercising any power as a director in relation to the law.

3.3 FREQUENCY OF MEETINGS

The Joint Venture Partners shall procure that the Board shall:

3.3.1 be responsible for the overall management, guidance and direction of the GP, which shall include the preparation of its business plan and the review of its objectives, business procedures, budgets and cash call mechanisms;

3.3.2 oversee the business development and sales and marketing activities for the GP worldwide;

3.3.3 identify Projects suitable for the LP;

3.3.4 develop and approve budgets for Projects;

3.3.5 optimise the use of existing resources from both Teekay and Petrojarl for all aspects of the Business, and endeavour to ensure that the contributions of each Joint Venture Partner to the GP and other Joint Venture Entities are broadly equivalent by reference to the reports delivered pursuant to clause 7.3;

3.3.6 appoint and supervise project teams from the employees of the Joint Venture Partners (via the Service Co) for each Project;

3.3.7 approve the terms of any bid for a Project; and

3.3.8 establish an appropriate authorisation matrix setting out the appropriate authorisations and signatories required for the different aspects of the Business.

3.4 DIRECTORS' REIMBURSEMENT FOR EXPENSES

No directors fees shall be paid to persons appointed as directors of any Joint Venture Entity, but this provision shall be without prejudice to the terms of any contract of services held by any such person. All out-of-pocket expenses incurred

13

by a director in carrying out his or her duties as a director shall be paid by the Joint Venture Partner who appointed that director.

3.5 DISCLOSURE OF INFORMATION

Each director shall be entitled to disclose any information relating to the Joint Venture Entities and its business, affairs and financial position to the Joint Venture Partner which appointed him.

4 MANAGEMENT AND STAFF

4.1 The managing director of the Service Co shall be appointed by mutual agreement between the Joint Venture Partners. Mr. Oystein Huglem shall be the first managing director.

4.2 The GP shall recruit and employ such staff as the Board shall from time to time consider necessary for the proper conduct of the Business. The present intention of the Joint Venture Partners is that the GP will not initially have any direct employees, but shall be resourced by secondments from the Joint Venture Partners via the Service Co.

4.3 Each Joint Venture Partner shall (if so requested by the Board) use reasonable endeavours to second appropriate personnel to the GP via the Service Co on a full time or a part time basis and otherwise on terms to be agreed between the Board and that Joint Venture Partner.

4.4 If a Joint Venture Partner decides that any person seconded pursuant to clause 4.3 or the Managing Director appointed pursuant to Clause 4.1 is not suitable for employment in connection with the Business it may require the Service Co to withdraw and replace such person (or, in the case of the Managing Director, for the Board to appoint a new Managing Director) or to take such other steps as it may deem necessary or expedient.

4.5 All the salaries, wages, allowances, travelling and accommodation expenses and other benefits to which such seconded executives may be entitled and all necessary employer's pension and national insurance contributions in each case relating to the period of such secondment shall, except where otherwise agreed, be borne and paid by the GP at rates agreed to by the Board, such rates to be established in a manner

14

consistent with sound business practices and any applicable transfer pricing principles and to form part of the reports delivered pursuant to clause 7.3.

5 OBJECTIVE AND CONDUCT OF BUSINESS

5.1 The principal activities in which the GP shall be engaged shall be as described in schedule 2.

5.2 It is the intention of the Joint Venture Partners that the GP shall operate so far as practicable as a self-sufficient unit in the contracting and performance of its activities, as specified in clause 5.1, but where this objective cannot be achieved then, until it is possible to do so, each Joint Venture Partner shall use its reasonable endeavours to provide Support Services to the GP via the Service Co pursuant to the terms of clause 8.1.

5.3 The GP will ensure that single purpose subsidiaries are established for each Project (the "JOINT VENTURE ENTITIES"). The constitution and governance of each Joint Venture Entity shall be consistent with the terms of this Agreement and with the constitution and governance of the GP, save that each Joint Venture Entity shall only be concerned with a single Project.

5.4 It is intended that the Joint Venture should be self-financing and that it should obtain additional funds from third parties without recourse to the Joint Venture Partners unless otherwise agreed to in the Budget. The Joint Venture shall borrow additional funds from third parties on the most favourable terms available and which are compatible with its needs, as provided for in the Budget, but with the intention of raising twenty per cent. (20%) of required capital in the form of contributions (in the Due Proportions) of the Joint Venture Partners and the balance of eighty per cent. (80%) in the form of third party debt.

5.5 Other than as provided in clause 6, the Joint Venture Partners shall not be obliged to guarantee or provide security for any indebtedness of the Joint Venture. The liability of the Joint Venture Partners under guarantees of the Joint Venture issued pursuant to this clause 5 shall be several and not joint or joint and several, unless otherwise agreed. If a Joint Venture Partner incurs any such liability, that Partner shall be entitled to contribution from the other Joint Venture Partner to ensure that

15

the aggregate liability of the Joint Venture Partners is borne equally by the Joint Venture Partners.

5.6 If a Joint Venture Partner guarantees or provides security for any indebtedness of the Joint Venture and thereby reduces the cost of borrowing of the Joint Venture, the Joint Venture shall pay to such Joint Venture Partner a guarantee fee calculated in accordance with transfer pricing principles that the Joint Venture Partners have agreed are applicable to the operation of the Joint Venture.

6 GUARANTEES AND INDEMNITIES

6.1 The GP shall not undertake any activity requiring a bond or guarantee or in any way pledging the credit of the Joint Venture Partners or either of them without the prior consent of each Joint Venture Partner. Where, for the purpose of providing such security, the Joint Venture Partners agree that any liability is to be assumed jointly and/or severally by them under any guarantee, undertaking or other obligation of a similar nature, it is the intention of the Joint Venture Partners that:

6.1.1 the amount of such liability shall be apportioned between them in the Due Proportions; and

6.1.2 Notwithstanding any agreement with the beneficiary of such guarantee, undertaking or obligation, they shall be liable to make contributions between themselves and indemnify and keep indemnified each other so that such liability is ultimately borne in the Due Proportions.

6.2 If any liability incurred is solely attributable to the act or default of one Joint Venture Partner then, notwithstanding the terms of clause 6.1, the whole of such liability shall be borne by such Joint Venture Partner who shall indemnify and keep indemnified the other Joint Venture Partner accordingly.

6.3 Neither Joint Venture Partner shall take or receive from the GP or any other person any security in connection with the Guarantees without the prior written consent of the other Joint Venture Partner. Any security so taken or received (or any sum of money received in respect of such security) shall be held by the relevant Joint Venture Partner as trustee for both Joint Venture Partners so that they shall share the benefit of the same in the Due Proportions.

16

6.4 Nothing contained in this Agreement shall operate to deprive either Joint Venture Partner of any rights or remedies available to it at law against the other Joint Venture Partner as co-sureties under the Guarantees, except to the extent that any rights or remedies are inconsistent with or excluded by the terms of this Agreement.

7 BUDGETS, ACCOUNTS AND FINANCE

7.1 The Joint Venture shall establish, maintain and duly administer an internal control system comprising policies, processes and such other features as are necessary or advisable, and in accordance with best practices in the industry, to help:

7.1.1 ensure its effective and efficient operation by enabling it to manage significant business, operational, financial, compliance and other risks to achieve its objectives;

7.1.2 ensure the quality of its internal and external reporting; and

7.1.3 ensure compliance with any applicable laws and regulations binding on it and assist in the compliance by the Joint Venture Partners (but with any incremental costs of so doing to be apportioned in accordance with Clause 7.3.7) with any applicable laws and regulations binding on any of them.

7.2 Subject always to any applicable obligations of confidentiality, the Joint Venture shall provide, at the expense of the Joint Venture Partner requesting the information, such information and such access to persons, premises or books and records as any of the Joint Venture Partners shall reasonably require in order to:

7.2.1 satisfy themselves that the provisions of Clause 7.1 are being complied with; and/or

7.2.2 allow them to comply with any obligations to which they are subject under the laws and regulations referred to in Clause 7.1.3.

7.3 The Joint Venture Partners shall procure that the Board of the GP shall be responsible for proper planning, forecasting and reporting and shall, among other things:

7.3.1 provide the Joint Venture Partners with financial reports of the LP, each Project and the Service Co. on a quarterly basis within fifteen (15)

17

Working Days after the end of each quarter including, but not limited to, a balance sheet, profit and loss statement, cash flow and forward projections on a rolling twelve (12) month basis showing the year-to-date performance against the Budget, and a rolling one year forecast of the performance against the Budget together with a statement as to the contributions of each Shareholder (in the form of seconding employees, provision of office space and other services) by reference to agreed rates specified from time to time by the Board of the GP;

7.3.2 prepare each annual Budget for submission to and approval by the Joint Venture Partners;

7.3.3 ensure that audited financial statements of the GP and all Joint Venture Entities are prepared in respect of each fiscal year and submitted to the Joint Venture Partners not more than sixty (60) days after the end of such fiscal year;

7.3.4 a report from the Board on the financial position and affairs of the Joint Venture within ten (10) Working Days after the end of each calendar quarter, such report to include a summary of the Joint Venture's "long" and "short" positions and a calculation of the capital at risk;

7.3.5 as soon as they are available, reasonable details of any actual or prospective material change in the Business or the financial position or affairs of the Joint Venture;

7.3.6 supply such other financial and other information to the Joint Venture Partners in such form and at such times as either of them may reasonably require in order to conform the Budgets and financial reports to the accounting standards and reporting obligations of the Joint Venture Partners, and comply with all such regulatory requirements as may be required by a Joint Venture Partner, it being agreed and acknowledged that any additional costs that may be incurred by the Joint Venture in meeting accounting or regulatory standards not applicable to the Joint Venture Partner shall be for the account of the relevant Joint Venture Partner.

18

7.4 The GP shall ensure that all accounting records of the Joint Venture Entities are maintained in accordance with accounting principles and practices generally accepted in the United States of America and such records shall be audited annually by the Auditors or such other firm of chartered accountants as shall be approved by the Board.

7.5 All records of the GP and the Joint Venture Entities shall be open to examination and audit by either Joint Venture Partner or its duly authorised representative, each of whom shall be entitled to such further information as it may reasonably require concerning their business affairs and financial position.

7.6 The Joint Venture Partners shall each use reasonable endeavours to procure that borrowings from banks and other similar sources shall be on the most favourable terms reasonably obtainable as to interest, repayment and security.

7.7 The working capital needs of the GP and LP, as envisaged in any Budget, together with any cost over-runs on Projects, shall be provided by the Joint Venture Partners in the Due Proportions to the extent that such needs are not satisfied from the any such company's share capital and reserves and third party borrowing. Such funding shall be by way of loan by each of the Joint Venture Partners to the GP in each case upon the terms of a note (a "Loan Note") on arm's length commercial terms but otherwise in form and substance acceptable to each Joint Venture Partner.

7.8 If (a) any of the GP or other Joint Venture Entities has excess working capital needs referred to in clause 7.7 and (b) the GP (or other relevant Joint Venture Entity) is unable to fund such excess by third party borrowing, then either Joint Venture Partner on behalf of the such company may require the Board of the GP to instruct the Auditors to confirm that such company is able to pay its debts as they fall due without realisation of any of its fixed assets and that the assets of such company exceed its liabilities. If the Auditors are unable to provide such confirmation they shall calculate and certify the amount of further working capital required by such company (the "Auditors' Certificate").

7.9 Unless otherwise agreed, the Joint Venture Partners shall advance to the GP or other Joint Venture Entity in the Due Proportions such sums as shall be equal in the aggregate to the further working capital specified in the Auditors' Certificate for the

19

purposes of financing the GP or other Joint Venture Entity on the terms of this clause and in the following manner:

7.9.1 forthwith upon receipt of the Auditors' Certificate the Joint Venture Partners shall procure that the Board issues to each of the Joint Venture Partners a notice in writing (a "Funding Notice"), specifying the amount which each of them is required to lend to such company;

7.9.2 each Joint Venture Partner shall advance to the GP or LP in cash the amount stated in such Funding Notice within ten (10) Working Days of the date of its receipt; and

7.9.3 amounts advanced by the Joint Venture Partners to the GP or LP shall be loaned in each case upon the terms of a Loan Note.

7.10 If either Joint Venture Partner (in this Clause 7 the "Defaulting Joint Venture Partner") fails to lend any amount properly requested by the Board of the GP pursuant to and within the time specified in clause 7.9.2, the other Joint Venture Partner (the "Supporting Joint Venture Partner") shall be entitled (subject only to its having duly loaned any amount properly required from it pursuant to this clause 7) to lend to the GP or LP in cash and on arm's length commercial terms the amount due to the GP or LP by the Defaulting Joint Venture Partner against security over the assets of the Project requiring the additional funding. The Defaulting Joint Venture Partner may provide its funds to the GP or LP within six (6) months of its initial failure to do and in such circumstances the Supporting Joint Venture Partner shall have its loan repaid and release any security it might hold for such loan.

7.11 At the end of the six (6) month period referred to in Clause 7.10 (and if the Defaulting Joint Venture Partner has not in the meantime provided its funds in full to the GP or the LP), the Supporting Joint Venture Partner has a further period of the lesser of (a) six (6) months from such date and (b) the period until the Unit in the Project for which the Defaulting Joint Venture Partner failed to lend goes on hire, to exercise an option (which once exercised shall be irrevocable) to purchase such Unit and such Project from the Joint Venture. The purchase price shall be the lesser of:

20

(i) the Fair Market Value of such Project (including the Unit) discounted by twenty per cent (20%) less the amount of loans made available for such Project by the Supporting Joint Venture Partner; and

(ii) the actual amounts paid by the Joint Venture in respect of such Project (including the Unit) discounted by twenty per cent (20%) less the amount of loans made available for such Project by the Supporting Joint Venture Partner,

but in any event shall not be less than zero.

If the Supporting Joint Venture Partner exercises this option, completion of the transfer of the Project and the Unit shall take place as soon as may be reasonably practical and the restrictions in clause 16 shall not apply to that Project and that Unit.

7.12 it is acknowledged and agreed that the only recourse and sanction against a Defaulting Joint Venture Partner for failing to advance funds in accordance with Clause 7.9 shall be as set out in Clauses 7.10 and 7.11.

8 SUPPORT SERVICES AND SUPPLIES

8.1 If the GP requires Support Services of a type or kind which either Joint Venture Partner is able to supply or provide, then that Joint Venture Partner may tender to provide such Support Services (via the Service Co) on an arm's length basis but having regard to customary transfer pricing principles for the relevant category of Support Services.

8.2 Either Joint Venture Partner may at any time require that the other Joint Venture Partner (in this clause a "Supplier") shall provide a certificate signed by the auditors for the time being of the Supplier stating that the Support Services concerned have been provided on the basis referred to in clause 8.1 (or if the auditors will not assist, an opinion from an appropriate tax counsel). The Joint Venture Partners shall use their respective reasonable endeavours to procure that such auditors are allowed access to all papers of the GP, LP, the Service Co and of the Joint Venture Partners which may be relevant to any enquiries they may make prior to giving a certificate under this clause. The costs of such auditors (or tax counsel) shall be borne by whichever Joint Venture Partner required such certificate, except that, if such

21

certificate is not given in the terms required by this clause, the costs shall be borne by the Supplier.

9 TAX TREATMENT

The LP is established under the assumption that it is not considered a separate tax subject in any jurisdiction where it might operate or hold shares in subsidiaries, whereas any income of the LP for tax purposes will flow through to and be taxed at the hand of the Joint Venture Partners in accordance with each Joint Venture Partner's ownership percentage in the LP. Each of the Joint Venture Partners are separately responsible for their own income taxes as well as other taxes or duties imposed on the activities performed by the LP, regardless of in which country(ies) such are levied. This includes, but is not limited to, any withholding tax on dividends paid by companies owned by the LP.

10 DISTRIBUTION OF PROFITS

As a general rule and unless otherwise decided by the Board of the GP, it is the intention of the Joint Venture Partners that, subject to the requirements of applicable law, on finalisation and audit of the financial statements of the GP and other Joint Venture Entities for each accounting period (subject to the due servicing of any loans made to the GP or LP by either of the Joint Venture Partners pursuant to this Agreement), the Board shall distribute as much as possible of the cash available for distribution, having regard to:

10.1 amounts determined by the Board of the GP to be required (not to exceed fifty per cent (50%) of distributable profits) to provide sufficient working capital and any reserves (whether required by law or otherwise) for the LP; and

10.2 the taxation position of the LP under the relevant legislation.

11 PARTNERSHIP INTEREST TRANSFERS

11.1 PROHIBITION

Neither Joint Venture Partner shall, without the prior written consent of the other, directly or indirectly Dispose of its partnership interests in the LP or its shares in either the GP or the Service Co or any other Joint Venture Entity or the certificates representing any of the foregoing now or in the future held by it, except by a transfer to a single transferee of the entire legal and beneficial interest in all its Joint

22

Venture Interest as expressly permitted by Clause 11 or Clause 15 of this Agreement or in accordance with Clause 11.3.

11.2 REGISTRATION OF TRANSFERS

The Joint Venture Partners hereby covenant and undertake with each other to comply with the terms of this Agreement and the Limited Liability Company Agreement and the Limited Partnership Agreement relating to the transfer of partnership interests and to take all such steps as may be required to effect due registration of transfers effected in accordance with this Agreement and/or the Limited Liability Company Agreement and the Limited Partnership Agreement.

11.3 Notwithstanding the provisions of this Clause 11, a Joint Venture Partner may encumber its Joint Venture Interests as security for any financing arrangement with a bona fide commercial bank in the ordinary course for business purposes, provided such bank is made aware of the terms and conditions of this Agreement.

11.4 A Joint Venture Partner may transfer all or a portion of its Joint Venture Interests to any Permitted Group Transferee as defined in clause 11.5 provided that:

11.4.1 the transferring Joint Venture Partner ("INTRA-GROUP TRANSFEROR") gives written notice of the impending transfer together with an executed deed referred to in clause 11.6 to the other Joint Venture Partner not less than 7 days before the transfer is to be effected; and

11.4.2 the terms of the transfer comply with clause 11.6.

11.5 For the purposes of this clause, where the Intra-Group Transferor is:

11.5.1 Petrojarl, the Permitted Group Transferee is any member of the Petrojarl Group; and

11.5.2 Teekay, the Permitted Group Transferee is any member of the Teekay Group.

11.6 As a condition precedent to any transfer under clause 11.4, the transferring Joint Venture Partner shall procure that the transferee executes a deed in favour of the Joint Venture and each other Joint Venture Partner stating that it shall assume as its own and be bound by all obligations of the transferring Joint Venture Partner under

23

this agreement as if it were a party to it. The transferring Joint Venture Partner will not be released from its obligations under this Agreement or under the Share Purchase Agreement as a result of such transfer or execution of such deed.

11.7 CHANGE OF CONTROL

If a Change of Control shall apply to either Joint Venture Partner, then the other Joint Venture Partner shall have the right (but not the obligation) within ninety (90) days of the Change of Control to instigate the procedure set out in clauses 15.7 to 15.9.

12 MUTUAL UNDERTAKINGS CONCERNING THE LP

MAJOR DECISIONS

Each Joint Venture Partner undertakes with the other to exercise its voting rights with a view to procuring that the GP shall not delegate responsibility in respect of anything which shall from time to time be declared by the Joint Venture Partners in writing to require the unanimous approval of the Board (which at the date of this Agreement shall be those matters set out in schedule 3, any of which may be varied at any time by the written agreement of the Joint Venture Partners).

12.1 EXERCISE OF VOTING RIGHTS

Each Joint Venture Partner undertakes with the other:

12.1.1 to exercise all voting rights and powers of control available to it in relation to the GP, the LP and the other Joint Venture Entities so as to give full effect to the terms of this Agreement;

12.1.2 to procure that the directors of the GP and the other Joint Venture Entities nominated by it and its other representatives will support and implement all reasonable proposals put forward at meetings of the Board and other meetings of the GP and the other Joint Venture Entities for the proper development and conduct of the Business as contemplated in this Agreement;

12.1.3 (except where specific time periods are referred to in this Agreement) to respond to any communication received from the other and/or the GP

24

and/or the other Joint Venture Entities within ten (10) Working Days of its receipt;

12.1.4 to procure that all third parties directly or indirectly under its control shall refrain from acting in a manner which will hinder or prevent the GP and/or the other Joint Venture Entities from carrying on the Business in a proper and reasonable manner; and

12.1.5 generally to use its reasonable endeavours to promote the Business and the interests of the GP and/or the other Joint Venture Entities.

12.2 CONFLICTS

In the event of any conflict between the terms of this Agreement and those of the Limited Liability Company Agreement, the Limited Partnership Agreement, and/or the constitutional documents of any Joint Venture Entity, then the Joint Venture Partners shall each take all such steps as lie within their respective powers to procure and effect any amendment or alteration to the Limited Liability Company Agreement, Limited Partnership Agreement and/or the constitutional documents of any Joint Venture Entity as may be necessary, to carry out the intention and terms of this Agreement, so far as such amendment or alteration is permitted by the applicable laws governing the Limited Liability Company Agreement, Limited Partnership Agreement and/or the constitutional documents of any Joint Venture Entity.

12.3 JOINT OBLIGATIONS

Whenever in this Agreement an obligation is imposed on the GP, such obligation shall be construed and applied so as to impose on the Joint Venture Partners, as between themselves, a joint obligation (additional to that of the GP) to procure, so far as they are able, that the GP or the LP shall perform its obligation.

12.4 GP'S OBLIGATIONS

Except where to do so would constitute an unlawful fetter on its powers, the GP undertakes with each of the Joint Venture Partners to be bound by and to comply with the provisions of this Agreement insofar as they relate to the GP and to act in all respects in the manner contemplated by this Agreement with respect to its own

25

business and the business of any other Joint Venture Entity, including but not limited to the LP.

12.5 MARKETING

Each Joint Venture Partner undertakes to provide all information and support as may be reasonably required in order to enable the GP and any other Joint Venture Entity to satisfy potential clients as to its or their capabilities and shall provide all details of experience, trading history, financial resources and other information reasonably required for this purpose.

12.6 PROTECTION OF NAME

Each Joint Venture Partner undertakes with the other that:

12.6.1 it shall not at any time use or permit to be used the name "Teekay" or the tagline "Teekay - The Marine Midstream Company" (in the case of Petrojarl) or "Petrojarl" or "Petrojarl Production" (in the case of Teekay) or any similar trading style; and

12.6.2 if the GP goes into liquidation or into Run Off (as defined in Clause 15.7) it will join with the other to cause the name of the GP to be changed to a name excluding the words Teekay and Petrojarl or any similar trading style.

12.7 SUBSIDIARIES

The GP shall procure (so far as it is able) that any company which becomes a subsidiary of the LP at any time during the term of this Agreement shall adopt new articles of association in such form as the Board of the GP shall approve in writing.

12.8 CONDUCT OF CLAIMS

If any dispute occurs between the GP or LP and a Joint Venture Partner or any member of such Joint Venture Partner's Group then (but only in relation to matters concerning such dispute):

12.8.1 such Joint Venture Partner shall not be allowed to exercise its voting rights in the GP or LP (as the case may be); and

26

12.8.2 the quorum requirements for all or that part of meetings of Joint Venture Partners, directors or any committee of directors of the GP at which such dispute is to be discussed or in relation to which resolutions are to be passed shall be varied accordingly so as to permit the other Joint Venture Partner to exercise sole control over the GP for all purposes relating to the dispute concerned.

13 DELIBERATELY NOT USED

14 COMMENCEMENT AND TERMINATION

14.1 This Agreement shall become effective on the date of the Demerger, subject always to all necessary regulatory approvals, pursuant to merger control, antitrust or competition laws, having been obtained (whether by decision of the relevant regulatory entity, expiry or termination of the waiting periods or otherwise) and/or all necessary competition or merger control notifications having been made.

14.2 Thereafter (subject to the terms of this clause) it shall continue until the first to occur of the following dates:

14.2.1 the date of commencement of the GP's winding up; or

14.2.2 the date on which the Joint Venture Partners unanimously agree to terminate this Agreement; or

14.2.3 the date of registration of a transfer of partnership interests resulting in all partnership interests in the GP or LP being held by or on behalf of one Joint Venture Partner;

subject to (a) the relevant provisions of this Agreement and (b) the performance of any obligations or exercise of any rights respectively remaining to be performed or exercised after the event and to any rights of the Parties in respect of antecedent breaches or non-observance of this Agreement.

14.3 It is agreed and acknowledged that the GP may execute this Agreement after it is executed by the Joint Venture Partners. However, as between the Joint Venture Partners, it shall be a valid and enforceable agreement (in accordance with its terms) from the execution of the Agreement by the Joint Venture Partners.

27

15 DEADLOCK

15.1 Whenever a matter is submitted to a general meeting of the GP pursuant to clause 12.1 and that general meeting is also unable to arrive at a decision on the matter by reason of a disagreement between the Joint Venture Partners then a deadlock shall be deemed to have occurred in relation to that matter.

15.2 If deadlock arises as to whether or not to bid on a Project then the GP will not, and will not cause any Joint Venture Entity to, bid on the Project. In such circumstances the Joint Venture Partner not wishing to bid on the Project shall not be entitled to tender for that Project, either directly or indirectly, alone or together with another party, nor shall that Joint Venture Partner assist or participate with any other person tendering on that Project except with the express written consent of the other Joint Venture Partner. The Joint Venture Partner that wishes to bid on the Project shall however be entitled to pursue the Project, either by itself or with a third party. For the avoidance of doubt if one Joint Venture Partner wishes to offer one of its existing Units for a Project it shall be free to do so and the Joint Venture may only make a competing bid if both Joint Venture Partners wish to do so. If deadlock arises as to the terms on which to bid on a Project, the matter should be referred to the Chief Executive Officers at such time (the "CEOs") of the ultimate holding companies of each Joint Venture Partner. Thereafter procedures set out in Clauses 15.4, 15.5 (but with the time limit of twenty (20) Working Days, replaced for these purposes only with a time period of five (5) Working Days) and 15.6 shall apply. If the CEOs are unable to reach a decision by the end of this consultation period, then each Joint Venture Partner shall be entitled to bid for the Project alone, and the provisions of Clause 16 shall not apply to such bids or any resulting contracts.

15.3 If and whenever a deadlock is deemed to have occurred (other than in the circumstances set out in clause 15.2), either Joint Venture Partner shall be entitled, within twenty (20) Working Days after the date on which the deadlock occurred, by written notice to the other, to require the matter to which the deadlock relates to be referred to the CEOs.

15.4 Each of the Joint Venture Partners and the GP shall supply the CEOs with any information which they may request.

28

15.5 The CEOs shall endeavour for a period of twenty (20) Working Days from the date of referral of the deadlock to them under Clause 15.3 (the "CEO Consultation Period") to decide the course of action which, in all the circumstances, it would be appropriate for the GP and the Joint Venture Entities to take in its best interests. In reaching their decision the CEOs shall, so far as possible, balance the interests of each Joint Venture Partner fairly but they shall not put the interests of any Joint Venture Partner before those of the GP and the Joint Venture Entities.

15.6 Forthwith upon receiving the CEOs decision each of the Joint Venture Partners and the GP shall ensure that the CEOs decision and directions are carried out.

15.7 If the CEOs are unable to reach a decision by the end of the CEO Consultation Period, within thirty (30) Working Days thereafter either Joint Venture Partner (the "Offeror") may by written notice to the other (which once given shall be irrevocable) declare that the Joint Venture is in run off ("Run Off").

15.8 Whilst the Joint Venture is in Run Off:

(i) any Projects then being considered by the Joint Venture, but prior to any bids having been irrevocably submitted, shall be terminated;

(ii) no new Projects shall be considered by the Joint Venture;

(iii) all other Projects shall continue to be run in the same manner as before until the relevant Unit finishes its then current contract, with capital expenditure required to meet obligations under such contract still to be funded in accordance with the terms of this Agreement;

(iv) no existing contracts for such Projects may be amended or extended or commitments to further capital expenditure made (other than as envisaged in paragraph (iii) above) without the consent of each Joint Venture Partner;

(v) when existing contracts come to an end, the relevant Unit shall not be redeployed by the Joint Venture but shall be marketed for sale to third parties and sold to the highest bidder (it being agreed and acknowledged that each Joint Venture Partner may bid for the Unit in its own capacity) on the best available terms; the GP will appoint an independent third party to

29

manage any such auction process in accordance with then prevailing best market practice;

(vi) neither Joint Venture Partner may solicit employees of the Joint Venture; and

(vii) the provisions of Clause 16 shall be of no further effect, but in all other respects this Agreement shall remain in full force and effect.

15.9 Notwithstanding the provisions of Clause 15.8, it is the intention of the Parties to enter into good faith negotiations when the Joint Venture goes into Run Off to seek an orderly separation of the Joint Venture assets and a winding up of the Joint Venture (subject to obtaining any necessary third party consents) within three (3) years.

16 RESTRICTIONS

16.1 In clauses 16.1 and 16.2, the following expressions have the following meanings:

"Exceptions"                          :   (i) the contracts as at the
                                          date hereof relating to
                                          Petrojarl FPSOs and, Teekay
                                          FSOs; (ii) any redeployment
                                          of Petrojarl FPSOs or Teekay
                                          FSOs; and (iii) any
                                          exception contemplated by
                                          clause 7.11 or by clause
                                          15.2;

"Prohibited Business"                 :   the Business carried on by
                                          any Joint Venture Entity as
                                          at the date in question or,
                                          if earlier, the Termination
                                          Date relating to the Joint
                                          Venture Partner concerned;

"Prohibited Supply Business"              the business of making
                                          supplies of the kind made to
                                          the GP during the Relevant
                                          Period in relation to any
                                          Prohibited Business;

"Relevant Period"                     :   the period from the date
                                          hereof until the Joint
                                          Venture goes into Run Off;

30

"Restricted Supplier"                 :   any person who was at any
                                          time in the Relevant Period
                                          a supplier of the GP or any
                                          Joint Venture Entity;

"Termination Date"                    :   in relation to any
                                          particular Joint Venture
                                          Partner, the date it ceases
                                          to hold any partnership
                                          interests.

16.2 Each of the Joint Venture Partners undertakes to the other, and separately with the GP, that it will not directly or indirectly on its own account or on behalf of any other person and whether as principal, Joint Venture Partner, partner, employee, agent or otherwise at any time prior to Run Off, (other than in respect of the Exceptions) carry on or be concerned or interested or engaged (except as a shareholder in a public listed company holding not more than five (5) per cent of the share capital, of any class, of such public company) in (a) any business competing with the whole or part of the Prohibited Business or (b) the setting up of any business which would compete with the whole or part of the Prohibited Business.

16.3 Nothing contained in this clause 16 shall preclude or restrict a Joint Venture Partner or any member of such Joint Venture Partner's Group from:

16.3.1 carrying on any activity carried on during the twelve (12) month period immediately preceding the date of this Agreement; or

16.3.2 offering any service or goods similar to those previously supplied as part of the Business but subsequently discontinued and not supplied by the LP at the time when such similar service or goods are offered.

For the purposes of this clause 16.3 a service or offer of goods shall be regarded as discontinued if it has not been provided or offered by the GP or any Joint Venture Entity for a twelve (12) month period.

16.4 The restrictions contained in clause 16.2 are considered reasonable by the Parties and are intended to be separate and severable. If any of those restrictions are held void but would be valid if part of the wording were deleted, such restriction shall apply with such deletion as may be necessary to make it valid and effective.

31

17 REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES

17.1 Each of Petrojarl and Teekay represents and warrants to the other that:

17.1.1 it is a corporation or company duly incorporated or formed under the laws of its place of incorporation or formation and has the corporate power and authority to accept the terms of this Agreement and perform its obligations under it;

17.1.2 its entry into this Agreement has been duly and validly authorised and all requisite corporate action has been taken in order to make such entry valid and binding upon it in accordance with the terms of this Agreement;

17.1.3 the entry into this Agreement and the consummation of the transactions contemplated by it will not:

(a) breach or conflict with any provision of its memorandum and articles of association or equivalent or result in a breach of, conflict with or constitute a default under any mortgage, indenture, agreement, other instrument or rules of any relevant stock exchange to which it is a party or by which it, or any of its properties or assets, is bound; or

(b) violate any order, judgement or decree of any court or governmental agency to which it is a party or by which it, or any of its properties or assets, is bound.

18 IP RIGHTS

18.1 Any Intellectual Property Rights held or owned by any Joint Venture Partner which are transferred, assigned, licensed or otherwise made available by to the Joint Venture shall remain the property of the transferring Joint Venture Partner (subject to the terms of the transfer, assignment, license or other applicable agreement), and shall not be used in any way by, and shall not confer any rights or interests on, any other Joint Venture Partner.

18.2 Any Intellectual Property Rights owned by the Joint Venture shall not be made available to a Joint Venture Partner solely by reason of the fact that it is a Joint Venture Partner. If the Joint Venture makes any such Intellectual Property Rights

32

available to a Joint Venture Partner, it shall only do so on commercial terms prescribed by the Board.

18.3 The Joint Venture Partners agree to establish, as soon as reasonably possible after the Completion Date, a co-branding strategy for the Joint Venture and its business. Each Joint Venture Partner agrees that it shall consider the reasonable requests of the Joint Venture to use its name, logo and other proprietary identifying marks on a non-exclusive basis for the purposes of co-branding, advertising or other promotions of the Joint Venture (but such obligation shall only be to consider such reasonable request, but not necessarily to grant any right in or to the same, the granting or withholding of such rights to be in the sole discretion of such Joint Venture Partner, it being acknowledged and agreed that all rights to the names "Petrojarl" and "Petrojarl Production" are to remain the property of Petrojarl and all rights to the name "Teekay" and the tag line "Teekay - The Marine Midstream Company" are to remain the property of Teekay).

19 CONFIDENTIALITY

19.1 For the purposes of this Clause, "CONFIDENTIAL INFORMATION" means:

19.1.1 the provisions of this Agreement or any document referred to in this Agreement;

19.1.2 in relation to the Joint Venture or a Joint Venture Partner or any member of the Teekay Group any information belonging or relating to the Joint Venture or a Joint Venture Partner or any member of the Teekay Group, its/their business, affairs, activities, products or services, which is disclosed by one party or an Affiliate (each a "Disclosing Party") to another party or an Affiliate (each a "Receiving Party") whether before or after the date of this Agreement. To fall within this definition, Disclosing Party must specify in writing which information is Confidential Information, and any disclosure in oral form shall not be subject to this Agreement, unless the oral disclosure is memorialized by Disclosing Party in a written document that is sent to Receiving Party within ten (10) Working Days from the date of disclosure;

33

19.2 During the term of this Agreement and for a period of three years after termination or expiration of this Agreement for any reason whatsoever each Receiving Party shall:

19.2.1 keep the Confidential Information confidential;

19.2.2 not disclose the Confidential Information to any other person other than with the prior written consent of the Disclosing Party or in accordance with Clauses 19.3 and 19.5; and

19.2.3 not use the Confidential Information for any purpose other than the performance of its obligations under this Agreement subject to Clauses 19.3 and 19.5.

19.3 During the term of this Agreement a Receiving Party may disclose the Confidential Information to

19.3.1 its directors, officers, employees, agents and advisers and to its Associated Companies and their directors, officers, employees, agents and advisers to the extent that it is necessary for the purposes of this Agreement or to enforce this Agreement; and

19.3.2 its financiers, the financiers of the Joint Venture, financiers to a member of the Teekay Group or the Petrojarl Group;

(each a "RECIPIENT")

19.4 The Receiving Party shall procure that each Recipient is made aware of and complies with all the Receiving Party's obligations of confidentiality under this Agreement as if the Recipient was a party to this Agreement.

19.5 The obligations contained in Clauses 19.1 to 19.4 shall not apply to any Confidential Information which:

19.5.1 is required to be disclosed by law or by a governmental authority or other authority with relevant powers to which the Receiving Party is subject provided that to the extent reasonably possible the disclosure shall be made after consultation with the Disclosing Party and after taking into

34

account the Disclosing Party's reasonable requirements as to its timing, content and manner of making or dispatch;

19.5.2 is required to be disclosed under the rules of any stock exchange on which the Joint Venture Partner or any member of its Group or debt instrument thereof are listed provided that to the extent reasonably possible the disclosure shall be made after consultation with the Disclosing Party and after taking into account the Disclosing Party's reasonable requirements as to its timing, content and manner of making or dispatch;

19.5.3 is at the date of this Agreement or at any time after the date of this Agreement comes into the public domain other than through breach of this Agreement by the Receiving Party or any Recipient;

19.5.4 can be shown by the Receiving Party to have been known to the Receiving Party prior to it being disclosed by the Disclosing Party to the Receiving Party;

19.5.5 subsequently comes lawfully into the possession of the Receiving Party from a third party that is not itself under a duty to maintain confidentiality; or

19.5.6 can be shown by the written records of the Receiving Party to have been independently developed by employees of the Receiving Party acting without access to the Confidential Information.

20 PUBLIC ANNOUNCEMENTS

20.1 No Joint Venture Partner shall make or send (and shall use reasonable endeavours to ensure that no associated company of such Joint Venture Partner makes or sends) a public announcement, communication or circular concerning the Joint Venture (an "ANNOUNCEMENT") unless it has first notified the other Joint Venture Partner.

20.2 Clause 20.1 shall not apply where a Joint Venture Partner reasonably determines that it is required by law or a rule of a stock exchange or by a governmental authority to make or send any Announcement prior to obtaining the agreement of the other Joint Venture Partner provided that the party has taken all reasonable steps

35

to provide the other party with an opportunity to comment on the Announcement prior to making or issuing the same.

21 ENFORCEMENT OF THE JOINT VENTURE'S RIGHTS

21.1 The following provisions of this clause 21 apply to any right of action which the Joint Venture may have or face in respect of the following:

21.1.1 an alleged breach of any Joint Venture Partner of this Agreement or any obligation owed to or by the Joint Venture; or

21.1.2 any alleged breach by any member of the Petrojarl Group or any member of the Teekay Group of a contract entered into between that party and the Joint Venture,

(each a "CONFLICTED ACTION").

21.2 Each Conflicted Action shall be prosecuted or defended by the directors of the Joint Venture appointed by the Non-Defaulting Joint Venture Partner and no director appointed by the Defaulting Joint Venture Partner shall be entitled to receive any document or other information relating to such dispute or any action taken in connection with such dispute. The directors appointed by the Non-Defaulting Joint Venture Partner shall have full authority on behalf of the Joint Venture to negotiate, litigate and settle any claim arising out of the alleged breach or exercise of any right of termination arising out of the alleged breach and the Joint Venture Partners shall take all steps within their power to give effect to the provisions of this Clause.

21.3 This clause is subject to, and shall not be construed as altering, the duties owed by directors to the Joint Venture.

21.4 In this clause 21:

"DEFAULTING JOINT VENTURE PARTNER" means the Joint Venture Partner the actions of which have given rise to, or which is involved in, the matters giving rise to, the cause of action and, where the cause of action arises from a breach of a contract between the Petrojarl Group or the Teekay Group and the Joint Venture, it means the Joint Venture Partner who is a member of that group; and

36

"NON-DEFAULTING JOINT VENTURE PARTNER" means the Joint Venture Partner who is not the Defaulting Joint Venture Partner in relation to the relevant cause of action.

22 ANCILLARY PROVISIONS

22.1 EXCLUSION OF LIABILITY

Except as provided by this Agreement, neither Joint Venture Partner shall in any circumstances whatsoever be under any liability to the other for any loss, damage or expenses sustained (whether or not caused by any negligence, default, want of care or breach of contract of such Joint Venture Partner, or of their servants or agents), unless and to the extent that such loss, damage, or expense arises as a result of any fraud or wilful misconduct committed by a Joint Venture Partner or a director nominated by a Joint Venture Partner to the Board.

22.2 WAIVER

No delay or failure by either Joint Venture Partner or the GP to exercise any of its powers, rights or remedies under this Agreement shall operate as a waiver of them, nor shall any single or partial exercise of any such powers, rights or remedies preclude any other or further exercise of them. The remedies provided in this Agreement are cumulative and not exclusive of any remedies provided by law. No waiver by any Party of any breach by any other Party of any provision of this Agreement shall be deemed to be a waiver of any subsequent breach of that or any other provision of this Agreement.

22.3 ASSIGNMENT

Except as otherwise expressly provided in this Agreement, no Party shall assign, encumber, dispose of or otherwise transfer its rights under this Agreement or its Partnership Interests, other than as permitted by clause 11 or purport to transfer any burden imposed on it under this Agreement, without the prior written consent of the other Parties, which may be withheld in their absolute discretion.

22.4 SEVERABILITY

If any part of this Agreement is found by any court or other competent authority to be invalid, unlawful or unenforceable then such part shall be severed from the

37

remainder of this Agreement which shall continue to be valid and enforceable to the fullest extent permitted by law.

22.5 COSTS AND EXPENSES

Each Joint Venture Partner shall pay its own costs and expenses incurred in the negotiation, preparation, execution, implementation and enforcement of this Agreement save that the costs of external counsel in establishing the LP and preparing this Agreement shall be shared equally by the Joint Venture Partners.

22.6 VALUE ADDED TAX

All sums payable under any term of this Agreement are exclusive of value added tax.

22.7 DOCUMENTARY TAXES

All applicable stamp duties and sales and transfer taxes which arise as a result of or in consequence of this Agreement shall be payable by the Joint Venture.

22.8 ENTIRE AGREEMENT

22.8.1 This Agreement and the documents referred to in it constitute the entire agreement and understanding between the Parties in relation to its subject matter.

22.8.2 Each of the Parties agrees that in entering into this Agreement, and the documents referred to in it, no Party may rely on, and shall have no right or remedy in respect of, any agreement, representation, warranty, statement, assurance or undertaking of any nature whatsoever (other than those expressly set out in this Agreement and the documents referred to in it) made by or given by any person prior to the date of this Agreement and all conditions, warranties or other terms implied by statute or common law are excluded to the fullest extent permitted by law. Nothing in this clause shall limit or exclude any liability for fraud.

22.8.3 Except as otherwise permitted by this Agreement, no change to its terms shall be effective unless it is in writing and signed by or on behalf of each of the Parties.

38

22.9 PARTNERSHIP

Nothing in this Agreement shall create or be deemed to create a partnership or the relationship of principal and agent or employer and employee between any of the Parties and no Party shall be responsible for the acts or omissions of the employees or representatives of the other Parties.

22.10 COUNTERPARTS

22.10.1 This Agreement may be executed in any one or more number of counterparts each of which, when executed, shall be deemed to form part of and together constitute this Agreement.

22.10.2 This Agreement shall be immediately binding and effective when each of the Parties has unconditionally executed either this Agreement or any of those counterparts, subject always to clause 14.3.

22.11 NOTICES

22.11.1 Any notice or other communication to be given under this Agreement shall (unless otherwise provided by this Agreement) be in writing and shall either be delivered by hand or sent by a generally recognised international courier service (with relevant fees prepaid) or facsimile transmission (provided that, in the case of facsimile transmission, the notice is confirmed by being delivered by hand or sent by recognised international courier service within two Working Days after transmission) as follows:

(a) (in the case of Petrojarl) to:

Address:                Petrojarl ASA
                        P O Box 82
                        N-7405 Trondheim
                        Norway

For the attention of:   Helge Krafft

Fax:                    +47 73 983014

(b) (in the case of Teekay) to:

Address:                C/O Teekay Shipping Corporation
                        Bayside House
                        Bayside Executive Park

39

                        West Bay Street and Blake Road
                        Nassau
                        The Bahamas

For the attention of:   General Counsel

Fax:                    +1224 502 8840

(c) (in the case of the GP) to:

Address:                c/o Teekay Shipping Corporation
                        Bayside House
                        Bayside Executive Park
                        West Bay Street and Blake Road
                        Nassau
                        The Bahamas

For the attention of:   General Counsel

Fax:                    +1 224 502 8840

22.11.2 A Party may change the address or facsimile number or the name of the person for whose attention notices are to be addressed by serving a notice on the others in accordance with this clause 22.11.

22.11.3 All notices shall be deemed to have been served as follows:-

(a) if delivered by hand, at the time of delivery;

(b) if sent (with relevant fees prepaid) by a generally recognised international courier service, at the expiration of two Working Days after the envelope containing the same was delivered into the custody of the relevant international courier; and

(c) if communicated by facsimile, six hours after the time of transmission;

PROVIDED that where, in the case of delivery by hand or by facsimile transmission, such delivery or transmission occurs after 5p.m. on a Working Day or on a day which is not a Working Day, service shall be deemed to occur at 9 a.m. on the next following Working Day.

40

22.11.4 In proving such service it shall be sufficient to prove that the envelope containing such notice was properly addressed and delivered either to the address shown thereon or into the custody of the relevant international courier or that a completed report confirming that such notice has been transmitted in full was received by the sender as the case may be.

22.12 GOVERNING LAW

This Agreement shall be construed and take effect in all respects in accordance with English law.

22.13 JURISDICTION

The Parties irrevocably agree, subject to the provisions of Clause 22.14, that the courts of England are to have jurisdiction to settle any disputes which may arise out of or in connection with this Agreement and that any proceedings may be brought in those courts. The Parties irrevocably waive any objection which they may now or in the future have to the laying of the venue of any proceedings in any court referred to in this Clause, and any claim that those proceedings have been brought in an inconvenient or inappropriate forum.

22.14 MEDIATION

If any dispute arises in connection with this Agreement, the Parties will attempt to settle it by mediation in accordance with the CEDR Model Mediation Procedure. Unless otherwise agreed between the Parties, the mediator will be nominated by CEDR. To initiate the mediation a party must give notice in writing ("ADR notice") to the other parties to the dispute requesting a mediation. A copy of the request should be sent to CEDR. The mediation will start not later than thirty (30) days after the date of the ADR notice. No Party may commence any court proceedings in relation to any dispute arising out of this Agreement until it has attempted to settle the dispute by mediation and either the mediation has terminated or the other party has failed to participate in the mediation, provided that the right to issue proceedings is not prejudiced by a delay.

41

22.15 SERVICE OF PROCESS

The Parties irrevocably agree that any writ, notice, judgment or other legal process shall be sufficiently served on them if addressed to them and left at or sent by post to the Address for Service, and in that event shall be conclusively deemed to have been served at the time of leaving or, if sent (with relevant fees prepaid) by a generally recognised international courier service, at 9.00 a.m. on the third Working Day after the envelope containing the same was delivered into the custody of the relevant international courier.

23 EXCLUSION OF CONTRACTS (RIGHTS OF THIRD PARTIES) ACT 1999

The parties to this Agreement do not intend any of its terms to be enforceable pursuant to the Contracts (Rights of Third Parties) Act 1999 by any person who is not a party to this Agreement.

This Agreement has been signed on the date first stated on page 1 above.

SIGNED by                    )
duly authorised for and on   )
behalf of PETROJARL JV AS    )
in the presence of:          )


SIGNED by                    )
duly authorised for and on   )
behalf of TEEKAY PETROJARL   )
OFFSHORE HOLDINGS L.L.C.     )
in the presence of:          )

TEEKAY PETROJARL GP L.L.C.

By: /s/ Kenneth Hvid, Attorney-in-fact
    ----------------------------------
Name:   Kenneth Hvid
      --------------------------------
Title:  Attorney in fact
       -------------------------------

42

SCHEDULE 1

PART A

(LIMITED PARTNERSHIP AGREEMENT OF LP)

43

SCHEDULE 1

PART B

(LIMITED LIABILITY COMPANY AGREEMENT OF GP)

44

SCHEDULE 2

(BUSINESS OF THE LP)

The owning and operation of FPSOs, FSOs and such other mobile production solutions as may be required by the oil industry from time to time. This will include but not be limited to:-

(i) marketing the LP;

(ii) identifying, defining and tendering for Projects;

(iii) executing, commissioning, operating and decommissioning Projects;

(iv) acquiring assets for Projects, converting such assets if required, and disposing of assets following completion of Projects (unless such assets are to be redeployed on other Projects);

(v) providing all related support activities and complying with all applicable legislative and regulatory requirements;

(vi) (at the request and cost of the relevant Joint Venture Partner) marketing the Petrojarl FPSOs and the Teekay FSOs.

45

SCHEDULE 3

(MAJOR DECISIONS)

1 Decisions to pursue a Project.

2 Decisions as to whether, and if so on what terms, to bid for a Project.

3 Any change in the Limited Partnership Agreement or Limited Liability Company Agreement.

4 Any variation, increase, reduction, redemption or repayment of any of the share capital or other change in the capital structure of the Joint Venture.

5 Any merger or other transaction resulting in a change of majority voting control or the sale of all or substantially all of the Joint Venture's assets.

6 Entering into any partnership, joint venture or profit-sharing arrangement with any person.

7 The making of any composition or arrangement with creditors of the Joint Venture or any Joint Venture Entity or the winding up or liquidation of the Joint Venture or any Joint Venture Entity or consenting to the appointment of a receiver or administrative receiver over the assets of the Joint Venture or any Joint Venture Entity.

8 Making any distribution of assets.

9 Altering the agreed dividend policy.

10 Entering into any contractual agreements or financial transactions with any member of the Petrojarl Group or any member of the Teekay Group other than chartering ships or buying services on arm's length terms.

11 The issue of any new equity, debenture or loan stock (whether secured or unsecured), or the granting of options or other instruments that entitle the holder to acquire new equity.

12 Any change in the business of the Joint Venture away from the Business.

13 Commencing litigation in the name of the Joint Venture or any Joint Venture Entity.

14 Renting or leasing premises for use by the Joint Venture for a term exceeding one year;

46

15 Issuing guarantees as provided in clause 5.

16 Engaging persons as employees of the Joint Venture.

17 Staffing of Projects.

18 Budgets for Projects/annual budgets and dealing with major deviations from budgets.

19 Competing with a Petrojarl FPSO or a Teekay FSO being redeployed.

20 Material acquisitions and disposals.

21 Borrowing sums in excess of one million Dollars (USD1,000,000).

47

SCHEDULE 4

DEED OF COVENANT

DATED: ____________ 200__

BETWEEN:

(1) [_______] [having its registered office/principal place of business] at
[_______] (the "Transferor");

(2) [_______] [having its registered office/principal place of business] at
[_______] (the "Transferee");

(3) TEEKAY PETROJARL GP L.L.C. [having its registered office/principal place of business] at [_______] (the "GP"); and

(4) [_______] [having its registered office/principal place of business] at
[_______] (the "Continuing Joint Venture Partner")

PRELIMINARY

This Agreement is supplemental to and entered into pursuant to clause [11.3] of the Joint Venture Partners' Agreement.

1 DEFINITIONS AND INTERPRETATION

In this Agreement, unless inconsistent with the context or otherwise defined:

1.1 the term "Joint Venture Partners' Agreement" means the agreement dated
[_______] 2006 (with schedules) made between (1) [the Continuing Joint Venture Partner/the Transferor] (2) [the Transferor/the Continuing Joint Venture Partner] and (3) the GP; and

1.2 all other words and phrases shall be defined and interpreted in accordance with the definitions and interpretation provisions contained in the Joint Venture Partners' Agreement.

2 COVENANT AND UNDERTAKING

2.1 The Transferee confirms that it has been supplied with a copy of the Joint Venture Partners' Agreement and covenants with each of the Continuing Joint Venture

48

Partner and the LP to observe, perform and be bound by all the terms of the Joint Venture Partners' Agreement which are capable of applying to the Transferee and which have not been performed at the date of this Agreement to the intent and effect that the Transferee shall be deemed with effect from [_______] to be a party to the Joint Venture Partners' Agreement and to be a holder of [_______] shares of
[_______] each in the GP.

2.2 The Transferee undertakes with the Transferor that it will enter into such Guarantees which the Transferor may have entered into and together with the Continuing Joint Venture Partner shall use all reasonable endeavours to obtain the release of the Transferor from such Guarantees as soon as reasonably practicable. Until such release is obtained the Transferee [together with the Continuing Joint Venture Partner] undertake[s] [on a joint and several basis] to indemnify and hold harmless the Transferor in respect of its continuing liability under such Guarantees.

2.3 Upon the Transferee being deemed to be a party to the Joint Venture Partners' Agreement in accordance with clause 2.1, the Transferor shall cease to be a party to the Joint Venture Partners' Agreement, provided that such cessation shall without prejudice to any rights or liabilities of the Continuing Joint Venture Partner, the Transferor or the GP which have then accrued.

3 REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES

The Transferee represents and warrants to each of the Transferor, the Continuing Joint Venture Partner and the GP as follows:

3.1.1 it is a [company/corporation] duly incorporated under the laws of
[_______] and has the corporate power and authority to accept the terms of this Agreement and perform its obligations under it;

3.1.2 its entry into this Agreement has been duly and validly authorised and all requisite corporate action has been taken in order to make such entry valid and binding upon it in accordance with the terms of this Agreement;

3.1.3 the entry into this Agreement and the consummation of the transactions contemplated by it will not:

49

(a) breach or conflict with any provision of its memorandum and articles of association or equivalent or result in a breach of, conflict with or constitute a default under any mortgage, indenture, agreement or other instrument to which it is a party or by which it, or any of its properties or assets, is bound; or

(b) violate any order, judgement or decree of any court or governmental agency to which it is a party or by which it, or any of its properties or assets, is bound.

4 REMAINING PROVISIONS

In all other respects, the terms of the Joint Venture Partners' Agreement shall continue in full force and effect. The provisions of clauses 22.13,
22.14 AND 22.15 of the Joint Venture Partners' Agreement shall apply to and be deemed to be incorporated into this Agreement.

5 EXCLUSION OF CONTRACTS (RIGHTS OF THIRD PARTIES) ACT 1999

The parties to this Agreement do not intend any of its terms to be enforceable pursuant to the Contracts (Rights of Third Parties) Act 1999 by any person who is not a party to this Agreement

This Agreement has been signed as a deed and delivered on the date first stated on page 1 above.

TEEKAY PETROJARL GP L.L.C.

By:
    ---------------------------------
Name:
      -------------------------------
Title:
       ------------------------------

THE COMMON SEAL of             )
THE TRANSFEREE was affixed     )
to this Deed in the presence   )
of:                            )


-------------------------------------
Director


-------------------------------------
Director/Secretary

50

THE COMMON SEAL of             )
the CONTINUING JOINT           )
VENTURE PARTNER                )
was affixed to this Deed       )
in the presence of:            )


-------------------------------------
Director


-------------------------------------
Director/Secretary

51

SCHEDULE 5

(BUDGET)

52

SCHEDULE 6

EXISTING UNITS

(A) Petrojarl FPSOs

(i) Petrojarl Foinaven;

(ii) Petrojarl I;

(iii) Ramform Banff;

(iv) Petrojarl Varg;

(v) Che Guavara

(B) Teekay FSOs

(i) Nordic Apollo

(ii) Karratha Spirit

(iii) Pattani Spirit

(iv) Dampier Spirit

(v) Su Tu Vang FSO (tbn)

53

SCHEDULE 7

SCHEDULE OF PETROJARL INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY

1 Title: Device by ship for production/test production of oil/gas from a field below seabed level

United States   Patent No. 6,199,500, granted 13 March 2001

Angola          Patent No. 104, granted 21 September 2001

Brazil          Pending Application P19808896-3, filed on 10 March 1998

China           Patent No. ZL98804994, granted 12 March 2003

Norway          Patent No. 308128, granted 31 July 2000

2 Title: Bearing System for a Turning Means

United States Patent No. 5,051,035, granted 24 September 1991

3 Title: System for Transferring Fluids from a Piping System in a Ship's Hull to a Turning Device, and Vice Versa

United States Patent No. 5,002,433, granted 26 March 1991

4 Management systems in the form of manuals, graphs etc created for use in Petrojarl.

5 Project studies concluded outside of the JV and not for the benefit of the JV.

6 Existing contracts between Petrojarl and its customers and vendors.

7 Topsides drawings and engineering studies for previous contracts not with the JV.

8 Conversion cost budgets for previous contracts not with the JV.

9 Business plans not relating to the business of the JV.

54

Execution Copy

DATED 14 JUNE 2006

(1) PETROJARL JV AS

(2) TEEKAY PETROJARL OFFSHORE HOLDINGS L.L.C.

(3) TEEKAY PETROJARL GP L.L.C.


JOINT VENTURE PARTNERS' AGREEMENT


STEPHENSON HARWOOD
ONE, ST PAUL'S CHURCHYARD
LONDON EC4M 8SH
TEL: 020 7329 4422
FAX: 020 7329 7100
REF: 819


CONTENTS

                                                                            PAGE
                                                                            ----
1  Definitions and Interpretation........................................     2
2  Preliminary Formalities...............................................    11
3  Board of Directors of GP..............................................    12
4  Management and Staff..................................................    14
5  Objective and Conduct of Business.....................................    15
6  Guarantees and Indemnities............................................    16
7  Budgets, Accounts and Finance.........................................    17
8  Support Services and Supplies.........................................    21
9  Tax treatment.........................................................    22
10 Distribution of profits...............................................    22
11 Partnership Interest Transfers........................................    22
12 Mutual Undertakings Concerning the LP.................................    24
13 Deliberately not used.................................................    27
14 Commencement and Termination..........................................    27
15 Deadlock..............................................................    28
16 Restrictions..........................................................    30
17 Representations and Warranties........................................    32
18 IP Rights.............................................................    32
19 Confidentiality.......................................................    33
20 Public Announcements..................................................    35
21 Enforcement of the Joint Venture's rights.............................    36


22 Ancillary Provisions..................................................    37
23 Exclusion of Contracts (Rights of Third Parties) Act 1999.............    42


EXHIBIT 21.1

SCHEDULE A


Teekay Offshore Operating GP L.L.C.         TK Nordic Holdings Inc. (MI)

Teekay Offshore Operating L.P.              Nordic Apollo L.L.C. (MI)

Norsk Teekay Holding Ltd. (Marshall         KS Nordic Apollo AS* (Norway)
Islands, or "MI")
                                            SUST III DA* (Norway)
Teekay European Holdings SARL
(Luxembourg)                                Teekay Offshore Australia Trust (MI)

Teekay Netherlands European Holdings        Pattani Spirit L.L.C. (MI)
 BV (Netherlands)
                                            Stena Spirit L.L.C. (Isle of Man)*
Norsk Teekay AS (Norway)
                                            Nordic Rio L.L.C. (MI)*
Teekay Norway AS (Norway)

Ugland Nordic Shipping AS (Norway)

PARTREDERIAVTALE for P/R STENA
UGLAND Shuttle Tankers I DA (or

"SUST I DA")* (Norway)

SUST II DA* (Norway)

Navion Offshore Loading AS (Norway)

Teekay Navion Offshore Loading Pte.
Ltd. (Singapore)


* Shared Ownership


EXHIBIT 23.1

CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC
ACCOUNTING FIRM

We consent to the reference to our firm under the caption "Experts" and to the use of our report dated August 25,2006 relating to the combined consolidated financial statements of Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor and our reports each dated September 6, 2006 relating to the balance sheets of Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C. and Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. in the Registration Statement (Form F-1) and related Prospectus of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. for the registration of 7,000,000 common units.

Vancouver, Canada                                         /s/ ERNST + YOUNG LLP
December 1, 2006                                          Chartered Accountants


December 1, 2006

Stockholders of Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor

We are aware of the use in the Registration Statement (Form F-1) of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. for the registration of 7,000,000 common units of our report dated August 25, 2006 relating to the unaudited combined consolidated interim financial statements of Teekay Offshore Partners Predecessor.

/s/ ERNST + YOUNG LLP
Chartered Accountants


EXHIBIT 23.4

CLARKSONS
St. Magnus House 3 Lower Thames Street London EC3R6HE [LOGO]
+44 (0) 20 7334 0000 www.clarksons.com

30th November 2006

Teekay Offshore Partners L.P.
Bayside House, Bayside Executive Park
West Bay Street and Blake Road
P.O. Box AP-59213
Nassau, Commonwealth of the Bahamas

Ladies & Gentlemen:

Reference is made to the Form F-1 registration statement (the "Registration Statement") relating to the initial public offering of common units of limited partner interests of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. (the "Company"). We hereby consent to all references to our name in the Registration Statement and to the use of the statistical information supplied by us set forth in sections of the Registration Statement entitled "Industry". We further advise the Company that our role has been limited to the provision of such statistical data supplied by us. With respect to such statistical data, we advise you that:

o some information in our database is derived from estimates or subjective judgments;

o the information in the database of other maritime data collection agencies may differ from the information in our database; and

o while we have taken reasonable care in the compilation of the statistical information and believe it to be accurate and correct, data compilation is subject to limited audit and validation procedures and may accordingly contain errors.

We hereby consent to the filing of this letter as an exhibit to the Registration Statement of the Company; on Form F-1 to be filed with the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission pursuant to the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and to the reference to our firm in the section of the Prospectus entitled "Industry and Market Data."

CLARKSON RESEARCH SERVICES LIMITED

By: /s/ C.J. Tyler
    -----------------
    Name:  C.J. Tyler
    Title: Director


EXHIBIT 23.5


DOUGLAS-WESTWOOD

29th August 2006

Teekay Offshore Partners L.P.
Bayside House, Bayside Executive Park
West Bay Street and Blake Road
P.O. Box AP-59213
Nassau, Commonwealth of the Bahamas

Ladies and Gentlemen:

Reference is made to the Form F-1 registration statement (the "Registration Statement") relating to the initial public offering of common units of limited partner interests of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. (the "Company"). We hereby consent to all references to our name in the Registration Statement and to the use of the statistical information supplied by us set forth in sections of the Registration Statement entitled "Industry," and "Business." We further advise the Company that our role has been limited to the provision of such statistical data supplied by us. With respect to such statistical data, we advise you that:

o some information in our database is derived from estimates or subjective judgments;

o the information in the database of other maritime data collection agencies may differ from the information in our database; and

o while we have taken reasonable care in the compilation of the statistical information and believe it to be accurate and correct, data compilation is subject to limited audit and validation procedures and may accordingly contain errors.

We hereby consent to the filing of this letter as an exhibit to the Registration Statement of the Company on Form F-1 to be filed with the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission pursuant to the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and to the reference to our firm in the section of the Prospectus entitled "Industry and Market Data."

DOUGLAS WESTWOOD

By:  /s/ John Westwood
     -----------------
Name: John Westwood
Title: Managing Director


EXHIBIT 23.6

[Wood Mackenzie Letterhead]

Date : 3 November 2006

Teekay Offshore Partners L.P.
Bayside House, Bayside Executive Park
West Bay Street and Blake Road
P.O. Box AP-59213
Nassau, Commonwealth of the Bahamas

Ladies and Gentlemen:

Reference is made to the Form F-l registration statement (the "Registration Statement") relating to the initial public offering of common units of limited partner interests of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. (the "Company"). We hereby consent to the reference to our name in the Registration Statement and to the use of the statistical information supplied by us set forth in section of the Registration Statement entitled "Business." We further advise the Company that our role has been limited to the provision of such statistical data supplied by us. With respect to such statistical data, we advise you that:

o some information in our database is derived from estimates or subjective judgments;

o the information in the database of other maritime data collection agencies may differ from the information in our database; and

o while we have taken reasonable care in the compilation of the statistical information and believe it to be accurate and correct, data compilation is subject to limited audit and validation procedures and may accordingly contain errors.

We hereby consent to the filing of this letter as an exhibit to the Registration Statement of the Company on Form F-1 to be filed with the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission pursuant to the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and to the reference to our firm in the section of the Prospectus entitled "Industry and Market Data."

Wood Mackenzie

By: /s/ Stephen Scullion
    --------------------
    Name: Stephen Scullion
    Title: Head of Energy Research


EXHIBIT 23.7

[IMA LOGO] INTERNATIONAL MARITIME ASSOCIATES, INC.
1250 24TH STREET NW, SUITE 350--WASHINGTON, DC 20037 USA--TEL: 202-333-8501-- FAX: 202-333-8504--E-MAIL: IMAASSOC@MSN.COM--WEBSITE: WWW.IMASTUDIES.COM

August 28, 2006

Teekay Offshore Partners L.P.
Bayside House, Bayside Executive Park
West Bay Street and Blake Road
P.O. Box AP-59213
Nassau, Commonwealth of the Bahamas

Ladies and Gentlemen:

Reference is made to the Form F-1 registration statement (the "Registration Statement") relating to the initial public offering of common units of limited partner interests of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. (the "Company"). We hereby consent to all references to our name in the Registration Statement and to the use of the statistical information supplied by us set forth in sections of the Registration Statement entitled "Industry," and "Business." We further advise the Company that our role has been limited to the provision of such statistical data supplied by us. With respect to such statistical data, we advise you that:

- some information in our database is derived from estimates or subjective judgments;

- the information in the database of other maritime data collection agencies may differ from the information in our database; and

- while we have taken reasonable care in the compilation of the statistical information and believe it to be accurate and correct, data compilation is subject to limited audit and validation procedures and may accordingly contain errors.

We hereby consent to the filing of this letter as an exhibit to the Registration Statement of the Company on Form F-1 to be filed with the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission pursuant to the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and to the reference to our firm in the section of the Prospectus entitled "Industry and Market Data."

INTERNATIONAL MARITIME
ASSOCIATES, INC.

/s/ James R. McCaul

James R. McCaul
President


EXHIBIT 23.8

[R.S. PLATOU SHIPBROKERS A.S LETTERHEAD]

TK Shipping (Canada)                            Department:       Tanker
Att: Quin Dawson, Investment Banking Manager    Telephone direct: 23 11 24 08
Suite 2000, Bentall 5                           Telefax:          23 11 23 22

550 Burrard Street E-mail Internet: tnk@platou.com Vancouver BC
Canada V6C 2K2

Our ref.: JTB / JTB OSLO, 06.07.06

SHUTTLE TANKER FLEET INFORMATION

Dear Sir,

With reference to statistics provided by R. S. Platou Shipbrokers as, Oslo, describing the World Shuttle Tanker Fleet, we are pleased to confirm that TK Shipping is authorized to copy this information for use in graphs and presentations provided a proper reference to the source is made.

Yours sincerely,
for R.S. Platou Shipbrokers a.s

/s/ Dag E. Sandberg

Dag E. Sanderberg


EXHIBIT 99.1

CONSENT OF DIRECTOR NOMINEE

I hereby consent to being named as a director nominee of Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C., a Marshall Island's limited liability company, in the Registration Statement on Form F-1 of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. (including the prospectus contained therein), and in all subsequent amendments and post-effective amendments or supplements thereto, filed with the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission.

Dated: November 30, 2006



Signature: /s/ David L. Lemmon
           -------------------
             David L. Lemmon


EXHIBIT 99.2

CONSENT OF DIRECTOR NOMINEE

I hereby consent to being named as a director nominee of Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C., a Marshall Island's limited liability company, in the Registration Statement on Form F-1 of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. (including the prospectus contained therein), and in all subsequent amendments and post-effective amendments or supplements thereto, filed with the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission.

Dated: November 30, 2006



Signature: /s/ Carl Mikael L.L. von Mentzer
           --------------------------------
             Carl Mikael L.L. von Mentzer


EXHIBIT 99.3

CONSENT OF DIRECTOR NOMINEE

I hereby consent to being named as a director nominee of Teekay Offshore GP L.L.C., a Marshall Island's limited liability company, in the Registration Statement on Form F-1 of Teekay Offshore Partners L.P. (including the prospectus contained therein), and in all subsequent amendments and post-effective amendments or supplements thereto, filed with the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission.

Dated: November 30, 2006



Signature: /s/ John J. Peacock
           -------------------
             John J. Peacock